CLI Descriptions ML 6600

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 1158

CLI Descriptions

MINI-LINK 6693

Description

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L


Copyright

© Ericsson AB 2018, 2019. All rights reserved. No part of this document may be
reproduced in any form without the written permission of the copyright owner.

Disclaimer

The contents of this document are subject to revision without notice due to
continued progress in methodology, design and manufacturing. Ericsson shall
have no liability for any error or damage of any kind resulting from the use of this
document.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Contents

Contents

1 Introduction 1

2 Typographic Conventions 2

3 CLI Command Definition Structure 4

4 Installation Mode Commands 5


4.1 copy 5
4.2 disable 6
4.3 enable 6
4.4 erase startup-config 7
4.5 investigation-mode 7
4.6 reload 7
4.7 show backplane 8
4.8 show config-validation-info 8
4.9 show version 9
4.10 telecom-standard 9

5 Basic and Navigation Commands 11


5.1 ? 11
5.2 TAB 12
5.3 cli compatibility 13
5.4 configure 14
5.5 disable 14
5.6 enable 15
5.7 in-service 15
5.8 ping 16
5.9 ping6 18
5.10 ssh 20
5.11 telnet 21
5.12 traceroute 22
5.13 traceroute6 23
5.14 write 24

6 User Access Commands 26


6.1 investigation-mode 26

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CLI Descriptions

7 Firewall Commands 27
7.1 clear iptables 28
7.2 clear ip6tables 28
7.3 close ip 29
7.4 close6 ip 30
7.5 close msm 31
7.6 close netman 31
7.7 close ping 32
7.8 close6 ping 32
7.9 close PORT 33
7.10 close6 PORT 34
7.11 close syn_cookies 35
7.12 open ip 35
7.13 open6 ip 36
7.14 open msm 37
7.15 open netman 38
7.16 open ping 38
7.17 open6 ping 39
7.18 open PORT 39
7.19 open6 PORT 40
7.20 open syn_cookies 41

8 Security Commands 43
8.1 aaa accounting network 45
8.2 aaa authentication login 46
8.3 ftp active ntp-key-server 47
8.4 ntp get-ntp-key 47
8.5 ntp set-ntp-protocol 48
8.6 passwd 48
8.7 radius-server 49
8.8 restart 51
8.9 secure-ssh 52
8.10 set_radius_address_Type 53
8.11 set_tacacs_address_Type 53
8.12 setbruteforcethreshold 54
8.13 setcliprotocol 55
8.14 setenablelocalusers 55

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Contents

8.15 setlegalnotice 56
8.16 setlocaluseridletimer 56
8.17 setsecureprotocols 57
8.18 setsnmpv3authprotocol 58
8.19 setsnmpv3privprotocol 59
8.20 setsnmpv3protocol 59
8.21 setstrongpasswd 60
8.22 set-file-integrity-alarm 61
8.23 set ssh_keys 61
8.24 snmp-server access 62
8.25 snmp-server community 63
8.26 snmp-server trap 64
8.27 tacacs-server 66

9 Software, Configuration, and Log File Handling Commands 68


9.1 activate 68
9.2 autobackup 69
9.3 copy 70
9.4 erase startup-config 71
9.5 ftp active 71
9.6 ftp activeftp 73
9.7 ftp server 73
9.8 reload 75

10 License Handling Commands 77


10.1 add 78
10.2 license install 78
10.3 license restrict-unlocked-period 79
10.4 license request 80
10.5 license unlockedperiod enter 80
10.6 license unlockedperiod exit 81
10.7 modify 82
10.8 remove 82
10.9 reset 83
10.10 upload 83

11 License Handling Commands in Monitoring Mode 85


11.1 add 85

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CLI Descriptions

11.2 license monitoring 86


11.3 modify 87
11.4 monitoring-auto-unlock 87
11.5 remove 88
11.6 reset 88

12 Basic Configuration Commands 90


12.1 clock set 90
12.2 config-changed-timer 91
12.3 ntp server 92
12.4 snmp-server syscontact 93
12.5 snmp-server syslocation 93
12.6 snmp-server sysname 94
12.7 snmp-server trapenable 95
12.8 sys_notes 95
12.9 timezone 96

13 DCN Basic Commands 98


13.1 dcn-lan-ctag 98
13.2 dcn-mode 99
13.3 pingtargethost 100

14 LAN-DCN IP Commands 102


14.1 lan-dcn ip dhcp relayaddress 102
14.2 lan-dcn ip domainname 103
14.3 lan-dcn ip dscp 104
14.4 lan-dcn ip name-server 104
14.5 lan-dcn ip route 105

15 LAN-DCN IPv6 Commands 107


15.1 lan-dcn ipv6 dhcp relayaddress 107
15.2 lan-dcn ipv6 domainname 108
15.3 lan-dcn ipv6 dscp 109
15.4 lan-dcn ipv6 name-server 109
15.5 lan-dcn ipv6 route 110

16 LAN-DCN Interface Commands 112


16.1 interface ip 112
16.2 interface lan-dcn 113
16.3 ip address 113

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Contents

16.4 ipv6 address 114


16.5 mtu 115
16.6 trapenable 116

17 DCN Loopback Interface Commands 117


17.1 interface lo-dcn 117
17.2 ip address 118
17.3 ipv6 address 119

18 DCN Local Access (USB) Interface Commands 121


18.1 interface local-access 121
18.2 ipv6 address 122
18.3 pingtargethost 123
18.4 shutdown 123

19 Router Basic Commands 125


19.1 access-list 127
19.2 capability 129
19.3 debug 130
19.4 match as-path 131
19.5 match community 132
19.6 match extcommunity 133
19.7 match interface 134
19.8 match ip address 135
19.9 match ip address prefix-list 136
19.10 match ip next-hop 136
19.11 match ip next-hop prefix-list 137
19.12 match ip peer 138
19.13 match metric 139
19.14 match origin 139
19.15 match route-type 141
19.16 match tag 141
19.17 router-id 142
19.18 route-map 143
19.19 set aggregator 144
19.20 set as-path 145
19.21 set atomic-aggregate 145
19.22 set comm-list 146

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CLI Descriptions

19.23 set community 147


19.24 set dampening 148
19.25 set extcommunity 149
19.26 set extcomm-list 150
19.27 set ip next-hop 151
19.28 set level 151
19.29 set local-preference 152
19.30 set metric 153
19.31 set metric-type 153
19.32 set origin 154
19.33 set originator-id 155
19.34 set tag 156
19.35 set vpnv4 next-hop 156
19.36 set weight 157

20 Router IP Commands 159


20.1 clear arp-cache 160
20.2 ip host interface 160
20.3 ip host mtu 161
20.4 ip prefix-list 162
20.5 ip route 164
20.6 ip vrf 165

21 IP VRF Commands 167


21.1 description 167
21.2 rd 168
21.3 route-target 168

22 Serial (PPP) Interface Commands 170


22.1 interface serial 170
22.2 ip address 171
22.3 ip unnumbered 172
22.4 mru 173
22.5 shutdown 173
22.6 trapenable 174

23 Router Loopback Interface Commands 175


23.1 interface ip lo 175
23.2 ip address 176

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Contents

24 L3 Interface Commands 178


24.1 interface ip 179
24.2 ip address 180
24.3 ip unnumbered 181
24.4 ip vrf forwarding 181
24.5 l3enable (VLAN) 182
24.6 l3enable (Ethernet Port) 183
24.7 mtu 184
24.8 name 185
24.9 shutdown 185
24.10 trapenable 186

25 BFD Configuration Commands 187


25.1 bfd multihop-peer 187

26 BFD Interface Commands 189


26.1 bfd disable 189
26.2 bfd interval 190
26.3 bfd session 191
26.4 bfd slow-timer 191

27 OSPF Configuration Commands 193


27.1 area authentication 195
27.2 area default-cost 196
27.3 area filter-list 196
27.4 area multi-area-adjacency 197
27.5 area nssa 198
27.6 area range 200
27.7 area shortcut 201
27.8 area stub 202
27.9 area virtual-link 203
27.10 auto-cost 205
27.11 bfd all-interfaces 205
27.12 clear ip ospf 206
27.13 compatible 206
27.14 default-information 207
27.15 default-metric 208
27.16 distance 209

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CLI Descriptions

27.17 distribute-list 210


27.18 domain-id 211
27.19 dscp 212
27.20 enable db-summary-opt 213
27.21 host 213
27.22 neighbor 214
27.23 network 215
27.24 ospf abr-type 216
27.25 ospf router-id 217
27.26 passive-interface 218
27.27 redistribute 219
27.28 router ospf 220
27.29 router-id 221
27.30 summary-address 221
27.31 timers 222

28 OSPF Interface Commands 224


28.1 ip ospf authentication 225
28.2 ip ospf authentication-key 226
28.3 ip ospf bfd 226
28.4 ip ospf cost 227
28.5 ip ospf databse-filter 228
28.6 ip ospf dead-interval 229
28.7 ip ospf disable 229
28.8 ip ospf hello-interval 230
28.9 ip ospf message-digest-key 230
28.10 ip ospf mtu 231
28.11 ip ospf mtu-ignore 232
28.12 ip ospf network 233
28.13 ip ospf priority 234
28.14 ip ospf retransmit-interval 234
28.15 ip ospf transmit-delay 235

29 IS-IS Commands 236


29.1 accept-lifetime 238
29.2 area-password 239
29.3 authentication key-chain 240
29.4 authentication mode 241

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Contents

29.5 authentication send-only 242


29.6 bfd all-interfaces 243
29.7 clear clns is-neighbors 244
29.8 clear clns neighbors 244
29.9 clear ip isis 245
29.10 clear isis 245
29.11 domain-password 246
29.12 ip route high-priority 247
29.13 is-type 247
29.14 key 248
29.15 key chain 249
29.16 key-string 250
29.17 lsp-gen-interval 251
29.18 lsp-mtu 252
29.19 lsp-refresh-interval 253
29.20 max-area-address 253
29.21 max-lsp-lifetime 254
29.22 metric-style 255
29.23 net 256
29.24 redistribute 257
29.25 router isis 258
29.26 send-lifetime 259
29.27 set-overload-bit 260
29.28 spf-interval-exp 262
29.29 summary-address 263

30 IS-IS Interface Commands 264


30.1 ip router isis 265
30.2 isis authentication key-chain 266
30.3 isis authentication mode 267
30.4 isis authentication send-only 268
30.5 isis circuit-type 269
30.6 isis csnp-interval 270
30.7 isis hello 271
30.8 isis hello-interval 272
30.9 isis hello-multiplier 273
30.10 isis metric 274

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CLI Descriptions

30.11 isis network 275


30.12 isis password 276
30.13 isis priority 277
30.14 isis retransmit-interval 278
30.15 isis tag 278
30.16 isis wide-metric 279

31 LDP Configuration Commands 281


31.1 advertisement-mode 283
31.2 clear ldp adjacency 284
31.3 clear ldp session 285
31.4 clear ldp statistics 285
31.5 control-mode 286
31.6 dscp 287
31.7 explicit-null 287
31.8 global-merge-capability 288
31.9 hello-interval 289
31.10 hold-time 289
31.11 import-bgp-routes 290
31.12 inter-area-lsp 290
31.13 keepalive-interval 291
31.14 keepalive-timeout 292
31.15 label-retention-mode 292
31.16 ldp-optimization 293
31.17 loop-detection 294
31.18 loop-detection-hop-count 294
31.19 loop-detection-path-vec-count 295
31.20 neighbor auth md5 password 295
31.21 multicast-hellos 296
31.22 propagate-release 297
31.23 request-retry 297
31.24 request-retry-timeout 298
31.25 router ldp 299
31.26 router-id 299
31.27 targeted-peer hello-interval 300
31.28 targeted-peer hold-time 300
31.29 transport-address ipv4 301

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Contents

32 LDP Interface Commands 303


32.1 disable-ldp 304
32.2 enable-ldp 304
32.3 ldp advertisement-mode 305
32.4 ldp hello-interval 306
32.5 ldp hold-time 307
32.6 ldp keepalive-interval 307
32.7 ldp keepalive-timeout 308
32.8 ldp label-retention-mode 309
32.9 ldp multicast-hellos 309
32.10 mpls ldp-igp sync 310
32.11 mpls ldp-igp sync-delay 311

33 BGP Commands 312


33.1 address-family 316
33.2 aggregate-address 318
33.3 auto-summary 319
33.4 bgp additional-paths install 319
33.5 bgp dampening 320
33.6 bgp default ipv4-unicast 321
33.7 bgp default local-preference 322
33.8 bgp inbound-route-filter 323
33.9 bgp nexthop-trigger delay 323
33.10 bgp nexthop-trigger enable 324
33.11 clear bgp * 324
33.12 clear bgp ASN 325
33.13 clear bgp external 326
33.14 clear bgp ipv4 327
33.15 clear bgp peer-group 328
33.16 default-information 329
33.17 distance bgp 330
33.18 dscp 331
33.19 ip as-path access-list 332
33.20 ip community-list (standard) 332
33.21 ip community-list (expanded) 334
33.22 ip extcommunity-list (standard) 335
33.23 ip extcommunity-list (expanded) 336

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CLI Descriptions

33.24 neighbor activate 336


33.25 neighbor advertisement-interval 337
33.26 neighbor allow-ebgp-vpn 338
33.27 neighbor allowas-in 339
33.28 neighbor as-origination-interval 340
33.29 neighbor as-override 340
33.30 neighbor attribute-unchanged 341
33.31 neighbor capability dynamic 342
33.32 neighbor capability orf 343
33.33 neighbor capability route-refresh 344
33.34 neighbor collide-established 344
33.35 neighbor default-originate 345
33.36 neighbor description 346
33.37 neighbor disallow-infinite-holdtime 346
33.38 neighbor dont-capability-negotiate 347
33.39 neighbor ebgp-multihop 348
33.40 neighbor enforce-multihop 348
33.41 neighbor fall-over bfd 349
33.42 neighbor filter-list 350
33.43 neighbor local-as 351
33.44 neighbor maximum-prefix 352
33.45 neighbor next-hop-self 353
33.46 neighbor override-capability 354
33.47 neighbor passive 354
33.48 neighbor password 355
33.49 neighbor peer-group 356
33.50 neighbor port 356
33.51 neighbor prefix-list 357
33.52 neighbor remote-as 358
33.53 neighbor remove-private-as 359
33.54 neighbor route-reflector-client 359
33.55 neighbor route-server-client 360
33.56 neighbor send-community 361
33.57 neighbor shutdown 362
33.58 neighbor soft-reconfiguration inbound 363
33.59 neighbor soo 364
33.60 neighbor strict-capability-match 364

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Contents

33.61 neighbor timers 365


33.62 neighbor update-source 366
33.63 neighbor version 367
33.64 neighbor weight 368
33.65 network 369
33.66 redistribute 370
33.67 router bgp 371
33.68 synchronization 371
33.69 timers bgp 372

34 MPLS Basic Commands 374


34.1 ping mpls 374
34.2 traceroute mpls 376

35 MPLS Configuration Commands 379


35.1 mpls ac-group 380
35.2 mpls admin-groups 381
35.3 mpls bfd 382
35.4 mpls disable-all-interfaces 383
35.5 mpls egress-ttl 384
35.6 mpls enable-all-interfaces 384
35.7 mpls ftn-entry 385
35.8 mpls ilm-entry pop 386
35.9 mpls ilm-entry swap 387
35.10 mpls ilm-entry vpnpop 389
35.11 mpls ingress-ttl 390
35.12 mpls label mode 391
35.13 mpls label-range 392
35.14 mpls map-route 392
35.15 mpls propagate-ttl 393
35.16 mpls traffic-eng 394

36 MPLS Interface Commands 395


36.1 label-switching 395

37 RSVP-TE Commands 397


37.1 <IPADDR> 400
37.2 ack-wait-timeout 401
37.3 clear rsvp session 401

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CLI Descriptions

37.4 clear rsvp statistics 402


37.5 clear rsvp trunk 403
37.6 detour-identification 404
37.7 dscp 405
37.8 explicit-null 405
37.9 ext-tunnel-id 406
37.10 from <IPADDR> 406
37.11 hello-interval 407
37.12 hello-timeout 408
37.13 keep-multiplier 409
37.14 loop-detection 409
37.15 map-route 410
37.16 mpls traffic-eng reoptimize 411
37.17 php 411
37.18 primary affinity 412
37.19 primary exclude-any 412
37.20 primary fast-reroute exclude-any 413
37.21 primary fast-reroute hop-limit 414
37.22 primary fast-reroute include-any 414
37.23 primary fast-reroute protection one-to-one 415
37.24 primary hop-limit 415
37.25 primary include-any 416
37.26 primary label-record 417
37.27 primary path 417
37.28 primary record 418
37.29 refresh-path-parsing 419
37.30 refresh-resv-parsing 419
37.31 refresh-time 420
37.32 reoptimize-lockdown 421
37.33 reoptimize timers frequency 421
37.34 router rsvp 422
37.35 rsvp-path 423
37.36 rsvp-trunk 423
37.37 rsvp-trunk-restart 424
37.38 select-preference 425
37.39 to <IPADDR> 425

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Contents

38 RSVP-TE Interface Commands 427


38.1 admin-group 428
38.2 disable-rsvp 429
38.3 enable-rsvp 429
38.4 rsvp ack-wait-timeout 430
38.5 rsvp bfd 431
38.6 rsvp hello 431
38.7 rsvp hello-interval 432
38.8 rsvp hello-timeout 433
38.9 rsvp keep-multiplier 433
38.10 rsvp refresh-reduction 434
38.11 rsvp refresh-time 434

39 DCN Remote Syslog Commands 436


39.1 rsyslog enable 436
39.2 rsyslog server 437
39.3 rsyslog6 server 437
39.4 rsyslog trapseverity 438

40 Security Remote Syslog Commands 440


40.1 rsyslogsec enable 441
40.2 rsyslogsec events auditlog globalsettings 441
40.3 rsyslogsec events localauth 442
40.4 rsyslogsec events login 443
40.5 rsyslogsec events protocols 443
40.6 rsyslogsec events radius 444
40.7 rsyslogsec events tacacs 445
40.8 rsyslogsec server 446
40.9 rsyslogsec6 server 447

41 Radio Link Terminal Commands: MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 -


RLT 448
41.1 aes-encryption-oth 449
41.2 aes-encryption-oth-mk 450
41.3 eqp-protection-switch-mode 450
41.4 eqp-active-unit 451
41.5 expected-far-end-id 452
41.6 fade-notification-timer 452
41.7 far-end-id-check 453

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CLI Descriptions

41.8 ferlt 454


41.9 id 455
41.10 manual-switch 455
41.11 mode 456
41.12 protection-switch-mode 457
41.13 reset 457
41.14 reset-tx-switch-alarm 458
41.15 revertive-preferred-tx 459
41.16 revertive-wait-to-restore 459
41.17 rlt 460
41.18 tx-switch-far-end 460

42 Radio Link Terminal Commands: MMU 1002 - XPIC 462


42.1 mode 462
42.2 xpic 463
42.3 xpic-auto-restore 464
42.4 xpic-recovery 464
42.5 xpic-restore 465

43 Radio Link Terminal Commands: MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 -


TDM 467
43.1 fetdm 467
43.2 rx-loop 468
43.3 tdm 469
43.4 tdm-connect 469
43.5 wanted-tdm-tributaries-allocation 470

44 Carrier Termination Commands: MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 472


44.1 ct 472
44.2 farend 473

45 Carrier Termination Commands: MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 -


Carrier 474
45.1 auto-remove-loop 475
45.2 ber-alarm-threshold 475
45.3 carrier-id 476
45.4 continuous_wave_mode 477
45.5 description 478
45.6 frame-id 478
45.7 if-loop 479

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Contents

45.8 polarization 479


45.9 reference-sec 480
45.10 reset 481
45.11 restore 482
45.12 rf-loop 482
45.13 sel-minAcm-maxAcm-Rsec 483
45.14 selected-max-acm 485
45.15 selected-min-acm 487
45.16 wanted-licensed-capacity 489

46 Carrier Termination Commands: MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 -


Frequency 490
46.1 duplex-configuration 490
46.2 duplex-distance 491
46.3 rx-frequency 492
46.4 tx-admin-status 492
46.5 tx-frequency 493

47 Carrier Termination Commands: MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 -


Spectrum Diagnostics 495
47.1 spectrum_diagnostics scan_start 495
47.2 spectrum_diagnostics scan_stop 496

48 Carrier Termination Commands: MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 -


Power 497
48.1 input-power-alarm-threshold 497
48.2 selected-max-output-power 498
48.3 selected-min-output-power 499
48.4 selected-output-power 499
48.5 selected-output-power-type 500
48.6 taps 501
48.7 target-input-power-far-end 501

49 Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Interfaces 503


49.1 alarm-enable 504
49.2 autoneg 504
49.3 flowcontrol 505
49.4 interface ethernet 506
49.5 lan 506
49.6 lock-to-service 507

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CLI Descriptions

49.7 mdix 507


49.8 name 508
49.9 qos 508
49.10 shutdown 509
49.11 speed 509
49.12 sync-enable 510
49.13 trapenable 511
49.14 wan 512

50 Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Bridging and Switching 513


50.1 add 514
50.2 add-egressports 516
50.3 add-untagged-ports 517
50.4 bridge mode 517
50.5 bridge-port 518
50.6 bridge tp-agingtime 518
50.7 clear mac-address-table 519
50.8 egressports 520
50.9 ethernet-epl 521
50.10 fdb 522
50.11 forward-unregistered-multicast 522
50.12 llf-enable 523
50.13 maxfs 523
50.14 name 524
50.15 port-ether-type 525
50.16 qinqtermination 525
50.17 remove 526
50.18 role 527
50.19 static-multicast 528
50.20 static-unicast 528
50.21 untagged-ports 529
50.22 vlan 530
50.23 vlans 531
50.24 vlan-statistics-enable 532

51 Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Ring Protection 533


51.1 alarm 534
51.2 clear-counters 534

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Contents

51.3 description 535


51.4 enable 535
51.5 erp-group 536
51.6 erp-port 537
51.7 mode 538
51.8 propagateTC 538
51.9 raps 539
51.10 switchover 540
51.11 timer 541
51.12 traffic-channel 542

52 Ethernet Commands: RSTP 544


52.1 spanning-tree admin-edgeport 545
52.2 spanning-tree admin-pointtopoint 545
52.3 spanning-tree autoedge 546
52.4 spanning-tree enable 547
52.5 spanning-tree force-version 547
52.6 spanning-tree forward-delay 548
52.7 spanning-tree mac-enable 549
52.8 spanning-tree max-age 549
52.9 spanning-tree max-hops 550
52.10 spanning-tree path-cost 551
52.11 spanning-tree port-enable 551
52.12 spanning-tree port-priority 552
52.13 spanning-tree priority 552
52.14 spanning-tree protocol-migration 553
52.15 spanning-tree restricted-role 554
52.16 spanning-tree restricted-tcn 554
52.17 spanning-tree transmit-holdcount 555
52.18 spanning-tree type 555

53 Ethernet Commands: MSTP 557


53.1 instance 557
53.2 name 558
53.3 revision 559
53.4 reset 560
53.5 spanning-tree cist-path-cost 560
53.6 spanning-tree mst path-cost 561

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CLI Descriptions

53.7 spanning-tree mst port-enable 561


53.8 spanning-tree mst priority 562

54 Ethernet Commands: Security and Admission Control 564


54.1 admit 565
54.2 bridge customer-BPDU 566
54.3 bridge l2cpmacdesttunnel 567
54.4 bridge l2cppriority 567
54.5 ethernet-alarms 568
54.6 forbidden-egressports 568
54.7 l2cp 569
54.8 loop-alarm 573
54.9 maclearning (per port) 574
54.10 mac-whitelist 575
54.11 max-learned-addresses 575
54.12 stormctrl bc 576
54.13 stormctrl dlf 577
54.14 stormctrl mc 578
54.15 stormctrl maxbcbw 578
54.16 stormctrl maxdlfbw 579
54.17 stormctrl maxmcbw 580

55 Ethernet Commands: Buffering 582


55.1 deep-buffering 582

56 Ethernet Commands: Traffic Classes 583


56.1 bridge priority-mapping map 583
56.2 bridge priority-mapping type 584

57 Ethernet Commands: QoS - Aging 586


57.1 bridge aging 586
57.2 bridge aging enable 587

58 Ethernet Commands: QoS - Scheduling 588


58.1 bridge scheduler-profile 589
58.2 ethernet-profiles 589
58.3 name 590
58.4 scheduler-profile 590
58.5 scheduler-profile 591
58.6 tc-scheduler-type-and-weight 592

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Contents

59 Ethernet Commands: QoS - WRED 593


59.1 exponentWeight 594
59.2 maxThreshold 594
59.3 minThreshold 595
59.4 name 596
59.5 p-mark 596
59.6 wred-profile 597

60 Ethernet Commands: QoS - Queue-Set 599


60.1 bridge queue-set-profile 599
60.2 name 600
60.3 queue-set-profile 601
60.4 queue-set-profile 601
60.5 tc-queue 602

61 Ethernet Commands: QoS - Policing and Color Marking 604


61.1 cbs 605
61.2 cir 606
61.3 default-cos 606
61.4 ebs 607
61.5 eir 608
61.6 mode 608
61.7 policing 609
61.8 policing-bandwidth-profile 609
61.9 policing-cos-group 610
61.10 policing-cos-group-mapping 611
61.11 policing-vlan-group 611
61.12 policing-vlan-group-mapping 612
61.13 pol-cos-and-cos-group 612
61.14 pol-cos-group-and-bandwidth-profile 613
61.15 pol-vlan-and-vlan-group 614
61.16 pol-vlan-group-and-bandwidth-profile 614
61.17 port-bandwidth-profile 615

62 Ethernet Commands: QoS - Port Shaping 616


62.1 shaper 616

63 Ethernet Commands: HQoS - Node and Profile Configuration


Commands 618

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CLI Descriptions

63.1 child-node 619


63.2 hqos-node 620
63.3 hqos-profile 622
63.4 h-scheduler 623
63.5 map 624
63.6 name 625
63.7 order 626
63.8 shaper 626

64 Ethernet Commands: HQoS - Profile Assignment Commands 628


64.1 hqos-profile 628

65 Ethernet Commands: Diagnostics Tools 630


65.1 mirror mirrored-port 630
65.2 mirror mode 630
65.3 mirror mtp-vlan 631

66 Ethernet Commands: Classification and Tagging 633


66.1 bridge network-pcp-selection 633
66.2 cep-pvid 634
66.3 cvid-registration 635
66.4 default-network-priority 635
66.5 trusted 636
66.6 user-priority-mapping 637

67 Ethernet Commands: LAG 639


67.1 alarm-enable-degraded-service 640
67.2 alarm-enable-no-traffic 640
67.3 alarm-enable-unable-to-protect 641
67.4 clear lag counters 641
67.5 hash-type 642
67.6 lacp activity 643
67.7 lacp controlmode 643
67.8 lacp lag-sys-priority 644
67.9 lacp max-delay 645
67.10 lacp revertive 646
67.11 lacp timeout 646
67.12 lag 647
67.13 members 647

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Contents

68 Ethernet Commands: LLDP 649


68.1 admin-status 650
68.2 clear counters 651
68.3 clear lldp counters 651
68.4 lldp dest-mac-address nearest-bridge 652
68.5 lldp message-fast-tx 652
68.6 lldp message-tx-hold-multiplier 653
68.7 lldp message-tx-interval 654
68.8 lldp notification-enable 654
68.9 lldp notification-interval 655
68.10 lldp tx-fast-init 656
68.11 tlvs-tx-enable 656

69 Ethernet Commands: L1 Bonding 658


69.1 alarm-enable-degraded-service 658
69.2 alarm-enable-no-traffic 659
69.3 enable-dynamic-vlan-mapping 659
69.4 l1-bonding 661
69.5 mapping 661
69.6 members 664
69.7 set-dynamic-vlan-mapping-list 665

70 TDM Cross-Connection Commands 666


70.1 connect-cc 666

71 CES Commands 668


71.1 ces server 670
71.2 ces tdm-profile 670
71.3 clock-recovery-mode 671
71.4 description 671
71.5 encap 672
71.6 jitter-buffer-playout-level 673
71.7 jitter-buffer-size 673
71.8 lops-clear-threshold 674
71.9 lops-set-threshold 674
71.10 mac-address 675
71.11 name (PW) 675
71.12 name (TDM Profile) 676

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CLI Descriptions

71.13 pw 676
71.14 packet-reorder 677
71.15 packet-replace-policy 678
71.16 payload-size 679
71.17 payload-suppression 679
71.18 receive-ecid 680
71.19 remote-mac 680
71.20 shutdown 681
71.21 tdm-profile 681
71.22 timing-input 682
71.23 transmit-ecid 683
71.24 trapenable 683
71.25 vlanid 684
71.26 vlan-priority 684

72 Performance Monitoring Commands 686


72.1 clear 687
72.2 clear-if-counters 687
72.3 ethernet-pm 688
72.4 ethernet-pm clear-all 689
72.5 pm 689
72.6 pmalarmview 690
72.7 pm15minsetthreshold 690
72.8 pm24hsetthreshold 692
72.9 pm-start-time 694

73 TWAMP Commands 696


73.1 twamp-reflector-light 696
73.2 twamp reset-statistics 698

74 Ethernet MAC White List Commands 699


74.1 ethernet-mac-whitelist 699
74.2 mac 700
74.3 name 700

75 ETU 1002 Commands: Equipment 702


75.1 board 702

76 LTU 1002 Commands: Equipment 704


76.1 activeunit 704

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Contents

76.2 board 705


76.3 controller xfprotection-equipment 706
76.4 mode 706
76.5 trapenable 707

77 LTU 1002 Commands: SDH STM-1 709


77.1 admstatus 709
77.2 controller sdhstm1porttable 710

78 LTU 1002 Commands: Line 712


78.1 controller xfprotection-line 712
78.2 working-rx 713

79 LTU 1002 Commands: RS 714


79.1 am-severity-lof 714
79.2 am-severity-tim 715
79.3 am-severity-uastne 716
79.4 controller rsttp 717
79.5 enable-pm-point 718
79.6 if-link-trap-enabled 718
79.7 name 719
79.8 reset-cur-15min-ne-regs 720
79.9 reset-cur-24h-ne-regs 720
79.10 trail-trace-enabled 721
79.11 trail-trace-expected 721
79.12 trail-trace-send 722

80 LTU 1002 Commands: MS 724


80.1 am-severity-ais 725
80.2 am-severity-deg 726
80.3 am-severity-exc 727
80.4 am-severity-k2mis 727
80.5 am-severity-rdi 728
80.6 am-severity-uastfe 729
80.7 am-severity-uastne 730
80.8 controller msttp 731
80.9 degm 731
80.10 degthr 732
80.11 enable-pm-point 733

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CLI Descriptions

80.12 if-link-trap-enabled 733


80.13 lineloop 734
80.14 name 735
80.15 rei 735
80.16 reset-cur-15min-fe-regs 736
80.17 reset-cur-15min-ne-regs 736
80.18 reset-cur-24h-fe-regs 737
80.19 reset-cur-24h-ne-regs 737
80.20 squelch 738

81 LTU 1002 Commands: MSP 740


81.1 am-severity-ais 741
81.2 am-severity-deg 741
81.3 am-severity-exc 742
81.4 am-severity-k2mis 743
81.5 am-severity-rdi 744
81.6 am-severity-uastfe 745
81.7 am-severity-uastne 746
81.8 controller msp 746
81.9 enable-pm-point 747
81.10 if-link-trap-enabled 748
81.11 name 748
81.12 reset-cur-15min-fe-regs 749
81.13 reset-cur-15min-ne-regs 749
81.14 reset-cur-24h-fe-regs 750
81.15 reset-cur-24h-ne-regs 751

82 LTU 1002 Commands: AU-4 and VC-4 752


82.1 controller au4ctp-vc4ttp 753
82.2 degm 754
82.3 degthr 754
82.4 if-link-trap-enabled 755
82.5 name 755
82.6 trail-trace-enabled 756
82.7 trail-trace-expected 757
82.8 trail-trace-send 757
82.9 vc4-am-severity-ais 758
82.10 vc4-am-severity-deg 759

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Contents

82.11 vc4-am-severity-exc 760


82.12 vc4-am-severity-lom 760
82.13 vc4-am-severity-lop 761
82.14 vc4-am-severity-plm 762
82.15 vc4-am-severity-rdi 763
82.16 vc4-am-severity-tim 764
82.17 vc4-am-severity-uastfe 765
82.18 vc4-am-severity-uastne 765
82.19 vc4-am-severity-uneq 766
82.20 vc4-enable-pm-point 767
82.21 vc4-reset-cur-15min-fe-regs 768
82.22 vc4-reset-cur-15min-ne-regs 768
82.23 vc4-reset-cur-24h-fe-regs 769
82.24 vc4-reset-cur-24h-ne-regs 770

83 LTU 1002 Commands: VC-12 771


83.1 am-severity-ais 772
83.2 am-severity-deg 773
83.3 am-severity-exc 774
83.4 am-severity-lom 775
83.5 am-severity-lop 775
83.6 am-severity-plm 776
83.7 am-severity-rdi 777
83.8 am-severity-tim 778
83.9 am-severity-uastfe 779
83.10 am-severity-uastne 780
83.11 am-severity-uneq 780
83.12 controller vc12ttp 781
83.13 degm 782
83.14 degthr 782
83.15 enable-pm-point 783
83.16 if-link-trap-enabled 784
83.17 name 784
83.18 reset-cur-15min-fe-regs 785
83.19 reset-cur-15min-ne-regs 785
83.20 reset-cur-24h-fe-regs 786
83.21 reset-cur-24h-ne-regs 787

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CLI Descriptions

83.22 trail-trace-enabled 787


83.23 trail-trace-expected 788
83.24 trail-trace-send 788

84 Synchronization Commands 790


84.1 assigned-qlevel 790
84.2 holdoff-time 792
84.3 lockout 792
84.4 network-synch enable 793
84.5 network-synch forced-switch 793
84.6 network-synch node-clock 794
84.7 network-synch nominee 794
84.8 network-synch selection-mode 795
84.9 network-synch squelch 796
84.10 priority 796
84.11 signal-degrade 797
84.12 wait-to-restore-time 797

85 Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: General


Configuration 799
85.1 alarm-enable 800
85.2 clear ptp clock-port statistics 801
85.3 clock 801
85.4 clock-local-priority 802
85.5 clock-port 803
85.6 domain 804
85.7 event-enable 804
85.8 holdover-timeout 805
85.9 interface 806
85.10 link-delay-compensation 807
85.11 log-clock-servo 807
85.12 network-synch-assistance 808
85.13 priority1 809
85.14 priority2 809
85.15 ptp 810
85.16 sync-port 810

86 Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: Clock Port


Configuration 812

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Contents

86.1 delay-mechanism 813


86.2 dscp 813
86.3 enabled 814
86.4 inner-tag 814
86.5 interface 815
86.6 ip-interface 816
86.7 local-priority 816
86.8 multicast-configuration 817
86.9 not-slave 817
86.10 port 818
86.11 unicast-configuration 819
86.12 vlan 819
86.13 vlan-priority 820

87 Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: Unicast and


Multicast Configuration 821
87.1 announce-interval 822
87.2 announce-timeout 823
87.3 delay-resp-interval 823
87.4 delay-resp-timeout 824
87.5 duration 825
87.6 min-delay-req-interval 826
87.7 query-interval 827
87.8 sync-interval 828
87.9 sync-timeout 828
87.10 unicast-master 829
87.11 wait-to-restore-time 830

88 Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: Unicast Master


Configuration 831
88.1 address 831
88.2 enabled 832
88.3 local-priority 832

89 Ethernet Service OAM Commands: General Configuration 834


89.1 cfm 834
89.2 soam logmask 834

90 Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Maintenance Domain


Configuration 836

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CLI Descriptions

90.1 md 836

91 Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Maintenance Association


Configuration 838
91.1 interface-tlv-enable 838
91.2 ma 839
91.3 port-tlv-enable 840

92 Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Maintenance End Point and


Maintenance Intermediate Point Configuration 842
92.1 alarm 842
92.2 mep 843
92.3 mep-list 845
92.4 mip 845

93 Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Linktrace and Loopback


Configuration 847
93.1 ccm-enable 847
93.2 ccm-state-update-enable 848
93.3 linktrace 849
93.4 loopback 849
93.5 pm 850

94 Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Ethernet Bandwidth


Notification 852
94.1 bandwidth-notification 853
94.2 enable 853
94.3 failed-link-message 854
94.4 format 854
94.5 full-link-speed-message 855
94.6 hold-time 856
94.7 interface 856
94.8 interval 857
94.9 level 857
94.10 port-id 858
94.11 priority 859
94.12 send-frequently-after-hold-time 859
94.13 send-options 860

95 Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Session Configuration 861


95.1 dm 861

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Contents

96 IGMP and MLD Snooping Commands 863


96.1 clear snooping counters 864
96.2 igmp snooping config-clear 865
96.3 igmp snooping enable 865
96.4 igmp snooping vlan 866
96.5 immediate-leave 867
96.6 mfib alarm-enable 868
96.7 mld snooping config-clear 869
96.8 mld snooping enable 869
96.9 mld snooping vlan 870
96.10 proxy-reporting 871
96.11 query-interval 871
96.12 robust 873

97 SFP Commands 874


97.1 alarm-threshold 874
97.2 als 875
97.3 reset 877
97.4 select 877
97.5 sfp 878
97.6 shutdown 879
97.7 trapenable 879

98 Report Commands 881


98.1 bug-report 881
98.2 generate-report 883

99 Show Commands 884


99.1 show (PW) 896
99.2 show (Ethernet alarms) 897
99.3 show (license) 897
99.4 show (license monitoring) 898
99.5 show aaa accounting network default group 900
99.6 show aaaPolicyStatus 901
99.7 show access-list 901
99.8 show alarms 902
99.9 show arp 902
99.10 show backplane 903

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CLI Descriptions

99.11 show bandwidth-notification 904


99.12 show bandwidth-notification brief 905
99.13 show bgp 906
99.14 show bgp community 907
99.15 show bgp community-list 908
99.16 show bgp dampening 909
99.17 show bgp filter-list 910
99.18 show bgp inconsistent-as 911
99.19 show bgp ipv4 911
99.20 show bgp label mode globals 912
99.21 show bgp mpls label mode 913
99.22 show bgp neighbors 913
99.23 show bgp nexthop-tracking 914
99.24 show bgp nexthop-tree-details 915
99.25 show bgp paths 916
99.26 show bgp prefix-list 916
99.27 show bgp quote-regexp 917
99.28 show bgp regexp 918
99.29 show bgp summary 919
99.30 show bgp vpnv4 all 920
99.31 show bgp vpnv4 details 920
99.32 show bgp vpnv4 rd 921
99.33 show bgp vpnv4 vrf 922
99.34 show board 922
99.35 show bridge-basics 924
99.36 show bridge-port 925
99.37 show bridge-port 925
99.38 show capability vrf-lite 926
99.39 show carrier-termination 926
99.40 show carrier-termination-capability 927
99.41 show ces server 928
99.42 show ces tdm-profile 930
99.43 show cfm alarms 931
99.44 show cfm ma 932
99.45 show cfm md 932
99.46 show cfm mep 933
99.47 show cfm mep-peer 934

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Contents

99.48 show cfm mip 935


99.49 show cliprotocol 936
99.50 show clns is-neighbors 937
99.51 show clns neighbors 938
99.52 show clock 939
99.53 show config 939
99.54 show config-changed-timer 940
99.55 show config-validation-info 940
99.56 show confirm 941
99.57 show confirm timer 942
99.58 show connect-cc 943
99.59 show copy 944
99.60 show counters 944
99.61 show current 945
99.62 show dcn-mode 948
99.63 show dcn-lan-ctag 948
99.64 show debug 949
99.65 show dm 950
99.66 show enableLocalUsers 951
99.67 show epl 952
99.68 show erp-group 952
99.69 show ferlt 953
99.70 show fetdm 954
99.71 show file-integrity-alarm 955
99.72 show ftpprotocol 955
99.73 show ftp active 956
99.74 show ftp activeftp 956
99.75 show ftp configtable 957
99.76 show history 957
99.77 show igmp snooping 958
99.78 show igmp snooping config 958
99.79 show igmp snooping group 959
99.80 show igmp snooping mrouter 960
99.81 show igmp snooping vlan 961
99.82 show interface 962
99.83 show interface (PTP) 965
99.84 show interface ethernet 966

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CLI Descriptions

99.85 show interface ethernet-pm 967


99.86 show interface ethernet status 968
99.87 show interface ip 969
99.88 show interface serial 971
99.89 show investigation-mode 972
99.90 show ip forwarding 973
99.91 show ip host interface 973
99.92 show ip host mtu 974
99.93 show ip interface host 974
99.94 show ip isis igp-shortcut-lsp 975
99.95 show ip isis route 976
99.96 show ip isis route igp-shortcut 977
99.97 show ip ospf 977
99.98 show ip ospf border-routers 978
99.99 show ip ospf database 979
99.100 show ip ospf igp-shortcut-lsp 980
99.101 show ip ospf igp-shortcut-route 981
99.102 show ip ospf interface 982
99.103 show ip ospf multi-area-adjacencies 983
99.104 show ip ospf neighbor 983
99.105 show ip ospf route 984
99.106 show ip ospf virtual-links 985
99.107 show ip prefix-list 986
99.108 show ip route 986
99.109 show ip vrf 988
99.110 show iptables 989
99.111 show ip6tables 989
99.112 show isis counter 990
99.113 show isis database 991
99.114 show isis interface 992
99.115 show isis topology 994
99.116 show l1-bonding 994
99.117 show lag 995
99.118 show lag lacpstats 996
99.119 show lag status 996
99.120 show lan-dcn 998
99.121 show lan-dcn ip 999

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Contents

99.122 show lan-dcn ipv6 1000


99.123 show lan-dcn ipv6 dhcp relayaddress 1001
99.124 show lan-dcn ipv6 dhcp status 1002
99.125 show ldp 1002
99.126 show ldp adjacency 1003
99.127 show ldp downstream 1004
99.128 show ldp fec 1005
99.129 show ldp inter-area-fecs 1006
99.130 show ldp interface 1007
99.131 show ldp lsp 1008
99.132 show ldp session 1009
99.133 show ldp statistics 1010
99.134 show ldp targeted-peers 1011
99.135 show ldp upstream 1012
99.136 show legalnotice 1013
99.137 show license install status 1013
99.138 show license restrict-unlocked-period 1014
99.139 show license status 1014
99.140 show license status ports 1016
99.141 show license unlockedperiod 1017
99.142 show license upload status 1018
99.143 show linktrace 1019
99.144 show lldp config 1020
99.145 show lldp counters 1021
99.146 show lldp local-info 1022
99.147 show lldp neighbors 1023
99.148 show local-info 1024
99.149 show localuseridletimer 1024
99.150 show loopback 1025
99.151 show mac-address-table 1026
99.152 show mac-whitelist 1027
99.153 show memory 1028
99.154 show mfib status 1029
99.155 show mld snooping 1029
99.156 show mld snooping config 1030
99.157 show mld snooping group 1031
99.158 show mld snooping mrouter 1032

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CLI Descriptions

99.159 show mld snooping vlan 1033


99.160 show mpls 1034
99.161 show mpls cross-connect-table 1035
99.162 show mpls forwarding-table 1035
99.163 show mpls ftn-table 1036
99.164 show mpls ilm-table 1037
99.165 show mpls in-segment-table 1038
99.166 show mpls interface 1038
99.167 show mpls ldp 1039
99.168 show mpls mapped-routes 1041
99.169 show mpls out-segment-table 1041
99.170 show mpls vc-table 1042
99.171 show mpls vrf-table 1043
99.172 show mst 1044
99.173 show neighbors 1044
99.174 show netstat 1045
99.175 show network-synch status 1046
99.176 show notification-log 1047
99.177 show ntp-status 1047
99.178 show pingtargethost 1048
99.179 show policing 1049
99.180 show policing-bandwidth-profile 1049
99.181 show policing-cos-groups 1050
99.182 show policing-cos-group-mapping 1051
99.183 show policing-vlan-groups 1051
99.184 show policing-vlan-group-mapping 1052
99.185 show processes 1053
99.186 show ptp alarms-and-events 1053
99.187 show ptp clock 1054
99.188 show ptp clock current-ds 1055
99.189 show ptp clock default-ds 1055
99.190 show ptp clock parent-ds 1056
99.191 show ptp clock settings 1057
99.192 show ptp clock time-properties-ds 1057
99.193 show ptp clock-port 1058
99.194 show ptp config 1060
99.195 show ptp interface 1061

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Contents

99.196 show ptp peers 1062


99.197 show ptp sync 1063
99.198 show qos 1064
99.199 show queue-set-profile 1064
99.200 show radius_address_Type 1065
99.201 show radius-server config 1065
99.202 show radius-server statistics 1066
99.203 show radius-server status 1067
99.204 show rf-frequency 1068
99.205 show rf-power 1069
99.206 show rlt 1070
99.207 show route-map 1071
99.208 show router-id 1072
99.209 show rsvp 1072
99.210 show rsvp admin-groups 1073
99.211 show rsvp interface 1073
99.212 show rsvp neighbor 1074
99.213 show rsvp nexthop-cache 1075
99.214 show rsvp path 1075
99.215 show rsvp session 1076
99.216 show rsvp session count 1076
99.217 show rsvp session egress 1077
99.218 show rsvp session ingress 1078
99.219 show rsvp session <LSP-NAME> 1079
99.220 show rsvp session transit 1080
99.221 show rsvp statistics 1080
99.222 show rsvp summary-refresh 1081
99.223 show rsvp trunk 1081
99.224 show rsvp version 1082
99.225 show rsyslog 1082
99.226 show rsyslog6 1083
99.227 show rsyslogsec 1084
99.228 show rsyslogsec6 1085
99.229 show running-config 1086
99.230 show running-config router 1087
99.231 show rx-frequency 1088
99.232 show scheduler-profile 1089

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CLI Descriptions

99.233 show secure-ssh 1089


99.234 show sfph 1090
99.235 show slot-capacity 1092
99.236 show snmpv3authprotocol 1093
99.237 show snmpv3privprotocol 1093
99.238 show snmpv3protocol 1094
99.239 show spanning-tree 1095
99.240 show spectrum-diagnostics-result 1096
99.241 show spectrum-diagnostics-status 1096
99.242 show startup-config 1097
99.243 show status 1098
99.244 show strongpasswd 1100
99.245 show subrack 1100
99.246 show system 1101
99.247 show sys_notes 1101
99.248 show tacacs_address_Type 1102
99.249 show tacacs-server config 1103
99.250 show tacacs-server statistics 1103
99.251 show tacacs-server status 1104
99.252 show taps 1105
99.253 show tdm 1106
99.254 show tdm-interfaces 1106
99.255 show temp 1107
99.256 show timezone 1108
99.257 show twamp sessions 1108
99.258 show twamp statistics 1109
99.259 show tx-frequency 1110
99.260 show userio 1110
99.261 show version 1111
99.262 show vlan 1112
99.263 show wred-profile 1112
99.264 show x 1113
99.265 show xpic 1114

100 Appendix 1115


100.1 DCN over IPv4 Address Limitations 1115
100.2 DCN over IPv6 Address Limitations 1117

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Introduction

1 Introduction

This description provides detailed information about all Command Line Interface
(CLI) commands for MINI-LINK 6693 with NPU 1002 or NPU 1003.

For an introduction to the CLI and installation instructions, see CLI User Guide.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1


CLI Descriptions

2 Typographic Conventions

Typographic conventions for the command syntax used in this document are
given in the following table.

Table 1 Typographic Conventions

Convention Description Example


Monospaced A command string entered on the ML66>show ip forwarding
font command line or a system response.
IP forwarding is off
Lowercase An option - often specifying the part of show networks
the system that a command will affect.
It must be typed exactly as shown.
Uppercase, An operand - specifying, for example, a telnet <HOST>
often within remote host to which the command
angle brackets creates a connection. The user must
type a valid value in place of the
operand.
| Delimits options or operands. Do not { events | status | timers }
enter the vertical bar as part of the
command.
{} Contains options or operands. Select { events | status | timers }
one from the list. Do not enter the
curved brackets as part of the
command.
[] Contains optional options or operands. [ detail | recv | send ]
Select none, one, or more from the list.
Do not enter the square brackets as
part of the command.
= Separates, for example, an operand <PROCESSID = 0-65535>
from a text string indicating
appropriate values. Do not enter the
equal sign as part of the command.
"" Operands must be surrounded by ML66(config)#network-synch
quotation marks in the examples if the nominee "1/4/1 NS"
operand contains space characters.
// Indicates that a line in an output Interface lo//
example was too long to fit the page Hardware is//
and has been wrapped. Loopback index 1//
metric 1 mtu//
16436 duplex-half//
arp ageing timeout 0

2 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Typographic Conventions

Convention Description Example


! Indicates that a line is a comment line ! In Global Configuration
and ignored by CLI. mode, configure adaptive
modulation

Note: Unless otherwise stated, press Enter after each command entry.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 3


CLI Descriptions

3 CLI Command Definition Structure

In the following sections, all CLI commands are described using the same
structure. This structure is divided into subsections as shown in the following
table.

Table 2 Sections

Section Name Description Mandatory?


Synopsis Contains the syntax of the command. The syntax is Yes
defined using the following templates:
<command name>
<command name> <OPERAND>
<command> { <option1> | <option2> | <option3> }
<command> [ <option1> | <option2> | <option3> ]
Many commands accept the option no placed before the
main command word. Using this option typically cancels
the effects of an earlier use of the command.
Example:
[no] ip domainname <DOMAINNAME>
For more information on typographic convections, see
Typographic Conventions on page 2.
Description Describes the purpose of the command and how it is Yes
used. If the command accepts the common no option,
this is mentioned in this section.
Command Mode Lists the command modes in which the command is Yes
available and can be used.
Options Lists relevant options together with an explanation. No
Options often specify the part of the system that a
command will affect.
Operands Lists relevant operands together with an explanation. No
Operands specify, for example, a remote host to which
the command creates a connection.
Examples Gives examples of how to use the command together Yes
with the system response (if any).
See Also Contains references to related commands. No

4 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Installation Mode Commands

4 Installation Mode Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table 3.

The following command modes are applicable for the installation mode
commands:

— Exec Installation mode

— Privileged Exec Installation mode

Table 3 Installation Mode Commands Overview


copy copy configuration files
disable exit from Privileged Exec Installation mode
to Exec Installation mode
enable change to Privileged Exec Installation mode
from Exec Installation mode
erase startup-config erase the startup configuration file
investigation-mode enable additional troubleshooting
possibilities for Ericsson engineers
reload reload on the selected configuration
show backplane display configuration information for a
backplane
show config-validation-info display the configuration information list
show version display software and hardware revision
information
telecom-standard select ETSI or ANSI standard

4.1 copy

Synopsis
copy ftp filename <FILENAME> startup-config

Description
Use this command to copy a configuration file from an FTP server to startup
configuration file. To copy load modules and SBLs, see copy on page 70.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 5


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Privileged Exec Installation mode

Operands

FILENAME The name of the file on the FTP to copy.

Examples
Copying a configuration file from on FTP server to startup configuration file:
ML66(installation-mode)#copy ftp filename Config1 startup-config

4.2 disable

Synopsis
disable

Description
Use this command to exit from Privileged Exec Installation mode to Exec
Installation mode.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec Installation mode

Examples
Exiting from Privileged Exec Installation mode:
ML66(installation-mode)#disable
ML66(installation-mode)>

4.3 enable

Synopsis
enable

Description
Use this command to switch to Privileged Exec Installation mode from Exec
Installation mode.

6 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Installation Mode Commands

Command Mode
Exec Installation mode

Examples
Switching to Privileged Exec Installation mode:
ML66(installation-mode)>enable
ML66(installation-mode)#

4.4 erase startup-config


For a detailed description of this command, see erase startup-config on page
71.

4.5 investigation-mode

Synopsis
investigation-mode

Description
Use this command to temporarily enable additional troubleshooting possibilities
for Ericsson engineers in Installation mode.

For enabling additional troubleshooting possibilities in operational mode, see


investigation-mode on page 26.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec Installation mode

Examples
Enabling additional troubleshooting possibilities in installation mode:
ML66(installation-mode)#investigation-mode

4.6 reload

Synopsis
reload [ rmm | ftp ]

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 7


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to exit installation mode and reload the configuration file. Use
the options to load configuration from an alternative source instead of current
startup-config.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec Installation mode

Options

rmm Restarts on configuration stored on Removable Memory


Module (RMM).

ftp Restarts on configuration downloaded from FTP.

Examples
Reloading the configuration from RMM and exiting from Installation mode:
ML66(installation-mode)#reload rmm

4.7 show backplane


For a detailed description of this command, see show backplane on page 903.

4.8 show config-validation-info

Synopsis
In Exec Installation mode:

— show config-validation-info source current

In Privileged Exec Installation mode:

— show config-validation-info source { ftp | rmm }

Description
Use this command to view information about the configuration file copied to the
node before applying the configuration.

Command Mode
Exec Installation mode and Privileged Exec Installation mode

8 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Installation Mode Commands

Options

current Current startup configuration.

ftp Configuration file from local FTP.

rmm Configuration file from Removable Memory Module


(RMM).

Examples
Displaying startup-configuration on local FTP:
ML66(installation-mode)#show config-validation-info source ftp
----------------------------------------
File: Loaded from FTP
----------------------------------------
NE Name: ML66-192-168-0-1
Created: Default
----------------------------------------
DCN Settings
IP Host address: 10.80.45.214
IP Host Subnet Mask: 255.255.255.0
IPv6 Host address: 2006::12
IPv6 Host prefix length: 128
----------------------------------------
Hardware Inventory
Backplane Product Number: ROJR 609 006/1
Backplane Revision: R1E

Position Product Number Release


1 ROJR 219 014/1 R1A
3 ROJ 208 357/1 R1A
4 ROJ 208 357/1 R1C
7 ROJR 211 006/2 R1A
8 ROJR 211 007/1 P1B
----------------------------------------

4.9 show version


For a detailed description of this command, see show version on page 1111.

4.10 telecom-standard

Synopsis
telecom-standard { etsi | ansi }

Description
Use this command to select ANSI or ETSI standard.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 9


CLI Descriptions

Note: Configuring the telecom standard clears the startup configuration file
and causes a warm restart of the NE. Plug-in units not supporting the
configured telecom standard are set Out of Service.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec Installation mode

Options

etsi Selects ETSI standard.

ansi Selects ANSI standard.

Examples
Selecting ETSI standard:
ML66(installation-mode)#telecom-standard etsi

10 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Basic and Navigation Commands

5 Basic and Navigation Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table 4.

The following command modes are applicable for the basic and navigation
commands:

— Exec mode — >

— Privileged Exec mode — #

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

Table 4 Basic and Navigation Commands Overview


? display help
TAB complete commands and display help
cli compatibility switch to or from CLI compatibility mode
configure change to Global Configuration mode
disable exit from Privileged Exec mode to Exec mode
enable change to Privileged Exec mode from Exec
mode
in-service set physical unit to in service
ping ping an IP remote host
ping6 ping an IPv6 remote host
ssh initiate a Secure Shell (SSH) connection to a
remote host
telnet initiate a telnet connection to a remote host
traceroute verify IP routing
traceroute6 verify IPv6 routing
write confirm configuration changes that could
disturb traffic

5.1 ?

Synopsis
?

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 11


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to display help for commands, options, and operands. Like
TAB, but unlike other commands, ? runs without pressing Enter.

Command Mode
All modes

Examples
Displaying help for all commands in a command mode:
ML66(config)#?
memory
snmp-server Configure SNMPv3
autobackup Enable automatic configure file backup
config-changed-timer Config changed event timer
sys_notes Config specific information related to site. Max →
allowed numbers of characters is 800
sfp SFP configuration
pm Configure PM data
controller Configure a specific controller
network-synch Configure network synch
ftp Configure FTP parameters
interface Configure interfaces
ip Configure IP settings
lan-dcn Configure LAN-DCN
rsyslog Configure remote syslog
rsyslog6 Configure remote syslog servers with IPv6 addres →
s
show Display status and configuration information
timezone Configure time zone
in-service Set the module inService
...
end Exit configuration mode
exit Exit configuration mode

Displaying all commands beginning with in in the current command mode:


ML66(config)#in?
interface Configure interfaces
in-service Set the module inService

Displaying help for all options that can follow the command interface:
ML66(config)#interface ?
ip Configure IP interface (defaults to LAN-DCN)
local-access Configure the Local Access (USB) interface
ethernet-eps Configure ethernet interface (EPS)

Displaying help for all options that can follow interface ip:
ML66(config)#interface ip ?
<IFNAME_RSP> Interface name (R/S/P)
<cr> Configure IP interface (defaults to LAN-DCN)

In the last example, <cr> means that interface ip does not necessarily need
further options and that it is possible to press Enter to run the command.

5.2 TAB

12 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Basic and Navigation Commands

Synopsis
TAB

Description
Use the TAB key to complete a command, see CLI User Guide. It can also be used
just like the ? command to display help for commands, options, and operands.
Like the ? command, but unlike other commands, TAB runs without pressing
Enter.

Command Mode
All modes

See Also
?

5.3 cli compatibility

Synopsis

— cli compatibility { verbose | silent }

— no cli compatibility

Description
Use this command to change to or from CLI compatibility mode. In compatibility
mode unidentified parameters are ignored.

Use the no option to exit CLI compatibility mode.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Options

verbose Displays information on ignored parameters.

silent Suppress the output information.

Examples
Changing to CLI compatibility mode:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 13


CLI Descriptions

ML66>cli compatibility silent

5.4 configure

Synopsis
configure [terminal]

Description
Use this command to change to Global Configuration mode.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Examples
Changing to Global Configuration mode:
ML66#configure
ML66(config)#

5.5 disable

Synopsis
disable

Description
Use this command to exit from Privileged Exec mode to Exec mode.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Examples
Exiting from Privileged Exec mode:
ML66#disable
ML66>

14 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Basic and Navigation Commands

5.6 enable

Synopsis
enable [user <USERNAME> ]

Description
Use this command to change to Privileged Exec mode from Exec mode.

Use this command without any parameter to authenticate as control_user. Use


this command with user <USERNAME> parameter to authenticate as a specified
user.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

USERNAME The name of the user.

Examples
Authenticating as admin_user:
ML66>enable user admin_user

5.7 in-service

Synopsis
[no] in-service <UNIT>

Description
Use this command to set the admin state of a unit to in service.

Use the no option to set the unit to out of service.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 15


CLI Descriptions

Operands

UNIT The physical unit to set to in service. The format of the


specified parameter is rack/slot/port.

Examples
Setting the admin state to in service for unit 1/6:
ML66(config)#in-service 1/6

5.8 ping

Synopsis

— ping [<IPADDR> [vrf <VRF>] [source <SOURCE>] [ttl <TTL>] [count


<COUNT>] [timeout <TIMEOUT>] [size <SIZE>] [df-set {no | yes}] [tos
<TOS>] [interval <INTERVAL>]]

— ping lan-dcn {<IPADDR> | <HOSTNAME>} [source {lan-dcn | local-


access | lo-dcn | <SOURCE>}] [ttl <TTL>] [count <COUNT>] [timeout
<TIMEOUT>] [size <SIZE>] [df-set {no | yes}] [interval <INTERVAL>]

Description
Use this command to ping an IP remote host on the LAN-DCN or the router
network. Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP) packets are sent to the other
host and the results are displayed.

Running the command without options opens an interactive ping session, where
all required parameters can be entered one by one. The ping is done on the router
network in this case. The command can be terminated by pressing the CTRL+C
key combination.

Note: Type of Service for LAN-DCN networks is controlled by the lan-dcn ip


dscp command.

The related commands are the following:

— lan-dcn ip dscp

— ping mpls

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

16 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Basic and Navigation Commands

Operands

IPADDR IPv4 address, where the format is <A.B.C.D>.

VRF The name of the Virtual Routing and Forwarding (VRF)


instance.

HOSTNAME The name of the host.

SOURCE The source IPv4 address, where the format is <A.B.C.D>.

TTL The Time To Live (TTL) value, which specifies the hop
limit of data in the network. The valid range is 1–255.
The default value is 64.

COUNT The count value, which specifies the number of echo


requests sent. The valid range is 1–65535. The default
value is 5.

TIMEOUT The timeout value which specifies the maximum interval


for each ping as waiting for answers in seconds. The valid
range is 1–2147 s.

SIZE The size of the packet. The valid range is 36–18024.

TOS Type of Service value. The valid range is 0–255.

INTERVAL The time interval between sending two packets in


seconds. The valid range is 1–1000 s.

Options

vrf Specifies the VRF instance.

lan-dcn Selects the LAN-DCN network to ping. Otherwise, the


router network is selected to ping.

source Specifies the source LAN-DCN interface or IP address


from which the requests are sent to the destination.

ttl Specifies the TTL value.

count Specifies the number of echo requests sent.

timeout Specifies the maximum interval for each ping as waiting


for answers.

size Specifies the number of data bytes to be sent.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 17


CLI Descriptions

df-set Sets the “Don’t Fragment” (DF) bit in the IP header. The
valid operands are yes and no.

tos Set the Type of Service value.

interval Set the interval time in seconds.

Examples
Testing the IP connection to a remote host on the LAN-DCN network:
ML66>ping lan-dcn 192.168.1.1
PING 192.168.1.1 (192.168.1.1): 56 octets data
64 octets from 192.168.1.1: icmp_seq=0 ttl=64 time=14.9 ms
64 octets from 192.168.1.1: icmp_seq=1 ttl=64 time=14.3 ms
64 octets from 192.168.1.1: icmp_seq=2 ttl=64 time=14.3 ms
64 octets from 192.168.1.1: icmp_seq=3 ttl=64 time=14.3 ms
64 octets from 192.168.1.1: icmp_seq=4 ttl=64 time=14.3 ms
--- 192.168.1.1 ping statistics ---
5 packets transmitted, 5 packets received, 0% packet loss
round-trip min/avg/max = 14.3/14.4/14.9 ms

ML66#ping lan-dcn 172.31.28.238 ttl 34 source lan-dcn

Testing the IP connection to a remote host on the router network:


ML66#ping
Protocol [ip]: ip
Target IP address: 10.2.3.3
Name of the VRF :
Repeat count [5]: 3
Datagram size [100]: 100
Timeout in seconds [2]: 1
Extended commands [n]:
PING 10.2.3.3 (10.2.3.3) 100(128) bytes of data.
108 bytes from 10.2.3.3: icmp_req=1 ttl=64 time=1.18 ms
108 bytes from 10.2.3.3: icmp_req=2 ttl=64 time=0.857 ms
108 bytes from 10.2.3.3: icmp_req=3 ttl=64 time=1.04 ms
--- 10.2.3.3 ping statistics ---
3 packets transmitted, 3 received, 0% packet loss, time 2003ms
rtt min/avg/max/mdev = 0.857/1.027/1.186/0.139 ms

5.9 ping6

Synopsis
ping6 lan-dcn {<IPV6ADDR> | <HOSTNAME>} [source {lan-dcn | local-
access | lo-dcn | <SOURCE>}] [ttl <TTL>] [count <COUNT>] [timeout
<TIMEOUT>] [size <SIZE>] [interval <INTERVAL>]

Description
Use this command to ping an IPv6 remote host on the LAN-DCN network.
Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMPv6) packets are sent to the other host,
and the results are displayed.

18 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Basic and Navigation Commands

Note: Type of Service for LAN-DCN networks is controlled by the lan-dcn


ipv6 dscp command.

The related commands are the following:

— lan-dcn ipv6 dscp

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IPV6ADDR IPv6 address, where the format is <X:X::X:X>.

HOSTNAME The name of the host.

SOURCE The source IPv6 address, where the format is <X:X::X:X>.

TTL The Time To Live (TTL) value, which specifies the hop
limit of data in the network. The valid range is 1–255.
The default value is 64.

COUNT The count value, which specifies the number of echo


requests sent. The valid range is 1–65535. The default
value is 5.

TIMEOUT The timeout value, which specifies the maximum interval


for each ping as waiting for answers in seconds. The valid
range is 1–2147 s.

SIZE The size of the packet. The valid range is 36–18024.

INTERVAL The time interval between sending two packets in


seconds. The valid range is 1–1000 s.

Options

lan-dcn Selects the LAN-DCN network to ping.

source Specifies the source LAN-DCN interface or IPv6 address


from which the requests are sent to the destination.

ttl Specifies the TTL value.

count Specifies the number of echo requests sent.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 19


CLI Descriptions

timeout Specifies the maximum interval for each ping as waiting


for answers.

size Specifies the number of data bytes to be sent.

interval Set the interval time in seconds.

Examples
Testing the IP connection to an IPv6 remote host:
ML66>ping6 lan-dcn 2001:1b70:8180:c001::1011

ML66>ping6 lan-dcn fe80::7c71:a7c4:d012:4acc ttl 34 source lan-dcn

5.10 ssh

Synopsis

— ssh [ -l <USERNAME> ] { <IPADDR> | <IP6ADDR> | <HOSTNAME> }

— ssh -d

— ssh cli@ { <IPADDR> | <IP6ADDR> }

— ssh -1 -c des cli@ { <IPADDR> | <IP6ADDR> }

Description
Use this command to establish a Secure Shell (SSH) session to another NE or to
get access to a shell on a remote server. To start a CLI session in local
authentication mode, the default user name is cli. To start a CLI session in
centralized authentication mode, enter your personal user ID and password.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Options

-d Deletes the locally saved host key. This action may be


necessary if a remote host changes its host key. Requires
Privileged Exec mode.

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the remote host, where the format is
<A.B.C.D> .

20 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Basic and Navigation Commands

IP6ADDR The IPv6 address of the remote host, where the format is
<X:X::X:X> .

HOSTNAME The name of the remote host or alias name. The format of
the alias name is <ferlt-R-S-P>, where R-S-P is the Rack,
Slot, and Port value of the near end radio.

USERNAME The name of the user.

Examples
Establishing an SSH session to a remote host:
ML66#ssh -l operator1 192.168.1.1
% WARNING CLI idle timer stopped while in ssh session

Establishing an SSH session when DCN connection to the far end is down:
ML66#ssh -l cli ferlt-1-1-1

Deleting known_host for SSH:


ML66#ssh -l view_user 192.168.1.1
% WARNING CLI idle timer stopped while in ssh session
ML66-192-168-1-1>enable
Password: ********
ML66-192-168-1-1#ssh -d known_host

5.11 telnet

Synopsis
telnet { <IPADDR> | <IP6ADDR> | <HOSTNAME> }

Description
Use this command to establish a telnet session to another NE. Both IPv4 and
IPv6 host addresses are supported.

When DCN connection to the far end is down, enter an alias name as hostname,
then change the configuration of the far end to restore the DCN connection.

To start a CLI session in local authentication mode, the default user name is
view_user. To start a CLI session in centralized authentication mode, enter your
personal user ID and password.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 21


CLI Descriptions

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address, where the format is <A.B.C.D> .

IP6ADDR The IPv6 address, where the format is <X:X::X:X> .

HOSTNAME The name of the host or the alias name.

The format of the alias name is <ferlt-R-S-P>, where <R-


S-P> is the Rack, Slot, and Port values of the near end
radio.

Examples
Establishing a telnet session to a remote IPv4 host:
ML66#telnet 192.168.1.1
% WARNING CLI idle timer stopped while in telnet session
Trying 192.168.1.1...
Connected to 192.168.1.1.
Escape character is '^]'.
CLI interface:
Password:

Establishing a telnet session when DCN connection to the far end is down:
ML66#telnet ferlt-1-1-1

Establishing a telnet session to a remote IPv6 host:


ML66#telnet 2001::53

5.12 traceroute

Synopsis

— traceroute {<IPADDR> } [vrf <VRF> ]

— traceroute lan-dcn { <IPADDR> | <HOSTNAME> }

Description
Use this command to verify routing in an IP network. UDP/IP packets are sent to
the other host and, if the connection is successful, the IP systems visited on the
way are listed.

Running the command without options opens an interactive traceroute session,


where all required parameters can be entered one by one. The traceroute is done
on the router network in this case. The command can be terminated by pressing
the CTRL+C key combination.

22 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Basic and Navigation Commands

During the interactive traceroute session, it is possible to specify the source IP


address.

The related commands are the following:

— traceroute mpls

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address, where the format is <A.B.C.D> .

VRF The name of the Virtual Routing and Forwarding (VRF)


instance.

HOSTNAME The name of the host.

Options

vrf Specifies the VRF instance.

lan-dcn Selects the LAN-DCN network to route. Otherwise, the


router network is selected to route.

Examples
Verifying the IP route to a remote host on the LAN-DCN network:
ML66>traceroute lan-dcn 192.168.1.1
traceroute to 192.168.1.1 (192.168.1.1), 30 hops max, 38 byte packets
1 192.168.1.1 (192.168.1.1) 12.561 ms 12.417 ms 12.848 ms

Verifying the IP route to a remote host on the router network:


ML66#traceroute 10.41.97.24
1 10.41.97.24 (10.41.97.24) 1.355 ms 1.257 ms 1.270 ms

5.13 traceroute6

Synopsis
traceroute6 { <HOSTNAME> | <IP6ADDR> }

Description
Use this command to verify IPv6 routing to a remote host.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 23


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

HOSTNAME The name of the host.

IP6ADDR The IPv6 address, where the format is <X:X::X:X> .

Examples
Verifying IPv6 routing:
ML66>traceroute6 fe80::7c71:a7c4:d012:4acc

5.14 write

Synopsis
write [ sf | all ]

Description
Use this command to confirm and write the configuration that could cause loss of
the Data Communication Network (DCN). Only the changed configuration files
are updated by default.

Note: If the configurations are not saved within 15 minutes, the NE makes a
warm restart, restoring the saved configurations, and the unconfirmed
changes are lost. For more information, see CLI User Guide.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Options

sf Saves the changed configuration as single-file.

all Forces to save all configuration files.

Examples
Confirming configuration changes:
ML66#write

24 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Basic and Navigation Commands

See Also
show confirm timer

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 25


CLI Descriptions

6 User Access Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table 5.

Table 5 User Access Commands Overview


investigation-mode enable additional troubleshooting
possibilities for Ericsson engineers

The related show commands are the following:

— show investigation-mode

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

6.1 investigation-mode

Synopsis
[no] investigation-mode

Description
Use this command to enable additional troubleshooting possibilities for Ericsson
engineers. By default, additional troubleshooting possibilities are disabled.

For enabling additional troubleshooting possibilities in installation mode, see


investigation-mode on page 7.

Use the no option to disable additional troubleshooting possibilities.

Note: After enabling or disabling this feature, File Integrity Violation alarm is
raised, if it was previously enabled. A warm restart clears the alarm.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode at admin level

Examples
Enabling additional troubleshooting possibilities in operational mode:
ML66(config)#investigation-mode

26 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Firewall Commands

7 Firewall Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table 6.

The following command mode is applicable for the firewall commands:

— Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Table 6 Firewall Commands Overview


clear iptables clear the IPv4 firewall
clear ip6tables clear the IPv6 firewall
close ip close a firewall port using an IPv4
service
close6 ip close a firewall port using an IPv6
service
close msm close the <3002-3021> port range
close netman close the <4002-4021> port range
close ping disable the incoming IPv4 ping
requests
close6 ping disable the incoming IPv6 ping
requests
close PORT close a TCP or a UDP port for nodes
with IPv4 support
close6 PORT close a TCP or a UDP port for nodes
with IPv6 support
close syn_cookies disable SYN cookies for nodes with
IPv4 support
open ip open a firewall port using an IPv4
service
open6 ip open a firewall port using an IPv6
service
open msm open the <3002-3021> port range
open netman open the <4002-4021> port range
open ping enable the incoming IPv4 ping
requests
open6 ping enable the incoming IPv6 ping
requests
open PORT open a TCP or a UDP port for nodes
with IPv4 support

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 27


CLI Descriptions

open6 PORT open a TCP or a UDP port for nodes


with IPv6 support
open syn_cookies enable SYN cookies for nodes with
IPv4 support

The related show commands are the following:

— show iptables

— show ip6tables

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

7.1 clear iptables

Synopsis
clear iptables config

Description
Use this command to clear the IPv4 firewall by removing all user-defined rules.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Examples
Removing all IPv4 firewall user-defined rules:
ML66(config)#clear iptables config

7.2 clear ip6tables

Synopsis
clear ip6tables config

Description
Use this command to clear the IPv6 firewall by removing all user-defined rules.

28 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Firewall Commands

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Examples
Removing all IPv6 firewall user-defined rules:
ML66(config)#clear ip6tables config

7.3 close ip

Synopsis
[no] close ip <SERVICE> [<IPADDR> | <IPADDR/PREFIX> ]

Description
Use this command to close a firewall port using an IPv4 service.

Use the no option to remove the firewall rule.

Note: Only admin_user can enable or disable ports.

The following ports can be closed only with the close ip <SERVICE> command:

— Port 22, 23, 161, and 162

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Operands

SERVICE The type of the protocol. The available types are the
following:

— ssh

— telnet

— snmp

— snmptrap

IPADDR The IP address of the source host, where the format is


<A.B.C.D> .

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 29


CLI Descriptions

IPADDR/PREFIX The IP address and prefix length of the source network.


Specified in decimal notation <A.B.C.D/P> , for example,
1.2.3.4/24.

Examples
Closing an SSH service for 192.168.2.0/24 IPv4 subnetwork:
ML66(config)#close ip ssh 192.168.2.0/24

7.4 close6 ip

Synopsis
[no] close6 ip <SERVICE> [<IP6ADDR> | <IP6ADDR/PREFIX> ]

Description
Use this command to close a firewall port using an IPv6 service.

Use the no option to remove the firewall rule.

Note: Only admin_user can enable or disable ports.

The following ports can be closed only with close6 ip <SERVICE> command:

— Port 22, 23, 161, and 162

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Operands

SERVICE The type of the protocol. The available types are the
following:

— ssh

— telnet

— snmp

— snmptrap

IP6ADDR The IPv6 address of the source host. Specified in


<X:X::X:X> format, for example, 2005::31.

30 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Firewall Commands

IP6ADDR/PREFIX
The IPv6 address and prefix length of the source
network. Specified in <X:X::X:X/P> format, for example,
2005::/127.

Examples
Closing an SSH service for IPv6 host 2001:db8::1:
ML66(config)#close6 ip ssh 2001:db8::1

7.5 close msm

Synopsis
[no] close msm

Description
Use this command to close the <3002-3021> port range for MINI-LINK Service
Manager (MSM) system, which is a legacy management SW. By default, the port
range is closed.

Use the no option to remove the firewall rule.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Examples
Closing the <3002-3021> port range:
ML66(config)#close msm

7.6 close netman

Synopsis
[no] close netman

Description
Use this command to close the <4002-4021> port range for Network Manager
(Netman) system, which is a legacy management SW. By default, the port range
is closed.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 31


CLI Descriptions

Use the no option to remove the firewall rule.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Examples
Closing the <4002-4021> port range:
ML66(config)#close netman

7.7 close ping

Synopsis
[no] close ping

Description
Use this command to disable the incoming IPv4 ping requests.

Use the no option to remove the firewall rule.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Examples
Disabling the incoming IPv4 ping requests:
ML66(config)#close ping

7.8 close6 ping

Synopsis
[no] close6 ping

Description
Use this command to disable the incoming IPv6 ping requests.

Use the no option to remove the firewall rule.

32 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Firewall Commands

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Examples
Disabling the incoming IPv6 ping requests:
ML66(config)#close6 ping

7.9 close PORT

Synopsis
[no] close { tcp | udp } <PORT> [<IPADDR> | <IPADDR/PREFIX> ]

Description
Use this command to close a TCP or a UDP port for nodes with IPv4 support.

Use the no option to remove the firewall rule.

The following ports cannot be closed with close { tcp | udp } command:

— Port 0

— Port 22, 23, 161, and 162

— Ports above 1023

To close these ports, see close ip command.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Operands

PORT The number of the port or a range of ports in port:port


format.

IPADDR The IP address of the source host, where the format is


<A.B.C.D> .

IPADDR/PREFIX The IP address and prefix length of the source network.


Specified in decimal notation <A.B.C.D/P> , for example,
1.2.3.4/24.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 33


CLI Descriptions

Options

tcp Selects a TCP port to close.

udp Selects a UDP port to close.

Examples
Closing TCP port 21 for 192.168.2.0/24 IPv4 subnetwork:
ML66(config)#close tcp 21 192.168.2.0/24

7.10 close6 PORT

Synopsis
[no] close6 { tcp | udp } <PORT> [<IP6ADDR> | <IP6ADDR/PREFIX> ]

Description
Use this command to close a TCP or a UDP port for nodes with IPv6 support.

Use the no option to remove the firewall rule.

The following ports cannot be closed with close6 { tcp | udp } command:

— Port 0

— Port 22, 23, 161, and 162

— Ports above 1023

To close these ports, see close6 ip command.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Operands

PORT The number of the port or a range of ports in port:port


format.

IP6ADDR The IPv6 address of the source host. Specified in


<X:X::X:X> format, for example, 2005::31.

IP6ADDR/PREFIX

34 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Firewall Commands

The IPv6 address and prefix length of the source


network. Specified in <X:X::X:X/P> format, for example,
2005::/127.

Options

tcp Selects a TCP port to close.

udp Selects a UDP port to close.

Examples
Closing TCP port 21 for IPv6 host 2005::31:
ML66(config)#close6 tcp 21 2005::31

7.11 close syn_cookies

Synopsis
[no] close syn_cookies

Description
Use this command to disable SYN cookies for nodes with IPv4 support.

Use the no option to remove the disable rule for SYN cookies.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Examples
Disabling SYN cookies for a node with IPv4 support:
ML66(config)#close syn_cookies

7.12 open ip

Synopsis
[no] open ip <SERVICE> [<IPADDR> | <IPADDR/PREFIX> ]

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 35


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to open a firewall port using an IPv4 service.

Use the no option to remove the firewall rule.

Note: Only admin_user can enable or disable ports.

The following ports can be opened only with the open ip <SERVICE> command:

— Port 22, 23, 161, and 162

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Operands

SERVICE The type of the protocol. The available types are the
following:

— ssh

— telnet

— snmp

— snmptrap

IPADDR The IP address of the source host, where the format is


<A.B.C.D> .

IPADDR/PREFIX The IP address and prefix length of the source network.


Specified in decimal notation <A.B.C.D/P> , for example,
1.2.3.4/24.

Examples
Opening an SSH service for 192.168.2.0/24 IPv4 subnetwork:
ML66(config)#open ip ssh 192.168.2.0/24

7.13 open6 ip

Synopsis
[no] open6 ip <SERVICE> [<IP6ADDR> | <IP6ADDR/PREFIX> ]

36 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Firewall Commands

Description
Use this command to open a firewall port using an IPv6 service.

Use the no option to remove the firewall rule.

Note: Only admin_user can enable or disable ports.

The following ports can be opened only with open6 ip <SERVICE> command:

— Port 22, 23, 161, and 162

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Operands

SERVICE The type of the protocol. The available types are the
following:

— ssh

— telnet

— snmp

— snmptrap

IP6ADDR The IPv6 address of the source host. Specified in


<X:X::X:X> format, for example, 2005::31.

IP6ADDR/PREFIX
The IPv6 address and prefix length of the source
network. Specified in <X:X::X:X/P> format, for example,
2005::/127.

Examples
Opening an SSH service for IPv6 host 2001:db8::1:
ML66(config)#open6 ip ssh 2001:db8::1

7.14 open msm

Synopsis
[no] open msm

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 37


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to open the <3002-3021> port range for MINI-LINK Service
Manager (MSM) system, which is a legacy management SW. By default, the port
range is closed.

Use the no option to remove the firewall rule.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Examples
Opening the <3002-3021> port range:
ML66(config)#open msm

7.15 open netman

Synopsis
[no] open netman

Description
Use this command to open the <4002-4021> port range for Network Manager
(Netman) system, which is a legacy management SW. By default, the port range
is closed.

Use the no option to remove the firewall rule.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Examples
Opening the <4002-4021> port range:
ML66(config)#open netman

7.16 open ping

Synopsis
[no] open ping

38 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Firewall Commands

Description
Use this command to enable the incoming IPv4 ping requests.

Use the no option to remove the firewall rule.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Examples
Enabling the incoming IPv4 ping requests:
ML66(config)#open ping

7.17 open6 ping

Synopsis
[no] open6 ping

Description
Use this command to enable the incoming IPv6 ping requests.

Use the no option to remove the firewall rule.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Examples
Enabling the incoming IPv6 ping requests:
ML66(config)#open6 ping

7.18 open PORT

Synopsis
[no] open { tcp | udp } <PORT> [<IPADDR> | <IPADDR/PREFIX> ]

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 39


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to open a TCP or a UDP port for nodes with IPv4 support.

Use the no option to remove the firewall rule.

The following ports cannot be opened with open { tcp | udp } command:

— Port 0

— Port 22, 23, 161, and 162

— Ports above 1023

To open these ports, see open ip command.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Operands

PORT The number of the port or a range of ports in port:port


format.

IPADDR The IP address of the source host, where the format is


<A.B.C.D> .

IPADDR/PREFIX The IP address and prefix length of the source network.


Specified in decimal notation <A.B.C.D/P> , for example,
1.2.3.4/24.

Options

tcp Selects a TCP port to open.

udp Selects a UDP port to open.

Examples
Opening TCP port 21 for 192.168.2.0/24 IPv4 subnetwork:
ML66(config)#open tcp 21 192.168.2.0/24

7.19 open6 PORT

Synopsis
[no] open6 { tcp | udp } <PORT> [<IP6ADDR> | <IP6ADDR/PREFIX> ]

40 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Firewall Commands

Description
Use this command to open a TCP or a UDP port for nodes with IPv6 support.

Use the no option to remove the firewall rule.

The following ports cannot be opened with open6 { tcp | udp } command:

— Port 0

— Port 22, 23, 161, and 162

— Ports above 1023

To open these ports, see open6 ip command.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Operands

PORT The number of the port or a range of ports in port:port


format.

IP6ADDR The IPv6 address of the source host. Specified in


<X:X::X:X> format, for example, 2005::31.

IP6ADDR/PREFIX
The IPv6 address and prefix length of the source
network. Specified in <X:X::X:X/P> format, for example,
2005::/127.

Options

tcp Selects a TCP port to open.

udp Selects a UDP port to open.

Examples
Opening TCP port 21 for IPv6 host 2005::31:
ML66(config)#open6 tcp 21 2005::31

7.20 open syn_cookies

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 41


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
[no] open syn_cookies

Description
Use this command to enable SYN cookies for nodes with IPv4 support.

Use the no option to remove the enable rule for SYN cookies.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Examples
Enabling SYN cookies for a node with IPv4 support:
ML66(config)#open syn_cookies

42 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Security Commands

8 Security Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table 7.

The following command modes are applicable for the security commands:

— Privileged Exec mode — #

— Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

Table 7 Security Commands Overview


aaa accounting network default group enable and configure session
accounting
aaa authentication login set authentication mode
ftp active ntp-key-server set the active FTP server for NTP key
file download
ntp get-ntp-key trigger the download of the ntp.keys
file from the selected FTP server
ntp set-ntp-protocol set the NTP protocol
passwd change password for a selected user
radius-server create a Remote Authentication Dial
In User Service (RADIUS) server
restart perform an Application Plug-In Unit
(APU) or a Network Element (NE)
restart
secure-ssh disable the use of weak SSH
encryption algorithms
set_radius_address_Type set the IP protocol type of the RADIUS
address
set_tacacs_address_Type set the IP protocol type of the
Terminal Access Controller Access
Control System Plus (TACACS+)
address
setbruteforcethreshold set the maximum allowed number of
authentication login errors
setcliprotocol apply CLI protocol change between
Telnet and SSH
setenablelocalusers enable or disable local users
(admin_user, view_user, control_user,

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 43


CLI Descriptions

and oper_user) when centralized


authentication (RADIUS or TACACS+)
is configured
setlegalnotice add or modify a legal notice
setlocaluseridletimer set the inactivity timer for local users
setsecureprotocols set secure level
setsnmpv3authprotocol set the SNMPv3 authentication
protocol
setsnmpv3privprotocol (1) set the SNMPv3 privacy protocol
setsnmpv3protocol set SNMPv3 with data encryption
setstrongpasswd set strong password enforcement
set-file-integrity-alarm enable or disable file integrity
monitoring function
set ssh_keys generate SSH keys
snmp-server access configure a Simple Network
Management Protocol (SNMP) access
group
snmp-server community permit access to the SNMP protocol
snmp-server trap configure SNMP trap destination and
trap parameters
tacacs-server create a TACACS+ server
(1) If data encryption is set to noPriv, privacy protocol cannot be set.

The related show commands are the following:

— show aaa accounting network default group

— show aaaPolicyStatus

— show enableLocalUsers

— show file-integrity-alarm

— show legalnotice

— show localuseridletimer

— show ntp-status

— show radius_address_Type

— show radius-server config

— show radius-server statistics

44 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Security Commands

— show radius-server status

— show secure-ssh

— show strongpasswd

— show snmpv3authprotocol

— show snmpv3privprotocol

— show snmpv3protocol

— show tacacs_address_Type

— show tacacs-server config

— show tacacs-server statistics

— show tacacs-server status

— show temp

— show x

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

8.1 aaa accounting network

Synopsis

— aaa accounting network default {start-stop | stop-only} group


{tacacs+ | radius}

— no aaa accounting network default group

Description
Use this command to enable and configure session accounting for the NE.

Use the no option to disable session accounting for the NE.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 45


CLI Descriptions

Options

start-stop Enables session accounting of the starting and ending of


management sessions.

stop-only Enables session accounting of the ending of management


sessions only.

group Configures AAA Policy type.

tacacs+ Configures the AAA Policy type to Terminal Access


Controller Access-Control System Plus (TACACS+).

radius Configures the AAA Policy type to Remote Authentication


Dial In User Service (RADIUS).

Examples
Setting accounting mode to TACACS+ with session accounting of start and stop
of management sessions:
ML66(config)#aaa accounting network default start-stop group tacacs+

8.2 aaa authentication login

Synopsis
aaa authentication login [ local | radius | tacacs+ ]

Description
Use this command to set authentication mode.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Options

local Sets authentication mode to local.

tacacs Sets authentication mode to Terminal Access Controller


Access-Control System Plus (TACACS+).

radius Sets authentication mode to Remote Authentication Dial


In User Service (RADIUS).

46 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Security Commands

Examples
Setting authentication mode to RADIUS:
ML66#aaa authentication login radius

8.3 ftp active ntp-key-server

Synopsis
ftp active ntp-key-server <FTPSERVERNAME>

Description
Use this command to set the active FTP server for NTP key file download.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Operands

FTPSERVERNAME
The name of the FTP server, which is used for NTP key file
download.

Examples
Setting the active FTP server for NTP key file download:
ML66(config)#ftp active ntp-key-server ftpserver

8.4 ntp get-ntp-key

Synopsis
ntp get-ntp-key

Description
Use this command to trigger the download of the ntp.keys file from the selected
FTP server.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 47


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Triggering the download of the ntp.keys file from the selected FTP server:
ML66(config)#ntp get-ntp-key

8.5 ntp set-ntp-protocol

Synopsis
ntp set-ntp-protocol { noauth | v4auth }

Description
Use this command to set the NTP protocol. The default value is no
authentication.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Options

noauth Sets no authentication.

v4auth Sets the NTP protocol to secure authentication (v4).

Examples
Setting no authentication:
ML66(config)#ntp set-ntp-protocol noauth

8.6 passwd

Synopsis
passwd {admin_user | view_user | oper_user | control_user}

Description
Use this command to allow the admin_user to change password for admin_user,
control_user, oper_user, and view_user accounts.

48 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Security Commands

Note: Only admin_user is allowed to change password.

The length of the new password must be at least 12 characters and


must contain at least three of the following categories:

— Lowercase letters

— Uppercase letters

— Numbers

— Special characters

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Options

admin_user Sets the password for the admin_user.

control_user Sets the password for the control_user.

oper_user Sets the password for the oper_user.

view_user Sets the password for the view_user.

Examples
Changing password for oper_user:
ML66(config)#passwd oper_user
New user password: ************
Confirm new password: ************

8.7 radius-server

Synopsis

— radius-server ipaddress <IPADDRESS> key <KEY> port <PORT>


enable {false | true} priority <PRIORITY> deadtime <DEADTIME>
maxretries <MAXRETRIES> timeout <TIMEOUT> acct-port
<ACCTPORT>

— no radius-server ipaddress <IPADDRESS>

Description
Use this command to create a Remote Authentication Dial In User Service
(RADIUS) server.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 49


CLI Descriptions

Use the no option to delete a RADIUS server.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Operands

IPADDRESS The IP address in <A.B.C.D> format.

KEY The authentication key value. The length of the string


must be between 1 and 64 characters.

PORT The port number. The valid range is 1–65535.

PRIORITY The priority of the server. The valid range is 1–6.

DEADTIME The dead time value in minutes. The valid range is 0–


1440 in minutes.

MAXRETRIES The maximum retry count value. The valid range is 0–3.

TIMEOUT The time out period in seconds. The valid range is 1–10.

ACCTPORT The port number for session accounting packets. The


default value is UDP port 1813.

Options

ipaddress Specifies the IP address.

key Specifies the authentication key.

port Specifies the port number.

enable false Disables the NE to contact the RADIUS server.

enable true Enables the NE to contact the RADIUS server.

priority Specifies the priority of the server.

deadtime Specifies the dead time.

maxretries Specifies the maximum retry count.

timeout Specifies the time out period.

50 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Security Commands

acct-port Specifies the port number for session accounting packets.

Examples
Creating a RADIUS server:
ML66(config)#radius-server ipaddress 10.58.28.225 key 4d6d8d6d4bcd6d8d2d //
port 1812 enable true priority 1 deadtime 5 maxretries 3 timeout 5 acct-port 1813

8.8 restart

Synopsis
restart {apu_cold <R/S> | node_cold | node_warm}

Description
Use this command to perform an Application Plug-In Unit (APU) cold restart or a
Network Element (NE) restart, which can be either a cold or a warm restart.

Attention!
A cold restart disturbs the traffic.

Attention!
During a warm restart on NPU 1003 the traffic forwarding is still in operation but active
Layer 2 and Layer 3 protocols (for example SOAM, xSTP, ERP, 1588, OSPF, BGP) are
impacted which might result in traffic disturbance.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Operands

R/S The rack and slot value of the selected APU where the
format is Rack/Slot.

Options

apu_cold Performs an APU cold restart.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 51


CLI Descriptions

node_cold Performs an NE cold restart.

node_warm Performs an NE warm restart.

Examples
Performing an NE warm restart:
ML66#restart node_warm

8.9 secure-ssh

Synopsis

— secure-ssh enable

— no secure-ssh

Description
Use this command to disable the use of weak SSH encryption algorithms.

The supported secure algorithms are the following:

— aes256-ctr

— aes192-ctr

— aes128-ctr

— arcfour256

— arcfour128

— arcfour

Use the no option to enable the use of weak SSH encryption algorithms.

Note: After executing this command, the SSH server is restarted and the
connection with the server may be lost.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Examples
Disabling the use of weak SSH encryption algorithms:

52 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Security Commands

ML66(config)#secure-ssh enable

Enabling the use of weak SSH encryption algorithms:


ML66(config)#no secure-ssh

8.10 set_radius_address_Type

Synopsis
set_radius_address_Type <TYPE>

Description
Use this command to set the IP protocol type of the Remote Authentication Dial
In User Service (RADIUS) address.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Operands

TYPE 1 — Set the IP protocol to IPv4.

2 — Set the IP protocol to IPv6.

Examples
Setting the IP protocol type of the RADIUS address to IPv4:
ML66(config)#set_radius_address_Type 1

8.11 set_tacacs_address_Type

Synopsis
set_tacacs_address_Type <TYPE>

Description
Use this command to set the IP protocol type of the Terminal Access Controller
Access Control System Plus (TACACS+) address.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 53


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Operands

TYPE 1 — Set the IP protocol to IPv4.

2 — Set the IP protocol to IPv6.

Examples
Setting the IP protocol type of the TACACS+ address to IPv4:
ML66(config)#set_tacacs_address_Type 1

8.12 setbruteforcethreshold

Synopsis
setbruteforcethreshold <THRESHOLD>

Description
Use this command to set the maximum allowed number of authentication login
errors before the NE is considered to be under brute force attack.

Set the <THRESHOLD> value to 0 to disable the protection against brute force
attack.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Operands

THRESHOLD The maximum allowed number of authentication login


errors.

0 value disables the protection against brute force attack.

Examples
Setting the maximum allowed number of authentication login errors to 5:
ML66#setbruteforcethreshold 5

Disabling the protection against brute force attack:

54 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Security Commands

ML66#setbruteforcethreshold 0

8.13 setcliprotocol

Synopsis
setcliprotocol { telnet | ssh }

Description
Use this command to apply CLI protocol change between Telnet and Secure Shell
(SSH). For information regarding the behavior of the NE when changing CLI
protocol, see CLI User Guide.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Options

telnet Set the CLI protocol to Telnet.

ssh Set the CLI protocol to SSH.

Examples
Setting the CLI protocol to Telnet:
ML66(config)#setcliprotocol telnet

8.14 setenablelocalusers

Synopsis
setenablelocalusers { 1 | 2 }

Description
Use this command to enable or disable local users (admin_user, view_user,
control_user, and oper_user) when centralized authentication (RADIUS or
TACACS+) is configured.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 55


CLI Descriptions

Options

1 Enables local users (admin_user, view_user, control_user,


and oper_user) when centralized authentication is
configured.

2 Disables local users (admin_user, view_user, control_user,


and oper_user) when centralized authentication is
configured.

Examples
Disabling local users (admin_user, view_user, control_user, and oper_user) when
centralized authentication is configured:
ML66(config)#setenablelocalusers 2

8.15 setlegalnotice

Synopsis
setlegalnotice <NOTICE>

Description
Use this command to add or modify a legal notice.

Use the show legalnotice command to display the added information.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

NOTICE The customized legal notice. The maximum length of the


string is 512 characters.

Examples
Adding a legal notice:
ML66(config)#setlegalnotice "This is a customized legal notice for the node."

8.16 setlocaluseridletimer

56 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Security Commands

Synopsis
setlocaluseridletimer <IDLE>

Description
Use this command to set the inactivity timer in minutes for the local users.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Operands

IDLE The inactivity timer value in minutes. The valid range is


0–30. The default value is 15 minutes.

When the operand is set to 0 the inactivity timer is


disabled.

Note: For centralized users, the <IDLE> operand is


provided by the remote server, which is used for
authentication.

Examples
Setting the inactivity timer for the local users to 15 minutes:
ML66(config)#setlocaluseridletimer 15

8.17 setsecureprotocols

Synopsis
setsecureprotocols {enabled | disabled}

Description
Use setsecureprotocols enabled command to set the most secure level for all
protocols (Secure Shell (SSH) and Simple Network Management Protocol version
3 (SNMPv3) with privacy) automatically at the same time.

Use setsecureprotocols disabled command to set the secure level for each
protocol (SSH and SNMPv3 with privacy), using the setcliprotocol and
setsnmpv3protocol commands respectively.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 57


CLI Descriptions

Note: — Executing setsecureprotocols enabled command causes a


warm restart of the node.

— Executing setsecureprotocols disabled command does not


cause a warm restart of the node.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Options

enabled Set the most secure level for all protocols.

disabled Set the secure level for each protocol.

Examples
Setting the most secure level for all protocols:
ML66(config)#setsecureprotocols enabled

8.18 setsnmpv3authprotocol

Synopsis
setsnmpv3authprotocol {md5 | sha1 | sha2}

Description
Use this command to set the Simple Network Management Protocol version 3
(SNMPv3) authentication protocol.

Note: Set data encryption to either noPriv or desPriv using


setsnmpv3protocol command.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Options

md5 Sets MD5 authentication protocol.

sha1 Sets SHA-1 authentication protocol.

sha2 Sets SHA-2 authentication protocol.

58 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Security Commands

Examples
Setting the SNMPv3 authentication protocol to SHA-1:
ML66(config)#setsnmpv3authprotocol sha1

8.19 setsnmpv3privprotocol

Synopsis
setsnmpv3privprotocol {des | aes128 | aes256}

Description
Use this command to set the Simple Network Management Protocol version 3
(SNMPv3) privacy protocol.

Note: Set data encryption to desPriv using setsnmpv3protocol command. If


data encryption is set to noPriv, privacy protocol cannot be set.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Options

des Sets DES privacy protocol.

aes128 Sets AES-128 privacy protocol.

aes256 Sets AES-256 privacy protocol. Available only if the


authentication protocol is sha2.

Examples
Setting the SNMPv3 privacy protocol to AES-128:
ML66(config)#setsnmpv3privprotocol aes128

8.20 setsnmpv3protocol

Synopsis
setsnmpv3protocol {noPriv | desPriv}

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 59


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to set Simple Network Management Protocol version 3
(SNMPv3) with data encryption.

Note: Executing the command causes a warm restart of the node.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Options

noPriv Sets no data encryption.

desPriv Sets data encryption.

Examples
Setting SNMPv3 with data encryption:
ML66(config)#setsnmpv3protocol desPriv

8.21 setstrongpasswd

Synopsis
setstrongpasswd { enabled | disabled }

Description
Use this command to set strong password enforcement. The default value is
enabled.

Note: Only available for admin_user.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Options

Enabled Sets strong password enforced.

Disabled Sets strong password not enforced.

60 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Security Commands

Examples
Setting enforced:
ML66(config)#setstrongpasswd enabled

8.22 set-file-integrity-alarm

Synopsis
set-file-integrity-alarm { on | off }

Description
Use this command to enable or disable file integrity monitoring function.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Options

on Enables file integrity monitoring function.

off Disables file integrity monitoring function.

Examples
Enabling file integrity monitoring function:
ML66(config)#set-file-integrity-alarm on

8.23 set ssh_keys

Synopsis
set ssh_keys

Description
Use this command to generate new SSH keys. Two pairs of SSH keys are
generated, one pair with RSA algorithm and 2028 bit length, and another pair
with DSA algorithm and 1024 bits length.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 61


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode, at admin level

Examples
Generating an SSH key:
ML66#set ssh_keys

8.24 snmp-server access

Synopsis
snmp-server access <ACCESS>

Use the following synopsis for ACCESS:

ACCESS { <GRP> <PRE> <MATCH> <MODEL> <LVL> <R> <W>


<N> <STAT> <STORAGE> }

Description
Use this command to configure a Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP)
access group.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Operands

GRP The name of the access group.

PRE The prefix value of the access group.

MATCH The match value of the access group.

MODEL The model value of the access group.

LVL The level of the access group.

R Sets read permission for the access group.

W Sets write permission for the access group.

N Sets notification permission for the access group.

62 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Security Commands

STAT The status value of the access group.

STORAGE The storage value of the access group.

Examples
Configuring SNMP access group:
ML66(config)#snmp-server access "writeGroup" 0 1 0 1 "completeView1" //
"completeView1" "0" 1 3

8.25 snmp-server community

Synopsis
snmp-server community <STRING>

Use the following synopsis for STRING:

STRING { <INDEX> <COMNAME> <SECNAME> <TRTAG>


<STORAGE> <STAT> }

Description
Use this command to permit access to the Simple Network Management Protocol
(SNMP).

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Operands

INDEX The community index.

COMNAME The community name.

SECNAME The community security name.

TRTAG The community transport tag.

STORAGE The community storage.

STAT The community status.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 63


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Permitting access to the SNMP protocol:
ML66(config)#snmp-server community "index3" "YTFC45ff" //
"ext_priv" "external" 3 1

8.26 snmp-server trap

Synopsis
snmp-server { targetaddr <ADDR> | targetparams <PARAMS> | targetext
<EXT> }

Use the following synopsis for the filters:

ADDR { <NAME> <TD> <TA> <TIMEOUT> <RET> <TLIST>


<PAR> <STAT> <STORAGE> }

PARAMS { <NAME> <MP> <SECM> <SECN> <SECL> <STAT>


<STORAGE> }

EXT { <NAME> <MASK> <MMS> }

Description
Use this command to configure Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP)
trap destination and trap parameters.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Operands

NAME Specifies the identifier of the table.

TD Specifies the transport domain of the address. The


allowed values are the following:

— UDP Domain — 1.3.6.1.6.1.1

— Transport Domain UDP IPv4 —


1.3.6.1.2.1.100.1.1

— Transport Domain UDP IPv6 —


1.3.6.1.2.1.100.1.2

64 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Security Commands

— TCP — 1.3.6.1.4.1.1977.200.1

— TCP persistent — 1.3.6.1.4.1.1977.200.2

TA Specifies the target address. The target address must be


consistent with the transport domain address.

TIMEOUT Sets a timeout value. The agent waits this amount of time
for a response before attempting again.

RET Sets the number of times that the agent resends the
message.

TLIST Provides the correlation between address and notify


tables.

PAR Indexes the row in the parameter table.

STAT Controls row creation and deletion.

STORAGE Specifies how to store the row.

MP Specifies the message processing model.

SECM Specifies the security model.

SECN Specifies the security name.

SECL Specifies the security level.

MASK Specifies the mask address in hexadecimal format.

MMS Specifies the maximum message size.

Options

targetaddr Configures SNMP trap destination.

targetparams Configures SNMP trap parameters.

targetext Configures SNMP extension table.

Examples
Configuring SNMP IPv4 trap destination:
ML66(config)#snmp-server targetaddr Mgr1 1.3.6.1.2.1.100.1.1 //
10.20.30.40:162 1500 3 trap Param1 1 3

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 65


CLI Descriptions

Configuring SNMP IPv6 trap destination:


ML66(config)#snmp-server targetaddr Mgr1 1.3.6.1.2.1.100.1.2 //
2010::4@162 1500 3 trap Param1 1 3

Configuring SNMP trap parameters:


ML66(config)#snmp-server targetparams Param1 1 2 ext_trap 1 1 3

Configuring SNMP extension table:


ML66(config)#snmp-server targetext Mgr1 000000000000 484

8.27 tacacs-server

Synopsis

— tacacs-server ipaddress <IPADDRESS> key <KEY> port <PORT>


enable {false | true} priority <PRIORITY> deadtime <DEADTIME>
maxretries <MAXRETRIES> timeout <TIMEOUT> acct-port
<ACCTPORT>

— no tacacs-server ipaddress <IPADDRESS>

Description
Use this command to create a Terminal Access Controller Access Control System
Plus (TACACS+) server.

Use the no option to delete a TACACS+ server.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Operands

IPADDRESS The IP address in <A.B.C.D> format.

KEY The authentication key. The valid range is 1–128.

PORT The port number. The valid range is 1–65535.

PRIORITY The priority of the server. The valid range is 1–6.

DEADTIME The dead time value in minutes. The valid range is 0–


1440 in minutes.

MAXRETRIES The maximum retry count value. The valid range is 0–3.

66 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Security Commands

TIMEOUT The time out period in seconds. The valid range is 1–15.

ACCTPORT The port number for session accounting packets. The


default value is TCP port 49.

Options

ipaddress Specifies the IP address.

key Specifies the authentication key.

port Specifies the port number.

enable false Disables the NE to contact the TACACS+ server.

enable true Enables the NE to contact the TACACS+ server.

priority Specifies the priority of the server.

deadtime Specifies the dead time.

maxretries Specifies the maximum retry count.

timeout Specifies the time out period.

acct-port Specifies the port number for session accounting packets.

Examples
Creating a TACACS+ server:
ML66(config)#tacacs-server ipaddress 10.58.28.225 key 4d6d8d6d4bcd6d8d2d //
port 49 enable true priority 1 deadtime 5 maxretries 3 timeout 5 acct-port 49

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 67


CLI Descriptions

9 Software, Configuration, and Log File


Handling Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table 8.

The following command modes are applicable for the software-configuration


and log file handling commands:

— Exec mode — >

— Privileged Exec mode — #

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

Table 8 Software, Configuration, and Log File Handling Commands Overview


activate activate the downloaded software in the
passive bank
autobackup enable or disable automatic backup
copy copy load modules and SBLs
erase startup-config erase the startup configuration file
ftp active associate a defined FTP server with a service
ftp activeftp set the FTP server to be used as default
ftp server define an FTP server in NE list of FTP servers
reload restart on selected configuration

The related show commands are the following:

— show config-validation-info

— show copy

— show ftp active

— show ftp activeftp

— show ftp configtable

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

9.1 activate

68 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Software, Configuration, and Log File Handling Commands

Synopsis
activate

Description
Use this command to activate the downloaded software in the passive bank. To
download the software to the passive bank, use the copy command.

Note: After executing the activate command, the NE is restarted and the
current session is closed.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Examples
Activating software:
ML66#activate

9.2 autobackup

Synopsis
[no] autobackup

Description
Use this command to enable FTP active autobackup-configuration.

Use the no option to disable the automatic backup.

Note: The autobackup files are named as ML66<ip_address>_.cfg. For


example, ML6610-41-104-230_.cfg.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Enabling autobackup-configuration:
ML66(config)#autobackup

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 69


CLI Descriptions

9.3 copy

Synopsis
copy { ftp {<FTPNAME> | filename} <FILEPATH> flash [nowait] | abort |
persistency }

Description
Use this command to copy load modules and SBLs from an FTP server to the
node. To copy configuration files, see copy on page 5.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Operands

FTPNAME The name of the FTP server configuration to get the file
from.

FILEPATH The path to the file on the FTP to copy.

Options

ftp Copies a file from an FTP server given by the


<FTPNAME> operand.

filename Copies a file from the FTP server set as active FTP for
software upgrade.

flash Copies a file to the passive bank.

nowait Returns immediately for some of the commands while the


copy operation is still ongoing.

abort Cancels ongoing copy operations.

persistency Copies persistency files.

Examples
Copying software modules:
ML66#copy ftp remotehost /tn_system_release/ml_tn_software/CXP9036600_1/CXP9036600 →
_1_MINI-LINK_6600_6366_1.3_R4A190 flash

70 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Software, Configuration, and Log File Handling Commands

9.4 erase startup-config

Synopsis
erase startup-config

Description
Use this command to erase the startup configuration file.

Use this command also to return to factory settings.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Examples
Erasing the startup configuration file:
ML66#erase startup-config

9.5 ftp active

Synopsis

— ftp active { audit-log | autobackup-configuration | backup-


configuration | configuration-report | diagnostic-logs | dir-list |
error-log | fint-upload-report | fint-view-report | license-install
| license-report | ne-pm | ntp-key-server | soam-pm | software-
upgrade } <FTPSERVERNAME>

— no ftp active { audit-log | autobackup-configuration | backup-


configuration | configuration-report | diagnostic-logs | dir-list |
error-log | fint-upload-report | fint-view-report | license-install
| license-report | ne-pm | ntp-key-server | soam-pm | software-
upgrade }

Description
Use this command to associate a defined FTP server with a service.

Use the no option to reset to the default setting. The default FTP server is set by
the ftp activeftp command.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 71


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

FTPSERVERNAME
The name of the FTP in the FTP server table.

Options

audit-log Sets active FTP for upload of the audit log.

autobackup-configuration
Sets active FTP used for automatic configuration backup.

backup-configuration
Sets active FTP for upload and download of configuration
files.

configuration-report
Sets active FTP for configuration report.

diagnostic-logs Sets active FTP for uploading node log files.

dir-list Sets active FTP used for listing directories in Simple


Network Management Protocol (SNMP).

error-log Sets active FTP for uploading the error log.

fint-upload-report
Sets active FTP server to upload the file integrity report.

fint-view-report
Sets active FTP server to view the file integrity report.

license-install Sets active FTP for license file installation.

license-report Sets active FTP for license report.

ne-pm Sets active FTP used for PM xml data.

ntp-key-server Sets active FTP for downloading a Network Time


Protocol (NTP) key file.

soam-pm Sets active FTP used for Service OAM PM xml data.

software-upgrade

72 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Software, Configuration, and Log File Handling Commands

Sets active FTP for software upgrade.

Examples
Selecting FTP server named localhost for license file installation:
ML66(config)#ftp active license-install localhost

9.6 ftp activeftp

Synopsis

— ftp activeftp <FTPSERVERNAME>

— no ftp activeftp

Description
Use this command to set the FTP server to be used as default. This command
also sets all services to use this default FTP server, see ftp active .

Use the no option to reset to the default FTP server.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

FTPSERVERNAME
The name of the FTP in the FTP server table.

Examples
Setting FTP server named localhost for all services:
ML66(config)#ftp activeftp localhost

9.7 ftp server

Synopsis

— ftp server name <NAME> address <ADDRESS> {user <USER> [password


<PASS> ]} [port <PORT> ] [servertype <PROTOCOL> ] [reserved
<USERGROUP> ]

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 73


CLI Descriptions

— no ftp server name <NAME>

Description
Use this command to define an FTP server in NE list of FTP servers.

Note: The command does not check if the host IP address exists or not.

Use the no option to remove an FTP definition. Any service associated with this
FTP server is changed to use the default FTP server set by the ftp activeftp
command.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

NAME The identifier of the selected FTP setting.

ADDRESS IP address or host name of the destination FTP server.


Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses can be used.

PORT Destination TCP port on the server.

Note: — Default value is 21.

— The ports of local and remote servers cannot


be changed immediately.

— The port value is aligned with the given


protocol as follows:

• 21 for FTP

• 22 for SFTP

USER FTP login name.

Default value is anonymous.

PASS FTP login password in unencrypted format.

PROTOCOL The type of the server. It can be either FTP or Secure FTP
(SFTP).

74 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Software, Configuration, and Log File Handling Commands

Note: — Default protocol is FTP.

— The protocol type is automatically aligned


with the port value if the protocol type is not
given.

USERGROUP The user group having exclusive authority to configure


the selected FTP server. The only available user is
admin_user and the operand must be set to ADMIN.

Options

name Specifies the unique name of the FTP server.

address Specifies the IP address of the FTP server.

port Specifies the destination TCP port on the FTP server.

user Specifies the FTP login name.

servertype Specifies the type of the server.

password Specifies the FTP login password.

reserved Specifies the user group having exclusive authority to


configure the selected FTP server.

Note: Only admin_user can specify this option. Once


an FTP server is reserved for security tasks, only
admin_user can modify it. To restore the access
rights of other users, the server needs to be
removed then created again without the admin
reserved flag enabled.

Examples
Defining generic FTP settings:
ML66(config)#ftp server name backupftp address 192.168.0.102 user anonymous passwo →
rd anonymous port 21 servertype ftp

Defining an FTP server reserved for admin_user:


ML66(config)#ftp server name newftp address 192.168.0.103 user anonymous password →
anonymous port 21 servertype ftp reserved admin

9.8 reload

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 75


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
reload

Description
Use this command to reload the current configuration and to perform a node
warm restart.

Attention!
Restarting the node may cause traffic disturbances and the loss of the Data
Communication Network (DCN) connection for a few minutes.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Examples
Reloading the current configuration and performing a node warm restart:
ML66#reload

76 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


License Handling Commands

10 License Handling Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table 9.

The following command modes are applicable for the license handling
commands:

— Privileged Exec mode — #

— License Request submode — (license-request)

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

Table 9 License Handling Commands Overview


add increase the number of requests for
the given license
license install download and install a License Key
File (LKF)
license restrict-unlocked-period disable or enable access to Emergency
and Maintenance unlocked period for
control_user
license request change to the (license-request)
submode
license unlockedperiod enter manually enter an unlocked period
license unlockedperiod exit manually exit from the current
unlocked period
modify modify the number of requests for the
given license
remove decrease the number of requests for
the given license
reset reset the number of the requested
licenses
upload upload the License Request File (LRF)

The related show commands are the following:

— show (license)

— show license install status

— show license restrict-unlocked-period

— show license status

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 77


CLI Descriptions

— show license status ports

— show license unlockedperiod

— show license upload status

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

10.1 add

Synopsis
add <FAL> <QUANTITY>

Description
Use this command to increase the number of requests for the given license.

Command Mode
License Request submode — (license-request)

Operands

FAL The license product FAL number.

QUANTITY The number of the licenses that is added to the number of


the actual licenses. The value of the operand must be
greater than or equal to 0.

Examples
Increasing the number of the requested capacity licenses (FAL 124 1115) by 2:
ML66(license-request)#add FAL1241115 2

10.2 license install

Synopsis
license install <FILENAME>

78 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


License Handling Commands

Description
Use this command to download and install a License Key File (LKF) using the
default license installation FTP server. To display the status of the LKF
installation, use show license install status command.

Note: — Executing the command causes a warm restart of the NE if the NE


License Status is Degraded before or after the license installation.

— The license installation is performed in the background and could


take a few minutes in case of slow DCN connection.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Operands

FILENAME The name of the LKF.

Examples
Downloading and installing an LKF:
ML66#license install my_license_file

10.3 license restrict-unlocked-period

Synopsis
license restrict-unlocked-period { disable | enable }

Description
Use this command to disable or enable access to Emergency and Maintenance
unlocked period for control_user.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode, at admin level — #

Options

disable Provides access to Emergency and Maintenance unlocked


period for control_user.

enable Denies access to Emergency and Maintenance unlocked


period for control_user.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 79


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Providing access to Emergency and Maintenance unlocked period for
control_user:
ML66#license restrict-unlocked-period disable

10.4 license request

Synopsis
license request

Description
Use this command to change to the (license-request) submode. In the (license-
request) submode it is possible to view and modify the number of the requested
licenses.

Note: The modifications are not stored in any configuration file and only
available in the uploaded License Request File (LRF). Therefore, avoid
any restart operation during the license request modification phase.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Examples
Changing to the (license-request) submode:
ML66#license request
ML66(license-request)#

10.5 license unlockedperiod enter

Synopsis
license unlockedperiod enter { integration | maintenance | emergency }

Description
Use this command to manually enter an unlocked period.

80 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


License Handling Commands

Note: — To execute the command, the token of the selected unlocked period
must be available.

— Executing the command causes a warm restart of the NE if the NE


License Status is Degraded.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Options

integration Enters Integration Unlocked Period.

maintenance Enters Maintenance Unlocked Period.

emergency Enters Emergency Unlocked Period.

Examples
Entering the Maintenance Unlocked Period:
ML66#license unlockedperiod enter maintenance

10.6 license unlockedperiod exit

Synopsis
license unlockedperiod exit

Description
Use this command to manually exit from the current unlocked period.

Note: Exiting manually from an unlocked period is only possible if no licenses


are missing.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Examples
Exiting from the current unlocked period:
ML66#license unlockedperiod exit

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 81


CLI Descriptions

10.7 modify

Synopsis
modify <FAL> <QUANTITY>

Description
Use this command to modify the number of requests for the given license.

Command Mode
License Request submode — (license-request)

Operands

FAL The license product FAL number.

QUANTITY The number of the licenses that need to be modified. The


value of the operand must be greater than or equal to 0.

Examples
Modifying the number of the requested capacity licenses (FAL 124 1115) to 3:
ML66(license-request)#modify FAL1241115 3

10.8 remove

Synopsis
remove <FAL> <QUANTITY>

Description
Use this command to decrease the number of requests for the given license.

Command Mode
License Request submode — (license-request)

Operands

FAL The license product FAL number.

82 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


License Handling Commands

QUANTITY The number of the licenses that is removed from the


number of the actual licenses. The value of the operand
must be greater than or equal to 0 and less than the
current value.

Examples
Decreasing the number of the requested capacity licenses (FAL 124 1115) by 1:
ML66(license-request)#remove FAL1241115 1

10.9 reset

Synopsis
reset

Description
Use this command to reset the number of the requested licenses to the minimum
number of licenses, which is needed for the actual configuration.

Command Mode
License Request submode — (license-request)

Examples
Resetting the number of all requested licenses:
ML66(license-request)#reset

10.10 upload

Synopsis
upload [ file <FILENAME> ] [ server <FTPSERVERNAME> ]

Description
Use this command to upload the License Request File (LRF) to the tn_licenses
directory on the FTP server. To display the status of the LRF upload, use show
license upload status command.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 83


CLI Descriptions

Note: The upload of the LRF could take a few minutes in case of slow DCN
connection.

Command Mode
License Request submode — (license-request)

Operands

FILENAME The name of the LRF. The file name must have .xml file
extension and must contain at least one of the following
characters:

— A–Z (English alphabet)

— a–z (English alphabet)

— 0–9 (numerical numbers)

— - (hyphen)

— _ (underscore)

— . (dot)

Executing the command without the <FILENAME>


operand, the file name is automatically generated using
the name of the NE.

FTPSERVERNAME
The name of the FTP server.

Executing the command without the


<FTPSERVERNAME> operand the LRF is uploaded to the
FTP server, which has been set as active for license
installation.

Examples
Uploading the LRF to the tn_licenses directory on the FTP server:
ML66(license-request)#upload

84 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


License Handling Commands in Monitoring Mode

11 License Handling Commands in Monitoring


Mode

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
10.

The following command modes are applicable for the license handling
commands in monitoring mode:

— Privileged Exec mode — # , at admin level

— License Monitoring submode — (license-monitoring) , at admin level

Table 10 Monitoring Mode License Handling Commands Overview


add increase the number of the monitored
licenses
license monitoring change to the (license-monitoring)
submode
modify modify the number of the monitored
licenses
monitoring-auto-unlock enable or disable automatic license
provisioning
remove decrease the number of the monitored
licenses
reset set the number of the currently
monitored licenses to 0 or clear all
monitored licenses

The related show command is the following:

— show (license monitoring)

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

11.1 add

Synopsis
add <FAL> <QUANTITY>

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 85


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to increase the number of the monitored licenses.

Command Mode
License Monitoring submode — (license-monitoring) , at admin level

Operands

FAL The license product FAL number.

QUANTITY The number of the licenses that is added to the number of


the actual licenses. The value of the operand must be
greater than or equal to 0.

Examples
Increasing the number of the monitored capacity licenses (FAL 124 1115) by 2:
ML66(license-monitoring)#add FAL1241115 2

11.2 license monitoring

Synopsis
license monitoring

Description
Use this command to change to the (license-monitoring) submode. In the
(license-monitoring) submode it is possible to view and modify the number of the
requested licenses.

Note: To enforce the modifications for the monitored licenses, perform a


manual warm restart.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — # , at admin level

Examples
Changing to the (license-monitoring) submode:
ML66#license monitoring
ML66(license-monitoring)#

86 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


License Handling Commands in Monitoring Mode

11.3 modify

Synopsis
modify <FAL> <QUANTITY>

Description
Use this command to modify the number of the monitored licenses.

Command Mode
License Monitoring submode — (license-monitoring) , at admin level

Operands

FAL The license product FAL number.

QUANTITY The number of the licenses that need to be modified. The


value of the operand must be greater than or equal to 0.

Examples
Modifying the number of the monitored capacity licenses (FAL 124 1115) to 3:
ML66(license-monitoring)#modify FAL1241115 3

11.4 monitoring-auto-unlock

Synopsis
monitoring-auto-unlock {disable | enable}

Description
Use this command to enable or disable automatic license provisioning.

Command Mode
License Monitoring submode — (license-monitoring) , at admin level

Options

disable Disables automatic license provisioning.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 87


CLI Descriptions

enable Enables automatic license provisioning.

Examples
Enabling automatic license provisioning:
ML66(license-monitoring)#monitoring-auto-unlock enable

11.5 remove

Synopsis
remove <FAL> <QUANTITY>

Description
Use this command to decrease the number of the monitored licenses.

Command Mode
License Monitoring submode — (license-monitoring) , at admin level

Operands

FAL The license product FAL number.

QUANTITY The number of the licenses that is removed from the


number of the actual licenses. The value of the operand
must be greater than or equal to 0 and less than the
current value.

Examples
Decreasing the number of the monitored capacity licenses (FAL 124 1115) by 1:
ML66(license-monitoring)#remove FAL1241115 1

11.6 reset

Synopsis
reset [<FAL> ]

Description
Use this command to set the number of the currently monitored licenses to 0.

88 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


License Handling Commands in Monitoring Mode

Executing the command without the <FAL> operand, all monitored licenses are
cleared.

Command Mode
License Monitoring submode — (license-monitoring) , at admin level

Operands

FAL The license product FAL number.

Examples
Setting the number of the monitored capacity licenses (FAL 124 1115) to 0:
ML66(license-monitoring)#reset FAL1241115

Clearing all monitored licenses:


ML66(license-monitoring)#reset

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 89


CLI Descriptions

12 Basic Configuration Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
11.

The following command modes are applicable for the basic configuration
commands:

— Privileged Exec mode — #

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

Table 11 Basic Configuration Commands Overview


clock set configure date and time
config-changed-timer set the timer value for the NE Configuration Changed
event
ntp server specify a Network Time Protocol (NTP) server
snmp-server syscontact set NE contact
snmp-server syslocation set NE location
snmp-server sysname set NE name
snmp-server trapenable enable or disable sending notifications
sys_notes add information related to the site
timezone set the time zone

The related show commands are the following:

— show clock

— show config-changed-timer

— show sys_notes

— show timezone

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

12.1 clock set

90 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Basic Configuration Commands

Synopsis
clock set <HH:MM:SS DAY MONTH YEAR>

Description
Use this command to configure date and time.

Note: A warm restart by using the restart node_warm command is required


before the new system time and date changes take effect.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode, at admin level — #

Operands

HH Hour using two digits.

MM Minute using two digits.

SS Second using two digits.

DAY Day of the month.

MONTH Month of the year using the first three letters of the
month.

YEAR Year using four digits.

Examples
Configuring date and time:
ML66#clock set 16:42:36 19 dec 2011

Then perform a warm restart for the NE:


ML66#reload

See Also
restart node_warm

12.2 config-changed-timer

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 91


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
config-changed-timer <SECONDS>

Description
Use this command to set the timer value for the NE Configuration Changed event.

When a setting is changed in the node, the timer starts to count. When the set
timer value is reached, the NE sends the NE Configuration Changed event. If a
setting is changed during the counting period, the timer restarts and starts to
count from 0.

Note: To be able to send NE Configuration Changed events, enable sending


notifications using snmp-server trapenable command.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

SECONDS The value of the timer in seconds. The valid range is 30–
86400 seconds. The default value is 900 seconds.

Examples
Setting the timer value for the NE Configuration Changed event to 900 seconds:
ML66(config)#config-changed-timer 900

12.3 ntp server

Synopsis
ntp server <NTPADDRESS>

Description
Use this command to specify the Network Time Protocol (NTP) server for clock
synchronization.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

92 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Basic Configuration Commands

Operands

NTPADDRESS Address of the NTP server, where the format is <A.B.C.D>


for IPv4 and <X:X::X:X> for IPv6.

Examples
Specifying an IPv4 NTP server:
ML66(config)#ntp server 192.168.1.1

12.4 snmp-server syscontact

Synopsis
snmp-server syscontact <CONTACT>

Description
Use this command to set NE contact.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

CONTACT Name of the system contact. The length of the parameter


cannot be over 255 characters.

Examples
Setting NE contact:
ML66(config)#snmp-server syscontact ContactName

12.5 snmp-server syslocation

Synopsis
snmp-server syslocation <LOCATION>

Description
Use this command to set NE location.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 93


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

LOCATION Name of system location. The length of the parameter


cannot be over 255 characters.

Examples
Setting NE location:
ML66(config)#snmp-server syslocation Budapest

12.6 snmp-server sysname

Synopsis

— snmp-server sysname <NODENAME>

— snmp-server no sysname

Description
Use this command to set the NE name.

Use the no option to set the NE name to default (auto-generated).

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

NODENAME Name of the system. The length of the parameter is


limited to 63 characters.

When entering free text, the following characters are


accepted:

— A–Z (English alphabet)

— a–z (English alphabet)

— 0–9 (numerical numbers)

— - (hyphen)

94 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Basic Configuration Commands

— . (dot)

The first character must be A–Z or a–z.

The last character must be A–Z, a–z, or 0–9.

Examples
Setting NE name:
ML66(config)#snmp-server sysname ML66-10-41-16-41

12.7 snmp-server trapenable

Synopsis
snmp-server trapenable <ENABLE>

Description
Use this command to enable or disable sending notifications, such as alarms or
events from the NE.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

ENABLE 1 — Enable

2 — Disable

Examples
Enabling sending notifications:
ML66(config)#snmp-server trapenable 1

12.8 sys_notes

Synopsis
sys_notes <NOTES>

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 95


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to add any kind of information related to the site, for example
logging a site visit.

Use show sys_notes command to display the added information.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

NOTES The entered site related information.

Note: Maximum 800 characters are allowed to enter.

Examples
Adding site related information:
ML66(config)#sys_notes "This is notes for the node"

12.9 timezone

Synopsis
timezone <CONTINENT> <CITY>

Description
Use this command to set the time zone.

There is no TAB command completion for the <CONTINENT> and <CITY>


operands, but all possible choices are listed when pressing TAB. The operands
have to be typed in full.

Note: A warm restart by using the restart node_warm command is required


before the new time zone changes take effect.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

CONTINENT The continent of the time zone.

96 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Basic Configuration Commands

CITY The city of the time zone.

Examples
Setting the time zone:
ML66(config)#timezone Europe Stockholm

Then return to Privileged Exec mode and perform a warm restart for the NE:
ML66(config)#exit
ML66#restart node_warm

See Also
restart node_warm

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 97


CLI Descriptions

13 DCN Basic Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
12.

The following command mode is applicable for the DCN basic commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

Table 12 DCN Basic Commands Overview


dcn-lan-ctag enable double tagged Data Communication Network
(DCN) traffic on Provider Bridge
dcn-mode change between DCN-Mode VLAN and DCN-Mode
Routed
pingtargethost define a Ping Target Host that is pinged

The related show commands are the following:

— show dcn-lan-ctag

— show dcn-mode

— show pingtargethost

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

13.1 dcn-lan-ctag

Synopsis

— dcn-lan-ctag ctag <C-TAG> [ priority <PRIORITY> ]

— no dcn-lan-ctag

Description
Use this command to enable double tagged Data Communication Network (DCN)
traffic on Provider Bridge.

Use the no option to disable double tagged DCN traffic.

98 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


DCN Basic Commands

Note: The feature is automatically disabled when the DCN VLAN configuration
is changed.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

C-TAG Sets the VLAN C-tag (0x8100) used for DCN double
tagged traffic.

The valid range is 1–4094.

PRIORITY Sets the VLAN priority bits used for DCN traffic.

The valid range is 0–7. The default value is 0.

Examples
Enabling DCN double tagging with 101 C-tag and 4 priority:
ML66(config)#dcn-lan-ctag ctag 101 priority 4

13.2 dcn-mode

Synopsis
dcn-mode {vlan | routed}

Description
Use this command to change between DCN-Mode VLAN and DCN-Mode Routed.
By default, DCN-Mode VLAN is selected.

Note: When changing the DCN mode to DCN-Mode Routed, the address of the
interface configured by the ip host interface command becomes the
host address.

It is recommended to remove the LAN-DCN configuration, for example,


the VLAN interface membership.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Options

vlan Sets DCN-Mode VLAN. This is the default DCN mode of


the NE.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 99


CLI Descriptions

routed Sets DCN-Mode Routed.

Examples
Changing to DCN-Mode Routed:
ML66(config)#dcn-mode routed

13.3 pingtargethost

Synopsis

— pingtargethost <IPADDR>

— no pingtargethost [<IPADDR> ]

Description
Use this command to define a Ping Target Host that is pinged while the Local
Access (USB) interface is disabled. If Ping Target Host is unreachable from the
NE the Local Access (USB) interface is enabled, regardless of its admin status is
set to down.

Use the no option to remove the Ping Target Host address.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Local Access configuration submode, at admin level— (interface-local-


access)

Operands

IPADDR The Ping Target Host IPv4 address in <A.B.C.D> format or


IPv6 address in <X:X::X:X> format.

The 0.0.0.0 IP address triggers a remove operation.

The following IPv4 addresses are not allowed to set as


Ping Target Host:

— Loopback addresses (subnet with 127.0.0.0/8).

— Link-local addresses (subnet with 169.254.0.0/16).

— Multicast addresses (subnet with 224.0.0.0/4).

100 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


DCN Basic Commands

— Reserved addresses (subnet with 240.0.0.0/4).

— The default host address (192.168.0.1).

— An address within the default subnet of the Local


Access (USB) interface (10.0.0.0/30).

— An address, which is already used by any active


interface (LO-DCN, LAN-DCN).

The following IPv6 addresses are not allowed to set as


Ping Target Host:

— Loopback address (::1/128) because it is not a


global unicast address.

— Link-local addresses (all addresses starting with


fe80::/10).

— Multicast addresses (all addresses starting with


ff00::/8).

— An address within the default subnet of the Local


Access (USB) interface (2001:db8::/127).

— An address within the configured subnet of the Local


Access (USB) interface.

— The address of any other active DCN interface (LO-


DCN, LAN-DCN).

Examples
Defining a Ping Target Host:
ML66(config)#pingtargethost 172.31.28.95

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 101


CLI Descriptions

14 LAN-DCN IP Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
13.

The following command mode is applicable for the LAN-DCN IP commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

Table 13 LAN-DCN IP Commands Overview


lan-dcn ip dhcp set the IP address of the Dynamic Host
relayaddress Configuration Protocol (DHCP) server for
which the NE is a relay
lan-dcn ip set the name of the domain to which the NE
domainname belongs
lan-dcn ip dscp set DSCP value for all IPv4 DCN services
lan-dcn ip name-server configure Domain Name System (DNS) servers
lan-dcn ip route establish IPv4 default or static routes

The related show commands are the following:

— show lan-dcn

— show lan-dcn ip

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

14.1 lan-dcn ip dhcp relayaddress

Synopsis

— lan-dcn ip dhcp relayaddress <DHCPRELAYADDRESS>

— no lan-dcn ip dhcp

Description
A Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) server allows nodes in the
network to request an IP address. The lan-dcn ip dhcp relayaddress
command makes the NE a relay for a specific DHCP server, making it possible for
nodes without direct contact with the DHCP server to request IP addresses
through the NE.

102 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LAN-DCN IP Commands

Use the no option to remove DHCP server settings.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

DHCPRELAYADDRESS
The address of the DHCP server for which the NE is a
relay.

Examples
Setting the address of the DHCP server for which the NE is a relay:
ML66(config)#lan-dcn ip dhcp relayaddress 192.168.0.1

14.2 lan-dcn ip domainname

Synopsis
[no] lan-dcn ip domainname <DOMAINNAME>

Description
Use this command to set the name of the domain to which the NE belongs, which
is used for name resolution.

Use the no option to remove domainname settings.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

DOMAINNAME The name of the domain.

The maximum length of the full domain name including


dots, is 253 characters. For example, www.example.com
counts 15 characters.

The maximum length of a label, which is part of the


domain name and separated by dots, is 63 characters.
For example, in www.example.com, www, example, and
com are the labels.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 103


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Setting the name of the domain:
ML66(config)#lan-dcn ip domainname labdomain

14.3 lan-dcn ip dscp

Synopsis

— lan-dcn ip dscp <DSCP>

— no lan-dcn ip dscp

Description
Use this command to set the Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP) value for
all IPv4 DCN service traffic originating from the node. DSCP is a field in the IPv4
packet header, which is used to achieve different QoS behavior in the network.

Use the no option to reset the default DSCP value, that is, the default forwarding.
The default value is 0.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

DSCP The DSCP value to set. The valid range is 0–63.

Examples
Setting the DSCP value:
ML66(config)#lan-dcn ip dscp 8

14.4 lan-dcn ip name-server

Synopsis

— lan-dcn ip name-server <IPADDRESS> [ <IPADDRESS>


[ <IPADDRESS> ] ]

— no lan-dcn ip name-server [<IPADDRESS> ]

104 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LAN-DCN IP Commands

Description
Use this command to add a Domain Name System (DNS) server with IP address.
The maximum number of allowed DNS servers is three. Domain names are
resolved in order by the given DNS servers.

Use the no option to remove all DNS servers or a specific DNS server.

Note: DNS server configuration is common to IPv4 and IPv6.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

IPADDRESS The address of the DNS server, where the format is


<A.B.C.D> for IPv4 or <X:X::X:X> for IPv6 addresses.

Examples
Setting an IPv4 DNS server:
ML66(config)#lan-dcn ip name-server 1.1.1.1

14.5 lan-dcn ip route

Synopsis

— lan-dcn ip route <DEST/PREFIX> <NEXTHOP>

— no lan-dcn ip route <DEST/PREFIX> [<NEXTHOP>]

Description
Use this command to establish IPv4 default or static routes.

Use the no option to remove static routes.

Note: Maximum 100 LAN-DCN IPv4 static routes can be defined.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

DEST/PREFIX The IP destination prefix, specified in decimal notation


<A.B.C.D>, followed by a prefix length, <PREFIX = 0–
32>. Use 0.0.0.0/0 to refer to the default gateway.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 105


CLI Descriptions

NEXTHOP The address of the next system on the route, specified in


decimal notation <A.B.C.D>. IP address 0.0.0.0 cannot be
used.

Examples
Establishing default route:
ML66(config)#lan-dcn ip route 0.0.0.0/0 192.168.0.1

106 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LAN-DCN IPv6 Commands

15 LAN-DCN IPv6 Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
14.

The following command mode is applicable for the LAN-DCN IPv6 commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

Table 14 LAN-DCN IPv6 Commands Overview


lan-dcn ipv6 dhcp set the IPv6 address of a Dynamic Host
relayaddress Configuration Protocol (DHCP) server for
which the NE is a relay
lan-dcn ipv6 set the name of the domain to which the NE
domainname belongs
lan-dcn ipv6 dscp set DSCP value for all IPv6 DCN services
lan-dcn ipv6 name- configure Domain Name System (DNS) servers
server
lan-dcn ipv6 route establish IPv6 default or static routes

The related show commands are the following:

— show lan-dcn

— show lan-dcn ipv6

— show lan-dcn ipv6 dhcp relayaddress

— show lan-dcn ipv6 dhcp status

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

15.1 lan-dcn ipv6 dhcp relayaddress

Synopsis

— lan-dcn ipv6 dhcp relayaddress <DHCPRELAYADDRESS>

— no lan-dcn ipv6 dhcp

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 107


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to make the NE a relay for a specific Dynamic Host
Configuration Protocol (DHCP) server. In this way, the nodes can request IPv6
addresses through the NE without direct contact with the DHCP server.

Use the no option to remove DHCP server settings.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

DHCPRELAYADDRESS
The IPv6 address or host name of the DHCP server for
which the NE is a relay.

Examples
Setting the address of the DHCP server for which the NE is a relay:
ML66(config)#lan-dcn ipv6 dhcp relayaddress 2005::34

15.2 lan-dcn ipv6 domainname

Synopsis
[no] lan-dcn ipv6 domainname <DOMAINNAME>

Description
Use this command to set the name of the domain to which the NE belongs, which
is used for name resolution.

Use the no option to remove domain name settings.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

DOMAINNAME The name of the domain.

The maximum length of the full domain name including


dots, is 253 characters. For example, www.example.com
counts 15 characters.

108 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LAN-DCN IPv6 Commands

The maximum length of a label, which is part of the


domain name and separated by dots, is 63 characters.
For example, in www.example.com, www, example, and
com are the labels.

Examples
Setting the name of the domain:
ML66(config)#lan-dcn ipv6 domainname labdomain

15.3 lan-dcn ipv6 dscp

Synopsis

— lan-dcn ipv6 dscp <DSCP>

— no lan-dcn ipv6 dscp

Description
Use this command to set the Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP) value for
all IPv6 DCN service traffic originating from the node. DSCP is part of the Traffic
Class field in the IPv6 packet header, which is used to achieve different QoS
behavior in the network.

Use the no option to reset the default DSCP value, that is, the default forwarding.
The default value is 0.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

DSCP The DSCP value to set. The valid range is 0–63.

Examples
Setting the DSCP value:
ML66(config)#lan-dcn ipv6 dscp 8

15.4 lan-dcn ipv6 name-server

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 109


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis

— lan-dcn ipv6 name-server <IPADDRESS> [ <IPADDRESS>


[ <IPADDRESS> ] ]

— no lan-dcn ipv6 name-server [<IPADDRESS> ]

Description
Use this command to add a Domain Name System (DNS) server with IP address.
The maximum number of allowed DNS servers is three. Domain names are
resolved in order by the given DNS servers.

Use the no option to remove all DNS servers or a specific DNS server.

Note: DNS server configuration is common to IPv4 and IPv6.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

IPADDRESS The address of the DNS server, where the format is


<A.B.C.D> for IPv4 or <X:X::X:X> for IPv6 addresses.

Examples
Setting an IPv6 DNS server:
ML66(config)#lan-dcn ipv6 name-server 2005::34

15.5 lan-dcn ipv6 route

Synopsis

— lan-dcn ipv6 route <DEST/PREFIX> <NEXTHOP>

— no lan-dcn ipv6 route <DEST/PREFIX> [<NEXTHOP> ]

Description
Use this command to establish IPv6 default or static routes.

Use the no option to remove the given static routes. When executing the no
option without the next hop operand, multiple static routes are deleted.

Note: Maximum 100 LAN-DCN IPv6 static routes can be defined.

110 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LAN-DCN IPv6 Commands

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

DEST/PREFIX The IPv6 destination prefix, specified in <X:X::X:X>


format, followed by a prefix length, <PREFIX = 0–128>.
Use 0::0/0 to refer to the default gateway.

NEXTHOP The address of the next system on the route, specified in


<X:X::X:X> format. IPv6 address 0::0 cannot be used.

Examples
Establishing default route:
ML66(config)#lan-dcn ipv6 route 0::0/0 2005::34

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 111


CLI Descriptions

16 LAN-DCN Interface Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
15.

The following command modes are applicable for the LAN-DCN interface
commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— LAN-DCN Interface configuration submode — (interface-lan-dcn)

Table 15 LAN-DCN Interface Commands Overview


interface ip configure the IP parameters of a LAN-
DCN IP interface
interface lan-dcn configure the LAN-DCN interface
ip address set the IP address of the LAN-DCN
interface
ipv6 address set the IPv6 address of the LAN-DCN
interface
mtu set Maximum Transmission Unit
(MTU) size
trapenable enable alarms and events

The related show commands are the following:

— show confirm

— show current

— show interface (DCN)

— show interface ip

— show ip interface host

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

16.1 interface ip

Synopsis
interface ip [<IFNAME_RSP>]

112 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LAN-DCN Interface Commands

Description
Use this command to configure the IP parameters of an IP interface for both IPv4
and IPv6 parameters.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

IFNAME_RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port values of the LAN-DCN IP


interface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/Port>. The
default value is 1/6/0 if the operand is not specified.

Examples
Configuring IP parameters of the LAN-DCN IP interface:
ML66(config)#interface ip

16.2 interface lan-dcn

Synopsis

— interface lan-dcn

— interface ip lan-dcn

Description
Use this command to configure the IP parameters of the LAN-DCN interface. The
command also changes to the (interface-lan-dcn) submode.

This command is the alias for the interface ip 1/6/0 command.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Configuring the IP parameters of the LAN-DCN interface:
ML66(config)#interface lan-dcn
ML66(interface-lan-dcn)#

16.3 ip address

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 113


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis

— ip address <ADDR/PREFIX>

— no ip address [<ADDR/PREFIX> ]

Description
Use this command to set the IP address of the LAN-DCN IP interface.

Use the no option to reset or remove the IP address.

Note: The IP address of the LAN-DCN interface cannot be removed. The no ip


address command sets it to the default value of 192.168.0.1/24.

Command Mode
LAN-DCN Interface configuration submode — (interface-lan-dcn)

Operands

ADDR/PREFIX The IP address and network prefix of the interface.


Specified in decimal notation <A.B.C.D/P> , for example
1.2.3.4/24.

The 0.0.0.0/0 IP address triggers a reset operation.

For IPv4 address limitations, see Table 114.

Examples
Setting the IP address of the LAN-DCN IP interface:
ML66(interface-lan-dcn)#ip address 172.31.29.48/24

Removing the IP address:


ML66(interface-lan-dcn)#no ip address

or

ML66(interface-lan-dcn)#no ip address 172.31.29.48/24

16.4 ipv6 address

Synopsis

— ipv6 address <ADDR/PREFIX>

114 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LAN-DCN Interface Commands

— no ipv6 address [<ADDR/PREFIX> ]

Description
Use this command to set the IPv6 address on the LAN-DCN IP interface.

Use the no option to remove the IPv6 address.

Command Mode
LAN-DCN Interface configuration submode — (interface-lan-dcn)

Operands

ADDR/PREFIX The IPv6 address and network prefix of the interface,


specified in <X:X::X:X/P> format, for example
2005::23/64.

The 0::0/0 IPv6 address triggers a remove operation.

For IPv6 address limitations, see Table 115.

Examples
Setting the IPv6 address of the LAN-DCN IP interface:
ML66(interface-lan-dcn)#ipv6 address 2005::23/64

Removing the IPv6 address:


ML66(interface-lan-dcn)#no ipv6 address

or
ML66(interface-lan-dcn)#no ipv6 address 2005::23/64

16.5 mtu

Synopsis

— mtu <MTU>

— no mtu

Description
Use this command to set the Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) size of a Data
Communication Network (DCN) interface, that is, to set the maximum size of the
packets.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 115


CLI Descriptions

Use the no option to set the MTU size to its default value.

Command Mode
LAN-DCN Interface configuration submode — (interface-lan-dcn)

Operands

MTU Size of the MTU in bytes. The valid range is 576–9000.


The default value is 1500.

For IPv6, the MTU size must be at least 1280 bytes.

Attention!
The MTU size must be the same in the whole network.
Changing the MTU size in one node could affect the DCN
traffic.

Examples
Setting MTU size to 1400 bytes:
ML66(interface-lan-dcn)#mtu 1400

16.6 trapenable

Synopsis
[no] trapenable

Description
Use this command to enable alarms and events.

Use the no option to disable alarms and events.

Command Mode
LAN-DCN Interface configuration submode — (interface-lan-dcn)

Examples
Enabling alarms and events:
ML66(interface-lan-dcn)#trapenable

116 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


DCN Loopback Interface Commands

17 DCN Loopback Interface Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
16.

The following command modes are applicable for the DCN loopback interface
commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Interface DCN Loopback configuration mode — (interface-lo-dcn)

Table 16 DCN Loopback Interface Commands Overview


interface lo-dcn configure the DCN loopback interface
ip address set the IPv4 address of the DCN
loopback interface
ipv6 address set the IPv6 address of the DCN
loopback interface

The related show commands are the following:

— show confirm

— show current

— show interface

— show ip interface host

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

17.1 interface lo-dcn

Synopsis

— interface lo-dcn

— interface ip lo-dcn

Description
Use this command to configure the DCN loopback interface. The command also
changes to the (interface-lo-dcn) submode.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 117


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Configuring the DCN loopback interface:
ML66(config)#interface lo-dcn
ML66(interface-lo-dcn)#

17.2 ip address

Synopsis

— ip address <ADDR/PREFIX>

— no ip address [<ADDR/PREFIX> ]

Description
Use this command to set the IP address of the DCN loopback interface. When
specifying the IP address for the first time, the host address of the node becomes
the address of the DCN loopback interface. This makes the address of the DCN
loopback interface the primary IP address to access the node.

Use the no option to remove the IP address of the DCN loopback interface. In this
case the IP address of the LAN-DCN interface becomes the host address of the
node again.

Command Mode
Interface DCN Loopback configuration mode — (interface-lo-dcn)

Operands

ADDR/PREFIX The IP address and network prefix of the DCN loopback


interface. Specified in decimal notation <A.B.C.D/P> , for
example, 1.2.3.4/32.

The network prefix is fixed as /32, that is, the subnet


mask is 255.255.255.255. The 0.0.0.0/0 IP address
triggers a remove operation.

For IPv4 address limitations, see Table 114.

Examples
Setting the IP address of the DCN loopback interface:

118 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


DCN Loopback Interface Commands

ML66(interface-lo-dcn)#ip address 172.31.29.47/32

Removing the IP address of the DCN loopback interface:


ML66(interface-lo-dcn)#no ip address

or

ML66(interface-lo-dcn)#no ip address 172.31.29.47/32

17.3 ipv6 address

Synopsis

— ipv6 address <ADDR/PREFIX>

— no ipv6 address [<ADDR/PREFIX> ]

Description
Use this command to set the IPv6 address of the DCN loopback interface. When
specifying the IPv6 address for the first time, the IPv6 host address of the node
becomes the address of the DCN loopback interface. This makes the address of
the DCN loopback interface the primary IPv6 address to access the node.

Use the no option to remove the IPv6 address of the DCN loopback interface. In
this case the IPv6 address of the LAN-DCN interface becomes the IPv6 host
address of the node again.

Command Mode
Interface DCN Loopback configuration mode — (interface-lo-dcn)

Operands

ADDR/PREFIX The IPv6 address and network prefix of the DCN


loopback interface. Specified in decimal notation
<X:X::X:X/P> format, for example 2005::47/128.

The network prefix is fixed as /128. The 0::0/0 IPv6


address triggers a remove operation.

For IPv6 address limitations, see Table 115.

Examples
Setting the IPv6 address of the DCN loopback interface:
ML66(interface-lo-dcn)#ipv6 address 2005::47/128

Removing the IPv6 address of the DCN loopback interface:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 119


CLI Descriptions

ML66(interface-lo-dcn)#no ipv6 address

or
ML66(interface-lo-dcn)#no ipv6 address 2005::47/128

120 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


DCN Local Access (USB) Interface Commands

18 DCN Local Access (USB) Interface


Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
17.

The following command modes are applicable for the DCN Local Access (USB)
interface commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Local Access configuration submode — (interface-local-access)

Table 17 DCN Local Access (USB) Interface Commands Overview


interface local-access configure the Local Access (USB)
interface
ipv6 address set the IPv6 address of the DCN Local
Access (USB) interface
pingtargethost define a Ping Target Host that is
pinged
shutdown disable local access to the NE

The related show commands are the following:

— show confirm

— show current

— show interface

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

18.1 interface local-access

Synopsis

— interface local-access [<IFNAME_RSP>]

— interface ip local-access [<IFNAME_RSP>]

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 121


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to configure the Local Access (USB) interface. The command
also changes to the (interface-local-access) submode.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

IFNAME_RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port values of the Local Access (USB)
interface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/Port>. The
default value is 1/6/1 if the operand is not specified.

Examples
Configuring a Local Access (USB) port:
ML66(config)#interface local-access
ML66(interface-local-access)#

18.2 ipv6 address

Synopsis

— ipv6 address <ADDR/PREFIX>

— no ipv6 address [<ADDR/PREFIX> ]

Description
Use this command to set the IPv6 address of the DCN Local Access (USB)
interface.

Use the no option to reset the IPv6 address of the DCN Local Access (USB)
interface.

Note: The IPv6 address of the DCN Local Access (USB) interface cannot be
removed.

The no ipv6 address command sets it to the default value of


2001:db8::/127.

Command Mode
Local Access configuration submode — (interface-local-access)

122 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


DCN Local Access (USB) Interface Commands

Operands

ADDR/PREFIX The IPv6 address and network prefix of the DCN Local
Access (USB) interface. Specified in <X:X::X:X/P> format,
for example 2007::48/127.

The network prefix is fixed as /127. The 0::0/0 IPv6


address triggers a reset operation.

For the IPv6 address limitations, see Table 115.

Examples
Setting the IPv6 address of the DCN Local Access (USB) interface:
ML66(interface-local-access)#ipv6 address 2007::48/127

Resetting the IPv6 address of the DCN Local Access (USB) interface:
ML66(interface-local-access)#no ipv6 address

or
ML66(interface-local-access)#no ipv6 address 2007::48/127

18.3 pingtargethost
For a detailed description of this command, see pingtargethost on page 100.

18.4 shutdown

Synopsis
shutdown

Description
Use this command together with the pingtargethost command to disable local
access to the NE by disabling the Local Access (USB) port.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 123


CLI Descriptions

Note: — If the NE cannot access the defined Ping Target Host, the NE
enables the Local Access (USB) interface regardless of it has been
disabled by the shutdown command. This prevents the
inaccessibility of the NE on all interfaces.

— If the Local Access (USB) port is disabled, it is no longer possible to


access the Data Communication Network (DCN) and the NE on-site.

— If the Local Access (USB) interface is disabled, the NE tries to access


the Ping Target Host every 15 minutes.

— If the Ping Target Host (SNMP or CLI) is changed, a ping test is


immediately performed.

Command Mode
Local Access configuration submode, at admin level — (interface-local-
access)

Examples
Disabling local access to the NE:
ML66(interface-local-access)#shutdown

124 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router Basic Commands

19 Router Basic Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
18.

The following command modes are applicable for the router IP commands:

— Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

— Privileged Exec mode, at admin level — #

Table 18 Router Basic Commands Overview


access-list create and configure access-list
capability enable Virtual Routing and
Forwarding lite (VRF-lite) support
debug turn on extra logging
match as-path match an autonomous system (AS)
path access list
match community specify a community to be matched
match extcommunity match a BGP external community list
match interface define an interface match criterion
match ip address specify the match address of a route
match ip address prefix-list match entries of a prefix list
match ip next-hop specify a next hop address to be
matched in a route map
match ip next-hop prefix-list specify the next hop IP address match
criterion using the prefix list
match ip peer specify the match peer IPv4 address
of a route
match metric match a metric of a route
match origin match origin code
match route-type match specified external route type
match tag match the specified tag value
route-map enter Route-map mode and permit or
deny match and set operations
router-id specify a router ID common for Open
Shortest Path First (OSPF), Border
Gateway Protocol (BGP), Label

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 125


CLI Descriptions

Distribution Protocol (LDP), and so on


processes
set aggregator set the AS number for the route map
and router ID
set as-path modify an AS path for a route
set atomic-aggregate set an atomic aggregate attribute
set comm-list delete the matching communities from
the community attribute of an inbound
or outbound update when applying
route-map
set community set the community attributes and
group destinations in a certain
community, as well as apply routing
decisions according to those
communities
set dampening enable route-flap dampening and set
parameter
set extcommunity set an extended community attribute
set extcomm-list delete the matched extended
communities
set ip next-hop set the specified next hop value
set level set the IS-IS level to export a route
set local-preference set the BGP local preference path
attribute
set metric set a metric value for a route and
influence external neighbors about the
preferred path into an autonomous
system (AS)
set metric-type set the metric type for the destination
routing protocol
set origin set the BGP origin code
set originator-id set the originator ID attribute
set tag set a specified tag value
set vpnv4 next-hop set a VPNv4 next hop address
set weight set weights for the routing table

The related show commands are the following:

— show access-list

— show capability vrf-lite

— show debug

126 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router Basic Commands

— show route-map

— show router-id

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

19.1 access-list

Synopsis

— [no] access-list {<NAME> | <NUMBER1> | <NUMBER2> | <NUMBER3>


| <NUMBER4>}

— [no] access-list <NAME> {deny | permit} any

— [no] access-list <NAME> {deny | permit} <IPADDR/PREFIX> exact-


match

— [no] access-list {<NUMBER1> | <NUMBER3>} {deny | permit}


<IPADDR> <IPADDR2>

— [no] access-list {<NUMBER1> | <NUMBER3>} {deny | permit} any

— [no] access-list {<NUMBER1> | <NUMBER3>} {deny | permit} host


<IPADDR>

— [no] access-list {<NUMBER2> | <NUMBER4>} {deny | permit} {<IANA>


| ah | any | esp | gre | icmp | igmp | ip | ipcomp | ipv4 | ospf | pim | rsvp |
tcp | udp | vrrp} {<SOURCE/PREFIX> | any} {<DEST/PREFIX> | any}
[fragments | log | interface {in | out} {<IFNAME_VLAN> |
<IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> | lo | lo.<VRF>} | label <LABEL> | {pkt-size {gt
| lt} <PKTSIZE> | pkt-size range <PKTSIZE_LOW> <PKTSIZE_HIGH>} |
precedence <PRECEDENCE> | {tos <TOS> | tos range <TOS_LOW>
<TOS_HIGH>}]

— [no] access-list {<NAME> | <NUMBER1> | <NUMBER2> | <NUMBER3>


| <NUMBER4>} remark <LINE>

Description
Use this command to create and configure access-list.

Use the no option to remove a specified access list.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 127


CLI Descriptions

Options

deny Specifies packets to reject.

permit Specifies packets to forward.

remark Specify comment for access-list entry.

any Any source/destination host.

host A single host address.

exact-match Exact match of the prefix.

Operands

NAME The name of the access list.

SOURCE/PREFIX
Source IP address with prefix length, where the format is
<A.B.C.D/P> .

DEST/PREFIX Destination IP address with prefix length, where the


format is <A.B.C.D/P> .

IPADDR IP address, where the format is <A.B.C.D> .

IPADDR2 Wildcard bits, where the format is <A.B.C.D> .

LINE A string of up to 80 characters that describe the access


list.

IFNAME_VLAN The VLAN number of the L3 VLAN interface, where the


format is vlan.<VLAN>, for example, vlan.100.

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN
The Rack, Slot, and Port values and VLAN number of the
L3 VLAN subinterface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/
Port.VLAN> , for example, 1/9/4.500.

lo The router loopback interface.

lo.VRF The loopback interface of a VRF instance, for example


lo.vrf_1.

NUMBER1 IP standard access list, valid range is 1–99.

NUMBER2 IP extended access list, valid range is 100–199.

128 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router Basic Commands

NUMBER3 IP standard access list with expanded range, valid range


is 1300–1999.

NUMBER4 IP extended access list with expanded range, valid range


is 2000–2699.

IANA IANA assigned protocol number. Valid range is 0–255.

LABEL Label value. Valid range is 1–65535.

PKTSIZE Packet size greater/less than. Valid range is 0–65535.

PKTSIZE_LOW Packet size range low value. Valid range is 0–65535.

PKTSIZE_HIGH Packet size range high value. Valid range is 0–65535.

PRECEDENCE Precedence value. Valid range is 0–7.

TOS Type of Service value. Valid range is 0–255.

TOS_LOW Type of Service lowest value in the range. Valid range is


0–255.

TOS_HIGH Type of Service highest value in the range. Valid range is


0–255.

VRF The name of the VRF instance.

Examples
ML66# access-list 150 permit any 1.2.3.4/32 any fragments label 5 log precedence 7

19.2 capability

Synopsis
[no] capability vrf-lite

Description
Use this command to enable Virtual Routing and Forwarding lite (VRF-lite)
support. To enable Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS) commands and Open
Shortest Path First (OSPF) Provider Edge-Customer Edge (PE-CE) support, this
parameter must be disabled.

Use the no option to disable VRF-lite support.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 129


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Turning off VRF-lite support (for L3 VPN):
ML66(config)#no capability vrf-lite

19.3 debug

Synopsis
[no] debug [bfd | bgp | hal | imi | isis | ldp | nsm | ospf | rsvp]

Description
Use this command to turn on extra logging for the associated router feature or
protocol. The log file is included in the next bug report.

The command is not persistent if entered in Exec mode, and persistent if entered
in Global Configuration mode.

Use the no option to turn off extra logging. It is recommended to disable logging
unless it is needed.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Privileged Exec mode, at admin level — #

Options

bfd Extra logging for Bidirectional Forwarding Detection


(BFD).

bgp Extra logging for Border Gateway Protocol (BGP).

hal Extra logging for Hardware Abstraction Layer (HAL).

imi Extra logging for Integrated Management Interface


(IMI).

isis Extra logging for the IS-IS routing protocol.

130 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router Basic Commands

ldp Extra logging for Label Distribution Protocol (LDP).

nsm Extra logging for Network Services Manager (NSM).

ospf Extra logging for Open Shortest Path First (OSPF).

rsvp Extra logging for Reservation Protocol (RSVP).

Examples
Turning on OSPF Link State Advertisement (LSA) debugging (non-persistent):
ML66#debug ospf lsa

Turning on OSPF LSA debugging (persistent):


ML66(config)#debug ospf lsa

Turning off OSPF LSA debugging (persistent):


ML66(config)#no debug ospf lsa

19.4 match as-path

Synopsis
match as-path <PATHNAME>

no match as-path [<PATHNAME>]

Description
Use this command to match an Autonomous System (AS) path access list by
specifying its skipped name.

There are four possible scenarios when executing this command:

— If the AS path access list is empty, the match rule is ignored and the match is
therefore skipped.

— If there is a match for the specified AS path access list and if the AS path
access list is empty, the match rule is ignored and the match is specified as
permit. The route is redistributed or controlled, as specified by the set action.

— If the match criteria are met and is specified, the route is not redistributed or
controlled.

— If the match criteria are not met, the route is neither accepted nor forwarded,
irrespective of permit or deny specifications.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 131


CLI Descriptions

The route specified by match as-path criteria, can differ from the one specified by
the routing protocols. Setting policies enable packets to take different routes,
depending on their length or content. Packet forwarding based on configured
policies overrides packet forwarding specified in routing tables.

Note: This command is valid only for BGP.

Use the no form of this command to remove a path list entry.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

PATHNAME Specifies an AS path access list by its name.

Examples
Setting the AS path access list to myaccesslist:
ML66(config-route-map)# match as-path myaccesslist

19.5 match community

Synopsis
match community {<NUMBER> | <NAME>} [exact-match]

no match community [<NUMBER> | <NAME> exact-match]

Description
Use this command to specify a community to be matched.

Communities are used to group and filter routes. They are designed to provide
the ability to apply policies to large number of routes by using match and set
commands. Community lists are used to identify and filter routes by their
common attributes. This command allows the matching based on community
lists.

The values set by the match community command overrides the global values.
The route that does not match at least one match clause is ignored.

Note: This command is only valid for BGP.

Use the no option to remove a community list entry.

132 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router Basic Commands

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

NUMBER The community list number. The standard value is 1-99,


the expanded value is 100-199.

NAME The community list name.

Options

exact-match Exact matching of communities.

Examples
Setting the community list name to mylist:
ML66(config-route-map)# match community mylist

19.6 match extcommunity

Synopsis
[no] match extcommunity {<NUMBER> | <NAME>} [exact-match]

Description
Use this command to match a BGP external community list.

Communities are used to group and filter routes. They are designed to provide
the ability to apply policies to large number of routes by using match and set
commands. Community lists are used to identify and filter routes by their
common attributes. This command allows the matching based on community
lists.

The values set by this command overrides the global values. The route that does
not match at least one match clause is ignored.

Note: This command is valid only for BGP.

Use the no form of this command to remove an external community list entry.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 133


CLI Descriptions

Operands

NUMBER The community list number The standard value is 1-99,


the expanded value is 100-199.

NAME The community list name.

Options

exact-match Exact matching of communities.

Examples
Setting the community list name to mylist:
ML66(config-route-map)# match extcommunity mylist

19.7 match interface

Synopsis
[no] match interface {<R/S/P.VLAN> | <vlan.VLAN> | <lo> | <R/S/P-
HIERARCHY>}

Description
Use this command to define an interface match criterion. This command specifies
the next hop interface name of a route to be matched.

Use the no form of this command to remove an interface match crietrion.

This function is disabled by default.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN
The Rack, Slot, and Port values and VLAN number, where
the format is <Rack/Slot/Port.VLAN> , for example,
1/9/4.500.

lo The router loopback interface.

IFNAME_RSP_H The Rack, Slot, Port, and Hierarchy values of the


interface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/Port-
Hierarchy>, for example, 1/5/5-RS:D1-3.

134 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router Basic Commands

Examples
Setting the next hop interface to eth0:
ML66(config-route-map)# match interface eth0

19.8 match ip address

Synopsis
match ip address {STANDARD | EXPANDED | NAME}

no match ip address [STANDARD | EXPANDED | NAME]

Description
Use this command to specify the match address of a route. If there is a match for
the specified IP address and permit is specified, the route is redistributed or
controlled, as specified by the set action. If the match criteria are met and deny is
specified, then the route is not redistributed or controlled. If the match criteria are
not met, the route is neither accepted nor forwarded, irrespective of permit or
deny specifications.

The route specified by the policies can differ from the one specified by the routing
protocols. Setting policies enable packets to take different routes, depending on
their length or content. Packet forwarding based on configured policies overrides
packet forwarding specified in routing tables.

Use the no form of this command to remove a match IP address entry.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

STANDARD The IP access list number (standard: 1-99).

EXPANDED The IP access list number (expanded: 1300-2699).

NAME The IP access list name.

Examples
Setting the IP list access name to list 1:
ML66(config-route-map)# match ip address list 1

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 135


CLI Descriptions

19.9 match ip address prefix-list

Synopsis
match ip address prefix-list <NAME>

no match ip address prefix-list [<NAME>]

Description
Use this command to match entries of a prefix list. If the specified prefix list is
empty, this match rule is ignored and the match is skipped.

The route specified by match ip address prefix-list criteria could be different as


specified by the routing protocols. set policies enable packets to take different
routes depending on their length or content. Packet forwarding based on the
configured policies overrides packet forwarding specified in routing tables.

Use the no form of this command to disable this function.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

NAME Specifies the IP prefix list name.

Examples
Setting the IP address prefix-list name to mylist:
ML66(config-route-map)# match ip address prefix-list mylist

19.10 match ip next-hop

Synopsis
match ip next-hop {<STANDARD> | <EXPANDED> | <NAME>}

no match ip next-hop [<STANDARD> | <EXPANDED> | <NAME>]

Description
Use this command to specify a next hop address to be matched in a route map.
The route specified by the policies could be different as specified by the routing
protocols. Setting policies enable packets to take different routes depending on

136 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router Basic Commands

their length or content. Packet forwarding based on configured policies overrides


packet forwarding specified in routing tables.

Use the no form of this command to disable this function.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

STANDARD Specify the IP access list number. The standard range is


1–99.

EXPANDED Specify the IP access list number. The expanded range is


1300–2699.

NAME Specifies the IP access list name.

Examples
Setting the next-hop address IP access list name to mylist:
ML66(config-route-map)# match ip next-hop mylist

19.11 match ip next-hop prefix-list

Synopsis
match ip next-hop <NAME>

no match ip next-hop [prefix-list <NAME>]

Description
Use this command to specify the next hop IP address match criterion using the
prefix list. This command matches the next hop IP address of a route.

Use the no form of this command to remove a match criterion.

This function is disabled by default.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 137


CLI Descriptions

Operands

NAME Specifies the IP prefix list name.

Examples:
Setting the next hop IP prefix list to list 1:
ML66(config-route-map)# match ip next-hop prefix-list list1

19.12 match ip peer

Synopsis
match ip peer {<STANDARD> | <EXPANDED> | <NAME>}

no match ip peer [<STANDARD> | <EXPANDED> | <NAME>]

Description
Use this command to specify the match peer IPv4 address of a route.

Use the no form of this command to remove a match criterion.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

STANDARD Specifies the IP access list number. The standard range is


1–99.

EXPANDED Specifies the IP access list number. The expanded range


is 1300–2699.

NAME Specifies the IP access list name.

Examples
Specifying IP peer 123:
ML66(config-route-map)# match ip peer 123

Removing IP peer 123:


ML66(config-route-map)# no match ip peer 123

138 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router Basic Commands

19.13 match metric

Synopsis
[no] match metric <METRIC>

Description
Use this command to match a metric of a route. The route specified by the
policies could be different as specified by the routing protocols. Setting policies
enable packets to take different routes depending on their length or content.
Packet forwarding based on configured policies overrides packet forwarding
specified in routing tables.

Note: This command is valid only for BGP, OSPF, RIP, and IS-IS.

Use the no form of this command to disable this function.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

METRIC Specifies the metric value. The valid range is 0–


4294967295.

Examples
Setting the metric value to 888999:
ML66(config-route-map)# match metric 888999

19.14 match origin

Synopsis
match origin {egp | igp | incomplete

no match origin [egp | igp | incomplete]

Description
Use this command to match origin code. The following origin attributes define
the origins of the path information:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 139


CLI Descriptions

— EQP — This parameter is indicated as an e in the routing table, and it


indicates that the origin of the information is learned via Exterior Gateway
Protocol (EGP).

— IGP — This parameter is indicated as an i in the routing table, and it


indicates the origin of the path information is interior to the originating AS.

— Incomplete — This parameter is indicated as a ? in the routing table, and


indicates that the origin of the path information is unknown or learned
through other means. If a static route is redistributed into BGP, the origin of
the route is incomplete.

This command specifies the origin to be matched. If there is a match for the
specified origin, and permit is specified when you created the route-map, the
route is redistributed or controlled as specified by the set action. If the match
criteria are met, and denies are specified, the route is not redistributed or
controlled. If the match criteria are not met, the route is neither accepted nor
forwarded, irrespective of permit or deny specifications.

The route specified by the policies could be different as specified by the routing
protocols. Setting policies enable packets to take different routes depending on
their length or content. Packet forwarding based on configured policies overrides
packet forwarding specified in routing tables.

Note: This command is valid only for BGP.

Use the no form of this command to disable the matching.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

EQP Remote exterior gateway protocol.

IQP Local internal gateway protocol.

Incomplete Unknown heritage.

Examples
Matching origin code EQP:
ML66(config-route-map)# match origin eqp

140 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router Basic Commands

19.15 match route-type

Synopsis
match route-type external {type-1 | type-2}

no match route-type external [type-1 | type-2]

Description
Use this command to match specified external route type. AS-external LSA is
either Type-1 or Type-2. External type-1 matches only Type 1 external routes
and external type-2 matches only Type 2 external routes.

Use the no form of this command to disable the matching.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

TYPE-1 Matches OSPF External Type 1 metrics.

TYPE-2 Matches OSPF External Type 2 metrics.

Examples
Matching the external router type to Type-1:
ML66(config-route-map)# match route-type external type-1

19.16 match tag

Synopsis
match tag <TAG>

no match tag [<TAG>]

Description
Use this command to match the specified tag value.

Use the no form of this command to disable the declaration.

The matching is disabled by default.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 141


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

TAG The tag value.

Examples
Setting the tag vaule to 100:
ML66(config-route-map)# match tag 100

19.17 router-id

Synopsis

— router-id <ROUTER_ID>

— no router-id [<ROUTER_ID> ]

Description
Use this command to specify a router ID common for Open Shortest Path First
(OSPF), Border Gateway Protocol (BGP), Label Distribution Protocol (LDP), and
so on processes. Use router-id command to set a process specific router ID.

Use the no option to remove the router ID.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

ROUTER_ID Router ID in IPv4 address format, that is, <A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Specifying a common router ID:
ML66(config)#router-id 10.10.10.60

142 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router Basic Commands

19.18 route-map

Synopsis
[no] route-map <MAPNAME> {permit | deny} <SEQUENCE>

Description
Use this command to enter Route-map mode and to permit or deny match and
set operations.

This command controls and modifies routing information to allow route


redistribution. It has a list of match and set commands associated with it. The
match commands specify the conditions under which redistribution is allowed,
and the set commands specify the particular redistribution actions to be
performed if the criteria enforced by match commands are met. Route maps are
used for detailed control over route distribution between routing processes.

Route maps also allow policy routing, and might route packets to a different
route than the obvious shortest path.

Use the no form of this command to disable the declaration.

Note: A route map tag can be an alphanumeric string up to 80 characters,


including spaces. The string cannot begin with a number.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode, at admin level — (config)

Operands

MAPNAME The route-map tag.

SEQUENCE The sequence to insert into or delete from an existing


route-map entry.

Options

permit Route map permits set operations. If this parameter is


specified and the match criteria are met, the route is
redistributed as specified by set actions. If the match
criteria are not met, the next route map with the same tag
is tested.

deny Route map denies set operations. If this parameter is


specified and the match criteria are met, the route is not
redistributed and any other route maps with the same
map tag are not examined.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 143


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Entering the route-map submode and permitting set operations:
ML66#configure terminal
ML66(config)#route-map route1 permit 1
ML66(config-route-map)#

19.19 set aggregator

Synopsis
set aggregator AS {<NUMBER> | <IPADDR>}

no set aggregator AS[<NUMBER> | <IPADDR>]

Description
Use this command to set the AS number for the route map and router ID. An
autonomous system (AS) is a collection of networks under a common
administration sharing a common routing strategy. It is subdivided by areas, and
is assigned a unique 16-bit number. Use the set aggregator command to assign
an AS number for the aggregator.

Use the no form of this command to disable this function.

This command requires a match clause.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

AS Specifies the AS number of the aggregator.

NUMBER The AS number.

IPADDR Specifies the IP address of the aggregator.

Examples
Setting the aggregator to AS number 43 and IP address 10.10.0.3:
ML66(config-route-map)# set aggregator AS 43 10.10.0.3

144 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router Basic Commands

19.20 set as-path

Synopsis
set as-path prepend <NUMBER>

no set as-path prepend [<NUMBER>]

Description
Use this command to modify an AS path for a route. By specifying the length of
the AS path, the router influences the best path selection by a neighbor. Use the
prepend parameter with this command to prepend an AS path string to routes
increasing the AS path length.

Use the no form of this command to disable this function.

This command requires a match clause.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

PREPEND Prepends the AS path.

NUMBER The AS number.

Examples
Modifying the AS path:
ML66(config-route-map)# set as-path prepend 8 24

19.21 set atomic-aggregate

Synopsis
[no] set atomic-aggregate

Description
Use this command to set an atomic aggregate attribute.

Use the no form of this command to disable this function.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 145


CLI Descriptions

This command requires a match clause.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Examples:
Setting atomic-aggregate:
ML66(config-route-map)# set atomic aggregate

19.22 set comm-list

Synopsis
[no] set comm-list {<NUMBER> | <NAME>} delete

Description
Use this command to delete the matching communities from the community
attribute of an inbound or outbound update when applying route-map.

Use the no form of this command to disable this function.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

NUMBER Specify the community list number (standard: 1–99,


expanded: 100–199).

NAME Specifies the community list name.

WORD Specifies the community list name.

DELETE Deletes the matching communities.

Examples
Deleting matching community 34:
ML66(config-route-map)# set comm-list 34 delete

146 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router Basic Commands

19.23 set community

Synopsis
[no] set community none

set community {<NUMBER> | <AA:NN> | internet | local-AS | no-advertise


| no-export}

no set community [<NUMBER> | <AA:NN> | internet | local-AS | no-


advertise | no-export]

Description
Use this command to set the community attributes and group destinations in a
certain community, as well as apply routing decisions according to those
communities.

Use the no form of this command to delete an entry.

This command requires a match clause.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

NONE Removes the community attribute from the prefixes that


pass the route-map.

ADDITIVE BGP community attribute (Adds to the existing


community).

AA:NN Community number in aa:nn format.

NUMBER Community number. The valid range is 1–65535.

INTERNET Internet (well-known community).

LOCAL-AS Do not send outside local AS (well-known community).

NO-ADVERTISE Do not advertise to any peer (well-known community).

NO-EXPORT Do not export to next AS (well-known community).

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 147


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Setting the community attributes to no-export and no advertise:
ML66(config-route-map)# set community no-export no-advertise

Setting the community attributes to no-advertise:


ML66(config-route-map)# set community no-advertise

19.24 set dampening

Synopsis
[no] set dampening <TIME1>

[no] set dampening <TIME1> <REUSE> [<SUPPRESS> | <TIME2> | <TIME3>]

Description
Use this command to enable route-flap dampening and set parameter in ML66.
Set the unreachability half-life time to be equal to or greater than the reachability
half-life time. The suppress-limit value must be greater than or equal to the reuse
limit value.

Use the no form of this command to delete an entry.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

TIME1 Specifies the reachability half-life time (1–45) in minutes.


The time for the penalty to decrease to one-half of its
current value. The default value is 15 minutes.

REUSE Specifies the reuse-limit value (1–20000). When the


penalty for a suppressed route decays below the reuse
value, the routes become unsuppressed. The default
reuse limit value is 750.

SUPPRESS Specifies the suppress-limit value (1–20000). When the


penalty for a route exceeds the suppress value, the route
is suppressed. The default suppress limit value is 2000.

TIME2 Specifies the max-suppress-time (1–255). Maximum


time that a dampened route is suppressed. The default

148 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router Basic Commands

max-suppress value is 4 times the half-life time (60


minutes).

TIME3 Specifies the unreachability half-life time (1–45) for


penalty, in minutes. The default value is 15 minutes.

Examples
Setting the dampening parameters:
ML66(config-route-map)# set dampening 20 333 534 30

19.25 set extcommunity

Synopsis
set extcommunity soo ASN:nn_or_IPaddr:nn

no set extcommunity soo [ASN:nn_or_IPaddr:nn]

set extcommunity rt ASN:nn_or_IPaddr:nn [additive]

no set extcommunity rt [ASN:nn_or_IPaddr:nn | additive]

Description
Use this command to set an extended community attribute.

Use the no form of this command to disable this function.

To use this command, you must first have a match clause.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

SOO Specifies the Site-of-Origin extended community.

ASN:NN_or_IPADDR:NN
Specifies the VPN extended community.

RT Specifies the Route Target extended community.

ADDITIVE BGP community attribute (Adds to the existing extended


community).

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 149


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Setting the Route Target extended community to 06:01:
ML66(config-route-map)# set extcommunity rt 06:01

Setting the Route Target extended community to 0.0.0.6:01:


ML66(config-route-map)# set extcommunity rt 0.0.0.6:01

Setting the Site-of-Origin extended community to 06:01:


ML66(config-route-map)# set extcommunity soo 06:01

Setting the Site-of-Origin extended community to 0.0.0.6:01:


ML66(config-route-map)# set extcommunity soo 0.0.0.6:01

19.26 set extcomm-list

Synopsis
[no] set extcomm-list <LISTNUMBER> | <NAME> [delete]

Description
Use this command to delete the matched extended communities.

Use the no form of this command to remove the configuration.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

NAME Specifies a community list by its name.

DELETE Deletes the matching extended communities.

Examples
Deleting matched extended list 34:
ML66(config-route-map)#set extcomm-list 34 delete

150 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router Basic Commands

19.27 set ip next-hop

Synopsis
set ip next-hop <IPADDR> [primary]

no set ip next-hop [<IPADDR> | primary]

Description
Use this command to set the specified next hop value.

Use the no form of this command to remove the setting.

The setting is disabled by default.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

IPADDR Specifies the IP address of the next hop.

PRIMARY Specifies the next hop as primary.

Examples
Setting the next hop value to 10.10.0.67:
ML66(config-route-map)# set ip next-hop 10.10.0.67

19.28 set level

Synopsis
set level {level-1 | level-2 | level-1-2}

no set level [level-1 | level-2 | level-1-2]

Description
Use this command to set the IS-IS level to export a route.

Use the no form of this command to disable this function.

The setting is disabled by default.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 151


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

LEVEL-1 Exports into a level-1 area.

LEVEL-2 Exports into level-2 sub-domain.

LEVEL-1-2 Exports into level-1 and level-2.

Exapmles
Setting the IS-IS level to exoprt into level 1:
ML66(config-route-map)# set level level-1

19.29 set local-preference

Synopsis
set local-preference <SEQUENCE>

no set local-preference [<SEQUENCE>]

Description
Use this command to set the BGP local preference path attribute.

Use the no form of this command to disable this function.

The setting is disabled by default.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

SEQUENCE The sequence value. The default value is 0–4294967295.

EXAMPLES
Setting the local preference path attribute to 12:
ML66(config-route-map)# set local preference 12

152 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router Basic Commands

19.30 set metric

Synopsis
set metric {<VALUE> | <+/-METRIC>}

no set metric [<VALUE> | <+/-METRIC>]

Description
Use this command to set a metric value for a route and influence external
neighbors about the preferred path into an autonomous system (AS).

Use the no form of this command to disable this function.

This command requires a match clause.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

VALUE The metric value. The valid range is 0–4294967295.

+/- METRIC Adds or subtracts a metric.

Examples
Setting the metric value to 600:
ML66(config-route-map)# set metric 600

19.31 set metric-type

Synopsis
[no] set metric-type [type-1 | type-2]

[no] set metric-type [internal | external]

no set metric-type

Description
Use this command to set the metric type for the destination routing protocol.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 153


CLI Descriptions

Use the no form of this command to restore the default.

Select a type to be either Type-1 or Type- 2 in the AS-external-LSA when the


route-map matches the condition.

Note: This command is only for OSPF, OSPFv3, or IS-IS.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

TYPE-1 Specifies an OSPF external type 1 metric.

TYPE-2 Specifies an OSPF external type 2 metric.

INTERNAL Specifies an IS-IS internal metric.

EXTERNAL Specifies an IS-IS external metric.

Examples
Setting the metric type of the destination protocol to OSPF external type 1:
ML66(config-route-map)# set metric-type 1

19.32 set origin

Synopsis
set origin {egp | igp | incomplete}

no set origin [egp | igp | incomplete]

Description
Use this command to set the BGP origin code.

Use the no form of this command to delete an entry.

The origin attribute defines the origin of the path information. The following
parameters with this command indicate different values:

— IGP— It is interior to the originating AS. This happens if IGP is redistributed


into the BGP.

154 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router Basic Commands

— EQP — It is learned through an Exterior Gateway Protocol.

— Incomplete — It is unknown or learned through some other means. This


happens when static route is redistributed in BGP and the origin of the route
is incomplete.

This command requires a match clause.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

EQP Specifies a remote EGP system.

IGP Specifies a local IGP system.

INCOMPLETE Specifies a system of unknown heritage.

Examples
Setting the BGP origin code to EQP:
ML66(config-route-map)# set origin eqp

19.33 set originator-id

Synopsis
set originator-id <IPADDR>

no set originator-id [<IPADDR>]

Description
Use this command to set the originator ID attribute.

Use the no form of this command to disable this function.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

IPADDR Specifies the IP address of the originator

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 155


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Setting the originator ID to 1.1.1.1:
ML66(config-route-map)# set originator id 1.1.1.1

19.34 set tag

Synopsis
set tag <value>

no set tag [<value>]

Description
Use this command to set a specified tag value.

Use the no form of this command to restore the default.

The Tag parameter is the route tag that is labeled by another routing protocol, for
example, BGP or other IGPs when redistributing, because AS-external-LSA has a
route-tag field in its LSAs. In addition, when using route-map, ML66 can tag the
LSAs with the appropriate tag value. The tag can either match with route-map or
it is used by another application.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

VALUE The tag value. The valid range is 0–4294967295.

Examples
Setting the tag value to 6:
ML66(config-route-map)# set tag 6

19.35 set vpnv4 next-hop

Synopsis
set vpnv4 next-hop <IPADDR>

no set vpnv4 next-hop [<IPADDR>]

156 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router Basic Commands

Description
Use this command to set a VPNv4 next hop address.

Use the no form of this command to disable this function.

This command requires a match clause.

Note: This command is valid only for BGP.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

Operands

IPADDR Specifies the IP address of the next hop.

Examples
Set the VPNv4 next hop address to 6.6.6.6:
ML66(config-route-map)#set vpnv4 next-hop 6.6.6.6

19.36 set weight

Synopsis
set weight <VALUE>

no set weight [<VALUE>]

Description
Use this command to set weights for the routing table.

Use the no form of this command to delete an entry.

The weight value is used to assist in best path selection. It is assigned locally to a
router. When there are several routes with a common destination, the routes with
a higher weight values are preferred.

This command requires a match clause.

Note: This command is valid only for BGP.

Command Mode
Route-map mode — (config-route-map)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 157


CLI Descriptions

Operands

VALUE The weight value. The valid range is 0–4294967295

Examples
Setting the weight value to 400:
ML66(config-route-map)# set weight 400

158 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router IP Commands

20 Router IP Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
19.

The following command modes are applicable for the router IP commands:

— Privileged Exec mode — #

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

Table 19 Router IP Commands Overview


clear arp-cache clear the router Address Resolution
Protocol (ARP) cache
ip host interface set the host interface for DCN-Mode
Routed
ip host mtu set the Maximum Transmission Unit
(MTU) size of the internal DCN
interface
ip prefix-list create an entry for a prefix-list
ip route establish IPv4 default or static routes
for the router
ip vrf create a Virtual Routing and
Forwarding (VRF) instance in the
router

The related show commands are the following:

— show ip host interface

— show ip host mtu

— show ip interface host

— show ip prefix-list

— show ip route

— show ip vrf

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 159


CLI Descriptions

20.1 clear arp-cache

Synopsis
clear arp-cache

Description
Use this command to clear the router Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) cache.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Examples
Clearing the router ARP cache:
ML66#clear arp-cache

20.2 ip host interface

Synopsis

— ip host interface [<IFNAME_RSP_H> | <IFNAME_VLAN> |


<IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> | lo]

— no ip host interface

Description
Use this command to set the host interface for DCN-Mode Routed.

Use the no option to set the host interface to be auto-selected by the NE, in the
following order of precedence:

— The Router Loopback interface if it has a valid IP address

— The first L3 VLAN interface in the default VRF having an IP address defined

— The first L3 VLAN subinterface in the default VRF having an IP address


defined

— The first serial (PPP) interface having an IP address defined

This setting is ineffective in DCN-Mode VLAN; however, the configuration is


retained.

160 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router IP Commands

In DCN-Mode VLAN, if an IPv4 or an IPv6 address is defined on the loopback


interface, that interface is the host interface. Otherwise, the LAN-DCN interface is
the host interface.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

IFNAME_VLAN The VLAN number of the L3 VLAN interface, where the


format is vlan.<VLAN>, for example, vlan.100.

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN
The Rack, Slot, and Port values and VLAN number of the
L3 VLAN subinterface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/
Port.VLAN>, for example, 1/9/4.500. The interface
should be associated with the DCN (default) VRF.

IFNAME_RSP_H The Rack, Slot, Port, and Hierarchy values of the serial
(PPP) interface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/Port-
Hierarchy>, for example, 1/5/5-RS:D1-3.

Options

lo The router loopback interface.

Examples
Setting the L3 VLAN subinterface 1/6/5.500 as the host:
ML66(config)#ip host interface 1/6/5.500

Setting the host interface to be auto-selected by the NE:


ML66(config)#no ip host interface

20.3 ip host mtu

Synopsis

— ip host mtu <MTU>

— no ip host mtu

Description
Use this command to set the Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) size of the
internal DCN interface, that is, to set the maximum size of the packets.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 161


CLI Descriptions

This command is an alias of the mtu command in the (config-router-if)


submode. When using DCN-Mode Routed, all L3 VLAN subinterfaces within the
Virtual Routing and Forwarding (VRF) must have the same MTU, otherwise the
connection does not work.

Changing the host MTU affects the MTU of the LAN-DCN interface in DCN-Mode
VLAN.

Use the no option to set the MTU size to its default value.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

MTU Size of the MTU in bytes. The valid range is 576–9000.


The default value is 1500.

Attention!
The MTU size must be the same in the whole network.
Changing the MTU size in one node could affect the DCN
traffic.

Examples
Setting MTU size to 9000 bytes:
ML66(config)#ip host mtu 9000

20.4 ip prefix-list

Synopsis

— [no] ip prefix-list <NAME>

— [no] ip prefix-list <NAME> {deny | permit} <IPADDR/PREFIX> [le


<NUMBER> | ge <NUMBER> ]

— [no] ip prefix-list <NAME> {deny | permit} any

— [no] ip prefix-list <NAME> seq <SEQNO> {deny | permit} <IPADDR/


PREFIX> [le <NUMBER> | ge <NUMBER> ]

— [no] ip prefix-list <NAME> seq <SEQNO> {deny | permit} any

162 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router IP Commands

— ip prefix-list <NAME> description <LINE>

— [no] ip prefix-list <NAME> description

— [no] ip prefix-list sequence-number

Description
Use this command to create an entry for a prefix list.

Use the no option to delete a prefix-list.

Use this command with description to add a description to the prefix list.

Use the no option to remove the description.

Use this command with sequence-number to include sequence number in


nonvolatile generation (NVGEN).

Use the no option to exclude sequence number in NVGEN.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Options

deny Specify packets to be rejected.

permit Specify packets to be accepted.

any Take packets of any length.

le Specify the maximum prefix length to be matched.

ge Specify the minimum prefix length to be matched.

seq Specify the sequence number of an entry.

description Specify the prefix list-specific description.

sequence-number
Include and exclude sequence numbers in NVGEN.

Operands

NAME The name of a prefix-list.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 163


CLI Descriptions

LINE A string of up to 80 characters that describes the prefix


list.

IPADDR/PREFIX IP address with prefix length, where the format is


<A.B.C.D/P> .

NUMBER Maximum/minimum prefix length to be matched. Valid


range is 0–32.

SEQNO Sequence number of the prefix list. Valid range is 1–


4294967295.

Examples
ML66(config)#ip prefix-list sample permit 1.2.3.4/30

20.5 ip route

Synopsis

— ip route [vrf <VRF>] <DEST/PREFIX> <NEXTHOP>

— no ip route [vrf <VRF>] <DEST/PREFIX> [<NEXTHOP>]

Description
Use this command to establish IPv4 default or static routes for the router. Use the
vrf option to define the IPv4 static route in a Virtual Routing and Forwarding
(VRF) instance other than the default. The router supports Equal-Cost Multi-Path
(ECMP) routing.

Use the no option to remove static routes. When executing the no option without
the next hop operand, multiple static routes are deleted.

Note: Maximum 100 router IPv4 static routes can be defined.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

VRF The name of the VRF instance.

DEST/PREFIX The IP destination prefix, specified in decimal notation


<A.B.C.D>, followed by a prefix length, <PREFIX = 0–
32>. Use 0.0.0.0/0 to refer to the default gateway.

164 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router IP Commands

NEXTHOP The address of the next system on the route, specified in


decimal notation <A.B.C.D>. IP address 0.0.0.0 cannot be
used.

Options

vrf Specifies the VRF instance.

Examples
Establishing default route for the router:
ML66(config)#ip route 0.0.0.0/0 192.168.0.1

Establishing default route for the router in the VRF instance vrf_1:
ML66(config)#ip route vrf vrf_1 0.0.0.0/0 172.31.0.1

20.6 ip vrf

Synopsis
[no] ip vrf <VRF>

Description
Use this command to create a Virtual Routing and Forwarding (VRF) instance in
the router. This command also changes to the (config-router-vrf) submode.

Use the no option to remove a VRF instance.

Note: — A maximum of 250 VRFs can be defined for NPU 1002 and a
maximum of 126 VRFs for NPU 1003.

— The loopback interface is automatically created for the VRF, and is


named as lo.<VRF>.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

VRF The name of the VRF instance.

Examples
Creating a VRF instance:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 165


CLI Descriptions

ML66(config)#ip vrf vrf_1


ML66(config-router-vrf)#

Removing the VRF instance vrf_1:


ML66(config)#no ip vrf vrf_1

166 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IP VRF Commands

21 IP VRF Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
20.

The following command mode is applicable for the IP Virtual Routing and
Forwarding (VRF) commands:

— VRF configuration submode — (config-router-vrf)

Table 20 IP VRF Commands Overview


description add a description for the Virtual
Routing and Forwarding (VRF)
rd assign a Route Distinguisher (RD) for
the VRF
route-target create a list of import and export route
target extended communities to the
VRF

The related show command is the following:

— show ip vrf

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

21.1 description

Synopsis

— description <LINE>

— no description

Description
Use this command to add a description for the Virtual Routing and Forwarding
(VRF) instance.

Use the no option to remove the description of the VRF instance.

Command Mode
VRF configuration submode — (config-router-vrf)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 167


CLI Descriptions

Operands

LINE The description of the VRF.

Examples
Adding a description for the VRF:
ML66(config-router-vrf)#description "My favourite VRF"

21.2 rd

Synopsis
[no] rd <RD>

Description
Use this command to assign a Route Distinguisher (RD) for the Virtual Routing
and Forwarding (VRF). The command creates routing and forwarding tables and
specifies the default RD for a VPN. The RD is added to the IPv4 prefixes of the
customer, changing them into globally unique VPN-IPv4 prefixes.

Command Mode
VRF configuration submode — (config-router-vrf)

Operands

RD The unique RD value on the router as follows:

— An Autonomous System (AS) number and an


arbitrary number, for example, 100:1.

— A 32-bit IP address and an arbitrary number, for


example, 192.16.10.1:1.

Examples
Creating an RD:
ML66(config-router-vrf)#rd 100:10

21.3 route-target

168 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IP VRF Commands

Synopsis
[no] route-target {import | export | both} <RD>

Description
Use this command to create a list of import and export route target extended
communities to the Virtual Routing and Forwarding (VRF). This command also
specifies a target VPN extended community. All routes with the specific route
target extended community are imported into all VRFs with the same extended
community as an import route target.

Note: Execute the command once for each community.

Use the no option to remove a route target.

Command Mode
VRF configuration submode — (config-router-vrf)

Operands

RD The unique Route Distinguisher (RD) value on the router


as follows:

— An Autonomous System (AS) number and an


arbitrary number, for example, 100:1.

— A 32-bit IP address and an arbitrary number, for


example, 192.16.10.1:1.

Options

import Adds a route target to the import routing information.

export Adds a route target to the export routing information.

both Adds a route target to both import and export routing


information.

Examples
Adding route target 100:10 to both import and export routing information:
ML66(config-router-vrf)#route-target both 100:10

Adding route target 100:20 to import routing information:


ML66(config-router-vrf)#route-target import 100:20

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 169


CLI Descriptions

22 Serial (PPP) Interface Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
21.

Note: — DCN over PPP is only supported when the DCN mode is set to DCN-
Mode Routed, see dcn-mode .

— These commands are only valid for ETSI.

The following command modes are applicable for the serial (PPP) interface
commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Interface Serial configuration submode — (config-serial-if)

Table 21 Serial (PPP) Interface Commands Overview


interface serial configure a serial interface for Point-
to-Point Protocol (PPP)
ip address set the IP address of a serial (PPP)
interface
ip unnumbered set the serial (PPP) interface to
numbered
mru set the Maximum Receive Unit (MRU)
size of a serial (PPP) interface
shutdown set the Administrative Status of a
serial (PPP) interface to disabled
trapenable enable alarms and events

The related show command is the following:

— show interface

— show interface ip

— show interface serial

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

22.1 interface serial

170 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Serial (PPP) Interface Commands

Synopsis

— interface serial <IFNAME_RSP_H>

— interface ip <IFNAME_RSP_H>

Description
Use this command to configure a serial interface for Point-to-Point Protocol
(PPP). The command also changes to the (config-serial-if) submode.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

IFNAME_RSP_H The Rack, Slot, Port, and Hierarchy values of the


interface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/Port-
Hierarchy>, for example, 1/5/5-RS:D1-3.

Examples
Configuring serial interface for PPP:
ML66(config)#interface serial 1/5/5-RS:D1-3
ML66(config-serial-if)#

22.2 ip address

Synopsis

— ip address <ADDR/PREFIX>

— no ip address [<ADDR/PREFIX> ]

Description
Use this command to set the IP address of a serial (PPP) interface.

Use the no option to disable the IP address of a serial (PPP) interface. After
removing the current IP address, the interface remains as a numbered interface.

Command Mode
Interface Serial configuration submode — (config-serial-if)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 171


CLI Descriptions

Operands

ADDR/PREFIX The IP address and network prefix of the interface.


Specified in decimal notation <A.B.C.D/P> , for example,
1.2.3.4/32.

The network prefix is fixed as /32, that is, the subnet


mask is 255.255.255.255. The 0.0.0.0/0 IP address
triggers a remove operation.

For IPv4 address limitations, see Table 114.

Examples
Setting the IP address of a serial interface:
ML66(config-serial-if)#ip address 1.2.3.4/32

Removing the IP address of the serial interface:


ML66(config-serial-if)#no ip address

or

ML66(config-serial-if)#no ip address 1.2.3.4/32

22.3 ip unnumbered

Synopsis
[no] ip unnumbered

Description
Use this command to set the interface to unnumbered. This is the default setting
of the serial (PPP) interfaces.

Use the no option to set the interface to numbered. For proper operation, specify
an IP address.

Command Mode
Interface Serial configuration submode — (config-serial-if)

Examples
Setting the interface to unnumbered:
ML66(config-serial-if)#ip unnumbered

172 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Serial (PPP) Interface Commands

22.4 mru

Synopsis
[no] mru <MRU>

Description
Use this command to set the Maximum Receive Unit (MRU) of the serial interface.

If the serial interface is used for DCN in DCN-Mode Routed, its MRU size must be
aligned with the MTU size of the internal DCN interface set by the ip host mtu
command, otherwise the DCN connection does not work.

Use the no option to restore the default value.

Command Mode
Interface Serial configuration submode — (config-serial-if)

Operands

MRU The MRU size in bytes. The valid range is 64–2048. The
default value is 1500.

Attention!
The MRU size must be the same in the whole network.
Changing the MRU size in one node can affect the DCN traffic.

Examples
Setting the MRU size to 1540 bytes:
ML66(config-serial-if)#mru 1540

22.5 shutdown

Synopsis
[no] shutdown

Description
Use this command to set the Administrative Status of a serial (PPP) interface to
disabled.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 173


CLI Descriptions

Use the no option to set the Administrative Status to enabled.

Command Mode
Interface Serial configuration submode — (config-serial-if)

Examples
Disabling the interface:
ML66(config-serial-if)#shutdown

22.6 trapenable

Synopsis
[no] trapenable

Description
Use this command to enable alarms and events.

Use the no option to disable alarms and events.

Command Mode
Interface Serial configuration submode — (config-serial-if)

Examples
Enabling alarms and events:
ML66(config-serial-if)#no trapenable

174 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router Loopback Interface Commands

23 Router Loopback Interface Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
22.

The following command modes are applicable for the router loopback interface
commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Router Loopback Interface configuration submode — (config-router-lo)

Table 22 Router Loopback Interface Commands Overview


interface ip lo configure the router loopback
interface or the loopback interface of a
Virtual Routing and Forwarding (VRF)
instance
ip address set the IP address of the router
loopback interface or the loopback
interface of a VRF instance

The related show commands are the following:

— show confirm

— show current

— show interface

— show interface ip

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

23.1 interface ip lo

Synopsis

— interface ip {lo | lo.<VRF> }

— interface lo

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 175


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to configure the router loopback interface or the loopback
interface of a Virtual Routing and Forwarding (VRF) instance. The command also
changes to the (config-router-lo) submode.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

lo The router loopback interface.

lo.VRF The loopback interface of a VRF instance, for example


lo.vrf_1.

Examples
Configuring the router loopback interface:
ML66(config)#interface ip lo
ML66(config-router-lo)#

23.2 ip address

Synopsis

— ip address <ADDR/PREFIX>

— no ip address [<ADDR/PREFIX> ]

Description
Use this command to set the IP address of the router loopback interface or the
loopback interface of a Virtual Routing and Forwarding (VRF) instance.

Use the no option to remove the IP address of the router loopback interface.

Command Mode
Router Loopback Interface configuration submode — (config-router-lo)

Operands

ADDR/PREFIX The IP address and network prefix of the router loopback


interface. Specified in decimal notation <A.B.C.D/P> , for
example 1.2.3.4/32.

176 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Router Loopback Interface Commands

The network prefix is fixed as /32, that is, the subnet


mask is 255.255.255.255. The 0.0.0.0/0 IP address
triggers a remove operation.

For IPv4 address limitations, see Table 114.

Examples
Setting the IP address of the router loopback interface:
ML66(config-router-lo)#ip address 12.31.29.47/32

Removing the IP address of the router loopback interface:


ML66(config-router-lo)#no ip address

or
ML66(config-router-lo)#no ip address 12.31.29.47/32

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 177


CLI Descriptions

24 L3 Interface Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
23.

The following command modes are applicable for the L3 interface commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

— VLAN configuration submode — (config-vlan)

— Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-


vlan)

— Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Table 23 L3 Interface Commands Overview


interface ip configure the IP parameters of an L3
interface
ip address set the IP address of the L3 interface
ip unnumbered enable IPv4 processing without an
explicit IPv4 address
ip vrf forwarding associate the L3 interface with a
specific Virtual Routing and
Forwarding (VRF) instance
l3enable create an L3 VLAN subinterface for an
Ethernet port
l3enable create an L3 VLAN interface for a
VLAN
mtu set the Maximum Transmission Unit
(MTU) size of an L3 interface
name set an alias name for the interface
shutdown set the Administrative Status of an L3
interface
trapenable enable alarms and events

The related protocol interface commands are the following:

— BFD Interface Commands

— OSPF Interface Commands

178 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


L3 Interface Commands

— IS-IS Interface Commands

— LDP Interface Commands

— MPLS Interface Commands

— RSVP-TE Interface Commands

The related show commands are the following:

— show confirm

— show current

— show interface

— show interface ip

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

24.1 interface ip

Synopsis
interface ip { <IFNAME_VLAN> | <IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> }

Description
Use this command to configure the IP parameters of an L3 interface. The
command also changes to the (config-router-if-vlan) or (config-router-if)
submode.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

IFNAME_VLAN The VLAN number of the L3 VLAN interface, where the


format is vlan.<VLAN>, for example, vlan.100.

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN
The Rack, Slot, and Port values and the VLAN number of
the L3 VLAN subinterface, where the format is <Rack/
Slot/Port.VLAN>, for example, 1/6/4.500.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 179


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Configuring IP parameters of a L3 VLAN interface:
ML66(config)#interface ip vlan.100
ML66(config-router-if-vlan)#

Configuring IP parameters of an L3 VLAN subinterface:


ML66(config)#interface ip 1/6/4.500
ML66(config-router-if)#

24.2 ip address

Synopsis

— ip address <ADDR/PREFIX>

— no ip address [ADDR/PREFIX]

Description
Use this command to set the IP address of the L3 interface.

Use the no option to remove the IP address.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

ADDR/PREFIX The IP address and network prefix of the interface.


Specified in decimal notation <A.B.C.D/P> , for example
1.2.3.4/24.

The 0.0.0.0/0 IP address triggers a remove operation.

For IPv4 address limitations, see Table 114.

Examples
Setting the IP address of an L3 VLAN subinterface:
ML66(config-router-if)#ip address 10.31.29.48/24

Removing the IP address:


ML66(config-router-if)#no ip address

180 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


L3 Interface Commands

or
ML66(config-router-if)#no ip address 10.31.29.48/24

24.3 ip unnumbered

Synopsis
[no] ip unnumbered

Description
Use this command to enable IPv4 processing without an explicit IPv4 address.
The L3 VLAN subinterface inherits the IPv4 address of the loopback interface of
the Virtual Routing and Forwarding (VRF) instance it is associated with.

Use the no option to disable IPv4 processing without an explicit IPv4 address.

Note: Running this command removes the IPv4 address from the interface.
Unnumbered Ethernet interface must be point-to-point, it does not work
over broadcast medium. OSPF must be configured for the loopback
interface for the connection to work.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Examples
Setting the L3 VLAN subinterface to unnumbered:
ML66(config-router-if)#ip unnumbered

24.4 ip vrf forwarding

Synopsis

— ip vrf forwarding <VRF>

— no ip vrf forwarding [<VRF> ]

Description
Use this command to associate the L3 interface with a specific Virtual Routing
and Forwarding (VRF) instance.

Use the no option to unbind the L3 interface from the VRF it is associated with.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 181


CLI Descriptions

Note: Running this command removes the IP address and other attributes of
the interface from the interface. The IP address and the other attributes
of the interface must be configured in context of the VRF.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

VRF The name of the VRF instance.

Examples
Associating the L3 VLAN subinterface with VRF instance vrf_1:
ML66(config-router-if)#ip vrf forwarding vrf_1

Unbinding the L3 VLAN subinterface from VRF vrf_1:


ML66(config-router-if)#no ip vrf forwarding vrf_1

24.5 l3enable (VLAN)

Synopsis
[no] l3enable

Description
Use this command to create a L3 VLAN interface for a VLAN.

Note: — To be able to create a L3 VLAN interface, the LAN-DCN port cannot


be set as an untagged egress port of the VLAN.

— In provider mode, Routed DCN VLANs and L3 VLAN interfaces can


only be used for single S-tagged DCN.

— The total number of L3 interfaces per node is limited to 512.

Use the no option to remove the L3 VLAN interface of the VLAN. All interface
configuration will be lost.

Command Mode
VLAN configuration submode — (config-vlan)

VLANs configuration submode — (config-vlans)

182 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


L3 Interface Commands

Examples
Creating an L3 VLAN interface for VLAN 100:
ML66(config)#vlan 100
ML66(config-vlan)#l3enable

Removing the L3 VLAN interface of VLAN 100:


ML66(config)#vlan 100
ML66(config-vlan)#no l3enable

24.6 l3enable (Ethernet Port)

Synopsis
[no] l3enable [<VLAN-ID>] [untagged]

Description
Use this command to create an L3 VLAN subinterface with the given VLAN for
the Ethernet port.

Use the no option to remove an L3 VLAN subinterface. All interface configuration


will be lost.

Note: The total number of L3 interfaces per node is limited to 512.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Operands

VLAN-ID The ID number of the VLAN.

Options

untagged If the untagged parameter is specified, the VLAN header


is removed from the outgoing packets. Incoming
untagged packets are routed on this port.

Examples
Creating an L3 VLAN subinterface connected to port 1/6/4 with VLAN 10:
ML66(config)#interface ethernet 1/6/4
ML66(config-eth)#bridge-port
ML66(config-bridgeport)#l3enable 10

Creating an untagged L3 VLAN subinterface connected to port 1/6/7 with VLAN


10:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 183


CLI Descriptions

ML66(config)#interface ethernet 1/6/7


ML66(config-eth)#bridge-port
ML66(config-bridgeport)#l3enable 10 untagged

Removing the untagged L3 VLAN subinterface 1/6/7.10:


ML66(config)#interface ethernet 1/6/7
ML66(config-eth)#bridge-port
ML66(config-bridgeport)#no l3enable 10

24.7 mtu

Synopsis

— mtu <MTU>

— no mtu

Description
Use this command to set the Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) size of an L3
interface, that is, to set the maximum size of the packets.

If the L3 interface is used for DCN in DCN-Mode Routed, its MTU size must be
aligned with the MTU size of the internal DCN interface set by the ip host mtu
command, otherwise the DCN connection does not work.

Use the no option to restore the default value.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

MTU Size of the MTU in bytes. The valid range is 576–9000.


The default value is 1500.

Attention!
The MTU size must be the same in the whole network.
Changing the MTU size in one node can affect the DCN traffic.

Examples
Setting the MTU size to 1400 bytes:

184 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


L3 Interface Commands

ML66(config-router-if)#mtu 1400

24.8 name

Synopsis

— name <NAME>

— no name

Description
Use this command to set an alias name for the interface.

Use the no option to set the alias name to the default empty string.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

NAME The alias name of the interface.

Examples
Setting an alias name for the interface:
ML66(config-router-if)#name “my alias”

24.9 shutdown

Synopsis
[no] shutdown

Description
Use this command to set the Administrative Status of an L3 interface to disabled.

Use the no option to set the Administrative Status to enabled.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 185


CLI Descriptions

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Examples
Setting the Administrative Status to enabled:
ML66(config-router-if)#no shutdown

24.10 trapenable

Synopsis
[no] trapenable

Description
Use this command to enable alarms and events for the interface.

Use the no option to disable alarms and events.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Examples
Enabling alarms and events:
ML66(config-router-if)#trapenable

186 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BFD Configuration Commands

25 BFD Configuration Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
24.

The following command mode is applicable for the Bidirectional Forwarding


Detection (BFD) configuration commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

Table 24 BFD Configuration Commands Overview


bfd multihop-peer configure BFD multihop peer timer
values

The related configuration commands are the following:

— area virtual-link

— bfd all-interfaces (IS-IS)

— bfd all-interfaces (OSPF)

— bfd disable

— bfd interval

— bfd session

— bfd slow-timer

— neighbor fall-over bfd

25.1 bfd multihop-peer

Synopsis
[no] bfd multihop-peer <SOURCE/PREFIX> <DEST/PREFIX> interval
<TRANSMIT> minrx <MINRX> multiplier <MULTIPLIER>

Description
Use this command to configure BFD multihop peer timer values.

Use the no form of this command to reset the multihop peer timer values to
default.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 187


CLI Descriptions

BFD multihop sessions are dynamically created by the neighbor fall-over


bfd command.

Note: For the changes to take effect, the clear bgp * command has to be
issued.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

SOURCE/PREFIX
The IPv4 source address and its prefix length, where the
format is <A.B.C.D/P>.

DEST/PREFIX The IPv4 destination address and its prefix length, where
the format is <A.B.C.D/P>.

TRANSMIT The BFD transmit interval in milliseconds. The valid range


is 10–4294967 ms. The default value is 300 ms.

MINRX The BFD minimum receive interval in milliseconds. The


valid range is 10–4294967 ms. The default value is 300
ms.

MULTIPLIER The failure detection multiplier. The valid range is 1–255.


The default value is 3.

Options

interval Specifies the BFD transmit interval.

minrx Specifies the BFD minimum receive interval.

multiplier Specifies the failure detection multiplier.

Examples
Configuring a multihop BFD session from 192.0.2.1/32 towards 10.1.1.1/32:
ML66(config)#bfd multihop-peer 192.0.2.1/32 10.1.1.1/32 interval 100 minrx 100 mul →
tiplier 3

188 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BFD Interface Commands

26 BFD Interface Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
25.

The following command modes are applicable for the Bidirectional Forwarding
Detection (BFD) interface commands:

— Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-


vlan)

— Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Table 25 BFD Interface Commands Overview


bfd disable disable all BFD sessions on an
interface
bfd interval configure BFD transmit and receive
intervals and the failure detection
multiplier
bfd session configure a BFD session
bfd slow-timer set the BFD slow timer interval

26.1 bfd disable

Synopsis
[no] bfd disable

Description
Use this command to disable all BFD sessions on an interface.

Use the no form of this command to enable all BFD sessions on an interface.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 189


CLI Descriptions

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#bfd disable

26.2 bfd interval

Synopsis
[no] bfd interval <TRANSMIT> minrx <MINRX> multiplier
<MULTIPLIER>

Description
Use this command to configure BFD transmit and receive intervals and the failure
detection multiplier.

Use the no form of this command to reset the transmit and receive intervals and
the failure detection multiplier to their default values.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

TRANSMIT The BFD transmit interval in milliseconds. The valid range


is 1–4294967 ms. The default value is 300 ms.

MINRX The BFD minimum receive interval in milliseconds. The


valid range is 1–4294967 ms. The default value is 300
ms.

MULTIPLIER The failure detection multiplier. The valid range is 1–255.


The default value is 3.

Options

interval Specifies the BFD transmit interval.

minrx Specifies the BFD minimum receive interval.

multiplier Specifies the failure detection multiplier.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#bfd interval 100 minrx 100 multiplier 5

190 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BFD Interface Commands

26.3 bfd session

Synopsis
[no] bfd session <SOURCE> <DEST> {demand-mode | non-persistent |
admin-down}

Description
Use this command to configure a BFD session.

Using this command, a standalone BFD session can be configured without any
existing BFD client (such as OSPF, RSVP-TE, or IS-IS). This can be useful in
scenarios where the peer has a BFD application and requires the BFD session to
be sustained.

Use the no form of this command to remove a BFD session.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

SOURCE The source IPv4 address.

DEST The destination IPv4 address.

Options

demand-mode Specifies that the session is in demand mode.

non-persistent Specifies that the session is not a persistent session.

admin-down Specifies that the session is admin down.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#bfd session 1.2.3.4 5.6.7.8 non-persistent admin-down

26.4 bfd slow-timer

Synopsis
[no] bfd slow-timer <TIMER>

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 191


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to set the BFD slow timer interval.

Use the no form of this command to unset the BFD slow timer interval.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

TIMER The BFD slow timer in milliseconds. The valid range is


1000–4294967 ms.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#bfd slow-timer 1500

192 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


OSPF Configuration Commands

27 OSPF Configuration Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
26.

The following command modes are applicable for OSPF configuration


commands:

— Privileged Exec mode — #

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Table 26 OSPF Configuration Commands Overview


area authentication enable authentication for an OSPF
area
area default-cost specify a cost for the default summary
route sent into a stub area or a Not-
so-stubby Area (NSSA).
area filter-list configure filters to advertise summary
routes on Area Border Routers (ABRs)
area multi-area-adjacency enable multi-area adjacency on an
interface
area nssa set an area as an NSSA
area range summarize OSPF routes at an area
boundary
area shortcut configure the short-cutting mode of an
area
area stub set an area as a stub area
area virtual-link configure a link between two
backbone areas
auto-cost calculate OSPF interface cost
bfd all-interfaces enable Bidirectional Forwarding
Detection (BFD) on all interfaces
clear ip ospf clear and restart all OSPF routing
processes or a selected OSPF routing
process
compatible restore the method used to calculate
summary route costs per RFC

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 193


CLI Descriptions

default-information create a default external route into an


OSPF routing domain
default-metric set default metric values for the OSPF
routing protocol
distance define OSPF route administrative
distances based on route type
distribute-list filter networks in routing updates
domain-id specify a domain ID for an OSPF VRF
instance
dscp set the OSPF DSCP value
enable db-summary-opt enable database summary list
optimization for OSPF
host configure an OSPF stub host entry
neighbor configure OSPF routers
interconnecting to non-broadcast
multiple access networks
network enable OSPF routing on interfaces
with IP addresses that match the
specified network address
ospf abr-type set an OSPF ABR type
ospf router-id specify a router ID for an OSPF
process
passive-interface suppress routing updates on an
interface
redistribute redistribute routes from a routing
protocol, static routes and kernel
routes into an OSPF routing table
router ospf create and configure an OSPF process
and change to the (config-router-ospf)
submode
router-id specify a router ID for an OSPF
process
summary-address configure IP address summaries
timers adjust minimum Link State
Advertisement (LSA) arrival interval

The related show commands are the following:

— show ip ospf

— show ip ospf border-routers

— show ip ospf database

194 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


OSPF Configuration Commands

— show ip ospf igp-shortcut-lsp

— show ip ospf igp-shortcut-route

— show ip ospf interface

— show ip ospf multi-area-adjacencies

— show ip ospf neighbor

— show ip ospf route

— show ip ospf virtual-links

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

27.1 area authentication

Synopsis

— area <AREA> authentication [message-digest]

— no area <AREA> authentication

Description
Use this command to enable authentication for an OSPF area. Running the
command without any parameter will enable simple text password
authentication.

Use the no option to remove the configuration.

Use the ip ospf authentication-key command to specify a simple text


password.

Use the ip ospf message-digest-key command to specify an MD5 password.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Operands

AREA OSPF area ID in IPv4 address format <A.B.C.D> or


decimal value. The valid range of the decimal value is 0–
4294967295.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 195


CLI Descriptions

Options

message-digest Enables MD5 authentication on the area.

Examples
Enabling authentication for an OSPF area:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#area 1 authentication message-digest

27.2 area default-cost

Synopsis
area <AREA> default-cost <COST>

Description
Use this command to specify a cost for the default summary route sent into a
stub area or a Not-so-stubby Area (NSSA).

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Operands

AREA OSPF area ID in IPv4 address format <A.B.C.D> or


decimal value. The valid range of the decimal value is 0–
4294967295.

COST Default summary cost advertised by the stub. The valid


range is 0–16777215. The default value is 1.

Examples
Setting the default cost to 10 for area 1:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#area 1 default-cost 10

27.3 area filter-list

Synopsis

— [no] area <AREA> filter-list access <ACL> [in | out]

196 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


OSPF Configuration Commands

— [no] area <AREA> filter-list prefix <ACL> [in | out]

Description
Use this command to configure filters to advertise summary routes on Area
Border Routers (ABRs).

Use the no option to remove the configuration.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Operands

AREA OSPF area ID in IPv4 address format <A.B.C.D> or


decimal value. The valid range of the decimal value is 0–
4294967295.

ACL The name of the access list or prefix list.

Options

access Uses an access list to filter networks.

prefix Uses a prefix list to filter networks.

in Filters routes sent to this area.

out Filters routes sent from this area.

Examples
Configuring filters to advertise summary routes:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#area 1 filter-list access 1 in

27.4 area multi-area-adjacency

Synopsis

— area <AREA> multi-area-adjacency { <IFNAME_RSP_H> |


<IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> | lo | lo. <VRF>} neighbor <IPADDR>

— no area <AREA> multi-area-adjacency {<IFNAME_RSP_H> | | lo |


<IFNAME_RSP_VLAN>lo. <VRF>} [neighbor <IPADDR>]

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 197


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to enable multi-area adjacency on an interface.

Use the no option to disable multi-area adjacency.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Operands

AREA OSPF area ID in IPv4 address format <<A.B.C.D> or


decimal value. The valid range of the decimal value is 0–
4294967295.

IFNAME_RSP_H The Rack, Slot, Port, and Hierarchy values of the serial
(PPP) interface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/Port-
Hierarchy>, for example, 1/5/5-RS:D1-3.

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN
The Rack, Slot, and Port values and VLAN number of the
L3 VLAN subinterface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/
Port.VLAN>, for example, 1/9/4.500.

IPADDR The IP address of the neighbor, where the format is


<A.B.C.D>.

Options

neighbor Specifies a neighbor.

lo Specifies the router loopback interface.

lo.VRF Specifies the loopback interface of a Virtual Routing and


Forwarding (VRF) instance, for example lo.vrf_1.

Examples
Enabling multi-area adjacency:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#area 1 multi-area-adjacency 1/9/4.500 neighbor 20.20.20.1 →
0

27.5 area nssa

198 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


OSPF Configuration Commands

Synopsis

— [no] area <AREA> nssa

— area <AREA> nssa [translate-candidate | translate-never |


translate-always]

— area <AREA> nssa {translator-role [candidate | never | always] | no-


redistribution | default-information-originate [metric <METRIC> |
metric-type <METRIC_TYPE> | metric <METRIC> metric-type
<METRIC_TYPE> | metric-type <METRIC_TYPE> metric <METRIC> ] |
no-summary}

— no area <AREA> nssa {translator-role | no-redistribution |


default-information-originate | no-summary}

Description
Use this command to set an area as a Not-So-Stubby-Area (NSSA).

Use the no option to remove the configuration.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Operands

AREA OSPF area ID in IPv4 address format <A.B.C.D> or


decimal value. The valid range of the decimal value is 0–
4294967295.

METRIC OSPF metric value.

The valid range is 0–16777214. The default value is 10.

METRIC_TYPE OSPF external link type. The following types can be used:

— 1 — Sets OSPF external type 1 metrics.

— 2 — Sets OSPF external type 2 metrics.

Options

translate-candidate
Sets NSSA-ABR for translate election. By default, this
option is selected.

translate-never Sets NSSA-ABR to never translate.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 199


CLI Descriptions

translate-always
Sets NSSA-ABR to always translate.

translator-role Specifies an NSSA-ABR translator role.

candidate Sets to candidate for translation.

never Sets to not translate.

always Sets to always translate.

no-redistribution
Sets to no redistribution into this NSSA area.

default-information-originate
Originates Type 7 default into this NSSA area.

metric Sets an OSPF metric.

metric-type Sets a metric type for default routes.

no-summary Sets not to send summary Link State Advertisement


(LSA) into NSSA.

Examples
Setting an area as an NSSA area:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#area 3 nssa translator-role candidate no-redistribution / →
/
default-information-originate metric 34 metric-type 2

27.6 area range

Synopsis
[no] area <AREA> range <IPADDR/PREFIX> [advertise | not-advertise]

Description
Use this command to summarize OSPF routes at an area boundary.

Use the no option to remove the configuration.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

200 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


OSPF Configuration Commands

Operands

AREA OSPF area ID in IPv4 address format <A.B.C.D> or


decimal value. The valid range of the decimal value is 0–
4294967295.

IPADDR/PREFIX IP address with prefix length, where the format is


<A.B.C.D/P> .

Options

advertise Sets to advertise the range. By default, this option is


selected.

not-advertise Sets not to advertise the range.

Examples
Summarizing OSPF routes:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#area 1 range 192.16.0.0/24

27.7 area shortcut

Synopsis

— area <AREA> shortcut [default | enable | disable]

— no area <AREA> shortcut [enable | disable]

Description
Use this command to configure the short-cutting mode of an area.

Use the no option to remove the configuration.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Operands

AREA OSPF area ID in IPv4 address format <A.B.C.D> or


decimal value. The valid range of the decimal value is 0–
4294967295.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 201


CLI Descriptions

Options

default Sets the default short-cutting behavior.

enable Enables short-cutting through the area.

disable Disables short-cutting through the area.

Examples
Disabling short-cutting through the area:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#area 52 shortcut disable

27.8 area stub

Synopsis
[no] area <AREA> stub [no-summary]

Description
Use this command to set an area as a stub area. By default, no stub area is
specified.

Use the no option to remove the configuration.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Operands

AREA OSPF area ID in IPv4 address format <A.B.C.D> or


decimal value. The valid range of the decimal value is 0–
4294967295.

Options

no-summary Disables the sending of summary link advertisements into


the stub area.

Examples
Setting an area as a stub area:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#area 1 stub no-summary

202 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


OSPF Configuration Commands

27.9 area virtual-link

Synopsis

— [no] area <AREA> virtual-link <VIRTUAL_LINK_ID> [fall-over bfd]

— area <AREA> virtual-link <VIRTUAL_LINK_ID> {authentication


[message-digest | null] | authentication-key <AUTHKEY> | message-
digest-key <KEY_ID> md5 <PASSWORD> | dead-interval
<DEAD_INTERVAL> | hello-interval <HELLO_PACKET_INTERVAL> |
retransmit-interval <RETRANSMIT_INTERVAL> | transmit-delay
<DELAY>}

— no area <AREA> virtual-link <VIRTUAL_LINK_ID> {authentication |


authentication-key | message-digest-key <KEY-ID> | dead-interval |
hello-interval | retransmit-interval | transmit-delay}

Description
Use this command to configure a link between two backbone areas that are
physically separated through other non-backbone area.

Use the no option to remove the configuration.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Operands

AREA OSPF area ID in IPv4 address format <A.B.C.D> or


decimal value. The valid range of the decimal value is 0–
4294967295.

VIRTUAL_LINK_ID
The ID associated with a virtual link neighbor, where the
format is <A.B.C.D>.

AUTHKEY Authentication key. The maximum key length is 8


characters.

KEY_ID Key ID. The valid range is 1–255.

PASSWORD The MD5 password. The maximum password length is 16


characters.

DEAD_INTERVAL Dead interval. The valid range is 1–65535 seconds.

HELLO_PACKET_INTERVAL

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 203


CLI Descriptions

Hello packet interval. The valid range is 1–65535


seconds.

RETRANSMIT_INTERVAL
Link State Advertisement (LSA) retransmit interval. The
valid range is 1–3600 seconds.

DELAY LSA transmission delay. The valid range is 1–3600


seconds.

Options

fall-over Sets fall-over detection.

bfd Sets Bidirectional Forwarding Detection (BFD) fall-over


detection.

authentication Enables authentication on the virtual link.

message-digest Uses message-digest authentication.

null Uses null authentication.

authentication-key
Sets the authentication key.

message-digest-key
Sets the message digest key.

md5 Uses MD5 algorithm.

dead-interval Sets the interval during which no packets are received


and after which the router acknowledges a neighboring
router as off-line. The default value is 40 seconds.

hello-interval Sets the interval the router waits before it sends a hello
packet. The default value is 10 seconds.

retransmit-interval
Sets the interval the router waits before it retransmits a
packet. The default value is 5 seconds.

transmit-delay Sets the interval the router waits before it transmits a


packet. The default value is 1 second.

Examples
Configuring a link between two backbone areas:

204 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


OSPF Configuration Commands

ML66(config-router-ospf)#area 1 virtual-link 10.10.11.50 hello 5 dead 10

27.10 auto-cost

Synopsis

— auto-cost reference-bandwidth <REF_BANDWIDTH>

— no auto-cost reference-bandwidth

Description
Use this command to calculate OSPF interface cost.

Use the no option to assign cost, based only on the interface bandwidth.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Operands

REF_BANDWIDTH Reference bandwidth in Mbps. The default value is 100


Mbps.

Examples
Calculating OSPF interface cost:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#auto-cost reference-bandwidth 50

27.11 bfd all-interfaces

Synopsis
[no] bfd all-interfaces

Description
Use this command to enable Bidirectional Forwarding Detection (BFD) on all
interfaces.

Use the no option to disable BFD on all interfaces.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 205


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Enabling BFD on all interfaces:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#bfd all-interfaces

27.12 clear ip ospf

Synopsis
clear ip ospf [<PROC_ID>] process

Description
Use this command to clear and restart all OSPF routing processes or a selected
OSPF routing process.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Operands

PROC_ID The ID of the OSPF process. The valid range is 0–65535.

Examples
Clearing and restarting all OSPF routing processes:
ML66#clear ip ospf process

Clearing and restarting OSPF routing process 555:


ML66#clear ip ospf 555 process

27.13 compatible

Synopsis
[no] compatible rfc1583

Description
Use this command to restore the method used to calculate summary route costs
per RFC. By default, OSPF is RFC 2328 compatible.

Prior to RFC 2328, OSPF has been compliant with RFC 1583, that specified
method for calculating the metric for summary routes based on the minimum

206 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


OSPF Configuration Commands

metric of the component paths available. RFC 2328 specifies a method for
calculating metrics based on maximum cost. With this change, it is possible that
all of the Area Border Routers (ABRs) in an area are not upgraded to the new
code at the same time. The compatible rfc1583 command addresses this issue
and allows the selective disabling of compatibility with RFC 2328.

Use the no option to disable RFC 1583 compatibility.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Examples
Restoring the method used to calculate summary route costs per RFC:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#compatible rfc1583

27.14 default-information

Synopsis

— default-information originate [metric <METRIC> | metric-type


<METRIC_TYPE> | route-map <MAPNAME> | always]

— no default-information originate [metric | metric-type | route-map


| always]

Description
Use this command to create a default external route into an OSPF routing
domain.

Use the no option to remove the configuration.

Note: The system acts like an Autonomous System Boundary Router (ASBR)
when the default-information originate command is used to
redistribute routes into an OSPF routing domain. An ASBR does not, by
default, generate a default route into the OSPF routing domain.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Operands

METRIC OSPF metric value.

The valid range is 0–16777214. The default value is 10.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 207


CLI Descriptions

METRIC_TYPE OSPF external link type. The following types can be used:

— 1 — Sets OSPF external type 1 metrics.

— 2 — Sets OSPF external type 2 metrics.

MAPNAME The route map name.

Options

metric Sets the OSPF metric used in creating the default route.
The default metric value is 10. The used value is specific
to the protocol.

metric-type Sets the OSPF external link type for default routes.

route-map References a route map.

always Advertises the default route regardless of whether the


software has a default route.

Examples
Creating a default external route into an OSPF routing domain:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#default-information originate always metric 23 metrictype →
2

27.15 default-metric

Synopsis

— default-metric <METRIC>

— no default-metric [<METRIC> ]

Description
Use this command to set default metric values for the OSPF routing protocol.

Use the no option to restore the default state.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

208 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


OSPF Configuration Commands

Operands

METRIC The metric value for the specified routing protocol. The
valid range is 1–16777214.

Examples
Setting default metric value to 100 for the OSPF routing protocol:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#default-metric 100

27.16 distance

Synopsis

— distance [<DISTANCE> | ospf] {intra-area <INTRA_AREA> | inter-


area <INTER_AREA> | external <EXTERNAL> }

— no distance <DISTANCE>

— no distance ospf

Description
Use this command to define OSPF route administrative distances based on route
type. This command sets the distance for an entire group of routes, rather than a
specific route that passes an access list.

Use the no option to restore the default value.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Operands

DISTANCE OSPF administrative distance. The valid range is 1–255.

INTRA_AREA Distance for intra-area routes. The valid range is 1–255.


The default value is 110.

INTER_AREA Distance for inter-area routes. The valid range is 1–255.


The default value is 110.

EXTERNAL Distance for external routes. The valid range is 1–255.


The default value is 110.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 209


CLI Descriptions

Options

ospf Selects OSPF routes administrative distance.

intra-area Sets the distance for intra-area routes.

inter-area Sets the distance for inter-area routes.

external Sets the distance for external routes.

Examples
Defining OSPF route administrative distances:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#distance ospf inter-area 20 intra-area 10 external 40

27.17 distribute-list

Synopsis
[no] distribute-list <NAME> in

[no] distribute-list <NAME> out {bgp | connected | isis | kernel |


static | ospf [<PROC_ID> ]}

Description
Use this command to filter networks in routing updates. This command also
redistributes other routing protocols into the OSPF routing table.

Use the no option to remove the configuration.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Operands

NAME The name of a distribute list.

PROC_ID The ID of an OSPF process. The valid range is 0–65535.

Options

in Filters incoming route updates.

out Filters outgoing route updates.

210 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


OSPF Configuration Commands

kernel Sets kernel routes.

connected Sets connected routes.

static Sets static routes.

bgp Sets Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) routes.

isis Sets Intermediate System to Intermediate System (IS-IS)


routes.

ospf Sets OSPF routes.

Examples
Filtering outgoing BGP routes:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#distribute-list list1 out bgp

27.18 domain-id

Synopsis
[no] domain-id {<DOMAIN_ID> [secondary] | NULL}

[no] domain-id type {type-as | type-as4 | type-back-comp} value


<EXT_COMM>

Description
Use this command to specify a domain ID for an OSPF Virtual Routing and
Forwarding (VRF) instance. By default, no domain ID is specified.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Operands

DOMAIN_ID OSPF domain ID in IPv4 address format <A.B.C.D> .

EXT_COMM OSPF domain ID extended community value in Hex


format.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 211


CLI Descriptions

Options

secondary When specified, the domain ID is considered as


secondary. If not specified, the domain ID is considered
as primary.

NULL Null domain ID.

type Sets the value type of the domain ID.

type-as Sets value type to AS format. The hex value is 0x0005.

type-as4 Sets value type to AS4 format. The hex value is 0x0205.

type-back-comp Sets value type for backward compatibility. Hex value is


0x8000.

Examples
Configuring a primary domain ID in IP address format:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#domain-id 12.12.12.12

Configuring a secondary domain ID in IP address format:


ML66(config-router-ospf)#domain-id 13.13.13.13 secondary

Configuring a primary domain ID in AS type format:


ML66(config-router-ospf)#domain-id type type-as value 123456abcdef

27.19 dscp

Synopsis

— dscp <DSCP>

— no dscp

Description
Use this command to set the OSPF DSCP value.

Use the no option to reset the default value.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

212 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


OSPF Configuration Commands

Operands

DSCP The DSCP value. The valid range is 0–63. The default
value is 48.

Examples
Setting the OSPF DSCP value to 16:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#dscp 16

27.20 enable db-summary-opt

Synopsis
[no] enable db-summary-opt

Description
Use this command to enable database summary list optimization for OSPF. By
default, the function is disabled.

Use the no option to disable database summary list optimization.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Examples
Enabling database summary list optimization:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#enable db-summary-opt

27.21 host

Synopsis

— host <IPADDR> area <AREA> [cost <COST> ]

— no host <IPADDR> area <AREA> [cost [<COST> ] ]

Description
Use this command to configure an OSPF stub host entry. By default, no stub host
is configured.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 213


CLI Descriptions

Use the no option to remove the configuration.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Operands

IPADDR The IP address of a stub host, where the format is


<A.B.C.D> .

AREA OSPF area ID in IPv4 address format <A.B.C.D> or


decimal value. The valid range of the decimal value is 0–
4294967295.

COST Cost value. The valid range is 0–65535.

Options

cost Sets the cost for a stub host.

Examples
Configuring OSPF stub host entry:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#host 172.16.10.100 area 1
ML66(config-router-ospf)#host 172.16.10.101 area 2 cost 10

27.22 neighbor

Synopsis

— neighbor <IPADDR> [cost <COST>]

— neighbor <IPADDR> {priority <PRIORITY> | poll-interval


<POLL_INTERVAL>}

— no neighbor <IPADDR> [cost [<COST>]]

— no neighbor <IPADDR> {priority [<PRIORITY>] | poll-interval


[<POLL_INTERVAL>]}

Description
Use this command to configure OSPF routers interconnecting to non-broadcast
multiple access networks.

Use the no option to remove the configuration.

214 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


OSPF Configuration Commands

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Operands

IPADDR The IP address of the neighbor, where the format is


<A.B.C.D> .

COST OSPF cost. The valid range is 1–65535.

PRIORITY Neighbor priority. The valid range is 0–255. The default


value is 0.

POLL_INTERVAL The inactive neighbor polling interval. The valid range is


1–65535. The default value is 120 seconds.

Options

cost Sets the OSPF cost for the neighbor.

priority Sets the 8-bit number indicating the router priority value
of the non-broadcast neighbor associated with the
specified IP address. This option does not apply to point-
to-multipoint interfaces.

poll-interval Sets the inactive neighbor polling interval.

Examples
Specifying a neighbor router:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#neighbor 1.2.3.4 priority 1 poll-interval 90
ML66(config-router-ospf)#neighbor 1.2.3.4 cost 15

27.23 network

Synopsis

— [no] network <IPADDR/PREFIX> area <AREA> [instance-id


<INSTANCE_ID>]

— [no] network <IPADDR> area <AREA> [instance-id <INSTANCE_ID>]

Description
Use this command to enable OSPF routing on interfaces with IP addresses that
match the specified network address.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 215


CLI Descriptions

Use the no option to disable OSPF routing on the interfaces.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Operands

IPADDR/PREFIX The IPv4 network address with prefix length, where the
format is <A.B.C.D/P>.

IPADDR The IPv4 network address, where the format is


<A.B.C.D>.

AREA OSPF area ID in IPv4 address format <A.B.C.D> or


decimal value. The valid range of the decimal value is 0–
4294967295.

INSTANCE_ID Instance ID. The valid range is 0–255.

Options

area Sets an OSPF area by its ID.

instance-id Sets the interface instance ID.

Examples
Enabling OSPF routing:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#network 10.0.0.0/8 area 3

27.24 ospf abr-type

Synopsis
[no] ospf abr-type [cisco | ibm | standard | shortcut]

Description
Use this command to set an OSPF Area Border Router (ABR) type. By default, the
ABR type is Cisco.

Use the no option to set the ABR type to default.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

216 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


OSPF Configuration Commands

Options

cisco Sets an alternative ABR using Cisco implementation.

ibm Sets an alternative ABR using IBM implementation.

standard Sets a standard behavior ABR.

shortcut Sets a shortcut ABR.

Examples
Setting OSPF ABR type to IBM:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#ospf abr-type ibm

27.25 ospf router-id

Synopsis

— ospf router-id <ROUTER_ID>

— no ospf router-id [<ROUTER-ID> ]

Description
Use this command to specify a router ID for an OSPF process.

Use the no option to remove the router ID.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Operands

ROUTER_ID OSPF router ID in IPv4 address format, that is,


<A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Specifying a router ID for an OSPF process:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#ospf router-id 2.3.4.5

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 217


CLI Descriptions

27.26 passive-interface

Synopsis

— passive-interface {<IFNAME_RSP_H> | <IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> | lo | lo.


<VRF>} [<IPADDR>]

— no passive-interface [{<IFNAME_RSP_H> | <IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> | lo


| lo. <VRF>} [<IPADDR>]]

Description
Use this command to suppress routing updates on an interface.

Use the no option to enable routing updates on an interface.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Operands

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN
The Rack, Slot, and Port values and VLAN number of the
L3 VLAN subinterface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/
Port.VLAN>, for example, 1/9/4.500.

IFNAME_RSP_H The Rack, Slot, Port, and Hierarchy values of the serial
(PPP) interface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/Port-
Hierarchy>, for example, 1/5/5-RS:D1-3.

IPADDR The IP address of the interface, where the format is


<A.B.C.D>.

Options

lo The router loopback interface.

lo.VRF The loopback interface of a Virtual Routing and


Forwarding (VRF) instance, for example lo.vrf_1.

Examples
Suppressing routing updates on L3 VLAN subinterface 1/9/4.500:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#passive-interface 1/9/4.500

218 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


OSPF Configuration Commands

27.27 redistribute

Synopsis

— redistribute [kernel | connected | static | bgp | isis | ospf


[<PROC_ID>] ] {metric <METRIC> | metric-type [<METRIC_TYPE>] | tag
<ROUTE_TAG>}

— no redistribute [kernel | connected | static | bgp | isis | ospf


[<PROC_ID>] ] {metric | metric-type | tag}

Description
Use this command to redistribute routes from a routing protocol, static routes and
kernel routes into an OSPF routing table.

Use the no option to disable the function.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Operands

PROC_ID The ID of an OSPF process. The valid range is 0–65535.

METRIC OSPF metric value.

The valid range is 0–16777214. The default value is 10.

METRIC_TYPE OSPF external link type. The following types can be used:

— 1 — Sets OSPF external type 1 metrics.

— 2 — Sets OSPF external type 2 metrics.

ROUTE_TAG The external route tag. The valid range is 0–


4294967295.

Options

kernel Sets kernel routes.

connected Sets connected routes.

static Sets static routes.

bgp Sets Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) routes.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 219


CLI Descriptions

isis Sets Intermediate System to Intermediate System (IS-IS)


routes.

ospf Sets OSPF routes.

metric Sets an OSPF metric.

metric-type Sets a metric type for the redistributed routes.

tag Sets an external route tag.

Examples
Redistributing information from another routing protocol:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#redistribute bgp metric 12

27.28 router ospf

Synopsis
[no] router ospf [<PROC_ID> [vrf <VRF>]]

Description
Use this command to create an OSPF process. This command also changes to
(config-router-ospf) submode.

Use the no option to remove an OSPF process.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

PROC_ID The ID of the OSPF process. The valid range is 0–65535.


The default value is 0.

VRF The name of the Virtual Routing and Forwarding (VRF)


instance that the OSPF process is bound to.

Options

vrf Specifies to bind the OSPF process to a VRF instance.

220 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


OSPF Configuration Commands

Examples
Creating an OSPF process and changing to the (config-router-ospf) submode:
ML66(config)#router ospf 0
ML66(config-router-ospf)#

27.29 router-id

Synopsis

— router-id <ROUTER_ID>

— no router-id [<ROUTER_ID> ]

Description
Use this command to specify a router ID for an OSPF process. This router ID
overrides the common router ID of the router set by the router-id command.

Use the no option to remove the router ID.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Operands

ROUTER_ID OSPF router ID in IPv4 address format, that is,


<A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Specifying a router ID for an OSPF process:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#router-id 10.10.10.60

27.30 summary-address

Synopsis
[no] summary-address <IPADDR/PREFIX> [not-advertise | tag <TAG> ]

Description
Use this command to configure IP address summaries.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 221


CLI Descriptions

Use the no option to disable the configuration of IP address summaries.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Operands

IPADDR/PREFIX

TAG Tag value. The valid range is 0–4294967295. The default


value is 0.

Options

not-advertise Suppresses external routes that match the prefix.

tag Sets a tag.

Examples
Configure IP address summaries:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#summary-address 172.16.0.0/16 tag 3

27.31 timers

Synopsis
timers [lsa arrival <SAME_LSA_MIN_DELAY> | spf
[<SPF_RECEIVING_DELAY> <SPF_CALC_HOLD_TIME> | exp
<SPF_MIN_RECEIVING_DELAY> ] | throttle lsa all
<THROTTLE_STARTING_DELAY> ]

Description
Use this command to adjust minimum Link State Advertisement (LSA) arrival
interval.

Command Mode
OSPF Router configuration submode — (config-router-ospf)

Operands

SAME_LSA_MIN_DELAY

222 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


OSPF Configuration Commands

The minimum delay in acceptance of the same LSA in ms.


The valid range is 0–600000.

SPF_RECEIVING_DELAY
The delay between receiving a change to SPF calculation
in ms. The valid range is 0–2147483647.

SPF_CALC_HOLD_TIME
The hold time between consecutive SPF calculations in
ms. The valid range is 0–2147483647.

SPF_MIN_RECEIVING_DELAY
The minimum delay between receiving a change to SPF
calculation in ms. The valid range is 0–2147483647.

THROTTLE_STARTING_DELAY
The starting delay for LSA generation calculation in ms.
The valid range is 0–600000.

Options

lsa Sets LSA.

spf Sets OSPF SPF timers.

throttle Sets OSPF LSA throttle timers.

Examples
Adjusting minimum LSA arrival interval:
ML66(config-router-ospf)#timers lsa arrival 3

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 223


CLI Descriptions

28 OSPF Interface Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
27.

The following command modes are applicable for OSPF interface commands:

— Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-


vlan)

— Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Table 27 OSPF Interface Commands Overview


ip ospf authentication enable authentication
ip ospf authentication-key set an OSPF authentication password
for the neighboring routers
ip ospf bfd enable Bidirectional Forwarding
Detection (BFD) on an OSPF interface
ip ospf cost set the interface cost
ip ospf database-filter filter OSPF Link State Advertisement
(LSA) during synchronization and
flooding
ip ospf dead-interval set the interval during which no hello
packets are received
ip ospf disable disable OSPF packet processing on an
interface
ip ospf hello-interval set the time between hello packets
ip ospf message-digest-key set an MD5 authentication password
ip ospf mtu set the Maximum Transmission Unit
(MTU) size of the OSPF interface
ip ospf mtu-ignore configure OSPF to not check the MTU
size
ip ospf network set the OSPF network type
ip ospf priority set the router priority
ip ospf retransmit-interval set the time between retransmitting
lost LSAs
ip ospf transmit-delay set the link state transmit delay

The related show commands are the following:

224 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


OSPF Interface Commands

— show ip ospf

— show ip ospf border-routers

— show ip ospf database

— show ip ospf igp-shortcut-lsp

— show ip ospf igp-shortcut-route

— show ip ospf interface

— show ip ospf multi-area-adjacencies

— show ip ospf neighbor

— show ip ospf route

— show ip ospf virtual-links

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

28.1 ip ospf authentication

Synopsis

— ip ospf authentication [null | message-digest]

— no ip ospf authentication

Description
Use this command to enable authentication.

Use the no option to disable authentication.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Options

null Uses no authentication. Overrides password or message-


digest authentication of the interface.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 225


CLI Descriptions

message-digest Uses message-digest authentication.

Examples
Setting no authentication:
ML66(config-router-if)#ip ospf authentication null

28.2 ip ospf authentication-key

Synopsis

— ip ospf authentication-key <AUTHKEY>

— no ip ospf authentication-key

Description
Use this command to specify a simple text OSPF authentication password for the
neighboring routers.

Use the no option to remove the configuration.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

AUTHKEY Authentication key. The maximum key length is 8


characters.

Examples
Setting authentication password mypwd:
ML66(config-router-if)#ip ospf authentication-key mypwd

28.3 ip ospf bfd

Synopsis

— ip ospf bfd [disable]

226 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


OSPF Interface Commands

— no ip ospf bfd

Description
Use this command to enable Bidirectional Forwarding Detection (BFD) on an
OSPF interface.

Use the no option to disable BFD on an OSPF interface.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Options

disable Disables BFD.

Examples
Enabling BFD on an OSPF interface:
ML66(config-router-if)#ip ospf bfd

28.4 ip ospf cost

Synopsis

— ip ospf cost <COST>

— no ip ospf cost

Description
Use this command to set the interface cost.

Use the no option to restore the default value.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 227


CLI Descriptions

Operands

COST The cost of the interface. The valid range is 1–65535. The
default value is 10.

Examples
Setting the interface cost to 10:
ML66(config-router-if)#ip ospf cost 10

28.5 ip ospf databse-filter

Synopsis

— ip ospf database-filter all out

— no ip ospf database-filter

Description
Use this command to filter OSPF Link State Advertisement (LSA) during
synchronization and flooding.

Use the no option to turn off the filter.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Options

all Filters all LSAs.

out Filters outgoing LSAs.

Examples
Filtering OSPF LSAs:
ML66(config-router-if)#ip ospf database-filter all out

228 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


OSPF Interface Commands

28.6 ip ospf dead-interval

Synopsis

— ip ospf dead-interval <DEAD_INTERVAL>

— no ip ospf dead-interval

Description
Use this command to set the interval during which no hello packets are received
and after which a neighbor is declared inactive.

Use the no option to restore the default.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

DEAD_INTERVAL The dead interval- The valid range is 1–65535. The


default value is 40 seconds.

Examples
Setting the dead interval to 10 seconds:
ML66(config-router-if)#ip ospf dead-interval 10

28.7 ip ospf disable

Synopsis
[no] ip ospf disable all

Description
Use this command to disable OSPF packet processing on an interface.

Use the no option to restore the default.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 229


CLI Descriptions

Options

all Disables all functionality.

Examples
Disabling OSPF:
ML66(config-router-if)#ip ospf disable all

28.8 ip ospf hello-interval

Synopsis

— ip ospf hello-interval <HELLO_INTERVAL>

— no ip ospf hello-interval

Description
Use this command to set the time between hello packets.

Use the no option to restore the default.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

HELLO_INTERVAL
The hello interval. The valid range is 1–65535 seconds.
The default value is 10 seconds.

Examples
Setting the hello interval to 3 seconds:
ML66(config-router-if)#ip ospf hello-interval 3

28.9 ip ospf message-digest-key

Synopsis

— ip ospf message-digest-key <KEY_ID> md5 <PASSWORD>

230 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


OSPF Interface Commands

— no ip ospf message-digest-key <KEY_ID>

Description
Use this command to register a key for OSPF MD5 authentication.

Use the no option to remove the configuration.

The router uses an algorithm based on the OSPF packet, the key and the key ID
to generate a message digest that gets appended to the packet. This command
supports uninterrupted transition between passwords. The system begins a
rollover process until all the neighbors have adopted the new password.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

KEY_ID Key ID. The valid range is 1–255.

PASSWORD OSPF key, a string of 1 to 16 characters. The maximum


key length is 16 characters.

Options

md5 Uses the MD5 algorithm.

Examples
Setting MD5 authentication password yourpass:
ML66(config-router-if)#ip ospf message-digest-key 1 md5 yourpass

Change MD5 authentication password to yourpass2:


ML66(config-router-if)#ip ospf message-digest-key 2 md5 yourpass2

Removing the old MD5 authentication password:


ML66(config-router-if)#no ip ospf message-digest-key 1

28.10 ip ospf mtu

Synopsis

— ip ospf mtu <MTU>

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 231


CLI Descriptions

— no ip ospf mtu

Description
Use this command to set the Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU) size of the
OSPF interface.

Use the no option to restore the default.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

MTU Size of the MTU in bytes. The valid range is 576–65535.

Attention!
The MTU size must be the same in the whole network.
Changing the MTU size in one node could affect the DCN
traffic.

Examples
Setting the MTU size to 1480 bytes:
ML66(config-router-if)#ip ospf mtu 1480

28.11 ip ospf mtu-ignore

Synopsis
[no] ip ospf mtu-ignore

Description
Use this command to configure OSPF to not check the MTU size during database
description exchange.

Use the no option to configure OSPF to check the MTU size during database
description exchange.

232 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


OSPF Interface Commands

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Examples
Configuring OSPF to not check the MTU size:
ML66(config-router-if)#ip ospf mtu-ignore

28.12 ip ospf network

Synopsis
ip ospf network [broadcast | non-broadcast | point-to-multipoint |
point-to-point]

Description
Use this command to set the OSPF network type. By default, the OSPF network
type is broadcast.

Use the no option to restore the default.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Options

broadcast Sets OSPF broadcast multi-access network type.

non-broadcast Sets OSPF Non-Broadcast Multiple Access (NBMA)


network type.

point-to-multipoint
Sets OSPF point-to-multipoint network type.

point-to-point Sets OSPF point-to-point network type.

Examples
Setting the OSPF network type to point-to-point:
ML66(config-router-if)#ip ospf network point-to-point

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 233


CLI Descriptions

28.13 ip ospf priority

Synopsis

— ip ospf priority <PRIORITY>

— no ip ospf priority

Description
Use this command to set the router priority.

Use the no option to restore the default.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

PRIORITY The router priority. The valid range is 0–255. The default
value is 1.

Examples
Setting the router priority to 3:
ML66(config-router-if)#ip ospf priority 3

28.14 ip ospf retransmit-interval

Synopsis

— ip ospf retransmit-interval <RETRANSMISSION_INTERVAL>

— no ip ospf retransmit-interval

Description
Use this command to set the time between retransmitting lost Link State
Advertisements (LSAs).

Use the no option to restore the default.

234 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


OSPF Interface Commands

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

RETRANSMISSION_INTERVAL
LSA retransmission interval. The valid range is 1–65535
seconds. The default value is 5 seconds.

Examples
Setting the OSPF retransmission interval to 6 seconds:
ML66(config-router-if)#ip ospf retransmit-interval 6

28.15 ip ospf transmit-delay

Synopsis

— ip ospf transmit-delay <DELAY>

— no ip ospf transmit-delay

Description
Use this command to set the link state transmit delay.

Use the no option to restore the default.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

DELAY The transmit delay. The valid range is 1–65535.

Examples
Setting the OSPF transmit delay to 3 seconds:
ML66(config-router-if)#ip ospf transmit-delay 3

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 235


CLI Descriptions

29 IS-IS Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
28.

The following command modes are applicable for the Intermediate System–
Intermediate System (IS-IS) commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Exec mode — >

— Privileged Exec mode — #

— IS-IS Router configuration submode — (config-router-isis)

— Keychain submode — (config-keychain)

— Keychain key submode — (config-keychain-key)

Table 28 IS-IS Commands Overview


accept-lifetime specify the time period during which
the authentication on a keychain is
received as valid
area-password set the authentication password for
the Level-1 area, and set
authentication on Level-1 SNP PDUs
authentication key-chain set the keychain to be used for
authentication at the instance level
authentication mode set the authentication mode at the
instance level
authentication send-only set the send-only option at the
instance level
bfd all-interfaces enable the Bidirectional Forwarding
Detection (BFD) feature on the
interfaces enabled with an IS-IS
instance
clear clns is-neighbors clear IS neighbor adjacencies
clear clns neighbors clear CLNS neighbor adjacencies
clear ip isis clear IS-IS routing information
clear isis clear and restart a selected IS-IS
routing instance

236 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IS-IS Commands

domain-password set the authentication password for


the Level-2 domain and to set the
authentication password on Level-2
SNP PDUs
ip route high-priority assign a high priority to an IS-IS IP
prefix
is-type set the IS to the specified level of
routing
key manage, add, or delete authentication
keys in a keychain
key chain enter the keychain management
submode, and configure a keychain
with a keychain name
key-string specify a password to be used by a key
lsp-gen-interval set the minimum interval before
regenerating the same LSP
lsp-mtu set the MTU size of LSPs
lsp-refresh-interval set the LSP refresh interval
max-area-address configure the maximum number of
addresses for an IS-IS area
max-lsp-lifetime set the maximum LSP lifetime
metric-style configure the IS-IS metric style
net add a Network Entity Title (NET) to an
instance
redistribute enable redistribution of information
from another routing protocol
router isis initiate an IS-IS routing instance and
enter IS-IS mode
send-lifetime specify the time period during which
the authentication key on a keychain
can be sent
set-overload-bit set the overload-bit in self-LSPs
spf-interval-exp set the minimum and maximum hold
intervals between Shortest Path First
(SPF) calculations
summary-address configure a summary address to
summarize IPv4 reachability
information

The related show commands are the following:

— show clns is-neighbors

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 237


CLI Descriptions

— show clns neighbors

— show ip isis igp-shortcut-lsp

— show ip isis route

— show ip isis route igp-shortcut

— show isis counter

— show isis database

— show isis interface

— show isis topology

— show running-config router

29.1 accept-lifetime

Synopsis

— accept-lifetime <STARTTIME> <STARTDATE> {<ENDTIME>


<ENDDATE> | duration <DURATION> | infinite}

— no accept-lifetime

Description
Use this command to specify the time period during which the authentication on
a keychain is received as valid.

Use the no form of this command to remove the configuration.

The related commands are the following:

— key

— key chain

— key-string

— send-lifetime

Command Mode
Keychain key submode — (config-keychain-key)

238 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IS-IS Commands

Operands

STARTTIME The start time of the accept lifetime in hours, minutes and
seconds, in the show rsvp interf: <HH:MM:SS> .

STARTDATE The start date of the accept lifetime in the following


format: <MONTH DAY YEAR> — Month of the year using
the first three letters of the month, day of the month, and
year using four digits. For example, Feb 3 2018.

ENDTIME The end time of the accept lifetime in hours, minutes and
seconds, in the following format: <HH:MM:SS> .

ENDDATE The end date of the accept lifetime in the following


format: <MONTH DAY YEAR> — Month of the year using
the first three letters of the month, day of the month, and
year using four digits. For example, Feb 3 2018.

DURATION The duration of the accept lifetime in seconds. The valid


range is 1–2147483646 s.

Options

duration Specifies the duration of the accept lifetime.

infinite Specifies the accept lifetime to never expire.

Examples
Setting the accept lifetime for key 1 on the keychain named mychain:
ML66(config-keychain-key)#accept-lifetime 03:03:01 Dec 3 2004 04:04:02 Dec 3 2006
ML66(config-keychain-key)#no accept-lifetime

29.2 area-password

Synopsis

— area-password <PASSWORD> [authenticate snp {send-only | validate

— no area-password

Description
Use this command to set the authentication password for the Level-1 area and to
set authentication on Level-1 SNP PDUs. This command enables authentication
when receiving and sending LSP and SNP PDU in Level-1 areas. The area
password must be the same for all the IS-IS routers in the same area.}]

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 239


CLI Descriptions

Use the no form of this command to remove the configuration.

The related commands are the following:

— domain-password

Command Mode
IS-IS Router configuration submode — (config-router-isis)

Operands

PASSWORD The area password. The maximum password length is


254 characters. In the default setting, the area password
is not configured.

Options

send-only Specifies to only insert the password into the Level-1 SNP
PDUs, but not to check the password in SNP PDUs that it
receives. Use this keyword during a software upgrade to
ease the transition.

validate Specifies to insert the password into the Level-1 SNP


PDUs and to check the password in SNPs that it receives.

Examples
ML66(config-router-isis)#area-password mypasswd
ML66(config-router-isis)#area-password mypasswd authenticate snp send-only
ML66(config-router-isis)#no area-password

29.3 authentication key-chain

Synopsis

— authentication key-chain <NAME> [level-1 | level-2]

— no authentication key-chain [level-1 | level-2]

Description
Use this command to set the keychain to be used for authentication at the
instance level. Authentication mode must be set to md5 to configure the keychain.
If no keychain is configured with the key command, no keychain authentication
is performed.

Only one authentication keychain is applied to a IS-IS interface at a time. That is,
executing a second isis authentication key-chain command overrides the

240 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IS-IS Commands

first isis authentication key-chain command. If neither the level-1 nor


the level-2 keyword is configured, the chain applies to both levels.
Authentication can be specified for an individual IS-IS interface using the isis
authentication key-chain command.

Use the no form of this command to unset the keychain used for authentication.

Command Mode
IS-IS Router configuration submode — (config-router-isis)

Operands

NAME The keychain name (valid authentication keys). In the


default setting, the keychain applies to the levels on
which authentication mode is configured as MD5 if no
level is specified.

Options

level-1 Specifies an authentication keychain for level-1 PDUs.

level-2 Specifies an authentication keychain for level-2 PDUs.

Examples
ML66(config-router-isis)#authentication mode md5
ML66(config-router-isis)#authentication key-chain ipi level-1

29.4 authentication mode

Synopsis
[no] authentication mode {md5 | text} [level-1 | level-2]

Description
Use this command to set the authentication mode at the instance level.

If clear-text authentication was configured using the area-password or domain-


password commands, the authentication mode command overrides both of
those commands (based on the level at which MD5 is configured). If the
authentication mode command was used first, and subsequently an attempt is
made to use the area-password or domain-password commands, the attempt
fails. To configure clear-text authentication using the area-password or domain-
password commands, first use the no authentication mode command.

If neither the level-1 nor the level-2 keyword is configured, the authentication
mode applies to both levels.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 241


CLI Descriptions

The type of authentication and the level to which it applies can be specified for a
single IS-IS interface, rather than per IS-IS instance, using the isis
authentication mode command.

Use the no form of this command to unset the MD5 authentication mode.

The related commands are the following:

— authentication key-chain

— authentication send-only

Command Mode
IS-IS Router configuration submode — (config-router-isis)

Options

md5 Specifies the keyed message digest mode (MD5). In the


default setting, the authentication mode is set to MD5 for
both levels if no level is specified.

text Specifies the text mode.

level-1 Specifies the authentication mode for level-1 PDUs.

level-2 Specifies the authentication mode for level-2 PDUs.

Examples
ML66(config-router-isis)#authentication mode md5 level-1
ML66(config-router-isis)#no authentication mode md5 level-1

29.5 authentication send-only

Synopsis
[no] authentication send-only [level-1 | level-2]

Description
Use this command to set the send-only option at the instance level.

Use this command before configuring the authentication mode and the
authentication keychain, so that the implementation of authentication goes
smoothly. That is, the routers will have more time for the keys to be configured on
each router if authentication is inserted only on the packets being sent, but not
checked on packets being received. After all routers that must communicate are

242 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IS-IS Commands

configured with this command, enable the authentication mode and the keychain
on each router. Then specify the no authentication send-only command to
disable the send-only feature.

If neither the level-1 nor the level-2 keyword is configured, the send-only
feature applies to both levels. The send-only option applies to both levels if no
level is specified.

In the default setting, the send-only option is disabled.

Use the no form of this command to unset the send-only option.

The related commands are the following:

— authentication key-chain

— authentication mode

Command Mode
IS-IS Router configuration submode — (config-router-isis)

Options

level-1 Specifies authentication send-only for level-1 PDUs.

level-2 Specifies authentication send-only for level-2 PDUs.

Examples
ML66(config-router-isis)#authentication send-only level-1
ML66(config-router-isis)#no authentication send-only level-1

29.6 bfd all-interfaces

Synopsis
[no] bfd all-interfaces

Description
Use this command to enable the Bidirectional Forwarding Detection (BFD)
feature on the interfaces enabled with an IS-IS instance.

This command sets BFD fall-over check for all the neighbors under a specified
process.

In the default setting, the BFD feature is disabled.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 243


CLI Descriptions

Use the no form of this command to disable BFD functionality for a IS-IS
instance.

Command Mode
IS-IS Router configuration submode — (config-router-isis)

Examples
ML66(config-router-isis)#bfd all-interfaces
ML66(config-router-isis)#no bfd all-interfaces

29.7 clear clns is-neighbors

Synopsis
clear clns is-neighbors <SYSTEM-ID>

Description
Use this command to clear IS neighbor adjacencies.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

SYSTEM-ID Specify the neighbor system ID in the format of


<XXXX.XXXX.XXXX> .

Examples
ML66>clear clns is-neighbors 0000.0000.0001

29.8 clear clns neighbors

Synopsis
clear clns neighbors

Description
Use this command to clear CLNS neighbor adjacencies.

244 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IS-IS Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
ML66>clear clns neighbors

29.9 clear ip isis

Synopsis
clear ip isis [<TAG> ] route {all | redistribution}

Description
Use this command to clear IS-IS routing information.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Operands

TAG The routing instance tag.

Options

all Specifies to clear all of the IS-IS routing table.

redistribution Specifies to clear IS-IS IP local redistribution routes.

Examples
ML66#clear ip isis route all

29.10 clear isis

Synopsis
clear isis [<TAG>] process

Description
Use this command to clear and restart a selected IS-IS routing instance.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 245


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Operands

TAG The routing instance tag.

Examples
Clearing and restarting ISIS routing instance is1:
ML66#clear isis is1 process

29.11 domain-password

Synopsis

— domain-password <PASSWORD> [authenticate snp {send-only |


validate}]

— no domain-password

Description
Use this command to set the authentication password for the Level-2 domain
and, optionally, to set the authentication password on Level-2 SNP PDUs.

Use this command to enable authentication when receiving and sending LSP and
SNP PDUs in the Level-2 domain. The domain password must be the same in the
Level-2 domain.

Use the no form of this command to clear the domain password.

The related commands are the following:

— area-password

Command Mode
IS-IS Router configuration submode — (config-router-isis)

Operands

PASSWORD Specify the password string. The maximum password


length is 254 characters. In the default setting, no
domain password is configured.

246 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IS-IS Commands

Options

send-only Specifies to only insert the password into the Level-1 SNP
PDUs, but not to check the password in SNP PDUs that
are received. Use this keyword during a software upgrade
to ease the transition.

validate Specifies to insert the password into the Level-1 SNP


PDUs and to check the password in SNP PDUs that are
received.

Examples
ML66(config-router-isis)#domain-password mypasswd
ML66(config-router-isis)#domain-password mypasswd authenticate snp send-only
ML66(config-router-isis)#no domain-password

29.12 ip route high-priority

Synopsis

— ip route high-priority tag <TAGVALUE>

— no ip route high-priority tag

Description
Use this command to assign a high priority to an IS-IS IP prefix.

Use the no form of this command to remove a high priority tag.

Command Mode
IS-IS Router configuration submode — (config-router-isis)

Operands

TAGVALUE Specify the tag value. The valid range is 1–4294967295.

Examples
ML66(config-router-isis)#ip route high-priority tag 42
ML66(config-router-isis)#no ip route high-priority tag

29.13 is-type

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 247


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis

— is-type {level-1 | level-1-2 | level-2-only}

— no is-type

Description
Use this command to set the IS to the specified level of routing.

Changing is-type brings down, then brings up a particular level of routing.


There is a limitation: only one IS-IS instance can run Level-2 routing (either
Level-2 only IS, or Level-1-2 IS).

By default, IS-IS uses level-1-2 if there is neither a Level-2 instance nor a


Level-1-2 instance. Otherwise, it uses level-1.

Use the no form of this command to set the IS to the default.

Command Mode
IS-IS Router configuration submode — (config-router-isis)

Options

level-1 Specifies to act only as a station router.

level-1-2 Specifies to act as both a station router and an area


router.

level-2-only Specifies to act only as an area router.

Examples
ML66(config-router-isis)#is-type level-1
ML66(config-router-isis)#no is-type

29.14 key

Synopsis
[no] key <KEY>

Description
Use this command to manage, add, or delete authentication keys in a keychain.
This command allows you to enter the keychain key submode to set a password
for the key.

248 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IS-IS Commands

Use the no form of this command to remove the configuration.

The related commands are the following:

— key chain

— key-string

— accept-lifetime

— send-lifetime

Command Mode
Keychain submode — (config-keychain)

Operands

KEY The key ID number. The valid range is 0–2147483647.

Examples
Configuring a key numbered 1, and changing to the keychain key command
submode:
ML66(config)#key chain mychain
ML66(config-keychain)#key 1
ML66(config-keychain-key)#

29.15 key chain

Synopsis
[no] key chain <NAME>

Description
Use this command to enter the keychain management submode and to configure
a keychain with a keychain name. This command allows you to enter the
keychain submode to specify keys on this keychain.

Use the no form of this command to remove the keychain.

The related commands are the following:

— key

— key-string

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 249


CLI Descriptions

— accept-lifetime

— send-lifetime

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

NAME The name of the keychain.

Examples
Creating a keychain named mychain, and changing to keychain submode:
ML66(config)#key chain mychain
ML66(config-keychain)#

29.16 key-string

Synopsis

— key-string <PASSWORD>

— no key-string

Description
Use this command to specify a password to be used by a key.

Use the no form of this command to remove the password.

The related commands are the following:

— key

— key chain

— accept-lifetime

— send-lifetime

Command Mode
Keychain key submode — (config-keychain-key)

250 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IS-IS Commands

Operands

PASSWORD The string of characters to be used as a password by the


key. The maximum length is 256 characters.

Examples
Setting the password for key 1 in the keychain named mychain to prime:
ML66(config)#key chain mychain
ML66(config-keychain)#key 1
ML66(config-keychain-key)#key-string prime

Removing the password for key 1 in the keychain named mychain:

ML66(config-keychain)#key 1
ML66(config-keychain-key)#no key-string

29.17 lsp-gen-interval

Synopsis

— lsp-gen-interval [level-1 | level-2] <INTERVAL>

— no lsp-gen-interval

Description
Use this command to set the minimum interval before regenerating the same
LSP. The smaller the interval, the faster the convergence.

Note: This setting might cause more frequent flooding.

If neither the level-1 nor the level-2 keyword is configured, the interval
applies to both levels.

By default, IS-IS uses 30 seconds for the interval, and the interval is applied to
both level-1 and level-2.

Use the no form of this command to set the interval to the default.

The related commands are the following:

— lsp-refresh-interval

Command Mode
IS-IS Router configuration submode — (config-router-isis)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 251


CLI Descriptions

Operands

INTERVAL The minimum interval in seconds. The valid range is 1–


120.

Options

level-1 Sets the interval only for level-1.

level-2 Sets the interval only for level-2.

Examples
ML66(config-router-isis)#lsp-gen-interval 5

29.18 lsp-mtu

Synopsis

— lsp-mtu [level-1 | level-2] <SIZE>

— no lsp-mtu [level-1 | level-2]

Description
Use this command to set the MTU size of LSPs.

If neither the level-1 nor the level-2 keyword is configured, the MTU size
applies to both levels.

Use the no form of this command to set the MTU size to the default.

Command Mode
IS-IS Router configuration submode — (config-router-isis)

Operands

SIZE The MTU size in bytes. The valid range is 512–1492.

Options

level-1 Sets the LSP MTU size for level-1 PDUs.

level-2 Sets the LSP MTU size for level-2 PDUs.

252 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IS-IS Commands

Examples
ML66(config-router-isis)#lsp-mtu 555

29.19 lsp-refresh-interval

Synopsis

— lsp-refresh-interval <INTERVAL>

— no lsp-refresh-interval

Description
Use this command to set the LSP refresh interval.

It is recommended to set the lsp-refresh-interval value to be smaller than


the max-lsp-lifetime value.

Use the no form of this command to set the interval to the default value.

The related commands are the following:

— lsp-gen-interval

— max-lsp-lifetime

Command Mode
IS-IS Router configuration submode — (config-router-isis)

Operands

INTERVAL TheLSP refresh interval in seconds. The valid range is 1–


65535 s. The default setting is 900 s.

Examples
ML66(config-router-isis)#lsp-refresh-interval 600
ML66(config-router-isis)#no lsp-refresh-interval

29.20 max-area-address

Synopsis

— max-area-address <NUMBER>

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 253


CLI Descriptions

— no max-area-address

Description
Use this command to configure the maximum number of addresses for an IS-IS
area.

Use the no form of this command to remove the configuration for an IS-IS area.

Command Mode
IS-IS Router configuration submode — (config-router-isis)

Operands

NUMBER Specifies the maximum number of area addresses that


can be supported. The valid range is 3–254. By default,
the maximum number of addresses is 3 for an IS-IS area.

Examples
ML66(config-router-isis)#max-area-address 25
ML66(config-router-isis)#no max-area-address

29.21 max-lsp-lifetime

Synopsis

— max-lsp-lifetime <LIFETIME>

— no max-lsp-lifetime

Description
Use this command to set the maximum LSP lifetime.

It is recommended to set the max-lsp-lifetime value to be greater than the


lsp-refresh-interval value.

Use the no form of this command to set the lifetime to the default.

The related commands are the following:

— lsp-refresh-interval

Command Mode
IS-IS Router configuration submode — (config-router-isis)

254 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IS-IS Commands

Operands

LIFETIME Specifies the maximum LSP lifetime in seconds. The valid


range is 350–65535 s. By default, the maximum LSP
lifetime is 1200 s.

Examples
ML66(config-router-isis)#max-lsp-lifetime 1500
ML66(config-router-isis)#no max-lsp-lifetime

29.22 metric-style

Synopsis

— metric-style {narrow | wide} [level-1 | level-1-2 | level-2]

— no metric-style {narrow | wide} [level-1 | level-2]

Description
Use this command to configure the IS-IS metric style.

By default, IS-IS uses narrow metric style for levels 1 and 2.

Use the no form of this command to set the style to the default style of narrow.

Use Table 29 when changing the method of how TLV encodes and SPF calculates
a decision.

Table 29 Metric-Style Command Options


Metric-Style Wide SPF Wide TLV Narrow SPF Narrow TLV
Command
narrow OFF OFF ON OFF
(default)
wide ON ON OFF OFF

Here, the following SPF and TLV settings are defined:

Wide SPF Uses wide TLVs for SPF calculation.

Wide TLV Encodes wide TLVs in the LSP.

Narrow SPF Uses narrow TLVs for SPF calculation.

Narrow TLV Encodes narrow TLVs in the LSP.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 255


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
IS-IS Router configuration submode — (config-router-isis)

Options

narrow Uses the old style of TLVs with narrow metric.

wide Uses the new style of TLVs to carry wider metric.

level-1 Specifies the metric style only for level 1.

level-1-2 Specifies the metric style for levels 1 and 2.

level-2 Specifies the metric style only for level 2.

Examples
ML66(config-router-isis)#metric-style wide level-1
ML66(config-router-isis)#no metric-style narrow
ML66(config-router-isis)#no metric-style wide level-1

29.23 net

Synopsis
[no] net <NET>

Description
Use this command to add a Network Entity Title (NET) for an instance.

On a router running IS-IS, a NET can be 8–20 bytes in length. The last byte is
always the n-selector, and must be zero. The n-selector indicates no transport
entity, and means that the packet is for the routing software of the system. The
six bytes directly preceding the n-selector are the system ID. The system ID
length is a fixed size and cannot be changed. The system ID must be unique
throughout each area (Level 1) and throughout the backbone (Level 2).

The bytes preceding the system ID are the area ID, which can be 1–13 bytes in
length. A maximum of three NETs per router are allowed with different area ID
but the system ID should be the same for all NETs.

By default, IS-IS does not configure a NET, and routing is not enabled for an
interface.

Use the no form of this command to remove a NET.

256 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IS-IS Commands

Command Mode
IS-IS Router configuration submode — (config-router-isis)

Operands

NET Specify a NET address in 1 to 13 octets in the format of


<XX.XXXX. ... .XXXX.XX> .

Examples
ML66(config-router-isis)#net 49.0000.0001.0002.0003.00

29.24 redistribute

Synopsis

— redistribute {bgp | connected | kernel | ospf | static} [level-1]


[level-2] [level-1-2] [metric-type {internal | external}] [metric
<METRIC>] [route-map <MAPNAME>]

— no redistribute {bgp | connected | kernel | ospf | static}

Description
Use this command to enable redistribution of information from another routing
protocol.

Use the no form of this command to disable redistribution.

Command Mode
IS-IS Router configuration submode — (config-router-isis)

Operands

METRIC The IS-IS default metric. The valid range is 0–


4261412864.

MAPNAME The route map name.

Options

bgp Specifies Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) routes.

connected Specifies connected routes.

kernel Specifies kernel routes.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 257


CLI Descriptions

ospf Specifies Open Shortest Path First (OSPF) routes.

static Specifies static routes.

level-1 Specifies IS-IS level-1 routes.

level-2 Specifies IS-IS level-2 routes.

level-1-2 Specifies IS-IS level-1 and level-2 routes.

metric-type Specifies an IS-IS exterior metric type for redistributed


routes.

internal Sets an IS-IS internal metric type.

external Sets an IS-IS external metric type.

metric Specifies a metric for redistributed routes.

route-map References a route map.

Examples
ML66(config-router-isis)#redistribute connected level-1 level-2 metric 42 metric-t →
ype internal route-map name
ML66(config-router-isis)#no redistribute connected

29.25 router isis

Synopsis
[no] router isis [<TAG>]

Description
Use this command to initiate a IS-IS routing instance and enter IS-IS
configuration mode. Configure at least one NET to start routing. Also, enable a
particular interface with the ip router isis command.

Use the no form of this command to remove an IS-IS routing instance.

Note: The router supports only one IS-IS routing instance.

The related commands are the following:

— ip router isis

258 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IS-IS Commands

— net

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

TAG Specifies an ISO routing instance tag, which identifies the


IS-IS routing instance.

Examples
Creating the IS-IS routing instance is1:
ML66(config)#router isis is1
ML66(config-router-isis)#

29.26 send-lifetime

Synopsis

— send-lifetime <STARTTIME> <STARTDATE> {<ENDTIME> <ENDDATE> |


duration <DURATION> | infinite}

— no send-lifetime

Description
Use this command to specify the time period during which the authentication key
on a keychain can be sent.

Use the no form of this command to remove the configuration.

The related commands are the following:

— key

— key chain

— key-string

— accept-lifetime

Command Mode
Keychain key submode — (config-keychain-key)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 259


CLI Descriptions

Operands

STARTTIME The start time of send-lifetime in hours, minutes and


seconds, in the following format: <HH:MM:SS> .

STARTDATE The start date of send-lifetime in the following format:


<MONTH DAY YEAR> — Month of the year using the first
three letters of the month, day of the month, and year
using four digits. For example, Feb 3 2018.

ENDTIME The end time of send-lifetime in hours, minutes and


seconds, in the following format: <HH:MM:SS> .

ENDDATE The end date of send-lifetime in the following format:


<MONTH DAY YEAR> — Month of the year using the first
three letters of the month, day of the month, and year
using four digits. For example, Feb 3 2018.

DURATION The duration of send-lifetime in seconds. The valid range


is 1–2147483646 s.

Options

duration Specifies the duration of send-lifetime.

infinite Specifies send-lifetime to never expire.

Examples
Setting send-lifetime for key 1 on the keychain named mychain:
ML66(config)#key chain mychain
ML66(config-keychain)#key 1
ML66(config-keychain-key)#send-lifetime 03:03:01 Jan 3 2004 04:04:02 Jan 3 2006

29.27 set-overload-bit

Synopsis

— set-overload-bit on-startup {<TIME> | wait-for-bgp} [suppress


{external | interlevel} [{interlevel | external}]]

— set-overload-bit suppress {external | interlevel} [[interlevel |


external] [on-startup {<TIME> | wait-for-bgp}]]

Description
Use this command to set the overload-bit in self-LSPs. If the overload-bit is set in
LSPs, the router is not used as a transit router during SPF calculation. This

260 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IS-IS Commands

command causes a router to update its own LSP with the overload bit set, and it
causes the other routers not to use this router as a transit or forwarding router.
The router continues to receive LSPs when the overload bit is set. If the on-
startup option is specified, the router sets the overload bit only at startup, then
clears the bit after the specified interval has elapsed. If the on-startup option is
specified using the wait-for-bgp option, the overload bit is set up at startup,
then the bit is cleared after the BGP router signals it has finished converging, or if
the router does not signal that it has finished converging in 10 minutes. If there is
no BGP process running, the overload bit clears immediately.

If the BGP process is started later than the overload bit is set, the bit clears after
the BGP router signals it has finished converging, or if the BGP router does not
signal that it has finished converging in 10 minutes. If the suppress option is
specified, the router suppresses the redistribution of specified types of
reachability data during overload state. The suppress option can be used with
the external or interlevel parameters, or both parameters.

By default, no overload-bit is set.

Use the no form of this command to clear the overload-bit from self-LSPs.

Command Mode
IS-IS Router configuration submode — (config-router-isis)

Operands

TIME The time in seconds to advertise oneself as overloaded


after reboot. The valid range is 5–86400 s.

Options

on-startup Specifies an interval in seconds after which the overload


state is exited.

wait-for-bgp Lets BGP decide when to unset the overload bit.

suppress Suppresses specific types of IP prefixes.

external Redistributes external reachability to prevent the IP


prefixes learned from other protocols from being
advertised.

interlevel Redistributes interlevel reachability to prevent the IP


prefixes learned from another IS-IS level from being
advertised.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 261


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Setting the overload bit at startup, not unsetting the overload bit until BGP
converges, suppressing redistribution between levels, and suppressing
redistribution from external routing protocols while the overload bit is set:
ML66(config-router-isis)#set-overload-bit on-startup wait-for-bgp suppress interle →
vel external

29.28 spf-interval-exp

Synopsis

— spf-interval-exp [level-1 | level-2] <MINDELAY> <MAXDELAY>

— no spf-interval-exp [level-1 | level-2]

Description
Use this command to set the minimum and maximum hold intervals between
Shortest Path First (SPF) calculations.

This command configures the minimum and maximum interval time between the
receipt of a topology change and the calculation of the SPF.

By default, IS-IS uses 500 ms for the minimum and 50,000 ms for the maximum
hold intervals, respectively. The values are applied to both level 1 and level 2 if
the level parameter is omitted.

Use the no form of this command to set the minimum and maximum hold
intervals to the default.

Command Mode
IS-IS Router configuration submode — (config-router-isis)

Operands

MINDELAY Specifies the minimum delay between receiving a change


and SPF calculation in milliseconds. The valid range is 0–
2147483647 ms.

MAXDELAY Specifies the maximum delay between receiving a


change and SPF calculation in milliseconds. The valid
range is 0–2147483647 ms.

Options

level-1 Specifies an interval for only level-1 IS.

262 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IS-IS Commands

level-2 Specifies an interval for only level-2 IS.

Examples
ML66(config-router-isis)#spf-interval-exp level-1 600 60000
ML66(config-router-isis)#no spf-interval-exp

29.29 summary-address

Synopsis

— summary-address <ADDR/PREFIX> [level-1] [metric <METRIC>]

— no summary-address <ADDR/PREFIX>

Description
Use this command to configure a summary address to summarize IPv4
reachability information.

By default, IS-IS does not configure the summary address.

Use the no form of this command to remove the configuration.

Command Mode
IS-IS Router configuration submode — (config-router-isis)

Operands

ADDR/PREFIX Specifies an IPv4 network prefix in the following format:


<A.B.C.D/P> , for example, 1.2.3.0/24.

METRIC The metric value. The valid range is 1–63.

Options

level-1 Summarizes reachability information only for level 1.

metric Specifies a metric for the summary address.

Examples
ML66(config-router-isis)#summary-address 10.10.0.0/16
ML66(config-router-isis)#no summary-address 10.10.0.0/16

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 263


CLI Descriptions

30 IS-IS Interface Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
30.

The following command mode is applicable for the Intermediate System–


Intermediate System (IS-IS) interface commands:

— Router Loopback Interface configuration submode — (config-router-lo)

— Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-


vlan)

— Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Table 30 IS-IS Commands Overview


ip router isis enable IS-IS IPv4 routing on an
interface
isis authentication key-chain set the keychain to be used for
authentication on the interface-
related packets
isis authentication mode set the MD5 authentication mode
isis authentication send-only set the send-only option to the
interface-related packets
isis circuit-type set the circuit type for an interface
isis csnp-interval set the Complete Sequence Number
PDU (CSNP) interval in seconds
isis hello configure the padding of IS-IS Hello
packets
isis hello-interval set the hello interval
isis hello-multiplier set a multiplier for the hello holding
time
isis metric set the default metric for an interface
isis network change a broadcast interface network
type to a point-to-point network type
isis password set the authentication password of
Hello PDUs on an interface
isis priority set the priority for LAN DIS election
isis retransmit-interval set the LSP retransmission interval

264 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IS-IS Interface Commands

isis tag set a tag on the IP address configured


for an interface when this IP prefix is
put into an IS-IS LSP
isis wide-metric set the wide metric for an interface

The related show commands are the following:

— show clns is-neighbors

— show clns neighbors

— show ip isis igp-shortcut-lsp

— show ip isis route

— show ip isis route igp-shortcut

— show isis counter

— show isis database

— show isis interface

— show isis topology

— show running-config router

30.1 ip router isis

Synopsis
[no] ip router isis <TAG>

Description
Use this command to enable IS-IS IPv4 routing on an interface. This command is
mandatory in an IS-IS configuration. Match the IS-IS instance tag to a tag of an
existing instance, or initiate a new instance with the tag name, otherwise routing
will not run on this interface.

This command enables the router to send IS-IS Hello with IP address TLV on this
interface. As a result, IP reachability information TLV in the LSP gets updated.

In the default setting, IPv4 routing is disabled on the router.

Use the no form of this command to disable IS-IS IPv4 routing on an interface.
This action does not clear the IS-IS database. To clear the database, unconfigure
the IS-IS routing instance.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 265


CLI Descriptions

The related commands are the following:

— router isis

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Router Loopback Interface configuration submode — (config-router-lo)

Operands

TAG The routing instance tag.

Examples
Enabling IS-IS routing on the interface:
ML66(config-router-if)#ip router isis is1

30.2 isis authentication key-chain

Synopsis

— isis authentication key-chain <NAME> [level-1 | level-2]

— no isis authentication key-chain [level-1 | level-2]

Description
Use this command to set the keychain to be used for authentication on the
interface-related packets.

Authentication mode must be set to MD5 to configure the keychain. If no


keychain is configured with the key command, no keychain authentication is
performed. Only one authentication keychain is applied to a IS-IS interface at a
time. Executing a second isis authentication key-chain command
overrides the first isis authentication key-chain command.

If neither the level-1 nor the level-2 keyword is configured, the keychain
applies to the levels on which the authentication mode is configured as MD5.
Authentication can be specified for an entire instance of IS-IS, instead of at the
interface level, by using the authentication key-chain command.

Use the no form of this command to unset the keychain used for authentication
on the interface-related packets.

The related commands are the following:

266 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IS-IS Interface Commands

— isis authentication mode

— isis authentication send-only

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

NAME The keychain name.

Options

level-1 Specifies an authentication keychain for level-1 PDUs.

level-2 Specifies an authentication keychain for level-2 PDUs.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#isis authentication mode md5
ML66(config-router-if)#isis authentication key-chain ipi level-1

30.3 isis authentication mode

Synopsis
[no] isis authentication mode {md5 | text} [level-1 | level-2]

Description
Use this command to set the MD5 authentication mode.

If clear text authentication was configured using the isis password command,
the isis authentication mode command overrides the isis password
command. If the isis authentication mode command was used and
subsequently an attempt is made to use the isis password command, the
attempt fails.

To configure clear text authentication using the isis password command, first
use the no isis authentication mode command. The type of authentication
and the level to which it applies can be specified for the entire IS-IS instance,
rather than per interface, using the authentication mode command.

Use the no form of this command to unset the MD5 authentication mode.

The related commands are the following:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 267


CLI Descriptions

— isis authentication key-chain

— isis authentication send-only

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Options

md5 Specifies the keyed message digest mode (MD5). In the


default setting, the authentication mode is set to MD5 for
both levels if no level is specified.

text Specifies the text mode.

level-1 Specifies the authentication mode for level-1 PDUs.

level-2 Specifies the authentication mode for level-2 PDUs.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#isis authentication mode md5 level-1

30.4 isis authentication send-only

Synopsis
[no] isis authentication send-only [level-1 | level-2]

Description
Use this command to set the send-only option to the interface-related packets.

Use this command before configuring the IS-IS authentication mode and IS-IS
authentication key-chain, so that the implementation of authentication goes
smoothly. That is, the routers will have more time for the keys to be configured on
each router if authentication is inserted only on the packets being sent, not
checked on packets being received. After all routers that must communicate are
configured with this command, enable the authentication mode and keychain on
each router.

If neither the level-1 nor the level-2 keyword is configured, the option applies
to both levels.

Use the no form of this command to unset the send-only option on the interface-
related packets.

268 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IS-IS Interface Commands

The related commands are the following:

— isis authentication key-chain

— isis authentication mode

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Options

level-1 Specifies authentication send-only for level-1 PDUs.

level-2 Specifies authentication send-only for level-2 PDUs.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#isis authentication send-only level-1

30.5 isis circuit-type

Synopsis

— isis circuit-type {level-1 | level-1-2 | level-2-only}

— no isis circuit-type

Description
Use this command to set the circuit type for an interface.

If level-1 or level-2-only is specified in this command, IS-IS sends only the


specified level of PDUs. On the point-to-point interface, there is only one type of
Hello packet, so in this case IS-IS Hello will be sent regardless of circuit-type. If
the is-type command is configured as level-1 or level-2-only, routing for
this instance is performed for only the specified level. In this manner, only the
particular level of PDUs are sent on the interface.

Use the no form of this command to reset the circuit type to the default.

The related commands are the following:

— is-type

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 269


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Options

level-1 Specifies that only Level-1 adjacencies are formed.

level-1-2 Specifies that Level-1-2 adjacencies are formed. This is


the default setting.

level-2-only Specifies that only Level-2 adjacencies are formed.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#isis circuit-type level-2-only

30.6 isis csnp-interval

Synopsis

— isis csnp-interval <INTERVAL> [level-1 | level-2]

— no isis csnp-interval [level-1 | level-2]

Description
Use this command to set the Complete Sequence Number PDU (CSNP) interval in
seconds.

This command changes the interval between two consecutive CSNP


transmissions. By default, both Level-1 and Level-2 CSNPs are sent every 10
seconds only by LAN DIS. This parameter is only valid on a broadcast interface,
since periodic CSNPs are only sent on a broadcast interface, while CSNPs on a
Point-to-Point interface are sent only when an adjacency is initiated.

If neither the level-1 nor the level-2 keyword is configured, the interval
applies to both levels.

Use the no form of this command to reset the CSNP interval to the default value.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

270 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IS-IS Interface Commands

Operands

INTERVAL The CSNP interval in seconds. The valid range is 1–


65535 s.

Options

level-1 Specifies an interval for Level-1 CSNPs.

level-2 Specifies an interval for Level-2 CSNPs.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#isis csnp-interval 20

30.7 isis hello

Synopsis
[no] isis hello padding

Description
Use this command to configure the padding of IS-IS Hello packets. IS-IS pads
Hello packets by default to notify neighbors of the supported MTU size.

Use the no form of this command to disable the padding.

The related commands are the following:

— isis hello-interval

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Options

padding Sets padding for IS-IS Hello packets.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#isis hello padding

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 271


CLI Descriptions

30.8 isis hello-interval

Synopsis

— isis hello-interval {minimal | <INTERVAL> } [level-1 | level-2]

— no isis hello-interval [level-1 | level-2]

Description
Use this command to set the hello interval in seconds. The hello interval is set
together with the hello-multiplier command.

This command changes the time interval between two consecutive Hello
transmissions. If a device receives its own LSP with a maximum sequence
number, then it suspends IS-IS for the hold interval. DIS sends Hello
transmissions at three times the rate of non-DIS. If IS-IS is elected as DIS on this
interface, IS-IS sends hello every 3.3 seconds.

If the minimal keyword is specified, Holding timer in Hello PDU is set to 1 second
and Hello interval is calculated by dividing by the hello-multiplier. For example, if
the hello-multiplier is configured as 4 and the hello-interval minimal command is
used, a Hello PDU is sent every 250 milliseconds.

By default, IS-IS uses 10 seconds for the interval, and the interval is applied to
both Level-1 and Level-2 IIHs.

If neither the level-1 nor the level-2 keyword is configured, the interval
applies to both levels.

Use the no form of this command to set the hello interval to the default.

The related commands are the following:

— isis hello-multiplier

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

INTERVAL The hello interval in seconds. The valid range is 1–65535.

Options

minimal Specifies the holding time as 1 second. The interval value


depends on the multiplier.

272 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IS-IS Interface Commands

level-1 Specifies the hello interval for level-1 IIHs.

level-2 Specifies the hello interval for level-2 IIHs.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#isis hello-interval 5 level-1
ML66(config-router-if)#isis hello-interval minimal

30.9 isis hello-multiplier

Synopsis

— isis hello-multiplier <MULTIPLIER> [level-1 | level-2]

— no isis hello-multiplier [level-1 | level-2]

Description
Use this command to set a multiplier for the hello holding time.

Changes Holding Timer in Hello PDU. Holding Timer is calculated by Hello-


Interval multiplied by this value. If the minimal keyword is specified with the
Hello-Interval, the Holding Timer is set to 1 second, and the Hello-Interval is
calculated by dividing 1 by this value.

By default, IS-IS uses 3 seconds for the multiplier value, and the multiplier is
applied to both Level-1 and Level-2.

If neither the level-1 nor the level-2 keyword is configured, the multiplier
applies to both levels.

Use the no form of this command to set the multiplier to the default.

The related commands are the following:

— isis hello-interval

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

MULTIPLIER The hello multiplier value. The valid range is 2–100.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 273


CLI Descriptions

Options

level-1 Specifies the hello multiplier for level-1 IIHs.

level-2 Specifies the hello multiplier for level-2 IIHs.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#isis hello-multiplier 4

30.10 isis metric

Synopsis

— isis metric <METRIC> [level-1 | level-2]

— no isis metric [level-1 | level-2]

Description
Use this command to set the default metric for an interface. The interface default
metric is put into IP reachability information TLVs, IS reachability information
TLVs, and IPv6 reachability TLVs in LSPs. The value is used for SPF calculation,
and is applied when the metric-style is configured as narrow.

If neither the level-1 nor the level-2 keyword is configured, the metric applies
to both levels.

By default, IS-IS uses 10 for the metric value, and the value is applied to both
level-1 and level-2 links.

Use the no form of this command to set the default metric to the default.

The related commands are the following:

— isis wide-metric

— metric-style

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

METRIC The default metric. The valid range is 1–63.

274 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IS-IS Interface Commands

Options

level-1 Applies a default metric to level-1 links.

level-2 Applies a default metric to level-2 links.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#isis metric 20

30.11 isis network

Synopsis

— isis network {broadcast | point-to-point}

— no isis network

Description
Use this command to change a broadcast interface network type to a point-to-
point network type.

By default, the network is set to a broadcast multi-access network.

Use the no form of this command to revert to the default setting of a broadcast
interface network type.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Options

broadcast Specifies an IS-IS broadcast multi-access network.

point-to-point Specifies an IS-IS point-to-point network.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#isis network point-to-point

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 275


CLI Descriptions

30.12 isis password

Synopsis

— isis password <PASSWORD> [level-1 | level-2]

— no isis password [level-1 | level-2]

Description
Use this command to set the authentication password of Hello PDUs on an
interface.

By default, no password is configured either for level-1 or for level-2 PDUs.

If neither the level-1 nor the level-2 keyword is configured, the password
applies to both levels.

Note: If the network type is point-to-point, the password is always applied to


both levels.

Use the no form of this command to clear the password.

The related commands are the following:

— area-password

— domain-password

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

PASSWORD The password string. The maximum password length is


254 characters.

Options

level-1 Specifies a password for level-1 PDUs.

level-2 Specifies a password for level-2 PDUs.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#isis password mypassword level-1

276 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IS-IS Interface Commands

30.13 isis priority

Synopsis

— isis priority <PRIORITY> [level-1 | level-2]

— no isis priority [level-1 | level-2]

Description
Use this command to set the priority for LAN DIS election. This command
changes the priority value in LAN IS-IS Hello PDUs. A lower priority value is less
preferred in DIS election, and a higher priority value is more preferred.

If neither the level-1 nor the level-2 keyword is configured, the priority applies
to both levels.

By default, IS-IS uses 64 for the priority value, and the priority is applied to both
level-1 and level-2 routing.

Note: This command is not valid for a point-to-point interface.

Use the no form of this command to set the priority to the default.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

PRIORITY The priority value. The valid range is 0–127.

Options

level-1 Specifies a priority for level-1 routing.

level-2 Specifies a priority for level-2 routing.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#isis priority 127

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 277


CLI Descriptions

30.14 isis retransmit-interval

Synopsis

— isis retransmit-interval <INTERVAL>

— no isis retransmit-interval

Description
Use this command to set the LSP retransmission interval.

Use the no form of this command to set the interval to the default.

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

INTERVAL Specify the interval between retransmissions of the same


LSP in seconds. The valid range is 0–65535 s. By default,
IS-IS uses an interval of 5 s.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#isis retransmit-interval 10
ML66(config-router-if)#no isis retransmit-interval

30.15 isis tag

Synopsis

— isis tag <TAGVALUE>

— no isis tag

Description
Use this command to set a tag on the IP address configured for an interface
when this IP prefix is put into an IS-IS link-state packet (LSP).

If neither the level-1 nor the level-2 keyword is configured, the tag applies to
both levels.

Use the no form of this command to remove a tag.

278 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IS-IS Interface Commands

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

TAGVALUE The tag value. The valid range is 1–4294967295.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#isis tag 42
ML66(config-router-if)#no isis tag

30.16 isis wide-metric

Synopsis

— isis wide-metric <WIDEMETRIC> [level-1 | level-2]

— no isis wide-metric [level-1 | level-2]

Description
Use this command to set the wide metric for an interface.

Interface wide-metric is put into Extended IP reachability TLVs, Extended IS


reachability TLVs, and IPv6 reachability TLVs in LSPs. The value is used for SPF
calculation. This value is applied when metric-style is configured as wide.

If neither the level-1 nor the level-2 keyword is configured, the wide metric
applies to both levels.

By default, IS-IS uses 10 for the metric value, and the metric is applied to both
level-1 and level-2 links.

Use the no form of this command to set the wide metric to the default.

The related commands are the following:

— isis metric

— metric-style

Command Mode
Router VLAN Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if-vlan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 279


CLI Descriptions

Operands

WIDEMETRIC The wide metric. The valid range is 1–16777214.

Options

level-1 Applies a metric to level-1 links.

level-2 Applies a metric to level-2 links.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#isis wide-metric 100
ML66(config-router-if)#no isis wide-metric

280 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LDP Configuration Commands

31 LDP Configuration Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
31.

The following command modes are applicable for the Label Distribution Protocol
(LDP) configuration commands:

— Exec mode — >

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Table 31 LDP Configuration Commands Overview


advertisement-mode set the label advertisement mode for
all the interfaces on the current Label
Switch Router (LSR)
clear ldp adjacency clear an adjacency with a specified
peer, or to clear all adjacencies for the
current LSR
clear ldp session clear a session established with a
specified peer, or to clear all sessions
for the current LSR
clear ldp statistics clear Label Distribution Protocol (LDP)
statistics
control-mode set the control mode for label
processing
dscp enable DSCP marking
explicit-null configure the router to send Explicit
Null labels for directly connected
Forwarding Equivalence Classes
(FECs) instead of Implicit Null labels
global-merge-capability override the default merge capability
setting of all the interfaces on the
current LSR
hello-interval set the interval after which hello
packets are sent out
hold-time set the global value for the hold time
after which the LSR rejects
adjacencies

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 281


CLI Descriptions

import-bgp-routes import Border Gateway Protocol


(BGP) routes into LDP
inter-area-lsp enable the creation of inter-area
Label-Switched Paths (LSPs)
keepalive-interval set the global value for the interval
after which keep alive packets are sent
out
keepalive-timeout set the time period for which an LSR
must wait for successive keepalive
messages from LDP peers
label-retention-mode set the retention mode to be used for
all labels exchanged
ldp-optimization optimize the resetting of an LDP
session
loop-detection enable loop detection on the current
LSR
loop-detection-hop-count set the loop detection hop count
loop-detection-path-vec-count set the loop detection vector count
neighbor auth md5 password set the password for each LDP peer
that is used for authentication when
communicating with the specified peer
multicast-hellos enable multicast hello exchange on all
interfaces enabled for LDP
propagate-release propagate the release of labels to
downstream routers
request-retry enable the retry of requests once a
request for a label has been rejected
for a valid reason
request-retry-timeout set the interval between retries
router ldp change to the (config-router-ldp)
submode
router-id set an LDP router ID
targeted-peer hello-interval set the interval for sending unicast
hello packets to targeted peers
targeted-peer hold-time set the timeout value that the router
waits before rejecting an adjacency
with targeted peers
transport-address ipv4 configure an IPv4 transport address
for a label space

The related show commands are the following:

282 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LDP Configuration Commands

— show ldp

— show ldp adjacency

— show ldp downstream

— show ldp fec

— show ldp inter-area-fecs

— show ldp interface

— show ldp lsp

— show ldp session

— show ldp statistics

— show ldp targeted-peers

— show ldp upstream

— show mpls ldp

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

31.1 advertisement-mode

Synopsis

— advertisement-mode {downstream-on-demand | downstream-


unsolicited}

— no advertisement-mode

Description
Use this command to set the label advertisement mode for all the interfaces on
the current Label Switch Router (LSR). Setting downstream-on-demand and
downstream-unsolicited mode affects which LSR initiates mapping requests
and mapping advertisements. By default, the downstream-unsolicited mode is
used.

Setting the advertisement mode for an interface using ldp advertisement-


mode command overrides the value set by this command. Running
advertisement-mode command before the interface is up, as all affected
sessions are closed and restarted.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 283


CLI Descriptions

Use the no option to restore the default advertisement mode value.

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Options

downstream-on-demand
Sets the downstream-on-Demand (DoD) advertisement
mode. The mode enables the router to send a label upon
request. When a users uses this mode, a router distributes
a label to a peer only if there is a pending label request
from a peer. The reaction of the downstream router to this
request depends on the label advertising mode supported
on the next hop. This mode is typically used with the
conservative label retention mode.

downstream-unsolicited
Sets the Downstream-Unsolicited (DU) advertisement
mode. The mode enables the router to send a label
without waiting a request. This mode distributes labels to
peers without waiting for a label request, and is typically
used with the liberal label retention mode.

Examples
Using the downstream-unsolicited advertisement mode for a Label Distribution
Protocol (LDP) session on its interfaces:
ML66(config-router-ldp)#advertisement-mode downstream-unsolicited

31.2 clear ldp adjacency

Synopsis
clear ldp adjacency [* | <IPADDR> ]

Description
Use this command to clear an adjacency with a specified peer, or to clear all
adjacencies for the current Label Switch Router (LSR).

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

284 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LDP Configuration Commands

Options

* Clears all adjacencies.

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of a peer, where the format is


<A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Clearing an adjacency with a specified peer:
ML66#clear ldp adjacency 123.123.123.33

31.3 clear ldp session

Synopsis
clear ldp session [* | <IPADDR> ]

Description
Use this command to clear a session established with a specified peer, or to clear
all sessions for the current Label Switch Router (LSR).

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Options

* Clears all sessions.

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of a peer, where the format is


<A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Clearing a session established with a specified peer:
ML66#clear ldp session 123.123.123.33

31.4 clear ldp statistics

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 285


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
clear ldp statistics

Description
Use this command to clear Label Distribution Protocol (LDP) statistics.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Clearing LDP statistics:
ML66#clear ldp statistics

31.5 control-mode

Synopsis

— control-mode {ordered | independent}

— no control-mode

Description
Use this command to set the control mode for label processing.

Use the no option to restore the default control mode.

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Options

ordered Sets ordered control mode.

independent Sets independent control mode.

Examples
Setting ordered control mode:
ML66(config-router-ldp)#control-mode ordered

286 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LDP Configuration Commands

31.6 dscp

Synopsis

— dscp <DSCP>

— no dscp

Description
Use this command to enable DSCP marking. The default value is 48.

Use the no option to set DSCP marking to default value.

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Operands

DSCP The DSCP value. The valid range is 0-63. The default
value is 48.

Examples
Enabling DSCP marking:
ML66(config-router-ldp)#dscp 16

31.7 explicit-null

Synopsis
[no] explicit-null

Description
Use this command to configure the router to send Explicit Null labels for directly
connected Forwarding Equivalence Classes (FECs) instead of Implicit Null labels.
By default, the router sends Implicit Null labels.

Note: Do not use this command if Label Distribution Protocol (LDP) is


concurrently used for Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS)/Border
Gateway Protocol (BGP) VPNs.

Use the no option to stop sending Explicit Null labels for directly connected FECs
and resume sending Implicit Null labels for them.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 287


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Examples
Sending Explicit Null labels:
ML66(config-router-ldp)#explicit-null

31.8 global-merge-capability

Synopsis

— global-merge-capability {merge-capable | non-merge-capable}

— no global-merge-capability

Description
Use this command to override the default merge capability setting of all the
interfaces on the current Label Switch Router (LSR).

Use the no option to restore the default merge capability settings of all the
interfaces for this LSR.

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Options

merge-capable Maps all incoming labels that are destined for the same
Forwarding Equivalence Class (FEC) to the same
outgoing label. This is the Ethernet default.

non-merge-capable
Maps all incoming labels, regardless of destination FEC,
to unique outgoing label. This is the non-Ethernet default.

Examples
Mapping all incoming labels that are destined for the same FEC to the same
outgoing label:
ML66(config-router-ldp)#global-merge-capability merge-capable

288 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LDP Configuration Commands

31.9 hello-interval

Synopsis

— hello-interval <TIME>

— no hello-interval

Description
Use this command to set the interval after which hello packets are sent out. By
default, the hello packet sending interval is 5 seconds. Setting the hello packet
sending interval on an interface using ldp hello-interval command overrides
the value set by this command.

Use the no option to restore the default.

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Operands

TIME Specifies the interval in seconds. The valid range is 1–


21845.

Examples
Setting the hello interval value for all interfaces on a Label Switch Router (LSR):
ML66(config-router-ldp)#hello-interval 35

31.10 hold-time

Synopsis

— hold-time <TIME>

— no hold-time

Description
Use this command to set the global value for the hold time after which the Label
Switch Router (LSR) rejects adjacencies. Setting the hold time on an interface
using ldp hold-time command overrides the value set by this command.

Use the no option to restore the default.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 289


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Operands

TIME Specifies the hold time value in seconds. The valid ranges
is 3–65535. The default value is 15 seconds.

Examples
Setting the hold time value for all interfaces on an LSR:
ML66(config-router-ldp)#hold-time 635

31.11 import-bgp-routes

Synopsis
[no] import-bgp-routes

Description
Use this command to import Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) routes into Label
Distribution Protocol (LDP).

Use the no option to flush out all BGP routes currently being used by LDP, and to
reject any further BGP specific routing updates.

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Examples
Importing BGP routed into LDP:
ML66(config-router-ldp)#import-bgp-routes

31.12 inter-area-lsp

Synopsis

— inter-area-lsp [config-only]

290 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LDP Configuration Commands

— no inter-area-lsp

Description
Use this command to enable the creation of inter-area Label-Switched Paths
(LSPs).

Use the no option to disable the configuration.

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Options

config-only Keeps existing Label Distribution Protocol (LDP) sessions.

Examples
Creating inter-area LSPs:
ML66(config-router-ldp)#inter-area-lsp

31.13 keepalive-interval

Synopsis

— keepalive-interval <TIME>

— no keepalive-interval

Description
Use this command to set the global value for the interval after which keep alive
packets are sent out. Setting the keep alive interval on an interface using ldp
keepalive-interval command overrides the value set by this command.

Use the no option to restore the default.

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Operands

TIME The interval value in seconds. The valid range is 10–


21845. The default value is 10 seconds.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 291


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Setting the keep alive timer for all interfaces of a Label Switch Router (LSR):
ML66(config-router-ldp)#keepalive-interval 635

31.14 keepalive-timeout

Synopsis

— keepalive-timeout <TIME>

— no keepalive-timeout

Description
Use this command to set the global value for the timeout after which sessions are
rejected. Setting the keep alive timeout value on an interface using ldp
keepalive-timeout command overrides the value set by this command.

Use the no option to restore the default.

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Options

TIME The timeout value in seconds. The valid range is 30–


65535. The default value is 30 seconds.

Examples
Setting the keep alive timeout value for all interfaces of a Label Switch Router
(LSR):
ML66(config-router-ldp)#keepalive-timeout 635

31.15 label-retention-mode

Synopsis

— label-retention-mode {conservative | liberal}

— no label-retention-mode

292 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LDP Configuration Commands

Description
Use this command to set the retention mode to be used for all labels exchanged.
Setting the retention mode on an interface using ldp label-retention-mode
command overrides the value set by this command.

Note: All affected sessions are restarted if any changes made to the retention
mode for an interface.

Use the no option to revert to the retention mode set for the main Label
Distribution Protocol (LDP) process.

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Options

conservative Sets conservative label retention mode. All unused labels


and Forwarding Equivalence Classes (FECs) are deleted.

liberal Sets liberal label retention mode. All labels, regardless of


use or not, are retained.

Examples
Setting the retention mode for all interfaces of a Label Switch Router (LSR):
ML66(config-router-ldp)#label-retention-mode liberal

31.16 ldp-optimization

Synopsis
[no] ldp-optimization

Description
Use this command to optimize the resetting of a Label Distribution Protocol
(LDP) session. By default, LDP optimization is disabled.

The following scalability features can be enabled for LDP:

— Resetting the session keep alive timer on receipt of a Hello message.

— Resetting the hold timer on receipt of any LDP control message.

Use the no option to disable the scalability features.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 293


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Examples
Enabling LDP optimization:
ML66(config-router-ldp)#ldp-optimization

31.17 loop-detection

Synopsis
[no] loop-detection

Description
Use this command to enable loop detection on the current Label Switch Router
(LSR).

Use the no option to disable loop detection.

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Examples
Enabling loop detection:
ML66(config-router-ldp)#loop-detection

31.18 loop-detection-hop-count

Synopsis

— loop-detection-hop-count <COUNT>

— no loop-detection-hop-count

Description
Use this command to set the loop detection hop count, which determines the
maximum hop count value.

Use the no option to restore the default loop detection count.

294 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LDP Configuration Commands

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Operands

COUNT Sets the loop detection hop count. The valid range is 1–
255.

Examples
Setting the loop detection hop count:
ML66(config-router-ldp)#loop-detection-hop-count 128

31.19 loop-detection-path-vec-count

Synopsis

— loop-detection-path-vec-count <COUNT>

— no loop-detection-path-vec-count

Description
Use this command to set the loop detection vector count, which determines the
maximum supported path vectors.

Use the no option to restore the default vector count.

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Operands

COUNT Sets the loop detection vector count. The valid range is
1–255.

Examples
Setting the loop detection vector count:
ML66(config-router-ldp)#loop-detection-path-vec-count 123

31.20 neighbor auth md5 password

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 295


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
neighbor <IPADDR> auth md5 password <PASSWORD>

no neighbor <IPADDR> auth md5 password [<PASSWORD> ]

Description
Use this command to set the password for each Label Distribution Protocol (LDP)
peer that is used for authentication when communicating with the specified peer.

Use the no option to remove the configuration.

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the neighbor, where the format is


<A.B.C.D> .

PASSWORD The MD5 password. The maximum password length is


256 characters.

Options

auth Specifies authentication type.

md5 Uses MD5 algorithm.

password Sets the MD5 password.

Examples
Setting the MD5 password for each LDP peer that is used for authentication:
ML66(config-router-ldp)#neighbor 192.168.3.5 auth md5 password mypwd

31.21 multicast-hellos

Synopsis
[no] multicast-hellos

296 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LDP Configuration Commands

Description
Use this command to enable multicast hello exchange on all interfaces enabled
for Label Distribution Protocol (LDP). By default, multicast hello exchange is
enabled.

Use the no option to disable multicast hello exchange.

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Examples
Enabling multicast hello exchnage on all interfaces enabled for LDP:
ML66(config-router-ldp)#multicast-hellos

31.22 propagate-release

Synopsis
[no] propagate-release

Description
Use this command to propagate the release of labels to downstream routers.

Use the no options to prevent the release propagation of labels.

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Examples
Propagating the release of labels to downstream routers:
ML66(config-router-ldp)#propagate-release

31.23 request-retry

Synopsis
[no] request-retry

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 297


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to enable the retry of requests once a request for a label has
been rejected for a valid reason. A Label Switch Router (LSR) can send maximum
five label requests if a label request is rejected by a Label Distribution Protocol
(LDP) peer. By default, the request retry is enabled.

Use the no option to disable the retry of requests.

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Examples
Enabling the retry of requests:
ML66(config-router-ldp)#request-retry

31.24 request-retry-timeout

Synopsis

— request-retry-timeout <TIME>

— no request-retry-timeout

Description
Use this command to set the interval between retries. Before this time elapses, a
request is resent to a peer.

Use the no option to restore the default request retry timeout time.

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Operands

TIME The interval between retries in seconds. The valid range is


1–65535. The default request retry timeout time is 5
seconds.

Examples
Setting the interval between retries:

298 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LDP Configuration Commands

ML66(config-router-ldp)#request-retry-timeout 512

31.25 router ldp

Synopsis
[no] router ldp

Description
Use this command to change to the (config-router-ldp) submode.

Use the no option to disable the configuration.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Changing to the (config-router-ldp) submode:
ML66(config)#router ldp
ML66(config-router-ldp)#

31.26 router-id

Synopsis

— router-id <IPADDR>

— no router-id [<IPADDR> ]

Description
Use this command to set a Label Distribution Protocol (LDP) router ID.

Use the no option to remove the configuration.

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 299


CLI Descriptions

Operands

IPADDR The LDP router ID, where the format is <A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Setting an LDP router ID:
ML66(config-router-ldp)#router-id 123.123.123.8

31.27 targeted-peer hello-interval

Synopsis

— targeted-peer hello-interval <TIME>

— no targeted-peer hello-interval

Description
Use this command to set the interval for sending unicast hello packets to targeted
peers.

Use the no option to restore the default targeted peer hello interval value.

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Operands

TIME The interval in seconds. The valid range is 1–21845. The


default value is 15 seconds.

Examples
Setting the interval for sending unicast hello packets:
ML66(config-router-ldp)#targeted-peer hello-interval 1

31.28 targeted-peer hold-time

Synopsis

— targeted-peer hold-time <TIME>

300 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LDP Configuration Commands

— no targeted-peer hold-time

Description
Use this command to set the timeout value that the router waits before rejecting
an adjacency with targeted peers.

Use the no option to restore the default targeted peer hold time value.

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Operands

TIME The hold time in seconds. The valid range is 3–65535.


The default value is 45 seconds.

Examples
Setting the timeout value that the router waits before rejecting an adjacency with
targeted peers:
ML66(config-router-ldp)#targeted-peer hold-time 555

31.29 transport-address ipv4

Synopsis
[no] transport-address ipv4 <IPADDR> [<LABELSPACE> ]

Description
Use this command to configure an IPv4 transport address for a label space. By
default, the loopback address is selected as the transport address.

Use the no option to stop using the transport address as the IPv4 transport
address. If the label space is not specified, a label space of zero is assumed.

Command Mode
LDP Router configuration submode — (config-router-ldp)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 transport address, where the format is


<A.B.C.D> . Only addresses bound to a loopback interface
are valid for manual transport address configuration.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 301


CLI Descriptions

LABELSPACE The name of a label space for which the transport


address is being configured.

Examples
Configuring an IPv4 transport address for a label space:
ML66(config-router-ldp)#transport-address ipv4 10.10.0.5 myspace

302 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LDP Interface Commands

32 LDP Interface Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
32.

The following command modes are applicable for the Label Distribution Protocol
(LDP) interface commands:

— Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Table 32 LDP Interface Commands Overview


disable-ldp disable LDP IPv4 on an interface
enable-ldp enable LDP IPv4 on an interface
ldp advertisement-mode set the label advertisement mode for
an interface for the current LSR
ldp hello-interval set the interval for sending multicast
hello packets through an interface
ldp hold-time set the hold time value after which the
LSR rejects adjacencies
ldp keepalive-interval set the interval for sending keep alive
messages to the peer to maintain a
session
ldp keepalive-timeout set the keep alive timeout value for
rejecting a session with a peer
ldp label-retention-mode set the retention mode to be used for
all labels exchanged through an
interface
ldp multicast-hellos enable multicast hello exchange on an
interface
mpls ldp-igp sync configure LDP-IGP synchronization
mpls ldp-igp sync-delay configure the delay time for LDP-
Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP)
synchronization

The related show commands are the following:

— show ldp

— show ldp adjacency

— show ldp downstream

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 303


CLI Descriptions

— show ldp fec

— show ldp inter-area-fecs

— show ldp interface

— show ldp lsp

— show ldp session

— show ldp statistics

— show ldp targeted-peers

— show ldp upstream

— show mpls ldp

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

32.1 disable-ldp

Synopsis
disable-ldp ipv4

Description
Use this command to disable Label Distribution Protocol (LDP) IPv4 on an
interface. This command disables the transmission of hello packets through the
current interface, and clears all created sessions and adjacencies for the interface.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Examples
Disabling LDP IPv4:
ML66(config-router-if)#disable-ldp ipv4

32.2 enable-ldp

304 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LDP Interface Commands

Synopsis
enable-ldp ipv4

Description
Use this command to enable Label Distribution Protocol (LDP) IPv4 on an
interface. This command enables the transmission of hello packets through the
current interface, so that LDP adjacencies and LDP sessions can be created.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Examples
Enabling LDP IPv4:
ML66(config-router-if)#enable-ldp ipv4

32.3 ldp advertisement-mode

Synopsis

— ldp advertisement-mode {downstream-on-demand | downstream-


unsolicited}

— no ldp advertisement-mode

Description
Use this command to set the label advertisement mode for an interface for the
current Label Switch Router (LSR). This command overrides the advertisement
set for an LSR using the global advertisement-mode command.

Use the no option to revert to the advertisement mode set for the main Label
Distribution Protocol (LDP) process.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Options

downstream-on-demand
Indicate that the sent label was requested. When a user
uses this parameter, a router distributes a label to a peer
only if there is a pending label request from a peer. The

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 305


CLI Descriptions

reaction of the downstream router to this request


depends on the label advertising mode supported on the
next hop. The downstream-on-demand mode is typically
used with the conservative label retention mode.

downstream-unsolicited
Indicate that the label was sent unrequested. This
parameter distributes labels to peers without waiting for
a label request. This mode is typically used with the
liberal label retention mode.

Examples
Setting the label advertisement mode for an interface:
ML66(config-router-if)#ldp advertisement-mode downstream-on-demand

32.4 ldp hello-interval

Synopsis

— ldp hello-interval <TIME>

— no ldp hello-interval

Description
Use this command to set the interval for sending multicast hello packets through
an interface. This command overrides the value set for a Label Switch Router
(LSR) using the global hello-interval command.

Use the no option to revert to the hello interval value set for the main Label
Distribution Protocol (LDP) process.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

TIME The hello interval value in seconds. The valid range is 1–


21845.

Examples
Setting the hello interval for an interface:
ML66(config-router-if)#ldp hello-interval 635

306 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LDP Interface Commands

32.5 ldp hold-time

Synopsis

— ldp hold-time <TIME>

— no ldp hold-time

Description
Use this command to set the hold time value after which the Label Switch Router
(LSR) rejects adjacencies. This command overrides the value set for an LSR using
the global hold-time command.

Use the no option to revert to the hold time value set for the main Label
Distribution Protocol (LDP) process.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

TIME The hold time value in seconds. The valid range is 3–


65535.

Examples
Setting the hold time for an interface:
ML66(config-router-if)#ldp hold-time 635

32.6 ldp keepalive-interval

Synopsis

— ldp keepalive-interval <TIME>

— no ldp keepalive-interval

Description
Use this command to set the interval for sending keep alive messages to the peer
to maintain a session. This command overrides the value set for a Label Switch
Router (LSR) using the global keepalive-interval command.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 307


CLI Descriptions

Use the no option to revert to the keep alive interval set for the main Label
Distribution Protocol (LDP) process.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

TIME The keep alive interval value in seconds. The valid range
is 10–21845.

Examples
Setting the keep alive sending interval for an interface:
ML66(config-router-if)#ldp keepalive-interval 635

32.7 ldp keepalive-timeout

Synopsis

— ldp keepalive-timeout <TIME>

— no ldp keepalive-timeout

Description
Use this command to set the keep alive timeout value for rejecting a session with
a peer. This command overrides the value set for a Label Switch Router (LSR)
using the global keepalive-timeout command.

Use the no option to revert to the keep alive timeout set for the main Label
Distribution Protocol (LDP) process.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

TIME The keep alive timeout value in seconds. The valid range
is 30–65535.

Examples
Setting the keep alive timeout value for an interface:

308 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LDP Interface Commands

ML66(config-router-if)#ldp keepalive-timeout 635

32.8 ldp label-retention-mode

Synopsis

— ldp label-retention-mode {conservative | liberal}

— no ldp label-retention-mode

Description
Use this command to set the retention mode to be used for all labels exchanged
through an interface. This command overrides the setting for a Label Switch
Router (LSR) using the global label-retention-mode command.

Use the no option to revert to the retention mode set for the main Label
Distribution Protocol (LDP) process.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Options

conservative Deletes all unused labels and Forwarding Equivalence


Classes (FECs).

liberal Retains all labels, regardless of use.

Examples
Setting the label retention mode for an interface:
ML66(config-router-if)#ldp label-retention-mode liberal

32.9 ldp multicast-hellos

Synopsis
[no] ldp multicast-hellos

Description
Use this command to enable multicast hello exchange on an interface. By default,
multicast hello exchange is enabled on an interface.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 309


CLI Descriptions

Use the no option to disable multicast hello exchange.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Examples
Enabling multicast hello exchange on an interface:
ML66(config-router-if)#ldp multicast-hellos

32.10 mpls ldp-igp sync

Synopsis

— mpls ldp-igp sync {isis | ospf} [holddown-timer <TIMER> ]

— mpls ldp-igp sync isis {level-1 | level-1-2 | level-2} [holddown-


timer <TIMER> ]

— no mpls ldp-igp sync {isis | ospf}

— no mpls ldp-igp sync isis {level-1 | level-1-2 | level-2}

Description
Use this command to configure LDP-IGP synchronization.

Use the no form of this command to remove the configuration.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

TIMER Holddown timer value in seconds. The valid range is 1–


2147483 s. The default setting is 60 s.

Options

isis Specifies IS-IS routes.

ospf Specifies Open Shortest Path First (OSPF) routes.

level-1 Specifies LDP-IGP synchronization for level 1 only.

310 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LDP Interface Commands

level-1-2 Specifies LDP-IGP synchornization for both level 1 and


level 2.

level-2 Specifies LDP-IGP synchronization for level 2 only.

holddown-timer Specifies the holddown time.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#mpls ldp-igp sync ospf holddown-timer 180
ML66(config-router-if)#mpls ldp-igp sync isis level-1

32.11 mpls ldp-igp sync-delay

Synopsis

— mpls ldp-igp sync-delay <DELAY>

— no mpls ldp-igp sync-delay

Description
Use this command to configure the delay time for Label Distribution Protocol
(LDP)-Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP) synchronization.

Use the no option to remove the configuration.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

DELAY The delay time in seconds. The valid range is 5–60.

Examples
Configuring the delay time for LDP-IGP synchronization:
ML66(config-router-if)#mpls ldp-igp sync-delay 12

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 311


CLI Descriptions

33 BGP Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
33.

The following command modes are applicable for the Border Gateway Protocol
(BGP) commands:

— Exec mode — >

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 configuration submode — (config-router-af-


ip)

— BGP Address family IPv4 labeled-unicast configuration submode —


(config-router-af-ip-labeled-ucast)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VPNv4 configuration submode — (config-


router-af-vpnv4)

Table 33 BGP Commands Overview


address-family change to different BGP submodes
aggregate-addres configure Border Gateway Protocol
(BGP) aggregate entries
auto-summary enable sending summarized routes
bgp additional-paths install enable additional paths
bgp dampening set the bgp route dampening
parameters
bgp default ipv4-unicast configure BGP defaults and activate
IPv4-unicast for a peer by default
bgp default local-preference change the default local preference
value
bgp inbound-route-filter enable the Multiprotocol Label
Switching (MPLS) VPN/BGP inbound
route filter
bgp nexthop-trigger delay set the delay time for nexthop address
tracking

312 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

bgp nexthop-trigger enable enable nexthop address tracking


clear bgp * reset the BGP connection for all peers
clear bgp ASN reset the BGP connection for peers in
the specified Autonomous System
(AS)
clear bgp external reset the BGP connection for all
external peers
clear bgp ipv4 reset the BGP connection for BGP
IPv4 peers
clear bgp peer-group reset the BGP connection for all
members of a peer group
default-information distribute a default route by
configuring a BGP routing process
distance bgp define an administrative distance for
all address families
define an administrative distance per
an IPv4 family
dscp enable DSCP marking
ip as-path access-list define a BGP AS path access list
ip community-list (standard) set a standard community list that
specifies BGP community attributes
ip community-list (expanded) set an expanded community list that
specifies BGP community attributes
ip extcommunity-list (standard) create a standard extended
community list
ip extcommunity-list (expanded) create an expanded extended
community list
neighbor activate enable the exchange of the specified
AF information with a neighboring
router
neighbor advertisement-interval set the minimum interval between the
sending of BGP routing updates
neighbor allow-ebgp-vpn allow an eBGP neighbor to be a VPN
peer
neighbor allowas-in accept routes with the BGP router own
AS present in AS-PATH
neighbor as-origination-interval set the minimum interval between
sending AS-origination routing
updates
neighbor as-override configure a PE router to override the
Autonomous System Number (ASN) of
a site

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 313


CLI Descriptions

neighbor attribute-unchanged advertise unchanged BGP attributes


to the specified neighbor
neighbor capability dynamic enable the dynamic capability for a
specific peer
neighbor capability orf enable Outbound Router Filtering
(ORF), and advertise the ORF
capability to its neighbors
neighbor capability route-refresh advertise route refresh capability to
the peer
neighbor collide-established specify including a neighbor, already
in an established state, for conflict
resolution when a TCP connection
collision is detected
neighbor default-originate allow a BGP local router to send the
default route 0.0.0.0 to a neighbor
neighbor description associate a description with a
neighbor
neighbor disallow-infinite-holdtime disallow the configuration of the
infinite hold-time
neighbor dont-capability-negotiate disable capability negotiation
neighbor ebgp-multihop accept and attempt BGP connections
to external peers on indirectly
connected networks
neighbor enforce-multihop turn on the enforcement of eBGP
neighbors perform multihop
neighbor fall-over bfd configure fall-over detection through
BFD for BGP
neighbor filter-list set up a BGP filter
neighbor local-as set an AS number to use with BGP
neighbor
neighbor maximum-prefix control the number of prefixes that
can be received from a neighbor
neighbor next-hop-self configure the router as the next hop
for a BGP-speaking neighbor or peer
group
neighbor override-capability override a capability negotiation result
neighbor passive set a BGP neighbor as passive
neighbor password specify a password for a neighbor
neighbor peer-group create a peer group
neighbor port set the BGP port that is used by active
neighbor when establishing
connection

314 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

neighbor prefix-list specify a prefix list for filtering BGP


advertisements
neighbor remote-as set the AS number of a neighbor
neighbor remove-private-as remove the private AS number from
outbound updates
neighbor route-reflector-client configure the router as a BGP route
reflector and configure the specified
neighbor as its client
neighbor route-server-client configure a neighbor as the route
server client
neighbor send-community specify that a community attribute is
sent to a BGP neighbor
neighbor shutdown disable a neighbor
neighbor soft-reconfiguration inbound store updates for inbound soft
reconfiguration
neighbor soo enable site-of-origin feature
neighbor strict-capability-match close the BGP connection if the
capability value does not completely
match to the remote peer
neighbor timers set the timers for a specific BGP
neighbor
neighbor update-source allow internal BGP sessions to use any
operational interface for TCP
connections
neighbor version configure the software to accept only
a particular BGP version
neighbor weight set a weight value, per address-family,
to all routes learned from a neighbor
network specify the networks to be advertised
by the BGP routing process
redistribute inject routes from one routing process
into another
router bgp create and configure a BGP process
and change to the (config-router-bgp)
submode
synchronization enable Internal Gateway Protocol
(IGP) synchronization of Internal BGP
(iBGP) learned routes with the IGP
system
timers bgp globally set the keep alive and hold
time values for all the neighbors

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 315


CLI Descriptions

The related show commands are the following:

— show bgp

— show bgp community

— show bgp community-list

— show bgp dampening

— show bgp filter-list

— show bgp inconsistent-as

— show bgp ipv4

— show bgp mpls label mode

— show bgp neighbors

— show bgp nexthop-tracking

— show bgp nexthop-tree-details

— show bgp paths

— show bgp prefix-list

— show bgp quote-regexp

— show bgp regexp

— show bgp summary

— show bgp vpn4 all

— show bgp vpnv4 details

— show bgp vpnv4 rd

— show bgp vpnv4 vrf

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

33.1 address-family

316 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

Synopsis

— address-family ipv4 [{unicast | labeled-unicast | vrf <VRF> }]

— no address-family ipv4 {labeled-unicast | vrf <VRF>}

— address-family vpnv4 [unicast]

— [no] address-family vpnv4

Description
Use this command to change to different submodes as follows:

— Use address-family ipv4 or address-family ipv4 unicast commands


to change to the (config-router-af-ip) submode.

— Use address-family ipv4 labeled-unicast command to change to the


(config-router-af-ip-labeled-ucast) submode.

— Use address-family ipv4 vrf <VRF> command to change to the (config-


router-af-vrf) submode.

— Use address-family vpnv4 or address-family vpnv4 unicast


commands to change to the (config-router-af-vpnv4) submode.

Use the no option to disable this function.

Command Mode
BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

Operands

VRF The name of the Virtual Routing and Forwarding (VRF)


instance.

Options

ipv4 Sets the IPv4 address family.

unicast Sets unicast as an address family modifier.

labeled-unicast Sets labeled-unicast as an address family modifier for


IPv4

vrf Sets a VRF instance for IPv4.

vpnv4 Sets the VPNv4 address family.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 317


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Changing to the (config-router-af-ip) submode:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#address-family ipv4
ML66(config-router-af-ip)#

33.2 aggregate-address

Synopsis

— [no] aggregate-address <IPADDR/PREFIX>

— [no] aggregate-address <IPADDR/PREFIX as-set

— [no] aggregate-address <IPADDR/PREFIX> as-set summary-only

— [no] aggregate-address <IPADDR/PREFIX> summary-only

— [no] aggregate-address <IPADDR/PREFIX> summary-only as-set

Description
Use this command to configure Border Gateway Protocol (BGP) aggregate
entries.

Use the no option to disable this function.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Operands

IPADDR/PREFIX The IPv4 aggregate address with prefix length, where the
format is <A.B.C.D/P> .

Options

as-set Generates Autonomous System (AS) set path


information.

summary-only Filters more specific routes from updates.

318 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

Examples
Configuring BGP aggregate entries:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#aggregate-address 10.0.0.0/8 as-set summary-only

33.3 auto-summary

Synopsis
[no] auto-summary

Description
Use this command to enable sending summarized routes.

Use the no option to disable this function.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 configuration submode — (config-router-af-


ip)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Examples
Enabling auto-summary:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#auto-summary

Enabling auto-summary:
ML66(config-router-af-ip)#auto-summary

33.4 bgp additional-paths install

Synopsis
[no] bgp additional-paths install

Description
Use this command to enable additional paths.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 319


CLI Descriptions

Use the no option to disable additional paths.

Command Mode
BGP Address family IPv4 VPNv4 configuration submode — (config-router-
af-vpnv4)

Examples
ML66(config-router-af-vpnv4)#bgp additional-paths install

33.5 bgp dampening

Synopsys

— [no] bgp dampening [<HL_TIME> [<REUSE_LIM> <SUPP_LIM>


<SUPP_TIME> [<UHL_TIME>]]]

— bgp dampening route-map <MAPNAME>

— no bgp dampening route-map [<MAPNAME>]

Description
Use this command to set the bgp route dampening parameters.

Route dampening minimizes the instability caused by route flapping.

A penalty is added for every flap in a flapping route. As soon as the total penalty
reaches the suppress limit the advertisement of the route is suppressed. This
penalty is decayed according to the configured half time value. Once the penalty
is lower than the reuse limit, the route advertisement is un-suppressed.

The dampening information is purged from the router once the penalty becomes
less than half of the reuse limit.

Use the no parameter to unset the bgp dampening parameters.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 configuration submode — (config-router-af-


ip)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

320 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

— BGP Address family IPv4 VPNv4 configuration submode — (config-


router-af-vpnv4)

Operands

HL_TIME Reachability half-life time in minutes. The time for the


penalty to decrease to one-half of its current value. The
valid range is 1-45 minutes. The default is 15 minutes.

REUSE_LIM Reuse limit value. When the penalty for a suppressed


route decays below the reuse value, the routes become
unsuppressed. The valid range is 1-20000. The default
reuse limit is 750.

SUPP_LIM Suppress limit value. When the penalty for a route


exceeds the suppress value, the route is suppressed. The
valid range is 1-20000. The default suppress limit is
2000.

SUPP_TIME Maximum suppress-time. The maximum time that a


dampened route is suppressed. The valid range is 1-255.
The default max-suppress value is 4 times the half-life
time (60 minutes).

UHL_TIME The unreachability half-life time for penalty, in minutes.


The valid range is 1-45 minutes.

MAPNAME The name of the route map.

Options

route-map Specifies route-map to specify criteria for dampening.

Note: This option is not supported in the (config-


router-af-vpnv4) submode

Examples
ML66(config-router-bgp)#bgp dampening 20 800 2500 80 25

33.6 bgp default ipv4-unicast

Synopsys

— [no] bgp default ipv4-unicast

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 321


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to configure BGP defaults and activate IPv4-unicast for a peer
by default. This affects the BGP global configuration.

Use the no parameter with this command to disable the default behavior of the
BGP routing process of exchanging IPv4 addressing information with BGP
neighbor routers.

Command Mode
BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

Examples
ML66(config-router-bgp)#bgp default ipv4-unicast

33.7 bgp default local-preference

Synopsys

— bgp default local-preference <PREF>

— no bgp default local-preference [<PREF>]

Description
Use this command to change the default local preference value.

Local preference indicates the preferred path when there are multiple paths to
the same destination. The path having a higher preference is preferred. The
preference is sent to all routers and access servers in the local autonomous
system.

Use the no parameter with this command to revert to the default setting.

Command Mode
BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

Operands

PREF The default local preference value. The valid range is


0-4294967295. The default value is 100.

Examples
ML66(config-router-bgp)#bgp default local-preference 2345555

322 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

33.8 bgp inbound-route-filter

Synopsys

— [no] bgp inbound-route-filter

Description
Use this command to enable the Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS) VPN/BGP
inbound route filter.

Use the no parameter with this command to disable this feature.

Command Mode
BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

Examples
ML66(config-router-bgp)#bgp inbound-route-filter

33.9 bgp nexthop-trigger delay

Synopsis

— bgp nexthop-trigger delay <DELAY>

— no bgp nexthop-trigger delay

Description
Use this command to set the delay time for nexthop address tracking.

Use the no option to reset the timer value to the default value.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

DELAY The delay time in seconds. The valid range is 1–100. The
default value is 5 seconds.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 323


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Setting the delay time for nexthop address tracking:
ML66(config)#bgp nexthop-trigger delay 6

33.10 bgp nexthop-trigger enable

Synopsis
[no] bgp nexthop-trigger enable

Description
Use this command to enable nexthop address tracking.

Use the no option to disable the feature. If the no option is given when nexthop
tracking is in the process of execution, an error appears and nexthop tracking is
not disabled. However, if the nexthop tracking timer is running at the time of
negation, the nexthop tracking timer is stopped, and nexthop tracking is disabled.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Enabling nexthop address tracking:
ML66(config)#bgp nexthop-trigger enable

33.11 clear bgp *

Synopsis
clear bgp * [in [prefix-filter] | out | soft [in | out] ]

Description
Use this command to reset the BGP connection for all peers.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

324 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

Options

in Indicates that incoming advertised routes are cleared.

prefix-filter Indicates the push out prefix-list Outbound Router


Filtering (ORF) and do inbound soft reconfiguration.

out Indicates that outgoing advertised routes are cleared.

soft Indicates that both incoming and outgoing routes are


cleared.

— in — Indicates soft reconfiguration inbound update.

— out — Indicates soft reconfiguration outbound


update.

Examples
Resetting the BGP connection for all peers:
ML66#clear bgp * soft in

33.12 clear bgp ASN

Synopsis
clear bgp <ASN> [in [prefix-filter] | out | soft [in | out] ]

Description
Use this command to reset the BGP connection for peers in the specified
Autonomous System (AS).

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

ASN The number of the AS. The valid range is 1–4294967295.

Options

in Indicates that incoming advertised routes are cleared.

prefix-filter Indicates the push out prefix-list Outbound Router


Filtering (ORF) and do inbound soft reconfiguration.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 325


CLI Descriptions

out Indicates that outgoing advertised routes are cleared.

soft Indicates that both incoming and outgoing routes are


cleared.

— in — Indicates soft reconfiguration inbound update.

— out — Indicates soft reconfiguration outbound


update.

Examples
Resetting the BGP connection for peers in the specified AS:
ML66#clear bgp 300 in prefix-filter
ML66#clear bgp 300 soft in
ML66#clear bgp 1 in prefix-filter

33.13 clear bgp external

Synopsis
clear bgp external [in [prefix-filter] | out | soft [in | out] ]

Description
Use this command to reset the BGP connection for all external peers.

Command mode
Exec mode — >

Options

in Indicates that incoming advertised routes are cleared.

prefix-filter Indicates the push out prefix-list Outbound Router


Filtering (ORF) and do inbound soft reconfiguration.

out Indicates that outgoing advertised routes are cleared.

soft Indicates that both incoming and outgoing routes are


cleared.

— in — Indicates soft reconfiguration inbound update.

— out — Indicates soft reconfiguration outbound


update.

326 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

Examples
Resetting the BGP connection for all external peers:
ML66#clear bgp external soft in

33.14 clear bgp ipv4

Synopsis

— clear bgp ipv4 unicast {dampening | flap-statistics} [<IPADDR> |


<IPADDR/PREFIX> ]

— clear bgp ipv4 <IPADDR> [in [prefix-filter] | out | soft [in | out] ]

— clear bgp ipv4 vrf <VRF> {dampening | flap-statistics} [<IPADDR> |


<IPADDR/PREFIX> ]

— clear bgp ipv4 external [in [prefix-filter] | out | soft [in | out] ]

— clear bgp ipv4 * [in [prefix-filter] | out | soft [in | out] ]

— clear bgp ipv4 <ASN> [in [prefix-filter] | out | soft [in | out] ]

— clear bgp ipv4 peer-group <NAME> [in [prefix-filter] | out | soft


[in | out] ]

Description
Use this command to reset the BGP connection for BGP IPv4 peers.

Command mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IPADDR The BGP IPv4 neighbor address, where the format is


<A.B.C.D> .

VRF The name of the Virtual Routing and Forwarding (VRF)


instance.

ASN The number of the Autonomous System (AS). The valid


range is 1–4294967295.

NAME The name of the peer group.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 327


CLI Descriptions

IPADDR The IP prefix network, where the format is <A.B.C.D> .

IPADDR/PREFIX The IP prefix network and length, where the format is


<A.B.C.D/P> .

Options

unicast Indicates the address family modifier as unicast.

dampening Clears route flap dampening information.

flap-statistics Clears route flap statistics.

vrf Clears the VRF.

* Resets the BGP connection for all BGP IPv4 peers.

external Resets the BGP connection for all external BGP IPv4
peers.

peer-group Resets the BGP connection for all BGP IPv4 members of
a peer group.

in Indicates that incoming advertised routes are cleared.

prefix-filter Indicates the push out prefix-list Outbound Router


Filtering (ORF) and do inbound soft reconfiguration.

out Indicates that outgoing advertised routes are cleared.

soft Indicates that both incoming and outgoing routes are


cleared.

— in — Indicates soft reconfiguration inbound update.

— out — Indicates soft reconfiguration outbound


update.

Examples
Resetting the BGP connection for BGP IPv4 peers:
ML66#clear bgp ipv4 unicast dampening 1.1.1.1

33.15 clear bgp peer-group

328 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

Synopsis
clear bgp peer-group <NAME>

Description
Use this command to reset the BGP connection for all members of a peer group.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

NAME The name of the BGP peer group.

Examples
Resetting the BGP connection for all members of a peer group:
ML66#clear bgp peer-group P1

33.16 default-information

Synopsis
[no] default-information originate

Description
Use this command in BGP Router or Address family configuration mode to
distribute a default route (network 0.0.0.0) by configuring a BGP routing process.

Use the no option disable the advertisement of a default route.

Note: This command only advertises default route. A redistribution statement


must also be configured to complete this configuration, or the default
route is not advertised.

Command Mode
BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-af-


vrf)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 329


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Distributing a default route:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#default-information originate

33.17 distance bgp

Synopsis

— [no] distance bgp <EXT-ROUTES> <INT-ROUTES> <LO-ROUTES>

— no distance bgp

Description

BGP Router configuration submode


Use this command to define an administrative distance
for all address families.

Use the no option to remove an administrative distance.

BGP Address family submode


Use this command to define an administrative distance
per an IPv4 family.

Use the no option to remove an administrative distance.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 configuration submode — (config-router-af-


ip)

— BGP Address family IPv4 labeled-unicast configuration submode —


(config-router-af-ip-labeled-ucast)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VPNv4 configuration submode — (config-


router-af-vpnv4)

Operands

EXT-ROUTES The distance for BGP external routes. The valid range is
1–255. The default value is 20.

330 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

INT-ROUTES The distance for BGP internal routes. The valid range is
1–255. The default value is 200.

LO-ROUTES The distance for BGP local routes. The valid range is 1–
255. The default value is 200.

Examples
Setting the administrative distance for BGP for all address families:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#distance bgp 34 23 15

33.18 dscp

Synopsis

— dscp <DSCP>

— no dscp

Description
Use this command to enable DSCP marking.

Use the no option to set DSCP marking to default value.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Operands

DSCP The DSCP value, which is a decimal integer. The valid


range is 0–63. The default value is 48.

Examples
Setting BGP DSCP value for the default VRF:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#dscp 16

Setting the BGP DSCP value for a specific VRF:


ML66(config-router-af-vrf)#dscp 10

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 331


CLI Descriptions

33.19 ip as-path access-list

Synopsis

— [no] ip as-path access-list <NAME> {deny | permit} <REGEXP>

— no ip as-path access-list <NAME>

Description
Use this command to define a BGP Autonomous System (AS) path access list.

Use the no option to disable the use of the access list.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

NAME The name of the access list.

REGEXP A regular expression, which matches to the BGP AS


paths.

Options

deny Denies access to matching conditions.

permit Permits access to matching conditions.

Examples
Defining a BGP AS path access list:
ML66(config)#ip as-path access-list mylist deny ^65535$

33.20 ip community-list (standard)

Synopsis
[no] ip community-list {<NUMBER> | standard <NAME> } {deny | permit}
[<AA:NN> | internet | local-AS | no-advertise | no-export]

332 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

Description
Use this command to set a standard community list that specifies BGP
community attributes. A standard community list can be specified by assigning
either a number or a name to it.

Use the community lists to specify BGP community attributes. The community
attribute is used for implementing policy routing. It is an optional, transitive
attribute and facilitates transfer of local policies through different autonomous
systems. It includes community values that are 32 bits long.

There are two kinds of community lists: expanded and standard. The standard
community list defines the community attributes in a specified format without
regular expressions. The expanded community list defines the community
attributes with regular expressions. The standard community list is compiled into
a binary format and is directly compared with the BGP communities attribute in
the BGP updates. The comparison is faster than in the case of the expanded
community list. Any community value that does not match the standard
community value is automatically treated as expanded.

Use the no option to delete the community-list entry.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

NUMBER The community-list number. The valid range is 1–99.

NAME The community-list name.

AA:NN The community-attribute value.

Options

deny Sets the community to reject.

permit Sets the community to accept.

internet Sets routes to be advertised to the Internet community.

local-AS Sets routes not to be advertised outside of the local


Autonomous System (AS).

no-export Sets routes not to be advertised to external BGP peers.

no-advertise Sets routes not to be advertised to other BGP peers.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 333


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Setting a standard community list that specifies BGP community attributes:
ML66(config)#ip community-list 55 permit 7675:80 7675:90
ML66(config)#ip community-list mylist permit 7675:80 7675:90
ML66(config)#ip community-list standard CLIST permit 7675:80 7675:90 no-export

33.21 ip community-list (expanded)

Synopsis
[no] ip community-list {<NUMBER> | expanded <NAME> } {deny | permit}
<REGEXP>

Description
Use this command to set an expanded community list that specifies BGP
community attributes. An expanded community list can be specified by assigning
either a number or a name to it.

Use the no option to delete the community-list entry.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

NUMBER The community-list number. The valid range is 100–199.

NAME The community-list name.

REGEXP A regular expression that matches the BGP Autonomous


System (AS) paths.

Options

deny Sets the community to reject.

permit Sets the community to accept.

Examples
Setting an expanded community list that specifies BGP community attributes:
ML66(config)#ip community-list 125 permit 6789906
ML66(config)#ip community-list expanded CLIST permit .*

334 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

33.22 ip extcommunity-list (standard)

Synopsis
[no] ip extcommunity-list {<NUMBER> | standard <NAME> } {deny |
permit} [rt | soo] [<AA:NN> | <A.B.C.D:NN> ]

Description
Use this command to create or delete a standard extended community list. A
standard extended community list can be specified by assigning either a number
or a name to it.

An extended community is based on a 6-byte value. These 6 bytes are


represented in a <4bytes:2bytes> format. There are two possible formats:

— <AA:NN> : The AS number is represented in higher-order 4 bytes. The NN


assigned value is represented in low-order 2 bytes.

— <IPaddr:NN> : The higher-order 4 bytes are used to represent the IP address,


and the low-order 2 bytes are used to represent the assigned value.

Use the no option to delete the community-list entry.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

NUMBER The community-list number. The valid range is 1–99.

NAME The community-list name.

Options

deny Sets the community to reject.

permit Sets the community to accept.

rt Route Target extended community

soo Site-of-Origin extended community

Examples
Creating a standard extended community list:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 335


CLI Descriptions

ML66(config)#ip extcommunity-list 75 permit 4567335


ML66(config)#ip extcommunity-list standard CLIST permit .*

33.23 ip extcommunity-list (expanded)

Synopsis
[no] ip extcommunity-list {<NUMBER> | expanded <NAME> } {deny |
permit} <REGEXP>

Description
Use this command to create an expanded extended community list. An expanded
extended community list can be specified by assigning either a number or a name
to it.

Use the no option to delete the community-list entry.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

NUMBER The community-list number. The valid range is 100–199.

NAME The community-list name.

REGEXP A regular expression that matches the BGP Autonomous


System (AS) paths.

Options

deny Sets the community to reject.

permit Sets the community to accept.

Examples
Creating an expanded extended community list:
ML66(config)#ip extcommunity-list 135 permit .*
ML66(config)#ip extcommunity-list expanded CLIST permit .*

33.24 neighbor activate

336 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> activate

Description
Use this command to enable the exchange of the specified AF information with a
neighboring router.

Use the no option to disable exchange of the specified AF information with a


neighbor.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 configuration submode — (config-router-af-


ip)

— BGP Address family IPv4 labeled-unicast configuration submode —


(config-router-af-ip-labeled-ucast)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VPNv4 configuration submode — (config-


router-af-vpnv4)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Enabling the exchange of the specified AF information with a neighboring router:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 1.2.3.4 activate

33.25 neighbor advertisement-interval

Synopsis

— [no] neighbor <IPADDR> advertisement-interval <TIME>

— no neighbor <IPADDR> advertisement-interval

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 337


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to set the minimum interval between the sending of BGP
routing updates.

Use the no option to set the interval time to default.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

TIME The advertisement interval in seconds. The valid range is


0–65535. the default value is 5 seconds for IBGP
neighbors and 30 seconds for EBGP neighbors.

Examples
Setting the minimum interval between the sending of BGP routing updates:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.0.3 advertisement-interval 45

33.26 neighbor allow-ebgp-vpn

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> allow-ebgp-vpn

Description
Use this command to allow an eBGP neighbor to be a VPN peer. By default, BGP
VPN functionality is allowed only for iBGP peers.

Use the no option to remove the configuration.

Command Mode

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VPNv4 configuration submode — (config-


router-af-vpnv4)

338 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Allowing an eBGP neighbor to be a VPN peer:
ML66config-router-af-vrf)#neighbor 66.66.66.66 allow-ebgp-vpn

33.27 neighbor allowas-in

Synopsis

— [no] neighbor <IPADDR> allowas-in

— neighbor <IPADDR> allowas-in <COUNT>

Description
Use this command to accept routes with the BGP router own Autonomous
System (AS) present in AS-PATH.

Use the no option to reset to default.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 configuration submode — (config-router-af-


ip)

— BGP Address family IPv4 labeled-unicast configuration submode —


(config-router-af-ip-labeled-ucast)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VPNv4 configuration submode — (config-


router-af-vpnv4)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

COUNT Number of occurrences of AS number. The valid range is


1–10. If the value is not specified, the parameter is set to
3.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 339


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Accepting routes with the BGP router own AS present in AS-PATH:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.0.3 allowas-in 4

33.28 neighbor as-origination-interval

Synopsis

— [no] neighbor <IPADDR> as-origination-interval <TIME>

— no neighbor <IPADDR> as-origination-interval

Description
Use this command to set the minimum interval between sending Autonomous
System (AS) origination routing updates.

Use the no option to set the interval time to default.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

TIME The time in seconds. The valid range is 1–65535. The


default value is 15 seconds.

Examples
Setting the minimum interval between sending AS origination routing updates:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.0.75 as-origination-interval 555

33.29 neighbor as-override

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> as-override

340 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

Description
Use this command to configure a PE router to override the Autonomous System
Number (ASN) of a site.

Use the no option to remove VPN IPv4 prefixes from a specified router.

Command Mode
BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-af-
vrf)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Configuring a PE router to override the ASN:
ML66(config-router-af-vrf)#neighbor 10.10.0.1 as-override

33.30 neighbor attribute-unchanged

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> attribute-unchanged [as-path] [next-hop] [med]

Description
Use this command to advertise unchanged BGP attributes to the specified
neighbor.

Use the no option to disable the function.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 configuration submode — (config-router-af-


ip)

— BGP Address family IPv4 labeled-unicast configuration submode —


(config-router-af-ip-labeled-ucast)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 341


CLI Descriptions

— BGP Address family IPv4 VPNv4 configuration submode — (config-


router-af-vpnv4)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

Options

as-path Sets Autonomous System (AS) path attribute.

next-hop Sets next hop attribute.

med Sets multi-exit discriminator attribute.

Examples
Advertising unchanged BGP attributes to the specified neighbor:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.0.75 attribute-unchanged as-path med

33.31 neighbor capability dynamic

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> capability dynamic

Description
Use this command to enable the dynamic capability for a specific peer.

Use the no option to disable the dynamic capability.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

342 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

Examples
Enabling the dynamic capability for a specific peer:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.10.1 capability dynamic

33.32 neighbor capability orf

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> capability orf prefix-list {both | receive |
send}

Description
Use this command to enable Outbound Router Filtering (ORF), and advertise the
ORF capability to its neighbors.

Use the no option to disable the function.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 configuration submode — (config-router-af-


ip)

— BGP Address family IPv4 labeled-unicast configuration submode —


(config-router-af-ip-labeled-ucast)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

Options

prefix-list Advertises prefix list ORF capability to this neighbor.

both Indicates that the local router can send ORF entries to its
peer, as well as receive ORF entries from its peer.

receive Indicates that the local router receives ORF entries from
its peer.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 343


CLI Descriptions

send Indicates that the local router sends ORF entries to its
peer.

Examples
Enabling ORF, and advertise the ORF capability to its neighbors:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.0.5 capability orf prefix-list both

33.33 neighbor capability route-refresh

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> capability route-refresh

Description
Use this command to advertise route refresh capability to the peer.

Use the no option to disable the function.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Advertising route refresh capability to the peer:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.10.1 capability route-refresh

33.34 neighbor collide-established

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> collide-established

344 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

Description
Use this command to specify including a neighbor, already in an established
state, for conflict resolution when a TCP connection collision is detected.

Use the no option to disable the function.

Command Mode
BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Specifying including a neighbor, already in an established state, for conflict
resolution:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 3.3.3.3 collide-established

33.35 neighbor default-originate

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> default-originate

Description
Use this command to allow a BGP local router to send the default route 0.0.0.0 to
a neighbor. This command can be used with standard or extended access lists.

Use the no option to send no route as a default.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 configuration submode — (config-router-af-


ip)

— BGP Address family IPv4 labeled-unicast configuration submode —


(config-router-af-ip-labeled-ucast)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 345


CLI Descriptions

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Allowing a BGP local router to send the default route 0.0.0.0 to a neighbor:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.10.1 default-originate

33.36 neighbor description

Synopsis

— [no] neighbor <IPADDR> description <LINE>

— no neighbor <IPADDR> description

Description
Use this command to associate a description with a neighbor.

Use the no option to remove the description.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

LINE The description of the neighbor. The maximum length is


80 characters.

Examples
Associating a description with a neighbor:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 1.2.3.4 description "Backup router"

33.37 neighbor disallow-infinite-holdtime

346 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> disallow-infinite-holdtime

Description
Use this command to disallow the configuration of the infinite hold-time.

Use the no option to allow the BGP speaker to accept a hold-time of 0.

Command Mode
BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Disallowing the configuration of the infinite hold-time:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.11.4.26 disallow-infinite-holdtime

33.38 neighbor dont-capability-negotiate

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> dont-capability-negotiate

Description
Use this command to disable capability negotiation.

Use the no option to enable capability negotiation.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 347


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Disabling capability negotiation:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.0.34 dont-capability-negotiate

33.39 neighbor ebgp-multihop

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> ebgp-multihop [<COUNT> ]

Description
Use this command to accept and attempt BGP connections to external peers on
indirectly connected networks.

Note: Multihop is not established if the only route to the multihop peer is a
default route.

Use the no option to set the default hop count.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

COUNT The maximum hop count. The valid range is 1–255. The
default value is 1 for EBGP peers.

If the value is not set, the hop count is 255.

Examples
Accepting and attempting BGP connections to external peers on indirectly
connected networks:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.10.34 ebgp-multihop 5

33.40 neighbor enforce-multihop

348 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> enforce-multihop

Description
Use this command to turn on the enforcement of eBGP neighbors perform
multihop.

Use the no option to disable the function.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Turning on the enforcement of eBGP neighbors perform multihop:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.0.34 enforce-multihop

33.41 neighbor fall-over bfd

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> fall-over bfd [multihop]

Description
Use this command to configure fall-over detection through BFD for BGP.

Use the no option to disable the function.

BFD multihop sessions are dynamically created or removed by this command.


Use the bfd multihop-peer command to configure BFD multihop peer timer
values.

Command Mode
BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 349


CLI Descriptions

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D>.

Options

bfd Sets Bidirectional Forwarding Detection (BFD).

multihop Specifies to use multihop BFD.

Examples
Configuring fall-over detection for BGP through multihop BFD:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.0.34 fall-over bfd multihop

33.42 neighbor filter-list

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> filter-list <NAME> {in | out}

Description
Use this command to set up a BGP filter.

Use the no option to disable the function.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 configuration submode — (config-router-af-


ip)

— BGP Address family IPv4 labeled-unicast configuration submode —


(config-router-af-ip-labeled-ucast)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VPNv4 configuration submode — (config-


router-af-vpnv4)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

350 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

NAME The name of an Autonomous System (AS) path filter list.

Options

in Indicates that incoming advertised routes are filtered.

out Indicates that outgoing advertised routes are filtered.

Examples
Setting up a BGP filter:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.0.34 filter-list out

33.43 neighbor local-as

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> local-as <ASN>

Description
Use this command to set an Autonomous System (AS) number to use with BGP
neighbor.

Use the no option to disable the function.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

ASN The number of the AS. The valid range is 1–4294967295.

Examples
Setting a AS number to use with BGP neighbor:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.0.34 local-as 12345

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 351


CLI Descriptions

33.44 neighbor maximum-prefix

Synopsis

— neighbor <IPADDR> maximum-prefix <COUNT> [<NUMBER>] [warning-


only]

— [no] neighbor <IPADDR> maximum-prefix [<COUNT> [warning-only]]

Description
Use this command to control the number of prefixes that can be received from a
neighbor.

Use the no option to disable the function.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 configuration submode — (config-router-af-


ip)

— BGP Address family IPv4 labeled-unicast configuration submode —


(config-router-af-ip-labeled-ucast)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VPNv4 configuration submode — (config-


router-af-vpnv4)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D>.

COUNT Sets the maximum number of prefixes accepted. The


valid range is 1–4294967295.

NUMBER Sets the threshold value. The valid range is 1–100


percent. If no threshold is given, the default 75%
threshold is set.

Options

warning-only Only gives a warning message when the limit is


exceeded.

352 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

Examples
Controlling the number of prefixes that can be received from a neighbor:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.0.72 maximum-prefix 1244 warning-only

33.45 neighbor next-hop-self

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> next-hop-self

Description
Use this command to configure the router as the next hop for a BGP-speaking
neighbor or peer group.

Use the no option to disable the feature.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 configuration submode — (config-router-af-


ip)

— BGP Address family IPv4 labeled-unicast configuration submode —


(config-router-af-ip-labeled-ucast)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VPNv4 configuration submode — (config-


router-af-vpnv4)

Operand

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Configuring the router as the next hop for a BGP-speaking neighbor or peer
group:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.0.72 next-hop-self

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 353


CLI Descriptions

33.46 neighbor override-capability

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> override-capability

Description
Use this command to override a capability negotiation result.

Use the no option to disable the function.

Command Mode
BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Overriding a capability negotiation result:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.10.10 override-capability

33.47 neighbor passive

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> passive

Description
Use this command to set a BGP neighbor as passive.

Use the no option to disable the function.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

354 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Setting a BGP neighbor as passive:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.10.10 passive

33.48 neighbor password

Synopsis

— [no] neighbor <IPADDR> password <PASSWORD>

— no neighbor <IPADDR> password

Description
Use this command to specify a password for a neighbor. This password is used
with TCP MD5 signature option.

Note: For the command to take effect, the neighbor session has to be cleared.

Use the no parameter with this command to disable the function.

Command Mode
BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D>.

PASSWORD The password for a neighbor. The maximum password


length is 80 characters.

Examples
Setting a password for a BGP neighbor:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.10.10 password ABC

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 355


CLI Descriptions

33.49 neighbor peer-group

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> peer-group <NAME>

Description
Use this command to create a peer group.

Use the no option to remove neighbor from the peer group.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

NAME The name of the peer group.

Examples
Creating a peer group:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.0.63 peer-group PeerGroup

33.50 neighbor port

Synopsis

— [no] neighbor <IPADDR> port <PORT>

— no neighbor <IPADDR> port

Description
Use this command to set the BGP port that is used by active neighbor when
establishing connection.

Use the no option to disable the function.

356 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

PORT The number of the TCP port.

Examples
Setting the BGP port:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.10.10 port 32768

33.51 neighbor prefix-list

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> prefix-list <NAME> {in | out}

Description
Use this command to specify a prefix list for filtering BGP advertisements.

Use the no option to remove prefix list configurations from the neighbor.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 configuration submode — (config-router-af-


ip)

— BGP Address family IPv4 labeled-unicast configuration submode —


(config-router-af-ip-labeled-ucast)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VPNv4 configuration submode — (config-


router-af-vpnv4)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 357


CLI Descriptions

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

NAME The name of the prefix list.

Options

in Specifies that the access list applies to incoming


advertisements.

out Specifies that the access list applies to outgoing


advertisements.

Examples
Specifying a prefix list for filtering BGP advertisements:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.10.10 prefix-list list1 in

33.52 neighbor remote-as

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> remote-as <ASN>

Description
Use this command to set the Autonomous System (AS) number of a neighbor.

Use the no option to remove the configuration.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

ASN The AS number of the neighbor. The valid range is 1–


4294967295.

358 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

Examples
Setting the AS number of a neighbor:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.0.73 remote-as 345

33.53 neighbor remove-private-as

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> remove-private-as

Description
Use this command to remove the private Autonomous System (AS) number from
outbound updates.

Use the no option to revert to default.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 configuration submode — (config-router-af-


ip)

— BGP Address family IPv4 labeled-unicast configuration submode —


(config-router-af-ip-labeled-ucast)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VPNv4 configuration submode — (config-


router-af-vpnv4)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Removing the private AS number from outbound updates:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.0.63 remove-private-as

33.54 neighbor route-reflector-client

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 359


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> route-reflector-client

Description
Use this command to configure the router as a BGP route reflector and configure
the specified neighbor as its client.

Use the no option to indicate that the neighbor is not a client.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 configuration submode — (config-router-af-


ip)

— BGP Address family IPv4 labeled-unicast configuration submode —


(config-router-af-ip-labeled-ucast)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VPNv4 configuration submode — (config-


router-af-vpnv4)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Configuring the router as a BGP route reflector and configure the specified
neighbor as its client:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 3.3.3.3 route-reflector-client

33.55 neighbor route-server-client

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> route-server-client

Description
Use this command to configure a neighbor as the route server client.

360 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

Use the no option to revert to default.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 configuration submode — (config-router-af-


ip)

— BGP Address family IPv4 labeled-unicast configuration submode —


(config-router-af-ip-labeled-ucast)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VPNv4 configuration submode — (config-


router-af-vpnv4)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Configuring a neighbor as the route server client:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.0.72 route-server-client

33.56 neighbor send-community

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> send-community [both | extended | standard]

Description
Use this command to specify that a community attribute is sent to a BGP
neighbor.

Use the no option to remove the entry.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 configuration submode — (config-router-af-


ip)

— BGP Address family IPv4 labeled-unicast configuration submode —


(config-router-af-ip-labeled-ucast)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 361


CLI Descriptions

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VPNv4 configuration submode — (config-


router-af-vpnv4)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

Options

both Sends Standard and Extended Community attributes.

extended Sends Extended Community attributes.

standard Sends Standard Community attributes.

Examples
Specifying that extended community attributes are sent to a BGP neighbor:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.0.72 send-community extended

33.57 neighbor shutdown

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> shutdown

Description
Use this command to disable a neighbor. This command shuts down any active
session for the specified neighbor and clears all related routing data.

Use the no option to enable the neighbor again.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

362 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Disabling a neighbor:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.0.72 shutdown

33.58 neighbor soft-reconfiguration inbound

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> soft-reconfiguration inbound

Description
Use this command to store updates for inbound soft reconfiguration.

Use the no option to disable the function.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 configuration submode — (config-router-af-


ip)

— BGP Address family IPv4 labeled-unicast configuration submode —


(config-router-af-ip-labeled-ucast)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Storing updates for inbound soft reconfiguration:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.10.10 soft-reconfiguration inbound

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 363


CLI Descriptions

33.59 neighbor soo

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> soo [<RD> ]

Description
Use this command to enable site-of-origin feature.

Use the no option to disable the feature.

Command Mode
BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-af-
vrf)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

RD The unique Route Distinguisher (RD) value on the router


as follows:

— ◦An Autonomous System (AS) number and an


arbitrary number, for example, 100:1.

— ◦A 32-bit IP address and an arbitrary number, for


example, 192.16.10.1:1.

Options

soo Indicates the site of origin.

Examples
Enabling site-of-origin feature:
ML66(config-router-af-vrf)#neighbor 10.10.0.1 soo 100:1

33.60 neighbor strict-capability-match

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> strict-capability-match

364 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

Description
Use this command to close the BGP connection if the capability value does not
completely match to the remote peer.

Use the no option to disable the function.

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Examples
Closing the BGP connection:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.10.10 strict-capability-match

33.61 neighbor timers

Synopsis

— neighbor <IPADDR> timers connect <TIME>

— neighbor <IPADDR> timers <INTERVAL> <HOLDTIME>

— no neighbor <IPADDR> timers

— no neighbor <IPADDR> timers connect

Description
Use this command to set the timers for a specific BGP neighbor.

Use the no option to clear the timers for a specific BGP neighbor.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 365


CLI Descriptions

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

TIME The connect timer. The valid range is 1–65535.

INTERVAL Interval after which, on not receiving a keep alive


message, the router declares a neighbor dead. The valid
range is 0–65535. The default value is 180 seconds.

HOLDTIME The hold time value. The valid range is 0–65535.

Examples
Setting the timers for a specific BGP neighbor:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.10.10 timers 60 120
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.10.10 timers connect 10

33.62 neighbor update-source

Synopsis
[no] neighbor <IPADDR> update-source {<IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> |
lo.<VRF> | lo | <IPADDR2>}

Description
Use this command to allow internal BGP sessions to use any operational
interface for TCP connections.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D>.

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN

366 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

The Rack, Slot, and Port values and the VLAN number of
the L3 VLAN subinterface, where the format is <Rack/
Slot/Port.VLAN>, for example, 1/9/4.500.

lo The router loopback interface.

lo.VRF The loopback interface of a VRF instance, for example


lo.vrf_1.

IPADDR2 The IP address of the interface, where the format is


<A.B.C.D>.

Examples
Allowing internal BGP sessions to use any operational interface for TCP
connections:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.0.72 update-source 1.2.3.4

33.63 neighbor version

Synopsis

— neighbor <IPADDR> version 4

— no neighbor <IPADDR> version

Description
Use this command to configure the software to accept only a particular BGP
version.

Use the no option to use the default version level of a neighbor.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 367


CLI Descriptions

Options

4 Sets the BGP version number.

Examples
Configuring the software to accept only BGP version 4:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.10.10 version 4

33.64 neighbor weight

Synopsis

— [no] neighbor <IPADDR> weight <NUMBER>

— no neighbor <IPADDR> weight

Description
Use this command to set a weight value, per address-family, to all routes learned
from a neighbor. The weights assigned using the set weight command override
the weights assigned using this command.

Use the no option to remove a weight assignment.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 configuration submode — (config-router-af-


ip)

— BGP Address family IPv4 labeled-unicast configuration submode —


(config-router-af-ip-labeled-ucast)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VPNv4 configuration submode — (config-


router-af-vpnv4)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

NUMBER The weight value. The valid range is 0–65535.

368 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

Examples
Setting a weight value, per address-family, to all routes learned from a neighbor:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#neighbor 10.10.10.10 weight 60

33.65 network

Synopsis

— [no] network {<IPADDR> | <IPADDR/PREFIX> } [backdoor]

— [no] network synchronization

Description
Use this command to specify the networks to be advertised by the BGP routing
process.

Use the no option to remove a network route entry.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 configuration submode — (config-router-af-


ip)

— BGP Address family IPv4 labeled-unicast configuration submode —


(config-router-af-ip-labeled-ucast)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Operands

IPADDR The IP prefix network, where the format is <A.B.C.D> .

IPADDR/PREFIX The IP prefix network and length, where the format is


<A.B.C.D/P> .

Options

backdoor Sets a BGP backdoor route.

synchronization Performs IGP synchronization on the network routes.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 369


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Specifying the networks to be advertised by the BGP routing process:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#network 2.0.0.0

Enabling IGP synchronization of BGP static network routes:


ML66(config-router-bgp)#network synchronization

33.66 redistribute

Synopsis
[no] redistribute {connected | isis | kernel | static | ospf {<PROC_ID>}}

Description
Use this command to inject routes from one routing process into another.

Use the no option to disable the function.

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Operands

PROC_ID The ID of an OSPF process. The valid range is 0–65535.

Options

connected Redistributes connected routes.

isis Redistributes IS-IS routes.

kernel Redistributes connected kernel routes.

static Redistributes static routes.

ospf Redistributes OSPF routes.

Examples
Injecting routes from one routing process into another:

370 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

ML66(config-router-bgp)#redistribute isis

33.67 router bgp

Synopsis
[no] router bgp <ASN>

Description
Use this command to create a BGP process. This command also changes to the
(config-router-bgp) submode.

Use the no option to remove a BGP process.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

ASN The number of the Autonomous System (AS). The valid


range is 1–65535.

Examples
Changing to the (config-router-bgp) submode:
ML66(config)#router bgp 1
ML66(config-router-bgp)#

33.68 synchronization

Synopsis
[no] synchronization

Description
Use this command to enable Internal Gateway Protocol (IGP) synchronization of
Internal BGP (iBGP) learned routes with the IGP system.

Use the no option to disable IGP synchronization.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 371


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode

— BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

— BGP Address family IPv4 configuration submode — (config-router-af-


ip)

— BGP Address family IPv4 labeled-unicast configuration submode —


(config-router-af-ip-labeled-ucast)

— BGP Address family IPv4 VRF configuration submode — (config-router-


af-vrf)

Examples
Enabling IGP synchronization of iBGP routes:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#synchronization

33.69 timers bgp

Synopsis

— [no] timers bgp <KEEPALIVE> <HOLDTIME>

— no timers bgp

Description
Use this command to globally set the keep alive and hold time values for all the
neighbors.

Use the no options to reset the timers to default value.

Command Mode
BGP Router configuration submode — (config-router-bgp)

Operands

KEEPALIVE The frequency with which the keep alive messages are
sent to the neighbors. The valid range is 0–65535. The
default keep alive value is 30 seconds.

HOLDTIME The interval after which the neighbor is considered dead


if keep alive messages are not received. The valid range is
0–65535. The default hold time value is 90 seconds.

372 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


BGP Commands

Examples
Setting the keep alive and hold time values:
ML66(config-router-bgp)#timers bgp 40 120

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 373


CLI Descriptions

34 MPLS Basic Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
34.

The following command mode is applicable for the MPLS basic commands:

— Exec mode — >

Table 34 MPLS Basic Commands Overview


ping mpls initiate the sending of echo request
packets in a specified MPLS protocol
traceroute mpls initiate tracing the route traversed by
a specified echo request packet in an
MPLS protocol

34.1 ping mpls

Synopsis
ping mpls ldp <IPADDR/PREFIX> [reply-mode {1 | 2} | validate-fec |
destination <DEST> | source <SOURCE> | ttl <TTL> | timeout <TIMEOUT> |
repeat <REPEAT> | interval <INTERVAL> | force-explicit-null | detail |
pad <PADDING> | reply-pad {1 | 2} | size <SIZE>]

Description
Use this command to initiate the sending of echo request packets in a specified
MPLS protocol.

The related commands are the following:

— ping

— show mpls ldp

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IPADDR/PREFIX The LDP FEC prefix address, where the format is


<A.B.C.D/P>.

374 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


MPLS Basic Commands

DEST The destination IP address, where the format is


<A.B.C.D>. This must be from the range 127/8 excluding
the default local loopback address.

SOURCE The source IP address, where the format is <A.B.C.D>.


The default setting is the router ID.

TTL The Time to Live (TTL) value, which specifies the reply
ping packet TTL value in seconds. The valid range is 1–
225 s. The default value is 225 s.

TIMEOUT The reply time to wait in seconds before rejecting the sent
probe as a failure. The valid range is 1–500 s. The default
value is 60 s.

REPEAT Specifies the number of ping packets to be sent. The valid


range is 5–5000. The default value is 5.

INTERVAL The interval in milliseconds between MPLS ping packets.


The valid range is 2–20000 ms. The default value is 2 ms.

PADDING Specifies the padding pattern in a 4-byte hexadecimal


format.

SIZE Packet size. The valid range is 48–500.

Options

ldp Specifies the FEC type as LDP.

reply-mode Specifies the reply modes defined in RFC.

1 – Specifies not to request reply.

2 – Specifies the reply with IP UDP packet. This is the


default setting.

validate-fec Specifies that the received LSR must do an FEC stack


validation. The default setting is disabled.

destination Specifies the destination IPv4 address field in the UPD


ping packet.

source Specifies the reply source IPv4 address field in the UPD
packet.

ttl Specifies the reply ping packet TTL value in seconds.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 375


CLI Descriptions

timeout Specifies the reply time to wait in seconds before


rejecting the sent probe as a failure.

repeat Specifies the number of ping packets to be sent.

interval Specifies the interval in milliseconds between MPLS ping


packets.

force-explicit-null
Forces Explicit Null label.

detail Specifies to print the detailed output of the ping


command.

pad Specifies the padding pattern.

reply-pad Specifies the handling of pad TLV in reply.

1 — Drop Pad TLV from reply.

2 — Copy Pad TLV to reply.

size Specifies the packet size.

Examples
ML66#ping mpls ldp 10.10.0.0/24 detail

ML66#ping mpls ldp 10.10.0.0/24 reply-mode 2 validate-fec destination 127.1.2.3 so →


urce
10.10.0.1 ttl 226 timeout 65 repeat 6 interval 3 detail force-explicit-null

34.2 traceroute mpls

Synopsis
traceroute mpls ldp <IPADDR/PREFIX> [reply-mode {1 | 2} | validate-fec
| destination <DEST> | source <SOURCE> | ttl <TTL> | timeout <TIMEOUT>
| force-explicit-null | detail]

Description
Use this command to initiate tracing the route traversed by a specified echo
request packet in an MPLS protocol.

The related commands are the following:

— traceroute

376 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


MPLS Basic Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IPADDR/PREFIX The LDP FEC prefix address, where the format is


<A.B.C.D/P> .

DEST The destination IP address, where the format is


<A.B.C.D> . This must be from the range 127/8 excluding
the default local loopback address.

SOURCE The source IP address, where the format is <A.B.C.D> .


The default setting is the router ID.

TTL The Time to Live (TTL) value, which specifies the reply
ping packet TTL value in seconds. The valid range is 1–
225 s. The default value is 225 s.

TIMEOUT The reply time to wait in seconds before rejecting the sent
probe as a failure. The valid range is 1–500 s. The default
value is 60 s.

Options

ldp Specifies the FEC type as LDP.

reply-mode Specifies the reply modes defined in RFC.

1 – Requests no reply with IP UDP packet.

2 – Specifies the reply with IP UDP packet. This is the


default setting.

validate-fec Specifies that the received LSR must do an FEC stack


validation. The default setting is disabled.

destination Specifies the destination IPv4 address field in the UPD


ping packet.

source Specifies the reply source IPv4 address field in the UPD
packet.

ttl Specifies the reply ping packet TTL value in seconds.

timeout Specifies the reply time to wait in seconds before


rejecting the sent probe as a failure.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 377


CLI Descriptions

force-explicit-null
Force Explicit Null label.

detail Specifies to print the detailed output of the ping


command.

Examples
ML66#traceroute mpls ldp 10.10.0.0/24 reply-mode 2 validate-fec destination 127.1. →
2.3 source
10.10.0.1 ttl 226 timeout 65 detail force-explicit-null

378 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


MPLS Configuration Commands

35 MPLS Configuration Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
35.

The following command mode is applicable for the Multiprotocol Label Switching
(MPLS) configuration commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— IS-IS Router configuration submode — (config-router-isis)

Table 35 MPLS Configuration Commands Overview


mpls ac-group create a new access circuit group for
MPLS
mpls admin-groups create a name-to-value binding for an
administrative group
mpls bfd configure a BFD session for MPLS
mpls disable-all-interfaces disable all interfaces for MPLS
mpls egress-ttl set a custom Time to Live (TTL) value
for LSPs for which this LSR is the
egressThe related configuration
commands are the following:
mpls enable-all-interfaces enable all interfaces for MPLS
mpls ftn-entry create FTN entries in the FTN table of
the MPLS forwarder
mpls ilm-entry pop create an Incoming Label Map (ILM)
entry in the ILM table to which a pop
incoming interface is bound
mpls ilm-entry swap The related configuration
commandscreate an ILM entry in the
ILM table to which a swap incoming
interface is bound
mpls ilm-entry vpnpop create an ILM entry in the ILM table
for vpnpop operation
mpls ingress-ttl set an enable TTL propagation value
for LSPs for which this LSR is the
ingress
mpls label mode configure per Virtual Routing and
Forwarding (VRF) labels
mpls label-range

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 379


CLI Descriptions

mpls map-route map a prefix to a Forwarding


Equivalence Class (FEC)
mpls propagate-ttl enable TTL propagation
mpls traffic-eng configure MPLS Traffic Engineering
feature for IS-IS
configure non-overlapping dynamic
and/or static label ranges for use
during MPLS VPN route forwarding

— capability

The related show commands are the following:

— show bgp label mode globals

— show mpls

— show mpls cross-connect-table

— show mpls forwarding-table

— show mpls ftn-table

— show mpls ilm-table

— show mpls in-segment-table

— show mpls interface

— show mpls ldp

— show mpls mapped-routes

— show mpls out-segment-table

— show mpls vc-table

— show mpls vrf-table

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

35.1 mpls ac-group

380 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


MPLS Configuration Commands

Synopsis

— mpls ac-group <NAME> <ID>

— no mpls ac-group <NAME>

Description
Use this command to create a new access circuit group for MPLS.

Use the no option to remove an access circuit group.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

NAME The name of the access circuit group.

ID The identifier of the group, which is used in LDP. The valid


range is 1–4294967295.

Examples
Creating a new access circuit group for MPLS:
ML66(config)#mpls ac-group new-ac 123

35.2 mpls admin-groups

Synopsis
[no] mpls admin-group <NAME> <VALUE>

Description
Use this command to create a name-to-value binding for an administrative
group.

Note: Only 32 administrative groups can be configured at one time.

Use the no parameter with this command to remove the specified administrative
group.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 381


CLI Descriptions

Operands

NAME The name of the administrative group.

VALUE The value of the administrative group. The valid range is


0–31.

Examples

ML66(config)#mpls admin-group sample 1

35.3 mpls bfd

Synopsis

— mpls bfd rsvp [tunnel name <NAME> | all] {lsp-ping-intv


<INTERVAL> l min-tx <TX> | min-rx <RX> | multiplier <MULTIPLIER> |
force-explicit-null | disable}

— no mpls bfd rsvp [tunnel-name <NAME> | all] {disable}

— no mpls bfd rsvp [tunnel-name <NAME> | all] {lsp-ping-intvl


<INTERVAL> | min-tx <TX> | min-rx <RX> | multiplier <MULTIPLIER> |
force-explicit-null}

Description
Use this command to configure a BFD session for RSVP MPLS paths.

Use the no parameter with this command to remove a configuration.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

NAME The name of the RSVP tunnel.

INTERVAL The LSP ping interval in seconds. The valid range is 1–


4294967 s. The default value is 5 s.

RX The minimum reception interval in milliseconds. The valid


range is 50–4294967 ms. The default value is 50 ms.

TX The minimum transmit interval in milliseconds. The valid


range is 50–4294967 ms. The default value is 50 ms.

382 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


MPLS Configuration Commands

MULTIPLIER The detection multiplier value. The valid range is 1–255.


The default value is 5.

Options

rsvp Configures a BFD session for RSVP.

tunnel-name Specifies an RSVP tunnel name.

all Specifies all RSVP switched paths.

lsp-ping-intvl Sets an LSP ping interval.

min-tx Sets the minimum transmit interval.

min-rx Sets the minimum reception interval.

multiplier Sets the BFD detection multiplier.

force-explicit-null
Forces the Explicit NULL label.

disable Disables BFD for the LSP.

Examples
Configuring a BFD session specifying all RSVP switched paths forcing Explicit
Null labels:
ML66(config)#mpls bfd rsvp all force-explicit-null

35.4 mpls disable-all-interfaces

Synopsis
mpls disable-all-interfaces

Description
Use this command to disable all interfaces for MPLS. This command completely
stops all signaling on the router.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 383


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Disabling all interfaces for MPLS:
ML66(config)#mpls disable-all-interfaces

35.5 mpls egress-ttl

Synopsis

— mpls egress-ttl <TTL>

— no mpls egress-ttl

Description
Use this command to set a custom Time to Live (TTL) value for LSPs for which
this LSR is the egress.

Use the no option to remove a custom TTL value.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

TTL The TTL value. The valid range is 0–255.

Examples
Setting a TTL value:
ML66(config)#mpls egress-ttl 45

35.6 mpls enable-all-interfaces

Synopsis
mpls enable-all-interfaces

Description
Use this command to enable all interfaces for MPLS. This command enables all
interfaces on a router for label switching.

384 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


MPLS Configuration Commands

Note: Executing this command does not enable any signaling protocol
interaction through all the interfaces. Each protocol needs to be
explicitly enabled per interface.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Enabling all interfaces for MPLS:
ML66(config)#mpls enable-all-interfaces

35.7 mpls ftn-entry

Synopsis

— [no] mpls ftn-entry <IPADDR/PREFIX> <IPADDR>


<IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> [<STACK_LABEL> | 0 | 3]

— [no] mpls ftn-entry tunnel-id <TUNNEL_ID> <IPADDR/PREFIX>


<LABEL> <IPADDR> <IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> [<FTN> ] [primary |
secondary]

Description
Use this command to create FTN entries in the FTN table of the MPLS forwarder.
For all incoming IP packets on an MPLS-enabled router, a best-match lookup is
done in the FTN table based on the destination address of the incoming IP
packet. If a match is found, the packet is labeled, and switched. All interfaces are
disabled by default.

Use the no option to remove the entry.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

IPADDR/PREFIX The forwarding equivalence class with prefix length,


where the format is <A.B.C.D/P> .

IPADDR The nexthop IPv4 address, where the format is


<A.B.C.D> .

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 385


CLI Descriptions

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN
The name of the outgoing interface name, where the
format is <Rack/Slot/Port.VLAN> .

STACK_LABEL Stack of outgoing labels. The valid range is 16–1048575.

LABEL The outgoing label. The valid range is 16–1048575.

TUNNEL_ID The tunnel ID value. The valid range is 1–100.

FTN The FTN index for updating an existing entry. The valid
range is 1–4294967295.

Options

0 Sets the outgoing label to IPv4 Explicit Null label (0).

3 Sets the outgoing label to Implicit Null label (3).

tunnel-id Sets a tunnel identifier.

primary Sets the primary LSP.

secondary Sets the secondary LSP.

Examples
Creating FTN entries in the FTN table of the MPLS forwarder:
ML66(config)#mpls ftn-entry 2 10.10.0.0/24 16 1.2.3.4 1/9/4.500 secondary

35.8 mpls ilm-entry pop

Synopsis

— mpls ilm-entry <LABEL> <IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> pop


[<IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> <IPADDR> <IPADDR/PREFIX> [<ILM> ] ]

— no mpls ilm-entry <LABEL> <IFNAME_RSP_VLAN>

Description
Use this command to create an Incoming Label Map (ILM) entry in the ILM table
to which a pop incoming interface is bound. Upon receipt of a labeled packet on
an MPLS-enabled router, a lookup is done based on the incoming label in the ILM
table. If a match is found, the packet is popped and passed over IP or next label.
In a pop operation, an outgoing label is not needed as is either accepted or

386 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


MPLS Configuration Commands

forwarded over IP. The nexthop option is also not mandatory because the
Forwarding Equivalence Class (FEC) IP address could be a local IP address.

Use the no option to remove an ILM entry. If there is no match, an error message
is displayed.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

LABEL The incoming label value.

IFNAME_RSP_sVLAN
The incoming interface name, where the format is <Rack/
Slot/Port.VLAN> .

IPADDR The nexthop IPv4 address, where the format is


<A.B.C.D> .

IPADDR/PREFIX The FEC for which this ILM entry is being created with
prefix length, where the format is <A.B.C.D/P> .

ILM The ILM index for updating an existing entry. The valid
range is 1–4294967295.

Options

pop Pops the incoming label.

Examples
Creating an ILM entry in the ILM table to which a pop incoming interface is
bound:
ML66(config)#mpls ilm-entry 100 1/9/4.500 pop

35.9 mpls ilm-entry swap

Synopsis

— mpls ilm-entry <LABEL> <IFNAME_RSP_VLAN_IN> swap {0 | 3 |


<OUT_LABEL>} <IFNAME_RSP_VLAN_OUT> <IPADDR> <IPADDR/
PREFIX> [<ILM>]

— no mpls ilm-entry <LABEL> <IFNAME_RSP_VLAN_IN>

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 387


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to create an Incoming Label Map (ILM) entry in the ILM table
to which a swap incoming interface is bound. Upon receipt of a labeled packet on
an MPLS-enabled router, a lookup is done based on the incoming label in the ILM
table. If a match is found, the packet is swapped and label-switched
downstream.

Use the no option to remove an ILM entry. If there is no match, an error message
is displayed.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

LABEL The incoming label value.

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN_IN
The incoming interface name, where the format is <Rack/
Slot/Port.VLAN>.

OUT_LABEL The outgoing label value. The valid range is 16–


1048575.

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN_OUT
The outgoing interface name, where the format is <Rack/
Slot/Port.VLAN>.

IPADDR The nexthop IPv4 address, where the format is


<A.B.C.D>.

IPADDR/PREFIX The Forwarding Equivalence Class (FEC) for which this


ILM entry is being created with prefix length, where the
format is <A.B.C.D/P>.

ILM The ILM index for updating an existing entry. The valid
range is 1–4294967295.

Options

swap Sets swap for the incoming label.

0 Sets the outgoing label to IPv4 Explicit Null label (0).

3 Sets the outgoing label to Implicit Null label (3).

388 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


MPLS Configuration Commands

Examples
Creating an ILM entry in the ILM table to which a swap incoming interface is
bound:
ML66(config)#mpls ilm-entry 100 1/9/4.500 swap 0 1/9/4.501 1.2.3.4 10.10.0.0/24 1

35.10 mpls ilm-entry vpnpop

Synopsis

— mpls ilm-entry <LABEL> <IFNAME_RSP_VLAN_IN> vpnpop


<IFNAME_RSP_VLAN_OUT> <IPADDR> <IPADDR/PREFIX> [<ILM>]

— no mpls ilm-entry <LABEL> <IFNAME_RSP_VLAN_IN>

Description
Use this command to create an Incoming Label Map (ILM) entry in the ILM table
for vpnpop operation. Upon receipt of a labeled packet on an MPLS-enabled
router, a lookup is done based on the incoming label in the ILM table. If a match
is found and operation is vpnpop, the packet is delivered to local VRF.

Use the no option to remove an ILM entry. If there is no match, an error message
is displayed.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

LABEL The incoming label value.

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN_IN
The incoming interface name, where the format is <Rack/
Slot/Port.VLAN>.

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN_OUT
The outgoing interface name, where the format is <Rack/
Slot/Port.VLAN>.

IPADDR The nexthop IPv4 address, where the format is


<A.B.C.D>.

IPADDR/PREFIX The Forwarding Equivalence Class (FEC) for which this


ILM entry is being created with prefix length, where the
format is <A.B.C.D/P>.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 389


CLI Descriptions

ILM The ILM index for updating an existing entry. The valid
range is 1–4294967295.

Options

vpnpop Pops the incoming label and forward the VPN packet.

Examples
Creating an ILM entry in the ILM table for vpnpop operation:
ML66(config)#mpls ilm-entry 100 1/9/4.500 vpnpop 1/9/4.501 1.2.3.4 10.10.0.0/24 1

35.11 mpls ingress-ttl

Synopsis

— mpls ingress-ttl <TTL>

— no mpls ingress-ttl

Description
Use this command to set a Time to Live (TTL) value for LSPs for which this LSR is
the ingress.

Use the no option to remove the configuration.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

TTL The TTL value. The valid range is 0–255.

Examples
Setting a TTL value for LSPs for which this LSR is the ingress:
ML66(config)#mpls ingress-ttl 5

390 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


MPLS Configuration Commands

35.12 mpls label mode

Synopsis
[no] mpls label mode {vrf <VRF> | all-vrfs} protocol bgp vpnv4 {per-
prefix | per-vrf}

Description
Use this command to configure per Virtual Routing and Forwarding (VRF) labels.

The label mode can be configured at two levels: at a global level or at a VRF
level. The configuration at the global level affects all VRFs except those that are
configured at the VRF level. To apply the global level configuration to a specific
VRF, the configuration at the VRF level must be removed. The per-prefix label
mode is the default mode.

Use the no parameter with this command to reset the configuration to the default
mode.

The related commands are the following:

— show bgp label mode globals

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

VRF The name of the VRF instance.

Options

vrf Specifies to configure a single VPN VRF domain.

all-vrfs Specifies to configure a label mode for all VRFs on the


router.

bgp-vpnv4 Specifies to apply the configuration to BGP VPNv4.

per-prefix Specifies the per-prefix label mode.

per-vrf Specifies the per-vrf label mode.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 391


CLI Descriptions

Examples
ML66#mpls label mode vrf vrf_1 protocol bgp-vpnv4 per-vrf

35.13 mpls label-range

Synopsis

— mpls label-range <DYNAMIC_LABEL_LOW> <DYNAMIC_LABEL_UP>

— no mpls label-range

Description
Use this command to configure non-overlapping dynamic label ranges for use
during MPLS VPN route forwarding. These labels are assigned dynamically
(dynamic range) on request by a protocol (BGP/LDP/OSPF-SR).

Use the no option to reset the label range to 16000–1048575.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

DYNAMIC_LABEL_LOW
The dynamic label range lower bound. The valid range is
16000–1048575.

DYNAMIC_LABEL_UP
The dynamic label range upper bound. The valid range is
16000–1048575.

Examples
Configuring non-overlapping dynamic range for use during MPLS VPN route
forwarding:
ML66(config)#mpls label-range 16020 16030

35.14 mpls map-route

Synopsis
[no] mpls map-route <FEC/PREFIX> <IPADDR/PREFIX>

392 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


MPLS Configuration Commands

Description
Use this command to map a prefix to a Forwarding Equivalence Class (FEC).

Use the no option to disable the configuration.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

FEC/PREFIX The IPv4 forwarding equivalence class with prefix length


for route to map, where the format is <A.B.C.D/P> .

IPADDR/PREFIX The IPv4 address with prefix length to map, where the
format is <A.B.C.D/P> .

Examples
Mapping 1.2.3.4 prefix to 5.6.7.8/32 FEC:
ML66(config)#mpls map-route 1.2.3.4/32 5.6.7.8/32

35.15 mpls propagate-ttl

Synopsis
[no] mpls propagate-ttl

Description
Use this command to enable Time to Live (TTL) propagation. Enabling TTL
propagation causes the TTL value in the IP header to be copied onto the TTL
field in the shim header, at the LSP ingress. By default, TTL propagation is
enabled.

Use the no to disable TTL propagation.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Enabling TTL propagation:
ML66(config)#mpls propagate-ttl

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 393


CLI Descriptions

35.16 mpls traffic-eng

Synopsis

— [no] mpls traffic-eng level-1

— mpls traffic-eng router-id <IPADDR>

— no mpls traffic-eng router-id

Description
Use this command to configure the MPLS Traffic Engineering feature for
Intermediate System–Intermediate System (IS-IS).

When mpls traffic-eng is enabled, CSPF will be enable automatically.

Note: Currently, CSPF is based on the Dijkstra algorithm, and the link metrics
are of higher priority during the calculation. As a result, the calculation
could fail if the result path is excluded by link affinities or explicit paths.
In field deployment with link affinities and explicit paths, the
downstream path is recommended.

By default, if this command is not used, traffic engineering TLVs and Sub-TLVs do
not get encoded by IS-IS.

Use the no parameter to turn off the feature.

Command Mode
IS-IS Router configuration submode — (config-router-isis)

Operands

IPADDR The IS-IS router-ID in IPv4 address format.

Options

level-1 Specifies the level-1 MPLS Traffic Engineering feature.

router-id Speficies a Traffic Engineering stable IP address for the


system.

Examples
ML66(config-router-isis)#mpls traffic-eng router-id 2.2.2.2

394 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


MPLS Interface Commands

36 MPLS Interface Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
36.

The following command mode is applicable for the Multiprotocol Label Switching
(MPLS) interface command:

— Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Table 36 MPLS Interface Commands Overview


label-switching enable label switching on an interface

The related show commands are the following:

— show mpls

— show mpls cross-connect-table

— show mpls forwarding-table

— show mpls ftn-table

— show mpls ilm-table

— show mpls in-segment-table

— show mpls interface

— show mpls ldp

— show mpls mapped-routes

— show mpls out-segment-table

— show mpls vc-table

— show mpls vrf-table

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

36.1 label-switching

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 395


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
[no] label-switching

Description
Use this command to enable label switching on an interface.

Use the no option to disable label switching on an interface.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Examples
Enabling label switching:
ML66(config-router-if)#label-switching

396 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


RSVP-TE Commands

37 RSVP-TE Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
37.

The following command modes are applicable for the Intermediate Resource
Reservation Protocol - Traffic Engineering (RSVP-TE) commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Exec mode — >

— Privileged Exec mode — #

— RSVP-TE Router configuration submode — (config-router-rsvp)

— RSVP-TE Trunk submode — (config-rsvp-trunk-ip)

— RSVP-TE Path submode — (config-rsvp-path)

Table 37 RSVP-TE Commands Overview


<IPADDR> define an explicit IPv4 route sub-
object as either loose or strict
ack-wait-timeout configure the acknowledgement wait
timeout for all RSVP-TE neighbors
clear rsvp session reset either all or specified sessions
originating from a specific ingress and
terminating on a specific egress
clear rsvp statistics reset all RSVP statistics counters to
zero
clear rsvp trunk clear a specific RSVP trunk or all
trunks
detour-identification set a detour Label Switched Path
(LSP) identification method
dscp set the RSVP-TE DSCP value
explicit-null send Explicit Null labels to directly-
connected FECs instead of Implicit
Null labels
ext-tunnel-id configure an extended tunnel
identifier used in RSVP messages
from <IPADDR> identify the source address of IPv4
packets sent out by the RSVP daemon

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 397


CLI Descriptions

hello-interval set the time interval between


successive Hello packets
hello-timeout set how long an RSVP node waits for
a Hello message before declaring a
neighbor to be down
keep-multiplier configure the constant to be used to
calculate a valid reservation lifetime
for a Labeled Switched Path (LSP)
loop-detection turn on loop detection for Path and
Reservation messages exchanged
between Label Switched Routers
(LSRs)
map-route map routes to a given RSVP trunk
mpls traffic-eng reoptimize trigger the LSP reoptimization
manually
php enable Penultimate-Hop-Popping for
the router
primary affinity enable the sending out of session-
attribute objects with resource-affinity
data
primary exclude-any specify the Administrative Groups that
are excluded from an LSP
configuration
primary fast-reroute exclude-any specify the Administrative Groups that
are excluded from a Fast Reroute
(FRR) backup LSP configuration
primary fast-reroute hop-limit set the hop limit for an FRR detour
LSP
primary fast-reroute include-any include any of the Administrative
Groups in an FRR backup LSP
primary fast-reroute protection one- create an FRR backup and set an LSP
to-one one-to-one protection mechanism
primary hop-limit specify a limit of hops for an RSVP
trunk
primary include-any include any of the Administrative
Groups in an LSP
primary label-record record all labels exchanged between
RSVP-enabled routers during the
reservation setup process
primary path specify an RSVP path to be used
primary record enable or disable the recording of the
route taken by Path and Reservation
Request (Resv) messages to confirm

398 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


RSVP-TE Commands

the establishment of reservations and


identify errors
refresh-path-parsing disable the parsing of Refresh PATH
messages received from upstream
nodes
refresh-resv-parsing disable the parsing of Refresh RESV
messages received from upstream
nodes
refresh-time configure the RSVP refresh interval
timer
reoptimize-lockdown disable the reoptimization for a
specific RSVP-TE trunk, while the
global LSP reoptimization is enabled
reoptimize timers frequency set the frequency of reoptimize timers
router rsvp enter RSVP-TE Router configuration
submode from Global Configuration
mode, and enable the RSVP daemon
rsvp-path create a new RSVP path, or enter
RSVP-TE Path submode
rsvp-trunk create a new RSVP trunk, or enter the
RSVP-TE Trunk submode to perform
maintenance on a specific trunk
rsvp-trunk-restart restart an RSVP trunk
select-preference configure a selected preference for an
RSVP trunk
to <IPADDR> specify an IPv4 egress for an LSP

The related show commands are the following:

— show rsvp

— show rsvp admin-groups

— show rsvp interface

— show rsvp neighbor

— show rsvp nexthop-cache

— show rsvp path

— show rsvp session

— show rsvp session count

— show rsvp session egress

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 399


CLI Descriptions

— show rsvp session ingress

— show rsvp session <LSP-NAME>

— show rsvp session transit

— show rsvp statistics

— show rsvp summary-refresh

— show rsvp trunk

— show rsvp version

— show running-config router

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

37.1 <IPADDR>

Synopsis
[no] <IPADDR> {loose | strict}

Description
Use this command to define an explicit IPv4 route sub-object as either loose or
strict. A list of sub-objects specifies an explicit route to the egress router for a
Label Switched Path (LSP).

For the strict type of route addresses, the route taken from the previous router to
the current router must be a directly connected path and a message exchanged
between the two routers should not pass any intermediate routers. This ensures
that routing is enforced on the basis of each link.

For the loose type of route addresses, the route taken from the previous router to
the current router does not need to be a direct path and a message exchanged
between the two routers can pass other routers.

A.B.C.D is the TE router ID or the incoming/outgoing interface address of the


router in the explicit route, and it indicates the router itself instead of the router
interface.

Note: If A.B.C.D is the incoming/outgoing interface address of the router, the


router should have Intermediate System–Intermediate System (IS-IS)
adjacency on that link.

Use the no parameter with this command to disable the configuration.

400 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


RSVP-TE Commands

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Path submode — (config-rsvp-path)

Options

loose Specifies the node as loose.

strict Specifies the node as strict.

Examples
ML66(config-rsvp-path)#1.2.3.4 strict

37.2 ack-wait-timeout

Synopsis
[no] ack-wait-timeout <TIMEOUT>

Description
Use this command to configure the acknowledgement wait timeout for all RSVP-
TE neighbors.

Use the no parameter with this command to revert to the default


acknowledgement wait timeout.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Router configuration submode — (config-router-rsvp)

Operands

TIMEOUT The acknowledgement wait timeout in seconds. The valid


range is 1–65535 s. The default value is 10 s.

Examples
ML66(config-router-rsvp)#ack-wait-timeout 65535

37.3 clear rsvp session

Synopsis
clear rsvp session *

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 401


CLI Descriptions

clear rsvp session <TUNNEL-ID> <LSP-ID> <IPADDR_IN>


<IPADDR2_OUT>

Description
Use this command to reset either all or specified sessions originating from a
specific ingress and terminating on a specific egress.

Note: If an affected session originates from the router where the command is
issued, the session is stopped and started. If the affected session does
not originate from the router where the command is issued, the session
is stopped and deleted.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

TUNNEL-ID The tunnel ID for the session. The valid range is 1–


65535.

LSP-ID The LSP ID for the session. The valid range is 1–65535.

IPADDR_IN The ingress IPv4 address for the session, where the
format is <A.B.C.D>.

IPADDR_OUT The egress IPv4 address for the session, where the
format is <A.B.C.D>.

Options

* Specifies to clear all RSVP sessions.

Examples
ML66#clear rsvp session 1 1 1.2.3.4 192.168.1.1

37.4 clear rsvp statistics

Synopsis
clear rsvp statistics

Description
Use this command to reset all RSVP statistics counters to zero. This command
sets the path receipt and sent counters to zero. Once this command is executed,

402 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


RSVP-TE Commands

all counters read zero, and if a new message is sent or received, it shows up in the
statistics.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
ML66#clear rsvp statistics

37.5 clear rsvp trunk

Synopsis

— clear rsvp trunk *

— clear rsvp trunk {<TRUNKNAME> | *} primary

— clear rsvp trunk ingress {<TRUNKNAME> | *}

— clear rsvp trunk non-ingress {<TRUNKNAME> | *}

Description
Use this command to clear a specific RSVP trunk or all trunks. Keep in mind that
while clearing a trunk, this command also kills any session associated with the
trunk. This command is useful when a created trunk is missing certain required
data. The trunk is in an incomplete state at this point, and clearing the trunk
correctly re-initializes the session.

Note: If the affected session on the Ingress router is where the command is
issued, the session is stopped and started. If the affected session on the
Egress router is where the command is issued, the session is not cleared.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

TRUNKNAME The name of a trunk.

Options

* Specifies all RSVP trunks.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 403


CLI Descriptions

ingress Specifies an RSVP ingress trunk.

non-ingress Specifies an RSVP non-ingress trunk.

primary Resets the primary sessions of the specified trunk or of all


trunks.

Examples
ML66#clear rsvp trunk trunk1 primary

37.6 detour-identification

Synopsis
[no] detour-identification {path | sender-template}

Description
Use this command to set a detour Label Switched Path (LSP) identification
method.

Use the no parameter with this command to unset the detour LSP identification
method.

Note: This command can be used to configure the backup LSP identification
method only for one-to-one protection.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Router configuration submode — (config-router-rsvp)

Options

path Specifies a path-specific detour identification method


(using a detour object).

sender-template
Specifies a sender-template-specific detour identification
method.

Examples
ML66(config-router-rsvp)#detour-identification path

404 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


RSVP-TE Commands

37.7 dscp

Synopsis

— dscp <DSCP>

— no dscp

Description
Use this command to set the RSVP-TE DSCP value.

Use the no option to reset to the default value.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Router configuration submode — (config-router-rsvp)

Operands

DSCP The DSCP value. The valid range is 0-63. The default
value is 48.

Examples
Setting the RSVP-TE DSCP value to 16::
ML66(config-router-rsvp)#dscp 16

37.8 explicit-null

Synopsis
[no] explicit-null

Description
Use this command to send Explicit Null labels to directly-connected FECs instead
of Implicit Null labels.

This command controls the label value advertised on the Egress router of an LSP.
By default, the Implicit Null label (label 3) is advertised to directly-connected
FECs. If the Implicit Null label is advertised, the penultimate hop removes the
label and sends the packet as a plain IP packet to the Egress router. The Explicit
Null command advertises the label 0 and retains the label so the Egress router
can pop it. For details on Explicit Null, refer to RFC 3032.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 405


CLI Descriptions

Use the no parameter to stop sending Explicit Null labels to directly connected
FECs and resume sending Implicit Null labels to them.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Router configuration submode — (config-router-rsvp)

Examples
ML66(config-router-rsvp)#explicit-null

37.9 ext-tunnel-id

Synopsis

— ext-tunnel-id <IPADDR>

— no ext-tunnel-id

Description
Use this command to configure an extended tunnel identifier used in RSVP
messages. If no extended tunnel ID is specified, the LSR-ID for the router is used
as the extended tunnel ID for all LSPs. The extended tunnel ID is a simple way of
identifying all LSPs belonging to the same trunk.

Use the no form of this command to unset the pre-configured extended tunnel ID.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Trunk submode — (config-rsvp-trunk-ip)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 representation of the extended tunnel ID.

Examples
ML66(config-rsvp-trunk-ip)#ext-tunnel-id 10.10.10.30

37.10 from <IPADDR>

406 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


RSVP-TE Commands

Synopsis

— from <IPADDR>

— no from [<IPADDR> ]

Description
Use this command to identify the source address of IPv4 packets sent out by the
RSVP daemon. In addition, the sender’s IPv4 address can also be specified in the
sender template object in Path messages.

This command can be used either in RSVP-TE Router configuration submode or


in RSVP-TE Trunk submode. In RSVP-TE Router configuration submode, this
command specifies the source address of IPv4 packets sent out by the RSVP
daemon. In RSVP-TE Trunk submode, this command specifies the sender address
in the sender template object used in Path messages.

Use the no parameter to revert to the default settings.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Router configuration submode — (config-router-rsvp) and RSVP-
TE Trunk submode — (config-rsvp-trunk-ip)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of tunnel ingress.

Examples
ML66(config-rsvp-trunk-ip)#from 10.10.10.30
ML66(config-router-rsvp)#from 10.10.10.30

37.11 hello-interval

Synopsis

— hello-interval <INTERVAL>

— no hello-interval

Description
Use this command to set the time interval between successive Hello packets.

Used as a global command, this value is overridden by the hello interval set on
the interface (see rsvp hello-interval ). For optimum performance, set this
value to no more than one-third of the hello timeout value.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 407


CLI Descriptions

Use the no parameter to revert to the default hello interval value.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Router configuration submode — (config-router-rsvp)

Operands

INTERVAL The time in seconds after which Hello packets are to be


sent. The valid range is 1–65535 s. The default value is 2
s.

Examples
ML66(config-router-rsvp)#hello-interval 10

37.12 hello-timeout

Synopsis

— hello-timeout <TIMEOUT>

— no hello-timeout

Description
Use this command to set how long an RSVP node waits for a Hello message
before declaring a neighbor to be down. If a Labeled Switched Router (LSR) has
not received a Hello message from a peer within the time period specified by this
command, all sessions shared with this are reset.

Use the no parameter to revert to the default hello timeout value.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Router configuration submode — (config-router-rsvp)

Operands

TIMEOUT The time period an RSVP node waits to receive a Hello


message, specified in seconds. The valid range is 1–
65535 s. The default value is 10 s.

Examples
ML66(config-router-rsvp)#hello-timeout 20

408 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


RSVP-TE Commands

37.13 keep-multiplier

Synopsis

— keep-multiplier <MULTIPLIER>

— no keep-multiplier [<MULTIPLIER> ]

Description
Use this command to configure the constant to be used to calculate a valid
reservation lifetime for an LSP.

The refresh time and keep multiplier are two interrelated timing parameters used
to calculate the valid reservation lifetime for an LSP. Use the following formula to
calculate the reservation lifetime for an LSP:

L ≥ (K + 0.5) * 1.5 * R K = keep multiplier


R = refresh timer

Refresh messages are sent periodically by the router so that the neighbors do not
timeout.

Use the no parameter to reset to the keep multiplier to the default setting.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Router configuration submode — (config-router-rsvp)

Operands

MULTIPLIER The keep multiplier value. The valid range is 1–255. The
default value is 3.

Examples
ML66(config-router-rsvp)#keep-multiplier 10

37.14 loop-detection

Synopsis
[no] loop-detection

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 409


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to turn on loop detection for Path and Reservation messages
exchanged between LSRs. When a Path or Reservation message is received, the
primary IP address of the incoming interface is compared with the received route
record list.

By default, loop detection for Path and Reservation messages is disabled.

Use the no parameter with this command to revert to the default settings.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Router configuration submode — (config-router-rsvp)

Examples
ML66(config-router-rsvp)#loop-detection

37.15 map-route

Synopsis
[no] map-route <IPADDR/PREFIX>

Description
Use this command to map routes to a given RSVP trunk. If the primary LSP for a
trunk is not available, all the mapped routes automatically use a secondary LSP
configured as backup for the primary LSP.

Use the no parameter with this command to unmap routes from specified trunks.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Trunk submode — (config-rsvp-trunk-ip)

Operands

IPADDR/PREFIX The IPv4 address to be mapped, with prefix length,


where the format is <A.B.C.D/P>.

Examples
ML66(config-rsvp-trunk-ip)#map-route 2.2.2.2/16

410 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


RSVP-TE Commands

37.16 mpls traffic-eng reoptimize

Synopsis
mpls traffic-eng reoptimize {all | <TRUNKNAME>}

Description
Use this command to trigger the LSP reoptimization manually.

This command starts the reoptimization immediately. Enter all or


<TRUNKNAME> to reoptimize all RSVP-TE trunks or a specific one.

Note: Use the reoptimize timers frequency command to set up intervals


of automatic reoptimization, which is enabled by default.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Operands

TRUNKNAME The name of a trunk.

Examples
Triggering the reoptimization of all RSVP-TE trunks:
ML66(config)#mpls traffic-eng reoptimize all

Triggering the reoptimization of a specific RSVP-TE trunk:


ML66(config)#mpls traffic-eng reoptimize trunk1

37.17 php

Synopsis
[no] php

Description
Use this command to enable Penultimate-Hop-Popping for the router.

An egress router sends either the Implicit Null or the Explicit Null label for LSPs.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 411


CLI Descriptions

Note: Use the show rsvp command to display the status of Penultimate-Hop-
Popping.

By default, Penultimate-Hop-Popping is enabled.

Use the no php command to disable this setting. If the no php command has
been used, the egress router sends non-reserved labels (labels from the label pool
range allotted to RSVP) to the upstream router.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Router configuration submode — (config-router-rsvp)

Examples
ML66(config-router-rsvp)#php

37.18 primary affinity

Synopsis

— primary affinity

— primary no-affinity

Description
Use this command to enable the sending out of session-attribute objects with
resource-affinity data.

By default, this feature is enabled.

Use the no-affinity command to disable the sending out of session-attribute


objects.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Trunk submode — (config-rsvp-trunk-ip)

Examples
ML66(config-rsvp-trunk-ip)#primary affinity

37.19 primary exclude-any

412 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


RSVP-TE Commands

Synopsis
[no] primary exclude-any <GROUP>

Description
Use this command to specify the Administrative Groups that are excluded from
an LSP configuration.

Administrative Groups are manually-assigned attributes that describe the colors


of links, so that links with the same color are in one class. These groups are used
to implement different policy-based LSP setups. Administrative Groups can be
defined to be excluded for an LSP or for the primary and secondary paths of a
path. If an exclude list is specified, any link that includes even one of the colors
specified in the exclude list will not be chosen.

Use the no parameter to remove a previously set group in the Exclude Any list.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Trunk submode — (config-rsvp-trunk-ip)

Operands

GROUP The Administrative Group name.

Examples
ML66(config-rsvp-trunk-ip)#primary exclude-any sample

37.20 primary fast-reroute exclude-any

Synopsis
[no] primary fast-reroute exclude-any <GROUP>

Description
Use this command to specify the Administrative Groups that are excluded from a
Fast Reroute (FRR) backup LSP configuration.

Use the no parameter to remove a previously set group in the Exclude Any list.

Note: This command can be used to configure the FRR backup LSP for either
one-to-one or facility backup protection.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Trunk submode — (config-rsvp-trunk-ip)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 413


CLI Descriptions

Operands

GROUP The Administrative Group name.

Examples
ML66(config-rsvp-trunk-ip)#primary fast-reroute exclude-any sample

37.21 primary fast-reroute hop-limit

Synopsis

— primary fast-reroute hop-limit <LIMIT>

— [no] primary fast-reroute hop-limit [<LIMIT>]

Description
Use this command to set the hop limit for a Fast Reroute (FRR) detour LSP.

Use the no parameter with this command to unset the detour LSP hop-limit.

Note: This command can be used to configure the FRR backup LSP only for
one-to-one backup protection.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Trunk submode — (config-rsvp-trunk-ip)

Operands

LIMIT The acceptable number of hops. The valid range is 1–


255.

Examples
ML66(config-rsvp-trunk-ip)#primary fast-reroute hop-limit 5

37.22 primary fast-reroute include-any

Syopsis
[no] primary fast-reroute include-any <GROUP>

414 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


RSVP-TE Commands

Description
Use this command to include any of the Administrative Groups in a Fast Reroute
(FRR) backup LSP.

Use the no parameter with this command to remove a previously set group in the
Include Any list of Administrative Groups.

Note: This command can be used to configure the FRR backup LSP only for
one-to-one backup protection.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Trunk submode — (config-rsvp-trunk-ip)

Operands

GROUP The Administrative Group name.

Examples
ML66(config-rsvp-trunk-ip)#primary fast-reroute include-any sample

37.23 primary fast-reroute protection one-to-one

Synopsis
[no] primary fast-reroute protection one-to-one

Description
Use this command to create a Fast Reroute (FRR) backup and to set an LSP one-
to-one protection mechanism.

Use the no parameter with this command to unset the LSP protection
mechanism.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Trunk submode — (config-rsvp-trunk-ip)

Examples
ML66(config-rsvp-trunk-ip)#primary fast-reroute protection one-to-one

37.24 primary hop-limit

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 415


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis

— primary hop-limit <LIMIT>

— no primary hop-limit [<LIMIT> ]

Description
Use this command to specify a limit of hops for an RSVP trunk.

Hop-limit data are sent to the CSPF server if CSPF is used. Upon configuration of
an arbitrary hop limit, the hop limit is compared with the number of hops
configured in the primary path, if a primary path has been configured. If the
number of hops in the primary path exceeds the hop limit configured, no Path
messages are sent, and any existing session is torn down. If no primary path is
configured, the trunk is processed normally, and Path messages are sent.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Trunk submode — (config-rsvp-trunk-ip)

Operands

LIMIT The acceptable number of hops. The valid range is 1–


255.

Examples
ML66(config-rsvp-trunk-ip)#primary hop-limit 5

37.25 primary include-any

Synopsis
[no] primary include-any <GROUP>

Description
Use this command to include any of the Administrative Groups in an LSP.

Administrative Groups, also known as link coloring or resource classes, are


manually-assigned attributes that ensure that links with the same color belong to
the same class. These groups are used to implement different policy-based LSP
setups. If an include-any list is configured, all chosen links must belong to at least
one of the Administrative Groups enumerated in the include-any list.

Use the no parameter to remove a previously set group in the Include Any list of
Administrative Groups.

416 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


RSVP-TE Commands

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Trunk submode — (config-rsvp-trunk-ip)

Operands

GROUP The Administrative Group name.

Examples
ML66(config-rsvp-trunk-ip)#primary include-any sample

37.26 primary label-record

Synopsis
[no] primary label-record

Description
Use this command to record all labels exchanged between RSVP-enabled routers
during the reservation setup process.

By default, the recording of all labels is enabled.

Use the no parameter to turn off recording.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Trunk submode — (config-rsvp-trunk-ip)

Examples
ML66(config-rsvp-trunk-ip)#primary label-record

37.27 primary path

Synopsis

— primary path <PATHNAME>

— no primary path

Description
Use this command to specify an RSVP path to be used.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 417


CLI Descriptions

The <PATHNAME> in this command is the string used to identify an RSVP path
defined for the node (see the rsvp-path command).

Use the no parameter to unset the configured RSVP path.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Trunk submode — (config-rsvp-trunk-ip)

Operands

PATHNAME The name of the path.

Examples
ML66(config-rsvp-trunk-ip)#primary path sample

37.28 primary record

Synopsis
primary {record | no-record}

Description
Use this command to enable or disable the recording of the route taken by Path
and Reservation Request (Resv) messages to confirm the establishment of
reservations and identify errors.

Routes are recorded by means of the Route Record Object (RRO) in RSVP
messages. By default, the recording of routes is enabled.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Trunk submode — (config-rsvp-trunk-ip)

Options

record Enables the recording of routes.

no-record Disables the recording of routes.

Examples
ML66(config-rsvp-trunk-ip)#primary record

418 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


RSVP-TE Commands

37.29 refresh-path-parsing

Synopsis
[no] refresh-path-parsing

Description
Use this command to disable the parsing of Refresh PATH messages received
from upstream nodes.

Enable this feature to minimize message processing by RSVP if a particular


router does not need to parse Refresh-PATH messages to check for changes,
because LSPs passing through this router are not required to be updated
simultaneously.

Use the no parameter to enable the parsing of Refresh PATH messages received
from upstream nodes.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Router configuration submode — (config-router-rsvp)

Examples
ML66(config-router-rsvp)#refresh-path-parsing

37.30 refresh-resv-parsing

Synopsis
[no] refresh-resv-parsing

Description
Use this command to disable the parsing of Refresh RESV messages received
from upstream nodes.

Enable this feature to minimize message processing by RSVP if a particular


router does not need to parse Refresh RESV messages to check for changes,
because LSPs passing through this router are not required to be updated
simultaneously.

Use the no parameter to enable the parsing of Refresh PATH messages received
from upstream nodes.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 419


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Router configuration submode — (config-router-rsvp)

Examples
ML66(config-router-rsvp)#refresh-resv-parsing

37.31 refresh-time

Synopsis

— refresh-time <TIME>

— no refresh-time [<TIME> ]

Description
Use this command to configure the RSVP refresh interval timer. The timer
specifies the interval after which Path and/or Reservation Request (Resv)
messages are sent out.

Refresh time and keep multiplier are two interrelated timing parameters used to
calculate the valid Reservation Lifetime for an LSP. Refresh time regulates the
interval between Refresh messages, which include Path and Reservation Request
(Resv) messages. Refresh messages are sent periodically so that reservation does
not timeout in the neighboring nodes. Each sender and receiver host sends Path
and Resv messages, downstream and upstream respectively, along the paths.

Use the no parameter to revert to the default refresh interval.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Router configuration submode — (config-router-rsvp)

Operands

TIME The time interval in seconds after which messages are


sent. The valid range is 1–65535 s. The default interval is
30 s.

Examples
ML66(config-router-rsvp)#refresh-time 20

420 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


RSVP-TE Commands

37.32 reoptimize-lockdown

Synopsis
[no] reoptimize-lockdown

Description
Use this command to disable the reoptimization for a specific RSVP-TE trunk,
while the global LSP reoptimization is enabled.

When an LSP is locked down, the reoptimization is disabled, even when it is


triggered manually.

Use the no option with this command to unlock the reoptimization.

Note: By default, the reoptimization is unlocked.

Use the mpls traffic-eng reoptimize command to manually trigger


the reoptimization.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Trunk submode — (config-rsvp-trunk-ip)

Examples
Disabling the reoptimization for a specific RSVP-TE trunk:
ML66(config-rsvp-trunk-ip)#reoptimize-lockdown

Unlocking the reoptimization:


ML66(config-rsvp-trunk-ip)#no reoptimize-lockdown

37.33 reoptimize timers frequency

Synopsis
reoptimize timers frequency [<INTERVAL>]

no reoptimize timers frequency

Description
Use this command to set the frequency of reoptimize timers.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 421


CLI Descriptions

The default value of the timer frequency is 3600 seconds. To set the default
value, use reoptimize timers frequency without operand.

At given intervals, LSP trunks are scanned for a better LSP path.

Use the no option to disable reoptimization.

Note: By default, the reoptimization of RSVP-TE trunks is enabled. The default


interval is 3600 seconds.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Router configuration submode — (config-router-rsvp)

Operands

INTERVAL Specifies a value of the timer frequency in seconds. The


valid range is 60-604800. The default value is 3600
seconds.

Examples
Setting reoptimize timers:
ML66(config-router-rsvp)# reoptimize timers frequency 100

37.34 router rsvp

Synopsis
[no] router rsvp

Description
Use this command to enter RSVP-TE Router configuration submode from Global
Configuration mode and to enable the RSVP daemon, if it is not enabled yet.

The RSVP internal state machine starts up only if this command is executed.

Use the no parameter in Global Configuration mode to disable RSVP on the node.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

422 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


RSVP-TE Commands

Examples
ML66(config)#router rsvp
ML66(config-router-rsvp)

37.35 rsvp-path

Synopsis
[no] rsvp-path <PATHNAME>

Description
Use this command to create a new RSVP path or to enter RSVP-TE Path
submode. In this mode, you can add or delete paths and specify the path to be
loose or strict.

Use the no parameter to delete the path and the specified hops of the path.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

PATHNAME The name of the path.

Examples
ML66(config)#rsvp-path sample
ML66(config-rsvp-path)

37.36 rsvp-trunk

Synopsis

— rsvp-trunk <TRUNKNAME> ipv4

— no rsvp-trunk <TRUNKNAME>

Description
Use this command to create a new RSVP trunk or to enter RSVP-TE Trunk
submode to perform maintenance on a specific trunk.

This command creates a new RSVP trunk and adds the attributes required to
configure an explicitly-routed or traditionally-routed Label Switched Path (LSP).

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 423


CLI Descriptions

Once the trunk is configured with the required attributes, an RSVP session (and
PSB) is created for this trunk, which enables the exchange of messages and
completes the LSP setup.

This command also modifies an existing RSVP Path to configure an explicitly-


routed or traditionally-routed LSP.

This command can also be used to set the address family of an RSVP trunk. If no
address family is specified, the default value of IPv4 is used. If the address family
is already set, a check is made to see if the address family configured and the one
already in the database are the same. An error message is sent if the two do not
match.

Use the no option with this command to remove a RSVP trunk and all the
configured attributes, except for the specified primary path.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

TRUNKNAME The name of the specific PSB trunk.

Options

ipv4 Specifies the IPv4 address family.

Examples
ML66(config)#rsvp-trunk sample ipv4
ML66(config-rsvp-trunk-ip)

37.37 rsvp-trunk-restart

Synopsis
rsvp-trunk-restart

Description
Use this command to restart the RSVP trunk. This command is used to kill the
existing LSP and to re-start the LSP setup procedure.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Trunk submode — (config-rsvp-trunk-ip)

424 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


RSVP-TE Commands

Examples
ML66(config-rsvp-trunk-ip)#rsvp-trunk-restart

37.38 select-preference

Synopsis

— select-preference <PREFERENCE>

— no select-preference

Description
Use this command to configure a selected preference for an RSVP trunk. The level
of preference is measured by the value of the number from 0 to 7. A greater
number indicates higher level of preference. If multiple trunks are defined
towards the same destination, the trunk with higher preference is selected as the
primary trunk. When the two trunks are with the same preference, the system
randomly selects one of them.

Use the no parameter with this command to unset the configuration.

Note: Do not configure select-preference and primary fast-reroute


protection at the same time. These are mutually exclusive.

Command Mode
RSVP Trunk submode — (config-rsvp-trunk-ip)

Operands

PREFERENCE Value that indicates the level of preference. Valid range is


0-7. The default value is 0.

Examples
Configure a selected preference for an RSVP trunk:
ML66(config-rsvp-trunk-ip)#select-preference 7

37.39 to <IPADDR>

Synopsis

— to <IPADDR>

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 425


CLI Descriptions

— no to

Description
Use this command to specify an IPv4 egress for an LSP.

When configuring an LSP, the egress router address must be specified using this
command in the trunk node. The egress definition is a mandatory attribute, and
an RSVP session will not be created if an egress is not defined.

Command Mode
RSVP-TE Trunk submode — (config-rsvp-trunk-ip)

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the tunnel egress.

Examples
ML66(config-rsvp-trunk-ip)#to 10.10.0.10

426 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


RSVP-TE Interface Commands

38 RSVP-TE Interface Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
38.

The following command mode is applicable for the Intermediate Resource


Reservation Protocol - Traffic Engineering (RSVP-TE) interface commands:

— Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Table 38 RSVP-TE Commands Overview


admin-group create an Administrative Group to be
used for links
disable-rsvp disable RSVP message exchange on
an interface
enable-rsvp enable RSVP message exchange on
an interface
rsvp ack-wait-timeout configure the acknowledgement wait
timeout for all neighbors detected
through the specific interface
rsvp bfd enable or disable BFD for RSVP on the
interface
rsvp hello enable or disable the receipt of Hello
messages from peers connected
through the specific interface
rsvp hello-interval enable the sending of Hello packets on
the interface, and set the time interval
between successive Hello packets
rsvp hello-timeout set how long an RSVP node waits for
a Hello message before declaring a
neighbor to be down
rsvp keep-multiplier configure the constant for calculating
a valid reservation lifetime for an LSP
for messages exchanged through this
interface
rsvp refresh-reduction enable Refresh Reduction capability
advertisement for a specific interface
rsvp refresh-time configure the RSVP refresh interval
timer for the specific interface

The related show commands are the following:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 427


CLI Descriptions

— show rsvp

— show rsvp admin-groups

— show rsvp interface

— show rsvp neighbor

— show rsvp nexthop-cache

— show rsvp path

— show rsvp session

— show rsvp session count

— show rsvp session egress

— show rsvp session ingress

— show rsvp session <LSP-NAME>

— show rsvp session transit

— show rsvp statistics

— show rsvp summary-refresh

— show rsvp trunk

— show rsvp version

— show running-config router

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884

38.1 admin-group

Synopsis
[no] admin-group <NAME>

Description
Use this command to create an Administrative Group to be used for links. Each
link can be a member of one or more or no Administrative Groups.

When used in Router Interface configuration submode, this command adds a link
between an interface and a group. The name is the name of the group previously

428 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


RSVP-TE Interface Commands

configured. There can be multiple groups per interface. The group is created in
Global Configurarion mode, then interfaces are added to the group in Router
Interface configuration submode.

Use the no parameter with this command to disable this command.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

NAME The name of the admin group.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#admin-group sample

38.2 disable-rsvp

Synopsis
disable-rsvp

Description
Use this command to disable RSVP message exchange on an interface. RSVP
message exchange can be enabled using the enable-rsvp command.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#disable-rsvp

38.3 enable-rsvp

Synopsis
enable-rsvp

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 429


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to enable RSVP message exchange on an interface. RSVP
message exchange can be disabled using the disable-rsvp command.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#enable-rsvp

38.4 rsvp ack-wait-timeout

Synopsis

— rsvp ack-wait-timeout <TIMEOUT>

— no rsvp ack-wait-timeout [<TIMEOUT> ]

Description
Use this command to configure the acknowledgement wait timeout for all
neighbors detected through the specific interface.

Use the no parameter with this command to revert to the default


acknowledgement wait timeout for the specified interface.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

TIMEOUT The acknowledgement wait timeout value in seconds.


The valid range is 1–65535 s. The default timeout value
is 10 s.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#rsvp ack-wait-timeout 200

430 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


RSVP-TE Interface Commands

38.5 rsvp bfd

Synopsis
rsvp bfd {enable | disable}

Description
Use this command to enable or disable Bidirectional Forwarding Detection (BFD)
for RSVP on the interface.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Options

enable Enables BFD for RSVP on the interface.

disable Disables BFD for RSVP on the interface.

Examples
Enabling BFD for RSVP on the interface:
ML66(config-router-if)#rsvp bfd enable

38.6 rsvp hello

Synopsis
rsvp hello {enable | disable}

Description
Use this command to enable or disable the receipt of Hello messages from peers
connected through the specific interface.

By default, the receipt of Hello messages is disabled.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 431


CLI Descriptions

Options

enable Enables the receipt of Hello messages.

disable Disables the receipt of Hello messages.

Examples
Enabling the receipt of Hello messages from peers connected through the
interface:
ML66(config-router-if)#rsvp hello enable

38.7 rsvp hello-interval

Synopsis

— rsvp hello-interval <INTERVAL>

— no rsvp hello-interval

Description
Use this command to enable the sending of Hello packets on the interface and to
set the time interval between successive Hello packets. For optimum
performance, set this value to less than one-third of the specified rsvp hello
timeout value.

This is an interface-specific command, and when it is not specified, the global


hello-interval state applies.

Use the no parameter to revert to default hello interval value.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

INTERVAL The interval in seconds. The valid range is 1–65535 s.


The default value is 1 s.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#rsvp hello-interval 10

432 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


RSVP-TE Interface Commands

38.8 rsvp hello-timeout

Synopsis

— rsvp hello-timeout <TIMEOUT>

— no rsvp hello-timeout

Description
Use this command to set how long an RSVP node waits for a Hello message
before declaring a neighbor to be down. If an LSR has not received a Hello
message from a peer connected through the specific interface within the time
period specified using this command, the LSR resets all sessions shared with this
particular peer.

This is an interface-specific command, and when it is not specified, the global


hello-timeout state applies.

Use the no parameter to revert to the default hello timeout value.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

TIMEOUT The time period an RSVP node waits to receive a Hello


message, specified in seconds. The valid range is 1–
65535 s. The default value is 3 s.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#rsvp hello-timeout 5

38.9 rsvp keep-multiplier

Synopsis
[no] rsvp keep-multiplier <MULTIPLIER>

Description
Use this command to configure the constant for calculating a valid reservation
lifetime for an LSP for messages exchanged through this interface.

Reservation lifetime is the duration of bandwidth reservation for the LSP. Refresh
time and keep multiplier are two interrelated timing parameters used to calculate

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 433


CLI Descriptions

the valid Reservation Lifetime for an LSP. Use the following formula to calculate
the reservation lifetime for an LSP:

L ≥ (K + 0.5) * 1.5 * R K = keep multiplier


R = refresh timer

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

MULTIPLIER The keep multiplier value. The valid range is 1–255.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#rsvp keep-multiplier 20

38.10 rsvp refresh-reduction

Synopsis
[no] rsvp refresh-reduction

Description
Use this command to enable Refresh Reduction capability advertisement for a
specific interface.

By default, Refresh Reduction the mechanism is enabled for all interfaces.

Use the no parameter with this command disable Refresh Reduction capability
advertisement for the specified interface.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#rsvp refresh-reduction

38.11 rsvp refresh-time

434 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


RSVP-TE Interface Commands

Synopsis

— rsvp refresh-time <TIME>

— no rsvp refresh-time [<TIME> ]

Description
Use this command to configure the RSVP refresh interval timer for the specific
interface.

This is an interface-specific command, and when it is not specified, the global


refresh-time state applies.

Refresh time and keep multiplier are two interrelated timing parameters used to
calculate the valid Reservation Lifetime for an LSP. Refresh time regulates the
interval between Refresh messages, which include Path and Reservation Request
(Resv) messages. Refresh messages are sent periodically so that the reservation
does not timeout in the neighboring nodes. Each sender and receiver host sends
Path and Resv messages, downstream and upstream respectively, along the
paths.

Use the no parameter with this command to revert to the refresh time value set in
RSVP-TE Router configuration submode.

Command Mode
Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Operands

TIME The time interval in seconds after which messages are


sent. The valid range is 1–65535 s. The default refresh-
time interval is 3 s.

Examples
ML66(config-router-if)#rsvp refresh-time 10

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 435


CLI Descriptions

39 DCN Remote Syslog Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
39.

The following command mode is applicable for the DCN remote syslog
commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

Table 39 DCN Remote Syslog Commands Overview


rsyslog enable enable remote syslog
rsyslog server add or modify a server for remote syslog
rsyslog6 server add a remote syslog server with IPv6 address
rsyslog trapseverity specify trap severities

The related show commands are the following:

— show rsyslog

— show rsyslog6

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

39.1 rsyslog enable

Synopsis
[no] rsyslog enable

Description
Use this command to enable the remote syslog.

Use the no option to disable the remote syslog.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

436 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


DCN Remote Syslog Commands

Examples
Enabling the remote syslog:
ML66(config)#rsyslog enable

39.2 rsyslog server

Synopsis
[no] rsyslog server <INDEX> <IPADDRESS> [<PORT> ]

Description
Use this command to add a remote syslog server.

Use the no option with the operand <INDEX> to remove a remote syslog server.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

INDEX The index number of the remote syslog server. All servers
must have a unique index number.

The valid range is 1–3.

IPADDRESS The address of the remote syslog server. Specified in


decimal notation <A.B.C.D> .

PORT The port to use on the remote syslog server.

Examples
Adding a remote syslog server with index 1 and port 514:
ML66(config)#rsyslog server 1 192.168.0.1 514

39.3 rsyslog6 server

Synopsis
[no] rsyslog6 server <INDEX> <IPV6ADDRESS> [<PORT> ]

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 437


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to add a remote syslog server with IPv6 address.

Use the no option with the operand <INDEX> to remove an IPv6 remote syslog
server.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

INDEX The unique number of the remote syslog server. The valid
range is 1–3.

IPV6ADDRESS The IPv6 address of the remote syslog server, where the
format is <X:X::X:X> .

PORT The used UDP port on the remote syslog server.

Examples
Adding an IPv6 remote syslog server with index 1 and port 514:
ML66(config)#rsyslog6 server 1 2001:1b70:8180:c001::1011 514

39.4 rsyslog trapseverity

Synopsis

— rsyslog trapseverity <HEXSTRINGBITMAP>

— no rsyslog trapseverity

Description
Use this command to specify trap severities. Only alarms and events with a
severity that are registered with this command are sent to the remote syslog.

Use the no option to remove all trap severities.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

438 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


DCN Remote Syslog Commands

Operands

HEXSTRINGBITMAP
Bitwise OR for the wanted severities, where the different
severities are represented by the following hexadecimal
strings: Indeterminate = 0x80, Critical = 0x40, Major =
0x20, Minor = 0x10, Warning = 0x08, Cleared = 0x04

Examples
Specifying that alarms and events with severities Critical and Major are sent to
the remote syslog server:
ML66(config)#rsyslog trapseverity 0x60

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 439


CLI Descriptions

40 Security Remote Syslog Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
40.

The following command mode is applicable for the security remote syslog
commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

Table 40 Security Remote Syslog Commands Overview


rsyslogsec enable enable the sending of selected security
events to an external syslog server in
syslog format
rsyslogsec events auditlog send all security events to the syslog
globalsettings server
rsyslogsec events localauth select which local authentication
events to send to the syslog server
rsyslogsec events login select which login events to send to
the syslog server
rsyslogsec events protocols select which security protocols events
to send to the syslog server
rsyslogsec events radius select which Remote Authentication
Dial In User Service (RADIUS) events
to send to the syslog server
rsyslogsec events tacacs select which Terminal Access
Controller Access Control System Plus
(TACACS+) events to send to the
syslog server
rsyslogsec server add a server to the server list for
security events
rsyslogsec6 server add a server with IPv6 address to the
server list for security events

The related show commands are the following:

— show rsyslogsec

— show rsyslogsec6

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

440 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Security Remote Syslog Commands

40.1 rsyslogsec enable

Synopsis
[no] rsyslogsec enable

Description
Use this command to enable the sending of selected security events to an
external syslog server in syslog format.

Use the no option to disable the sending of selected security events to an external
syslog server in syslog format.

Command mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Enabling remote syslog for security events:
ML66(config)#rsyslogsec enable

40.2 rsyslogsec events auditlog globalsettings

Synopsis
rsyslogsec events auditlog globalsettings { yes | no }

Description
Use this command with the yes option to send all security events to the syslog
server.

Use the no option not to send security events to the syslog server.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Sending all security events to the syslog server:
ML66(config)#rsyslogsec events auditlog globalsettings yes

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 441


CLI Descriptions

Not sending security events to the syslog server:


ML66(config)#rsyslogsec events auditlog globalsettings no

40.3 rsyslogsec events localauth

Synopsis
rsyslogsec events localauth { aaa | localuseren | parammod | pwdchange
| pwdchangefailure | pwdreset } { yes | no }

Description
Use this command with the yes option to select which local authentication events
to send to the syslog server.

Use the no option not to send the previously selected local authentication events
to the syslog server.

Command mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Options

aaa Selects AAA change events for logging.

localuseren Selects Local User Enable events for logging.

parammod Selects Local User Parameter Modified events for logging.

pwdchange Selects Password Change events for logging.

pwdchangefailure
Selects Password Change Failure events for logging.

pwdreset Selects Password Reset events for logging.

Examples
Selecting AAA change events to send to the syslog server:
ML66(config)#rsyslogsec events localauth aaa yes

Not sending AAA change events to the syslog server:


ML66(config)#rsyslogsec events localauth aaa no

442 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Security Remote Syslog Commands

40.4 rsyslogsec events login

Synopsis
rsyslogsec events login { centralfailure | centralsuccess |
localfailure | localsuccess } { yes | no }

Description
Use this command with the yes option to select which login events to send to the
syslog server.

Use the no option not to send the previously selected login events to the syslog
server.

Command mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Options

centralfailure Selects failed centralized user login events for logging.

centralsuccess Selects successfully centralized user login events for


logging.

localfailure Selects failed local user login events for logging.

localsuccess Selects successfully local user login events for logging.

Examples
Selecting failed centralized user login events to send to the syslog server:
ML66(config)#rsyslogsec events login centralfailure yes

Not sending failed centralized user login events to the syslog server:
ML66(config)#rsyslogsec events login centralfailure no

40.5 rsyslogsec events protocols

Synopsis
rsyslogsec events protocols { brute | clien | cliprot | ftpprot |
ntpprot | ntpset | snmpperm | snmpv3priv } { yes | no }

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 443


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command with the yes option to select which security protocols events to
send to the syslog server.

Use the no option not to send the previously selected security protocols events to
the syslog server.

Command mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Options

brute Selects brute force defence settings events for logging.

clien Selects CLI enabling events for logging.

cliprot Selects protocol settings events for logging.

ftpprot Selects FTP protocol settings events for logging.

ntpprot Selects Network Time Protocol (NTP) protocol settings


events for logging.

ntpset Selects NTP settings events for logging.

snmpperm Selects changes in Simple Network Management Protocol


(SNMP) v1/2 permissions events for logging.

snmpv3priv Selects SNMPv3 privacy settings events for logging.

Examples
Selecting brute force defence settings events to send to the syslog server:
ML66(config)#rsyslogsec events protocols brute yes

Not sending brute force defence settings events to the syslog server:
ML66(config)#rsyslogsec events protocols brute no

40.6 rsyslogsec events radius

Synopsis
rsyslogsec events radius { serveradddel | serveravailability |
serverchanged | serverunknown } { yes | no }

444 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Security Remote Syslog Commands

Description
Use this command with the yes option to select which Remote Authentication
Dial In User Service (RADIUS) events to send to the syslog server.

Use the no option not to send the previously selected RADIUS events to the
syslog server.

Command mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Options

serveradddel Selects RADIUS server added or deleted events for


logging.

serveravailability
Selects server availability events for logging.

serverchanged Selects server parameter change events for logging.

serverunknown Selects server unknown status events for logging.

Examples
Selecting server availability events to send to the syslog server:
ML66(config)#rsyslogsec events radius server availability yes

Not sending server availability events to the syslog server:


ML66(config)#rsyslogsec events radius server availability no

40.7 rsyslogsec events tacacs

Synopsis
rsyslogsec events tacacs { serveradddel | serveravailability |
serverchanged | serverunknown } { yes | no }

Description
Use this command with the yes option to select which Terminal Access Controller
Access Control System Plus (TACACS+) events to send to the syslog server.

Use the no option not to send the previously selected TACACS+ events to the
syslog server.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 445


CLI Descriptions

Command mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Options

serveradddel Selects TACACS+ server added or deleted events for


logging.

serveravailability
Selects server availability events for logging.

serverchanged Selects server parameter change events for logging.

serverunknown Selects server unknown status events for logging.

Examples
Selecting server availability events to send to the syslog server:
ML66(config)#rsyslogsec events tacacs serveravailability yes

Not sending server availability events to the syslog server:


ML66(config)#rsyslogsec events tacacs server availability no

40.8 rsyslogsec server

Synopsis
[no] rsyslogsec server <INDEX> <IPADDRESS> [<PORT> ]

Description
Use this command to add a server to the server list for security events.

Use the no option with the operand <INDEX> to remove the server.

Command mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

INDEX The index number of the server. All servers must have a
unique index number.

The valid range is 1–3.

446 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Security Remote Syslog Commands

IPADDRESS The address of the server. Specified in decimal notation


<A.B.C.D> .

PORT The port to use on the server.

Examples
Adding a server with index 1 and port 514 to the server list:
ML66(config)#rsyslogsec server 1 10.120.58.18 514

40.9 rsyslogsec6 server

Synopsis
[no] rsyslogsec6 server <INDEX> <IPV6ADDRESS> [<PORT> ]

Description
Use this command to add a server with IPv6 address to the server list for security
events.

Use the no option with the operand <INDEX> to remove the IPv6 server.

Command mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

INDEX The unique number of the server. The valid range is 1–3.

IPV6ADDRESS The IPv6 address of the server, where the format is


<X:X::X:X> .

PORT The used UDP port on the server.

Examples
Adding a server with index 1 and port 514 to the server list:
ML66(config)#rsyslogsec6 server 1 2001:1:1::18 514

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 447


CLI Descriptions

41 Radio Link Terminal Commands: MMU 1001


and MMU 1002 - RLT

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
41.

The following command modes are applicable for MMU 1001 and MMU 1002
Radio Link Terminal (RLT) commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

— Far End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-ferlt)

Table 41 MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 - Radio Link Terminal Commands
Overview
aes-encryption-oth enable or disable AES Encryption
Over-the-Hop (OTH) for the specified
Radio Link Terminal (RLT)
aes-encryption-oth-mk set the master key for AES Encryption
OTH
eqp-protection-switch-mode configure the mode in which the EQP
switching mechanism is configured
eqp-active-unit set the active MMU in EQP
configuration
expected-far-end-id set the expected ID of the RLT at far
end
fade-notification-timer set the notification suppression timer
far-end-id-check enable or disable the checking of the
RLT ID at the far end
ferlt configure a specific RLT at far end
id set the RLT ID
manual-switch move the active Tx from one CT to the
other CT at the near end
mode set the mode of the RLT at near end
protection-switch-mode set the switching mechanism mode
reset reset the default RLT settings

448 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Radio Link Terminal Commands: RLT

reset-tx-switch-alarm manually reset the remote Tx


switchover and the Tx switchover
alarms
revertive-preferred-tx define the preferred CT of the RLT in
auto-revertive protection mode
revertive-wait-to-restore set the waiting time in seconds before
switching back to the preferred Tx in
auto-revertive mode
rlt configure a specific RLT at near end
tx-switch-far-end enable or disable the remote Tx
switchover and the Tx switchover
functions and the related alarm
notifications

The related show commands are the following:

— show ferlt

— show rlt

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

41.1 aes-encryption-oth

Synopsis
aes-encryption-oth {enable | disable}

Description
Use this command to enable or disable AES Encryption Over-the-Hop (OTH) for
the specified Radio Link Terminal (RLT).

By default, AES Encryption OTH is disabled.

Note: This command is available only on MMU 1002, but not on MMU 1001.

Command Mode
Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

Options

enable Enables AES Encryption OTH.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 449


CLI Descriptions

disable Disables AES Encryption OTH.

Examples
Enabling AES Encryption OTH:

ML66(config-rlt)#aes-encryption-oth enable

41.2 aes-encryption-oth-mk

Synopsis
aes-encryption-oth-mk <MASTER-KEY>

Description
Use this command to set the master key for AES Encryption Over-The-Hop
(OTH).

By default, the master key is empty and must be set.

Note: This command is available only on MMU 1002, but not on MMU 1001.

Command Mode
Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

Operands

MASTER-KEY The master encryption key, which is 12–64 characters.

Examples
Setting the master key for AES Encryption OTH to
D8qsUppDGEL4q120gZxj3qvDDn8dM48M:

ML66(config-rlt)#aes-encryption-oth-mk D8qsUppDGEL4q120gZxj3qvDDn →
8dM48M

41.3 eqp-protection-switch-mode

Synopsis
eqp-protection-switch-mode <SWITCH-MODE>

450 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Radio Link Terminal Commands: RLT

Description
Use this command to configure the mode in which the EQP switching mechanism
is configured. The default value is AUTO.

Note: The command is only applicable in radio link equipment protection


configuration.

Command Mode

— Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

— Far End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-ferlt)

Operands

SWITCH-MODE — auto — The system automatically switches from one


MMU to the other MMU.

— manual — Automatic switching is disabled, and the


operator can select the active MMU manually.

Examples
Setting the SWITCH-MODE to MANUAL:
ML66(config-rlt)# eqp-protection-switch-mode manual

41.4 eqp-active-unit

Synopsis
eqp-active-unit <UNIT>

Description
Use this command to set the active MMU in EQP configuration.

Note: This command is only applicable in equipment protection configuration.

Command Mode

— Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

— Far End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-ferlt)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 451


CLI Descriptions

Operands

UNIT — low-unit — MMU in lower slot of the EQP group

— high-unit — MMU in higher slot of the EQP group

Examples
Setting the MMU in the lower slot of the EQP group as the active MMU:
ML66(config-rlt)# eqp-active-unit low-unit

41.5 expected-far-end-id

Synopsis
expected-far-end-id <NAME>

Description
Use this command to set the expected ID of the Radio Link Terminal (RLT) at far
end.

Command Mode

— Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

— Far End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-ferlt)

Operands

NAME The expected ID of the RLT at the far end. The maximum
length of the ID is 32 characters.

Examples
Setting the expected ID of the RLT at far end to LindholmenB:
ML66(config-rlt)#expected-far-end-id LindholmenB

41.6 fade-notification-timer

Synopsis
fade-notification-timer <INTERVAL>

452 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Radio Link Terminal Commands: RLT

Description
Use this command to set the notification suppression timer. Alarms, caused by
fading, with duration less than the specified time are not reported.

Note: — This command is applicable only in radio link protection


configuration.

— When the timer is set to 0, the suppression is disabled.

Command Mode

— Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

— Far End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-ferlt)

Operands

INTERVAL The value of the notification suppression timer. The valid


range is 0–1000 seconds. The default value is 200.

Examples
Setting the notification suppression timer to 300 seconds:
ML66(config-rlt)#fade-notification-timer 300

41.7 far-end-id-check

Synopsis
far-end-id-check <ID-CHECK>

Description
Use this command to enable or disable the checking of the Radio Link Terminal
(RLT) ID at far end. By default, the ID checking is disabled.

When enabled, the system verifies that the far end RLT ID is the same as the
expected far end RLT ID. If the verification succeeds, the RLT status is UP,
otherwise it is DOWN.

Command Mode

— Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

— Far End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-ferlt)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 453


CLI Descriptions

Operands

ID-CHECK — enable — Enables the checking of the RLT ID at far


end.

— disable — Disables the checking of the RLT ID at far


end.

Examples
Enabling the checking of the RLT ID at far end:
ML66(config-rlt)#far-end-id-check enable

41.8 ferlt

Synopsis
ferlt <DISTINGUISHED-NAME>

Description
Use this command to configure a specific Radio Link Terminal (RLT) at far end.
The command also changes to the (config-ferlt) submode.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

DISTINGUISHED-NAME
The relative distinguished name of the RLT where the
format is <Rack/Slot/Port>. The Port number is the RLT
number, that is, 1 or 2.

Note: When equipment protection (EQP) is enabled,


for example between slots 1 and 3, the
distinguished name is changed as follows: R/
S1+S2/P. Still, the RLT is entered using only the
lower slot (rlt 1/1/1 and ferlt 1/1/1).

Examples
Configuring RLT 1:
ML66(config)#ferlt 1/1/1
ML66(config-ferlt)#

454 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Radio Link Terminal Commands: RLT

41.9 id

Synopsis
id <NAME>

Description
Use this command to set the Radio Link Terminal (RLT) ID.

Command Mode

— Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

— Far End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-ferlt)

Operands

NAME The ID of the RLT. The maximum length of the ID is 32


characters.

Note: The ID is used by the far end when checking that


it is connected to the correct RLT.

Examples
Setting the RLT ID as LindholmenA:
ML66(config-rlt)#id LindholmenA

41.10 manual-switch

Synopsis
manual-switch

Description
Use this command in hot standby protection mode to move the active Tx from
one Carrier Termination (CT) to the other CT at near end.

Command Mode

— Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

— Far End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-ferlt)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 455


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Moving the active Tx from one CT to the other CT at near end:
ML66(config-rlt)#manaul-switch

41.11 mode

Synopsis
mode <RLT-MODE>

Description
Use this command to set the mode of the Radio Link Terminal (RLT) at near end.
The default mode is 1+0.

Note: All modes are available on MMU 1002, but not on MMU 1001.

Command Mode
Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

Operands

RLT-MODE The mode of the RLT. The valid values are the following:

— 1+0

— 2+0RLB

— 1+1RLP

— 1+1RLPEQP

— 2+0RLBEQP

— 2+2RLPEQP

— 4+0RLBEQP

Examples
Setting the mode of the RLT to 2+0RLB:
ML66(config-rlt)#mode 2+0RLB

456 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Radio Link Terminal Commands: RLT

41.12 protection-switch-mode

Synopsis
protection-switch-mode <SWITCH-MODE>

Description
Use this command to set the switching mechanism mode. The default mode is
AUTO.

Note: The command is only applicable in radio link protection configuration.

Command Mode

— Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

— Far End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-ferlt)

Operands

SWITCH-MODE — auto — The system automatically switches from the


degraded Tx to the other Tx.

— manual — Automatic switching is disabled and the


Tx can be selected manually. Once the active Tx is
selected manually, it functions as the active Tx.

— auto-revertive — The preferred active Tx can be


selected manually. The active Tx selection is
automatic but once the fault is cleared, the active Tx
changes back to the preferred active Tx.

— disabled — Automatic switching is disabled and no


Tx can be selected manually. The diversity CT is Rx
only.

Examples
Setting the switching mechanism mode to manual:
ML66(config-rlt)#protection-switch-mode manual

41.13 reset

Synopsis
reset

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 457


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to reset the default Radio Link Terminal (RLT) settings at near
end.

Note: Before resetting the default RLT settings, check the following:

— WAN interface is connected to a switch port

— TDM is assigned to the RLT with a not null number of tributaries

— XPIC is enabled

— Carrier Termination (CT) is assigned to the RLT

Command Mode
Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

Examples
Resetting the default RLT settings:
ML66(config-rlt)#reset

41.14 reset-tx-switch-alarm

Synopsis
reset-tx-switch-alarm

Description
Use this command to manually reset the remote Tx switchover and the Tx
switchover alarms.

Command Mode

— Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

— Far End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-ferlt)

Examples
Resetting the remote Tx switchover and the Tx switchover alarms:
ML66(config-rlt)#reset-tx-switch-alarm

458 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Radio Link Terminal Commands: RLT

41.15 revertive-preferred-tx

Synopsis
revertive-preferred-tx <CT>

Description
Use this command to define the preferred Carrier Termination (CT) of the Radio
Link Terminal (RLT) in auto-revertive protection mode.

Note: The command is only applicable in radio link protection configuration.

Command Mode

— Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

— Far End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-ferlt)

Operands

CT Defines the Tx of the CT R/S/P, where the format is


<Rack/Slot/Port> .

Examples
Defining the preferred CT of the RLT:
ML66(config-rlt)#revertive-preferred-tx 1/2/1

41.16 revertive-wait-to-restore

Synopsis
revertive-wait-to-restore <INTERVAL>

Description
Use this command to set the waiting time in seconds before switching back to the
preferred Tx in auto-revertive mode.

Note: This command is only applicable in radio link protection configuration


and in auto-revertive mode.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 459


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode

— Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

— Far End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-ferlt)

Operands

INTERVAL The number of seconds to wait before switching back to


the preferred Tx. The default value is 0 second.

Examples
Setting the waiting time to 10 seconds:
ML66(config-rlt)#revertive-wait-to-restore 10

41.17 rlt

Synopsis
rlt <DISTINGUISHED-NAME>

Description
Use this command to configure a specific Radio Link Terminal (RLT) at near end.
The command also changes to the (config-rlt) submode.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

DISTINGUISHED-NAME
The relative distinguished name of the RLT where the
format is <Rack/Slot/Port> . The Port number is the RLT
number, that is, 1 or 2.

Examples
Configuring RLT 1:
ML66(config)#rlt 1/1/1
ML66(config-rlt)#

41.18 tx-switch-far-end

460 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Radio Link Terminal Commands: RLT

Synopsis
tx-switch-far-end <TX-SWITCH>

Description
Use this command to enable or disable the remote Tx switchover and the Tx
switchover functions and the related alarm notifications. By default, the
functions and the related alarm notifications are disabled.

Note: This command is only applicable in radio link protection configuration.

Command Mode

— Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

— Far End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-ferlt)

Operands

TX-SWITCH — enable — Enables the remote Tx switchover and the


Tx switchover functions and the related alarm
notifications.

— disable — Disables the remote Tx switchover and the


Tx switchover functions and the related alarm
notifications.

Examples
Enabling the remote Tx switchover and the Tx switchover functions and the
related alarm notifications:
ML66(config-rlt)#tx-switch-far-end enable

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 461


CLI Descriptions

42 Radio Link Terminal Commands: MMU 1002


- XPIC

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
42.

The following command modes are applicable for MMU 1002 XPIC commands:

— Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

— Near End Radio Link Terminal XPIC submode — (config-rlt-xpic)

Table 42 MMU 1002 - XPIC Commands Overview


mode enable or disable the XPIC associated
with the upper-level Radio Link
Terminal (RLT)
xpic create an XPIC pair associated with
the upper-level RLT
xpic-auto-restore enable or disable the automatic XPIC
restore function
xpic-recovery enable or disable the automatic XPIC
recovery procedure
xpic-restore restore XPIC functionality after XPIC
recovery has been triggered and the
fault has been repaired

The related show command is the following:

— show xpic

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

42.1 mode

Synopsis
mode {CT-Pair-1 | CT-Pair-2} <XPIC-MODE>

Description
Use this command to enable or disable the XPIC associated with the upper-level
Radio Link Terminal (RLT). By default, the XPIC is disabled.

462 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Radio Link Terminal Commands: XPIC

Command Mode
Near End Radio Link Terminal XPIC submode — (config-rlt-xpic)

Operands

XPIC-MODE — enable — Enables the XPIC associated with the


upper-level RLT.

— disable — Disables the XPIC associated with the


upper-level RLT.

Options

CT-Pair-1 Specifies the first CT-pair. This parameter is used for


nodes in 2+0, 2 (1+0) CT 1/x/1, and CT 1/X/2
configurations. In 4+0 and 2+2 configurations, CT-Pair-1
is on the low slot.

CT-Pair-2 Specifies the second CT-pair. This parameter is used for


nodes in 4+0 and 2+2 configurations, where CT-Pair-2 is
on the high slot.

Examples
Enabling the XPIC associated with the upper-level RLT:
ML66(config-rlt-xpic)#mode CT-Pair-1 enable

Enabling the XPIC on both the high and the low slot in a 4+0 configuration:
ML66(config-rlt-xpic)#mode CT-Pair-1 CT-Pair-2 enable

42.2 xpic

Synopsis
xpic

Description
Use this command to create an XPIC pair associated with the upper-level Radio
Link Terminal (RLT). The command also changes to the (config-rlt-xpic)
submode.

Command Mode
Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 463


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Creating an XPIC pair associated with the upper-level RLT:
ML66(config-rlt)#xpic
ML66(config-rlt-xpic)#

42.3 xpic-auto-restore

Synopsis
xpic-auto-restore {CT-Pair-1 | CT-Pair-2} <AUTO-RESTORE>

Description
Use this command to enable or disable the automatic XPIC restore function. By
default, the automatic XPIC restore function is disabled.

Command Mode
Near End Radio Link Terminal XPIC submode — (config-rlt-xpic)

Operands

AUTO-RESTORE — enable — Enables automatic XPIC restore function.

— disable — Disables automatic XPIC restore function.

Options

CT-Pair-1 Specifies the first CT-pair. This parameter is used for


nodes in 2+0, 2 (1+0) CT 1/x/1, and CT 1/X/2
configurations. In 4+0 and 2+2 configurations, CT-Pair-1
is on the low slot.

CT-Pair-2 Specifies the second CT-pair. This parameter is used for


nodes in 4+0 and 2+2 configurations, where CT-Pair-2 is
on the high slot.

Examples
Enabling the automatic XPIC restore function:
ML66(config-rlt-xpic)#xpic-auto-restore CT-Pair-1 enable

42.4 xpic-recovery

464 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Radio Link Terminal Commands: XPIC

Synopsis
xpic-recovery {CT-Pair-1 | CT-Pair-2} <RECOVERY>

Description
Use this command to enable or disable the automatic XPIC recovery procedure.
By default, automatic XPIC recovery is disabled.

Command Mode
Near End Radio Link Terminal XPIC submode — (config-rlt-xpic)

Operands

RECOVERY — enable — Enables automatic XPIC recovery


procedure.

— disable — Disables automatic XPIC recovery


procedure.

Options

CT-Pair-1 Specifies the first CT-pair. This parameter is used for


nodes in 2+0, 2 (1+0) CT 1/x/1, and CT 1/X/2
configurations. In 4+0 and 2+2 configurations, CT-Pair-1
is on the low slot.

CT-Pair-2 Specifies the second CT-pair. This parameter is used for


nodes in 4+0 and 2+2 configurations, where CT-Pair-2 is
on the high slot.

Examples
Enabling the automatic XPIC recovery procedure for CT-Pair-1:
ML66(config-rlt-xpic)#xpic-recovery CT-Pair-1 enable

42.5 xpic-restore

Synopsis
xpic-restore {CT-Pair-1 | CT-Pair-2}

Description
Use this command to restore XPIC functionality after XPIC recovery has been
triggered and the fault has been repaired.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 465


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Near End Radio Link Terminal XPIC submode — (config-rlt-xpic)

Options

CT-Pair-1 Specifies the first CT-pair. This parameter is used for


nodes in 2+0, 2 (1+0) CT 1/x/1, and CT 1/X/2
configurations. In 4+0 and 2+2 configurations, CT-Pair-1
is on the low slot.

CT-Pair-2 Specifies the second CT-pair. This parameter is used for


nodes in 4+0 and 2+2 configurations, where CT-Pair-2 is
on the high slot.

Examples
Restoring the XPIC functionality for CT-Pair-1:
ML66(config-rlt-xpic)#xpic-restore CT-Pair-1

466 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Radio Link Terminal Commands: TDM

43 Radio Link Terminal Commands: MMU 1001


and MMU 1002 - TDM

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
43.

The following command modes are applicable for MMU 1001 and MMU 1002
TDM commands:

— Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

— Far End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-ferlt)

— Near End Radio Link Terminal TDM submode — (config-rlt-tdm)

— Far End Radio Link Terminal TDM submode — (config-ferlt-fetdm)

Table 43 MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 - TDM Commands Overview


fetdm change to the (config-ferlt-fetdm)
submode of the upper level Radio Link
Terminal (RLT) at far end
rx-loop enable or disable the Rx loop
tdm change to the (config-rlt-tdm)
submode of the upper level RLT at
near end
tdm-connect connect or disconnect TDM to the
upper level Radio Link Terminal (RLT)
wanted-tdm-tributaries-allocation allocate TDM tributaries

The related show commands are the following:

— show fetdm

— show tdm

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

43.1 fetdm

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 467


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
fetdm

Description
Use this command to change to the (config-ferlt-fetdm) submode of the upper
level Radio Link Terminal (RLT) at far end.

Command Mode
Far End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-ferlt)

Examples
Changing to the (config-ferlt-fetdm) submode:
ML66(config-ferlt)#fetdm
ML66(config-ferlt-fetdm)#

43.2 rx-loop

Synopsis
rx-loop <LOOP>

Description
Use this command to enable or disable the Rx loop. By default, the Rx loop is
disabled.

Command Mode

— Near End Radio Link Terminal TDM submode — (config-rlt-tdm)

— Far End Radio Link Terminal TDM submode — (config-ferlt-fetdm)

Operands

LOOP — enable — Enables the Rx loop.

— disable — Disables the Rx loop.

Examples
Enabling the Rx loop:
ML66(config-rlt-tdm)#rx-loop enable

468 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Radio Link Terminal Commands: TDM

43.3 tdm

Synopsis
tdm

Description
Use this command to change to the (config-rlt-tdm) submode of the upper level
Radio Link Terminal (RLT) at near end.

Command Mode
Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

Examples
Changing to the (config-rlt-tdm) submode:
ML66(config-rlt)#tdm
ML66(config-rlt-tdm)#

43.4 tdm-connect

Synopsis
tdm-connect <CONNECT>

Description
Use this command to connect or disconnect TDM to the upper level Radio Link
Terminal (RLT). By default, the connection is disabled.

Command Mode

— Near End Radio Link Terminal TDM submode — (config-rlt-tdm)

— Far End Radio Link Terminal TDM submode — (config-ferlt-fetdm)

Operands

CONNECT — enable — Connects TDM to the upper level RLT.

— disable — Disconnects TDM from the upper level RLT.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 469


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Connecting TDM to the upper level RLT:
ML66(config-rlt-tdm)#tdm-connect enable

43.5 wanted-tdm-tributaries-allocation

Synopsis
wanted-tdm-tributaries-allocation <TDM-ALLOCATION>

Description
Use this command to allocate TDM tributaries.

Command Mode

— Near End Radio Link Terminal TDM submode — (config-rlt-tdm)

— Far End Radio Link Terminal TDM submode — (config-ferlt-fetdm)

Operands

TDM-ALLOCATION
The allocated TDM tributaries as ranges or single values.
The valid range is 0–80. The default value is 0.

Note: — When more than one tributaries are


specified, the values must be surrounded by
quotation marks and separated by commas.

— Use show tdm command to display the


maximum number of TDM tributaries, which
can be less than 80, in available-tdm-
tributaries row. The maximum number of
TDM tributaries supported by the current
configuration depends on the frame ID, the
maximum modulation, and the licensed
capacity.

Examples
Allocating 1–10 TDM tributaries:
ML66(config-rlt-tdm)#wanted-tdm-tributaries-allocation 1-10

Allocating 1–10, 15, and 55 TDM tributaries:

470 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Radio Link Terminal Commands: TDM

ML66(config-rlt-tdm)#wanted-tdm-tributaries-allocation "1-10,15,55"

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 471


CLI Descriptions

44 Carrier Termination Commands: MMU 1001


and MMU 1002

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
44.

The following command mode is applicable for the Carrier Termination (CT)
MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 command:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

Table 44 Carrier Termination Commands: MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 Overview
ct configure a specific Carrier
Termination (CT)
farend change to the (config-ct-far) submode

The related show commands are the following:

— show carrier-termination

— show carrier-termination-capability

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

44.1 ct

Synopsis
ct <DISTINGUISHED-NAME>

Description
Use this command to configure a specific Carrier Termination (CT). The command
also changes to the (config-ct) submode.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

472 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Carrier Termination Commands

Operands

DISTINGUISHED-NAME
The relative distinguished name of the CT where the
format is <Rack/Slot/Port> . The Port number is the CT
number, that is, 1 or 2.

Examples
Configuring CT 1:
ML66(config)#ct 1/1/1
ML66(config-ct)#

44.2 farend

Synopsis
farend

Description
Use this command to change to the (config-ct-far) submode.

Command Mode
Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

Examples
Changing to the (config-ct-far) submode:
ML66(config-ct)#farend
ML66(config-ct-far)#

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 473


CLI Descriptions

45 Carrier Termination Commands: MMU 1001


and MMU 1002 - Carrier

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
45.

The following command mode is applicable for MMU 1001 and MMU 1002
carrier commands:

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Table 45 MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 - Carrier Commands Overview


auto-remove-loop remove the IF and RF loops
automatically after 15 minutes
ber-alarm-threshold set the threshold for the Bit Error Ratio
(BER) alarm
carrier-id set the carrier ID, that is, the preamble
value of the radio frame
continuous_wave_mode enable or disable Continuous Wave
mode
description add a description about the CT
frame-id set the radio frame
if-loop enable or disable the IF loop
polarization set the antenna polarization
associated with the CT
reference-sec set the reference Spectrum Efficiency
Class (SEC)
reset reset the default CT settings
restore clear the IF and RF loops, turn the
RAU transmitter on, and set the
protection switch mode to Auto
rf-loop enable or disable the RF loop
sel-minAcm-maxAcm-Rsec set the minimum and maximum
Adaptive Coding and Modulation
(ACM) and the reference SEC at the
same time
selected-max-acm set the maximum ACM value
selected-min-acm set the minimum ACM value

474 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Carrier Termination Commands: Carrier

wanted-licensed-capacity set the wanted licensed capacity in


kbps

The related show commands are the following:

— show carrier-termination

— show carrier-termination-capability

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

45.1 auto-remove-loop

Synopsis
auto-remove-loop <LOOP>

Description
Use this command to remove the IF and RF loops automatically after 15 minutes.
By default, the automatic removal of the loops is disabled.

Command Mode
Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

Operands

LOOP — enable — Enables the automatic removal of the IF


and RF loops.

— disable — Disables the automatic removal of the IF


and RF loops.

Examples
Enabling the automatic removal of the IF and RF loops:
ML66(config-ct)#auto-remove-loop enable

45.2 ber-alarm-threshold

Synopsis
ber-alarm-threshold <BER>

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 475


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to set the threshold for the Bit Error Ratio (BER) alarm.

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Operands

BER The BER level. The default value is Ber1e3. The valid
values are the following:

— Ber1e3 — 10-3

— Ber1e4 — 10-4

— Ber1e5 — 10-5

— Ber1e6 — 10-6

Examples
Setting the threshold for the BER alarm to Ber1e6:
ML66(config-ct)#ber-alarm-threshold Ber1e6

45.3 carrier-id

Synopsis
carrier-id <PREAMBLE>

Description
Use this command to set the carrier ID, that is, the preamble value of the radio
frame.

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

476 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Carrier Termination Commands: Carrier

Operands

PREAMBLE The carrier ID, that is, the preamble value of the radio
frame. The preamble value is used in XPIC and MIMO
configurations and it must be the same on both sides of
the hop. The default value is A. The valid values are the
following:

— A

— B

— C

— D

Examples
Setting the carrier ID to B:
ML66(config-ct)#carrier-id B

45.4 continuous_wave_mode

Synopsis
continuous_wave_mode {enable | disable}

Description
Use this command to enable or disable Continuous Wave mode.

Note: Only admin_user can enable or disable Continuous Wave mode.

Continuous Wave is traffic-interrupting and is only to be used for


homologation or advanced troubleshooting.

This is a non-persistent configuration that is cleared after a warm


restart.

Command Mode
Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

Options

enable Enables Continuous Wave mode.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 477


CLI Descriptions

disable Disables Continuous Wave mode.

Examples
Enabling Continuous Wave mode:
ML66(config-ct)#continuous_wave_mode enable

45.5 description

Synopsis
description <LABEL>

Description
Use this command to add a description about the Carrier Termination (CT).

Command Mode
Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

Operands

LABEL The description of the CT. The maximum length of the


description is 32 characters.

Examples
Adding Site3A as description of the CT:
ML66(config-ct)#description Site3A

45.6 frame-id

Synopsis
frame-id <IDENTIFIER>

Description
Use this command to set the radio frame.

Note: To list the available frame IDs, use show carrier-termination-


capability command.

478 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Carrier Termination Commands: Carrier

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Operands

IDENTIFIER The unique identifier of the radio frame.

Examples
Setting the radio frame to 256:
ML66(config-ct)#frame-id 256

45.7 if-loop

Synopsis
if-looop <LOOP>

Description
Use this command to enable or disable the IF loop. By default, the IF loop is
disabled.

Command Mode
Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

Operands

LOOP — enable — Enables the IF loop.

— disable — Disables the IF loop.

Examples
Enabling the IF loop:
ML66(config-ct)#if-loop enable

45.8 polarization

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 479


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
polarization <POL>

Description
Use this command to set the antenna polarization associated with the Carrier
Termination (CT). By default, the antenna polarization is not specified.

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Operands

POL The antenna polarization associated with the CT when it


is used in XPIC and MIMO configurations. The
polarization must be the same on both sides of the hop.
The default value is NotSpecified. The valid values are
the following:

— horizontal

— vertical

— NotSpecified

Examples
Setting the antenna polarization to horizontal:
ML66(config-ct)#polarization horizontal

45.9 reference-sec

Synopsis
reference-sec <SEC>

Description
Use this command to set the reference Spectrum Efficiency Class (SEC).

480 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Carrier Termination Commands: Carrier

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Operands

SEC The value of the SEC. The default value is 2. The valid
values are the following:

— 2

— 4L

— 4H

— 5B

— 5LB

— 5HB

— 6B

— 6LB

— 6HB

— 7B

Examples
Setting the reference SEC to 4H:
ML66(config-ct)#reference-sec 4h

45.10 reset

Synopsis
reset

Description
Use this command to reset the default Carrier Termination (CT) settings.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 481


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

Examples
Resetting the default CT settings:
ML66(config-ct)#reset

45.11 restore

Synopsis
restore

Description
Use this command to clear the IF and RF loops, turn the RAU transmitter on, and
set the protection switch mode to Auto.

Command Mode
Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

Examples
Clearing the IF and RF loops and turning the RAU transmitter on:
ML66(config-ct)#restore

45.12 rf-loop

Synopsis
rf-loop <LOOP>

Description
Use this command to enable or disable the RF loop. By default, the RF loop is
disabled.

Command Mode
Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

482 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Carrier Termination Commands: Carrier

Operands

LOOP — enable — Enables the RF loop.

— disable — Disables the RF loop.

Examples
Enabling the RF loop:
ML66(config-ct)#rf-loop enable

45.13 sel-minAcm-maxAcm-Rsec

Synopsis
sel-minAcm-max-Acm-Rsec <MINACM> selected-max-acm <MAXACM>
reference-sec <SEC>

Description
Use this command to set the minimum and maximum Adaptive Coding and
Modulation (ACM) and the reference Spectrum Efficiency Class (SEC) at the same
time.

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Operands

MINACM / MAXACM
The minimum and the maximum value of the ACM in the
selected radio frame. The valid values are the following:

— 4_QAM_STRONG

— 4_QAM

— 4_QAM_LIGHT

— 16_QAM_STRONG

— 16_QAM

— 16_QAM_LIGHT

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 483


CLI Descriptions

— 32_QAM_STRONG

— 32_QAM

— 32_QAM_LIGHT

— 64_QAM_STRONG

— 64_QAM

— 64_QAM_LIGHT

— 128_QAM_STRONG

— 128_QAM

— 128_QAM_LIGHT

— 256_QAM_STRONG

— 256_QAM

— 256_QAM_LIGHT

— 512_QAM_STRONG

— 512_QAM

— 512_QAM_LIGHT

— 1024_QAM_STRONG

— 1024_QAM

— 1024_QAM_LIGHT

— 2048_QAM_STRONG

— 2048_QAM

— 2048_QAM_LIGHT

— 4096_QAM_STRONG

— 4094_QAM

— 4096_QAM_LIGHT

SEC The value of the SEC. The default value is 2. The valid
values are the following:

484 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Carrier Termination Commands: Carrier

— 2

— 4L

— 4H

— 5B

— 5LB

— 5HB

— 6B

— 6LB

— 6HB

— 7B

Examples
Setting the minimum ACM to 4QAM, the maximum ACM to 64QAM, and the
reference SEC to 4H:
ML66(config-ct)#sel-minAcm-maxAcm-Rsec 4_qam selected-max-acm 64_qam reference-sec →
4h

45.14 selected-max-acm

Synopsis
selected-max-acm <MAXACM>

Description
Use this command to set the maximum Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM)
value.

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 485


CLI Descriptions

Operands

MINACM The maximum value of the ACM in the selected radio


frame. The valid values are the following:

— 4_QAM_STRONG

— 4_QAM

— 4_QAM_LIGHT

— 16_QAM_STRONG

— 16_QAM

— 16_QAM_LIGHT

— 32_QAM_STRONG

— 32_QAM

— 32_QAM_LIGHT

— 64_QAM_STRONG

— 64_QAM

— 64_QAM_LIGHT

— 128_QAM_STRONG

— 128_QAM

— 128_QAM_LIGHT

— 256_QAM_STRONG

— 256_QAM

— 256_QAM_LIGHT

— 512_QAM_STRONG

— 512_QAM

— 512_QAM_LIGHT

— 1024_QAM_STRONG

— 1024_QAM

486 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Carrier Termination Commands: Carrier

— 1024_QAM_LIGHT

— 2048_QAM_STRONG

— 2048_QAM

— 2048_QAM_LIGHT

— 4096_QAM_STRONG

— 4094_QAM

— 4096_QAM_LIGHT

Examples
Setting the maximum ACM to 64QAM:
ML66(config-ct)#selected-max-acm 64_qam

45.15 selected-min-acm

Synopsis
selected-min-acm <MINACM>

Description
Use this command to set the minimum Adaptive Coding and Modulation (ACM)
value.

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Operands

MINACM The minimum value of the ACM in the selected radio


frame. The valid values are the following:

— 4_QAM_STRONG

— 4_QAM

— 4_QAM_LIGHT

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 487


CLI Descriptions

— 16_QAM_STRONG

— 16_QAM

— 16_QAM_LIGHT

— 32_QAM_STRONG

— 32_QAM

— 32_QAM_LIGHT

— 64_QAM_STRONG

— 64_QAM

— 64_QAM_LIGHT

— 128_QAM_STRONG

— 128_QAM

— 128_QAM_LIGHT

— 256_QAM_STRONG

— 256_QAM

— 256_QAM_LIGHT

— 512_QAM_STRONG

— 512_QAM

— 512_QAM_LIGHT

— 1024_QAM_STRONG

— 1024_QAM

— 1024_QAM_LIGHT

— 2048_QAM_STRONG

— 2048_QAM

— 2048_QAM_LIGHT

— 4096_QAM_STRONG

— 4094_QAM

488 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Carrier Termination Commands: Carrier

— 4096_QAM_LIGHT

Examples
Setting the minimum ACM to 16QAM Strong:
ML66(config-ct)#selected-min-acm 16_qam_strong

45.16 wanted-licensed-capacity

Synopsis
wanted-licensed-capacity <LICENSE>

Description
Use this command to set the wanted licensed capacity in kbps.

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Operands

LICENSE The wanted traffic licensed capacity in kbps. The default


value is 0, that is, the capacity is not selected by the user.

Examples
Setting the wanted licensed capacity to 25000 kbps:
ML66(config-ct)#wanted-licensed-capacity 25000

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 489


CLI Descriptions

46 Carrier Termination Commands: MMU 1001


and MMU 1002 - Frequency

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
46.

The following command mode is applicable for MMU 1001 and MMU 1002
frequency commands:

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Table 46 MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 - Frequency Commands Overview


duplex-configuration enable or disable duplex configuration
duplex-distance set the distance between the Tx and
Rx frequencies
rx-frequency set the receiver frequency
tx-admin-status set the administrative status of the
transmitter
tx-frequency set the transmitter frequency

The related show commands are the following:

— show rf-frequency

— show rx-frequency

— show tx-frequency

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

46.1 duplex-configuration

Synopsis
duplex-configuration <DUPLEX-CONF>

490 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Carrier Termination Commands: Frequency

Description
Use this command to enable or disable duplex configuration. By default, the
duplex configuration is disabled.

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Operands

DUPLEX-CONF — enable — Enables duplex configuration, that is, the


Rx frequency is calculated from the Tx frequency and
the duplex distance.

Note: Only applicable if the duplex type is


variable, otherwise the duplex
configuration is disabled.

— disable — Disables duplex configuration, that is, the


Rx frequency and the Tx frequency are directly
specified.

Examples
Enabling the duplex configuration:
ML66(config-ct)#duplex-configuration enable

46.2 duplex-distance

Synopsis
duplex-distance <DUPLEX-DIST>

Description
Use this command to set the distance between the Tx and Rx frequencies.

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 491


CLI Descriptions

Operands

DUPLEX-DIST The distance between the Tx and the Rx frequencies in


MHz.

Note: Only applicable if the duplex type is variable


and the duplex configuration is enabled.

Examples
Setting the distance between the Tx and Rx frequencies to 266 MHz:
ML66(config-ct)#duplex-distance 266

46.3 rx-frequency

Synopsis
rx-frequency <FREQUENCY>

Description
Use this command to set the receiver frequency.

Note: The Rx frequency can only be set if the duplex configuration is disabled,
otherwise it is read-only.

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Operands

FREQUENCY The Rx frequency in kHz.

Examples
Setting the Rx frequency to 7604000 kHz:
ML66(config-ct)#rx-frequency 7604000

46.4 tx-admin-status

492 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Carrier Termination Commands: Frequency

Synopsis
tx-admin-status <STATUS>

Description
Use this command to set the administrative status of the transmitter.

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Operands

STATUS The administrative status of the transmitter. The default


value is Off. The valid values are the following:

— Off

— On

Examples
Setting the administrative status of the transmitter to on:
ML66(config-ct)#tx-admin-status On

46.5 tx-frequency

Synopsis
tx-frequency <FREQUENCY>

Description
Use this command to set the transmitter frequency.

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 493


CLI Descriptions

Operands

FREQUENCY The Tx frequency in kHz.

Examples
Setting the Tx frequency to 7450000 kHz:
ML66(config-ct)#tx-frequency 7450000

494 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Carrier Termination Commands: Spectrum Diagnostics

47 Carrier Termination Commands: MMU 1001


and MMU 1002 - Spectrum Diagnostics

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
47.

The following command mode is applicable for the MMU 1001 and MMU 1002
Spectrum Diagnostics commands:

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

Table 47 MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 Spectrum Diagnostics Commands


Overview
spectrum_diagnostics scan_start on perform a scan of the channel around
page 495 the operating Rx frequency or of the
sub-band of the connected RAU
spectrum_diagnostics scan_stop on stop a Spectrum Diagnostics scan
page 496

The related show commands are the following:

— show spectrum-diagnostics-result

— show spectrum-diagnostics-status

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

47.1 spectrum_diagnostics scan_start

Synopsis
spectrum_diagnostics scan_start {channel | subband}

Description
Use this command to perform a scan of the channel around the operating Rx
frequency or of the sub-band of the connected RAU.

The channel scan is performed between (operating Rx frequency − (channel


space ÷ 2) + 1 MHz) and (operating Rx frequency + (channel space ÷ 2) − 1 MHz)
in 2 MHz steps.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 495


CLI Descriptions

The sub-band scan is performed between (Rx lower edge + 1 MHz) and (Rx
upper edge − 1 MHz) in 2 MHz steps.

Use the spectrum_diagnostics scan_stop command to stop a running scan.

Command Mode
Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

Options

channel Specifies to start a Spectrum Diagnostics scan on the


channel around the configured Rx frequency.

subband Specifies to start a Spectrum Diagnostics scan on the


RAU sub-band.

Examples
Starting a channel scan:
ML66#spectrum_diagnostics scan_start channel

47.2 spectrum_diagnostics scan_stop

Synopsis
spectrum_diagnostics scan_stop

Description
Use this command to stop a Spectrum Diagnostics scan.

Command Mode
Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

Examples
Stopping a running scan:
ML66(config-ct)#spectrum_diagnostics scan_stop

496 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Carrier Termination Commands: Power

48 Carrier Termination Commands: MMU 1001


and MMU 1002 - Power

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
48.

The following command mode is applicable for MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 power
commands:

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Table 48 MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 - Power Commands Overview


input-power-alarm-threshold set the threshold for the input power
alarm
selected-max-output-power set the maximum output power of the
transmitter
selected-min-output-power set the minimum output power of the
transmitter
selected-output-power set the minimum and maximum
output power of the transmitter at the
same time
selected-output-power-type set the output power type
taps enable or disable Traffic Aware Power
Save (TAPS)
target-input-power-far-end set the target input power at the far
end

The related show command is the following:

— show rf-power

— show taps

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

48.1 input-power-alarm-threshold

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 497


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
input-power-alarm-threshold <POWER>

Description
Use this command to set the threshold for the input power alarm.

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Operands

POWER The threshold for the input power of the receiver in dBm.
The valid range is from −99 to −30 dBm. The default
value is −93 dBm.

Examples
Setting the threshold for the input power alarm to −70 dBm:
ML66(config-ct)#input-power-alarm-threshold -70

48.2 selected-max-output-power

Synopsis
selected-max-output-power <POWER>

Description
Use this command to set the maximum output power of the transmitter. By
default, the output power is 10 dBm.

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Operands

POWER The maximum output power of the transmitter in dBm.

498 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Carrier Termination Commands: Power

Examples
Setting the maximum output power of the transmitter to 15 dBm:
ML66(config-ct)#selected-max-output-power 15

48.3 selected-min-output-power

Synopsis
selected-min-output-power <POWER>

Description
Use this command to set the minimum output power of the transmitter. By
default, the output power is 10 dBm.

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Operands

POWER The minimum output power of the transmitter in dBm.

Examples
Setting the minimum output power of the transmitter to −5 dBm:
ML66(config-ct)#selected-min-output-power -5

48.4 selected-output-power

Synopsis
selected-output-power <MINPOWER> <MAXPOWER>

Description
Use this command to set the minimum and maximum output power of the
transmitter at the same time. By default, the output power is 10 dBm.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 499


CLI Descriptions

Note: The maximum output power must be greater or equal to the minimum
output power.

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Operands

MINPOWER The minimum output power of the transmitter in dBm.

MAXPOWER The maximum output power of the transmitter in dBm.

Examples
Setting the minimum output power to −5 dBm and the maximum output power
to 15 dBm:
ML66(config-ct)#selected-output-power -5 15

48.5 selected-output-power-type

Synopsis
selected-output-power-type <POWERTYPE>

Description
Use this command to set the output power type.

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Operands

POWERTYPE The type of the output power. The default value is


standard. The valid values are the following:

— standard

— high

500 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Carrier Termination Commands: Power

Note: When the output power type is high, an HP


license key is required.

Examples
Setting the output power type to high:
ML66(config-ct)#selected-output-power-type high

48.6 taps

Synopsis
taps <TAPS>

Description
Use this command to enable or disable Traffic Aware Power Save (TAPS).

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Operands

TAPS The wanted setting of TAPS. The valid values are the
following:

— enable

— disable

Note: When the setting is enabled, an Energy Efficiency license is needed.

Examples
Enabling TAPS:
ML66(config-ct)#taps enable

Disabling TAPS:
ML66(config-ct)#taps disable

48.7 target-input-power-far-end

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 501


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
target-input-power-far-end <POWER>

Description
Use this command to set the target input power at the far end.

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Operands

POWER The target input power of the receiver in dBm at the far
end. The valid range is from −99 to −30 dBm. The default
value is −35 dBm.

Examples
Setting the target input power of the receiver to −45 dBm:
ML66(config-ct)#target-input-power-far-end -45

502 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Interfaces

49 Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Interfaces

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
49.

The following command modes are applicable for the Ethernet interfaces
commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Ethernet interface configuration submode — (config-eth)

— Ethernet MAC White List configuration submode — (config-eth-mac-


whitelist)

— LAN configuration submode — (config-lan)

— WAN configuration submode — (config-wan)

Table 49 Ethernet Interfaces Commands Overview


alarm-enable enable or disable alarms
autoneg set the port to auto negotiation
flowcontrol activate flow control on the port
interface ethernet change to the (config-eth) submode
lan change to the (config-lan) submode
lock-to-service lock the interface to the common Ethernet
service parameters
mdix set the Medium Dependent Interface/Medium
Dependent Interface Crossover (MDI/MDIX)
configuration for the Ethernet port
name set an alias name for the interface
qos change to the (config-qos) submode
shutdown disable the interface
speed set the Ethernet speed
sync-enable enable or disable sync Ethernet
trapenable enable alarms and events
wan change to the (config-wan) submode

The related show commands are the following:

— show alarms

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 503


CLI Descriptions

— show bridge-port

— show interface ethernet

— show interface ethernet status

— show qos

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

49.1 alarm-enable

Synopsis
[no] alarm-enable [ sync-unsupported | ethernet-down ]

Description
Use this command to enable or disable sync unsupported or Ethernet down
alarms.

Command Mode
LAN configuration submode — (config-lan)

Options

sync-unsupported
Enables or disables synch unsupported alarm.

ethernet-down Enables or disables Ethernet down alarm.

Examples
Enabling sync unsupported alarm:
ML66(config-lan)#alarm-enable sync-unsupported

49.2 autoneg

Synopsis
[no] autoneg

504 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Interfaces

Description
Use this command to set the port to auto negotiation. This is the default
behavior.

Use the no option to disable auto negotiation.

Command Mode
LAN configuration submode — (config-lan)

Examples
Disabling auto negotiation:
ML66(config-lan)#no autoneg

49.3 flowcontrol

Synopsis
[no] flowcontrol [autoneg]

Description
Use this command to activate flow control on the port.

Use the no option to deactivate flow control.

Command Mode
LAN configuration submode — (config-lan)

Options

autoneg Enables flow control using the Auto Negotiation protocol.

Examples
Deactivating flow control:
ML66(config-lan)#no flowcontrol

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 505


CLI Descriptions

49.4 interface ethernet

Synopsis
interface ethernet <RSP>

Description
Use this command to configure a selected interface. The command also changes
to the (config-eth) submode.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port value of the interface where the
format is <Rack/Slot/Port>.

Examples
Configuring LAN interface:
ML66(config)#interface ethernet 1/6/5
ML66(config-eth)#

49.5 lan

Synopsis
lan

Description
Use this command to change to the (config-lan) submode.

Command Mode
Ethernet interface configuration submode — (config-eth)

Examples
Changing to the (config-lan) submode:
ML66(config-eth)#lan
ML66(config-lan)#

506 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Interfaces

49.6 lock-to-service

Synopsis
[no] lock-to-service

Description
Use this command to lock the interface to the common Ethernet service
parameters. This means that the interface inherits the bridge level scheduler and
queue-set profiles and that these profiles cannot be changed at interface level.
This is the default behavior.

Use the no option to unlock the interface from the common Ethernet service
parameters. This means that the interface does not inherit the bridge level
scheduler and queue-set profiles, so the assignment of these profiles is done
individually at interface level.

Command Mode
Interface QoS configuration submode — (config-qos)

Examples
Unlocking the interface from Ethernet service parameters:
ML66(config-qos)#no lock-to-service

49.7 mdix

Synopsis
[no] mdix { manual-switched | manual-normal | auto }

Description
Use this command to set the Medium Dependent Interface/Medium Dependent
Interface Crossover (MDI/MDIX) configuration for the Ethernet interface.

Command Mode
LAN configuration submode — (config-lan)

Options

manual-switched Sets the configuration to MDIX.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 507


CLI Descriptions

manual-normal Sets the configuration to MDI.

auto Makes the system set the MDI/MDIX configuration


automatically.

Examples
Setting configuration to MDIX:
ML66(config-lan)#mdix manual-switched

49.8 name

Synopsis

— name <NAME>

— no name

Description
Use this command to set an alias name for the interface.

Use the no option to set the alias name to the default empty string.

Command Mode
Ethernet interface configuration submode — (config-eth)

Operands

NAME The alias name of the interface.

Examples
Setting an alias name for the interface:
ML66(config-eth)#name "my alias"

49.9 qos

Synopsis
qos

508 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Interfaces

Description
Use this command to change to the (config-qos) submode.

Command Mode
Ethernet interface configuration submode — (config-eth)

Examples
Changing to the (config-qos) submode:
ML66(config-eth)#qos
ML66(config-qos)#

49.10 shutdown

Synopsis
[no] shutdown

Description
Use this command to disable the interface.

Use the no option to enable the interface.

Command Mode
Ethernet interface configuration submode — (config-eth)

Examples
Disabling the interface:
ML66(config-eth)#shutdown

49.11 speed

Synopsis
speed { auto-detect | full-duplex10 | full-duplex100 | full-
duplexSlave100 | full-duplexMaster100 | full-duplex1000 | full-
duplexSlave1000 | full-duplexMaster1000 | full-duplex2500 }

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 509


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to set the Ethernet speed. By default, the speed is set to auto
detect.

Command Mode
LAN configuration submode — (config-lan)

Options

auto-detect Makes the system detect the speed automatically.

full-duplex10 Sets the speed to 10 Mbps full-duplex.

full-duplex100 Sets the speed to 100 Mbps full-duplex.

full-duplexSlave100
Sets the speed to 100 Mbps full-duplex and configures
the port as receiver of Ethernet sync.

full-duplexMaster100
Sets the speed to 100 Mbps full-duplex and configures
the port as transmitter of Ethernet sync.

full-duplex1000 Sets the speed to 1000 Mbps full-duplex.

full-duplexSlave1000
Sets the speed to 1000 Mbps full-duplex and configures
the port as receiver of Ethernet sync.

full-duplexMaster1000
Sets the speed to 1000 Mbps full-duplex and configures
the port as transmitter of Ethernet sync.

full-duplex2500 Sets the speed to 2500 Mbps full-duplex when applicable


optical SFP is used.

Examples
Setting the speed to 100 Mbps full-duplex:
ML66(config-lan)#speed full-duplex100

49.12 sync-enable

510 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Interfaces

Synopsis

— sync-enable [noESMC]

— no synch-enable

Description
Use this command to enable or disable sync Ethernet.

Command Mode
LAN configuration submode — (config-lan)

Operands

noESMC Enables sync Ethernet without Ethernet Synchronization


Messaging Channel (ESMC) signaling.

Examples
Enabling sync Ethernet:
ML66(config-lan)#sync-enable

49.13 trapenable

Synopsis
[no] trapenable

Description
Use this command to enable alarms and events. This command overrules media-
specific settings.

Use the no option to disable alarms and events.

Command Mode
Ethernet interface configuration submode — (config-eth)

Examples
Disabling alarms and events:
ML66(config-eth)#no trapenable

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 511


CLI Descriptions

49.14 wan

Synopsis
wan

Description
Use this command to change to the (config-wan) submode.

Command Mode
Ethernet interface configuration submode — (config-eth)

Examples
Changing to the (config-wan) submode:
ML66(config-eth)#wan
ML66(config-wan)#

512 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Bridging and Switching

50 Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Bridging and


Switching

Table 50.

The following command modes are applicable for the Ethernet bridging in and
switching commands:

— Privileged Exec mode — #This section contains detailed information about


the commands listed

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Layer 1 configuration submode — (config-eth-epl)

— Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

— VLAN configuration submode — (config-vlan)

— VLANs configuration submode — (config-vlans)

— VLAN FDB configuration submode — (config-vlan-fdb)

— QinQ configuration submode — (config-qinqtermination)

Table 50 Ethernet Bridging and Switching Commands Overview


add add a row to the termination table of the
bridge port
add-egressports add ports as member of a VLAN
add-untagged-ports add untagged ports to VLAN
bridge mode set the bridge mode to customer or provider
bridge-port configure bridge ports
bridge tp-agingtime set the time-out period for aging of
dynamically-learned forwarding information
clear mac-address-table clear the MAC address table
egressports specify the list of ports that are members of
this VLAN
ethernet-epl configure a Layer 1 connection between two
Layer service ports
fdb configure Forwarding of Database (FDB)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 513


CLI Descriptions

forward-unregistered-multicast specify if multicast frames are forwarded to all


member ports of the VLAN
l3enable (Ethernet Port) create an L3 interface with the given VLAN for
the Ethernet port
llf-enable enable link loss forwarding
maxfs set the maximum frame size for this port
name set a name for this VLAN
port-ether-type set the EtherType of the outer VLAN on the
configured interface
qinqtermination configure the QinQ termination table for the
bridge port
remove remove a row from the termination table of the
bridge port
role set the role of the port
static-multicast specify set of ports that must be forwarded
static-unicast define which port unicast packets can be
routed
untagged-ports specify the ports of this VLAN that transmit
untagged egress packets
vlan create a new VLAN entry or modify an existing
VLAN entry
vlans create and configure a range of new VLANs
vlan-statistics-enable on page enable or disable VLAN statistics
532

The related show commands are the following:

— show bridge-port

— show current

— show epl

— show vlan

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

50.1 add

514 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Bridging and Switching

Synopsis
Adding a single row to the termination table:

add <CeVID> <PeVID>

Description
Use this command to add a row to the termination table of the bridge port. After
the execution of the command, the termination entry is active on the port.

Note: By default Ethernet frames are transmitted unchanged over a bridge


port if the termination does not contain any matching entries for them.

Command Mode
QinQ configuration submode — (config-qinqtermination)

Operands

CeVID The incoming VLAN tag. It can be extended by the outer


VLAN tag. The valid range is 0–4094.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 515


CLI Descriptions

Note: — A UNI port might give different outer VLAN


tags to different incoming VLAN tags. The
rule is the following:

• Ingress frames with Ce VLAN IDs


explicitly specified get the
corresponding Pe VLAN IDs.

• Ingress frames with VLAN IDs not


specified either as Ce VLAN ID or Pe
VLAN ID are forwarded without the
addition of a second VLAN tag if the
port is configured to be member of the
VLAN.

• When there is no default mapping rule


specified for a port, if a VLAN ID is
configured as Pe VLAN ID for a port,
and there is no entry for that port with
that ID as Ce VLAN ID, ingress frames
with that VLAN ID are dropped for that
port.

• When the operand is set to 0, a default


mapping rule is specified. If none of the
above rules apply for an ingress C-
tagged frame, it is tagged with an
additional C-tag, using the
corresponding (default) Pe VLAN ID.
When QinQ is configured for a port, the
port can be an untagged member of a
VLAN only if there is a default QinQ
mapping rule specified.

PeVID The outer VLAN tag. The valid range is 1–4094.

Examples
Adding a row to the termination table of the bridge port:
ML66(config-qinqtermination)#add 100 201

50.2 add-egressports

Synopsis
add-egressports <PORTLIST>

Description
Use this command to add egress ports to VLAN. Already existing ports are kept.

516 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Bridging and Switching

Command Mode
VLAN configuration submode — (config-vlan)

Operands

PORTLIST List of ports in <Rack/Slot/Port> format. The RSP values


are separated by commas.

Examples
Adding VLAN member ports:
ML66(config-vlan)#add-egressports 1/6/0,1/6/5

50.3 add-untagged-ports

Synopsis
add-untagged-ports <PORTLIST>

Description
Use this command to add egressports as untagged ports in a VLAN. Only ports
that are already added as egressports can be added as untagged.

Command Mode
VLAN configuration submode — (config-vlan)

Operands

PORTLIST List of ports in <Rack/Slot/Port> format. The RSP values


are separated by commas.

Examples
Adding untagged ports to VLAN:
ML66(config-vlan)#add-untagged-ports 1/6/4,1/6/5

50.4 bridge mode

Synopsis
bridge mode dot1 { q | ad }

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 517


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to set the bridge mode to customer or provider.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Options

q Sets the bridge mode to customer mode.

ad Sets the bridge mode to provider mode.

Examples
Setting the bridge mode to provider mode:
ML66(config)#bridge mode dot1 ad

50.5 bridge-port

Synopsis
bridge-port

Description
Use this command to configure the bridge ports in the Ethernet bridge. The
command also changes to the (config-bridgeport) submode.

Command Mode
Ethernet interface configuration submode — (config-eth)

Examples
Configuring bridge port:
ML66(config-eth)#bridge-port
ML66(config-bridgeport)#

50.6 bridge tp-agingtime

518 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Bridging and Switching

Synopsis

— bridge tp-agingtime <TIME>

— no bridge tp-agingtime

Description
Use this command to set the time-out period for aging of dynamically-learned
forwarding information.

Use the no option to reset the default value.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

TIME Time-out period in seconds. The value can be set from 10


to 1000000. The default value is 300 seconds.

Examples
Setting the aging to 200 seconds:
ML66(config)#bridge tp-agingtime 200

50.7 clear mac-address-table

Synopsis
clear mac-address-table

Description
Use this command to clear the Media Access Control (MAC) address table.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Examples
Clearing the MAC address table:
ML66#clear mac-address-table

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 519


CLI Descriptions

50.8 egressports

Synopsis

— egressports <PORTLIST>

— no egressports [<PORTLIST>]

Description
In the (config-vlan) submode, use this command as follows:

— Specify the list of ports that are members of this VLAN. For the available
ports in customer and provider mode, see Table 51.

Note: This command replaces any existing port list. See add-egressports
for adding ports to an existing port list.

— Use the no option without <PORTLIST> operand to clear the whole port list.

Use the no option with <PORTLIST> operand to remove only the selected
ports from the port list.

In the (config-vlans) submode, use this command as follows:

— Specify the list of ports that are members of all VLANs in the range of VLANs
added by the vlans command. For the available ports in customer and
provider mode, see Table 51.

Note: This command replaces any existing port list.

— Use the no option without <PORTLIST> operand to clear the whole port list.

Use the no option with <PORTLIST> operand to remove only the selected
ports from the port list.

Table 51 Egressports in Customer and Provider mode


Switch Mode Port Role Allowed to Be Egressport
UNI Yes
Customer mode
I-NNI Yes
CE-UNI No
Provider mode CN-UNI Yes
I-NNI (PN) Yes

Note: Ports with mirror role cannot be added to a VLAN.

520 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Bridging and Switching

Command Mode
VLAN configuration submode — (config-vlan)

VLANs configuration submode — (config-vlans)

Operands

PORTLIST The egress port list in <Rack/Slot/Port> format. The RSP


values are separated by commas.

Examples
Specifying the egress port list for this VLAN as 1/6/4 and 1/6/5:
ML66(config-vlan)#egressports 1/6/4,1/6/5

50.9 ethernet-epl

Synopsis

— [no] ethernet-epl <RSP> <RSP>

— [no] ethernet-epl port1 <RSP> port2 <RSP>

Description
Use this command to configure a Layer 1 connection between two Layer 1
interfaces. The command also changes to the (config-eth-epl) submode.

Use the no option to remove the connection.

Note: EPL configuration cannot be deleted if any EPL interfaces are used in
DCN over VLAN for a Layer 1 connection. For more information see
Configuring DCN over VLAN for Layer 1 Connections.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port value of the interface where the
format is <Rack/Slot/Port>.

Examples
Configuring Layer 1 connection between interfaces 1/6/4 and 1/6/5:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 521


CLI Descriptions

ML66(config)#ethernet-epl port1 1/6/4 port2 1/6/5


ML66(config-eth-epl)#

50.10 fdb

Synopsis
[no] fdb

Description
Use this command to configure the Forwarding Database (FDB) of this VLAN.
The command also changes to the (config-vlan-fdb) submode.

Command Mode
VLAN configuration submode — (config-vlan)

Examples
Configuring FDB:
ML66(config-vlan)#fdb
ML66(config-vlan-fdb)#

50.11 forward-unregistered-multicast

Synopsis
[no] forward-unregistered-multicast

Description
In the (config-vlan) submode, use this command as follows:

— Specify if multicast group-addressed frames for which there is no more


specific forwarding information are to be forwarded to all member ports of
the VLAN or not. Default value is Forward.

— Use the no option to switch to Filter mode.

In the (config-vlans) submode, use this command as follows:

— Specify if multicast group-addressed frames for which there is no more


specific forwarding information are to be forwarded to all member ports of
all VLANs or not in the range of VLANs added by the vlans command.
Default value is Forward.

522 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Bridging and Switching

— Use the no option to switch to Filter mode.

Command Mode
VLAN configuration submode — (config-vlan)

VLANs configuration submode — (config-vlans)

Examples
Forwarding frames to all member ports of the VLAN:
ML66(config-vlan)#forward-unregistered-multicast

50.12 llf-enable

Synopsis
[no] llf-enable

Description
Use this command to enable link loss forwarding.

Use the no option to disable link loss forwarding.

Command Mode
Layer 1 configuration submode — (config-eth-epl)

Examples
Enabling link loss forwarding:
ML66(config-eth-epl)#llf-enable

50.13 maxfs

Synopsis
maxfs <MAXFRAMESIZE>

Description
Use this command to set the maximum frame size for this port. The frame size
can be set for UNI, CE-UNI, and CN-UNI ports.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 523


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Operands

MAXFRAMESIZE The maximum frame size. The valid range is 1518–9216.


The default value is 2000.

Examples
Setting the maximum frame size to 1518:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#maxfs 1518

50.14 name

Synopsis

— name <NAME>

— no name

Description
In the (config-vlan) submode, use this command as follows:

— Set the name of this VLAN.

— Use the no option to clear the name of the VLAN.

In the (config-vlans) submode, use this command as follows:

— Set the name of all VLANs to the same value in the range of VLANs added by
the vlans command.

— Use the no option to clear the name of all VLANs.

Command Mode
VLAN configuration submode — (config-vlan)

VLANs configuration submode — (config-vlans)

Operands

NAME The name of the VLAN.

524 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Bridging and Switching

Examples
Setting the name for this VLAN to DCN:
ML66(config-vlan)#name DCN

50.15 port-ether-type

Synopsis
port-ether-type <ETHERTYPE>

Description
Use this command to set the Ethertype, also known as Tag Protocol Identifier
(TPID), of the outer VLAN on the configured interface.

Ethertype changing is used when at the other end of the connection a legacy
hardware is placed that is only able to handle a specific VLAN type, typically with
0x8100 (also known as C-tag) value in the TPID field. When the TPID is changed
on the edge node interface of the provider bridge, frames received from the QinQ
domain are swapped from TPID 0x8100 to TPID 0x88A8, while frames
transmitted to the QinQ domain are swapped from TPID 0x88A8 to TPID
0x8100.

Note: Ethertype changing is only supported on I-NNI ports in Provider Bridge


mode.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Operands

ETHERTYPE The Ethertype or TPID value. The valid values are


0x8100 and 0x88A8.

Examples
Changing the Ethertype from 0x88A8 to 0x8100:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#port-ether-type 0x8100

50.16 qinqtermination

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 525


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
qinqtermination

Description
Use this command to configure the QinQ termination table for the bridge port in
the Ethernet bridge. The command also changes to the (config-qinqtermination)
submode.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Examples
Configuring the QinQ termination table:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#qinqtermination
ML66(config-qinqtermination)#

50.17 remove

Synopsis
Removing a single row from the termination table:

remove <CeVID>

Description
Use this command to remove a row from the termination table of the bridge port.
After the execution of the command, the termination entry is no longer available
in the termination table.

Command Mode
QinQ configuration submode — (config-qinqtermination)

Operands

CeVID The incoming VLAN tag. The valid range is 0–4094.

526 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Bridging and Switching

Note: — After removing the default mapping rule, all


C-tagged frames with Ce VLAN IDs not
specified in the QinQ Termination table are
discarded.

— If a port with QinQ Termination configured


is set to be member of VLANs which have
VLAN IDs configured neither as Ce VLAN ID
nor Pe VLAN ID of a QinQ Termination rule,
ingress traffic with those VLAN IDs is
accepted without the addition of a second C-
VLAN tag.

Examples
Removing a row from the termination table of the bridge port:
ML66(config-qinqtermination)#remove 100

50.18 role

Synopsis
role {uni | inni | mirror | cep | cnp | layer1}

Description
Use this command to set the role of the port.

Command Mode
Ethernet interface configuration submode — (config-eth)

Options

uni Sets the role to UNI. Only applicable for customer mode.

inni Sets the role to I-NNI. Applicable for both customer and
provider mode.

mirror Sets the role of the port to mirror. Applicable for both
customer and provider mode.

cep Sets the role to Customer Edge Port (CEP). This role is
called CE-UNI in MINI-LINK Node GUI. Only applicable
for provider mode.

cnp Sets the role to Customer Network Port (CNP). This role is
called CN-UNI in MINI-LINK Node GUI. Only applicable
for provider mode.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 527


CLI Descriptions

layer1 Sets the role to Layer 1. Applicable for both customer and
provider mode.

Examples
Setting the role to CE-UNI:
ML66(config-eth)#role cep

50.19 static-multicast

Synopsis

— static-multicast dest-mac <MAC> egressports <PORTLIST>

— no static-multicast dest-mac <MAC>

Description
Use this command to specify the set of ports to which frames destined for a
specific Multicast or Broadcast Media Access Control (MAC) address must be
forwarded.

Command Mode
VLAN FDB configuration submode — (config-vlan-fdb)

Operands

MAC Destination MAC address.

PORTLIST List of ports in <Rack/Slot/Port> format. The RSP values


are separated by commas.

Examples
Adding a static multicast filter where packets can be forwarded to ports 1/6/4
and 1/6/5:
ML66(config-vlan-fdb)#static-multicast dest-mac 0C:0C:0B:14:CD:F3 //
egressport 1/6/4,1/6/5

50.20 static-unicast

Synopsis

— static-unicast dest-mac <MAC> allowedtogotoports <RSP>

528 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Bridging and Switching

— no static-unicast dest-mac <MAC>

Description
Use this command to define to which port unicast packets destined for a specific
Media Access Control (MAC) address must be forwarded.

Command Mode
VLAN FDB configuration submode — (config-vlan-fdb)

Operands

MAC Destination MAC address.

RSP Egress port in <Rack/Slot/Port> format.

Examples
Defining unicast packets that can be routed:
ML66(config-vlan-fdb)#static-unicast dest-mac 0C:0C:0B:14:CD:F3 //
allowedtogotoports 1/6/5

50.21 untagged-ports

Synopsis
[noPORTLIST]> untagged-ports

Description
Use this command to define the port list of untagged ports to be included in a
VLAN. Only ports that are already added as egressports can be added as
untagged. For the available ports in customer and provider mode, see Table 52.

Note: This command replaces any existing port list. See add-untagged-ports
for adding ports to an existing port list.

Use the no option without <PORTLIST> operand to clear the whole port list.

Use the no option with <PORTLIST> operand to remove only the selected ports
from the port list.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 529


CLI Descriptions

Table 52 Untagged Ports in Customer and Provider mode


Switch Mode Port Role Allowed to Be Untagged
Port
UNI Yes
Customer mode
I-NNI No
CE-UNI No
Provider mode CN-UNI Yes
I-NNI (PN) No

Command Mode
VLAN configuration submode — (config-vlan)

Operands

PORTLIST The port list in <<Rack/Slot/Port> format. The RSP


values are separated by commas.

Examples
Specifying that port 1/6/5 transmits untagged egress packets:
ML66(config-vlan)#untagged-ports 1/6/5

50.22 vlan

Synopsis
[no] vlan <VLANID> [<NAME> ]

Description
Use this command to create a new VLAN entry or to modify an existing VLAN
entry by using the ID of the specified VLAN. The command also changes to the
(config-vlan) submode.

Use the no option to delete the VLAN entry. Only allowed if the specified VLAN
does not have egressport and untagged-port or an L3 VLAN interface.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

530 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Bridging and Switching

Operands

VLANID The ID of the VLAN. The valid range is 1–4094. The


maximum number of VLANs per switch is 1000.

NAME Descriptive name of the VLAN.

Examples
Creating a new VLAN entry with VLAN ID 2:
ML66(config)#vlan 2
ML66(config-vlan)#

50.23 vlans

Synopsis
[no] vlans <X–Y>

Description
Use this command to create and configure a range of new VLANs. The command
also changes to the (config-vlans) submode.

Use the no option to remove a range of VLANs.

Note: When a wide range of VLANs are added or removed, the execution of
the command takes some time.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

X–Y The range of the VLANs, where X is the first VLAN ID


(VID) and Y is the last VID in the selected range of
VLANs.

Examples
Adding a range of new VLANs from 100 to 200:
ML66(config)#vlans 100-200
ML66(config-vlans)#

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 531


CLI Descriptions

50.24 vlan-statistics-enable

Synopsis
[no] vlan-statistics-enable

Description
Use this command to enable VLAN statistics on a specific VLAN.

Use the no option to disable VLAN statistics on a specific VLAN.

Command Mode
VLAN configuration submode — (config-vlan)

Examples
Enabling VLAN statistics:
ML66(config-vlan)#vlan-statistics-enable

532 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Ring Protection

51 Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Ring


Protection

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
53.

The following command modes are applicable for the Ethernet Ring Protection
(ERP) commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Ethernet Ring Protection Group submode — (erp-group)

Table 53 ERP Commands Overview


alarm enable alarm notifications
clear-counters reset the switchover counter
description set the ring description
enable enable protection on the ring
erp-group create a new ERP ring with the given
ring ID
erp-port configure the given logical port
mode set the Ring Protection Link (RPL)
owner mode
propagateTC enable topology change propagation
raps configure the Ring Automatic
Protection Switching (RAPS) channel
switchover set or clear user defined switchovers,
either manual or forced, on the current
node
timer set the timer values
traffic-channel add listed VLANs as managed traffic
VLANs to the ring

The related show command is the following:

— show current

— show erp-group

— show status

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 533


CLI Descriptions

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

51.1 alarm

Synopsis
[no] alarm {link-loss | protocol-error | unable-to-protect}

Description
Use this command to enable alarm notifications.

Use the no option to disable alarm notifications.

Command Mode
Ethernet Ring Protection Group submode — (erp-group)

Options

link-loss Enables link loss alarm notifications.

protocol-error Enables protocol error alarm notifications.

unable-to-protect
Enables unable to protect alarm notifications.

Examples
Enabling protocol error alarm notifications:
ML66(erp-group)#protocol-error-alarm

51.2 clear-counters

Synopsis
clear-counters

Description
Use this command to reset the switchover counter.

534 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Ring Protection

Command Mode
Ethernet Ring Protection Group submode — (erp-group)

Examples
Resetting the switchover counter:
ML66(erp-group)#clear-counters

51.3 description

Synopsis
description <DESCRIPTION>

Description
Use this command to set the ring description.

Command Mode
Ethernet Ring Protection Group submode — (erp-group)

Operands

DESCRIPTION The description of the ring.

Examples
Setting the ring description:
ML66(erp-group)#description main-erp-ring

51.4 enable

Synopsis
[no] enable

Description
Use this command to enable protection on the ring.

Use the no option to disable protection on the ring.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 535


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Ethernet Ring Protection Group submode — (erp-group)

Examples
Enabling protection on the ring:
ML66(erp-group)#enable

51.5 erp-group

Synopsis

— erp-group <RINGID> [raps-vlan <RAPSVLAN> ]

— no erp-group <RINGID>

Description
Use this command to create a new Ethernet Ring Protection (ERP) ring with the
given ring ID. The command also changes to the (erp-group) submode.

Use the no option to delete the ERP ring with the given ring ID.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

RINGID The ID of the ring.

RAPSVLAN The ID of the VLAN.

Options

raps-vlan Assigns the given VLAN as control VLAN to the ring.

Examples
Creating a new ERP ring and assigning VLAN 100 as control VLAN:
ML66(config)#erp-group 2 raps-vlan 100
ML66(erp-group)#

Deleting ERP ring with ring ID 2:

536 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Ring Protection

ML66(config)#no erp-group 2

51.6 erp-port

Synopsis

— erp-port {east | west} {bind {interface-name <RSP> | subring-


endpoint} | role {normal | rpl-neighbor | rpl-owner} | rmep <RMEPID>}

— no erp-port {east | west} {bind | rmep}

Description
Use this command to configure the given logical port.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
Ethernet Ring Protection Group submode — (erp-group)

Operands

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port value of the interface where the
format is <Rack/Slot/Port>.

RMEPID The ID of the RMEP.

Options

east Configures logical port east.

west Configures logical port west.

bind interface-name — Binds an interface to the logical ERP


port

subring-endpoint — Sets the selected ERP port to subring


endpoint.

role normal — Sets port role to Ring Protection Line (RPL)


normal.

rpl-neighbor — Sets port role to RPL neighbor.

rpl-owner — Sets port role to RPL owner.

rmep Subscribes to a Remote Maintenance End Point (RMEP)


to receive Continuity Check Message (CCM) missing
notifications.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 537


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Configuring the east port:
ML66(erp-group)#erp-port east bind interface-name 1/6/4
ML66(erp-group)#erp-port east role normal
ML66(erp-group)#erp-port east rmep 15

51.7 mode

Synopsis
mode {reverting | no-reverting}

Description
Use this command to set the Ring Protection Link (RPL) owner mode.

Command Mode
Ethernet Ring Protection Group submode — (erp-group)

Options

reverting Sets RPL owner mode to reverting.

no-reverting Sets RPL owner mode to no-reverting.

Examples
Setting RPL owner mode to reverting:
ML66(erp-group)#mode reverting

51.8 propagateTC

Synopsis
[no] propagateTC

Description
This command enables topology change propagation. If it is enabled, on a
topology change event in the subring, every node of the connected main rings
performs a flush. Otherwise, only the interconnection nodes flush.

538 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Ring Protection

Command Mode
Ethernet Ring Protection Group submode — (erp-group)

Examples
ML66(erp-group)#propagateTC

51.9 raps

Synopsis
raps {vlan <VLANID> | vlan-priority <VLANPRIORITY> | ring-mdl
<MAINTENANCEDOMAINLEVEL> | subring-raps {vraps | no-vraps} }

Description
Use this command to configure the Ring Automatic Protection Switching (RAPS)
channel.

Command Mode
Ethernet Ring Protection Group submode — (erp-group)

Operands

VLANID The RAPS VLAN value.

VLANPRIORITY The priority of the RAPS channel.

MAINTENANCEDOMAINLEVEL
The Maintenance Domain Level.

Options

vlan Sets RAPS VLAN.

vlan-priority Sets the RAPS channel priority.

ring-mdl Sets the Maintenance Domain Level for the RAPS


channel.

subring-raps vraps — Enables RAPS virtual channel on the ring. This is


the default setting for every ring.

no-vraps — Disables RAPS virtual channel on the ring.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 539


CLI Descriptions

Note: This option command should not be used with


the no-vraps parameter in a ring that is intended
to be a main ring.

Examples
Configuring the RAPS channel:
ML66(erp-group)#raps vlan 100
ML66(erp-group)#raps vlan-priority 7
ML66(erp-group)#raps ring-mdl 5
ML66(erp-group)#raps subring-raps vraps

51.10 switchover

Synopsis

— switchover forced {east | west}

— swithcover manual {east | west}

— switchover clear switch

— switchover clear

Description
Use this command to set or clear user defined switchovers, either manual or
forced, on the current node.

Command Mode
Ethernet Ring Protection Group submode — (erp-group)

Options

forced east Sets forced switchover on port east.

forced west Sets forced switchover on port west.

manual east Sets manual switchover on port east.

manual west Sets manual switchover on port west.

clear switch Clears all previously set manual switchovers.

clear Reverts the node from pending state.

540 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Ring Protection

Examples
Setting forced switchover on port east, then clearing all previously set manual
switchovers:
ML66(erp-group)#switchover forced east
ML66(erp-group)#switchover clear switch

51.11 timer

Synopsis
timer {hold-off | guard | wait-to-block | wait-to-restore}
<TIMER_VALUE>

Description
Use this command to set the timer values.

Command Mode
Ethernet Ring Protection Group submode — (erp-group)

Operands

TIMER_VALUE The timer value.

— For the hold-off timer value, the valid range is 0–


10000 ms, in 100 ms steps.

— For the guard timer value, the valid range is 10–2000


ms, in 10 ms steps.

— For the wait-to-block timer value, the minimum value


is the guard timer value + 5000 ms, in 10 ms steps.

— For the wait-to-restore timer value, the valid range is


1–12 minutes, in 1 minute steps.

Options

hold-off Sets the hold-off timer value.

guard Sets the guard timer value.

wait-to-block Sets the wait-to-block timer value.

wait-to-restore Sets the wait-to-restore timer value.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 541


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Setting the hold-off timer value to 5000 ms:
ML66(erp-group)#timer hold-off 5000

Setting the guard timer value to 2000 ms:


ML66(erp-group)#timer guard-time 2000

Setting the wait-to-block timer value to 8000 ms:


ML66(erp-group)#timer wait-to-block 8000

Setting the wait-to-restore timer value to 1 minute:


ML66(erp-group)#timer wait-to-restore 1

51.12 traffic-channel

Synopsis
[no] traffic-channel <VLANIDS>

Description
Use this command to add listed VLANs as managed traffic VLANs to the ring.

Use the no option to remove listed VLANs from managed traffic VLANs in the
ring.

Command Mode
Ethernet Ring Protection Group submode — (erp-group)

Operands

VLANIDS The IDs of the VLANs, separated by commas. The valid


range is 1–4095.

Maximum 1000 traffic VLANs can be assigned to one


ERP group.

Examples
Adding VLANs 3, 7–10, and 50:
ML66(erp-group)#traffic-channel 3,7-10,50

Removing VLANs 7–9:

542 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Ring Protection

ML66(erp-group)#traffic-channel 7-9

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 543


CLI Descriptions

52 Ethernet Commands: RSTP

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
54.

The following command modes are applicable for the Rapid Spanning Tree
Protocol (RSTP) commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Table 54 RSTP Commands Overview


spanning-tree admin-edgeport configure the port as an edge port
spanning-tree admin- set the point-to-point status of the LAN
pointtopoint network segment attached to this port
spanning-tree autoedge set automatic edge port operation
spanning-tree enable enable or disable the Spanning Tree Protocol
(STP)
spanning-tree force-version instructs Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol
(MSTP) to emulate additional aspects of
earlier versions of the spanning tree protocol
spanning-tree forward-delay set how fast a port changes its spanning tree
state when moving towards the Forwarding
state
spanning-tree mac-enable enable Media Access Control (MAC)
addressing for the port
spanning-tree max-age set the maximum age of STP information
before it is discarded
spanning-tree max-hops defines the initial value of remaining hops
spanning-tree path-cost set the cost contribution of this port
spanning-tree port-enable enable the port
spanning-tree port-priority set the priority of the port
spanning-tree priority set the priority of a spanning tree
spanning-tree protocol-migration force the port to transmit Rapid Spanning Tree
Protocol (RSTP) Bridge Protocol Data Units
(BPDUs) for a short period of time
spanning-tree restricted-role set Common and Internal Spanning Tree
(CIST) port restricted role

544 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: RSTP

spanning-tree restricted-tcn indicate the state of restricted Topology


Change Notification (TCN)
spanning-tree transmit-holdcount limit the maximum transmission rate
spanning-tree type set spanning tree protocol

The related show command is the following:

— show spanning-tree

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

52.1 spanning-tree admin-edgeport

Synopsis
[no] spanning-tree admin-edgeport

Description
Use this command to configure the port as an edge port. A bridge port attached
to an interface that has no other bridges attached to it can be configured as an
edge port. By default, ports are configured as non-edge ports.

Use the no option to configure the port as a non-edge port.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Examples
Configuring the port as an edge port:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#spanning-tree admin-edgeport

52.2 spanning-tree admin-pointtopoint

Synopsis

— spanning-tree admin-pointtopoint [auto]

— no spanning-tree admin-pointtopoint

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 545


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to set the point-to-point status of the LAN network segment
attached to this port. The status can be point-to-point link, shared media
connection, or auto. The default value is auto for I-NNI and I-NNI (PN) ports, and
shared media connection for UNI and CN-UNI ports.

Use spanning-tree admin-pointtopoint to set the status to point-to-point


link. This is equivalent to the value forceTrue in MINI-LINK Node GUI.

Use the no option to set the status to shared media connection. This is equivalent
to the value forceFalse in MINI-LINK Node GUI.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Options

auto Sets the status to point-to-point link in the following


scenarios:

— The port is an aggregator and all of its members can


be aggregated.

— The MAC entity is configured for full duplex


operation.

Otherwise, sets the status to shared media connection.

Examples
Setting the status to point-to-point link:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#spanning-tree admin-pointtopoint

52.3 spanning-tree autoedge

Synopsis
[no] spanning-tree autoedge

Description
Use this command to detect automatically if the port operates as edge port or
not.

546 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: RSTP

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Examples
Detecting edge port operation:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#spanning-tree autoedge

52.4 spanning-tree enable

Synopsis
[no] spanning-tree enable

Description
Use this command to enable or disable the Spanning Tree Protocol (STP). STP is
enabled by default.

Use the no option to disable this functionality.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Enable STP:
ML66(config)#spanning-tree enable

52.5 spanning-tree force-version

Synopsis

— spanning-tree force-version { stp | rstp | mstp }

— no spanning-tree force-version

Description
Use this command to instruct Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol (MSTP) to emulate
additional aspects of earlier versions of the behavior of the spanning tree

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 547


CLI Descriptions

protocol. The no spanning-tree enable command must be executed prior to


usage of this command.

Use the no option to disable this functionality.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Options

stp Forces version to Spanning Tree Protocol (STP).

rstp Forces version to Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol (RSTP).

mstp Forces version to MSTP. This is the default behavior.

Examples
Force version to RSTP:
ML66(config)#spanning-tree force-version rstp

52.6 spanning-tree forward-delay

Synopsis

— spanning-tree forward-delay <DELAY>

— no spanning-tree forward-delay

Description
Use this command to set how fast a port changes its spanning tree state when
moving towards the Forwarding state when the bridge is acting as the root.

Use the no option to disable this functionality.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

DELAY Sets the delay of how fast a port shall change its
spanning-tree state when moving towards the

548 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: RSTP

Forwarding state when the bridge is acting as the root.


Default value is 1500 (centiseconds).

Note: This parameter has the following constraint


compared to max-age:

2 × (DELAY - 1) ≥ AGE

See also spanning-tree max-age on page 549.

Examples
Set forward-delay to 1200 (centiseconds):
ML66(config)#spanning-tree forward-delay 1200

52.7 spanning-tree mac-enable

Synopsis
[no] spanning-tree mac-enable

Description
Use this command to enable Media Access Control (MAC) addressing for the port.
MAC addressing is enabled by default.

Use the no option to disable MAC addressing for the port.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Examples
Disabling MAC addressing for the port:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#no spanning-tree mac-enable

52.8 spanning-tree max-age

Synopsis

— spanning-tree max-age <AGE>

— no spanning-tree max-age

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 549


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to set the maximum age of Spanning Tree Protocol (STP)
information learned from the network on any port before it is discarded.

Use the no option to set the maximum age to its default value.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

AGE Sets the maximum age of spanning-tree information. The


valid range is 600–4000 (centiseconds) in steps of 100.
Default value is 20.

Note: This parameter has the following constraint


compared to forward_delay:

2 × (DELAY - 1) ≥ AGE

See also spanning-tree forward-delay on page


548.

Examples
Set max-age to 800:
ML66(config)#spanning-tree max-age 800

52.9 spanning-tree max-hops

Synopsis

— spanning-tree max-hops <MAX-HOPS>

— no spanning-tree max-hops

Description
Use this command to set the initial value of remaining hops for Multiple Spanning
Tree Instance (MSTI) information generated at the boundary of an MSTI region.

Use the no option to disable this functionality.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

550 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: RSTP

Operands

MAX-HOPS Initial value of remaining hops. The valid range is 6–40.


Default value is 20.

Examples
Set max-hops to 15:
ML66(config)#spanning-tree max-hops 15

52.10 spanning-tree path-cost

Synopsis

— spanning-tree path-cost <COST>

— no spanning-tree path-cost

Description
Use this command to set the cost contribution of this port. This cost is added to
the path cost toward the spanning tree root. The default value is 0.

Use the no option to reset the cost to 0.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Operands

COST The cost contribution. The valid range is 0–200000000.


The value 0 can be used instead of the value 200000 (the
equivalent of 100 megabits).

Examples
Setting the cost contribution to 100000:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#spanning-tree path-cost 100000

52.11 spanning-tree port-enable

Synopsis
[no] spanning-tree port-enable

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 551


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to enable the port. By default, the port is disabled.

Use the no option to disable the port.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Examples
Enabling the port:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#spanning-tree port-enable

52.12 spanning-tree port-priority

Synopsis

— spanning-tree port-priority <PRIORITY>

— no spanning-tree port-priority

Description
Use this command to set the priority of the port.

Use the no option to set the priority to 0.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Operands

PRIORITY The priority. The valid range is 0–240, in steps of 16. The
default value is 128.

Examples
Setting the port priority to 64:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#spanning-tree port-priority 64

52.13 spanning-tree priority

552 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: RSTP

Synopsis

— spanning-tree priority <PRIORITY>

— no spanning-tree priority

Description
Use this command to set the priority of a spanning-tree.

Use the no option to disable this functionality.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

PRIORITY Sets the priority of a spanning-tree. The valid range is 0–


61440 in steps of 4096. Default value is 32768.

Examples
Set priority to 4096:
ML66(config)#spanning-tree priority 4096

52.14 spanning-tree protocol-migration

Synopsis
spanning-tree protocol-migration

Description
Use this command to force the port to transmit Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol
(RSTP) Bridge Protocol Data Units (BPDUs) for a short period of time. This
command is only valid when operating in RSTP (version 2) mode.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Examples
Forcing the port to transmit RSTP BPDUs:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#spanning-tree protocol-migration

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 553


CLI Descriptions

52.15 spanning-tree restricted-role

Synopsis
[no] spanning-tree restricted-role

Description
Use this command to enable or disable the restricted role for the port. If this
parameter is enabled, the port is not selected as root port for the Common and
Internal Spanning Tree (CIST) or any Multiple Spanning Tree Instance (MSTI),
even if it has the best spanning tree priority vector. The port is selected as an
alternate port after the root port is selected.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Examples
Enabling the restricted role for a port:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#spanning-tree restricted-role

52.16 spanning-tree restricted-tcn

Synopsis
[no] spanning-tree restricted-tcn

Description
Use this command to indicate the current state of restricted Topology Change
Notification (TCN) for the port.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Examples
Indicating the state of TCN:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#spanning-tree restricted-tcn

554 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: RSTP

52.17 spanning-tree transmit-holdcount

Synopsis

— spanning-tree transmit-holdcount <COUNT>

— no spanning-tree transmit-holdcount

Description
Use this command to limit the maximum transmission rate.

Use the no option to set the value to default 3.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

COUNT Maximum transmission rate. The valid range is 1–10.

Examples
Set the maximum transmission rate to 2:
ML66(config)#spanning-tree hold-count 2

52.18 spanning-tree type

Synopsis
spanning-tree type { rstp | mstp }

Description
Use this command to set spanning tree protocol.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Options

rstp Selects Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol (RSTP). This is the


default value.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 555


CLI Descriptions

mstp Selects Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol (MSTP).

Examples
Select RSTP:
ML66(config)#spanning-tree type rstp

556 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: MSTP

53 Ethernet Commands: MSTP

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
55.

The following command modes are applicable for the Multiple Spanning Tree
Protocol (MSTP) commands:

— Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

— MST configuration submode — (config-mst)

Table 55 MSTP Commands Overview


instance map VLAN to the Multiple Spanning Tree
Instance (MSTI) and set the Bridge priority for
the current instance
name set the configuration name
revision set the revision level
reset reset the Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol
(MSTP) setting
spanning-tree cist- set the Common and Internal Spanning Tree
path-cost (CIST) path cost
spanning-tree mst set the cost contribution of this port in the
path-cost Multiple Spanning Tree (MST) instance
spanning-tree mst enable the port in the MST instance
port-enable
spanning-tree mst set the priority for the port in the MST instance
priority

The related show command is the following:

— show spanning-tree

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

53.1 instance

Synopsis
[no] instance <INSTANCE-ID> [ vlan <VLAN_RANGE> | priority
<PRIORITY> ]

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 557


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to create Multiple Spanning Tree (MST) Instances, specify
VLAN members, and set the priority part of the Bridge Identifier for the instance.

Use the no option without parameters to remove the instance. Use the no option
with vlan or priority parameter to reset it to default value.

Command Mode
MST configuration submode — (config-mst)

Options

vlan Selects settings for VLAN_RANGE.

priority Selects settings for PRIORITY.

Operands

INSTANCE-ID The ID of the instance. The valid range is 1–16.

VLAN_RANGE The valid range is 1–4094. Single numbers or ranges can


be assigned, such as 298 or 300–302.

PRIORITY The priority of the Bridge Identifier of the Spanning Tree


instance. The default value is 32768. The valid range is
0–61440 in steps of 4096.

Examples
Creating MST instance with ID 3:
ML66(config-mst)#instance 3

Setting the VLAN range 300 to 304 for instance ID 3:


ML66(config-mst)#instance 3 vlan 300-304

Setting the priority for instance 3 to 16384:


ML66(config-mst)#instance 3 priority 16384

53.2 name

Synopsis

— name <NAME>

558 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: MSTP

— no name

Description
Use this command to set the name of the Multiple Spanning Tree (MST)
configuration.

Use the no option to reset the name to unconfigured.

Command Mode
MST configuration submode — (config-mst)

Operands

NAME The name of the configuration. Maximum length is 32


characters. The default name is the Media Access Control
(MAC) address for the node.

Examples
Set the name of the spanning-tree to MyMST:
ML66(config-mst)#name MyMST

53.3 revision

Synopsis

— revision <REVISION>

— no revision

Description
Use this command to set revision level.

Use the no option to set revision back to default value.

Command Mode
MST configuration submode — (config-mst)

Operands

REVISION The level of the revision. Default value is 0.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 559


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Set the revision of the spanning-tree to 1:
ML66(config-mst)#revision 1

53.4 reset

Synopsis
reset

Description
Use this command to reset the Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol (MSTP) setting.

Command Mode
MST configuration submode — (config-mst)

Examples
Reset a spanning-tree:
ML66(config-mst)#reset

53.5 spanning-tree cist-path-cost

Synopsis

— spanning-tree cist-path-cost <PATH-COST>

— no spanning-tree cist-path-cost

Description
Use this command to set the Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CIST) path
cost from the transmitting bridge to the CIST Regional Root. The default cost is 0.

Use the no option to reset the CIST path cost.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

560 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: MSTP

Operands

PATH-COST The CIST path cost. The valid range is 0–200000000.

Examples
Setting the CIST path cost to 50000000:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#spanning-tree cist-path-cost 50000000

53.6 spanning-tree mst path-cost

Synopsis

— spanning-tree mst <INSTANCE-ID> path-cost <COST>

— no spanning-tree mst <INSTANCE-ID> path-cost

Description
Use this command to set the cost contribution of this port. This cost is added to
the path cost toward the spanning tree instance root which includes this port.

Use the no option to reset the cost to 0.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Operands

INSTANCE-ID The ID of the Multiple Spanning Tree (MST) instance. The


valid range is 1–4094.

COST The cost contribution. The valid range is 0–200000000.

Examples
Setting the cost for the MST instance 3 to 10000000:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#spanning-tree mst 3 path-cost 10000000

53.7 spanning-tree mst port-enable

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 561


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
[no] spanning-tree mst <INSTANCE-ID> port-enable

Description
Use this command to enable the port in the Multiple Spanning Tree (MST)
instance. By default, the port is disabled.

Use the no option to disable the port in the MST instance.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Operands

INSTANCE-ID The ID of the MST instance. The valid range is 1–4094.

Examples
Enabling the port for the MST instance 3:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#spanning-tree mst 3 port-enable

53.8 spanning-tree mst priority

Synopsis

— spanning-tree mst <INSTANCE-ID> priority <PRIORITY>

— no spanning-tree mst <INSTANCE-ID> priority

Description
Use this command to set the priority for the port in the Multiple Spanning Tree
(MST) instance. The default value is 128.

Use the no option to reset the priority to 0.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Operands

INSTANCE-ID The ID of the MST instance. The valid range is 1–4094.

562 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: MSTP

PRIORITY The priority. The valid range is 0–255.

Examples
Setting the priority for the MST instance 3 to 7:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#spanning-tree mst 3 priority 7

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 563


CLI Descriptions

54 Ethernet Commands: Security and Admission


Control

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
56.

The following command modes are applicable for the security and admission
control commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

— Ethernet Alarms configuration submode — (config-eth-alarms)

— VLAN configuration submode — (config-vlan)

Table 56 Security and Admission Control Commands Overview


admit specify which frame types to accept on a UNI
or a CN-UNI port
bridge customer-BPDU specify how to handle customer Bridge
Protocol Data Units (BPDUs) on all CE-UNI
and CN-UNI ports of the bridge in provider
mode
bridge l2cpmacdesttunnel set the Layer 2 Control Protocol (L2CP) MAC
destination tunneling address
bridge l2cppriority set the Priority Code Point (PCP) priority for
L2CP tunneling
ethernet-alarms change to the (config-eth-alarms) submode
forbidden-egressports define a list of forbidden egress ports
l2cp specify the filtering behavior of a Layer 2
Control Protocol (L2CP)
loop-alarm configure Ethernet loop detection
maclearning (per port) enable MAC address learning on a specific
bridge port
mac-whitelist associate a Media Access Control (MAC) white
list with a port
max-learned-addresses set the maximum number of MAC addresses
that the port is allowed to learn
stormctrl bc enable storm control for broadcast frames

564 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Security and Admission Control

stormctrl dlf enable storm control for destination look-up


failures
stormctrl mc enable storm control for multicast frames
stormctrl maxbcbw set the maximum transmission rate for
broadcast frames
stormctrl maxdlfbw set the maximum transmission rate for
destination look-up failures
stormctrl maxmcbw set the maximum transmission rate for
multicast frames

The related show commands are the following:

— show (Ethernet alarms)

— show mac-whitelist

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

54.1 admit

Synopsis

— admit untagged [priority-tagged] [vlan-tagged]

— admit priority-tagged [untagged] [vlan-tagged]

— admit vlan-tagged [untagged] [priority-tagged]

— no admit

Description
Use this command to specify which frame types to accept on a UNI or a CN-UNI
port.

The following frame type combinations are possible:

— untagged, priority-tagged, and vlan-tagged, that is, admit all frames

— untagged and priority-tagged

— vlan-tagged

By default, the port admits all frame types.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 565


CLI Descriptions

Note: Enter one or more of the three options for the synopsis.

Use the no option to reset the frame type to untagged and priority-tagged.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Options

untagged Admits untagged frames.

priority-tagged Admits priority-tagged frames.

vlan-tagged Admits VLAN-tagged frames.

Examples
Admitting VLAN-tagged frames:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#admit vlan-tagged

54.2 bridge customer-BPDU

Synopsis
bridge customer-BPDU { discard | forward }

Description
Use this command to specify how to handle customer Bridge Protocol Data Units
(BPDUs) on all CE-UNI and CN-UNI ports of the bridge in provider mode.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Options

discard Discards customer BPDUs when the bridge is in provider


mode.

forward Forwards customer BPDUs unchanged when the bridge is


in provider mode.

566 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Security and Admission Control

Examples
Specifying that customer BPDUs are forwarded unchanged when the bridge is in
provider mode:
ML66(config)#bridge customer-BPDU forward

54.3 bridge l2cpmacdesttunnel

Synopsis
[no] bridge l2cpmacdesttunnel <ADDRESS>

Description
Use this command to set the Layer 2 Control Protocol (L2CP) MAC destination
tunneling address on UNI, CE-UNI, and CN-UNI ports.

Use the no option to clear the previously set L2CP MAC destination tunneling
address and set back the default configuration.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

ADDRESS The MAC address, which is used for tunneling. The


default MAC destination tunneling address is
01:A0:AD:xx:xx:xx.

Examples
Setting L2CP MAC destination tunneling address to xx:AB:AE:xx:xx:xx:
ML66(config)#bridge l2cpmacdesttunnel xx:AB:AE:xx:xx:xx

54.4 bridge l2cppriority

Synopsis
bridge l2cppriority <PRIORITY>

Description
Use this command to set the VLAN priority bits in case of Layer 2 Control
Protocol (L2CP) tunneling for untagged frames.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 567


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

PRIORITY The VLAN priority bits to be used when tunneling


untagged L2CP frames. The valid range is 0–7. The
default value is 0.

Examples
Setting VLAN priority bits to 5 in case of L2CP tunneling:
ML66(config)# bridge l2cppriority 5

54.5 ethernet-alarms

Synopsis
ethernet-alarms

Description
Use this command to change to the (config-eth-alarms) submode.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Changing to the (config-eth-alarms) submode:
ML66(config)#ethernet-alarms
ML66(config-eth-alarms)#

54.6 forbidden-egressports

Synopsis

— forbidden-egressports <PORTLIST>

— no forbidden-egressports

568 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Security and Admission Control

Description
Use this command to specify that the port cannot send packets to specific ports,
even if they are on the same VLAN. The list of forbidden ports is defined by the
PORTLIST operand.

Use the no option to clear the list of forbidden egress ports.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Operands

PORTLIST The list of forbidden egress ports in <Rack/Slot/Port>


format.

Examples
Defining a list of forbidden egress ports:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#forbidden-egressports 1/6/4,1/6/5

54.7 l2cp

Synopsis
l2cp { allbridgeaddr | bpdu | esmc | futurestdbridge | futurestdgarp |
futurestdslow | gmrp | gvrp | pgvrp | lacp | lldp | lamp | linkoam | macpause
| pbpdu | portauth802dot1x } { peer | discard | forward | tunnel }

Description
Use this command to specify the filtering behavior of a Layer 2 Control Protocol
(L2CP).

In case of Layer 2 service this can be configured on UNI, CE-UNI, and CN-UNI
ports. On I-NNI and I-NNI (PN) ports, the behavior depends on the protocol
running in the node. The default behavior on all port types is discard. Table 57
shows the supported filtering behavior on the different protocols.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 569


CLI Descriptions

Table 57 Filtering Behavior on UNI, CE-UNI, and CN-UNI Ports


Protocol Filtering Behavior
Discard Peer Forward Tunnel
Unchanged
allbridgeaddr Supported Not Not Supported
(default) supported supported
customer- Supported Supported in Supported in Supported
BPDU (default) Customer Provider
Mode Mode
esmc Supported Supported Not Not
(default) supported supported
futurestdbridge Supported Not Not Supported
(default) supported supported
futurestdgarp Supported Not Not Supported
(default) supported supported
futurestdslow Supported Not Not Supported
(default) supported supported
gmrp Supported Not Not Supported
(default) supported supported
gvrp Supported Not Not Supported
(default) supported supported
pgvrp Supported Not Not Supported
(default) supported supported
lacp Supported Supported Not Supported
(default) supported
lldp Supported Supported(1) Not Supported
(default) supported
lamp Supported Supported Not Supported
(default) supported
linkoam Supported Supported Not Supported
(default) supported
macpause Supported Not Not Not
(default) supported supported supported
pbpdu Supported Supported in Not Supported
(default) Provider supported
Mode
portauth802do Supported Supported Not Supported
t1x (default) supported
(1) When LLDP is enabled on a port it is peered regardless of the configured L2CP behavior. The
configured L2CP behavior is applied when LLDP is disabled.

570 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Security and Admission Control

In case of Layer 1 service Table 58 shows the supported filtering behaviors.


Tunneling is not supported in case of Layer 1 ports.

Table 58 Filtering Behavior on Layer 1 Ports


Protocol Filtering Behavior
Discard Forward Peer
Unchanged
allbridgeaddr Not supported Supported Not supported
(default)
customer-BPDU Not supported Supported Not supported
(default)
esmc Supported Supported Supported
(default)
futurestdbridge Not supported Supported Not supported
(default)
futurestdgarp Not supported Supported Not supported
(default)
futurestdslow Not supported Supported Not supported
(default)
gmrp Not supported Supported Not supported
(default)
gvrp Not supported Supported Not supported
(default)
pgvrp Not supported Supported Not supported
(default)
lacp Supported Supported Not supported
(default)
lldp Supported Supported Supported(1)
(default)
lamp Supported Supported Not supported
(default)
linkoam Supported Supported Supported
(default)
macpause Supported Not supported Not supported
(default)
pbpdu Not supported Supported Not supported
(default)
portauth802dot1x Not supported Supported Not supported
(default)
(1) When LLDP is enabled on a port it is peered regardless of the configured L2CP behavior. The
configured L2CP behavior is applied when LLDP is disabled.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 571


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport) for both Layer 1
service ports and Layer 2 service ports

Options

allbridgeaddr Specifies that the application is All LANs Bridge


Management Group Address.

Note: It is not recommended to use this option.

bpdu Specifies that the application is Bridge Group Address


(BPDUs).

esmc Specifies that the application is Ethernet Synchronization


Messaging Channel (ESMC).

futurestdbridge Specifies that the application is future standard bridge


protocols.

futurestdgarp Specifies that the application is future standard Generic


Attribute Registration Protocol (GARP).

futurestdslow Specifies that the application is future standard slow


protocols (sub type 0x04–0x09).

gmrp Specifies that the application is GARP Multicast


Registration Protocol.

gvrp Specifies that the application is GARP VLAN Registration


Protocol.

pgvrp Specifies that the application is Provider GARP VLAN


Registration Protocol.

lacp Specifies that the application is Link Aggregation Control


Protocol (LACP).

lldp Specifies that the application is Link Layer Discovery


Protocol (LLDP).

lamp Specifies that the application is Location Aware MAC


Protocol.

linkoam Specifies that the application is Link Operation,


Administration, and Maintenance (OAM).

macpause Specifies that the application is MAC Pause.

572 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Security and Admission Control

pbpdu Specifies that the application is Provider Bridge Group


Address (PBPDUs).

portauth802dot1x
Specifies that the application is 802.1X Port
Authentication.

peer Sets the filtering behavior to peer.

discard Sets the filtering behavior to discard.

forward Sets the filtering behavior to forward unchanged.

tunnel Sets the filtering behavior to tunneling.

Examples
Setting the filtering behavior for Provider Bridge Group Address to peer:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#l2cp pbpdu peer

54.8 loop-alarm

Synopsis

— loop-alarm { address <MAC_ADDRESS> | members { <PORTLIST> | all }


| threshold <SECONDS> | vlan { <VLAN> | all } }

— [no] loop-alarm enable

Description
Use this command to configure Ethernet loop detection.

Use the no option to disable Ethernet loop detection.

Command Mode
Ethernet Alarms configuration submode — (config-eth-alarms)

Operands

MAC_ADDRESS The target MAC address. The default value is


ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff.

PORTLIST List of ports in <Rack/Slot/Port> format. The RSP values


are separated by commas.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 573


CLI Descriptions

SECONDS The alarm threshold value in seconds. The valid range is


10–200 seconds. The default value is 10 seconds.

VLAN The VLAN identification number. The valid range is 1–


4094.

Options

address Specifies the target MAC address where the test frames
are sent.

enable Enables or disables Ethernet loop detection.

members Specifies which ports are used for Ethernet loop


detection.

threshold Specifies the alarm threshold in seconds.

vlan Specifies which VLANs are used for Ethernet loop


detection.

all Uses all ports or VLANs for Ethernet loop detection.

Examples
Enabling Ethernet loop detection:
ML66(config-eth-alarms)#loop-alarm enable

54.9 maclearning (per port)

Synopsis
[no] maclearning

Description
Use this command to enable MAC address learning on a specific bridge port. By
default, per port MAC address learning is enabled.

Use the no option to disable per port MAC address learning for new MAC
addresses. Before disabling MAC address learning, make sure that it will not
cause any issues in the network, as unicast frames entering on the port will be
flooded to all other ports in the VLAN.

Note: Disabling per port MAC address learning does not flush the table, so
there is no immediate change on existing flows.

574 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Security and Admission Control

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Examples
Disabling MAC learning on the current bridge port:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#no maclearning

54.10 mac-whitelist

Synopsis

— mac-whitelist <LISTNO>

— no mac-whitelist

Description
Use this command to associate a Media Access Control (MAC) white list with a
port. If no white list is selected, all MAC addresses are allowed. When a white list
is selected, only traffic from addresses in the white list are allowed; other traffic is
discarded. The ethernet-mac-whitelist command manages the white lists.

Use the no option to disassociate a white list from a port.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Operands

LISTNO The number of the MAC address list. The value 0


indicates that there is no MAC address white list access
control for the port. The default value is 0.

Examples
Specifying MAC address list 3 as white list:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#mac-whitelist 3

54.11 max-learned-addresses

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 575


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis

— max-learned-addresses <MAXNUMBER>

— no max-learned-addresses

Description
Use this command to define the maximum number of source Media Access
Control (MAC) addresses to be supported on the port. When the limit is reached
packets are discarded. 0 means that the function is turned off, that is, only limited
by the capacity of the switch.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Operands

MAXNUMBER The maximum number of MAC addresses. The valid


range is 0–16383. 0 means that the function is turned off,
that is, the maximum number is limited by bridge
capacity. The default value is 0 for all port roles.

Examples
Setting the maximum number of MAC addresses to 30:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#max-learned-addresses 30

54.12 stormctrl bc

Synopsis
[no] stormctrl bc

Description
Use this command to enable storm control for broadcast frames. By default,
storm control is disabled.

Use the no option to disable storm control for broadcast frames.

The command is only applicable for the following port roles:

— UNI for customer mode

— CN-UNI for provider mode

576 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Security and Admission Control

— CE-UNI for provider mode

— I-NNI for customer mode

— I-NNI (PN) for provider mode

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Examples
Enabling storm control for broadcast frames:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#stormctrl bc

54.13 stormctrl dlf

Synopsis
[no] stormctrl dlf

Description
Use this command to enable storm control for unknown unicast frames causing
destination look-up failures. By default, storm control is disabled.

Use the no option to disable storm control for destination look-up failures.

The command is only applicable for the following port roles:

— UNI for customer mode

— CN-UNI for provider mode

— CE-UNI for provider mode

— I-NNI for customer mode

— I-NNI (PN) for provider mode

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Examples
Enabling storm control for destination look-up failures:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 577


CLI Descriptions

ML66(config-bridgeport)#stormctrl dlf

54.14 stormctrl mc

Synopsis
[no] stormctrl mc

Description
Use this command to enable storm control for multicast frames. By default, storm
control is disabled.

Use the no option to disable storm control for multicast frames.

The command is only applicable for the following port roles:

— UNI for customer mode

— CN-UNI for provider mode

— CE-UNI for provider mode

— I-NNI for customer mode

— I-NNI (PN) for provider mode

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Examples
Enabling storm control for multicast frames:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#stormctrl mc

54.15 stormctrl maxbcbw

Synopsis

— stormctrl maxbcbw <MAXBCBW>

— no stormctrl maxbcbw

578 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Security and Admission Control

Description
Use this command to set the maximum transmission rate for broadcast frames.
The maximum rate is only applicable if storm control for broadcast frames is
enabled.

Use the no option to set the default value.

The command is only applicable for the following port roles:

— UNI for customer mode

— CN-UNI for provider mode

— CE-UNI for provider mode

— I-NNI for customer mode

— I-NNI (PN) for provider mode

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Operands

MAXBCBW The maximum allowed transmission rate in frames per


second. The valid range is 2–65534, and only even
numbers are supported. The default value is 100.

Examples
Setting the maximum transmission rate to 50:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#stormctrl maxbcbw 50

54.16 stormctrl maxdlfbw

Synopsis

— stormctrl maxdlfbw <MAXDLFBW>

— no stormctrl maxdlfbw

Description
Use this command to set the maximum transmission rate for destination look-up
failures. The maximum rate is only applicable if storm control for destination
look-up failures is enabled.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 579


CLI Descriptions

Use the no option to set the default value.

The command is only applicable for the following port roles:

— UNI for customer mode

— CN-UNI for provider mode

— CE-UNI for provider mode

— I-NNI for customer mode

— I-NNI (PN) for provider mode

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Operands

MAXDLFBW The maximum allowed transmission rate in frames per


second. The valid range is 2–65534, and only even
numbers are supported. The default value is 100.

Examples
Setting the maximum transmission rate to 50:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#stormctrl maxdlfbw 50

54.17 stormctrl maxmcbw

Synopsis

— stormctrl maxmcbw <MAXMCBW>

— no stormctrl maxmcbw

Description
Use this command to set the maximum transmission rate for multicast frames.
The maximum rate is only applicable if storm control for multicast frames is
enabled.

Use the no option to set the default value.

The command is only applicable for the following port roles:

580 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Security and Admission Control

— UNI for customer mode

— CN-UNI for provider mode

— CE-UNI for provider mode

— I-NNI for customer mode

— I-NNI (PN) for provider mode

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Operands

MAXMCBW The maximum allowed transmission rate in frames per


second. The valid range is 2–65534, and only even
numbers are supported. The default value is 100.

Examples
Setting the maximum transmission rate to 50:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#stormctrl maxmcbw 50

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 581


CLI Descriptions

55 Ethernet Commands: Buffering

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
59.

The following command mode is applicable for the buffering commands:

— Interface QoS configuration submode — (config-qos)

Table 59 Buffering Commands Overview


deep-buffering enable/disable deep buffering on an
Ethernet interface

55.1 deep-buffering

Synopsis
[no] deep-buffering

Description
Use this command to enable deep buffering on an Ethernet interface.

Use the no option to disable deep buffering. If deep-buffering is disabled on an


interface, the WRED and Colordrop features are automatically disabled.

Note: Changing the deep buffering setting of an interface results in 2–3


seconds of traffic loss on that interface. It might cause the same
disturbance on few other interfaces, and consequently a short outage in
DCN connectivity might also happen.

Command Mode
Interface QoS configuration submode — (config-qos)

Examples
Disabling deep-buffering on an Ethernet interface:
ML66(config-qos)# no deep-buffering

582 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Traffic Classes

56 Ethernet Commands: Traffic Classes

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
60.

The following command mode is applicable for the traffic classes commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

Table 60 QoS - Traffic Class Mapping Commands Overview


bridge priority-mapping map map a priority to a traffic class
bridge priority-mapping type specify the type of priority mapping used

56.1 bridge priority-mapping map

Synopsis
bridge priority-mapping map <NETWORKPRIORITY> <TC-QUEUE>

Description
Use this command to map a priority to a traffic class. The command is only used
when the type is set to userdefined and applies for both Layer 1 service ports
and Layer 2 service ports.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

NETWORKPRIORITY
The priority. The valid range is 0–7.

TC-QUEUE The traffic class.

Examples
Mapping the priority 1 to traffic class 2:
ML66(config)#bridge priority-mapping map 1 2

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 583


CLI Descriptions

56.2 bridge priority-mapping type

Synopsis
bridge priority-mapping type { d-std | q-std | userdefined }

Description
Use this command to specify the type of priority mapping used for both Layer 1
service ports and Layer 2 service ports: D-Standard (see Table 61), Q-Standard
(see Table 62), or user-defined. The default mapping is D-Standard.

Table 61 D-Standard Priority to Traffic Class Mapping


Priority Traffic Class
0 2
1 0
2 1
3 3
4 4
5 5
6 6
7 7

Table 62 Q-Standard Priority to Traffic Class Mapping


Priority Traffic Class
0 1
1 0
2 2
3 3
4 4
5 5
6 6
7 7

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

584 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Traffic Classes

Options

d-std Sets priority mapping to D-Standard.

q-std Sets priority mapping to Q-Standard.

userdefined Sets priority mapping to user-defined.

Examples
Setting the priority mapping to Q-standard:
ML66(config)#bridge priority-mapping type q-std

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 585


CLI Descriptions

57 Ethernet Commands: QoS - Aging

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
63.

The following command mode is applicable for the aging command:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

Table 63 QoS - Aging Commands Overview


bridge aging set the time-out period in seconds for frame
aging per traffic class
bridge aging enable enable aging for all Traffic Classes (TCs)

57.1 bridge aging

Synopsis
bridge aging <TRAFFICCLASS> <AGING>

Description
Use this command to set the time-out period in seconds for frame aging per
traffic class for both Layer 1 service ports and Layer 2 service ports.

For UNI, CNP, and Layer 1 ports the incoming PCP value is considered as network
priority value from aging point of view. The ingress port QoS settings, that is, the
Trust Port Configuration and the User Priority to Network Priority Mapping are
ignored. For frames entering on NNI, CEP, or QinQ ports, the frame aging
configuration is in line with the queuing.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

TRAFFICCLASS The traffic class. The valid range is 0–7.

AGING Time-out period in milliseconds.

The valid values are 24, 36, 48, 60, 72, and 84 ms. The
default value is 84 ms for all traffic classes.

586 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: QoS - Aging

Examples
Setting the aging to 60 ms for traffic class 3:
ML66(config)#bridge aging 3 60

57.2 bridge aging enable

Synopsis
[no] bridge aging enable

Description
Aging is disabled by default. Use this command to enable aging for all Traffic
Classes (TCs).

Use the no option to disable aging for all TCs.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Enabling aging for all TCs:
ML66(config)#bridge aging enable

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 587


CLI Descriptions

58 Ethernet Commands: QoS - Scheduling

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
64.

The following command modes are applicable for the scheduling commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Scheduler Profile configuration submode — (config-scheduler-profile)

— Ethernet Profile configuration submode — (config-ethernet-profiles)

— Interface QoS configuration submode — (config-qos)

Table 64 QoS - Scheduling Commands Overview


bridge scheduler- assign a scheduler profile at service level
profile
ethernet-profiles configure Ethernet profiles
name change the name of the profile
scheduler-profile create or edit a scheduler profile
scheduler-profile assign a scheduler profile at interface level
tc-scheduler-type-and- specify the scheduler type and Deficit
weight Weighted Round Robin (DWRR) weight

The related show commands are the following:

— show current

— show scheduler-profile

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

The following four scheduler profiles cannot be removed:

— All strict priority (index 1)

— 3 strict priority and 5 weighted (index 2)

— 3 strict priority and 5 weighted with Best Effort (index 3)

— 4 strict priority and 4 weighted with Best Effort (index 4)

588 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: QoS - Scheduling

58.1 bridge scheduler-profile

Synopsis
bridge scheduler-profile <PROFILENUMBER>

Description
Use this command to assign a scheduler profile at service level, that is, to provide
common settings for all Layer 1 service ports and Layer 2 service ports. This
setting applies only for lock-to-service ports.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

PROFILENUMBER
The unique index of the scheduler profile.

Examples
Configuring bridge scheduler profile:
ML66(config)#bridge scheduler-profile 5

58.2 ethernet-profiles

Synopsis
ethernet-profiles

Description
Use this command to configure Ethernet profiles, such as Weighted Random
Early Detection (WRED) profile and scheduler profile. The command also
changes to the (config-ethernet-profiles) submode.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Configuring Ethernet profiles:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 589


CLI Descriptions

ML66(config)#ethernet-profiles
ML66(config-ethernet-profiles)#

58.3 name

Synopsis
name <NAME>

Description
Use this command to change the name of the scheduler profile. The name can
only be changed if the profile is not in use.

Command Mode
Scheduler Profile configuration submode — (config-scheduler-profile)

Operands

NAME Name of the scheduler profile. Must be unique and at


least one character long.

Examples
Changing the name of the scheduler profile:
ML66(config-scheduler-profile)#name SchedulerProfile5

58.4 scheduler-profile

Synopsis
Creating a scheduler profile:

— scheduler-profile <PROFILENUMBER> name <NAME>

Editing a scheduler profile:

— scheduler-profile <PROFILENUMBER>

Removing a scheduler profile:

— no scheduler-profile <PROFILENUMBER>

590 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: QoS - Scheduling

Description
Use this command to create or edit a scheduler profile. The command also
changes to the (config-scheduler-profile) submode.

Use the no option to remove the scheduler profile.

Command Mode
Ethernet Profile configuration submode — (config-ethernet-profiles)

Operands

PROFILENUMBER
The unique index of the scheduler profile.

NAME The name of the scheduler profile.

Options

name Sets the name of the scheduler profile.

Examples
Creating a new scheduler profile:
ML66(config-ethernet-profiles)#scheduler-profile 5 name newschedulerprofile
ML66(config-scheduler-profile)#

Removing scheduler profile number 5:


ML66(config-ethernet-profiles)#no scheduler-profile 5

58.5 scheduler-profile

Synopsis
scheduler-profile <PROFILENUMBER>

Description
Use this command to assign a scheduler profile to an Ethernet interface, that is,
to override common Ethernet service settings. These settings apply only for no
lock-to-service interfaces.

Command Mode
Interface QoS configuration submode — (config-qos)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 591


CLI Descriptions

Operands

PROFILENUMBER
The unique index of the scheduler profile.

Examples
Assigning scheduler profile number 5 at interface level:
ML66(config-qos)#scheduler-profile 5

58.6 tc-scheduler-type-and-weight

Synopsis
tc-scheduler-type-and-weight <TC> { strict-priority | dwrr
<DWRRWEIGHT> }

Description
Use this command to specify the scheduler type and Deficit Weighted Round
Robin (DWRR) weight.

Command Mode
Scheduler Profile configuration submode — (config-scheduler-profile)

Operands

TC Traffic class.

DWRRWEIGHT The default weight, as an integer, to be used when the


traffic class is served as DWRR. The valid range is 1–100.
The default value is 1.

Examples
Setting the scheduler type for traffic class 2 to DWRR with a weight of 40:
ML66(config-scheduler-profile)#tc-scheduler-type-and-weight 2 dwrr 40

592 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: QoS - WRED

59 Ethernet Commands: QoS - WRED

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
65.

The following command modes are applicable for the Weighted Random Early
Detection (WRED) commands:

— Ethernet Profile configuration submode — (config-ethernet-profiles)

— WRED Profile configuration submode — (config-wred-profile)

Table 65 QoS - WRED Commands Overview


exponentWeight specify how quickly WRED reacts
maxThreshold specify upper threshold for WRED
minThreshold specify lower threshold for WRED
name change the name of the profile
p-mark specify the probability for packet dropping
wred-profile create or edit a WRED profile

A WRED profile can be used by many users and it cannot be removed as long as
it is in use. A profile must have a non-empty unique name.

To display current mode settings, see the command show current .

The read-only profile (index 1) has the following parameters:

— name = Standard WRED

— minThreshold = 15 (15×64 KB)

— maxThreshold = 48 (48×64 KB)

— p-mark = 10% (0.1)

— exponentWeight = 9

The related show commands are the following:

— show current

— show wred-profile

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 593


CLI Descriptions

59.1 exponentWeight

Synopsis
exponentWeight <GAIN>

Description
Use this command to specify how quickly Weighted Random Early Detection
(WRED) reacts. A low gain value makes WRED react quickly. This makes it
sensitive to short bursts. A high gain values makes WRED react slowly on
transients. This can result in buffer overflow and tail drop.

Command Mode
WRED Profile configuration submode — (config-wred-profile)

Operands

GAIN The convergence speed of the average queue size. The


valid range is 0–15. The default value is 9.

Examples
Specifying how quickly WRED reacts:
ML66(config-wred-profile)#exponentWeight 7

59.2 maxThreshold

Synopsis
maxThreshold <THRESHOLDMAXBYTES>

Description
Use this command to specify the Weighted Random Early Detection (WRED)
upper threshold.

Command Mode
WRED Profile configuration submode — (config-wred-profile)

Operands

THRESHOLDMAXBYTES

594 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: QoS - WRED

The upper threshold for WRED expressed in bytes in n×64


KB units. When the average buffer size crosses
<THRESHOLDMAXBYTES> , all incoming packets are
dropped. If the difference between
<THRESHOLDMINBYTES> and
<THRESHOLDMAXBYTES> is too small, many packets
can be dropped at once. This can lead to global
synchronization issues. The threshold values can be set
between 0×64 KB and 5625×64 KB. The default value is
48×64 KB.

Examples
Setting the WRED upper threshold to 3072 KB:
ML66(config-wred-profile)#maxThreshold 48

59.3 minThreshold

Synopsis
minThreshold <THRESHOLDMINBYTES>

Description
Use this command to specify the Weighted Random Early Detection (WRED)
lower threshold.

Command Mode
WRED Profile configuration submode — (config-wred-profile)

Operands

THRESHOLDMINBYTES
The lower threshold for WRED expressed in bytes in n×64
KB units. When the average buffer size crosses
<THRESHOLDMINBYTES> , WRED is activated. Set
<THRESHOLDMINBYTES> high enough to maximize link
use. If it is set too low, packets can be dropped
unnecessarily. If the difference between
<THRESHOLDMINBYTES> and
<THRESHOLDMAXBYTES> is too small, many packets
can be dropped at once. This can lead to global
synchronization issues. The threshold values can be set
between 0×64 KB and 5625×64 KB. The default value is
15×64 KB.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 595


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Setting the WRED lower threshold to 960 KB:
ML66(config-wred-profile)#minThreshold 15

59.4 name

Synopsis
name <NAME>

Description
Use this command to change the name of the Weighted Random Early Detection
(WRED) profile.

Command Mode
WRED Profile configuration submode — (config-wred-profile)

Operands

NAME Name of the WRED profile. Must be unique and at least


one character long.

Examples
Changing the name of the WRED profile:
ML66(config-wred-profile)#name WREDProfile2

59.5 p-mark

Synopsis
p-mark <MAXDROPPROBABILITY>

Description
Use this command to specify the probability for packet dropping.

Command Mode
WRED Profile configuration submode — (config-wred-profile)

596 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: QoS - WRED

Operands

MAXDROPPROBABILITY
The maximum probability for packet dropping expressed
as a percentage. Weighted Random Early Detection
(WRED) starts to drop packets randomly when the WRED
lower threshold is crossed and the drop probability
increases linearly with queue size up to
<MAXDROPPROBABILITY>. The valid values are 1, 2, 3,
4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 25, 50, 75, and 100. The default value is
10 (that is, 0.1 probability).

Examples
Set the maximum probability for packet dropping to 25%:
ML66(config-wred-profile)#p-mark 25

59.6 wred-profile

Synopsis
Creating a WRED profile:

— wred-profile <PROFILENUMBER> name <NAME>

Editing a WRED profile:

— wred-profile <PROFILENUMBER>

Removing a WRED profile:

— no wred-profile <PROFILENUMBER>

Description
Use this command to create or edit a Weighted Random Early Detection (WRED)
profile. The command also changes to the (config-wred-profile) submode.

Use the no option to remove a WRED profile.

Command Mode
Ethernet Profile configuration submode — (config-ethernet-profiles)

Operands

PROFILENUMBER

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 597


CLI Descriptions

The unique index of the WRED profile.

NAME Name of the new WRED profile. Must be unique and at


least one character long.

Options

name Sets the name of the WRED profile.

Examples
Creating a new WRED profile:
ML66(config-ethernet-profiles)#wred-profile 2 name WREDProfileB
ML66(config-wred-profile)#

598 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: QoS - Queue-Set

60 Ethernet Commands: QoS - Queue-Set

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
66.

The following command modes are applicable for the queue-set commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Ethernet Profile configuration submode — (config-ethernet-profiles)

— Queue Set Profile submode — (queue-set-profile)

— Interface QoS configuration submode — (config-qos)

Table 66 QoS - Queue-Set Commands Overview


bridge queue-set-profile assign a queue-set profile at service
level
name change the name of the queue-set
profile
queue-set-profile create a new queue-set profile
queue-set-profile assign a queue-set profile at interface
level
tc-queue configure Weighted Random Early
Detection (WRED), color-aware
WRED, or color-dropping for a set of 8
Traffic Class (TC) queues

The related show command is the following:

— show queue-set-profile

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

60.1 bridge queue-set-profile

Synopsis
bridge queue-set-profile <PROFILENUMBER>

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 599


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to assign a queue-set profile at service level, that is, to provide
common settings for all Layer 1 service ports and Layer 2 service ports that
support WRED and color dropping. This setting applies only for lock-to-service
ports with enabled deep-buffer.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

PROFILENUMBER
The number of the queue-set profile.

Examples
Assigning a queue-set profile at service level:
ML66(config)#bridge queue-set-profile 4

60.2 name

Synopsis
name <NAME>

Description
Use this command to change the name of the queue-set profile.

Command Mode
Queue Set Profile submode — (queue-set-profile)

Operands

NAME The name of the queue-set profile.

Examples
Changing the name of the queue-set profile:
ML66(queue-set-profile)#name ProfileName

600 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: QoS - Queue-Set

60.3 queue-set-profile

Synopsis

— queue-set-profile <PROFILENUMBER> name <NAME>

— queue-set-profile <PROFILENUMBER>

— no queue-set-profile <PROFILENUMBER>

Description
Use this command to create a new queue-set profile. The queue-set-profile
<PROFILENUMBER> command also changes to the (queue-set-profile)
submode.

Use the no option to remove the queue-set profile.

Command Mode
Ethernet Profile configuration submode — (config-ethernet-profiles)

Operands

PROFILENUMBER
The number of the queue-set profile.

NAME The name of the queue-set profile.

Options

name Sets the name of the queue-set profile.

Examples
Configuring a queue-set profile:
ML66(config-ethernet-profiles)#queue-set-profile 5
ML66(queue-set-profile)#

60.4 queue-set-profile

Synopsis
queue-set-profile <PROFILENUMBER>

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 601


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to assign a queue-set profile at Ethernet interface level, that
is, to override common Ethernet service settings. These settings are available
only to no lock-to-service interfaces with enabled deep-buffer.

Command Mode
Interface QoS configuration submode — (config-qos)

Operands

PROFILENUMBER
The number of the queue-set profile.

Examples
Assigning a queue-set profile at Ethernet interface level:
ML66(config-qos)#queue-set-profile 3

60.5 tc-queue

Synopsis
tc-queue <TC> {wred-profile <PROFILENUMBER> [yellow-wred-profile
<YELLOWPROFILENUMBER>] | color-dropping <YELLOWLIMIT> | taildrop
[queuesize <QUEUESIZE>]}

Description
Use this command to configure Weighted Random Early Detection (WRED),
color-aware WRED, or color-dropping for a set of 8 Traffic Class (TC) queues. It is
possible to configure either WRED or color-dropping for a single TC.

Command Mode
Queue Set Profile configuration submode — (queue-set-profile)

Operands

TC Traffic class. The valid range is 0–7.

PROFILENUMBER
The number of the WRED profile.

YELLOWPROFILENUMBER
The number of the color-aware WRED profile.

602 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: QoS - Queue-Set

YELLOWLIMIT The buffer level, as the ration of the total buffer size, at
which all yellow packets are dropped. The buffer level is
configured in percentage of the buffer size. The valid
values are 12.5, 25, 37.5, 50, 62.5, 75, and 87.5.

QUEUESIZE The hard limit of the queue size when tail dropping is
enabled. The queue cannot exceed this size in the shared
buffer, even when more buffer space is available. 0 value
disables the hard limit and the queue size is only limited
by the dynamically calculated discard threshold. The valid
values (expressed in KB) are between 0 and 360000.

Options

wred-profile Sets the queue-set profile to WRED for a TC.

yellow-wred-profile
Sets the queue-set profile to color-aware WRED for a TC.

color-dropping Sets the queue-set profile to color-dropping for a TC.

taildrop Disables the drop function for the TC, that is, the queue
size is limited by the buffer size. This is the default setting
for all TCs.

queuesize Sets hard limit for tail dropping queue.

Examples
Configuring WRED for traffic class 3:
ML66(queue-set-profile)#tc-queue 3 wred-profile 2

Configuring color-aware WRED for traffic class 3:


ML66(queue-set-profile)#tc-queue 3 wred-profile 2 yellow-wred-profile 3

Configuring tail drop with user defined limit of 1440 KB for traffic class 4:
ML66(queue-set-profile)#tc-queue 4 taildrop queuesize 1440

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 603


CLI Descriptions

61 Ethernet Commands: QoS - Policing and


Color Marking

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
67.

The following command modes are applicable for the policing and color marking
commands:

— Ethernet Profile configuration submode — (config-ethernet-profiles)

— Policing Bandwidth Profile configuration submode — (config-pol-bw-


profile)

— Interface QoS configuration submode — (config-qos)

— QoS Policing configuration submode — (config-qos-policing)

— QoS Policing CoS Group configuration submode — (config-qos-pol-cos-


group)

— QoS Policing CoS Group Mapping configuration submode — (config-qos-


pol-cos-group-mapping)

— QoS Policing VLAN Group configuration submode — (config-qos-pol-vlan-


group)

— QoS Policing VLAN Group Mapping configuration submode — (config-qos-


pol-vlan-group-mapping)

Table 67 QoS - Policing and Color Marking Commands Overview


cbs set Committed Burst Size (CBS) value
cir set Committed Information Rate (CIR) value
default-cos set default Class of Service (CoS) value
ebs set Excess Burst Size (EBS) value
eir set Excess Information Rate (EIR) value
mode set policing
policing change to the (config-qos-policing) submode
policing-bandwidth- create or edit a bandwidth profile
profile
policing-cos-group enable policing, and change to the (config-
qos-pol-cos-group) submode

604 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: QoS - Policing and Color Marking

policing-cos-group- set the default CoS group for all CoSs


mapping
policing-vlan-group change to QoS Policing VLAN Group
configuration submode
policing-vlan-group- configure policing VLAN mapping, and change
mapping to QoS Policing VLAN Group Mapping
configuration submode
pol-cos-and-cos- define CoS value and CoS group
group
pol-cos-group-and- define according to which bandwidth profile
bandwidth-profile the CoS group is policedset the default VLAN
group for all VLANs, and change to QoS
Policing VLAN Group Mapping configuration
submode
pol-vlan-and-vlan- map a VLAN ID to a VLAN group
group
pol-vlan-group-and- define according to which bandwidth profile
bandwidth-profile the VLAN group is policed
port-bandwidth- associate a bandwidth profile with a port
profile

The related show commands are the following:

— show policing

— show policing-bandwidth-profile

— show policing-cos-groups

— show policing-cos-group-mapping

— show policing-vlan-groups

— show policing-vlan-group-mapping

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

61.1 cbs

Synopsis
cbs [ 0 | 16k | 32k | 64k | 128k | 256k | 512k | 1024k | 2048k | 4096k | 8192k
| 16384k ]

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 605


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to set the Committed Burst Size (CBS) value in kilobytes.

Command Mode
Policing Bandwidth Profile configuration submode — (config-pol-bw-
profile)

Examples
Setting CBS to 32 KB:
ML66(config-pol-bw-profile)#cbs 32k

61.2 cir

Synopsis
cir <COMMITTEDINFORMATIONRATE>

Description
Use this command to set the Committed Information Rate (CIR) value in n×64
kbps units.

Command Mode
Policing Bandwidth Profile configuration submode — (config-pol-bw-
profile)

Operands

COMMITTEDINFORMATIONRATE
The CIR value. The valid range is 1–15625 (×64 kbps) for
1 Gbps ports and 1–156250 (×64 kbps) for 10 Gbps
ports.

Examples
Setting CIR value to 640 Mbps:
ML66(config-pol-bw-profile)#cir 10000

61.3 default-cos

606 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: QoS - Policing and Color Marking

Synopsis
default-cos <DEFAULTCOS>

Description
Use this command to set the default Class of Service (CoS) value.

Command Mode
QoS Policing configuration submode — (config-qos-policing)

Operands

DEFAULTCOS The default CoS value. Valid range depends on the type
of Trusted Port:

— DSCP IPv4 — The valid range is 0–63.

— DSCP IPv6 — The valid range is 0–63.

— DSCP IPv4/IPv6 — The valid range is 0–63.

— MPLS — The valid range is 0–7.

Examples
Setting default CoS value to 2:
ML66(config-qos-policing)#default-cos 2

61.4 ebs

Synopsis
ebs [ 0 | 16k | 32k | 64k | 128k | 256k | 512k | 1024k ]

Description
Use this command to set the Excess Burst Size (EBS) value in kilobytes.

Command Mode
Policing Bandwidth Profile configuration submode — (config-pol-bw-
profile)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 607


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Setting EBS to 16 KB:
ML66(config-pol-bw-profile)#ebs 16k

61.5 eir

Synopsis
eir <EXCESSINFORMATIONRATE>

Description
Use this command to set the Excess Information Rate (EIR) value in n×64 kbps
units.

Command Mode
Policing Bandwidth Profile configuration submode — (config-pol-bw-
profile)

Operands

EXCESSINFORMATIONRATE
The EIR value. The valid range is 1–15625 (×64 kbps) for
1 Gbps ports and 1–156250 (×64 kbps) for 10 Gbps
ports.

Examples
Setting EIR value to 64 Mbps:
ML66(config-pol-bw-profile)#eir 1000

61.6 mode

Synopsis
mode {policePortAndVlan | policePortAndCos | policePort | noPolice}

Description
Use this command to set policing mode.

608 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: QoS - Policing and Color Marking

Command Mode
QoS Policing configuration submode — (config-qos-policing)

Options

policePortAndVlan
Activate policing per port and VLAN ID.

policePortAndCos
Activate policing per port and class of service.

policePort Activate policing on port level.

noPolice No policing.

Examples
Activating policing on port level:
ML66(config-qos-policing)#mode policePort

61.7 policing

Synopsis
policing

Description
Use this command to change to the (config-qos-policing) submode.

Command Mode
Interface QoS configuration submode — (config-qos)

Examples
Changing to the (config-qos-policing) submode:
ML66(config-qos)#policing
ML66(config-qos-policing)#

61.8 policing-bandwidth-profile

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 609


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
Creating a bandwidth profile:

— policing-bandwidth-profile <PROFILENUMBER> name <NAME>

Editing a bandwidth profile:

— policing-bandwidth-profile <PROFILENUMBER>

Removing a bandwidth profile:

— no policing-bandwidth-profile <PROFILENUMBER>

Description
Use this command to create or edit a bandwidth profile. The command also
changes to the (config-pol-bw-profile) submode.

Use the no option to remove the bandwidth profile.

Note: The dropNone and dropAll default profiles cannot be modified.

Command Mode
Ethernet Profile configuration submode — (config-ethernet-profiles)

Operands

PROFILENUMBER
The unique index of the bandwidth profile.

NAME The name of the bandwidth profile.

Options

name Sets the name of the bandwidth profile.

Examples
Creating a bandwidth profile:
ML66(config-ethernet-profiles)#policing-bandwidth-profile 3 name "My profile"
ML66(config-pol-bw-profile)#

61.9 policing-cos-group

610 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: QoS - Policing and Color Marking

Synopsis
policing-cos-group

Description
Use this command to enable policing. The command also changes to the (config-
qos-pol-cos-group) submode.

Command Mode
Interface QoS configuration submode — (config-qos)

Examples
Enabling policing:
ML66(config-qos)#policing-cos-group
ML66(config-qos-pol-cos-group)#

61.10 policing-cos-group-mapping

Synopsis
policing-cos-group-mapping

Description
Use this command to configure policing CoS mapping. The command also
changes to the (config-qos-pol-cos-group-mapping) submode.

Command Mode
Interface QoS configuration submode — (config-qos)

Examples
Changing to the (config-qos-pol-cos-group-mapping) submode:
ML66(config-qos)#policing-cos-group-mapping
ML66(config-qos-pol-cos-group-mapping)#

61.11 policing-vlan-group

Synopsis
policing-vlan-group

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 611


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to change to QoS Policing VLAN Group configuration
submode.

Command Mode
Interface QoS configuration submode — (config-qos)

Examples
Changing to QoS Policing VLAN Group configuration submode:
ML66(config-qos)#policing-vlan-group
ML66(config-qos-pol-vlan-group)#

61.12 policing-vlan-group-mapping

Synopsis
[no] policing-vlan-group-mapping

Description
Use this command to configure policing VLAN mapping. The command also
changes to QoS Policing VLAN Group Mapping configuration submode.

Use the no option to set the default VLAN group for all VLANs, that is, all VLANs
to be mapped to VLAN group 0.

Command Mode
Interface QoS configuration submode — (config-qos)

Examples
Setting the default VLAN group for all VLANs:
ML66(config-qos)#no policing-vlan-group-mapping
ML66(config-qos-pol-vlan-group-mapping)#

61.13 pol-cos-and-cos-group

Synopsis
pol-cos-and-cos-group <COS> <COSGROUP>

612 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: QoS - Policing and Color Marking

Description
Use this command to map Class of Service (CoS) value to CoS group.

Command Mode
QoS Policing CoS Group Mapping configuration submode — (config-qos-pol-
cos-group-mapping)

Operands

COS The CoS value.

COSGROUP The CoS group.

Examples
Mapping CoS value 1 to CoS group 2:
ML66(config-qos-pol-cos-group-mapping)#pol-cos-and-cos-group 1 2

61.14 pol-cos-group-and-bandwidth-profile

Synopsis
pol-cos-group-and-bandwidth-profile <GROUP> <PROFILENUMBER>

Description
Use this command to define according to which bandwidth profile the Class of
Service (CoS) group is policed. Create bandwidth profiles with commands in the
(config-pol-bw-profile) submode.

Command Mode
QoS Policing CoS Group configuration submode — (config-qos-pol-cos-
group)

Operands

GROUP The CoS group.

PROFILENUMBER
The unique index of the bandwidth profile.

Examples
Specifying that CoS group 2 is policed by bandwidth profile 5:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 613


CLI Descriptions

ML66(config-qos-pol-cos-group)#pol-cos-group-and-bandwidth-profile 2 5

61.15 pol-vlan-and-vlan-group

Synopsis
pol-vlan-and-vlan-group <VLAN> <VLANGROUP>

Description
Use this command to map a VLAN ID to a VLAN group.

Command Mode
QoS Policing VLAN Group Mapping configuration submode — (config-qos-pol-
vlan-group-mapping)

Operands

VLAN The VLAN ID.

VLANGROUP The VLAN group.

Examples
Mapping VLAN 1 to VLAN group 2:
ML66(config-qos-pol-vlan-group-mapping)#pol-vlan-and-vlan-group 1 2

61.16 pol-vlan-group-and-bandwidth-profile

Synopsis
pol-vlan-group-and-bandwidth-profile <GROUP> <PROFILENUMBER>

Description
Use this command to define according to which bandwidth profile the VLAN
group is policed.

To create bandwidth profiles, use the commands available in the (config-pol-


bw-profile) submode.

Command Mode
QoS Policing VLAN Group configuration submode — (config-qos-pol-vlan-group)

614 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: QoS - Policing and Color Marking

Operands

GROUP The VLAN group.

PROFILENUMBER
The unique index of the bandwidth profile.

Examples
Specifying that VLAN group 2 is policed according to bandwidth profile 5:
ML66(config-qos-pol-vlan-group)#pol-vlan-group-and-bandwidth-profile 2 5

61.17 port-bandwidth-profile

Synopsis
port-bandwidth-profile <PROFILENUMBER>

Description
Use this command to associate a bandwidth profile with a port.

Command Mode
QoS Policing configuration submode — (config-qos-policing)

Operands

PROFILENUMBER
The unique index of the bandwidth profile.

Examples
Associating bandwidth profile 1 to a port:
ML66(config-qos-policing)#port-bandwidth-profile 1

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 615


CLI Descriptions

62 Ethernet Commands: QoS - Port Shaping

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
68.

The following command modes are applicable for the Ethernet Commands: QoS -
Port Shaping commands.

— Interface QoS configuration submode — (config-qos)

Table 68 Shaper Commands Overview


shaper set traffic shaping for selected port
(interface)

62.1 shaper

Synopsis

— shaper [cir <RATE> | cbs <BURSTSIZE>]

— no shaper

Description
Use this command to enable traffic shaping on the selected port.

Use the no option to disable traffic port shaping.

Note: Port shaping is not supported on Layer 1 ports.

Command Mode
Interface QoS configuration submode — (config-qos)

Operands

RATE The committed information rate limit in 64 kbps steps.


The actual bandwidth rate limit is calculated as <RATE> *
64 kbps. If not configured, shaper is enabled with
maximum traffic rate of the port. For example, in case of
a 1G LAN port cir=15625 or for a 10G LAN port
cir=156250.

616 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: QoS - Port Shaping

BURSTSIZE The committed maximum burst size in kilobytes. Only the


following burst values are valid: 16, 32, 64, 128, 256, 512,
1024, 2048. If not provided, shaper is enabled with
default 128 kB burst size.

Examples
Enabling port shaping with 64,000 kbps rate and 1024 kBytes burst size:
ML66(config-qos)#shaper cir 10000 cbs 1024

Disabling port shaper:


ML66(config-qos)#no shaper

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 617


CLI Descriptions

63 Ethernet Commands: HQoS - Node and


Profile Configuration Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
69.

The following command modes are applicable for the HQoS - Node and Profile
Configuration commands.

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Ethernet Profile configuration submode — (config-ethernet-profiles)

— HQoS Profile configuration submode — (config-hqos-profile)

— HQoS Node configuration submode — (config-hqos-node)

Table 69 HQoS Node and Profile Commands Overview


child-node create a Hierarchical Quality of Service
(HQoS) child node in selected profile
hierarchy
hqos-node manage an HQoS node of a profile
hqos-profile create and manage an HQoS profile
h-scheduler set child node hierarchical scheduler
priority at parent node
map set VLAN traffic mapping for the
selected HQoS node
name name an HQoS profile
order change child order within parent node
shaper set VLAN traffic shaping for the
selected HQoS node

The related show command is the following:

— show current

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

618 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: HQoS - Node and Profile Configuration Commands

63.1 child-node

Synopsis

— child-node <CHILDNODENAME> order <ORDER> [h-scheduler {strict


| weighted <WEIGHT>}]

— no child-node <CHILDNODENAME>

Description
Use this command to create a Hierarchical Quality of Service (HQoS) child node
in the selected profile hierarchy, with the specified parameter settings.

Use the no option to delete an HQoS child node and any of its descendants.

Note: Node configuration parameters can be set or modified using separate


commands as well.

Command Mode
HQoS Node configuration submode — (config-hqos-node)

Operands

CHILDNODENAME
The name of the child node.

ORDER The order of child nodes under a parent. The lowest ID is


scheduled first.

WEIGHT The weight for the selected HQoS child node. The valid
range is 1–100.

Options

order Sets the order of the child nodes under its parent node.

strict Sets strict priority scheduling for the selected HQoS child
node. Considering nodes under the same parent, strict
priority can be set for a child node only if it has lower
order than all others with WDRR priority.

weighted Sets WDRR priority scheduling for the selected HQoS


child node.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 619


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Creating an HQoS child node:
ML66(config-hqos-node)#child-node Child_1 order 20 h-scheduler weighted 10

Deleting an HQoS child node and any possible descendants from a parent node:
ML66(config-hqos-node)#no child-node Child_1

63.2 hqos-node

Synopsis
[no] hqos-node {root | default | <NODENAME>}

Description
Use this command to configure a Hierarchical Quality of Service (HQoS) node
resource. This command also changes to the (config-hqos-node) submode.

Note: Only those HQoS node names are accepted that are already exist in the
profile.

The following specific purpose nodes are reserved and created automatically for
each profile when the profile is created:

root It is the root of the hierarchy within the profile. The root
node is connected to a port when the profile is assigned
to it.

default The non-hierarchical default queue system, where all


traffic which is not matched to any VLAN mapping rule is
enqueued. This traffic is called any traffic.

Note: Root and default nodes cannot be renamed or deleted.

In the (config-hqos-node) submode, it is possible to configure the following:


— child nodes

— node order

— hierarchical scheduling type and weight

— VLAN mapping

— shaper

— scheduling profile

620 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: HQoS - Node and Profile Configuration Commands

For the allowed configuration commands for different node types, see the
following table:

Table 70 Allowed Configuration Commands for Node Types


root default leaf node internal node
child-node X - - X
order - X X X
h-scheduler - X X X
map - - X -
shaper - X X X

Use the no option to delete an HQoS node.

Command Mode
HQoS Profile configuration submode — (config-hqos-profile)

Operands

NODENAME The unique profile name of the HQoS node.

Options

root Selects the root node of the profile.

default Selects the default hierarchy node of the profile that


handles any unicast and replicated traffic.

Examples
Entering HQoS Node configuration submode selecting the root node of the
profile:
ML66(config-hqos-profile)#hqos-node root

ML66(config-hqos-node)#

Entering HQoS Node configuration submode selecting the default node of the
profile:
ML66(config-hqos-profile)#hqos-node default

ML66(config-hqos-node)#

Entering HQoS Node configuration submode selecting an existing HQoS node


name:
ML66(config-hqos-profile)#hqos-node HNode_1

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 621


CLI Descriptions

ML66(config-hqos-node)#

Deleting an HQoS node:


ML66(config-hqos-profile)#no hqos-node HNode_1

63.3 hqos-profile

Synopsis
[no] hqos-profile <PROFILEID> [name <PROFILENAME>]

Description
Use this command to create a Hierarchical Quality of Service (HQoS) profile or
manage an existing one. This command also changes to the (config-hqos-profile)
submode.

If the profile does not exist, this command creates the HQoS profile and its root
and default nodes connected.

Further configuration of HQoS hierarchy is possible by entering the root node or


its descendant nodes in HQoS Node configuration submode.

Use the no option to delete an HQoS profile.

Command Mode
Ethernet Profile configuration submode — (config-ethernet-profiles)

Operands

PROFILEID The unique identifier of an HQoS profile in range 2 .. 32.


Profile=1 is reserved for the default traffic.

PROFILENAME The unique name of an HQoS profile. It is mandatory,


when the profile is first created.

Options

name Names the new HQoS profile to be created.

Examples
Creating an HQoS profile:
ML66(config-ethernet-profiles)#hqos-profile 12 name Profile_1

ML66(config-hqos-profile)#

622 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: HQoS - Node and Profile Configuration Commands

Changing to an existing HQoS profile:


ML66(config-ethernet-profiles)#hqos-profile 12

ML66(config-hqos-profile)#

Deleting an HQoS profile:


ML66(config-ethernet-profiles)#no hqos-profile 12

63.4 h-scheduler

Synopsis
h-scheduler {strict | weighted <WEIGHT>}

Description
Use this command to set the scheduler priority of the Hierarchical Quality of
Service (HQoS) child node on its parent node scheduler.

Only strict priority or Weighted Deficit Round Robin (WDRR) scheduling priority
can be selected.

Command Mode
HQoS Node configuration submode — (config-hqos-node)

Operands

WEIGHT The weight for the selected HQoS child node. The valid
range is 1–100.

Options

strict Sets strict priority scheduling for the selected HQoS child
node. Considering nodes under the same parent, strict
priority can be set for a child node only if it has lower
order than all others with WDRR priority.

weighted Sets WDRR priority scheduling for the selected HQoS


child node.

Examples
Setting strict priority for an HQoS child node:
ML66(config-hqos-node)#h-scheduler strict

Setting WDRR priority for an HQoS child node:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 623


CLI Descriptions

ML66(config-hqos-node)#h-scheduler weighted 30

63.5 map

Synopsis
[no] map {any | outer-vid <OUTERVID> [inner-vid <INNERVID>]}

Description
Use this command to set VLAN traffic mapping on the selected Hierarchical
Quality of Service (HQoS) leaf node.

One map command can include one outer and one inner VLAN ID (VID).

To map multiple VIDs to the same node, use the command as many times as
many VIDs are required.

Note: The number of total mapping values is limited.

VLAN mapping must be unique within a profile.

When using only the outer-vid option, the inner VID, if any exists, is handled as
any.

Command Mode
HQoS Node configuration submode — (config-hqos-node)

Operands

OUTERVID The outer VLAN identifier.

INNERVID The inner VLAN identifier.

Options

any Maps traffic belonging to non-specified VLANs to a user-


defined leaf node.

Note: This option overwrites the implicit any mapping


of the default node that is automatically created
at profile creation.

outer-vid Maps the VID from the Ethernet header to the leaf node.
In case of a double-tagged Ethernet header, the outer
VID is mapped.

624 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: HQoS - Node and Profile Configuration Commands

inner-vid Maps the VID from the inner VLAN tag in the case of a
double-tagged Ethernet frame. In case of double tagging
in Provider Mode, the outer tag is called Service VLAN tag
(S-tag), and the inner tag is called Customer VLAN tag
(C-tag).

Note: The option inner-vid cannot be used together


with any, use outer VID only.

Examples
Mapping non-specified VIDs:
ML66(config-hqos-node)#map any

Mapping outer VID 105:


ML66(config-hqos-node)#map outer-vid 105

Mapping outer VID 105 and inner VID 201:


ML66(config-hqos-node)#map outer-vid 105 inner-vid 201

Deleting an already mapped VID:


ML66(config-hqos-node)#no map any

ML66(config-hqos-node)#no map outer-vid 105

ML66(config-hqos-node)#no map outer-vid 105 inner-vid 201

63.6 name

Synopsis
name <PROFILENAME>

Description
Use this command to set the name of the selected Hierarchical Quality of Service
(HQoS) profile.

Command Mode
HQoS Profile configuration submode — (config-hqos-profile)

Operands

PROFILENAME The name of the HQoS profile.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 625


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Naming an HQoS profile:
ML66(config-hqos-profile)#name Profile_2

63.7 order

Synopsis
order <NODEORDER>

Description
Use this command to change the order of the Hierarchical Quality of Service
(HQoS) child nodes to define proper scheduling priority among them.

The lowest ordered child is assigned to the highest priority when using strict
priority.

Note: All child nodes with strict h-scheduler priority have to have lower order
number than child nodes with weighted h-scheduler priority.

The order is effective on the selected HQoS node.

Command Mode
HQoS Node configuration submode — (config-hqos-node)

Operands

NODEORDER The new order for the child node. The valid range is 1–
1024. In order to make later reordering easier, it is
recommended to leave room between consecutive child
nodes.

Examples
Changing the order of a child node:
ML66(config-hqos-node)#order 25

63.8 shaper

Synopsis
[no] shaper cir <CIRVALUE> [cbs <CBSVALUE>]

626 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: HQoS - Node and Profile Configuration Commands

Description
Use this command to add or modify bandwidth shaping on the selected
Hierarchical Quality of Service (HQoS) node. Bandwidth shaping can be
configured to limit bandwidth rate and to limit burst size.

Use the no option to delete the bandwidth shaping on the selected HQoS node.

Command Mode
HQoS Node configuration submode — (config-hqos-node)

Operands

CIRVALUE The committed information rate limit in 64 kbps chunks.


The bandwidth rate limit is calculated as <CIRVALUE> *
64 kbps.

CBSVALUE The committed maximum burst size in kilobytes. Only the


following values are valid: 16, 32, 64, 128, 256, 512,
1024, 2048.

Options

cir Configures the committed information rate limit.

cbs Configures the committed maximum burst size.

Examples
Changing bandwidth rate limit to 300 Mbps on an HQoS child node:
ML66(config-hqos-node)#shaper cir 4688

Changing bandwidth rate limit to 300 Mbps with 32 kBytes burst size on an
HQoS child node:
ML66(config-hqos-node)#shaper cir 4688 cbs 32

Removing all bandwidth rate limit:


ML66(config-hqos-node)#no shaper

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 627


CLI Descriptions

64 Ethernet Commands: HQoS - Profile


Assignment Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Ethernet
Commands: HQoS - Profile Assignment Commands on page 628.

The following command modes are applicable for the HQoS - Profile Assignment
commands.

— Interface QoS configuration submode — (config-qos)

Table 71 HQoS Profile Assignment Commands Overview


hqos-profile assign a Hierarchical Quality of
Service (HQoS) profile to a selected
interface or port

64.1 hqos-profile

Synopsis
hqos-profile <PROFILEID>

Description
Use this command to assign a Hierarchical Quality of Service (HQoS) profile to
the selected Ethernet interface.

Note: Short traffic loss might be experienced during the change of an HQoS
profile as the egress queues need to be reconfigured.

The same profile can be assigned to different interfaces.

Any further changes to the HQoS profile is automatically updated on the


interface(s) it is assigned to.

Removing hierarchical profile from an interface can be done by returning


to the default HQoS profile (PROFILEID = 1).

Command Mode
Interface QoS configuration submode — (config-qos)

628 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: HQoS - Profile Assignment Commands

Operands

PROFILEID The unique identifier of the HQoS profile. It can take the
value of 1 ..32.

Examples
Assigning an HQoS profile to an interface:
ML66(config-qos)#hqos-profile 10

Disabling the HQoS feature by assigning the default profile to an interface:


ML66(config-qos)#hqos-profile 1

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 629


CLI Descriptions

65 Ethernet Commands: Diagnostics Tools

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
72.

The following command mode is applicable for the diagnostics tools commands:

— Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Table 72 Diagnostics Tools Commands Overview


mirror mirrored-port mirror a port
mirror mode specify which type of traffic to mirror
mirror mtp-vlan specify mtp vlan

65.1 mirror mirrored-port

Synopsis
mirror mirrored-port <RSP>

Description
Use this command to mirror a port.

Note: Port role must be set to mirror for port mirroring.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Operands

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port value of the port to be mirrored
in <Rack/Slot/Port> format.

Examples
Mirroring port 1/6/5:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#mirror mirrored-port 1/6/5

65.2 mirror mode

630 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Diagnostics Tools

Synopsis
mirror mode { ingress | egress | ingressEgress }

Description
Use this command to specify which type of traffic to mirror. The default behavior
is to mirror both ingress and egress traffic.

Note: Port role must be set to mirror for port mirroring.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Options

ingress Sets mirroring to ingress traffic only.

egress Sets mirroring to egress traffic only.

ingressEgress Sets mirroring to both ingress and egress traffic.

Examples
Setting mirroring to ingress traffic only:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#mirror mode ingress

65.3 mirror mtp-vlan

Synopsis
mirror mtp-vlan <VLAN>

Description
Use this command to tag the mirrored egress and ingress traffic on the mirror-to-
port with the MTP VLAN tag as outer tag. The MTP VLAN tag allows to route the
mirrored packets to a remote packet analyzer.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 631


CLI Descriptions

Operands

VLAN Identification number of the VLAN. The value can be set


from 0 to 4094.

Setting the value 0 disables tagging of the mirrored


traffic.

Examples
Adding VLAN tagging of egress traffic:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#mirror mtp-vlan 1

632 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Classification and Tagging

66 Ethernet Commands: Classification and


Tagging

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
73.

The following command modes are applicable for the classification and tagging
commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Table 73 Classification and Tagging Commands Overview


bridge network-pcp-selection set the Priority Code Point (PCP) selection
cep-pvid set the port VID (PVID) for a CE-UNI port
cvid-registration add a C-VID–S-VID pair to the C-VID
registration table
default-network-priority set the default network priority for a UNI, CE-
UNI, CN-UNI, or Layer 1 service port
trusted specify which priority field in the incoming
packet is trusted on a UNI, CE-UNI, CN-UNI, or
Layer 1 service port
user-priority-mapping add a user priority to network priority mapping

66.1 bridge network-pcp-selection

Synopsis

— bridge network-pcp-selection { 8p0d | 7p1d | 6p2d | 5p3d | 8p8d }

— no bridge network-pcp-selection

Description
Use this command to set the Priority Code Point (PCP) selection, which defines
the priority to traffic class mapping for both Layer 1 service ports and Layer 2
service ports.

Note: If priority to traffic class mapping is set to 802.1 D standard, only the
8p0d value is available.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 633


CLI Descriptions

Use the no option to reset default values.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Options

8p0d Sets the PCP selection to 8 priorities, 0 priorities with


color dropping.

7p1d Sets the PCP selection to 7 priorities 1 priority with color


dropping.

6p2d Sets the PCP selection to 6 priorities, 2 priorities with


color dropping.

5p3d Sets the PCP selection to 5 priorities, 3 priorities with


color dropping.

8p8d Sets the PCP selection to 8 priorities, the Drop Eligible


Indicator (DEI) bit in the S-VLAN tag is used to retrieve or
indicate the drop eligibility of frames. Only available in
provider mode.

Examples
Setting the PCP selection to 6p2d:
ML66(config)#bridge network-pcp-selection 6p2d

66.2 cep-pvid

Synopsis
cep-pvid <PVID>

Description
Use this command to set the PVID for a CE-UNI port when the bridge is in
provider mode.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

634 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Classification and Tagging

Operands

PVID The PVID. The value can be set from 0 to 4094.

Examples
Setting the PVID to 2:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#cep-pvid 2

66.3 cvid-registration

Synopsis
Adding a single C-VID–S-VID pair to the C-VID registration table:

[no] cvid-registration <CVID> <SVID>

Description
Use this command to add a C-VID–S-VID pair to the C-VID registration table.

Use the no option to remove a C-VID–S-VID pair from the C-VID registration
table.

Command Mode
Bridgeport configuration submode — (config-bridgeport)

Operands

CVID The C-VID of the pair. The valid range is 0–4094.

SVID The S-VID of the pair. The valid range is 1–4094.

Examples
Adding the C-VID–S-VID pair 3 12:
ML66(config-bridgeport)#cvid-registration 3 12

66.4 default-network-priority

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 635


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis

— default-network-priority <PRIORITY>

— no default-network-priority

Description
Use this command to set the default network priority for a UNI, CE-UNI, CN-UNI,
or Layer 1 service port. The default value is 0 on LAN and WAN interfaces, and 4
on the LAN-DCN interface.

Use the no option to reset the default network priority.

Command Mode
Interface QoS configuration submode — (config-qos)

Operands

PRIORITY The network priority. The value can be set from 0 to 7.

Examples
Setting the default network priority to 7:
ML66(config-qos)#default-network-priority 7

66.5 trusted

Synopsis

— trusted { stagPcp | exp | dscpIPv6 | dscpIPv4 | dscpIPv4IPv6 | ctagPcp |


expDscp }

— no trusted

Description
Use this command to specify which priority field in the incoming packet is trusted
on a UNI, CE-UNI, CN-UNI, or Layer 1 service port. By default, no priority field in
the incoming packet is trusted, and the default priority is used.

Use the no option to specify that no priority field in the incoming packet is
trusted.

Command Mode
Interface QoS configuration submode — (config-qos)

636 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: Classification and Tagging

Options

stagPcp Specifies the Priority Code Point (PCP) field on the S-tag
as trusted. Only valid for Layer 1, and CN-UNI in provider
mode for Layer 2. If the packet is untagged, the default
priority is used.

exp Specifies the Experimental, redefined as Traffic Class,


field on Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS) as trusted.
If the packet is not MPLS, the default priority is used.

dscpIPv6 Specifies the Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)


field on IPv6 as trusted. If the packet is not IPv6, the
default priority is used.

dscpIPv4 Specifies the DSCP field on IPv4 as trusted. If the packet


is not IPv4, the default priority is used.

dscpIPv4IPv6 Specifies the DSCP field on either IPv4 or IPv6 as trusted.


If the packet is neither IPv4 nor IPv6, the default priority
is used.

ctagPcp Specifies the PCP field on the C-tag as trusted. It is valid


for Layer 1. For Layer 2, it is valid for UNI in customer
mode and CE-UNI in provider mode. It is valid for CN-UNI
in provider mode only if the acceptable frame type of the
CN-UNI port is set to admit only untagged and priority-
tagged frames. If the packet is untagged, the default
priority is used.

expDscp Specifies the Experimental, redefined as Traffic Class,


field on MPLS as trusted. If the packet is not MPLS, it
specifies the DSCP field on IPv4/IPv6 as trusted. If the
packet is not IP, the default priority is used.

Examples
Specifying the PCP field on the C-tag as trusted:
ML66(config-qos)#trusted ctagPcp

66.6 user-priority-mapping

Synopsis

— user-priority-mapping <PRIORITY> <NETWORKPRIORITY>

— no user-priority-mapping <PRIORITY>

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 637


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to add a user priority to network priority mapping.

Use the no option to load the default mapping.

Command Mode
Interface QoS configuration submode — (config-qos)

Operands

PRIORITY The user priority.

NETWORKPRIORITY
The network priority.

Examples
Adding the user priority to network priority mapping 2 to 3:
ML66(config-qos)#user-priority-mapping 2 3

638 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: LAG

67 Ethernet Commands: LAG

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
74.

The following command modes are applicable for the Link Aggregation Group
(LAG) commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— LAG configuration submode — (config-lag)

Table 74 LAG Commands Overview


alarm-enable-degraded-service enable or disable the degraded
service alarm
alarm-enable-no-traffic enable or disable no traffic alarm
alarm-enable-unable-to-protect enable or disable unable to protect
alarm
clear lag counters clear LAG-level Switchovers
counter and the LACP counters on
all member links of the LAG
hash-type define the hashing algorithm
lacp activity define Link Aggregation Control
Protocol (LACP) Activity
lacp controlmode enable or disable LACP
lacp lag-sys-priority define LACP system priority
lacp max-delay set collector maximum delay
lacp revertive enable revertive mode for a LAG
lacp timeout set the length of LACP timeout
lag create Link Aggregation Group
(LAG)
members define LAG member ports

The related show commands are the following:

— show lag

— show lag lacpstats

— show lag status

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 639


CLI Descriptions

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

67.1 alarm-enable-degraded-service

Synopsis
[no] alarm-enable-degraded-service

Description
Use this command to enable the degraded service alarm.

Use the no option to disable the degraded service alarm.

Command Mode
LAG configuration submode — (config-lag)

Examples
Enabling degraded service alarm:
ML66(config-lag)#alarm-enable-degraded-service

67.2 alarm-enable-no-traffic

Synopsis
[no] alarm-enable-no-traffic

Description
Use this command to enable the no traffic alarm.

Use the no option to disable no traffic alarm.

Command Mode
LAG configuration submode — (config-lag)

Examples
Enabling no traffic alarm:

640 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: LAG

ML66(config-lag)#alarm-enable-no-traffic

67.3 alarm-enable-unable-to-protect

Synopsis
[no] alarm-enable-unable-to-protect

Description
Use this command to enable the unable to protect alarm.

This alarm is raised if one of the links is faulty in 1+1 mode.

Use the no option to disable the unable to protect alarm.

Command Mode
LAG configuration submode — (config-lag)

Examples
ML66(config-lag)#alarm-enable-unable-to-protect

67.4 clear lag counters

Synopsis
clear lag counters <LAGID>

Description
Use this command to clear LAG-level Switchovers counter and the LACP counters
on all member links of the LAG.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

LAGID The Link Aggregation Group (LAG) ID in <Rack/Slot/


Port> format.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 641


CLI Descriptions

Examples
ML66>clear lag counters 1/6/5

67.5 hash-type

Synopsis
hash-type { mac-sa-da | mac-sa | mac-da | ip-src-dst | ip-src | ip-dst }

Description
Use this command to define the hashing algorithm for Link Aggregation Group
(LAG) load balancing.

Note: This command is not applicable to LACP 1+1 mode.

The default hashing algorithm is mac-sa-da.

Attention!
The reconfiguration of the hashing algorithm may lead to traffic errors on the receiver
side. Changing the hashing algorithm causes packet reordering for the traffic flows, due
to the different traffic distribution in the LAG.

Command Mode
LAG configuration submode — (config-lag)

Options

mac-sa-da The hashing algorithm is based on source Media Access


Control (MAC) address, destination MAC address, VLAN
ID, Ethertype, and source bridge port ID.

mac-sa The hashing algorithm is based on source MAC address,


VLAN ID, Ethertype, and source bridge port ID.

mac-da The hashing algorithm is based on destination MAC


address, VLAN ID, Ethertype, and source bridge port ID.

ip-src-dst The hashing algorithm is based on source IP address,


destination IP address, source TCP/UDP port, and
destination TCP/UDP port.

642 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: LAG

ip-src The hashing algorithm is based on source IP address and


source TCP/UDP port.

ip-dst The hashing algorithm is based on destination IP address


and destination TCP/UDP port.

Examples
Define the hashing algorithm based on source MAC address, destination MAC
address, VLAN ID, Ethertype, and source bridge port ID:
ML66(config-lag)#hash-type mac-sa-da

67.6 lacp activity

Synopsis
lacp activity { active | passive }

Description
Use this command to define Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) Activity.

Note: The default setting of the LACP Activity must be changed to Active
manually, at least on one side of the LAG.

Command Mode
LAG configuration submode — (config-lag)

Options

active Sets LACP Activity to active. The LACP in the current LAG
is able to start negotiation with the peer.

passive Sets LACP Activity to passive. The LACP is waiting for the
Protocol Data Unit (PDU) sent by the peer to start
negotiation.

Examples
Setting LACP Activity to active:
ML66(config-lag)#lacp activity active

67.7 lacp controlmode

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 643


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
lacp controlmode {active | static | 1+1}

Description
Use this command to enable or disable Link Aggregation Control Protocol
(LACP).

Note: If the LACP is enabled, the default setting of the LACP Activity must be
changed to Active manually, at least on one side of the LAG.

Command Mode
LAG configuration submode — (config-lag)

Options

active Enables LACP.

static Disables LACP.

1+1 Enables LACP 1+1 mode.

Examples
Enabling LACP:
ML66(config-lag)#lacp controlmode active

67.8 lacp lag-sys-priority

Synopsis
lacp lag-sys-priority <PRIO>

Description
Use this command to define Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) system
priority.

644 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: LAG

Attention!
This command takes effect on all LAGs that use LACP. It may entail a short traffic
disturbance until the LACP protocol adapts to the changed value.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

PRIO The system priority. The valid range is 0–65535.

Examples
Defining LACP system priority to 100:
ML66(config)#lacp lag-sys-priority 100

67.9 lacp max-delay

Synopsis
lacp max-delay <MAXDELAY>

Description
Use this command to set collector maximum delay.

Command Mode
LAG configuration submode — (config-lag)

Operands

MAXDELAY The value of the collector maximum delay in tens of


milliseconds.

Examples
Setting collector maximum delay to 10 ms:
ML66(config-lag)#lacp max-delay 10

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 645


CLI Descriptions

67.10 lacp revertive

Synopsis
[no] lacp revertive

Description
Use this command to enable revertive mode for a LAG.

If revertive mode is enabled, the higher priority link will regain the active role
after its recovery.

Note: This command is only applicable to 1+1 mode.

Use the no option to disable revertive mode.

Command Mode
LAG configuration submode — (config-lag)

Examples
ML66(config-lag)#lacp revertive

67.11 lacp timeout

Synopsis
lacp timeout { short | long }

Description
Use this command to set the length of Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP)
timeout.

Command Mode
LAG configuration submode — (config-lag)

Options

short Sets short timeout with 3s length.

long Sets long timeout with 90s length.

646 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: LAG

Examples
Setting short timeout with 3s:
ML66(config-lag)#lacp timeout short

67.12 lag

Synopsis

— lag <LAGID> [<NAME>]

— no lag <LAGID>

Description
Use this command to configure Link Aggregation Group (LAG) for Ethernet
protection. The command also changes to the (config-lag) submode.

Use the no option to remove the LAG.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

LAGID The Rack, Slot, and Port value of the master port of the
LAG in <Rack/Slot/Port> format.

NAME The name of the LAG. The length of the string must be
between 0 and 32 characters.

Examples
Creating LAG:
ML66(config)#lag 1/6/5
ML66(config-lag)#

67.13 members

Synopsis
members <PORTLIST>

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 647


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to define Link Aggregation Group (LAG) member ports.

Command Mode
LAG configuration submode — (config-lag)

Operands

PORTLIST A list of ports that shows all members of the group in


<Rack/Slot/Port> format. The RSP values are separated
by commas.

Examples
Defining LAG member ports:
ML66(config-lag)#members 1/6/4,1/6/5

648 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: LLDP

68 Ethernet Commands: LLDP

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
75.

The following command modes are applicable for the Link Layer Discovery
Protocol (LLDP) commands:

— Ethernet interface configuration submode — (config-eth)

— LLDP interface level configuration submode — (config-lldp)

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Exec mode — >

Table 75 LLDP Commands Overview


admin-status change the LLDP admin status on the
Ethernet interface
clear counters clear LLDP counters
clear lldp counters clear LLDP counters
lldp dest-mac-address nearest-bridge enter LLDP interface level
configuration (config-lldp) submode
lldp message-fast-tx set the time interval between LLDP
Data Unit (LLDPDU) transmissions
during fast transmission periods
lldp message-tx-hold-multiplier set the multiplier used for Time To Live
(TTL) calculation of LLDPDUs
lldp message-tx-interval set the time interval between periodic
LLDPDU transmissions
lldp notification-enable enable LLDP notifications about
changes in the LLDP remote systems
database
lldp notification-interval set the minimum time interval
between LLDP notifications about
changes in the LLDP remote systems
database
lldp tx-fast-init set the number of LLDPDUs that are
transmitted during fast transmission
periods
tlvs-tx-enable enable Type-Length-Value (TLV)
types in transmitted LLDP packets

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 649


CLI Descriptions

The related show commands are the following:

— show counters

— show current

— show lldp config

— show lldp counters

— show lldp local-info

— show lldp neighbors

— show local-info

— show neighbors

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

68.1 admin-status

Synopsis
admin-status {tx-and-rx | disabled}

Description
Use this command to change the Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) admin
status on the Ethernet interface.

By default, the LLDP admin status is disabled on Ethernet interfaces.

Command Mode
LLDP interface level configuration submode — (config-lldp)

Options

tx-and-rx Enables LLDP packet transmission and reception.

disabled Disables LLDP packet transmission and reception.

Examples
Enabling LLDP packet transmission on the Ethernet interface:
ML66(config-lldp)#admin-status tx-and-rx

650 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: LLDP

68.2 clear counters

Synopsis
clear counters

Description
Use this command to clear the Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) counters of
the accessed Ethernet interface.

Command Mode
LLDP interface level configuration submode — (config-lldp)

Examples
Clearing LLDP counters on the Ethernet interface:
ML66(config-lldp)#clear counters

68.3 clear lldp counters

Synopsis
clear lldp counters [<RSP>]

Description
Use this command to clear Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) counters.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

RSP The rack, slot, and port values of the interface whose
current LLDP counters are to be cleared, in the following
format: <Rack/Slot/Port>.

Examples
Clearing all LLDP counters:
ML66>clear lldp counters

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 651


CLI Descriptions

Clearing the LLDP counters of LAN 1/6/4 only:


ML66>clear lldp counters 1/6/4

68.4 lldp dest-mac-address nearest-bridge

Synopsis
[no] lldp dest-mac-address nearest-bridge

Description
Use this command to enter Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) interface level
configuration (config-lldp) submode, where interface level LLDP configuration
commands are available.

Use the no option to delete the interface LLDP configuration. As a result, LLDP
packet transmission and reception on that interface stops.

Command Mode
Ethernet interface configuration submode — (config-eth)

Examples
Changing to LLDP interface level configuration submode:
ML66(config-eth)#lldp dest-mac-address nearest-bridge
ML66(config-lldp)#

68.5 lldp message-fast-tx

Synopsis
lldp message-fast-tx <INTERVAL>

Description
Use this command to set the time interval between Link Layer Discovery Protocol
Data Unit (LLDPDU) transmissions during fast transmission periods.

652 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: LLDP

Attention!
This command takes effect on all interfaces with enabled LLDP configuration.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

INTERVAL The LLDPDU fast transmission interval in seconds. The


valid range is 1–3600. The default value is 1.

Examples
Setting the fast transmission interval to 3 s:
ML66(config)#lldp message-fast-tx 3

68.6 lldp message-tx-hold-multiplier

Synopsis
lldp message-tx-hold-multiplier <MULTIPLIER>

Description
Use this command to set the multiplier used for the Time To Live (TTL)
calculation of Link Layer Discovery Protocol Data Units (LLDPDUs).

The TTL of the sent LLDPDUs is calculated as follows: TTL = message-tx-interval


× tx-hold-multiplier + 1.

Attention!
This command takes effect on all interfaces with enabled LLDP configuration.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

MULTIPLIER The Tx Hold multiplier value. The valid range is 2–10. The
default value is 4.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 653


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Setting the Tx Hold multiplier to 6:
ML66(config)#lldp message-tx-hold-multiplier 6

68.7 lldp message-tx-interval

Synopsis
lldp message-tx-interval <INTERVAL>

Description
Use this command to set the time interval between periodic Link Layer Discovery
Protocol Data Unit (LLDPDU) transmissions.

Attention!
This command takes effect on all interfaces with enabled LLDP configuration.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

INTERVAL The LLDPDU transmission interval in seconds. The valid


range is 5–3600. The default value is 30.

Examples
Setting the LLDPDU transmission interval to 40 s:
ML66(config)#lldp message-tx-interval 40

68.8 lldp notification-enable

Synopsis
[no] lldp notification-enable

654 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: LLDP

Description
Use this command to enable sending Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP)
notifications about changes in the LLDP remote systems database.

Use the no option to disable LLDP notifications.

By default, LLDP notifications are disabled.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Enabling LLDP notifications:
ML66(config)#lldp notification-enable

68.9 lldp notification-interval

Synopsis
lldp notification-interval <INTERVAL>

Description
Use this command to set the minimum time interval between Link Layer
Discovery Protocol (LLDP) notifications about changes in the LLDP remote
systems database.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

INTERVAL The LLDP notification interval in seconds. The valid range


is 5–3600. The default value is 30.

Examples
Setting the LLDP notification interval to 50 s:
ML66(config)#lldp notification-interval 50

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 655


CLI Descriptions

68.10 lldp tx-fast-init

Synopsis
lldp tx-fast-init <NUM>

Description
Use this command to set the number of Link Layer Discovery Protocol Data Units
(LLDPDUs) that are transmitted during fast transmission periods.

Attention!
This command takes effect on all interfaces with enabled LLDP configuration.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

NUM The number of LLDPDUs sent during a fast transmission


period. The valid range is 1–8. The default value is 4.

Examples
Setting the number of LLDPDUs sent to 2:
ML66(config)#lldp tx-fast-init 2

68.11 tlvs-tx-enable

Synopsis
[no] tlvs-tx-enable {man-addr-ipv4 | man-addr-ipv6 | sys-desc | sys-
name}

Description
Use this command to enable Type-Length-Value (TLV) types in transmitted Link
Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) packets.

Use the no option to disable TLV types in transmitted LLDP packets.

By default, the following optional TLVs are enabled on an Ethernet interface:

656 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: LLDP

— man-addr-ipv4

— sys-desc

— sys-name

Command Mode
LLDP interface level configuration submode — (config-lldp)

Options

man-addr-ipv4 Enables or disables the IPv4 Management Address TLV.

man-addr-ipv6 Enables or disables the IPv6 Management Address TLV.

sys-desc Enables or disables the System Description TLV.

sys-name Enables or disables the System Name TLV.

Examples
Enabling the IPv4 Management Address to be sent in LLDP packets:
ML66(config-lldp)#tlvs-tx-enable man-addr-ipv4

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 657


CLI Descriptions

69 Ethernet Commands: L1 Bonding

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
76.

The following command modes are applicable for the L1-bonding commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— L1 bonding submode — (l1-bonding)

Table 76 Layer 1 Bonding Commands Overview


alarm-enable-degraded-service enable or disable the Degraded
Service alarm
alarm-enable-no-traffic enable or disable the No Traffic alarm
enable-dynamic-vlan-mapping enable the dynamic remapping of
VLANs
l1-bonding create an L1-bonding group
mapping map traffic forwarding with specific
priorities or VLAN towards L1-
bonding member interfaces
members define L1-bonding member interfaces
set-dynamic-vlan-mapping-list set the list of VLANs to be included in
dynamic VLAN mapping

The related show command is the following:

— show l1-bonding

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

69.1 alarm-enable-degraded-service

Synopsis
[no] alarm-enable-degraded-service

Description
Use this command to enable the Degraded Service alarm.

658 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: L1 Bonding

Use the no option to disable the Degraded Service alarm.

Command Mode
L1 bonding submode — (l1-bonding)

Examples
Enabling the Degraded Service alarm:
ML66(l1-bonding)#alarm-enable-degraded-service

69.2 alarm-enable-no-traffic

Synopsis
[no] alarm-enable-no-traffic

Description
Use this command to enable the No Traffic alarm.

Use the no option to disable the No Traffic alarm.

Command Mode
L1 bonding submode — (l1-bonding)

Examples
Enabling the No Traffic alarm:
ML66(l1-bonding)#alarm-enable-no-traffic

69.3 enable-dynamic-vlan-mapping

Synopsis

— enable-dynamic-vlan-mapping <VLANS>

— no enable-dynamic-vlan-mapping

Description
Use this command to enable the dynamic remapping of VLANs.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 659


CLI Descriptions

If used without a VLAN list, dynamic VLAN mapping is enabled for all VLANs in
which the specific bonding is a member and which do not have explicit VLAN
mapping configured. For example, if the L1-bonding instance is a member of
VLANs 2, 3, 4, and 5 and there is a manual VLAN mapping configured for VLAN
3, then dynamic VLAN mapping only handles VLANs 2, 4, and 5.

If a VLAN list is defined, dynamic VLAN handling is enabled only for the VLANs
included in the list. For example, enable-dynamic-vlan-mapping 2,6 enables
the dynamic remapping of VLANs 2 and 6. Dynamic mapping consumes one
VLAN mapping rule for each VLAN that is part of the scope of dynamic mapping.

Dynamic VLAN handling operates as follows:

— After dynamic VLAN handling is enabled, there is a 30 s measurement period


while the necessary bandwidth information is collected.

— The 30 s measurement period is repeated after each mapping action, which


means that there is at least 30 s between two consecutive mapping actions.
However, if more than 30 s have passed since the last mapping action,
reaction to events is close to instantaneous.

— If the bandwidth utilization of the traditional link is below 60%, a mapping


action is triggered, during which the functionality tries to achieve 70%
utilization on the traditional link. The 70% target is selected to leave enough
room for unexpected, quick traffic bursts.

— If the bandwidth utilization of the traditional link exceeds 80%, a new


mapping action is triggered to determine a new VLAN set to reach 70%
utilization on the traditional link. If the bandwidth utilization exceeds the
80% limit within 30 s after the last mapping action, the new mapping action
is executed once the 30 s measurement period is over. Otherwise, the new
mapping action is executed in the next second.

— Disabling dynamic VLAN handling resets the rules created by dynamic


mapping, so the traffic is then mapped based on the manually configured
priority mapping rules.

Command Mode
L1 bonding submode — (l1-bonding)

Operands

VLANS The list of VLANs to be included in the scope of dynamic


VLAN handling, separated by commas.

Examples
Enabling dynamic VLAN handling for VLANs in which the current bonding
instance is member:
ML66(l1-bonding)#enable-dynamic-vlan-mapping

660 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: L1 Bonding

Enabling dynamic VLAN handling for specific VLANs:


ML66(l1-bonding)#enable-dynamic-vlan-mapping 10,17

Disabling dynamic VLAN handling:


ML66(l1-bonding)#no enable-dynamic-vlan-mapping

69.4 l1-bonding

Synopsis
[no] l1-bonding <RSP>

Description
Use this command to change to L1-bonding submode and to create an L1-
bonding group.

The interface passed here becomes the Master. By default, all PCP values are
mapped to the Master interface.

Use the no option to remove an L1 bonding group.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port values of the Master interface
selected for the L1-bonding group, in the following
format: <R/S/P> .

Examples
Entering L1-bonding submode and creating an L1-bonding group:
ML66(config)#l1-bonding 1/1/1
ML66(l1-bonding)#

69.5 mapping

Synopsis

— mapping <RSP> {pcp <PRIOLIST> | dscp <PRIOLIST> | mpls <PRIOLIST> |


vlan <VLAN>}[protected]

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 661


CLI Descriptions

— no mapping <RSP> {pcp | dscp | mpls | vlan}

Description
Use this command to map traffic forwarding towards L1-bonding member
interfaces.

Use this command with the pcp option to map traffic forwarding with specific
priorities towards L1-bonding member interfaces. All Priority Code Point (PCP)
values must be mapped to an interface, thus, PCP-mappings cannot be deleted,
only remapped or reset to Master. PCP-mappings are protected, so in case of link
failure, all values are remapped to the working interface.

Use the no option with the pcp option to reset all PCP mappings of the specified
interface to the Master interface. PCP-mappings from the Master interface
cannot be reset, so the Master interface is an invalid parameter.

Use this command with the dscp option to map the traffic forwarding of specific
DSCP values towards L1-bonding member interfaces. The maximum number of
allowed DSCP-mappings is 144 for all L1-bonding instances. DSCP-mappings are
protected, so in case of link failure, all values are remapped to the working
interface. DSCP-mapping is stronger than priority mapping, which means that for
the mapped DSCP values, the PCP field says “don’t care”. DSCP-mappings can be
remapped to other members on the fly, without resetting first. MPLS traffic
cannot be mapped with DSCP rules even if there are not any MPLS TC rules
configured.

Use the no option with the dscp option to remove the specified DSCP-mapping.

Use this command with the mpls option to map the traffic forwarding of a
specific MPLS traffic class values towards L1-bonding member interfaces. As
MPLS-mappings are protected, in case of link failure, all values are remapped to
the working interface. MPLS-mapping is stronger than priority and DSCP
mappings, which means that the PCP and DSCP fields disregard the mapped
MPLS values. MPLS-mapping can be reconfigured without resetting first.

Use the no option with the mpls option to remove the specified MPLS-mapping.

Use this command with the vlan option to map the traffic forwarding of a specific
VLAN towards L1-bonding member interfaces. The maximum number of allowed
VLAN-mappings is 44 for all layer 1 bonding instances. The L1-bonding group
must be a member interface in the specific VLAN if the vlan parameter is used.
VLAN-mappings can be unprotected, so they are not remapped to the working
interface in case of link failure or protected if the protected option is used. VLAN-
mapping is stronger than any priority mapping (PCP, DSCP, MPLS), which means
that the PCP field disregard the mapped VLAN. VLAN-mapping can be
reconfigured without resetting first.

Use the no option with the vlan option to remove the specified VLAN-mapping.

662 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: L1 Bonding

Command Mode
L1 bonding submode — (l1-bonding)

Operands

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port values of the L1-bonding


member interface to which traffic is mapped, in the
following format: <Rack/Slot/Port>.

PRIOLIST A list of the PCP, DSCP or MPLS TC values separated by


commas, for example, 0,1,2,3.

VLAN The VLAN from which traffic is to be forwarded towards


the selected L1-bonding member interface.

Options

pcp Specifies to map the traffic forwarding of the selected


PCP towards the selected L1-bonding member interface.

dscp Specifies to map the traffic forwarding of the selected


DSCP towards the selected L1-bonding member
interface.

mpls Specifies to map the traffic forwarding of the selected


MPLS TC towards the selected L1-bonding member
interface.

vlan Specifies to map the traffic forwarding of the selected


VLAN towards the selected L1-bonding member
interface.

protected When VLAN mapping is configured, it specifies to map


the specific traffic as protected.

Examples
Mapping traffic forwarding with the PCP values 0,1,2,3 to the L1-bonding
interface:
ML66(l1-bonding)#mapping 1/6/7 pcp 0,1,2,3

Mapping traffic forwarding with the DSCP values 1,59,63 to the L1-bonding
interface:
ML66(l1-bonding)#mapping 1/6/7 dscp 1,59,63

Mapping traffic forwarding with the MPLS TC values 0,1,2,3 to the L1-bonding
interface:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 663


CLI Descriptions

ML66(l1-bonding)#mapping 1/6/7 mpls 0,1,2,3

Mapping traffic forwarding from VLAN 100 to the L1-bonding interface:


ML66(l1-bonding)#mapping 1/6/7 vlan 100

Mapping traffic forwarding from VLAN 200 to the L1-bonding interface as


protected traffic:
ML66(l1-bonding)#mapping 1/6/7 vlan 200 protected

69.6 members

Synopsis
members <INTERFACELIST>

Description
Use this command to define L1-bonding member interfaces.

The maximum number of members is two, including the Master interface.

The Master interface cannot be removed from the member list and is not
required, although possible, to define in the <INTERFACELIST>.

To remove a member, list only the Master interface in the <INTERFACELIST>.

Note: If an interface with active PCP mappings is removed, all PCP mappings
are reset to the Master, and VLAN mappings are deleted automatically.

Command Mode
L1 bonding submode — (l1-bonding)

Operands

INTERFACELIST The Rack, Slot, and Port values of the Master interface or
of the L1-bonding member interface to be added, in the
following format: <Rack/Slot/Port>.

Examples
Adding an L1-bonding member:
ML66(l1-bonding)#members 1/6/7
ML66(l1-bonding)#show current l1-bonding 1/1/1
members 1/1/1,1/6/7
mapping 1/1/1 pcp 0,1,2,3,4,5,6,7
alarm-enable-degraded-service
alarm-enable-no-traffic

Removing all L1-bonding members:

664 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Commands: L1 Bonding

ML66(l1-bonding)#members 1/1/1
ML66(l1-bonding)#show current l1-bonding 1/1/1
members 1/1/1
mapping 1/1/1 pcp 0,1,2,3,4,5,6,7
alarm-enable-degraded-service
alarm-enable-no-traffic

69.7 set-dynamic-vlan-mapping-list

Synopsis
set-dynamic-vlan-mapping-list <VLANS>

Description
Use this command to set a list of VLANs to be included in dynamic VLAN
handling.

Using this command, the VLAN scope of dynamic VLAN handling can be changed
even if the feature has already been enabled.

Command Mode
L1 bonding submode — (l1-bonding)

Operands

VLANS The list of VLANs to be included in the scope of dynamic


VLAN handling.

Examples
Setting a VLAN list for dynamic VLAN handling:
ML66(l1-bonding)#set-dynamic-vlan-mapping-list 11

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 665


CLI Descriptions

70 TDM Cross-Connection Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
77.

The following command modes are applicable for the Time Division Multiplex
(TDM) Cross-Connection commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

Table 77 TDM Cross-Connection Commands Overview


connect-cc cross-connect a TDM port with
another TDM port

The related show commands are the following:

— show connect-cc

— show tdm-interfaces

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

70.1 connect-cc

Synopsis

— connect-cc <NAME> <PORTTYPE1> <PORT1> <PORTTYPE2> <PORT2>

— no connect-cc {<PORT1> | <PORT2>}

Description
Use this command to cross-connect a TDM port with another TDM port.

Use the no option to delete a cross-connection.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

666 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


TDM Cross-Connection Commands

Operands

NAME The description of the connection in free text.

PORTTYPE1 The type of the first port. The valid values are E1 and DS1.

Note: This parameter is not case-sensitive.

PORT1 The Rack, Slot, and Port values of the first port, in the
following format: <Rack/Slot/Port>.

PORTTYPE2 The type of the second port. The valid values are E1 and
DS1.

Note: This parameter is not case-sensitive.

PORT2 The Rack, Slot, and Port values of the second port, in the
following format: <Rack/Slot/Port>.

Examples
Setting a TDM port cross-connection:
ML66(config)#connect-cc name e1 "1/1/101 1" e1 "1/1/101 2"

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 667


CLI Descriptions

71 CES Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
78.

Note: These commands are only valid for LTU 1002 with ETSI.

The following command modes are applicable for the Circuit Emulation Service
(CES) commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— CES Server configuration submode — (config-ces-server)

— CES PW configuration submode — (config-ces-server-pw)

— CES Ethernet configuration submode — (config-ces-server-pw-eth)

— CES TDM Profile configuration submode — (config-ces-tdm-profile)

Table 78 CES Commands Overview


ces server
ces tdm-profile create a CES TDM profile, and enter
CES TDM Profile configuration
submodeselect the CES server to
configure, and switch to CES Server
configuration submode
clock-recovery-mode set Clock Recovery Mode
description set the description of a Pseudo-Wire
(PW)
encap set the encapsulation type of the PW,
and enter CES Ethernet configuration
submode
jitter-buffer-playout-level set the level of Jitter Buffer Playout
jitter-buffer-size set the size of Jitter Buffer
lops-clear-threshold set the number of consecutive packets
with sequential sequence numbers to
exit LOPS
lops-set-threshold set the number of consecutive missing
packets that are required to enter
LOPS

668 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CES Commands

mac-address configure the MAC address of the CES


server
name (PW) set the name of a PW
name (TDM Profile) set the name of a TDM profile
pw create or delete a PW, and enter CES
PW configuration submode
packet-reorder enable or disable the Packet Reorder
feature
packet-replace-policy define the packet replacement policy
in case of Jitter buffer Underrun
payload-size set payload size
payload-suppression enable or disable payload suppression
receive-ecid set the remote Emulated Circuit
Identifier (ECID)
remote-mac set the remote MAC address
shutdown set the PW admin status to Down or
Up
tdm-profile set the TDM configuration profile
timing-input set the timing input
transmit-ecid set the local ECID
trapenable enable sending alarms for the PW
vlanid set a VLAN
vlan-priority set the VLAN priority value

The related show commands are the following:

— show (CES)

— show ces server

— show ces tdm-profile

— show connect-cc

— show current

— show memory

— show status

— show tdm-interfaces

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 669


CLI Descriptions

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

71.1 ces server

Synopsis
ces server <RSC>

Description
Use this command to select the Circuit Emulation Service (CES) server to
configure and to switch to CES Server configuration submode.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

RSC The Rack, Slot, and CesServerId values of the CES server
to be configured, in the following format: <Rack/Slot/
CesServerId>.

Examples
Setting CES server 1/6/101:
ML66(config)#ces server 1/6/101
ML66(config-ces-server)#

71.2 ces tdm-profile

Synopsis
ces tdm-profile [<ID>]

Description
Use this command to create a Circuit Emulation Service (CES) TDM profile and
enter CES TDM Profile configuration submode.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

670 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CES Commands

Operands

ID The ID of the TDM profile.

Examples
Displaying the next available TDM profile ID:
ML66(config)#ces tdm-profile
% INFO Next available unassigned TDM profile index: 4

Creating TDM profile 4:


ML66(config)#ces tdm-profile 4
ML66(config-ces-tdm-profile)#

71.3 clock-recovery-mode

Synopsis
clock-recovery-mode {adaptive}

Description
Use this command to set Clock Recovery Mode.

Command Mode
CES TDM Profile configuration submode — (config-ces-tdm-profile)

Options

adaptive Sets Clock Recovery Mode to adaptive.

Examples
Setting Clock Recovery Mode to adaptive:
ML66(config-ces-tdm-profile)#clock-recovery-mode adaptive

71.4 description

Synopsis
description <PWDESCR>

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 671


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to set the description of a Pseudo-Wire (PW).

Command Mode
CES PW configuration submode — (config-ces-server-pw)

Operands

PWDESCR The description of the PW in free text.

Examples
Setting the description of a PW:
ML66(config-ces-server-pw)#description "My favorite PW"

71.5 encap

Synopsis
encap eth

Description
Use this command to set the encapsulation type of the Pseudo-Wire (PW) and to
switch to CES Ethernet configuration submode.

Note: The encapsulation type must be configured before the admin status of
the PW can be set to Up.

Command Mode
CES PW configuration submode — (config-ces-server-pw)

Options

eth Sets the encapsulation type to Ethernet (MEF-8).

Examples
Setting the encapsulation type:
ML66(config-ces-server-pw)#encap eth
ML66(config-ces-server-pw-eth)#

672 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CES Commands

71.6 jitter-buffer-playout-level

Synopsis
jitter-buffer-playout-level <LIMIT>

Description
Use this command to set the level of Jitter Buffer for Playout in units of packets.

Command Mode
CES TDM Profile configuration submode — (config-ces-tdm-profile)

Operands

LIMIT The level of Jitter Buffer for Playout in units of packets.


The valid range is 1–512.

Examples
Setting the level of Jitter Buffer for Playout to 5:
ML66(config-ces-tdm-profile)#jitter-buffer-playout-level 5

71.7 jitter-buffer-size

Synopsis
jitter-buffer-size <SIZE>

Description
Use this command to set the size of Jitter Buffer in units of packets.

Command Mode
CES TDM Profile configuration submode — (config-ces-tdm-profile)

Operands

SIZE The size of Jitter Buffer in units of packets. The valid


range is 1–512.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 673


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Setting the size of Jitter Buffer to 128:
ML66(config-ces-tdm-profile)#jitter-buffer-size 128

71.8 lops-clear-threshold

Synopsis
lops-clear-threshold <PACKETNUMBER>

Description
Use this command to set the number of consecutive packets with sequential
sequence numbers to exit LOPS.

Command Mode
CES TDM Profile configuration submode — (config-ces-tdm-profile)

Operands

PACKETNUMBER The number of consecutive packets to exit LOPS. The


valid range is 4–10.

Examples
Setting the number of packets to exit LOPS to 6:
ML66(config-ces-tdm-profile)#lops-clear-threshold 6

71.9 lops-set-threshold

Synopsis
lops-set-threshold <PACKETNUMBER>

Description
Use this command to set the number of consecutive missing packets that are
required to enter LOPS.

Command Mode
CES TDM Profile configuration submode — (config-ces-tdm-profile)

674 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CES Commands

Operands

PACKETNUMBER The number of consecutive missing packets that are


required to enter LOPS. The valid range is 4–15.

Examples
Setting the number of missing packets required to enter LOPS to 6:
ML66(config-ces-tdm-profile)#lops-set-threshold 6

71.10 mac-address

Synopsis
mac-address <MACADDRESS>

Description
Use this command to configure the MAC address of the Circuit Emulation Service
(CES) server.

Command Mode
CES Server configuration submode — (config-ces-server)

Operands

MACADDRESS The MAC address to be set for the CES server, in the
following format: <AA:BB:CC:DD:EE:FF>.

Examples
Setting the MAC address of the CES server:
ML66(config-ces-server)#mac-address 00:A0:C9:14:C8:29

71.11 name (PW)

Synopsis
name <PWNAME>

Description
Use this command to set the name of a Pseudo-Wire (PW).

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 675


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
CES PW configuration submode — (config-ces-server-pw)

Operands

PWNAME The name of the PW in free text.

Examples
Setting a PW name:
ML66(config-ces-server-pw)#name pw-test1

71.12 name (TDM Profile)

Synopsis
name <TPNAME>

Description
Use this command to set the name of a TDM profile.

Command Mode
CES TDM Profile configuration submode — (config-ces-tdm-profile)

Operands

TPNAME The name of the TDM profile in free text.

Examples
Setting a TDM profile name:
ML66(config-ces-tdm-profile)#name tdm-test1

71.13 pw

Synopsis
[no] pw satop [<ID>]

676 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CES Commands

Description
Use this command to create a Pseudo-Wire (PW) and to enter CES PW
configuration submode for a specific PW.

Use the no option to delete a PW.

Command Mode
CES Server configuration submode — (config-ces-server)

Operands

ID The ID of the PW.

Options

satop Sets Structure-Agnostic TDM over Packet (SAToP) mode.

Examples
Displaying the next available PW ID on the Circuit Emulation Service (CES)
server:
ML66(config-ces-server)#pw satop
% INFO Next available Pw identifier: 7

Creating PW 7 and entering CES PW configuration submode:


ML66(config-ces-server)#pw satop 7
ML66(config-ces-server-pw)#

71.14 packet-reorder

Synopsis
[no] packet-reorder

Description
Use this command to enable the Packet Reorder feature.

Use the no option to disable the Packet Reorder feature.

Command Mode
CES TDM Profile configuration submode — (config-ces-tdm-profile)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 677


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Enabling Packet Reorder:
ML66(config-ces-tdm-profile)#packet-reorder

71.15 packet-replace-policy

Synopsis
packet-replace-policy {allones | filler <FILLER>}

Description
Use this command to define the packet replacement policy in case of Jitter Buffer
Underrun.

Command Mode
CES TDM Profile configuration submode — (config-ces-tdm-profile)

Options

allones Sets the packet replacement policy to allOnes. The byte


pattern that is sent (played) on the TDM line in case of
Jitter Buffer Underrun consists of all 1s for every bit. This
is the default setting.

filler Sets the packet replacement policy to filler. The byte


pattern that is sent (played) on the TDM line in case of
Jitter Buffer Underrun consists of a user-defined byte
pattern.

Operands

FILLER The filler byte pattern. The valid range is 0x00-0xFF.

Examples
Setting packet replacement policy to filler:
ML66(config-ces-tdm-profile)#packet-replace-policy filler 0x55

678 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CES Commands

71.16 payload-size

Synopsis
payload-size <PAYLOADSIZE>

Description
Use this command to set the size of payload of the TDM profile.

Command Mode
CES TDM Profile configuration submode — (config-ces-tdm-profile)

Operands

PAYLOADSIZE The size of the payload in bytes. The valid values are 256,
256 + N, 256 + 2 × N, 256 + 3 × N, and so on up to 1440 −
256, where N = 32.

Examples
Setting the payload size to 320:
ML66(config-ces-tdm-profile)#payload-size 320

71.17 payload-suppression

Synopsis
[no] payload-suppression

Description
Use this command to enable payload suppression.

Use the no option to disable payload suppression.

Command Mode
CES TDM Profile configuration submode — (config-ces-tdm-profile)

Examples
Enabling payload suppression:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 679


CLI Descriptions

ML66(config-ces-tdm-profile)#payload-suppression

71.18 receive-ecid

Synopsis
receive-ecid <ECID>

Description
Use this command to set the remote Emulated Circuit Identifier (ECID).

Note: The remote ECID must not be zero, and it must be unique on the CES
server.

Command Mode
CES Ethernet configuration submode — (config-ces-server-pw-eth)

Operands

ECID The remote ECID. The valid range is 1-1048575.

Examples
Setting the remote ECID:
ML66(config-ces-server-pw-eth)#receive-ecid 1048575

71.19 remote-mac

Synopsis
remote-mac <MACADDRESS>

Description
Use this command to set the remote MAC address.

Command Mode
CES Ethernet configuration submode — (config-ces-server-pw-eth)

680 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CES Commands

Operands

MACADDRESS The remote MAC address, in the following format:


<AA:BB:CC:DD:EE:FF>.

Examples
Setting the remote MAC address:
ML66(config-ces-server-pw-eth)#remote-mac 20:A0:C9:14:C8:29

71.20 shutdown

Synopsis
[no] shutdown

Description
Use this command to set the Pseudo-Wire (PW) admin status to Down.

Use the no option to set the PW admin status to Up.

Note: The PW admin status must be set to Down before configuring any other
PW parameters.

Command Mode
CES PW configuration submode — (config-ces-server-pw)

Examples
Setting the PW status to Down:
ML66(config-ces-server-pw)#shutdown

71.21 tdm-profile

Synopsis
tdm-profile <ID>

Description
Use this command to set the TDM configuration profile.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 681


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
CES PW configuration submode — (config-ces-server-pw)

Operands

ID The ID of the TDM configuration profile.

Examples
Configuring TDM configuration profile 2:
ML66(config-ces-server-pw)#tdm-profile 2

71.22 timing-input

Synopsis
timing-input {looped | netsync | recovered}

Description
Use this command to set the timing input.

Command Mode
CES PW configuration submode — (config-ces-server-pw)

Options

looped Sets TDM timing input to looped. TDM transmit clock is


derived from the received TDM signal.

netsync Sets TDM timing input to netsync. TDM transmit clock is


derived from the SEC in network frequency
synchronization mode.

recovered Sets TDM timing input to recovered. TDM transmit clock is


derived from the packet arrival rate over the emulated
circuit.

Examples
Setting TDM timing input to looped:
ML66(config-ces-server-pw)#timing-input looped

682 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CES Commands

71.23 transmit-ecid

Synopsis
transmit-ecid <ECID>

Description
Use this command to set the local Emulated Circuit Identifier (ECID).

The local ECID is used as the Pseudo-Wire (PW) label for Circuit Emulation
Service (CES) over Ethernet PWs. The PW label is used to demultiplex ingress
PW packets and must be unique across all PWs in one CES server.

Command Mode
CES Ethernet configuration submode — (config-ces-server-pw-eth)

Operands

ECID The local ECID. The valid range is 0-1048575.

Examples
Setting the local ECID:
ML66(config-ces-server-pw-eth)#transmit-ecid 1048575

71.24 trapenable

Synopsis
trapenable

Description
Use this command to enable sending alarms for the Pseudo-Wire (PW).

Command Mode
CES PW configuration submode — (config-ces-server-pw)

Examples
Enabling sending alarms for the PW:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 683


CLI Descriptions

ML66(config-ces-server-pw)#trapenable

71.25 vlanid

Synopsis
vlanid <VLANID>

Description
Use this command to set a VLAN.

Note: The Pseudo-Wire (PW) VLAN ID is not used for PW demultiplex;


different VLAN IDs can be set for the nodes connected by the PW.

Command Mode
CES Ethernet configuration submode — (config-ces-server-pw-eth)

Operands

VLANID The ID of the VLAN. The valid range is 1–4094.

Examples
Setting the VLAN ID:
ML66(config-ces-server-pw-eth)#vlanid 1000

71.26 vlan-priority

Synopsis
vlan-priority <VLANPRIO>

Description
Use this command to set the VLAN priority value.

Command Mode
CES Ethernet configuration submode — (config-ces-server-pw-eth)

684 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


CES Commands

Operands

VLANPRIO The VLAN priority value. The valid range is 0–7, where
the highest value is 7.

Examples
Setting the VLAN priority to 1:
ML66(config-ces-server-pw-eth)#vlan-priority 1

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 685


CLI Descriptions

72 Performance Monitoring Commands

By default, the 15 minutes or 24 hours Ethernet PM counters are enabled in the


node. For more information about PM, see Monitoring Ethernet Performance.

To see which interfaces are active and can be used for Ethernet PM, use the
Packet - ethernet performance monitoring overview page in MINI-LINK Node
GUI.

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
79.

The following command modes are applicable for the Ethernet PM commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— PM submode — (pm)

— Ethernet PM submode — (eth-pm)

— Ethernet interface configuration submode — (config-eth)

— LAN configuration submode — (config-lan)

— WAN configuration submode — (config-wan)

— Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Table 79 Ethernet PM Commands Overview


clear clear Ethernet Performance Monitoring (PM)
data for the selected Ethernet interface
clear-if-counters clear PM counters for the interface
ethernet-pm select an Ethernet interface
ethernet-pm clear-all clear all Ethernet PM data
pm switch to PM Mode configuration mode
pmalarmview enable or disable the PM alarms
pm15minsetthreshold set the PM alarm thresholds for each 15
minutes measurement
pm24hsetthreshold set the PM alarm thresholds for each 24 hour
measurement
pm-start-time set the PM start time

The related show commands are the following:

686 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Performance Monitoring Commands

— show current

— show interface ethernet-pm

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

72.1 clear

Synopsis
clear

Description
Use this command to clear Ethernet Performance Monitoring (PM) data for the
selected Ethernet interface. Use the command ethernet-pm to select an Ethernet
interface.

Note: The PM data is cleared immediately, but the current interval is not
marked as invalid until it is completed. To clear PM data and mark the
current interval as invalid immediately, use MINI-LINK Node GUI.

Command Mode
Ethernet PM submode — (eth-pm)

Examples
Clearing Ethernet PM data for the selected Ethernet interface:
ML66(eth-pm)#clear

72.2 clear-if-counters

Synopsis
clear-if-counters

Description
Use this command to clear the counters that are displayed on the MINI-LINK
Node GUI status page of an interface.

Command Mode
Ethernet interface configuration submode — (config-eth)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 687


CLI Descriptions

LAN configuration submode — (config-lan)

WAN configuration submode — (config-wan)

Router Interface configuration submode — (config-router-if)

Examples
Clearing Performance Monitoring (PM) counters:
ML66(config-lan)#clear-if-counters

72.3 ethernet-pm

Synopsis
ethernet-pm <RSP> {wan | lan}

Description
Use this command to change to the (eth-pm) submode for the Ethernet interface
specified by the given Rack, Slot, and Port. The clear command can then be
used to clear the Ethernet Performance Monitoring (PM) data for this interface.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Options

wan Specifies that this is a WAN interface.

lan Specifies that this is a LAN interface.

Operands

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port of the interface to select. The
format is <Rack/Slot/Port>, for example, 1/6/1.

Note: Port refers to a WAN or LAN interface, not to a


switch port.

Examples
Entering the (eth-pm) submode for Ethernet interface 1/6/1:
ML66(config)#ethernet-pm 1/6/1 lan
ML66(eth-pm)#

688 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Performance Monitoring Commands

72.4 ethernet-pm clear-all

Synopsis
ethernet-pm clear-all

Description
Use this command to clear all Ethernet Performance Monitoring (PM) data.

Note: The PM data is cleared immediately, but the current interval is not
marked as invalid until it is completed. To clear PM data and mark the
current interval as invalid immediately, use MINI-LINK Node GUI.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Options

clear-all Clears all Ethernet PM data.

Examples
Clearing all Ethernet PM data:
ML66(config)#ethernet-pm clear-all

72.5 pm

Synopsis
pm

Description
Use this command to change to the (pm) submode.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Changing to the (pm) submode:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 689


CLI Descriptions

ML66(config)#pm
ML66(pm)#

72.6 pmalarmview

Synopsis
pmalarmview { enable | disable }

Description
Use this command to enable or disable the Performance Monitoring (PM) alarms.

Command Mode
Ethernet PM submode — (eth-pm)

Options

enable Enables the PM alarms.

disable Disables the PM alarms.

Examples
Enabling the PM alarms:
ML66(eth-pm)#pmalarmview enable

72.7 pm15minsetthreshold

Synopsis

— pm15minsetthreshold <rxLoss> <rxBandwidthUtilization> <txLoss>


<txBandwidthUtilization> [ <tc0Threshold> <tc1Threshold> <tc2Threshold>
<tc3Threshold> <tc4Threshold> <tc5Threshold> <tc6Threshold>
<tc7Threshold> ]

— pm15minsetthreshold { tx | rx } { loss | bandwidthutilization }


<threshold>

— pm15minsetthreshold tc <tcNumber> <threshold>

690 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Performance Monitoring Commands

Description
Use this command to set the Performance Monitoring (PM) alarm thresholds for
each 15 minutes measurement.

Note: The TC alarm thresholds can be set only for WAN interfaces and
buffered VLAN interfaces.

Command Mode
Ethernet PM submode — (eth-pm)

Operands

rxLoss Sets the Rx Loss threshold value. The valid range is <0.1–
0.000000001> . The default value is 0.000001. When the
value is set to 0, the threshold is disabled.

rxBandwidthUtilization
Sets the Rx Bandwidth Utilization threshold value. The
valid range is 1–100. The default value is 95. When the
value is set to 100, the threshold is disabled.

txLoss Sets the Tx Loss threshold value. The valid range is <0.1–
0.000000001> . The default value is 0.000001. When the
value is set to 0, the threshold is disabled.

txBandwidthUtilization
Sets the Tx Bandwidth Utilization threshold value. The
valid range is 1–100. The default value is 95. When the
value is set to 100, the threshold is disabled.

tc0Threshold–tc7Threshold
Sets the Traffic Class (TC) discard threshold values. The
valid range is <0.1–0.000000001>. The default value is
0.000001. When the value is set to 0, the threshold is
disabled.

tcNumber Specifies for which TC the discard threshold is set. The


valid range is 0–7.

threshold Sets the threshold value.

— When the loss or the tc options are specified, the


valid range of the threshold is <0.1–0.000000001> .
The default value is 0.000001. When the value is set
to 0, the threshold is disabled.

— When the bandwidthutilization option is specified,


the valid range of the threshold is 1–100. The default

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 691


CLI Descriptions

value is 95. When the value is set to 100, the


threshold is disabled.

Options

tx Specifies the Tx direction for the selected alarm threshold.

rx Specifies the Rx direction for the selected alarm threshold

loss Specifies the Loss alarm threshold.

bandwidthutilization
Specifies the Bandwidth Utilization alarm threshold.

tc Specifies the TC for the selected alarm threshold.

Examples
Setting the Loss and Bandwidth Utilization alarm thresholds for a 15 minutes
measurement both in Tx and Rx directions:
ML66(eth-pm)#pm15minsetthreshold 0.0001 95 0.0001 95

Setting all PM alarm thresholds for a 15 minutes measurement:


ML66(eth-pm)#pm15minsetthreshold 0.0001 95 0.0001 95 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.1 0 →
.1

Setting a single TC threshold for a 15 minutes measurement:


ML66(eth-pm)#pm15minsetthreshold tc 0 0.1

Setting the Rx Loss alarm threshold for a 15 minutes measurement:


ML66(eth-pm)#pm15minsetthreshold rx loss 0.1

72.8 pm24hsetthreshold

Synopsis

— pm24hsetthreshold <rxLoss> <rxBandwidthUtilization> <txLoss>


<txBandwidthUtilization> [ <tc0Threshold> <tc1Threshold> <tc2Threshold>
<tc3Threshold> <tc4Threshold> <tc5Threshold> <tc6Threshold>
<tc7Threshold> ]

— pm24hsetthreshold { tx | rx } { loss | bandwidthutilization }


<threshold>

— pm24hsetthreshold tc <tcNumber> <threshold>

692 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Performance Monitoring Commands

Description
Use this command to set the Performance Monitoring (PM) alarm thresholds for
each 24 hour measurement.

Note: The TC alarm thresholds can be set only for WAN interfaces and
buffered VLAN interfaces.

Command Mode
Ethernet PM submode — (eth-pm)

Operands

rxLoss Sets the Rx Loss threshold value. The valid range is <0.1–
0.000000001> . The default value is 0.000001. When the
value is set to 0, the threshold is disabled.

rxBandwidthUtilization
Sets the Rx Bandwidth Utilization threshold value. The
valid range is 1–100. The default value is 95. When the
value is set to 100, the threshold is disabled.

txLoss Sets the Tx Loss threshold value. The valid range is <0.1–
0.000000001> . The default value is 0.000001. When the
value is set to 0, the threshold is disabled.

txBandwidthUtilization
Sets the Tx Bandwidth Utilization threshold value. The
valid range is 1–100. The default value is 95. When the
value is set to 100, the threshold is disabled.

tc0Threshold–tc7Threshold
Sets the Traffic Class (TC) discard threshold values. The
valid range is <0.1–0.000000001> . The default value is
0.000001. When the value is set to 0, the threshold is
disabled.

tcNumber Specifies for which TC the discard threshold is set. The


valid range is 0–7.

threshold Sets the threshold value.

— When the loss or the tc options are specified, the


valid range of the threshold is <0.1–0.000000001> .
The default value is 0.000001. When the value is set
to 0, the threshold is disabled.

— When the bandwidthutilization option is specified,


the valid range of the threshold is 1–100. The default

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 693


CLI Descriptions

value is 95. When the value is set to 100, the


threshold is disabled.

Options

tx Specifies the Tx direction for the selected alarm threshold.

rx Specifies the Rx direction for the selected alarm threshold

loss Specifies the Loss alarm threshold.

bandwidthutilization
Specifies the Bandwidth Utilization alarm threshold.

tc Specifies the TC for the selected alarm threshold.

Examples
Setting the Loss and Bandwidth Utilization alarm thresholds for a 24 hour
measurement both in Tx and Rx directions:
ML66(eth-pm)#pm24hsetthreshold 0.0001 95 0.0001 95

Setting all PM alarm thresholds for a 24 hour measurement:


ML66(eth-pm)#pm24hsetthreshold 0.0001 95 0.0001 95 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.1 0.1

Setting a single TC threshold for a 24 hour measurement:


ML66(eth-pm)#pm24hsetthreshold tc 0 0.1

Setting the Rx Loss alarm threshold for a 24 hour measurement:


ML66(eth-pm)#pm24hsetthreshold rx loss 0.1

72.9 pm-start-time

Synopsis
pm-start-time <HOUR> <MINUTE> <SECOND>

Description
Use this command to set the Performance Monitoring (PM) start time during the
day. Start time is the beginning of the 24h interval.

Command Mode
PM submode — (pm)

694 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Performance Monitoring Commands

Operands

HOUR Hours in two digits.

MINUTE Minutes in two digits.

SECOND Seconds in two digits.

Examples
Setting the PM start time:
ML66(pm)#pm-start-time 15 30 00

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 695


CLI Descriptions

73 TWAMP Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
80.

The following command mode is applicable for the Two-Way Active


Measurement Protocol (TWAMP) commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Privileged Exec mode — #

Table 80 TWAMP Commands Overview


twamp-reflector-light configure a TWAMP reflector light
session
twamp reset-statistics reset all TWAMP statistics to zero

The related show commands are the following:

— show twamp sessions

— show twamp statistics

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

73.1 twamp-reflector-light

Synopsis

— twamp-reflector-light <SESSION_ID> <IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> <UDP>

— no twamp-reflector-light <SESSION_ID>

— twamp-reflector-light <SESSION_ID> {enable | disable}

— twamp-reflector-light <SESSION_ID> use-dscp <DSCP>

— no twamp-reflector-light <SESSION_ID> use-dscp

Description
Use this command to configure a TWAMP reflector light session.

Use the no option to delete the TWAMP reflector light session.

696 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


TWAMP Commands

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

SESSION_ID The unique ID of the TWAMP reflector light session. The


valid range is 1–4294967295.

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN
The name of the interface where the TWAMP reflector
light session is assigned, in the following format <R/S/
P.VLANID>.

UDP The UDP port where the TWAMP reflector light session is
assigned. The valid range is 862–49151.

DSCP The value of the DSCP field. The valid range is 0–63.

Options

enable Enables the TWAMP reflector light session.

disable Disables the TWAMP reflector light session.

Note: The TWAMP reflector light session is not deleted


when this option is used.

use-dscp Specifies to configure DSCP.

Note: When DSCP is enabled, the reflector instance


sends the response test packet with the
configured DSCP value. When DSCP is disabled,
the reflector copies the DSCP value from the
received test packet.

By default, DSCP is disabled in a newly created


TWAMP reflector light session.

Examples
Creating a TWAMP reflector light session with session number 1 for interface
1/6/5.6 and UDP port 862:
ML66(config)#twamp-reflector-light 1 1/6/5.6 862

Deleting the TWAMP reflector light session with session number 1:


ML66(config)#no twamp-reflector-light 1

Disabling the TWAMP reflector light session with session number 1:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 697


CLI Descriptions

ML66(config)#twamp-reflector-light 1 disable

Configuring the TWAMP reflector light session with session number 1 to enable
DSCP and use DSCP value 52:
ML66(config)#twamp-reflector-light 1 use-dscp 52

73.2 twamp reset-statistics

Synopsis
twamp reset-statistics

Description
Use this command to reset all TWAMP statistics to zero.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Examples
Resetting all TWAMP statistics to zero:
ML66#twamp reset-statistics

698 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet MAC White List Commands

74 Ethernet MAC White List Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
81.

The following command modes are applicable for the Ethernet list commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Ethernet MAC White List configuration submode — (config-eth-mac-


whitelist)

Table 81 Ethernet List Commands Overview


ethernet-mac-whitelist specify a Media Access Control (MAC)
address white list
mac create a MAC entry
name set the name of the white list

74.1 ethernet-mac-whitelist

Synopsis
[no] ethernet-mac-whitelist { <LISTNO> | name <NAME> }

Description
Use this command to create a Media Access Control (MAC) white list where MAC
addresses can be added to or removed from the list. The command also changes
to the (config-eth-mac-whitelist) submode. The white list can be associated with
a port using the command mac-whitelist in the (config-bridgeport) submode.

Use the no option to delete the MAC white list identified by either number or
name.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

LISTNO The number of the MAC address list. The value 0


indicates that there is no MAC address white list access
control for the port. The default value is 0.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 699


CLI Descriptions

NAME The name of the MAC address list.

Examples
Creating or configuring Ethernet MAC white list:
ML66(config)#ethernet-mac-whitelist 3
ML66(config-eth-mac-whitelist)#

74.2 mac

Synopsis
[no] mac <MACADDRESS>

Description
Use this command to create a MAC entry with the specified Media Access Control
(MAC) address.

Command Mode
Ethernet MAC White List configuration submode — (config-eth-mac-
whitelist)

Operands

MACADDRESS The specified MAC address, where the format is


<AA:BB:CC:DD:EE:FF> .

Examples
Creating a MAC entry with F0:A0:C9:14:C8:29:
ML66(config-eth-mac-whitelist)#mac F0:A0:C9:14:C8:29

74.3 name

Synopsis

— name <NAME>

— no name

700 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet MAC White List Commands

Description
Use this command to set the name of the white list.

Use the no option to set the name to the default empty string.

Command Mode
Ethernet MAC White List configuration submode — (config-eth-mac-
whitelist)

Operands

NAME The name of the white list.

Examples
Setting the name of the white list:
ML66(config-eth-mac-whitelist)#name MacListName

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 701


CLI Descriptions

75 ETU 1002 Commands: Equipment

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
82.

Note: 1x10G can only be used in MINI-LINK 6691, MINI-LINK 6692, MINI-
LINK 6693, and MINI-LINK 6694.

The following command mode is applicable for the ETU 1002 equipment
commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

Table 82 ETU 1002 Equipment Commands Overview


board configure the board

The related show commands are the following:

— show board

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

75.1 board

Synopsis
board <R/S> profile <ID>

Description
Use this command to select the board profile.

Note: 1x10G can only be used in MINI-LINK 6691, MINI-LINK 6692, MINI-
LINK 6693, and MINI-LINK 6694.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

R/S The Rack and Slot values of the board to configure, in the
following format: <Rack/Slot>.

702 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


ETU 1002 Commands: Equipment

ID The ID of the board profile. The valid values are the


following:

— 1 — 4x1G

— 2 — 1x10G

Options

profile Configures the board profile.

Examples
Selecting board profile 1x10G for board 1/2:
ML66(config)#board 1/2 profile 2

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 703


CLI Descriptions

76 LTU 1002 Commands: Equipment

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
83.

Note: These commands are only valid for ETSI.

The following command modes are applicable for the LTU 1002 equipment
commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Controller Protection Equipment submode — (controller-xfprotection-


eq)

Table 83 LTU 1002 Equipment Commands Overview


activeunit set active unit
board configure the board
controller xfprotection-equipment change to the (controller-xfprotection-
eq) submode
mode set protection mode
trapenable enable or disable notifications

The related show commands are the following:

— show board

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

76.1 activeunit

Synopsis

— activeunit <INDEX>

— no activeunit

Description
Use this command to set the active unit.

Use the no option to reset the setting to the default value 1.

704 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: Equipment

Note: If protection mode is automatic, the new active unit is rejected if the unit
is down.

Command Mode
Controller Protection Equipment submode — (controller-xfprotection-eq)

Operands

INDEX 1 — Low slot

2 — High slot

Examples
Setting active unit to low slot:
ML66(controller-xfprotection-eq)#activeunit 1

76.2 board

Synopsis
board <R/S> [profile <ID>]

Description
Use this command to configure the board.

Use this command with the profile option to select the board profile. By default,
when LTU 1002 is inserted, it is first started with the PDH and SDH profile.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

R/S The Rack and Slot values of the board to configure, in the
following format: <Rack/Slot>.

ID The ID of the board profile. The valid values are the


following:

— 1 — PDH and SDH

— 2 — PDH and CES

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 705


CLI Descriptions

— 3 — CES only

— 4 — SDH48 and CES32

— 5 — SDH63 and CES16

— 6 — PDH and SDH48 and CES16

Options

profile Configures the board profile.

Examples
Selecting board profile PDH and CES for board 1/11:
ML66(config)#board 1/11 profile 2

76.3 controller xfprotection-equipment

Synopsis
controller xfprotection-equipment <RS>

Description
Use this command to change to the (controller-xfprotection-eq) submode for the
specified Rack/Slot.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

RS The Rack and Slot value of the interface where the


format is <Rack/Slot> .

Examples
Changing to the (controller-xfprotection-eq) submode for 1/1:
ML66(config)#controller xfprotection-equipment 1/1
ML66(controller-xfprotection-eq)#

76.4 mode

706 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: Equipment

Synopsis

— mode <MODE>

— no mode

Description
Use this command to set the protection mode in the (controller-xfprotection-eq)
submode.

Note: The protection mode affects both equipment and line protection.

Use the no option to reset the setting to the default value automatic.

Command Mode
Controller Protection Equipment submode — (controller-xfprotection-eq)

Operands

MODE 1 — Automatic

2 — Manual

Examples
Setting protection mode to automatic:
ML66(controller-xfprotection-eq)#mode 1

76.5 trapenable

Synopsis
[no] trapenable

Description
Use this command to enable notifications.

Use the no option to disable notifications.

Command Mode
Controller Protection Equipment submode — (controller-xfprotection-eq)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 707


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Enabling notifications:
ML66(controller-xfprotection-eq)#trapenable

708 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: SDH STM-1

77 LTU 1002 Commands: SDH STM-1

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
84.

Note: These commands are only valid for ETSI.

The following command modes are applicable for the LTU 1002 SDH STM-1
commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Controller SDH STM-1 submode — (controller-xfsdhstm1)

Table 84 LTU 1002 SDH STM-1 Commands Overview


admstatus configure status of Synchronous
Transport Module level 1 (STM-1)
board
controller sdhstm1porttable change to the (controller-xfsdhstm1)
submode

77.1 admstatus

Synopsis

— admstatus <STATUS>

— no admstatus

Description
Use this command to configure the status of the LTU 1002 plug-in unit.

Use the no option to reset the setting to the default value Not configured.

Command Mode
Controller SDH STM-1 submode — (controller-xfsdhstm1)

Operands

STATUS The following modes are available for LTU 1002:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 709


CLI Descriptions

— 1 — Not configured

In this mode, the LTU 1002 is not configured for


traffic. The RS and MS interfaces are available and
can be used for DCC traffic. The MS interface can also
be used as a sync source.

— 2 — Standalone

Configures the LTU 1002 for traffic. In addition to the


RS and MS interface, one VC-4, 63 VC-12, and 63 E1
interfaces are created. The Signal Label for VC-4 is
TUG-structure and for VC-12 it is asynchronous
mapping.

— 3 — MSP 1+1

Configures the LTU 1002 for traffic with equipment


and line protection. Creates protected interfaces, such
as 1 MSP, 1 VC-4, 63 VC-12, and 63 E1. The DCC and
Sync interfaces are also protected. Signal Label for
VC-4 is TUG-structure and for VC-12 it is
asynchronous mapping.

Note: This value can only be configured for the low


slot plug-in unit in a protection pair. The
high slot plug-in unit must be in Not
configured mode.

Examples
Configuring standalone status for the LTU 1002 plug-in unit:
ML66(controller-xfsdhstm1)#admstatus 2

77.2 controller sdhstm1porttable

Synopsis
controller sdhstm1porttable <RSP>

Description
Use this command to change to the (controller-xfsdhstm1) submode for the
specified <Rack/Slot/Port> .

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

710 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: SDH STM-1

Operands

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port value of the interface where the
format is <Rack/Slot/Port> .

Examples
Changing to the (controller-xfsdhstm1) submode for 1/1/1:
ML66(config)#controller sdhstm1porttable 1/1/1
ML66(controller-xfsdhstm1)#

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 711


CLI Descriptions

78 LTU 1002 Commands: Line

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
85.

Note: These commands are only valid for ETSI.

The following command modes are applicable for the LTU 1002 line commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Controller Protection Line submode — (controller-xfprotection-line)

Table 85 LTU 1002 Line Commands Overview


controller xfprotection-line change to the (controller-xfprotection-
line) submode
working-rx set active line

78.1 controller xfprotection-line

Synopsis
controller xfprotection-line <RSP>

Description
Use this command to change to the (controller-xfprotection-line) submode for
the specified Rack/Slot/Plot.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port value of the interface where the
format is <Rack/Slot/Port> .

Examples
Changing to the (controller-xfprotection-line) submode for 1/1/1:

712 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: Line

ML66(config)#controller xfprotection-line 1/1/1


ML66(controller-xfprotection-line)#

78.2 working-rx

Synopsis

— working-rx <WORKING_RX>

— no working-rx

Description
Use this command to set the active line to 1 or 2.

Use the no option to reset the setting to the default value 1.

Note: If protection mode is automatic, the new active line is rejected if the
quality of it is less than the quality of the current line.

Command Mode
Controller Protection Line submode — (controller-xfprotection-line)

Operands

WORKING_RX 1 — Line on the low slot board

2 — Line on the high slot board

Examples
Setting the active unit to 1:
ML66(controller-xfprotection-line)#working-rx 1

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 713


CLI Descriptions

79 LTU 1002 Commands: RS

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
86.

Note: These commands are only valid for ETSI.

The following command modes are applicable for the LTU 1002 RS commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— RS submode — (controller-rsttp)

Table 86 LTU 1002 RS Commands Overview


am-severity-lof set the severity of the Loss of Frame
(LOF) alarm
am-severity-tim set the severity of the Trace Identifier
Mismatch (TIM) alarm
am-severity-uastne set the severity of the Unavailable
State alarm
controller rsttp change to the (controller-rsttp)
submode
enable-pm-point enable Performance Monitoring (PM)
on the RS interface
if-link-trap-enabled enable notifications for the RS
interface
name set the name of the RS interface
reset-cur-15min-ne-regs reset the current 15 minute
performance data of the near end
reset-cur-24h-ne-regs reset the current 24 hour performance
data of the near end
trail-trace-enabled enable the controlling of tail trace ID
supervision
trail-trace-expected set the expected identifier of the
received payload
trail-trace-send set the identifier of the transmitted
payload

79.1 am-severity-lof

714 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: RS

Synopsis

— am-severity-lof <AM_SEVERITY_LOF>

— no am-severity-lof

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Loss of Frame (LOF) alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
RS submode — (controller-rsttp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_LOF
Severity of the LOS failure. The following values are
available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the LOS alarm:
ML66(controller-rsttp)#am-severity-lof 5

79.2 am-severity-tim

Synopsis

— am-severity-tim <AM_SEVERITY_TIM>

— no am-severity-tim

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 715


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Trace Identifier Mismatch (TIM)
alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
RS submode — (controller-rsttp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_TIM
Severity of the TIM failure. The following values are
available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the TIM alarm:
ML66(controller-rsttp)#am-severity-tim 4

79.3 am-severity-uastne

Synopsis

— am-severity-uastne <AM_SEVERITY_UASTNE>

— no am-severity-uastne

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Unavailable State alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

716 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: RS

Command Mode
RS submode — (controller-rsttp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_UASTNE
Severity of the Unavailable State failure. The following
values are available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the Unavailable State alarm:
ML66(controller-rsttp)#am-severity-uastne 5

79.4 controller rsttp

Synopsis
controller rsttp <R/S/Index>

Description
Use this command to configure an RS interface. The command also changes to
the (controller-rsttp) submode.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

R/S/Index The Rack, Slot, and Index value of the RS interface where
the format is R/S/Index.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 717


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Configuring the RS interface and changing to the (controller-rsttp) submode:
ML66(config)#controller rsttp 1/3/1
ML66(controller-rsttp)#

79.5 enable-pm-point

Synopsis

— enable-pm-point <ENABLE_PERF_MON_POINT>

— no enable-pm-point

Description
Use this command to enable Performance Monitoring (PM) on the RS interface.

Use the no option to disable PM on the RS interface.

Command Mode
RS submode — (controller-rsttp)

Operands

ENABLE_PERF_MON_POINT
1 — Enables PM on the RS interface.

2 — Disables PM on the RS interface.

Examples
Enabling PM on the RS interface:
ML66(controller-rsttp)#enable-pm-point 1

79.6 if-link-trap-enabled

Synopsis

— if-link-trap-enabled <TRAP_ENABLED>

— no if-link-trap-enabled

718 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: RS

Description
Use this command to enable notifications for the RS interface.

Use the no option to disable notifications for the RS interface.

Command Mode
RS submode — (controller-rsttp)

Operands

TRAP_ENABLED 1 — Enables notifications for the RS interface.

2 — Disables notifications for the RS interface.

Examples
Enabling notifications for the RS interface:
ML66(controller-rsttp)#if-link-trap-enabled 1

79.7 name

Synopsis
name <NAME>

Description
Use this command to set the name of the RS interface.

Command Mode
RS submode — (controller-rsttp)

Operands

NAME The name of the RS interface.

Examples
Setting the name of the RS interface to 'RSInterface':
ML66(controller-rsttp)#name RSInterface

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 719


CLI Descriptions

79.8 reset-cur-15min-ne-regs

Synopsis
reset-cur-15min-ne-regs <RESET_CUR_15MIN_NE_REGS>

Description
Use this command to reset the current 15 minute performance data of the near
end.

Command Mode
RS submode — (controller-rsttp)

Operands

RESET_CUR_15MIN_NE_REGS
1 — Resets the current 15 minute performance data of
the near end.

Examples
Resetting the current 15 minute performance data of the near end:
ML66(controller-rsttp)#reset-cur-15min-ne-regs 1

79.9 reset-cur-24h-ne-regs

Synopsis
reset-cur-24h-ne-regs <RESET_CUR_24H_NE_REGS>

Description
Use this command to reset the current 24 hour performance data of the near end.

Command Mode
RS submode — (controller-rsttp)

Operands

RESET_CUR_24H_NE_REGS

720 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: RS

1 — Resets the current 24 hour performance data of the


near end.

Examples
Resetting the current 24 hour performance data of the near end:
ML66(controller-rsttp)#reset-cur-24h-ne-regs 1

79.10 trail-trace-enabled

Synopsis

— trail-trace-enabled <TRAIL_TRACE_ENABLED>

— no trail-trace-enabled

Description
Use this command to enable the controlling of trail trace ID supervision.

Use the no option to disable the function.

Command Mode
RS submode — (controller-rsttp)

Operands

TRAIL_TRACE_ENABLED
1 — Enables trail trace.

2 — Disables trail trace.

Examples
Enabling the controlling of trail trace ID supervision:
ML66(controller-rsttp)#trail-trace-enabled 1

79.11 trail-trace-expected

Synopsis

— trail-trace-expected <TRAIL_TRACE_EXPECTED>

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 721


CLI Descriptions

— no trail-trace-expected

Description
Use this command to set the expected identifier of the received payload.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
RS submode — (controller-rsttp)

Operands

TRAIL_TRACE_EXPECTED
The name of the expected identifier.

Examples
Setting the expected identifier of the received payload to 'NoTraceAssigned':
ML66(controller-rsttp)#trail-trace-expected NoTraceAssigned

79.12 trail-trace-send

Synopsis

— trail-trace-send <TRAIL_TRACE_SEND>

— no trail-trace-send

Description
Use this command to set the identifier of the transmitted payload.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
RS submode — (controller-rsttp)

Operands

TRAIL_TRACE_SEND
The name of the identifier.

722 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: RS

Examples
Setting the identifier of the transmitted payload to 'NoTraceAssigned':
ML66(controller-rsttp)#trail-trace-send NoTraceAssigned

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 723


CLI Descriptions

80 LTU 1002 Commands: MS

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
87.

Note: These commands are only valid for ETSI.

The following command modes are applicable for the LTU 1002 MS commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— MS submode — (controller-msttp)

Table 87 LTU 1002 MS Commands Overview


am-severity-ais set the severity of the Multiplex
Section Alarm Indication Signal (AIS)
alarm
am-severity-deg set the severity of the Degraded alarm
am-severity-exc set the severity of the Excessive Errors
alarm
am-severity-k2mis set the severity of the K2 Mismatch
alarm
am-severity-rdi set the severity of the Remote Defect
Indication (RDI) alarm
am-severity-uastfe set the severity of the Unavailable
State Far End alarm
am-severity-uastne set the severity of the Unavailable
State alarm
controller msttp change to the (controller-msttp)
submode
degm set the monitoring period, Degraded
Monitoring (DEGM), used to declare
Degraded Signal (DEG
degthr set the Degraded Threshold (DEGTHR)
value used to detect a degraded defect
at MS
enable-pm-point enable Performance Monitoring (PM)
for the MS interface
if-link-trap-enabled enable notifications for the MS
interface

724 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: MS

lineloop set the line loop state on the MS


interface
name set the name of the MS interface
rei enable or disable Multiplex Section
Remote Error Indication (MS-REI)
reset-cur-15min-fe-regs reset the current 15 minute
performance data of the far end
reset-cur-15min-ne-regs reset the current 15 minute
performance data of the near end
reset-cur-24h-fe-regs reset the current 24 hour performance
data of the far end
reset-cur-24h-ne-regs reset the current 24 hour performance
data of the near end
squelch enable clock squelching for the
interface

80.1 am-severity-ais

Synopsis

— am-severity-ais <AM_SEVERITY_AIS>

— no am-severity-ais

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Multiplex Section Alarm Indication
Signal (AIS) alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
MS submode — (controller-msttp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_AIS
Severity of the Multiplex Section AIS failure. The
following values are available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 725


CLI Descriptions

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the Multiplex Section AIS alarm:
ML66(controller-msttp)#am-severity-ais 3

80.2 am-severity-deg

Synopsis

— am-severity-deg <AM_SEVERITY_DEG>

— no am-severity-deg

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Degraded alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
MS submode — (controller-msttp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_DEG
Severity of the Degraded failure. The following values are
available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

726 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: MS

Examples
Setting the severity of the Degraded alarm:
ML66(controller-msttp)#am-severity-deg 3

80.3 am-severity-exc

Synopsis

— am-severity-exc <AM_SEVERITY_EXC>

— no am-severity-exc

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Excessive Errors alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
MS submode — (controller-msttp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_EXC
Severity of the Excessive Errors failure. The following
values are available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the Excessive Errors alarm:
ML66(controller-msttp)#am-severity-exc 2

80.4 am-severity-k2mis

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 727


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
am-severity-k2mis <AM_SEVERITY_K2MIS>

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the K2 Mismatch alarm.

Command Mode
MS submode — (controller-msttp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_K2MIS
Severity of the K2 Mismatch failure. The following values
are available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the K2 Mismatch alarm:
ML66(controller-msttp)#am-severity-k2mis 3

80.5 am-severity-rdi

Synopsis

— am-severity-rdi <AM_SEVERITY_RDI>

— no am-severity-rdi

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Remote Defect Indication (RDI)
alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

728 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: MS

Command Mode
MS submode — (controller-msttp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_RDI
Severity of the RDI failure. The following values are
available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the RDI alarm:
ML66(controller-msttp)#am-severity-rdi 4

80.6 am-severity-uastfe

Synopsis

— am-severity-uastfe <AM_SEVERITY_UASTFE>

— no am-severity-uastfe

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Unavailable State Far End alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
MS submode — (controller-msttp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_UASTFE

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 729


CLI Descriptions

Severity of the Unavailable State Far End failure. The


following values are available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the Unavailable State Far End alarm:
ML66(controller-msttp)#am-severity-uastfe 5

80.7 am-severity-uastne

Synopsis

— am-severity-uastne <AM_SEVERITY_UASTNE>

— no am-severity-uastne

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Unavailable State alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
MS submode — (controller-msttp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_UASTNE
Severity of the Unavailable State failure. The following
values are available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

730 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: MS

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the Unavailable State alarm:
ML66(controller-msttp)#am-severity-uastne 5

80.8 controller msttp

Synopsis
controller msttp <R/S/Index>

Description
Use this command to configure an MS interface. The command also changes to
the (controller-msttp) submode.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

R/S/Index The Rack, Slot, and Index value of the MS interface


where the format is R/S/Index.

Examples
Configuring the MS interface and changing to the (controller-msttp) submode:
ML66(config)#controller msttp 1/3/1
ML66(controller-msttp)#

80.9 degm

Synopsis
degm <VALUE>

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 731


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to set the monitoring period, Degraded Monitoring (DEGM),
used to declare Degraded Signal (DEG).

Command Mode
MS submode — (controller-msttp)

Operands

VALUE The monitoring period in seconds. The valid range is 2–


10. The default value is 3.

Examples
Setting the monitoring period to 4 seconds:
ML66(controller-msttp)#degm 4

80.10 degthr

Synopsis
degthr <VALUE>

Description
Use this command to set the Degraded Threshold (DEGTHR) value used to detect
a degraded defect at MS.

Command Mode
MS submode — (controller-msttp)

Operands

VALUE The DEGTHR value. The valid range is 1–100. The


default value is 30.

Examples
Setting the DEGTHR value to 50:
ML66(controller-msttp)#degthr 50

732 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: MS

80.11 enable-pm-point

Synopsis

— enable-pm-point <ENABLE_PERF_MON_POINT>

— no enable-pm-point

Description
Use this command to enable Performance Monitoring (PM) on the MS interface.

Use the no option to disable PM on the MS interface.

Command Mode
MS submode — (controller-msttp)

Operands

ENABLE_PERF_MON_POINT
1 — Enables PM on the MS interface.

2 — Disables PM on the MS interface.

Examples
Enabling PM on the MS interface:
ML66(controller-msttp)#enable-pm-point 1

80.12 if-link-trap-enabled

Synopsis

— if-link-trap-enabled <TRAP_ENABLED>

— no if-link-trap-enabled

Description
Use this command to enable notifications for the MS interface.

Use the no option to disable notifications for the MS interface.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 733


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
MS submode — (controller-msttp)

Operands

TRAP_ENABLED 1 — Enables notifications for the MS interface.

2 — Enables notifications for the MS interface.

Examples
Enabling notifications for the MS interface:
ML66(controller-msttp)#if-link-trap-enabled 1

80.13 lineloop

Synopsis
lineloop <LINE>

Description
Use this command to set the line loop state on the MS interface.

Command Mode
MS submode — (controller-msttp)

Operands

LINE 0 — No loop.

1 — Line loop.

2 — Local loop.

3 — Line + local loop.

Examples
Setting the line loop state on the MS interface to line loop:
ML66(controller-msttp)#lineloop 1

734 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: MS

80.14 name

Synopsis
name <NAME>

Description
Use this command to set the name of the MS interface.

Command Mode
MS submode — (controller-msttp)

Operands

NAME The name of the MS interface.

Examples
Setting the name of the MS interface to 'MSInterface':
ML66(controller-msttp)#name MSInterface

80.15 rei

Synopsis
rei <REI_VALUE>

Description
Use this command to enable or disable Performance Monitoring (PM) for
Multiplex Section Remote Error Indication (MS-REI).

Command Mode
MS submode — (controller-msttp)

Operands

REI_VALUE 1 — Enables PM for MS-REI.

2 — Disables PM for MS-REI.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 735


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Enabling PM for MS-REI:
ML66(controller-msttp)#rei 1

80.16 reset-cur-15min-fe-regs

Synopsis
reset-cur-15min-fe-regs <RESET_CUR_15MIN_FE_REGS>

Description
Use this command to reset the current 15 minute performance data of the far
end.

Command Mode
MS submode — (controller-msttp)

Operands

RESET_CUR_15MIN_FE_REGS
1 — Resets the current 15 minute performance data of
the far end.

Examples
Resetting the current 15 minute performance data of the far end:
ML66(controller-msttp)#reset-cur-15min-fe-regs 1

80.17 reset-cur-15min-ne-regs

Synopsis
reset-cur-15min-ne-regs <RESET_CUR_15MIN_NE_REGS>

Description
Use this command to reset the current 15 minute performance data of the near
end.

736 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: MS

Command Mode
MS submode — (controller-msttp)

Operands

RESET_CUR_15MIN_NE_REGS
1 — Resets the current 15 minute performance data of
the near end.

Examples
Resetting the current 15 minute performance data of the near end:
ML66(controller-msttp)#reset-cur-15min-ne-regs 1

80.18 reset-cur-24h-fe-regs

Synopsis
reset-cur-24h-fe-regs <RESET_CUR_24H_FE_REGS>

Description
Use this command to reset the current 24 hour performance data of the far end.

Command Mode
MS submode — (controller-msttp)

Operands

RESET_CUR_24H_FE_REGS
1 — Resets the current 24 hour performance data of the
far end.

Examples
Resetting the current 24 hour performance data of the far end:
ML66(controller-msttp)#reset-cur-24h-fe-regs 1

80.19 reset-cur-24h-ne-regs

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 737


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
reset-cur-24h-ne-regs <RESET_CUR_24H_NE_REGS>

Description
Use this command to reset the current 24 hour performance data of the near end.

Command Mode
MS submode — (controller-msttp)

Operands

RESET_CUR_24H_NE_REGS
1 — Resets the current 24 hour performance data of the
near end.

Examples
Resetting the current 24 hour performance data of the near end:
ML66(controller-msttp)#reset-cur-24h-ne-regs 1

80.20 squelch

Synopsis

— squelch <SQUELCH>

— no squelch

Description
Use this command to enable SDH STM clock squelch for the interface.

Use the no option to disable SDH STM clock squelch.

Command Mode
MS submode — (controller-msttp)

Operands

SQUELCH 1 — Enables clock squelch.

2 — Disables clock squelch.

738 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: MS

Examples
Enabling SDH STM clock squelch:
ML66(controller-msttp)#squelch 1

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 739


CLI Descriptions

81 LTU 1002 Commands: MSP

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
88.

Note: These commands are only valid for ETSI.

The following command modes are applicable for the LTU 1002 MSP commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— MSP submode — (controller-msp)

Table 88 LTU 1002 MSP Commands Overview


am-severity-ais set the severity of the Multiplex
Section Alarm Indication Signal (AIS)
alarm
am-severity-deg set the severity of the Degraded alarm
am-severity-exc set the severity of the Excessive Errors
alarm
am-severity-k2mis set the severity of the K2 Mismatch
alarm
am-severity-rdi set the severity of the Remote Defect
Indication (RDI) alarm
am-severity-uastfe set the severity of the Unavailable
State Far End alarm
am-severity-uastne set the severity of the Unavailable
State alarm
controller msp change to the (controller-msp)
submode
enable-pm-point enable Performance Monitoring (PM)
on the MSP interface
if-link-trap-enabled enable notifications for the MSP
interface
name set the name of the MSP interface
reset-cur-15min-fe-regs reset the current 15 minute
performance data of the far end
reset-cur-15min-ne-regs reset the current 15 minute
performance data of the near end
reset-cur-24h-fe-regs reset the current 24 hour performance
data of the far end

740 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: MSP

reset-cur-24h-ne-regs reset the current 24 hour performance


data of the near end

81.1 am-severity-ais

Synopsis

— am-severity-ais <AM_SEVERITY_AIS>

— no am-severity-ais

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Multiplex Section Alarm Indication
Signal (AIS) alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
MSP submode — (controller-msp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_AIS
Severity of the Multiplex Section AIS failure. The
following values are available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the Multiplex Section AIS alarm:
ML66(controller-msp)#am-severity-ais 3

81.2 am-severity-deg

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 741


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis

— am-severity-deg <AM_SEVERITY_DEG>

— no am-severity-deg

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Degraded alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
MSP submode — (controller-msp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_DEG
Severity of the Degraded failure. The following values are
available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the Degraded alarm:
ML66(controller-msp)#am-severity-deg 3

81.3 am-severity-exc

Synopsis

— am-severity-exc <AM_SEVERITY_EXC>

— no am-severity-exc

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Excessive Errors alarm.

742 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: MSP

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
MSP submode — (controller-msp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_EXC
Severity of the Excessive Errors failure. The following
values are available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the Excessive Errors alarm:
ML66(controller-msp)#am-severity-exc 2

81.4 am-severity-k2mis

Synopsis
am-severity-k2mis <AM_SEVERITY_K2MIS>

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the K2 Mismatch alarm.

Command Mode
MSP submode — (controller-msp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_K2MIS
Severity of the K2 Mismatch failure. The following values
are available:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 743


CLI Descriptions

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the K2 Mismatch alarm:
ML66(controller-msp)#am-severity-k2mis 3

81.5 am-severity-rdi

Synopsis

— am-severity-rdi <AM_SEVERITY_RDI>

— no am-severity-rdi

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Remote Defect Indication (RDI)
alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
MSP submode — (controller-msp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_RDI
Severity of the RDI failure. The following values are
available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

744 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: MSP

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the RDI alarm:
ML66(controller-msp)#am-severity-rdi 4

81.6 am-severity-uastfe

Synopsis

— am-severity-uastfe <AM_SEVERITY_UASTFE>

— no am-severity-uastfe

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Unavailable State Far End alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
MSP submode — (controller-msp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_UASTFE
Severity of the Unavailable State Far End failure. The
following values are available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the Unavailable State Far End alarm:
ML66(controller-msp)#am-severity-uastfe 5

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 745


CLI Descriptions

81.7 am-severity-uastne

Synopsis

— am-severity-uastne <AM_SEVERITY_UASTNE>

— no am-severity-uastne

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Unavailable State alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
MSP submode — (controller-msp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_UASTNE
Severity of the Unavailable State failure. The following
values are available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the Unavailable State alarm:
ML66(controller-msp)#am-severity-uastne 5

81.8 controller msp

Synopsis
controller msp <R/S/Index>

746 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: MSP

Description
Use this command to configure an MSP interface. The command also changes to
the (controller-msp) submode.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

R/S/Index The Rack, Slot, and Index value of the MSP interface
where the format is R/S/Index.

Examples
Configuring the MSP interface and changing to the (controller-msp) submode:
ML66(config)#controller msp 1/3/1
ML66(controller-msp)#

81.9 enable-pm-point

Synopsis

— enable-pm-point <ENABLE_PERF_MON_POINT>

— no enable-pm-point

Description
Use this command to enable Performance Monitoring (PM) on the MSP interface.

Use the no option to disable PM on the MSP interface.

Command Mode
MSP submode — (controller-msp)

Operands

ENABLE_PERF_MON_POINT
1 — Enables PM on the MSP interface.

2 — Disables PM on the MSP interface.

Examples
Enabling PM on the MSP interface:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 747


CLI Descriptions

ML66(controller-msp)#enable-pm-point 1

81.10 if-link-trap-enabled

Synopsis

— if-link-trap-enabled <TRAP_ENABLED>

— no if-link-trap-enabled

Description
Use this command to enable notifications for the MSP interface.

Use the no option to disable notifications for the MSP interface.

Command Mode
MSP submode — (controller-msp)

Operands

TRAP_ENABLED 1 — Enables notifications for the MSP interface.

2 — Disables notifications for the MSP interface.

Examples
Enabling notifications for the MSP interface:
ML66(controller-msp)#if-link-trap-enabled 1

81.11 name

Synopsis
name <NAME>

Description
Use this command to set the name of the MSP interface.

Command Mode
MSP submode — (controller-msp)

748 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: MSP

Operands

NAME The name of the MSP interface.

Examples
Setting the name of the MSP interface to 'MSPInterface':
ML66(controller-msp)#name MSPInterface

81.12 reset-cur-15min-fe-regs

Synopsis
reset-cur-15min-fe-regs <RESET_CUR_15MIN_FE_REGS>

Description
Use this command to reset the current 15 minute performance data of the far
end.

Command Mode
MSP submode — (controller-msp)

Operands

RESET_CUR_15MIN_FE_REGS
1 — Resets the current 15 minute performance data of
the far end.

Examples
Resetting the current 15 minute performance data of the far end:
ML66(controller-msp)#reset-cur-15min-fe-regs 1

81.13 reset-cur-15min-ne-regs

Synopsis
reset-cur-15min-ne-regs <RESET_CUR_15MIN_NE_REGS>

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 749


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to reset the current 15 minute performance data of the near
end.

Command Mode
MSP submode — (controller-msp)

Operands

RESET_CUR_15MIN_NE_REGS
1 — Resets the current 15 minute performance data of
the near end.

Examples
Resetting the current 15 minute performance data of the near end:
ML66(controller-msp)#reset-cur-15min-ne-regs 1

81.14 reset-cur-24h-fe-regs

Synopsis
reset-cur-24h-fe-regs <RESET_CUR_24H_FE_REGS>

Description
Use this command to reset the current 24 hour performance data of the far end.

Command Mode
MSP submode — (controller-msp)

Operands

RESET_CUR_24H_FE_REGS
1 — Resets the current 24 hour performance data of the
far end.

Examples
Resetting the current 24 hour performance data of the far end:
ML66(controller-msp)#reset-cur-24h-fe-regs 1

750 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: MSP

81.15 reset-cur-24h-ne-regs

Synopsis
reset-cur-24h-ne-regs <RESET_CUR_24H_NE_REGS>

Description
Use this command to reset the current 24 hour performance data of the near end.

Command Mode
MSP submode — (controller-msp)

Operands

RESET_CUR_24H_NE_REGS
1 — Resets the current 24 hour performance data of the
near end.

Examples
Resetting the current 24 hour performance data of the near end:
ML66(controller-msp)#reset-cur-24h-ne-regs 1

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 751


CLI Descriptions

82 LTU 1002 Commands: AU-4 and VC-4

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
89.

Note: These commands are only valid for ETSI.

The following command modes are applicable for the LTU 1002 AU-4 and VC-4
commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

Table 89 LTU 1002 AU-4 and VC-4 Commands Overview


controller au4ctp-vc4ttp configure an AU-4 or a VC-4 interface
degm set the monitoring period, Degraded
Monitoring (DEGM), used to declare
Degraded Signal (DEG)
degthr set the Degraded Threshold (DEGTHR)
value used to detect a degraded defect
at VC-4
if-link-trap-enabled enable notifications for the VC-4
interface
name set the name of the VC-4 interface
trail-trace-enabled enable the controlling of trail trace ID
supervision
trail-trace-expected set the expected identifier of the
received payload
trail-trace-send set the identifier of the transmitted
payload
vc4-am-severity-ais set the severity of the AU Alarm
Indication Signal (AIS) alarm
vc4-am-severity-deg set the severity of the Degraded alarm
vc4-am-severity-exc set the severity of the Excessive Errors
alarm
vc4-am-severity-lom set the severity of the Loss of
Multiframe (LOM) alarm
vc4-am-severity-lop set the severity of the AU Loss of
Pointer (LOP) alarm

752 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: AU-4 and VC-4

vc4-am-severity-plm set the severity of the Payload


Mismatch (PLM) alarm
vc4-am-severity-rdi set the severity of the Remote Defect
Indication (RDI) alarm
vc4-am-severity-tim set the severity of the VC-4 Trace
Identifier Mismatch (TIM) alarm
vc4-am-severity-uastfe set the severity of the Unavailable
State Far End alarm
vc4-am-severity-uastne set the severity of the Unavailable
State alarm
vc4-am-severity-uneq set the severity of the Unequipped
Indication alarm
vc4-enable-pm-point enable Performance Monitoring (PM)
on the VC-4 interface
vc4-reset-cur-15min-fe-regs reset the current 15 minute
performance data of the far end
vc4-reset-cur-15min-ne-regs reset the current 15 minute
performance data of the near end
vc4-reset-cur-24h-fe-regs reset the current 24 hour performance
data of the far end
vc4-reset-cur-24h-ne-regs reset the current 24 hour performance
data of the near end

82.1 controller au4ctp-vc4ttp

Synopsis
controller au4ctp-vc4ttp <R/S/Index>

Description
Use this command to configure an AU-4 or a VC-4 interface. The command also
changes to the (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp) submode.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

R/S/Index The Rack, Slot, and Index value of the AU-4 or the VC-4
interface where the format is R/S/Index.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 753


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Configuring the VC-4 interface and changing to the (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)
submode:
ML66(config)#controller au4ctp-vc4ttp 1/3/5
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#

82.2 degm

Synopsis
degm <VALUE>

Description
Use this command to set the monitoring period, Degraded Monitoring (DEGM),
used to declare Degraded Signal (DEG).

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

Operands

VALUE The monitoring period in seconds. The valid range is 2–


10. The default value is 3.

Examples
Setting the monitoring period to 4 seconds:
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#degm 4

82.3 degthr

Synopsis
degthr <VALUE>

Description
Use this command to set the Degraded Threshold (DEGTHR) value used to detect
a degraded defect at VC-4.

754 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: AU-4 and VC-4

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

Operands

VALUE The DEGTHR value. The valid range is 1–100. The


default value is 30.

Examples
Setting the DEGTHR value to 50:
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#degthr 50

82.4 if-link-trap-enabled

Synopsis

— if-link-trap-enabled <TRAP_ENABLED>

— no if-link-trap-enabled

Description
Use this command to enable notifications for the VC-4 interface.

Use the no option to disable notifications for the VC-4 interface.

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

Operands

TRAP_ENABLED 1 — Enables notifications for the VC-4 interface.

2 — Disables notifications for the VC-4 interface.

Examples
Enabling notifications for the VC-4 interface:
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#if-link-trap-enabled 1

82.5 name

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 755


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
name <NAME>

Description
Use this command to set the name of the VC-4 interface.

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

Operands

NAME The name of the VC-4 interface.

Examples
Setting the name of the VC-4 interface to 'VC4Interface':
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#name VC4Interface

82.6 trail-trace-enabled

Synopsis

— trail-trace-enabled <TRAIL_TRACE_ENABLED>

— no trail-trace-enabled

Description
Use this command to enable the controlling of trail trace ID supervision.

Use the no option to disable the function.

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

Operands

TRAIL_TRACE_ENABLED
1 — Enables trail trace.

2 — Disables trail trace.

756 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: AU-4 and VC-4

Examples
Enabling the controlling of trail trace ID supervision:
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#trail-trace-enabled 1

82.7 trail-trace-expected

Synopsis

— trail-trace-expected <TRAIL_TRACE_EXPECTED>

— no trail-trace-expected

Description
Use this command to set the expected identifier of the received payload.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

Operands

TRAIL_TRACE_EXPECTED
The name of the expected identifier.

Examples
Setting the expected identifier of the received payload to 'NoTraceAssigned':
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#trail-trace-expected NoTraceAssigned

82.8 trail-trace-send

Synopsis

— trail-trace-send <TRAIL_TRACE_SEND>

— no trail-trace-send

Description
Use this command to set the identifier of the transmitted payload.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 757


CLI Descriptions

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

Operands

TRAIL_TRACE_SEND
The name of the identifier.

Examples
Setting the identifier of the transmitted payload to 'NoTraceAssigned':
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#trail-trace-send NoTraceAssigned

82.9 vc4-am-severity-ais

Synopsis

— vc4-am-severity-ais <VC4_AM_SEVERITY_AIS>

— no vc4-am-severity-ais

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the AU Alarm Indication Signal (AIS)
alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

Operands

VC4_AM_SEVERITY_AIS
Severity of the AU AIS failure. The following values are
available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

758 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: AU-4 and VC-4

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the AU AIS alarm:
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#am-severity-ais 3

82.10 vc4-am-severity-deg

Synopsis

— vc4-am-severity-deg <VC4_AM_SEVERITY_DEG>

— no vc4-am-severity-deg

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Degraded alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

Operands

VC4_AM_SEVERITY_DEG
Severity of the Degraded failure. The following values are
available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the Degraded alarm:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 759


CLI Descriptions

ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#am-severity-deg 3

82.11 vc4-am-severity-exc

Synopsis

— vc4-am-severity-exc <VC4_AM_SEVERITY_EXC>

— no vc4-am-severity-exc

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Excessive Errors alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

Operands

VC4_AM_SEVERITY_EXC
Severity of the Excessive Errors failure. The following
values are available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the Excessive Errors alarm:
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#am-severity-exc 2

82.12 vc4-am-severity-lom

760 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: AU-4 and VC-4

Synopsis

— vc4-am-severity-lom <VC4_AM_SEVERITY_LOM>

— no vc4-am-severity-lom

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Loss of Multiframe (LOM) alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

Operands

VC4_AM_SEVERITY_LOM
Severity of the LOM failure. The following values are
available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the LOM alarm:
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#vc4-am-severity-lom 4

82.13 vc4-am-severity-lop

Synopsis

— vc4-am-severity-lop <VC4_AM_SEVERITY_LOP>

— no vc4-am-severity-lop

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the AU Loss of Pointer (LOP) alarm.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 761


CLI Descriptions

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

Operands

VC4_AM_SEVERITY_LOP
Severity of the AU LOP failure. The following values are
available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the AU LOP alarm:
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#vc4-am-severity-lop 4

82.14 vc4-am-severity-plm

Synopsis

— vc4-am-severity-plm <VC4_AM_SEVERITY_PLM>

— no vc4-am-severity-plm

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Payload Mismatch (PLM) alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

762 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: AU-4 and VC-4

Operands

VC4_AM_SEVERITY_PLM
Severity of the PLM failure. The following values are
available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the PLM alarm:
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#vc4-am-severity-plm 4

82.15 vc4-am-severity-rdi

Synopsis

— vc4-am-severity-rdi <VC4_AM_SEVERITY_RDI>

— no vc4-am-severity-rdi

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Remote Defect Indication (RDI)
alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

Operands

VC4_AM_SEVERITY_RDI
Severity of the RDI failure. The following values are
available:

— 1 — undetermined

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 763


CLI Descriptions

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the RDI alarm:
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#am-severity-rdi 4

82.16 vc4-am-severity-tim

Synopsis

— vc4-am-severity-tim <VC4_AM_SEVERITY_TIM>

— no vc4-am-severity-tim

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the VC-4 Trace Identifier Mismatch (TIM)
alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

Operands

VC4_AM_SEVERITY_TIM
Severity of the VC-4 TIM failure. The following values are
available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

764 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: AU-4 and VC-4

Examples
Setting the severity of the VC-4 TIM alarm:
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#am-severity-tim 4

82.17 vc4-am-severity-uastfe

Synopsis

— vc4-am-severity-uastfe <VC4_AM_SEVERITY_UASTFE>

— no vc4-am-severity-uastfe

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Unavailable State Far End alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

Operands

VC4_AM_SEVERITY_UASTFE
Severity of the Unavailable State Far End failure. The
following values are available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the Unavailable State Far End alarm:
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#am-severity-uastfe 5

82.18 vc4-am-severity-uastne

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 765


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis

— vc4-am-severity-uastne <VC4_AM_SEVERITY_UASTNE>

— no vc4-am-severity-uastne

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Unavailable State alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

Operands

VC4_AM_SEVERITY_UASTNE
Severity of the Unavailable State failure. The following
values are available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the Unavailable State alarm:
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#am-severity-uastne 5

82.19 vc4-am-severity-uneq

Synopsis

— vc4-am-severity-uneq <VC4_AM_SEVERITY_UNEQ>

— no vc4-am-severity-uneq

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Unequipped Indication alarm.

766 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: AU-4 and VC-4

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

Operands

VC4_AM_SEVERITY_UNEQ
Severity of the Unequipped Indication failure. The
following values are available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the Unequipped Indication alarm:
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#vc4-am-severity-uneq 4

82.20 vc4-enable-pm-point

Synopsis

— vc4-enable-pm-point <ENABLE_PERF_MON_POINT>

— no vc4-enable-pm-point

Description
Use this command to enable Performance Monitoring (PM) on the VC-4 interface.

Use the no option to disable PM on the VC-4 interface.

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 767


CLI Descriptions

Operands

ENABLE_PERF_MON_POINT
1 — Enables PM on the VC-4 interface.

2 — Disables PM on the VC-4 interface.

Examples
Enabling PM on the VC-4 interface:
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#vc4-enable-pm-point 1

82.21 vc4-reset-cur-15min-fe-regs

Synopsis
vc4-reset-cur-15min-fe-regs <RESET_CUR_15MIN_FE_REGS>

Description
Use this command to reset the current 15 minute performance data of the far
end.

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

Operands

RESET_CUR_15MIN_FE_REGS
1 — Resets the current 15 minute performance data of
the far end.

Examples
Resetting the current 15 minute performance data of the far end:
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#vc4-reset-cur-15min-fe-regs 1

82.22 vc4-reset-cur-15min-ne-regs

Synopsis
vc4-reset-cur-15min-ne-regs <RESET_CUR_15MIN_NE_REGS>

768 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: AU-4 and VC-4

Description
Use this command to reset the current 15 minute performance data of the near
end.

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

Operands

RESET_CUR_15MIN_NE_REGS
1 — Resets the current 15 minute performance data of
the near end.

Examples
Resetting the current 15 minute performance data of the near end:
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#vc4-reset-cur-15min-ne-regs 1

82.23 vc4-reset-cur-24h-fe-regs

Synopsis
vc4-reset-cur-24h-fe-regs <RESET_CUR_24H_FE_REGS>

Description
Use this command to reset the current 24 hour performance data of the far end.

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

Operands

RESET_CUR_24H_FE_REGS
1 — Resets the current 24 hour performance data of the
far end.

Examples
Resetting the current 24 hour performance data of the far end:
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#vc4-reset-cur-24h-fe-regs 1

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 769


CLI Descriptions

82.24 vc4-reset-cur-24h-ne-regs

Synopsis
vc4-reset-cur-24h-ne-regs <RESET_CUR_24H_NE_REGS>

Description
Use this command to reset the current 24 hour performance data of the near end.

Command Mode
AU-4 and VC-4 submode — (controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)

Operands

RESET_CUR_24H_NE_REGS
1 — Resets the current 24 hour performance data of the
near end.

Examples
Resetting the current 24 hour performance data of the near end:
ML66(controller-au4ctp-vc4ttp)#vc4-reset-cur-24h-ne-regs 1

770 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: VC-12

83 LTU 1002 Commands: VC-12

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
90.

Note: These commands are only valid for ETSI.

The following command modes are applicable for the LTU 1002 VC-12
commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

Table 90 LTU 1002 VC-12 Commands Overview


am-severity-ais set the severity of the TU Alarm
Indication Signal (AIS) alarm
am-severity-deg set the severity of the Degraded alarm
am-severity-exc set the severity of the Excessive Errors
alarm
am-severity-lom set the severity of the Loss of
Multiframe (LOM) alarm
am-severity-lop set the severity of the TU Loss of
Pointer (LOP) alarm
am-severity-plm set the severity of the Payload
Mismatch (PLM) alarm
am-severity-rdi set the severity of the Remote Defect
Indication (RDI) alarm
am-severity-tim set the severity of the VC-12 Trace
Identifier Mismatch (TIM) alarm
am-severity-uastfe set the severity of the Unavailable
State Far End alarm
am-severity-uastne set the severity of the Unavailable
State alarm
am-severity-uneq set the severity of the Unequipped
Indication alarm
controller vc12ttp change to the (controller-vc12ttp)
submode
degm set the monitoring period, Degraded
Monitoring (DEGM), used to declare
Degraded Signal (DEG)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 771


CLI Descriptions

degthr set the Degraded Threshold (DEGTHR)


value used to detect a degraded defect
at VC-12
enable-pm-point enable Performance Monitoring (PM)
on the VC-12 interface
if-link-trap-enabled enable notifications for the VC-12
interface
name set the name of the VC-12 interface
reset-cur-15min-fe-regs reset the current 15 minute
performance data of the far end
reset-cur-15min-ne-regs reset the current 15 minute
performance data of the near end
reset-cur-24h-fe-regs reset the current 24 hour performance
data of the far end
reset-cur-24h-ne-regs reset the current 24 hour performance
data of the near end
trail-trace-enabled enable the controlling of trail trace ID
supervision
trail-trace-expected set the expected identifier of the
received payload
trail-trace-send set the identifier of the transmitted
payload

83.1 am-severity-ais

Synopsis

— am-severity-ais <AM_SEVERITY_AIS>

— no am-severity-ais

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the TU Alarm Indication Signal (AIS)
alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

772 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: VC-12

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_AIS
Severity of the TU AIS failure. The following values are
available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the TU AIS alarm:
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#am-severity-ais 3

83.2 am-severity-deg

Synopsis

— am-severity-deg <AM_SEVERITY_DEG>

— no am-severity-deg

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Degraded alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_DEG
Severity of the Degraded failure. The following values are
available:

— 1 — undetermined

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 773


CLI Descriptions

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the Degraded alarm:
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#am-severity-deg 3

83.3 am-severity-exc

Synopsis

— am-severity-exc <AM_SEVERITY_EXC>

— no am-severity-exc

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Excessive Errors alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_EXC
Severity of the Excessive Errors failure. The following
values are available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

774 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: VC-12

Examples
Setting the severity of the Excessive Errors alarm:
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#am-severity-exc 2

83.4 am-severity-lom

Synopsis

— am-severity-lom <AM_SEVERITY_LOM>

— no am-severity-lom

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Loss of Multiframe (LOM) alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_LOM
Severity of the LOM failure. The following values are
available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the LOM alarm:
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#vc4-am-severity-lom 4

83.5 am-severity-lop

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 775


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis

— am-severity-lop <AM_SEVERITY_LOP>

— no am-severity-lop

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the TU Loss of Pointer (LOP) alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_LOP
Severity of the TU LOP failure. The following values are
available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the TU LOP alarm:
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#vc4-am-severity-lop 4

83.6 am-severity-plm

Synopsis

— am-severity-plm <AM_SEVERITY_PLM>

— no am-severity-plm

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Payload Mismatch (PLM) alarm.

776 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: VC-12

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_PLM
Severity of the PLM failure. The following values are
available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the PLM alarm:
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#vc4-am-severity-plm 4

83.7 am-severity-rdi

Synopsis

— am-severity-rdi <AM_SEVERITY_RDI>

— no am-severity-rdi

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Remote Defect Indication (RDI)
alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 777


CLI Descriptions

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_RDI
Severity of the RDI failure. The following values are
available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the RDI alarm:
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#am-severity-rdi 4

83.8 am-severity-tim

Synopsis

— am-severity-tim <AM_SEVERITY_TIM>

— no am-severity-tim

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the VC-12 Trace Identifier Mismatch
(TIM) alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_TIM
Severity of the VC-12 TIM failure. The following values
are available:

— 1 — undetermined

778 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: VC-12

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the VC-12 TIM alarm:
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#am-severity-tim 4

83.9 am-severity-uastfe

Synopsis

— am-severity-uastfe <AM_SEVERITY_UASTFE>

— no am-severity-uastfe

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Unavailable State Far End alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_UASTFE
Severity of the Unavailable State Far End failure. The
following values are available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 779


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Setting the severity of the Unavailable State Far End alarm:
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#am-severity-uastfe 5

83.10 am-severity-uastne

Synopsis

— am-severity-uastne <AM_SEVERITY_UASTNE>

— no am-severity-uastne

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Unavailable State alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_UASTNE
Severity of the Unavailable State failure. The following
values are available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the Unavailable State alarm:
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#am-severity-uastne 5

83.11 am-severity-uneq

780 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: VC-12

Synopsis

— am-severity-uneq <AM_SEVERITY_UNEQ>

— no am-severity-uneq

Description
Use this command to set the severity of the Unequipped Indication alarm.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

Operands

AM_SEVERITY_UNEQ
Severity of the Unequipped Indication failure. The
following values are available:

— 1 — undetermined

— 2 — warning

— 3 — minor

— 4 — major

— 5 — critical

Examples
Setting the severity of the Unequipped Indication alarm:
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#vc4-am-severity-uneq 4

83.12 controller vc12ttp

Synopsis
controller vc12ttp <R/S/Index>

Description
Use this command to configure a VC-12 interface. The command also changes to
the (controller-vc12ttp) submode.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 781


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

R/S/Index The Rack, Slot, and Index value of the VC-12 interface
where the format is R/S/Index.

Examples
Configuring the VC-12 interface and changing to the (controller-vc12ttp)
submode:
ML66(config)#controller vc12ttp 1/3/1
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#

83.13 degm

Synopsis
degm <VALUE>

Description
Use this command to set the monitoring period, Degraded Monitoring (DEGM),
used to declare Degraded Signal (DEG).

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

Operands

VALUE The monitoring period in seconds. The valid range is 2–


10. The default value is 3.

Examples
Setting the monitoring period to 4 seconds:
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#degm 4

83.14 degthr

782 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: VC-12

Synopsis
degthr <VALUE>

Description
Use this command to set the Degraded Threshold (DEGTHR) value used to detect
a degraded defect at VC-12.

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

Operands

VALUE The DEGTHR value. The valid range is 1–100. The


default value is 30.

Examples
Setting the DEGTHR value to 50:
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#degthr 50

83.15 enable-pm-point

Synopsis

— enable-pm-point <ENABLE_PERF_MON_POINT>

— no enable-pm-point

Description
Use this command to enable Performance Monitoring (PM) on the VC-12
interface.

Use the no option to disable PM on the VC-12 interface.

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

Operands

ENABLE_PERF_MON_POINT
1 — Enables PM on the VC-12 interface.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 783


CLI Descriptions

2 — Disables PM on the VC-12 interface.

Examples
Enabling PM on the VC-12 interface:
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#enable-pm-point 1

83.16 if-link-trap-enabled

Synopsis

— if-link-trap-enabled <TRAP_ENABLED>

— no if-link-trap-enabled

Description
Use this command to enable notifications for the VC-12 interface.

Use the no option to disable notifications for the VC-12 interface.

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

Operands

TRAP_ENABLED 1 — Enables notifications for the VC-12 interface.

2 — Disables notifications for the VC-12 interface.

Examples
Enabling notifications for the VC-12 interface:
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#if-link-trap-enabled1 1

83.17 name

Synopsis
name <NAME>

784 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: VC-12

Description
Use this command to set the name of the VC-12 interface.

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

Operands

NAME The name of the VC-12 interface.

Examples
Setting the name of the VC-12 interface to 'VC12Interface':
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#name VC12Interface

83.18 reset-cur-15min-fe-regs

Synopsis
reset-cur-15min-fe-regs <RESET_CUR_15MIN_FE_REGS>

Description
Use this command to reset the current 15 minute performance data of the far
end.

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

Operands

RESET_CUR_15MIN_FE_REGS
1 — Resets the current 15 minute performance data of
the far end.

Examples
Resetting the current 15 minute performance data of the far end:
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#reset-cur-15min-fe-regs 1

83.19 reset-cur-15min-ne-regs

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 785


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
reset-cur-15min-ne-regs <RESET_CUR_15MIN_NE_REGS>

Description
Use this command to reset the current 15 minute performance data of the near
end.

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

Operands

RESET_CUR_15MIN_NE_REGS
1 — Resets the current 15 minute performance data of
the near end.

Examples
Resetting the current 15 minute performance data of the near end:
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#reset-cur-15min-ne-regs 1

83.20 reset-cur-24h-fe-regs

Synopsis
reset-cur-24h-fe-regs <RESET_CUR_24H_FE_REGS>

Description
Use this command to reset the current 24 hour performance data of the far end.

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

Operands

RESET_CUR_24H_FE_REGS
1 — Resets the current 24 hour performance data of the
far end.

Examples
Resetting the current 24 hour performance data of the far end:

786 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: VC-12

ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#reset-cur-24h-fe-regs 1

83.21 reset-cur-24h-ne-regs

Synopsis
reset-cur-24h-ne-regs <RESET_CUR_24H_NE_REGS>

Description
Use this command to reset the current 24 hour performance data of the near end.

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

Operands

RESET_CUR_24H_NE_REGS
1 — Resets the current 24 hour performance data of the
near end.

Examples
Resetting the current 24 hour performance data of the near end:
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#reset-cur-24h-ne-regs 1/1/5

83.22 trail-trace-enabled

Synopsis

— trail-trace-enabled <TRAIL_TRACE_ENABLED>

— no trail-trace-enabled

Description
Use this command to enable the controlling of trail trace ID supervision.

Use the no option to disable the function.

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 787


CLI Descriptions

Operands

TRAIL_TRACE_ENABLED
1 — Enables trail trace.

2 — Disables trail trace.

Examples
Enabling the controlling of trail trace ID supervision:
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#trail-trace-enabled 1

83.23 trail-trace-expected

Synopsis

— trail-trace-expected <TRAIL_TRACE_EXPECTED>

— no trail-trace-expected

Description
Use this command to set the expected identifier of the received payload.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

Operands

TRAIL_TRACE_EXPECTED
The name of the expected identifier.

Examples
Setting the expected identifier of the received payload to 'NoTraceAssigned':
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#trail-trace-expected NoTraceAssigned

83.24 trail-trace-send

788 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


LTU 1002 Commands: VC-12

Synopsis

— trail-trace-send <TRAIL_TRACE_SEND>

— no trail-trace-send

Description
Use this command to set the identifier of the transmitted payload.

Use the no option to reset the configuration.

Command Mode
VC-12 submode — (controller-vc12ttp)

Operands

TRAIL_TRACE_SEND
The name of the identifier.

Examples
Setting the identifier of the transmitted payload to 'NoTraceAssigned':
ML66(controller-vc12ttp)#trail-trace-send NoTraceAssigned

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 789


CLI Descriptions

84 Synchronization Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
91.

The following command modes are applicable for the synchronizations


commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Synch Nominee configuration submode — (config-synch-nominee)

Table 91 Synchronization Commands Overview


assigned-qlevel assign quality level to a nominee
holdoff-time set holdoff time
lockout exclude nominee from synchronization
selection
network-synch enable enable network synchronization
network-synch forced-switch perform forced switch to the selected
synchronization source
network-synch node-clock enable fixed E1/DS1 as 2 MHz clock
input or output
network-synch nominee enable or disable the selected interface
network-synch selection-mode set selection mode
network-synch squelch enable squelching
priority set the priority for the synchronization
source
signal-degrade enable the use of signal degrade
wait-to-restore-time set the wait to restore time

84.1 assigned-qlevel

Synopsis
assigned-qlevel <QUALITYLEVEL>

Description
Use this command to assign a quality level to the nominee.

790 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Synchronization Commands

Command Mode
Synch Nominee configuration submode — (config-synch-nominee)

Operands

QUALITYLEVEL Selects the level of the quality.

For ETSI, the following values are available:

— 1 — PRC

— 2 — SSU-A

— 3 — SSU-B

— 4 — SEC

— 5 — NOT assigned

For ANSI, the following values are available:

— 5 — NOT assigned

— 6 — PRS

— 7 — STU

— 8 — ST2

— 9 — TNC

— 10 — ST3E

— 11 — STE

— 12 — SMC

Default value is SSU-B for ETSI.

Examples
For ETSI, assigning SSU-B quality level to the nominee:
ML66(config-synch-nominee)#assigned-qlevel 3

For ANSI, assigning PRS quality level to the nominee:


ML66(config-synch-nominee)#assigned-qlevel 6

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 791


CLI Descriptions

84.2 holdoff-time

Synopsis

— holdoff-time <TIME-IN-MS>

— no holdoff-time

Description
Use this command to set holdoff time in milliseconds.

Use the no option to set back the default value.

Command Mode
Synch Nominee configuration submode — (config-synch-nominee)

Operands

TIME-IN-MS The holdoff time value. The default value is 500 ms.

Examples
Setting holdoff time to 500 ms:
ML66(config-synch-nominee)#holdoff-time 500

84.3 lockout

Synopsis
[no] lockout

Description
Use this command to exclude the nominated interface from the synchronization
source selection process.

Use the no option to remove the lockout.

Command Mode
Synch Nominee configuration submode — (config-synch-nominee)

792 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Synchronization Commands

Examples
Excluding the nominee from the synchronization selection:
ML66(config-synch-nominee)#lockout

84.4 network-synch enable

Synopsis
[no] network-synch enable

Description
Use this command to enable network synchronization.

Use the no option to disable network synchronization.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Enabling network synchronization:
ML66(config)#network-synch enable

84.5 network-synch forced-switch

Synopsis

— network-synch forced-switch { <IFNAME> | holdover }

— no network-synch forced-switch

Description
Use this command to perform a forced switch to the selected synchronization
source.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 793


CLI Descriptions

Operands

IFNAME The synchronization source interface.

Options

holdover Execute a forced switch to holdover.

Examples
Performing forced switch to holdover:
ML66(config)#network-synch forced-switch holdover

84.6 network-synch node-clock

Synopsis
[no] network-synch node-clock

Description
Use this command to enable the fixed E1/DS1 as 2 MHz clock input or output
instead of being an E1/DS1.

Note: The E1/DS1 can only be enabled as clock input or output if it is not used
by any other services.

Use the no option to disable the fixed E1/DS1 as 2 MHz clock input or output.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Enabling the fixed E1/DS1 as 2 MHz clock input:
ML66(config)#network-synch node-clock

84.7 network-synch nominee

Synopsis
[no] network-synch nominee <IFNAME>

794 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Synchronization Commands

Description
Use this command to enable the selected interface as synchronization nominee.
The command also changes to the (config-synch-nominee) submode.

Use the no option to disable the selected interface.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

IFNAME Name of the selected interface.

Note: The operand must be surrounded by " if it


contains space characters.

Examples
Enabling the selected interface as synchronization nominee:
ML66(config)#network-synch nominee 1/6/1

84.8 network-synch selection-mode

Synopsis

— network-synch selection-mode { ql-enabled | ql-disabled }

— no network-synch selection-mode

Description
Use this command to set selection mode.

Use the no option to reset to the default setting of QL-Enabled.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Options

ql-enabled Sets selection mode to QL-Enabled mode where the


selection logic selects the synchronization source.

ql-disabled Sets selection mode to QL-Disabled more where the


selection logic selects the synchronization source.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 795


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Setting QL-Enabled selection mode:
ML66(config)#network-synch selection-mode ql-enabled

84.9 network-synch squelch

Synopsis
[no] network-synch squelch

Description
Use this command to enable squelching, that is, Alarm Indication Signal (AIS)
propagation.

Use the no option to disable squelching.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Enabling squelching:
ML66(config)#network-synch squelch

84.10 priority

Synopsis
priority <INTEGER>

Description
Use this command to set the priority for the synchronization source.

Command Mode
Synch Nominee configuration submode — (config-synch-nominee)

796 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Synchronization Commands

Operands

INTEGER The priority value. It can be set from 1 to 4, where 1 is the


highest priority. The default value is 4.

Examples
Setting the priority to 4:
ML66(config-synch-nominee)#priority 4

84.11 signal-degrade

Synopsis
[no] signal-degrade

Description
Use this command to enable the use of signal degrade.

Command Mode
Synch Nominee configuration submode — (config-synch-nominee)

Examples
Enabling the use of signal degrade:
ML66(config-synch-nominee)#signal-degrade

84.12 wait-to-restore-time

Synopsis
wait-to-restore-time <TIME-IN-SECONDS>

Description
Use this command to assure that a synchronization input signal is stable before it
is used.

Command Mode
Synch Nominee configuration submode — (config-synch-nominee)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 797


CLI Descriptions

Operands

TIME-IN-SECONDS
Waiting time before using synchronization input signal in
seconds.

The value can be 0 or 10. The default value is 10.

Examples
Waiting 10 seconds before using synchronization input signal:
ML66(config-synch-nominee)#wait-to-restore-time 10

798 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: General Configuration

85 Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands:


General Configuration

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
92.

The following command modes are applicable for the synchronization PTP
1588v2 general configuration commands:

— Privileged Exec mode — #

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— PTP configuration submode — (config-ptp)

Table 92 General Configuration Overview


alarm-enable enable a specific alarm or all alarms
clear ptp clock-port statistics clear performance counters
clock configure the Precision Time Protocol (PTP)
clock
clock-local-priority set the clock level local priority value when
the clock mode is set to G.8275.1
clock-port create a new clock port
domain configure the domain value
event-enable enable a specific event or all events
holdover-timeout set the time/phase holdover timeout value
for the clock
interface compensate the link delay asymmetry
link-delay-compensation set the link delay on Ethernet LAN interfaces
log-clock-servo record the timestamps of the transmitted and
received 1588 packets
network-synch-assistance enable the use of network synchronization
frequency in Real Time Clock (RTC)
priority1 set priority1 value of the local clock
priority2 set priority2 value of the local clock
ptp change to the (config-ptp) submode
sync-port enable the PTP synchronization port

The related show commands are the following:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 799


CLI Descriptions

— show interface (PTP)

— show ptp alarms-and-events

— show ptp clock

— show ptp clock current-ds

— show ptp clock default-ds

— show ptp clock parent-ds

— show ptp clock settings

— show ptp clock time-properties-ds

— show ptp clock-port

— show ptp config

— show ptp interface

— show ptp peers

— show ptp sync

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

85.1 alarm-enable

Synopsis
[no] alarm-enable [ clockProtectionLost | freeRunningMode |
holdoverEntered | incompatibleHardware | traceabilityLost ]

Description
Use this command to enable a specific alarm or all alarms.

Use the no option to disable a specific alarm or all alarms.

Command Mode
PTP configuration submode — (config-ptp)

800 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: General Configuration

Options

clockProtectionLost
Enables loss of master clock protection alarm.

freeRunningMode
Enables phase free running mode entered alarm.

holdoverEntered Enables phase holdover mode entered alarm.

incompatibleHardware
Enables IEEE1588 incompatible hardware alarm.

traceabilityLost Enables loss of grand master traceability alarm.

Examples
Enabling loss of master clock protection alarm:
ML66(config-ptp)#alarm-enbale clockProtectionLost

85.2 clear ptp clock-port statistics

Synopsis
clear ptp clock-port <NAME> statistics

Description
Use this command to clear the performance counters on the given port.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Operands

NAME The name of the clock port.

Examples
Clearing the performance counters on cp1 port:
ML66#clear ptp clock-port cp1 statistics

85.3 clock

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 801


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
clock {ieee1588v2 | g82651 | g82751} [{ordinary | boundary | transparent}]
[{unicast | multicast}] [{grandmaster | slave-only | bmc}]

Description
Use this command to configure the Precision Time Protocol (PTP) clock.

Command Mode
PTP configuration submode — (config-ptp)

Options

ieee1588v2 Selects IEEE 1588v2 profile.

g82651 Selects G.8265.1 profile.

g82751 Selects G.8275.1 profile.

ordinary Selects ordinary clock.

boundary Selects boundary clock.

transparent Selects transparent clock.

unicast Selects unicast configuration.

multicast Selects multicast configuration.

grandmaster Uses the node as PTP Grandmaster.

slave-only Selects slave-only mode.

bmc Uses best master clock algorithm.

Examples
Configuring PTP clock as boundary clock for IEEE 1588v2:
ML66(config-ptp)#clock ieee1588v2 boundary unicast bmc

85.4 clock-local-priority

802 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: General Configuration

Synopsis
clock-local-priority <PRIORITY>

Description
Use this command to set the clock level local priority value when the clock mode
is set to G.8275.1.

Command Mode
PTP configuration submode — (config-ptp)

Operands

PRIORITY The clock level local priority value. The valid range is 1–
255. The default value is 128.

Examples
Setting the clock level local priority value to 200:
ML66(config-ptp)#clock-local-priority 200

85.5 clock-port

Synopsis
[no] clock-port <NAME>

Description
Use this command to create a new clock port. The command also changes to
(config-clock-port) submode. To use this command, the clock needs to be
configured as an ordinary or a boundary clock.

Use the no option to delete a clock port. Time-stamping remains enabled after
this command is used. Time-stamping can be switched off manually with the no
interface command in ptp submode. Use the no option and omit the clock port
name to list the existing clock ports.

Command Mode
PTP configuration submode — (config-ptp)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 803


CLI Descriptions

Operands

NAME The name of the clock port. The name must be unique.

Examples
Creating a new clock port:
ML66(config-ptp)#clock-port myPort1
ML66(config-clock-port)#

Deleting an existing clock port:


ML66(config-ptp)#no clock-port myPort1

Listing the existing clock ports:


ML66(config-ptp)#no clock-port

85.6 domain

Synopsis
domain <VALUE>

Description
Use this command to configure the Precision Time Protocol (PTP) domain value.

Command Mode
PTP configuration submode — (config-ptp)

Operands

VALUE PTP domain value.

When the clock mode is set to G.8275.1, the valid range is


24–43. The default value is 24.

Examples
Configuring PTP domain value when the clock mode is set to G.8275.1:
ML66(config-ptp)#domain 24

85.7 event-enable

804 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: General Configuration

Synopsis
[no] event-enable [clockSwitch]

Description
Use this command to enable a specific event or all events.

Use the no option to disable a specific event or all events.

Command Mode
PTP configuration submode — (config-ptp)

Options

clockSwitch Enables switch of parent clock event.

Examples
Enabling switch of parent clock event:
ML66(config-ptp)#event-enbale clockSwitch

85.8 holdover-timeout

Synopsis
[no] holdover-timeout <VALUE>

Description
Use this command to set the time/phase holdover timeout value for the clock.

Use the no option to disable the holdover timeout, in this case there is no timeout.

Command Mode
PTP configuration submode — (config-ptp)

Operands

VALUE The holdover timeout value in seconds. The valid range is


0–10000. The default value is 3000 seconds.

If the value expires, the clock leaves the time/phase


holdover state and switches back to free running mode.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 805


CLI Descriptions

If the value is set to 0, the clock never switches to time/


phase holdover state.

Examples
Setting the holdover timeout value to 1000 seconds:
ML66(config-ptp)#holdover-timeout 1000

85.9 interface

Synopsis
[no] interface <RSP> [<linkdelayAsymmetry>]

Description
Use this command to compensate for the link delay asymmetry per physical
interface and switch on time-stamping on the given physical interface.

Use the no option to switch off explicitly the time-stamping on the current
interface. The no option is not allowed when the clock mode is set to boundary
and a clock port is present on the given physical interface.

Command Mode
PTP configuration submode — (config-ptp)

Operands

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port value of the selected interface,
where the format is <Rack/Slot/Port>.

linkdelayAsymmetry
(masterToSlaveDelay − slaveToMasterDelay) ÷ 2 in
nanoseconds.

Examples
Setting 100 ns link delay asymmetry on the 1/1/2 interface:
ML66(config-ptp)#interface 1/1/2 100

Switching on time-stamping on the 1/1/2 interface without setting link delay


asymmetry:
ML66(config-ptp)#interface 1/1/2

Switching off time-stamping on the 1/1/2 interface:

806 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: General Configuration

ML66(config-ptp)#no interface 1/1/2

85.10 link-delay-compensation

Synopsis
link-delay-compensation <NAME> <LINK_DELAY_COMPENSATION>

Description
Use this command to set the link delay on Ethernet LAN interfaces, when
multiple links are grouped (LAG) to provide equal delays on all links within the
group.

Command Mode
PTP configuration submode — (config-ptp)

Operands

NAME Specifies the name of the LAN interface, where the


format is <Rack/Slot/Port>.

LINK_DELAY_COMPENSATION
Specifies the value of the link delay compensation. The
valid range is from −5000 to 5000 ns. The default value is
0. A positive value increases, a negative value decreases
the real link delay.

Examples
Setting 100 ns link delay on 1/6/1 interface, which is a LAN interface:
ML66(config-ptp)#link-delay-compensation 1/6/1 100

85.11 log-clock-servo

Synopsis
log-clock-servo <FREQUENCY> <SECONDS>

Description
Use this command to record the timestamps of the transmitted and received
1588 packets. The recorded samples are available in the local.log.cslog file
generated by the Bug Reporting Tool within the tn_local_logs_*.tgz file. This
file contains the timestamps in a compressed format.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 807


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
PTP configuration submode — (config-ptp)

Operands

FREQUENCY Specifies the frequency of the logging. Every nth sample


is saved. The valid range is 1–1000.

SECONDS Specifies the time duration for the logging in seconds. The
valid range is 0–100000. The value 0 stops the logging.

Examples
Recording the timestamps of the transmitted and received 1588 packets for 100
seconds:
ML66(config-ptp)#log-clock-servo 1 100

85.12 network-synch-assistance

Synopsis
network-synch-assistance {enabled | disabled}

Description
Use this command to enable or disable the use of network synchronization
frequency in Real Time Clock (RTC). Default state is disabled.

Command Mode
PTP configuration submode — (config-ptp)

Options

enabled Enables the use of network synchronization frequency.

disabled Disables the use of network synchronization frequency.

Examples
Enabling the usage of network synchronization frequency:
ML66(config-ptp)#network-synch-assistance enabled

808 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: General Configuration

85.13 priority1

Synopsis
priority1 <PRIORITY>

Description
Use this command to set the Priority1 value of the local clock.

Note: The command is not applicable when the clock mode is set to G.8275.1.

Command Mode
PTP configuration submode — (config-ptp)

Operands

PRIORITY The Priority1 value. The valid range is 0–255.

Examples
Setting Priority1 value:
ML66(config-ptp)#priority1 140

85.14 priority2

Synopsis
priority2 <PRIORITY>

Description
Use this command to set the Priority2 value of the local clock.

Command Mode
PTP configuration submode — (config-ptp)

Operands

PRIORITY The Priority2 value. The valid range is 0–255.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 809


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Setting Priority2 value:
ML66(config-ptp)#priority2 128

85.15 ptp

Synopsis
ptp

Description
Use this command to change to the (config-ptp) submode.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Changing to the (config-ptp) submode:
ML66(config)#ptp
ML66(config-ptp)#

85.16 sync-port

Synopsis
sync-port {enabled | disabled}

Description
Use this command to enable or disable the Precision Time Protocol (PTP)
synchronization port.

Note: When configuring a Packet Slave node using the G.8265.1 Telecom
profile, the sync-port must be enabled.

Command Mode
PTP configuration submode — (config-ptp)

810 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: General Configuration

Options

enabled Enables the PTP synchronization port.

disabled Disables the PTP synchronization port.

Examples
Enabling the PTP synchronization port:
ML66(config-ptp)#sync-port enabled

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 811


CLI Descriptions

86 Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands:


Clock Port Configuration

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
93.

The following command mode is applicable for the synchronization PTP 1588v2
clock port configuration commands:

— Clock Port configuration submode — (config-clock-port)

Table 93 Clock Port Configuration Overview


delay-mechanism configure the delay mechanism for a clock port
dscp configure the Differentiated Services Code Point
(DSCP) field in IP header
enabled enable Precision Time Protocol (PTP) on the
current clock port
inner-tag enable inner VLAN tagging
interface configure destination MAC address
ip-interface select an IP interface to which the current PTP
clock port is connected
local-priority set the clock-port level local priority value when
the clock mode is set to G.8275.1
multicast-configuration change to the (config-multicast) submode
not-slave set the boundary clock as Not Slave
port select the LAN or WAN interface to which the
current PTP port is connected
unicast-configuration change to the (config-unicast) submode
vlan specify the VLAN to which the current clock port
is assigned
vlan-priority configure VLAN priority

The related show command is the following:

— show current

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

812 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: Clock Port Configuration

86.1 delay-mechanism

Synopsis
delay-mechanism {e2e}

Description
Use this command to configure the delay mechanism for a clock port.
Configuration of the delay mechanism is allowed only for boundary clock.

Command Mode
Clock Port configuration submode — (config-clock-port)

Options

e2e Sets delay mechanism to end-to-end.

Examples
Configuring delay mechanism to end-to-end:
ML66(config-clock-port)#delay-mechanism e2e

86.2 dscp

Synopsis
dscp <VALUE>

Description
Use this command to configure the Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP)
field in the IP header. This command is valid only on clock ports connected to an
IP interface.

Command Mode
Clock Port configuration submode — (config-clock-port)

Operands

VALUE Sets DSCP in the IP header. The valid range is 0–63. The
default value is 46.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 813


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Setting the DSCP:
ML66(config-clock-port)#dscp 54

86.3 enabled

Synopsis
[no] enabled

Description
Use this command to enable Precision Time Protocol (PTP) on the current clock
port. The command also enables time-stamping on the underlying physical
interface.

Use the no option to disable PTP on the current clock port, but not time-
stamping. Time-stamping can be switched off manually with the no interface
command in ptp submode.

Command Mode
Clock Port configuration submode — (config-clock-port)

Examples
Enabling PTP:
ML66(config-clock-port)#enabled

86.4 inner-tag

Synopsis

— inner-tag {<VLAN-ID> <PRIORITY> }

— no inner-tag

Description
Use this command to enable inner VLAN tagging and to specify VLAN ID and
customer VLAN priority.

Use the no option to disable inner VLAN tagging.

814 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: Clock Port Configuration

Note: Customer VLAN is only applicable in Provider Bridge mode.

This command is only valid for clock ports connected to L2 interfaces.

Command Mode
Clock Port configuration submode — (config-clock-port)

Operands

VLAN-ID Sets inner tag VLAN ID.

PRIORITY Sets inner tag VLAN priority.

Examples
Enabling customer VLAN tagging:
ML66(config-clock-port)#inner-tag 7 7

86.5 interface

Synopsis
interface ieee8023 {forwardable | non-forwardable}

Description
Use this command to configure the destination MAC address for a clock port
using Ethernet multicast.

Command Mode
Clock Port configuration submode — (config-clock-port)

Options

forwardable Sets the multicast MAC address to forwardable:


01-1B-19-00-00-00.

non-forwardable Sets the multicast MAC address to non-forwardable:


01-80-C2-00-00-0E.

Examples
Configuring a clock port to use non-forwardable MAC:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 815


CLI Descriptions

ML66(config-clock-port)#interface ieee8023 non-forwardable

86.6 ip-interface

Synopsis
ip-interface <RSP_VLAN>

Description
Use this command to select an IP interface to which the current Precision Time
Protocol (PTP) clock port is connected. To execute this command, the clock has to
be configured as boundary.

Omit the parameter to list the existing L3 interfaces.

Command Mode
Clock Port configuration submode — (config-clock-port)

Operands

RSP_VLAN The name of the IP interface, where the format is <Rack/


Slot/Port.VLAN>.

Examples
Connecting the clock port to IP interface 1/6/7.1588:
ML66(config-clock-port)#ip-interface 1/6/7.1588

Listing the existing L3 interfaces:


ML66(config-clock-port)#ip-interface
Timestamping Capable IP Interfaces:
1/6/7.1588

86.7 local-priority

Synopsis
local-priority <PRIORITY>

Description
Use this command to set the clock-port level local priority value when the clock
mode is set to G.8275.1.

816 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: Clock Port Configuration

Command Mode
Clock Port configuration submode — (config-clock-port)

Operands

PRIORITY The clock-port level local priority value. The valid range is
1–255. The default value is 128.

Examples
Setting the clock-port level local priority value to 200:
ML66(config-clock-port)#local-priority 200

86.8 multicast-configuration

Synopsis
multicast-configuration

Description
Use this command to change to the (config-multicast) submode. To use this
command, the clock needs to be configured for multicast.

Note: IPv4 multicast configuration is not supported.

Command Mode
Clock Port configuration submode — (config-clock-port)

Examples
Changing to the (config-multicast) submode:
ML66(config-clock-port)#multicast-configuration
ML66(config-multicast)#

86.9 not-slave

Synopsis
not-slave {true | false}

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 817


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to set the boundary clock as Not Slave.

Command Mode
Clock Port configuration submode — (config-clock-port)

Options

true Sets the boundary clock-port role to master.

false Best Master Clock (BMC) algorithm sets the clock-port


role.

Examples
Setting the boundary clock as Not Slave:
ML66(config-clock-port)#not-slave true

86.10 port

Synopsis
port <RSP>

Description
Use this command to select an L2 LAN or WAN interface to which the current
Precision Time Protocol (PTP) clock port is connected. To execute this command,
the clock has to be configured as boundary.

Omit the parameter to list the existing L2 interfaces capable of time-stamping.

Command Mode
Clock Port configuration submode — (config-clock-port)

Operands

RSP The name of the L2 LAN or WAN interface, where the


format is <Rack/Slot/Port>.

Examples
Connecting the clock port to interface LAN 1/6/4:
ML66(config-clock-port)#port 1/6/4

818 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: Clock Port Configuration

Listing the existing L2 interfaces capable of time-stamping:


ML66(config-clock-port)#port
Timestamping Capable LAN and WAN Interfaces:
1/6/4
1/6/5

86.11 unicast-configuration

Synopsis
unicast-configuration

Description
Use this command to change to the (config-unicast) submode. To use this
command, the clock needs to be configured for unicast.

Command Mode
Clock Port configuration submode — (config-clock-port)

Examples
Changing to the (config-unicast) submode:
ML66(config-clock-port)#unicast-configuration
ML66(config-unicast)#

86.12 vlan

Synopsis
[no] vlan <VLAN>

Description
Use this command to specify the VLAN to which the current clock port is
assigned.

This command is only valid for clock ports connected to L2 interfaces.

The no option is available only when the clock mode is set to G.8275.1. Use the
no option to remove the VLAN.

Command Mode
Clock Port configuration submode — (config-clock-port)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 819


CLI Descriptions

Operands

VLAN Number of the VLAN.

Examples
Configuring VLAN:
ML66(config-clock-port)#vlan 7

86.13 vlan-priority

Synopsis
vlan-priority <PRIORITY>

Description
Use this command to configure VLAN priority. This command is only valid for
clock ports connected to L2 interfaces.

Command Mode
Clock Port configuration submode — (config-clock-port)

Operands

PRIORITY The VLAN priority. The valid range is from 0 to 7.

Examples
Configuring VLAN priority:
ML66(config-clock-port)#vlan-priority 7

820 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: Unicast and Multicast Configuration

87 Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands:


Unicast and Multicast Configuration

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
94.

The following command modes are applicable for the synchronization PTP
1588v2 unicast and multicast configuration commands:

— Unicast configuration submode — (config-unicast)

— Multicast configuration submode — (config-multicast)

Table 94 Unicast and Multicast Configuration Overview


announce-interval specify the requested mean time interval between
successive Announce messages
announce-timeout specify the number of announce-intervals that
have to pass without receipt of an Announce
message
delay-resp-interval specify the requested mean time interval between
successive Delay Response messages
delay-resp-timeout specify the number of delay response intervals
that have to pass without receipt of a Delay
Response message
duration configure the requested number of seconds for
which the requested messages are transmitted
min-delay-req-interval set minimum delay request transmission interval
query-interval configure the mean interval in seconds between
requests from a node, for example, for a unicast
Announce message
sync-interval specify the requested mean time interval between
successive Sync messages
sync-timeout specify the number of synchronization intervals
that have to pass without receipt of a Sync
message
unicast-master create a new master
wait-to-restore-time configure the time for which a disqualified master
has to operate adequately after a fault before it is
considered again

The related show command is the following:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 821


CLI Descriptions

— show current

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

87.1 announce-interval

Synopsis
announce-interval <VALUE>

Description
Use this command to specify the requested mean time interval between
successive Announce messages from the unicast master.

Note: In the (config-multicast) submode, the value of the interval is always −3


when the clock mode is set to G.8275.1.

Command Mode
Unicast configuration submode — (config-unicast)

Multicast configuration submode — (config-multicast)

Operands

VALUE The logarithm to base 2 of the requested mean period


between messages, in seconds. The valid range is from −3
to 4. The default value is 1.

— 4 at every 16 seconds

— 3 at every 8 seconds

— 2 at every 4 seconds

— 1 at 0.5 Hz, that is, at every 2 seconds

— 0 at 1 Hz

— −1 at 2 Hz

— −2 at 4 Hz

— −3 at 8 Hz

822 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: Unicast and Multicast Configuration

Examples
Specifying the requested mean time interval:
ML66(config-unicast)#announce-interval 0

87.2 announce-timeout

Synopsis
announce-timeout <VALUE>

Description
Use this command to specify the number of announce-intervals that have to pass
without receipt of an Announce message before a timeout event is generated.

Command Mode
Unicast configuration submode — (config-unicast)

Multicast configuration submode — (config-multicast)

Operands

VALUE Number of announce-intervals. The valid range is from 2


to 10. The default value is 3.

Examples
Specifying the number of announce-intervals:
ML66(config-multicast)#announce-timeout 5

87.3 delay-resp-interval

Synopsis
delay-resp-interval <VALUE>

Description
Use this command to specify the requested mean time interval between
successive Delay Response messages from a unicast master.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 823


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Unicast configuration submode — (config-unicast)

Operands

VALUE The logarithm to base 2 of the requested mean period


between messages, in seconds. The valid range is from −6
to 6. The default value is 0.

— 6 at every 64 seconds

— 5 at every 32 seconds

— 4 at every 16 seconds

— 3 at every 8 seconds

— 2 at every 4 seconds

— 1 at 0.5 Hz, that is, at every 2 seconds

— 0 at 1 Hz

— −1 at 2 Hz

— −2 at 4 Hz

— −3 at 8 Hz

— −4 at 16 Hz

— −5 at 32 Hz

— −6 at 64 Hz

Examples
Specifying the requested mean time interval:
ML66(config-unicast)#delay-resp-interval 0

87.4 delay-resp-timeout

Synopsis
delay-resp-timeout <VALUE>

824 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: Unicast and Multicast Configuration

Description
Use this command to specify the number of delay response intervals that have to
pass without receipt of a Delay Response message before a timeout event is
generated.

Command Mode
Unicast configuration submode — (config-unicast)

Operands

VALUE Number of Delay Response intervals. The valid range is


from 2 to 64. The default value is 3.

Examples
Specifying the number of delay response intervals:
ML66(config-unicast)#delay-resp-timeout 16

87.5 duration

Synopsis
duration <VALUE>

Description
Use this command to configure the requested number of seconds for which the
requested messages are transmitted.

Command Mode
Unicast configuration submode — (config-unicast)

Operands

VALUE The requested number of seconds. The valid range is 10–


1000 seconds. Default value is 300 seconds.

Examples
Configuring the requested number of seconds:
ML66(config-unicast)#duration 300

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 825


CLI Descriptions

87.6 min-delay-req-interval

Synopsis
min-delay-req-interval <VALUE>

Description
Use this command to set the minimum delay request transmission interval.

Note: The value of the interval is always −4 when the clock mode is set to
G.8275.1.

Command Mode
Multicast configuration submode — (config-multicast)

Operands

VALUE The value of the interval. The valid range is between 5


and −6, but never more frequent than the rate of the Sync
messages. It is recommended to use the same rate as for
the Sync messages.

— 5 at every 32 seconds

— 4 at every 16 seconds

— 3 at every 8 seconds

— 2 at every 4 seconds

— 1 at every 0.5 Hz, that is, at every 2 seconds

— 0 at 1 Hz

— −1 at 2 Hz

— −2 at 4 Hz

— −3 at 8 Hz

— −4 at 16 Hz

— −5 at 32 Hz

— −6 at 64 Hz

826 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: Unicast and Multicast Configuration

Examples
Setting the minimum delay request transmission interval at 1 Hz:
ML66(config-multicast)#min-delay-req-interval 0

87.7 query-interval

Synopsis
query-interval <VALUE>

Description
Use this command to configure the mean interval in seconds between requests
from a node, for example, for a unicast Announce message.

Command Mode
Unicast configuration submode — (config-unicast)

Operands

VALUE The logarithm to base 2 of the interval in seconds. The


valid range is from 0 to 7.

— 7 at every 128 seconds

— 6 at every 64 seconds

— 5 at every 32 seconds

— 4 at every 16 seconds

— 3 at every 8 seconds

— 2 at every 4 seconds

— 1 at every 2 seconds

— 0 at every second

Examples
Configuring the mean interval:
ML66(config-unicast)#query-interval 0

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 827


CLI Descriptions

87.8 sync-interval

Synopsis
sync-interval <VALUE>

Description
Use this command to specify the requested mean time interval between
successive Sync messages from a unicast master.

Note: In the (config-multicast) submode, the value of the interval is always −4


when the clock mode is set to G.8275.1.

Command Mode
Unicast configuration submode — (config-unicast)

Multicast configuration submode — (config-multicast)

Operands

VALUE The logarithm to base 2 of the requested mean period in


seconds. The valid range is from −6 to −3.

— −3 at 8 Hz

— −4 at 16 Hz

— −5 at 32 Hz

— −6 at 64 Hz

Examples
Specifying the requested mean time interval:
ML66(config-unicast)#sync-interval 0

87.9 sync-timeout

Synopsis
sync-timeout <VALUE>

828 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: Unicast and Multicast Configuration

Description
Use this command to specify the number of synchronization intervals that have
to pass without receipt of a Sync message before a timeout event is generated.

Command Mode
Unicast configuration submode — (config-unicast)

Operands

VALUE Number of sync intervals. The valid range is from 2 to 64.


The default value is 3.

Examples
Specifying the number of synchronization intervals:
ML66(config-unicast)#sync-timeout 16

87.10 unicast-master

Synopsis
[no] unicast-master <NAME>

Description
Use this command to create a new master. The command also changes to the
(config-unicast-master) submode.

Use the no option to delete an existing master.

Command Mode
Unicast configuration submode — (config-unicast)

Operands

NAME Name of the new master. The name must be unique.

Examples
Creating a new master:
ML66(config-unicast)#unicast-master myMaster1
ML66(config-unicast-master)#

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 829


CLI Descriptions

87.11 wait-to-restore-time

Synopsis
wait-to-restore-time <VALUE>

Description
Use this command to configure the time for which a disqualified master has to
operate adequately after a fault before it is considered again.

Command Mode
Unicast configuration submode — (config-unicast)

Operands

VALUE The time, in minutes, to wait before using a disqualified


master again. The valid range is from 0 to 12. The default
value is 5.

Examples
Waiting 5 minutes before using a disqualified master again:
ML66(config-unicast)#wait-to-restore-time 5

830 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: Unicast Master Configuration

88 Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands:


Unicast Master Configuration

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
95.

The following command mode is applicable for the synchronization PTP 1588v2
unicast master configuration commands:

— Unicast Master configuration submode — (config-unicast-master)

Table 95 Unicast Master Configuration Overview


address configure the address of the unicast
master candidate
enabled enable the current unicast master
local-priority configure the master priority

The related show command is the following:

— show current

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

88.1 address

Synopsis
address {ieee8023 <MAC-ADDRESS> | udpipv4 <IP-ADDRESS>}

Description
Use this command to configure the address of the unicast master candidate.

Command Mode
Unicast Master configuration submode — (config-unicast-master)

Operands

MAC-ADDRESS Media Access Control (MAC) address in


<AA:BB:CC:DD:EE:FF> format. Need to be configured
when the communication protocol is set to IEEE 802.3.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 831


CLI Descriptions

IP-ADDRESS IP adress in <A.B.C.D> format. This parameter needs to


be configured when the communication protocol is set to
UDP over IPv4.

Options

ieee8023 Sets the communication protocol to IEEE 802.3.

udpipv4 Sets the unicast master communication protocol to UDP


over IPV4. This option is only valid if the clock port is
connected to an IP interface.

Examples
Configuring the MAC address of the unicast master candidate:
ML66(config-unicast-master)#address ieee8023 ac:60:b6:99:a5:8d

Configuring the IP address of the unicast master candidate:


ML66(config-unicast-master)#address udpipv4 192.168.0.2

88.2 enabled

Synopsis
[no] enabled

Description
Use this command to enable the current unicast master.

Use the no option to disable the current unicast master.

Command Mode
Unicast Master configuration submode — (config-unicast-master)

Examples
Enabling the current unicast master:
ML66(config-unicast-master)#enabled

88.3 local-priority

832 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: Unicast Master Configuration

Synopsis
local-priority <VALUE>

Descriptions
Use this command to configure the master priority.

Command Mode
Unicast Master configuration submode — (config-unicast-master)

Operands

VALUE The master priority value. The valid range is 1–16.


Default value is 8.

Examples
Configuring master priority:
ML66(config-unicast-master)#local-priority 16

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 833


CLI Descriptions

89 Ethernet Service OAM Commands: General


Configuration

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
96.

The following command mode is applicable for the Ethernet Service Operation,
Administration, and Maintenance (SOAM) general configuration commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

Table 96 General Configuration Overview


cfm configure Ethernet Service Operation,
Administration, and Maintenance
(OAM)
soam logmask set Ethernet Service OAM logmask

89.1 cfm

Synopsis
cfm

Description
Use this command to change to the (cfm) submode for Ethernet Service
Operation, Administration, and Maintenance (OAM) configuration.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Configuring Ethernet Service OAM:
ML66(config)#cfm
ML66(cfm)#

89.2 soam logmask

834 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Service OAM Commands: General Configuration

Synopsis
soam logmask <MASK>

Description
Use this command to set Ethernet Service Operation, Administration, and
Maintenance (OAM) log mask.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

MASK The log mask value.

Examples
Setting Ethernet Service OAM log mask:
ML66(config)#soam logmask 135

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 835


CLI Descriptions

90 Ethernet Service OAM Commands:


Maintenance Domain Configuration

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
97.

The following command mode is applicable for the Ethernet Service Operation,
Administration, and Maintenance (SOAM) Maintenance Domain (MD)
configuration commands:

— Ethernet Service OAM submode — (cfm)

Table 97 Maintenance Domain Configuration Overview


md set Maintenance Domain (MD) name
format type

The related show commands are the following:

— show cfm md

— show config

— show status

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

90.1 md

Synopsis

— md { string <NAME> <LEVEL> | none <LEVEL> }

— no md { string <NAME> | none <LEVEL> }

Description
Use this command to set the Maintenance Domain (MD) name format type. The
command also changes to the (cfm-md) submode.

Use the no option to delete an MD.

836 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Maintenance Domain Configuration

Command Mode
Ethernet Service OAM submode — (cfm)

Operands

LEVEL The level of the MD. The valid range is 0–7.

NAME The name of the MD.

Options

none Sets the domain name format type to none.

string Sets the domain name format type to string.

Examples
Setting the MD name format type to string:

Note: The system automatically generates an index number at the end of the
line.

ML66(cfm)#md string PB 3 1
ML66(cfm-md)#

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 837


CLI Descriptions

91 Ethernet Service OAM Commands:


Maintenance Association Configuration

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
98.

The following command modes are applicable for the Ethernet Service
Operation, Administration, and Maintenance (SOAM) Maintenance Association
(MA) configuration commands:

— Ethernet Service OAM MD submode — (cfm-md)

— Ethernet Service OAM MD MA submode — (cfm-md-ma)

Table 98 Maintenance Association Configuration Overview


interface-tlv-enable enable the inclusion of the Interface
Status TLV in transmitted CCM frames
ma configure a Maintenance Association
(MA)
port-tlv-enable enable the inclusion of the Port Status
TLV in transmitted CCM frames

The related show commands are the following:

— show cfm ma

— show config

— show status

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

91.1 interface-tlv-enable

Synopsis
[no] interface-tlv-enable

Description
Use this command to enable the inclusion of the Interface Status Type Length
Value (TLV) in transmitted Continuity Check Message (CCM) frames.

838 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Maintenance Association Configuration

Use the no option to disable the inclusion of the Interface Status TLV in
transmitted CCM frames.

Command Mode
Ethernet Service OAM MD MA submode — (cfm-md-ma)

Examples
Enabling the inclusion of the Interface Status TLV in transmitted CCM frames:
ML66(cfm-md-ma)#interface-tlv-enable

91.2 ma

Synopsis

— ma { string | icc } <NAME> <INTERVAL> <VLANTYPE> <VLANID>


<PORTSTATUS> <INTERFACESTATUS>

— no ma { string | icc } <NAME>

Description
Use this command to configure a Maintenance Association (MA). The command
also changes to the (cfm-md-ma) submode.

Use the no option to delete an MA.

Command Mode
Ethernet Service OAM MD submode — (cfm-md)

Operands

INTERFACESTATUS
The interface status Type Length Value (TLV).

— 0 — Do not send interface status TLV.

— 1 — Send interface status TLV.

INTERVAL The length of the interval.

— 4 — Sets the interval to 1 second.

— 5 — Sets the interval to 10 seconds.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 839


CLI Descriptions

— 6 — Sets the interval to 1 minute.

— 7 — Sets the interval to 10 minutes.

NAME The name of the MA.

PORTSTATUS The port status TLV.

— 0 — Do not send port status TLV.

— 1 — Send port status TLV.

VLANID The VLAN ID of the MA.

— 0 — No VLAN.

— 1–4094 — The valid range of the VLAN ID.

VLANTYPE The type of the VLAN.

— 0 — No VLAN.

— 1 — Sets the MA VLAN type to C-VID.

— 2 — Sets the MA VLAN type to S-VID.

Options

icc Sets the format of the MA to ITU Carrier Code (ICC).

string Sets the format of the MA to string.

Examples
Configuring an MA:

Note: The system automatically generates an index number at the end of the
line.

ML66(cfm-md)#ma string Blue 5 2 200 1 1 1


ML66(cfm-md-ma)#

91.3 port-tlv-enable

Synopsis
[no] port-tlv-enable

840 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Maintenance Association Configuration

Description
Use this command to enable the inclusion of the Port Status Type Length Value
(TLV) in transmitted Continuity Check Message (CCM) frames.

Use the no option to disable the inclusion of the Port Status TLV in transmitted
CCM frames.

Command Mode
Ethernet Service OAM MD MA submode — (cfm-md-ma)

Examples
Enabling the inclusion of the Port Status TLV in transmitted CCM frames:
ML66(cfm-md-ma)#port-tlv-enable

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 841


CLI Descriptions

92 Ethernet Service OAM Commands:


Maintenance End Point and Maintenance
Intermediate Point Configuration

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
99.

The following command mode is applicable for the Ethernet Service Operation,
Administration, and Maintenance (SOAM) Maintenance End Point (MEP) and
Maintenance Intermediate Point (MIP) configuration commands:

— Ethernet Service OAM MD MA submode — (cfm-md-ma)

Table 99 Maintenance End Point and Maintenance Intermediate Point


Configuration Overview
alarm enable Connectivity Fault
Management (CFM) and Performance
Monitoring (PM) alarms
mep configure a Maintenance End Point
(MEP)
mep-list add a remote MEP
mip configure a Maintenance Intermediate
Point (MIP)

The related show commands are the following:

— show cfm alarms

— show cfm mep

— show cfm mep-peer

— show cfm mip

— show config

— show status

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

92.1 alarm

842 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Maintenance End Point and Maintenance Intermediate Point Configuration

Synopsis

— alarm { cfm <TYPE> | pm }

— no alarm { cfm | pm }

Description
Use this command to enable Connectivity Fault Management (CFM) and PM
alarms.

Use the no option to disable CFM and PM alarms.

Command Mode
Ethernet Service OAM MD MA submode — (cfm-md-ma)

Operands

TYPE Specifies the CFM alarm type.

— 0 — Enables 802.1 alarms.

— 1 — Enables Y.1731 alarms.

Options

cfm Enables CFM alarm.

pm Enables PM alarm.

Examples
Enabling 802.1 CFM alarms:
ML66(cfm-md-ma)#alarm cfm 0

92.2 mep

Synopsis

— mep <MEPID> {down | up} <PRIMARYVID> <PRIORITY> <CCMENABLE>


{port <RSP> | lag <LAGID>}

— no mep <MEPID>

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 843


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to configure a Maintenance End Point (MEP). The command
also changes to the (cfm-md-ma-mep) submode.

Use the no option to delete a MEP.

Command Mode
Ethernet Service OAM MD MA submode — (cfm-md-ma)

Operands

CCMENABLE Enables or disables the Continuity Check Message (CCM).

— 0 — Disables CCM.

— 1 — Enables CCM.

LAGID The Link Aggregation Group (LAG) ID in <Rack/Slot/


Port> format.

MEPID The MEP ID.

RSP The Rack, Slot, Port value of the port where the format is
<Rack/Slot/Port>.

PRIMARYVID The primary VLAN ID.

PRIORITY The Protocol Data Unit (PDU) priority. The valid range is
0–7.

Options

down Specifies the MEP direction to down.

lag Configures MEP on a LAG.

port Configures MEP on a LAN or WAN port.

up Specifies the MEP direction to up.

Examples
Configuring a MEP:
ML66(cmf-md-ma)#mep 61 up 200 7 1 port 1/6/5

844 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Maintenance End Point and Maintenance Intermediate Point Configuration

92.3 mep-list

Synopsis
[no] mep-list <MEPID>

Description
Use this command to add a remote MEP.

Use the no option to remove a remote MEP.

Command Mode
Ethernet Service OAM MD MA submode — (cfm-md-ma)

Operands

MEPID Specifies the remote MEP ID.

Examples
Adding a remote MEP:
ML66(cfm-md-ma)#mep-list 61

92.4 mip

Synopsis
[no] mip {port <RSP> | lag <LAGID>}

Description
Use this command to add a Maintenance Intermediate Point (MIP).

Use the no option to delete a MIP.

Command Mode
Ethernet Service OAM MD MA submode — (cfm-md-ma)

Operands

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port value of the MIP port where the
format is <Rack/Slot/Port>.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 845


CLI Descriptions

LAGID The Link Aggregation Group (LAG) ID in <Rack/Slot/


Port> format.

Options

port Configures MIP on a LAN or WAN port.

lag Configures MIP on a LAG.

Examples
Adding a MIP:
ML66(cfm-md-ma)#mip port 1/6/5

846 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Linktrace and Loopback Configuration

93 Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Linktrace


and Loopback Configuration

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
100.

The following command mode is applicable for the Ethernet Service Operation,
Administration, and Maintenance (SOAM) linktrace and loopback configuration
commands:

— Ethernet Service OAM MD MA MEP submode — (cfm-md-ma-mep)

Table 100 Linktrace and Loopback Configuration Overview


ccm-enable enable Continuity Check Message
(CCM)
ccm-state-update-enable enable link status change triggers on
the Maintenance End Point (MEP)
interface in case of CCM failures
linktrace start linktrace
loopback start loopback
pm configure a PM session

The related show commands are the following:

— show config

— show linktrace

— show loopback

— show status

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

93.1 ccm-enable

Synopsis
[no] ccm-enable

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 847


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to enable Continuity Check Message (CCM).

Use the no option to disable CCM.

Command Mode
Ethernet Service OAM MD MA MEP submode — (cfm-md-ma-mep)

Examples
Enabling CCM:
ML66(cfm-md-ma-mep)#ccm-enable

93.2 ccm-state-update-enable

Synopsis
[no] ccm-state-update-enable

Description
Use this command to enable link status change triggers on the Maintenance End
Point (MEP) interface in case of Continuity Check Message (CCM) failures.

In case of Remote Defect Indication (RDI) or Loss of Continuity (LOC) defects,


the MEP interface link status is set to DOWN. Occasionally, this can trigger
switchovers in the following features:

— Ethernet Ring Protection (ERP)

— L1 Bonding

Use the no option to disable updates. If the MEP is removed or the status update
is disabled, the link status is reset to UP.

Command Mode
Ethernet Service OAM MD MA MEP submode — (cfm-md-ma-mep)

Examples
Enabling CCM state updates:
ML66(cfm-md-ma-mep)#ccm-state-update-enable

848 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Linktrace and Loopback Configuration

93.3 linktrace

Synopsis
linktrace <TTL> <USEFDBONLY> { <TARGETMEPID> | <MACADDRESS> }

Description
Use this command to start a linktrace.

Command Mode
Ethernet Service OAM MD MA MEP submode — (cfm-md-ma-mep)

Operands

MACADDRESS The Media Access Control (MAC) address of the


traceroute target in <AA:BB:CC:DD:EE:FF> format.

TARGETMEPID The Maintenance End Point (MEP) ID of the traceroute


target. The valid range is 1–8191.

TTL Time To Live (TTL) value in the traceroute. The valid


range is 1–255.

USEFDBONLY Selects which database is used by intermediate bridges to


forward the Linktrace Message (LTM) frame.

— 0 — Uses the MIP Continuity Check Message (CCM)


database.

— 1 — Uses the Forwarding Database.

Examples
Starting a linktrace:
ML66(cfm-md-ma-mep)#linktrace 64 1 3

93.4 loopback

Synopsis
loopback <LBM> <INTERVAL> <DATATLVLENGTH> <DATAPATTERN>
<TIMEOUT> <PRIORITY> <DROP> { <DESTMEPID> | <MACADDRESS> }

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 849


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to start a loopback.

Command Mode
Ethernet Service OAM MD MA MEP submode — (cfm-md-ma-mep)

Operands

DATAPATTERN The content of the data Type Length Value (TLV) of the
ping packet. The maximum length of the string is 32
characters.

DATATLVLENGTH
The length of the data TLV in bytes. The valid range is 0–
9186.

DESTMEPID The target MEP ID of the ping packet. The valid range is
0–8191.

DROP The Drop Eligibility Indicator Bit. The value is 0 if the


Loopback Message (LBM) cannot be dropped. The value
is 1 if the LBM can be dropped.

INTERVAL The PDU interval in milliseconds. The valid range is


1000–60000 with a granularity of 100.

LBM The number of Loopback Messages (LBMs) to be sent.


The valid range is 1–1024.

MACADDRESS The target MAC address of the ping packet in


<AA:BB:CC:DD:EE:FF> format.

PRIORITY The PDU priority value. The valid range is 0–7.

TIMEOUT Timeout in milliseconds. The valid range is 100–10000.

Examples
Starting a loopback:
ML66(cfm-md-ma-mep)#loopback 10 1000 1024 testpattern 100 7 0 62

93.5 pm

850 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Linktrace and Loopback Configuration

Synopsis

— pm <SESSIONID> <CONFINT> <DMMCOSPRIO> { <DESTMEPID> |


<MACADDRESS> }

— no pm

Description
Use this command to set a PM session. The command also changes to the (cfm-
md-ma-mep-pm) submode.

Use the no option to remove a PM session.

Command Mode
Ethernet Service OAM MD MA MEP submode — (cfm-md-ma-mep)

Operands

CONFINT The confident interval in percent. The valid range is 1–


100.

DESTMEPID The destination MEP ID.

DMMCOSPRIO The Delay Measurement Message (DMM) CoS priority.


The valid range is 0–7.

MACADDRESS The MAC address in <AA:BB:CC:DD:EE:FF> format.

SESSIONID The session ID. The valid range is 1–128.

Examples
Setting a PM session:
ML66(cfm-md-ma-mep)#pm 1 10 2 186

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 851


CLI Descriptions

94 Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Ethernet


Bandwidth Notification

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
101.

The following command modes are applicable for Ethernet Bandwidth


Notification (ETH-BN) commands:

— Ethernet Service OAM MD MA MEP submode — (cfm-md-ma-mep)

— Ethernet Bandwidth Notification submode — (bnm)

— Send Options submode — (send-options)

Table 101 Ethernet Bandwidth Notification Overview


bandwidth-notification change to the (bnm) submode to
configure Ethernet Bandwidth
Notification (ETH-BN)
enable enable a Bandwidth Notification
Message (BNM) instance on the
Maintenance End Point (MEP) for the
configured interface
failed-link-message send one BNM once the link fails and
the hold-timer expires
format set the L2 frame format of the
Ethernet Bandwidth Notification
full-link-speed-message send one more BNM once the link
speed is restored
hold-time set the timeout between the
degradation time and sending BNM
with the updated bandwidth
interface configure an interface to be monitored
for the bandwidth changes
interval set the interval between BNM frames
level set the Maintenance Entity Group
(MEG) level on which immediate
Maintenance Intermediate Points
(MIPs) and MEPs interact with the
BNM
port-id set the port ID and make the interface
unique

852 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Ethernet Bandwidth Notification

priority set the priority of the Ethernet frame


send-frequently-after-hold-time send BNM more frequently once the
hold-timer expires
send-options configure when to send and not send
BNMs

The related show commands are the following:

— show bandwidth-notification

— show bandwidth-notification brief

— show current

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

94.1 bandwidth-notification

Synopsis
bandwidth-notification

Description
Use this command to change to the (bnm) submode to configure Ethernet
Bandwidth Notification (ETH-BN).

Command Mode
Ethernet Service OAM MD MA MEP submode — (cfm-md-ma-mep)

Examples
Changing to the (bnm) submode:
ML66(cfm-md-ma-mep)#bandwidth-notification
ML66(bnm)#

94.2 enable

Synopsis
[no] enable

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 853


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to enable a Bandwidth Notification Message (BNM) instance
on the Maintenance End Point (MEP) for the configured interface.

Use the no option to disable a BNM instance on the MEP for the configured
interface.

Command Mode
Ethernet Bandwidth Notification submode — (bnm)

Examples
Enabling a BNM instance on the MEP:
ML66(bnm)#enable

94.3 failed-link-message

Synopsis
[no] failed-link-message [always]

Description
Use this command to send one Bandwidth Notification Message (BNM) once the
link fails and the hold-timer expires.

Use the no option to not send BNM when the link is down.

Command Mode
Send Options submode — (send-options)

Options

always Sends BNM frames periodically when the link is down.

Examples
Sending BNM frames periodically when the link is down:
ML66(send-options)#failed-link-message always

94.4 format

854 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Ethernet Bandwidth Notification

Synopsis
format {itu-t | cisco}

Description
Use this command to set the L2 frame format of the Ethernet Bandwidth
Notification (ETH-BN).

Command Mode
Ethernet Bandwidth Notification submode — (bnm)

Options

itu-t Sets the frame format to ITU-T. This is the default value.

cisco Sets the frame format to Cisco.

Examples
Setting the L2 frame format of the ETH-BN to ITU-T:
ML66(bnm)#format itu-t

94.5 full-link-speed-message

Synopsis
[no] full-link-speed-message [always]

Description
Use this command to send one more Bandwidth Notification Message (BNM)
once the link speed is restored.

Use the no option to not send BNM when the link speed is restored.

Command Mode
Send Options submode — (send-options)

Options

always Always sends BNM when the link is at full speed.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 855


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Always sending BNM when the link is at full speed:
ML66(send-options)#full-link-speed-message always

94.6 hold-time

Synopsis
hold-time <HOLD-TIME>

Description
Use this command to set the timeout between the degradation time and sending
Bandwidth Notification Message (BNM) with the updated bandwidth.

Command Mode
Ethernet Bandwidth Notification submode — (bnm)

Operands

HOLD-TIME The timeout value in seconds. The valid range is 0–10.

Examples
Setting the timeout value to 2 seconds:
ML66(bnm)#hold-time 2

94.7 interface

Synopsis
[no] interface <RSP>

Description
Use this command to configure an interface to be monitored for the bandwidth
changes.

Use the no option to reset the Bandwidth Notification Message (BNM) interface.

Command Mode
Ethernet Bandwidth Notification submode — (bnm)

856 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Ethernet Bandwidth Notification

Operands

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port value of the interface where the
format is <Rack/Slot/Port>.

Examples
Configuring an interface to be monitored for the bandwidth changes:
ML66(bnm)#interface 1/6/5

94.8 interval

Synopsis
interval <INTERVAL>

Description
Use this command to set the interval between Bandwidth Notification Message
(BNM) frames.

Command Mode
Ethernet Bandwidth Notification submode — (bnm)

Operands

INTERVAL The interval between BNM frames in seconds. The valid


values are the following:

— 1s

— 10s

— 1min

Examples
Setting the interval between BNM frames to 10 seconds:
ML66(bnm)#interval 10s

94.9 level

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 857


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
level <LEVEL>

Description
Use this command to set the Maintenance Entity Group (MEG) level on which
immediate Maintenance Intermediate Points (MIPs) and Maintenance End
Points (MEPs) interact with the Bandwidth Notification Message (BNM).

Command Mode
Ethernet Bandwidth Notification submode — (bnm)

Operands

LEVEL The MEG level. The valid range is 1–7.

Examples
Setting the MEG level to 2:
ML66(bnm)#level 2

94.10 port-id

Synopsis
port-id <PORTID>

Description
Use this command to set the port ID and make the interface unique when more
Bandwidth Notification Message (BNM) instances exist in the network.

Command Mode
Ethernet Bandwidth Notification submode — (bnm)

Operands

PORTID A 32 bit length unique identifier.

Examples
Setting the port ID to 1234567890:

858 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Ethernet Bandwidth Notification

ML66(bnm)#port-id 1234567890

94.11 priority

Synopsis
priority <PRIORITY>

Description
Use this command to set the priority of the Ethernet frame.

Command Mode
Ethernet Bandwidth Notification submode — (bnm)

Operands

PRIORITY The priority of the Ethernet frame. The valid range is 0–7.

Examples
Setting the priority of the Ethernet frame to 7:
ML66(bnm)#priority 7

94.12 send-frequently-after-hold-time

Synopsis
[no] send-frequently-after-hold-time

Description
Use this command to send Bandwidth Notification Message (BNM) more
frequently once the hold-timer expires.

Use the no option to send BNM at the default frequency when the hold-timer
expires.

Command Mode
Send Options submode — (send-options)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 859


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Sending BNM more frequently once the hold-timer expires:
ML66(send-options)#send-frequently-after-hold-time

94.13 send-options

Synopsis
send-options

Description
Use this command to configure when to send and not send Bandwidth
Notification Messages (BNMs). The command also changes to the (send-options)
submode.

Command Mode
Ethernet Bandwidth Notification submode — (bnm)

Examples
Changing to the (send-options) submode to configure when to send BNMs:
ML66(bnm)#send-options
ML66(send-options)#

860 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Session Configuration

95 Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Session


Configuration

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
102.

The following command mode is applicable for the Ethernet Service Operation,
Administration, and Maintenance (SOAM) session configuration commands:

— Ethernet Service OAM MD MA MEP PM submode — (cfm-md-ma-mep-pm)

Table 102 Session Configuration Overview


dm start a Delay Measurement (DM)
session

The related show command is the following:

— show dm

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

95.1 dm

Synopsis

— dm <INTERVAL> <DELAYPERCENTILE> <DELAYVARIARTION>


<DELAYTHRESHOLD> <DELAYVARTHRESHOLD>

— no dm

Description
Use this command to start a Delay Measurement (DM) session.

Use the no option to terminate a DM session.

Command Mode
Ethernet Service OAM MD MA MEP PM submode — (cfm-md-ma-mep-pm)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 861


CLI Descriptions

Operands

DELAYPERCENTILE
The percentile of the frame delay performance. The valid
range is 1–100.

DELAYTHRESHOLD
The delay threshold value in milliseconds. The valid range
is 1–10000.

DELAYVARTHRESHOLD
The delay variation threshold value in milliseconds. The
valid range is 1–10000.

DELAYVARIATION
The variation percentile of the frame delay performance.
The valid range is 1–100.

INTERVAL The Delay Measurement Message (DMM) interval in


seconds. Only the values 1 and 10 are supported.

Examples
Starting a DM session:
ML66(cfm-md-ma-mep-pm)#dm 1 90 90 100 100

862 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IGMP and MLD Snooping Commands

96 IGMP and MLD Snooping Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
103, Table 104, and Table 105.

The following command modes are applicable for the Internet Group
Management Protocol (IGMP) and Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD) snooping
commands:

— Privileged Exec mode — #

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— IGMP Snooping VLAN configuration submode — (config-igmp-snooping-


vlan)

— MLD Snooping VLAN configuration submode — (config-mld-snooping-


vlan)

Table 103 IGMP Snooping Commands Overview


clear snooping counters reset the counters to 0
igmp snooping config-clear delete all Internet Group Management
Protocol (IGMP) snooping
configuration on the NE
igmp snooping enable enable IGMP snooping on the NE
igmp snooping vlan enable IGMP snooping on a VLAN
mfib alarm-enable enable the IP Multicast Forwarding
Table Full alarm

Table 104 MLD Snooping Commands Overview


clear snooping counters reset the counters to 0
mld snooping config-clear delete all Multicast Listener Discovery
(MLD) snooping configuration on the
NE
mld snooping enable enable MLD snooping on the NE
mld snooping vlan enable MLD snooping on a VLAN
mfib alarm-enable enable the IP Multicast Forwarding
Table Full alarm

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 863


CLI Descriptions

Table 105 VLAN-level IGMP and MLD Snooping Commands Overview


immediate-leave enable immediate leave on the selected
ports
proxy-reporting enable proxy reporting
query-interval set the query interval of the IGMPv2
(IPv4), respectively MLDv1 (IPv6)
querier routers
robust set the robustness value of the IGMPv2
(IPv4), respectively MLDv1 (IPv6)
querier routers

The related show commands are the following:

— show igmp snooping

— show igmp snooping config

— show igmp snooping group

— show igmp snooping mrouter

— show igmp snooping vlan

— show mfib status

— show mld snooping

— show mld snooping config

— show mld snooping group

— show mld snooping mrouter

— show mld snooping vlan

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

96.1 clear snooping counters

Synopsis
clear snooping counters

864 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IGMP and MLD Snooping Commands

Description
Use this command to reset the counters, displayed by show igmp snooping
vlan and show mld snooping vlan commands, to 0.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Examples
Resetting the Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) and Multicast
Listener Discovery (MLD) snooping counters to 0:
ML66#clear snooping counters

96.2 igmp snooping config-clear

Synopsis
igmp snooping config-clear

Description
Use this command to delete all Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP)
snooping configuration on the NE. The command also resets the default disabled
state of the IGMP snooping.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Deleting IGMP snooping configuration:
ML66#igmp snooping config-clear

96.3 igmp snooping enable

Synopsis
[no] igmp snooping enable

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 865


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to enable Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP)
snooping on the NE. When IGMP snooping is enabled, IGMP messages are sent
to the switch CPU for processing. Otherwise, the IGMP messages are forwarded
as ordinary multicast packets.

Use the no option to disable IGMP snooping on the NE.

Note: While IGMP snooping is disabled on the NE, the VLAN-level IGMP
snooping settings take no effect.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Enabling IGMP snooping on the NE:
ML66(config)#igmp snooping enable

96.4 igmp snooping vlan

Synopsis
[no] igmp snooping vlan <VLANID> [ ctag <CVID> ]

Description
Use this command to enable Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP)
snooping on a VLAN. The command also changes to the (config-igmp-snooping-
vlan) submode.

Use the no option to disable IGMP snooping and to delete the IGMP
configuration and the learned group membership information on a VLAN.

Note: When IGMP snooping is disabled globally on the NE, snooping can still
be configured per VLAN, but the settings does not take effect until the
snooping is re-enabled globally.

IGMP snooping is disabled on all VLANs by default.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

866 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IGMP and MLD Snooping Commands

Operands

VLANID The VLAN identification number in the outer VLAN tag.


The valid range is 1–4094.

CVID The C-VID identification number in the inner VLAN tag.


The valid range is 1–4094.

Options

ctag The customer VLAN tag.

Examples
Enabling IGMP snooping on VLAN 2:
ML66(config)#igmp snooping vlan 2
ML66(config-igmp-snooping-vlan)#

96.5 immediate-leave

Synopsis

— immediate-leave ports <PORTLIST>

— immediate-leave add <PORTLIST>

— no immediate-leave

— no immediate-leave ports <PORTLIST>

Description
Use this command to enable immediate leave on the selected ports of the VLAN.
By default the immediate leave is disabled.

Note: — Enable immediate leave only on VLAN ports to which a single host
is attached. Otherwise, some hosts can be inadvertently dropped.

— When executing immediate-leave ports <PORTLIST> command,


the current port list is overwritten. Use the immediate-leave add
<PORTLIST> command to add ports to the current port list.

Use the no immediate-leave command to remove all ports from the port list.

Use the no immediate-leave ports <PORTLIST> command to remove the


selected ports from the port list.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 867


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
For IGMP snooping (IPv4):

— IGMP Snooping VLAN configuration submode — (config-igmp-snooping-


vlan)

For MLD snooping (IPv6):

— MLD Snooping VLAN configuration submode — (config-mld-snooping-


vlan)

Operands

PORTLIST The list of the ports in <Rack/Slot/Port> format. The RSP


values are separated by commas.

Options

add Adds new ports to the current port list.

Examples
Enabling immediate leave on ports 1/6/4 and 1/6/5 in an IPv4 network:
ML66(config-igmp-snooping-vlan)#immediate-leave ports 1/6/4,1/6/5

Enabling immediate leave on ports 1/6/4 and 1/6/5 in an IPv6 network:


ML66(config-mld-snooping-vlan)#immediate-leave ports 1/6/4,1/6/5

96.6 mfib alarm-enable

Synopsis
[no] mfib alarm-enable

Description
Use this command to enable the IP Multicast Forwarding Table Full alarm.

Use the no option to disable the IP Multicast Forwarding Table Full alarm.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

868 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IGMP and MLD Snooping Commands

Examples
Enabling the IP multicast forwarding table related alarm:
ML66(config)#mfib alarm-enable

96.7 mld snooping config-clear

Synopsis
mld snooping config-clear

Description
Use this command to delete all Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD) snooping
configuration on the NE. The command also resets the default disabled state of
the MLD snooping.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Deleting MLD snooping configuration:
ML66#mld snooping config-clear

96.8 mld snooping enable

Synopsis
[no] mld snooping enable

Description
Use this command to enable Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD) snooping on the
NE. When MLD snooping is enabled, MLD messages are sent to the switch CPU
for processing. Otherwise, the MLD messages are forwarded as ordinary
multicast packets.

Use the no option to disable MLD snooping on the NE.

Note: While MLD snooping is disabled on the NE, the VLAN-level MLD
snooping settings take no effect.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 869


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Enabling MLD snooping on the NE:
ML66(config)#mld snooping enable

96.9 mld snooping vlan

Synopsis
[no] mld snooping vlan <VLANID> [ ctag <CVID> ]

Description
Use this command to enable Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD) snooping on a
VLAN. The command also changes to the (config-mld-snooping-vlan) submode.

Use the no option to disable MLD snooping and to delete the MLD configuration
and the learned group membership information on a VLAN.

Note: When MLD snooping is disabled globally on the NE, snooping can still be
configured per VLAN, but the settings does not take effect until the
snooping is re-enabled globally.

MLD snooping is disabled on all VLANs by default.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

VLANID The VLAN identification number in the outer VLAN tag.


The valid range is 1–4094.

CVID The C-VID identification number in the inner VLAN tag.


The valid range is 1–4094.

Options

ctag The customer VLAN tag.

870 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IGMP and MLD Snooping Commands

Examples
Enabling MLD snooping on VLAN 2:
ML66(config)#mld snooping vlan 2
ML66(config-mld-snooping-vlan)#

96.10 proxy-reporting

Synopsis
[no] proxy-reporting

Description
Use this command to enable proxy reporting on a VLAN.

Use the no option to disable proxy reporting.

Proxy reporting is disabled by default and the switch performs snooping by


transparently forwarding all IGMP (IPv4), respectively MLD (IPv6) messages
between the hosts and the routers.

Command Mode
For IGMP snooping (IPv4):

— IGMP Snooping VLAN configuration submode — (config-igmp-snooping-


vlan)

For MLD snooping (IPv6):

— MLD Snooping VLAN configuration submode — (config-mld-snooping-


vlan)

Examples
Enabling proxy reporting in an IPv4 network:
ML66(config-igmp-snooping-vlan)#proxy-reporting

Enabling proxy reporting in an IPv6 network:


ML66(config-mld-snooping-vlan)#proxy-reporting

96.11 query-interval

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 871


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
query-interval <SECONDS>

Description
Use this command to set the query interval of the IGMPv2 (IPv4), respectively
MLDv1 (IPv6) querier routers.

In the presence of an IGMPv2 (IPv4) or MLDv1 (IPv6) querier, the switch uses
the configured values of query-interval and robust to calculate the Host
membership timeout as follows:

Host membership timeout = query interval × robust + Max Resp Time

The Host membership timeout determines how long a port is kept in the
forwarding table for a multicast group, if the last host left without sending an
IGMP Leave or MLD Done message.

Note: If the querier is IGMPv3 (IPv4) or MLDv2 (IPv6), the switch extracts the
query interval and robustness variable of the querier either from the
IGMP General Query or the MLD General Query. The configured values
are ignored.

Command Mode
For IGMP snooping (IPv4):

— IGMP Snooping VLAN configuration submode — (config-igmp-snooping-


vlan)

For MLD snooping (IPv6):

— MLD Snooping VLAN configuration submode — (config-mld-snooping-


vlan)

Operands

SECONDS Sets the query interval in seconds. The valid range is 1–


31744. The default value is 125.

Examples
Setting the query interval to 125 seconds in an IPv4 network:
ML66(config-igmp-snooping-vlan)#query-interval 125

Setting the query interval to 125 seconds in an IPv6 network:


ML66(config-mld-snooping-vlan)#query-interval 125

872 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


IGMP and MLD Snooping Commands

96.12 robust

Synopsis
robust <COUNT>

Description
Use this command to set the robustness variable of the IGMPv2 (IPv4),
respectively MLDv1 (IPv6) querier routers.

For more information about how to use this value, see the query-interval
command.

Command Mode
For IGMP snooping (IPv4):

— IGMP Snooping VLAN configuration submode — (config-igmp-snooping-


vlan)

For MLD snooping (IPv6):

— MLD Snooping VLAN configuration submode — (config-mld-snooping-


vlan)

Operands

COUNT Sets the robustness variable. The valid range is 2–7. The
default value is 2.

Examples
Setting the robustness variable to 2 in an IPv4 network:
ML66(config-igmp-snooping-vlan)#robust 2

Setting the robustness variable to 2 in an IPv6 network:


ML66(config-mld-snooping-vlan)#robust 2

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 873


CLI Descriptions

97 SFP Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
106.

The following command modes are applicable for the Small Form-Factor
Pluggable (SFP) commands:

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— SFP submode — (sfp)

Table 106 SFP Commands Overview


alarm-threshold configure the SFP alarm thresholds
als specify the Automatic Laser Shutdown
(ALS) mode and to initiate a manual
restart of the laser transmitter
reset reset the default factory alarm
thresholds of the SFP
select select the SFP application
sfp configure the parameters of a selected
SFP
shutdown set the SFP admin status to non-
operating mode
trapenable enable sending notifications

The related show commands are the following:

— show sfph

For a detailed description of the show commands, see Show Commands on page
884.

97.1 alarm-threshold

Synopsis

— alarm-threshold { RXPower <LOW-ALARM> <LOW-WARNING> <HIGH-


WARNING> <HIGH-ALARM> | TXBias <LOW-ALARM> <LOW-WARNING>
<HIGH-WARNING> <HIGH-ALARM> | TXPower <LOW-ALARM> <LOW-
WARNING> <HIGH-WARNING> <HIGH-ALARM> | Temperature <LOW-
ALARM> <LOW-WARNING> <HIGH-WARNING> <HIGH-ALARM> |

874 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


SFP Commands

Voltage <LOW-ALARM> <LOW-WARNING> <HIGH-WARNING> <HIGH-


ALARM> }

— [no] alarm-threshold { RXPower | TXBias | TXPower | Temperature |


Voltage }

Description
Use this command to configure the SFP alarm thresholds.

Use the no option to disable the configured SFP alarm thresholds.

Command Mode
SFP submode — (sfp)

Operands

LOW-ALARM Sets the low alarm threshold value.

LOW-WARNING Sets the low warning alarm threshold value.

HIGH-WARNING Sets the high warning alarm threshold value.

HIGH-ALARM Sets the high alarm threshold value.

Options

RXPower Specifies the Rx power of the SFP in mW.

TXBias Specifies the bias current of the SFP in mA.

TXPower Specifies the Tx power of the SFP in mW.

Temperature Specifies the temperature of the SFP in ºC.

Voltage Specifies the supply voltage of the SFP in V.

Examples
Specifying the temperature of the SFP:
ML66(sfp)#alarm-threshold Temperature −45 −40 95 100

97.2 als

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 875


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis

— als { mode <MODE> | restart <CMD> }

— no als

Description
Use this command to specify the Automatic Laser Shutdown (ALS) mode and to
initiate a manual restart of the laser transmitter.

Note: Configuring the restart interval of the laser is only possible if the ALS
mode is set tho automatic.

Use the no option to set the default ALS mode.

Command Mode
SFP submode — (sfp)

Operands

MODE Specifies the mode of the ALS.

— 1 — Sets the laser to constantly on.

— 2 — Sets the laser to constantly off.

— 3 — Sets automatic mode. Automatic mode is the


default mode of the ALS.

CMD Specifies the length of the restart.

— 1 — Initiates one 2 second restart test, that is, the


laser is restarted once for 2 seconds.

— 2 — Initiates one 12 second restart test, that is, the


laser is restarted once for 12 seconds.

— 3 — Initiates one 90 second restart test, that is, the


laser is restarted once for 90 seconds.

Options

mode The mode of the ALS.

restart The length of the restart.

876 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


SFP Commands

Examples
Setting the laser to constantly on:
ML66(sfp)#als mode 3

97.3 reset

Synopsis
reset { RXPower | TXBias | TXPower | Temperature | Voltage | all }

Description
Use this command to reset the default factory alarm thresholds of the SFP.

Command Mode
SFP submode — (sfp)

Options

RXPower Resets the configured Rx power thresholds of the SFP.

TXBias Resets the configured bias current thresholds of the SFP.

TXPower Resets the configured Tx power thresholds of the SFP.

Temperature Resets the configured temperature thresholds of the SFP.

Voltage Resets the configured supply voltage thresholds of the


SFP.

all Resets all configured thresholds of the SFP.

Examples
Resetting the default factory Rx power threshold of the SFP:
ML66(sfp)#reset RXPower

97.4 select

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 877


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis

— select <APPLICATION>

— no select

Description
Use this command to select an SFP application for the SFP, which has just been
plugged in.

Note: If multiple applications are available, the user has to select one
supported application before the SFP is taken into operation. If only one
application is available, the system automatically selects that
application.

Use the no option to delete the selected SFP application type if multiple
application types are available.

Command Mode
SFP submode — (sfp)

Operands

APPLICATION The SFP application. The value of the SFP application


can be displayed by using show sfph subslot
command.

Examples
Selecting the SFP application:
ML66(sfp)#select 0x380c

97.5 sfp

Synopsis
[no] sfp <SLOT/SUBSLOT>

Description
Use this command to change to the (sfp) submode for a selected SFP.

Use the no option to clear the SFP configuration for unplugged SFPs.

878 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


SFP Commands

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

SLOT/SUBSLOT The Slot and Subslot value of the SFP, where the format
is Slot/Subslot.

Examples
Changing to the (sfp) submode for the SFP in subslot 6/3:
ML66(config)#sfp 6/3
ML66(sfp)#

97.6 shutdown

Synopsis
[no] shutdown

Description
Use this command to set the SFP admin status to non-operating mode.

Use the no option to set the SFP status to operating mode.

Command Mode
SFP submode — (sfp)

Examples
Setting the SFP admin status to operating mode:
ML66(sfp)#no shutdown

97.7 trapenable

Synopsis
[no] trapenable

Description
Use this command to enable sending notifications.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 879


CLI Descriptions

Use the no option to disable sending notifications.

Command Mode
SFP submode — (sfp)

Examples
Enabling notifications:
ML66(sfp)#trapenable

880 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Report Commands

98 Report Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
107.

The following command mode is applicable for the report commands:

— Exec mode — >

Table 107 Report Commands Overview


bug-report generate a bug report and upload it to
an FTP server
generate-report generate a report of the configuration
and inventory data of the NE

98.1 bug-report

Synopsis
bug-report description <DESC> ftp <NAME> <OPTIONALS>

Description
Use this command to generate a bug report and upload it to an FTP server.

The parameters of the bug report can be configured using mandatory and
optional parameters. The optional parameters can be used in any combination
and in any order, independently of one another.

By default, all parameters are included, and a zip archive is used as a container.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

DESCRIPTION The bug description, with a maximum of 1,000


characters. If the description contains more than one
word, it must be entered between quotation marks.

NAME The FTP server to upload to. The server must already be
configured in the FTP manager of the node. The

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 881


CLI Descriptions

parameters value should be the name of the desired


server configured in the FTP manager.

OPTIONALS The following optional parameters can be specified:

— ftp-path <PATH> — Specifies the target directory


on the FTP server.

— nefiles <yes/no> — Includes the NE log files in the


bug report. The default value is yes.

— neinfo <yes/no> — Includes NE information in the


bug report. The default value is yes.

— configreport <yes/no> — Includes the


configuration report log in the bug report. The default
value is yes.

— snmpwalk <yes/no> — Includes the SNMP walk log


in the bug report. The default value is yes.

— nrlogs <NUM> — Specifies the number of recent


backup log files to collect. The default value is 5.

— nrnotif <NUM> — Specifies the number of recent


backup notification history files to collect. The default
value is 10.

— format <zip/tar> — Specifies the bug report archive


format. The default format is zip.

Options

description Specifies the bug description.

ftp Specifies the FTP server to upload to.

Examples
Generating a default bug report and uploading it to the FTP server named
remote:
ML66>bug-report description "Example of bug report collection" ftp remote

Generating a bug report with optional parameters and uploading it to a specified


directory of the FTP server named remote:
ML66>bug-report description "Example of bug report collection" ftp remote snmpwalk →
no ftp-path data/bug_reports

882 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Report Commands

98.2 generate-report

Synopsis
generate-report report-data-content <REPORT-CATEGORIES>

Description
Use this command to generate XML report and transfer it to FTP server defined
for the report service. The report contains the configuration of the specified
categories or all of them if no category is specified.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

REPORT-CATEGORIES
The following categories can be specified:

— all

— ces

— equipment

— ethernet

— inventory

— ne

— pdh

— rl

— sdh

— security

Examples
Generating report for NE, equipment, and inventory:
ML66>generate-report report-data-content ne equipment inventory

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 883


CLI Descriptions

99 Show Commands

This section contains detailed information about the commands listed in Table
108.

The following command modes are applicable for the monitoring commands:

— Exec mode — >

— Privileged Exec mode — #

— Global Configuration mode — (config)

— Ethernet Alarms configuration submode — (config-eth-alarms)

— License Request submode — (license-request)

— Ethernet Service OAM submode — (cfm)

— Ethernet Service OAM MD submode — (cfm-md)

— Ethernet Service OAM MD MA submode — (cfm-md-ma)

— Ethernet Service OAM MD MA MEP submode — (cfm-md-ma-mep)

— Ethernet Service OAM MD MA MEP PM submode — (cfm-md-ma-mep-pm)

— Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

— Far End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-ferlt)

— Near End Radio Link Terminal XPIC submode — (config-rlt-xpic)

— Near End Radio Link Terminal TDM submode — (config-rlt-tdm)

— Far End Radio Link Terminal TDM submode — (config-ferlt-fetdm)

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Local Access configuration submode — (interface-local-access)

— PTP configuration submode — (config-ptp)

— LLDP interface level configuration submode — (config-lldp)

— CES Server configuration submode — (config-ces-server)

884 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Table 108 Monitoring Commands Overview


show (PW) list the Pseudo-Wires (PWs) hosted on the
Circuit Emulation Service (CES) server
show (Ethernet display configuration information and the
alarms) status of the Ethernet alarms
show (license) display the requested licenses
show (license display the currently monitored licenses
monitoring)
show aaa accounting display session accounting configuration
network default group
show aaaPolicyStatus display the status of the Authentication,
Authorization, and Accounting (AAA) policy
show access-list display access lists
show alarms display alarm information
show arp display Address Resolution Protocol (ARP)
Management Information Base (MIB)
show backplane display configuration information for a
backplane
show bandwidth- display the configured Bandwidth Notification
notification Message (BNM) instances
show bandwidth- display a brief summary of the configured
notification brief BNM instances
show bgp display BGP route information
show bgp community display unicast route information that match
communities within an IPv4 environment
show bgp community- display BGP route information that match
list specified community list
show bgp dampening display detailed BGP dampening information
show bgp filter-list display BGP routes conforming to the specified
filter list
show bgp inconsistent- display BGP routes with inconsistent
as Autonomous System (AS) paths
show bgp ipv4 display unicast route information for a single
IP in an IPv4 environment
show bgp label mode display detailed information about label mode
globals settings at a global level
show bgp mpls label display the global BGP MPLS label mode and
mode the VRF label mode
show bgp neighbors display detailed information on TCP and BGP
neighbor connections

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 885


CLI Descriptions

show bgp nexthop- display BGP nexthop-tracking status


tracking
show bgp nexthop- display BGP nexthop-tree details
tree-details
show bgp paths display BGP path information
show bgp prefix-list display unicast route information that match a
prefix list within an IPv4 environment.
show bgp quote- display unicast route information for an AS
regexp path regular expression within an IPv4
environment
show bgp regexp display unicast route information that match
the AS path regular expression within an IPv4
environment
show bgp summary display BGP neighbor status summary
show bgp vpnv4 all display information about all VPNv4 NLRIs
show bgp vpnv4
details
show bgp vpnv4 rd display information for a VPNv4 Route
Distinguisher
show bgp vpnv4 vrf display BGP VPNv4 routing or forwarding
instance information
show board display configuration information for a board
show bridge-basics display bridge basic configuration
show bridge-port display bridge-port configuration
show bridge-port display bridge port settings of the interface
show capability vrf-lite display Virtual Routing and Forwarding lite
(VRF-lite) support status
show carrier- display the Carrier Termination (CT)
termination configuration
show carrier- display CT capability information
termination-capability
show ces server display available CES servers and the PWs
available on them
show ces tdm-profile display available TDM configuration profiles
show cfm alarms display active Ethernet Service Operation,
Administration, and Maintenance (OAM)
alarms
show cfm ma display a Maintenance Association (MA)
show cfm md display a Maintenance Domain (MD)
show cfm mep display a Maintenance End Point (MEP)

886 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

show cfm mep-peer display MEP peers or remote MEPs


show cfm mip display a Maintenance Intermediate Point
(MIP)
show cliprotocol display the current CLI protocol setting
show clns is-neighbors display all IS neighbor adjacencies
show clns neighbors display IS neighbor adjacencies
show clock display the system clock
show config display configuration information
show config-changed- display the value of the timer set for the NE
timer Configuration Changed event
show config- display the configuration information list
validation-info
show confirm display the confirmed IP address
show confirm timer display the status of the confirm timer
show connect-cc display TDM cross-connections
show copy display the status of ongoing software updates
show counters display the Link Layer Discovery Protocol
(LLDP) interface level counters of the current
Ethernet interface
show current display current mode settings
show dcn-lan-ctag display double tagged Data Communication
Network (DCN) traffic
show dcn-mode display the current DCN mode
show debug display debugging configuration
show dm display Delay Measurement (DM) statistics
show display the status of local users (admin_user
enableLocalUsers and view_user) when centralized
authentication is configured
show epl display configured Layer 1 connections
show erp-group display the configured Ethernet Ring
Protection (ERP) rings
show ferlt display the RLT configuration at far end
show fetdm display information regarding TDM at far end
show file-integrity- display the status of the file integrity
alarm on page 955 monitoring function
show ftpprotocol display the current default FTP protocol
setting
show ftp active display the associated FTP server for all
services

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 887


CLI Descriptions

show ftp activeftp display the default FTP server


show ftp configtable display the FTP server entries of the FTP
configuration table
show history display the command history
show igmp snooping display the global status of IGMP snooping on
the NE
show igmp snooping display IGMP snooping configuration
config
show igmp snooping display a list of IGMP multicast groups and the
group associated member ports on a specific VLAN
show igmp snooping display the multicast router ports on a specific
mrouter VLAN
show igmp snooping display IGMP snooping status on a specific
vlan VLAN
show interface (DCN) display the configuration and counter values of
a DCN or a router interface
show interface (PTP) display the available interfaces capable of
time-stamping and their statuse
show interface display the current configuration of the
ethernet Ethernet interface
show interface display Ethernet PM data
ethernet-pm
show interface display status information for all Ethernet
ethernet status interfaces
show interface ip display the IP parameters of an IP interface
show interface serial display the configuration parameters of a
serial (PPP) interface
show investigation- display the status of additional
mode troubleshooting possibilities
show ip forwarding display IP forwarding status
show ip host interface display the host interface configuration for
DCN-Mode Routed
show ip host mtu display the host Maximum Transmission Unit
(MTU) configuration
show ip interface host display the configuration of the current host
interface
show ip isis igp- display the IS-IS IGP shortcut LSP entries
shortcut-lsp
show ip isis route display IS-IS routing table for IPv4

888 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

show ip isis route igp- display the IS-IS IGP shortcut routing table
shortcut
show ip ospf display general information about OSPF
routing processes
show ip ospf border- display the Area Border Routers (ABRs) and
routers Autonomous System Border Routers (ASBRs)
for an OSPF instance
show ip ospf database display a database summary for OSPF
information
show ip ospf igp- display Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP)
shortcut-lsp Shortcut Labeled Switch Paths (LSPs) used by
OSPF
show ip ospf igp- display IGP Shortcut routes calculated by
shortcut-route OSPF
show ip ospf interface display interface information for OSPF
show ip ospf multi- display multi-area adjacency information for
area-adjacencies OSPF instances
show ip ospf neighbor display information on OSPF neighbors
show ip ospf route display OSPF routing table
show ip ospf virtual- display virtual link information
links
show ip prefix-list display IP prefix lists
show ip route display the IP routing table for a protocol or
from a particular table
show ip vrf display Virtual Routing and Forwarding (VRF)
information
show iptables display IPv4 firewall status information
show ip6tables display IPv6 firewall status information
show isis counter display the IS-IS system counter entry MIBs
show isis database display link state database information
show isis interface display detailed interface information
show isis topology display IS-IS topology information
show l1-bonding display members and configured mappings for
a specific L1 bonding group or for all L1
bonding groups
show lag display Link Aggregation Group (LAG)
show lag lacpstats display Link Aggregation Control Protocol
(LACP) statistics
show lag status display status information about the Link
Aggregation Group (LAG)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 889


CLI Descriptions

show lan-dcn display information about the LAN-DCN


network
show lan-dcn ip display information about the DCN IP network
and interfaces
show lan-dcn ipv6 display information about the DCN IPv6
network and interfaces
show lan-dcn ipv6 display the configured Dynamic Host
dhcp relayaddress Configuration Protocol (DHCP) server address
show lan-dcn ipv6 display the running state of the DHCP relay
dhcp status agent
show ldp display basic Label Distribution Protocol (LDP)
attributes defined for the current Label Switch
Router (LSR)
show ldp adjacency display all the adjacencies for the current LSR
show ldp downstream display the status of all downstream sessions
and the label information exchanged
show ldp fec display all Forwarding Equivalence Classes
(FECs) known to the current LSR
show ldp inter-area- all FECs using the LPM-based mapping
fecs procedure
show ldp interface display the list of all interfaces on the current
LSR, and to indicate whether a given interface
is label-switching or not
show ldp lsp display LDP LSPs and, optionally, advertise-
label information
show ldp session display all sessions established between the
current LSR and other LSRs
show ldp statistics display LDP packet statistics
show ldp targeted- display the targeted peers configured on the
peers current LSR
show ldp upstream display the status of all upstream sessions and
label information exchanged
show legalnotice display the customized legal notice
show license install display the status of the License Key File (LKF)
status installation
show license restrict- display the current status of the unlocked
unlocked-period period restriction for control_user
show license status display the licensing status of the NE
show license status display detailed information on license usage
ports on the NE

890 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

show license display status information of the licensing


unlockedperiod unlocked periods
show license upload display the upload status of the License
status Request File (LRF)
show linktrace display linktrace results
show lldp config display the current Link Layer Discovery
Protocol (LLDP) configuration
show lldp counters display LLDP counters
show lldp local-info display the LLDP-related local system
information that is advertised to LLDP
neighbors
show lldp neighbors display the LLDP information received from
LLDP neighbors
show local-info display the LLDP-related local system
information that is advertised to LLDP
neighbors
show display the idle timeout for local users
localuseridletimer
show loopback display loopback results
show mac-address- display MAC address table
table
show mac-whitelist display MAC white lists
show memory display information about memory processes
show mfib status display the status of the IP multicast
forwarding table
show mld snooping display the global status of MLD snooping on
the NE
show mld snooping display MLD snooping configuration
config
show mld snooping display a list of MLD multicast groups and the
group associated member ports on a specific VLAN
show mld snooping display the multicast router ports on a specific
mrouter VLAN
show mld snooping display MLD snooping status on a specific
vlan VLAN
show mpls display MPLS data
show mpls cross- display detailed information for all entries
connect-table created in the MPLS cross-connect table
show mpls forwarding- display Diffserv configuration information and
table the forwarding table entries

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 891


CLI Descriptions

show mpls ftn-table display MPLS FEC-To-NHLFE (FTN) table


information
show mpls ilm-table display MPLS Incoming Label Map (ILM) table
information
show mpls in-segment- display detailed information about all entries
table in the ILM table
show mpls interface display all interfaces bound to an MPLS
interface
show mpls ldp display MPLS Label Distribution Protocol
(LDP) data
show mpls mapped- display MPLS mapped routes
routes
show mpls out- display detailed information of out-segment
segment-table entries table
show mpls vc-table display configured virtual circuit components
show mpls vrf-table display detailed information for all the
installed FTN entries for a Virtual Routing and
Forwarding (VRF) instance
show mst display spanning tree Multiple Spanning Tree
(MST) configuration
show neighbors display the LLDP information received from
LLDP neighbors
show netstat display netstatistics
show network-synch display status information about the Netsync
status and configured Netsync Nominees
show notification-log display notification-log
show ntp-status display NTP configuration and status
show pingtargethost display the Ping Target Host address
show policing display policing configuration
show policing- display policing-bandwidth profiles
bandwidth-profile
show policing-cos- display policing Class of Service (CoS) groups
groups configuration
show policing-cos- display policing CoS group mapping
group-mapping configuration
show policing-vlan- display policing VLAN groups configuration
groups
show policing-vlan- display policing VLAN group mapping
group-mapping configuration
show processes display running processes

892 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

show ptp alarms-and- display alarm and event status of the Precision
events Time Protocol (PTP) function
show ptp clock display clock status information
show ptp clock current- display the current values in the current
ds Dataset (DS)
show ptp clock default- display the current values in the default DS
ds
show ptp clock parent- display the current values in the parent DS
ds
show ptp clock settings display the general settings of the clock
show ptp clock time- display the current values in time properties
properties-ds DS
show ptp clock-port display the clock port related objects
show ptp config display PTP configuration
show ptp interface display the available interfaces capable of
time-stamping
show ptp peers display the connected peers
show ptp sync display the status of the frequency
synchronization signal that is recovered from
the IEEE1588 session and can be used as
nominee for the Network Synchronization
function
show qos display QoS settings of the interface
show queue-set-profile display the queue-set profile settings
show display the IP protocol type of the Remote
radius_address_Type Authentication Dial In User Service (RADIUS)
server
show radius-server display RADIUS server configuration
config
show radius-server display RADIUS server statistics
statistics
show radius-server display RADIUS server status
status
show rf-frequency display the RF parameters for MMU 1001 and
MMU 1002
show rf-power display the RF Power data for MMU 1001 and
MMU 1002
show rlt display the RLT configuration at near end
show route-map display route-map information
show router-id display the router ID common for OSPF, BGP,
LDP, and so on processes

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 893


CLI Descriptions

show rsvp display RSVP information


show rsvp admin- display RSVP Administrative Group
groups information
show rsvp interface display RSVP interface information
show rsvp neighbor display RSVP neighbor information
show rsvp nexthop- display nexthop information cached in RSVP
cache
show rsvp path display RSVP path information
show rsvp session display RSVP session information
show rsvp session display the count of existing RSVP sessions on
count a router
show rsvp session display RSVP sessions that end at a router
egress
show rsvp session display RSVP sessions that originate from the
ingress router
show rsvp session display RSVP sessions for an LSP specified by
<LSP-NAME> the LSP name
show rsvp session display RSVP sessions that pass through the
transit router
show rsvp statistics display RSVP statistics
show rsvp summary- display RSVP Summary Refresh information
refresh
show rsvp trunk display RSVP trunk information
show rsvp version display the RSVP version
show rsyslog display the remote syslog configuration for
alarms and events
show rsyslog6 display the remote syslog configuration for
alarms and events for IPv6
show rsyslogsec display the remote syslog configuration for
security events
show rsyslogsec6 display the remote syslog configuration for
security events for IPv6
show running-config display currently running configuration file
show running-config display router configuration
router
show rx-frequency display the Rx frequency for MMU 1001 and
MMU 1002
show scheduler-profile display scheduler profiles
show secure-ssh display the status of the file ssh-server security
function

894 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

show sfph display Small Form-Factor Pluggable (SFP)


information
show slot-capacity display the maximum supported, respectively
the allocated backplane Ethernet capacity
between the NPU and APU slots
show display the SNMPv3 authentication protocol
snmpv3authprotocol
show display the SNMPv3 privacy protocol
snmpv3privprotocol
show snmpv3protocol display the SNMPv3 data encryption type
show spanning-tree display the current spanning-tree
configuration
show spectrum- display the measured values of the latest sub-
diagnostics-result on band or channel scan
page 1096
show spectrum- display the status of sub-band and channel
diagnostics-status on scans
page 1096
show startup-config display current saved configuration
show status display status information
show strongpasswd display strong password enforcement
show subrack display configuration information for a subrack
show system display configuration information for the
system
show sys_notes display the added information related to the
site
show display the IP protocol type of the Terminal
tacacs_address_Type Access Controller Access Control System Plus
(TACACS+) address
show tacacs-server display TACACS+ server configuration
config
show tacacs-server display TACACS+ server statistics
statistics
show tacacs-server display TACACS+ server status
status
show taps display Traffic Aware Power Save (TAPS)
configuration status
show tdm display information regarding TDM at near
end
show tdm-interfaces display all the available TDM interfaces that
can be used in cross-connection for a specific
slot

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 895


CLI Descriptions

show temp display the temperature of the unit


show timezone display the time zone currently set
show twamp sessions display configured Two-Way Active
Measurement Protocol (TWAMP) sessions
show twamp statistics display TWAMP statistics
show tx-frequency display the Tx frequency for MMU 1001 and
MMU 1002
show userio display user Input/Output (I/O) configuration
and status of the NPU
show version display software and hardware revision
information
show vlan display Virtual Local Area Networks (VLANs)
show wred-profile display WRED profiles
show x display log information
show xpic display information regarding the XPIC pair
associated with the RLT

99.1 show (PW)

Synopsis
show

Description
Use this command to list the Pseudo-Wires (PWs) hosted on the Circuit
Emulation Service (CES) server.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— CES Commands

Command Mode
CES Server configuration submode — (config-ces-server)

Examples
Displaying the PWs hosted on the CES server:
ML66(config-ces-server)#show

896 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

99.2 show (Ethernet alarms)

Synopsis
show { current | loop }

Description
Use this command to display configuration information and the status of the
Ethernet alarms.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: Security and Admission Control

Command Mode
Ethernet Alarms configuration submode — (config-eth-alarms)

Options

current Displays the current mode settings.

loop Displays the currently active loop alarms.

Examples
Displaying configuration information:
ML66(config-eth-alarms)#show current

99.3 show (license)

Synopsis
show

Description
Use this command to display the requested licenses.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— License Handling Commands

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 897


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
License Request submode — (license-request)

Examples

Table 109 Displayed Information of the Requested Licenses


Ins Displays the number of the installed licenses.
Us Displays the number of the used licenses.
e
Qt Displays how many new licenses are requested by the License Request
y File (LRF). The default value is the number of the missing licenses.

Displaying the amount of the requested licenses:


ML66(license-request)#show
Prod NO |Product Name |Ins|Use|Qty| Status
------------+--------------------------------------------+---+---+---+--------
FAL1241479|Emergency Unlock | 0| 1| 1| Ok
FAL1241480|Maintenance Unlock | 0| 1| 1| Ok
FAL1242515|M-L 669x R1 Basic SW | 1| 1| 0| Ok
FAL1242517|M-L 6600 Eth ProviderMode | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242518|M-L 6600 Eth SOAM FM/PM | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242519|M-L 6600 IGMP snooping | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242520|M-L 6600 1588v2 BasicSync | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242521|M-L 6600 1588v2 Enh Sync | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242522|M-L 6600 1588v2 Sync Distr | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242523|M-L 6600 PDH Network Prot | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242524|M-L 6600 Enable Eth port | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242525|M-L 6600 UG 25to50Mbps | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242526|M-L 6600 UG 50to100Mbps | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242527|M-L 6600 UG 100to150Mbps | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242528|M-L 6600 UG 150to200Mbps | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242529|M-L 6600 UG 200to250Mbps | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242530|M-L 6600 UG 250to300Mbps | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242531|M-L 6600 UG 300to350Mbps | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242532|M-L 6600 UG 350to400Mbps | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242533|M-L 6600 UG 400to450Mbps | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242534|M-L 6600 UG 450to500Mbps | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242535|M-L 6600 UG 500to600Mbps | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242536|M-L 6600 1+1 RL Prot | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242537|M-L 6600 XPIC | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242538|M-L 6600 RL Bonding | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242540|M-L 6600 Header Compr | 1| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242541|M-L 6600 2nd carrier | 1| 1| 0| Ok
FAL1242542|M-L 6600 TX HP | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242543|M-L 6600 Mod Agile RAU Xu | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242671|M-L 6600 UG 600to700Mbps | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242672|M-L 6600 UG 700to800Mbps | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242673|M-L 6600 UG 800to900Mbps | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242674|M-L 6600 UG 900to1000Mbps | 0| 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242675|M-L 6600 UG 1000to1250Mbps | 0| 0| 0| Ok

99.4 show (license monitoring)

Synopsis
show [monitoring-auto-unlock]

898 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Description
Use this command to display the currently monitored licenses and their status.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— License Handling Commands in Monitoring Mode

Command Mode
License Monitoring submode — (license-monitoring), at admin level

Options

monitoring-auto-unlock
Displays the current status of automatic license
provisioning.

Examples

Table 110 Displayed Information of the Monitored Licenses


Use Displays the number of the used
licenses.
Ins Displays the number of the installed
licenses.
Unl Displays the total number of unlocked
licenses for the feature.
Sum Displays the total number of licenses
unlocked and installed.

Displaying the number of the currently monitored licenses:


ML66(license-monitoring)#show
NE License Status: Ok
NE License Mode: Locked
RMM fingerprint: 6801135122667f051120ffff
Prod NO |Product Name |Use|Ins| Status
------------+------------------------------------------------+---+---+--------
FAL1241479|Emergency Unlock | 1| 0| Ok
FAL1241480|Maintenance Unlock | 1| 0| Ok
FAL1242515|M-L 669x R1 Basic SW | 1| 1| Ok
FAL1242517|M-L 6600 Eth ProviderMode | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242518|M-L 6600 Eth SOAM FM/PM | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242519|M-L 6600 IGMP snooping | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242520|M-L 6600 1588v2 BasicSync | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242521|M-L 6600 1588v2 Enh Sync | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242522|M-L 6600 1588v2 Sync Distr | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242523|M-L 6600 PDH Network Prot | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242524|M-L 6600 Enable Eth port | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242525|M-L 6600 UG 25to50Mbps | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242526|M-L 6600 UG 50to100Mbps | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242527|M-L 6600 UG 100to150Mbps | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242528|M-L 6600 UG 150to200Mbps | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242529|M-L 6600 UG 200to250Mbps | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242530|M-L 6600 UG 250to300Mbps | 0| 0| Ok

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 899


CLI Descriptions

FAL1242531|M-L 6600 UG 300to350Mbps | 0| 0| Ok


FAL1242532|M-L 6600 UG 350to400Mbps | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242533|M-L 6600 UG 400to450Mbps | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242534|M-L 6600 UG 450to500Mbps | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242535|M-L 6600 UG 500to600Mbps | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242536|M-L 6600 1+1 RL Prot | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242537|M-L 6600 XPIC | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242538|M-L 6600 RL Bonding | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242540|M-L 6600 Header Compr | 0| 1| Ok
FAL1242541|M-L 6600 2nd carrier | 1| 1| Ok
FAL1242542|M-L 6600 TX HP | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242543|M-L 6600 Mod Agile RAU Xu | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242671|M-L 6600 UG 600to700Mbps | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242672|M-L 6600 UG 700to800Mbps | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242673|M-L 6600 UG 800to900Mbps | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242674|M-L 6600 UG 900to1000Mbps | 0| 0| Ok
FAL1242675|M-L 6600 UG 1000to1250Mbps | 0| 0| Ok

Displaying the current status of automatic license provisioning:


ML66(license-monitoring)#show monitoring-auto-unlock
Automatic license provisioning is disable

99.5 show aaa accounting network default group

Synopsis
show aaa accounting network default group {tacacs+ | radius}

Description
Use this command to display session accounting configuration.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Commands

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Options

tacacs+ Displays Terminal Access Controller Access-Control


System Plus (TACACS+) session accounting
configuration.

radius Displays Remote Authentication Dial In User Service


(RADIUS) session accounting configuration.

Examples
Displaying TACACS+ session accounting configuration:

900 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

ML66#show aaa accounting network default group tacacs+


tacacs session accounting sent at session start and stop

99.6 show aaaPolicyStatus

Synopsis
show aaaPolicyStatus

Description
Use this command to display the status of the Authentication, Authorization, and
Accounting (AAA) policy.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the status of the AAA policy:
ML66>show aaaPolicyStatus
AAAPolicyStatus is radiusUpLocUsrEn

99.7 show access-list

Synopsis
show access-list

Description
Use this command to display access lists.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Router Basic Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 901


CLI Descriptions

Examples
ML66#show access-list

99.8 show alarms

Synopsis
show alarms

Description
Use this command to show alarm information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Interfaces

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying alarm information:
ML66>show alarms
Alarm ID 3
Severity critical
Alarm Type equipment Alarm
Alarm Time 2000-2-1 23:52:6.1 UTC +0:0
Source SFP 1000BASE-LX (SMF 10 km) I-t 1/4.4
Specific Problem SFP RX Power Low at NPU1002
Alarm ID 5
Severity major
Alarm Type equipment Alarm
Alarm Time 2000-2-1 23:52:14.9 UTC +0:0
Source MINI-LINK Traffic Node ML66-172-19-82-100
Specific Problem Power Failure (upper input)

99.9 show arp

Synopsis

— show lan-dcn arp

— show arp [vrf <VRF>]

or

— show arp lan-dcn

902 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

— show arp router [vrf <VRF>]

Description
Use this command to display the Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) cache.

If no parameter is specified, the command displays the ARP cache of the router
network for the default Virtual Routing and Forwarding (VRF).

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

VRF The name of the VRF instance.

Options

lan-dcn Displays the ARP cache of the LAN-DCN network.

vrf Displays the router ARP cache for the VRF instance.

router Displays the ARP cache of the router network.

Examples
Displaying the ARP cache of the LAN-DCN network:
ML66>show arp lan-dcn
ARP output:
Address HWtype HWaddress Flags Mask Iface →
Port CVLAN SVLAN
10.41.96.1 ether 00:30:88:04:1e:4d C 1/6/0 →
0 0 0

Displaying the ARP cache of the router network for the default VRF:
ML66>show arp router
ARP output:
Address HWtype HWaddress Flags Mask Iface
192.168.35.32 ether ac:60:b6:a1:e5:1c C 1/6/4.50→
0

99.10 show backplane

Synopsis
show backplane <RACK> [ hw | eeprom ]

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 903


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to display configuration information for a backplane.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

RACK The number of the rack.

Options

hw Displays hardware configuration information.

eeprom Displays Electrically Erasable Programmable Read-Only


Memory (EEPROM) configuration information.

Examples
Displaying hardware configuration information for rack 1:
ML66>show backplane 1 hw
EEPROM identifiers:
Board Product Number: ROJR 609 006/1
Board Revision: R1E
Product Serial Number: TY12749610
Date of Manufacturing: 20110623
Place of Manufacturing: TY1
SPI CPLD Product Number:
SPI CPLD Revision:
Power Capability: 3

99.11 show bandwidth-notification

Synopsis

— show bandwidth-notification

— show bandwidth-notification md <mdName>

— show bandwidth-notification md <mdName> ma <maName>

Description
Use this command to display the configured Bandwidth Notification Message
(BNM) instances.

Running the command without any options all parameters are displayed.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

904 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

— Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Ethernet Bandwidth Notification

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Operands

mdName The name of the Maintenance Domain (MD).

maName The name of the Maintenance Association (MA).

Options

md Displays the configured BNM instances in the MD.

ma Displays the configured BNM instances in the MA.

Examples
Displaying the configured BNM instances with all parameters:
ML66#show bandwidth-notification
md string md1
ma string ma1
mep 150
bandwidth-notification
interface 1/3/2
format itu-t
hold time 2
interval 1s
priority 0
level 5
portID 456
enable
send
full-link-message always
failed-link-message
send-frequently-after-hold-time
md string md2

99.12 show bandwidth-notification brief

Synopsis

— show bandwidth-notification brief

— show bandwidth-notification brief md <mdName>

— show bandwidth-notification brief md <mdName> ma <maName>

— show bandwidth-notification brief md <mdName> ma <maName> mep


<mepId>

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 905


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to display a brief summary of the configured Bandwidth
Notification Message (BNM) instances.

Running the command without any options all parameters are displayed.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Ethernet Bandwidth Notification

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Operands

mdName The name of the Maintenance Domain (MD).

maName The name of the Maintenance Association (MA).

mepId The ID of the Maintenance End Point (MEP).

Options

md Displays a brief summary of the configured BNM


instances in the MD.

ma Displays a brief summary of the configured BNM


instances in the MA.

mep Displays a brief summary of the configured BNM


instances in the MEP.

Examples
Displaying a brief summary of the configured BNM instances:
ML66#show bandwidth-notification brief
MD MA MEP interface enable
md1 ma1 140 1/3/1 disabled
md1 ma2 150 1/3/2 enabled
md2 ma3 160 1/2/1 enabled

99.13 show bgp

Synopsis
show bgp ipv4 {unicast | labeled-unicast}

906 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Description
Use this command to display BGP route information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— BGP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying BGP route information:
ML66#show bgp ipv4 labeled-unicast

99.14 show bgp community

Synopsis

— show bgp community

— show bgp ipv4 unicast community

— show bgp community [<AA:NN> | local-AS | no-advertise | no-export]

— show bgp ipv4 {unicast | labeled-unicast} community [<NUMBER> |


local-AS | no-advertise | no-export]

Description
Use this command to display unicast route information that match communities
within an IPv4 environment.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— BGP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

AA:NN A valid value for a community number.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 907


CLI Descriptions

Options

ipv4 Sets IPv4 address family.

unicast Indicates the address family modifier as unicast.

labeled-unicast Indicates the address family modifier as labeled-unicast.

local-AS Do not send outside local Autonomous System (AS) (well-


known community).

no-advertise Do not advertise to any peer (well-known community).

no-export Do not export to next AS (well-known community).

Examples
Displaying unicast route information that match communities:
ML66#show bgp ipv4 unicast community 12:34

99.15 show bgp community-list

Synopsis

— show bgp community-list <NAME> exact-match

— show bgp ipv4 {unicast | labeled-unicast} community-list <NAME>


[exact-match]

Description
Use this command to display BGP route information that match specified
community list.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— BGP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

NAME The name of the community list.

908 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Options

ipv4 Sets IPv4 address family.

unicast Indicates the address family modifier as unicast.

labeled-unicast Indicates the address family modifier as labeled-unicast.

exact-match Sets that the exact match of the communities are


displayed.

Examples
Displaying BGP route information that match specified community list:
ML66#show bgp ipv4 unicast community-list mylist exact-match

99.16 show bgp dampening

Synopsis

— show bgp dampening {dampened-paths | flap-statistics | parameters}

— show bgp ipv4 {unicast | labeled-unicast} dampening {dampened-


paths | flap-statistics | parameters}

Description
Use this command to display detailed BGP dampening information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— BGP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Options

ipv4 Sets IPv4 address family.

unicast Indicates the address family modifier as unicast.

labeled-unicast Indicates the address family modifier as labeled-unicast.

dampened-paths Displays paths suppressed due to dampening.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 909


CLI Descriptions

flap-statistics Displays flap statistics of routes.

parameters Displays details of configured dampening parameters.

Examples
Displaying detailed BGP dampening information:
ML66#show bgp ipv4 unicast dampening dampened-paths

99.17 show bgp filter-list

Synopsis

— show bgp filter-list <NAME>

— show bgp ipv4 {unicast | labeled-unicast} filter-list <NAME>

Description
Use this command to display BGP routes conforming to the specified filter list.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— BGP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

NAME The name of the regular-expression access list.

Options

ipv4 Sets IPv4 address family.

unicast Indicates the address family modifier as unicast.

labeled-unicast Indicates the address family modifier as labeled-unicast.

Examples
Displaying BGP routes conforming to the specified filter list:
ML66#show bgp ipv4 unicast filter-list mylist

910 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

99.18 show bgp inconsistent-as

Synopsis

— show bgp inconsistent-as

— show bgp ipv4 {unicast | labeled-unicast} inconsistent-as

Description
Use this command to display BGP routes with inconsistent Autonomous System
(AS) paths.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— BGP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying BGP routes with inconsistent AS paths:
ML66#show bgp ipv4 unicast inconsistent-as

99.19 show bgp ipv4

Synopsis
show bgp ipv4 unicast {<IPADDR> | <IPADDR/PREFIX> [longer-
prefixes] }

Description
Use this command to display unicast route information in an IPv4 environment.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— BGP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 911


CLI Descriptions

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the BGP neighbor, where the format
is <A.B.C.D> .

IPADDR/PREFIX The IP prefix network and length, where the format is


<A.B.C.D/P> .

Options

ipv4 Sets IPv4 address family.

unicast Indicates the address family modifier as unicast.

longer-prefixes Displays route and more specific routes.

Examples
Displaying unicast route information:
ML66#show bgp ipv4 multicast 1.2.3.4

99.20 show bgp label mode globals

Synopsis
show bgp label mode globals

Description
Use this command to display detailed information about label mode settings at a
global level.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples

ML66>show bgp label mode globals

912 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

99.21 show bgp mpls label mode

Synopsis
show bgp mpls label mode [vrf <VRF>]

Description
Use this command to display the global BGP MPLS label mode and the Virtual
Routing and Forwarding (VRF) label mode. The VRF label mode configuration of
per-vrf is in preference to the global configuration of per-prefix.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

VRF The name of the VRF instance.

Options

vrf Specifies the VRF instance.

Examples

ML66>show bgp mpls label mode vrf vrf_1


BGP vpnv4 label allocation global mode: per-prefix
BGP vpnv6 label allocation global mode: per-prefix

VRF Address-family Mode


vrf_1 bgp-vpnv4 per-prefix
bgp-vpnv6 per-prefix

99.22 show bgp neighbors

Synopsis

— show bgp neighbors [<IPADDR> [advertised-routes | received


prefix-filter | received-routes | routes] ]

— show bgp ipv4 {unicast | labeled-unicast} neighbors [<IPADDR>


[advertised-routes | received prefix-filter | received-routes |
routes] ]

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 913


CLI Descriptions

— show bgp vpn4 neighbors <IPADDR> {advertised-routes | routes}

Description
Use this command to display detailed information on TCP and BGP neighbor
connections.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— BGP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the neighbor, where the format is


<A.B.C.D> .

Options

ipv4 Sets IPv4 address family.

unicast Indicates the address family modifier as unicast.

labeled-unicast Indicates the address family modifier as labeled-unicast.

advertised-routes
Displays the routes advertised to a BGP neighbor.

received-routes Displays the received routes from a neighbor. To display


all the received routes from the neighbor, configure the
BGP soft reconfigure first.

received prefix-filter
Displays the prefix list filter.

routes Displays all accepted routes learned from neighbors.

Examples
Displaying detailed information about the routes advertised to a BGP neighbor:
ML66#show bgp ipv4 unicast neighbors 1.2.3.4 advertised-routes

99.23 show bgp nexthop-tracking

914 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Synopsis
show bgp nexthop-tracking

Description
Use this command to display BGP nexthop-tracking status.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— BGP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Display BGP nexthop-tracking status:
ML66#show bgp nexthop-tracking

99.24 show bgp nexthop-tree-details

Synopsis
show bgp nexthop-tree-details

Description
Use this command to display BGP nexthop-tree details.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— BGP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying BGP nexthop-tree details:
ML66#show bgp nexthop-tree-details

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 915


CLI Descriptions

99.25 show bgp paths

Synopsis

— show bgp paths

— show bgp ipv4 {unicast | labeled-unicast} paths

Description
Use this command to display BGP path information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— BGP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Options

ipv4 Sets IPv4 address family.

unicast Indicates the address family modifier as unicast.

labeled-unicast Indicates the address family modifier as labeled-unicast.

Examples
Displaying BGP path information:
ML66#show bgp ipv4 unicast paths

99.26 show bgp prefix-list

Synopsis

— show bgp prefix-list <NAME>

— show bgp ipv4 {unicast | labeled-unicast} prefix-list <NAME>

Description
Use this command to display unicast route information that match a prefix list
within an IPv4 environment.

916 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— BGP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

NAME The name of the IP prefix list.

Options

ipv4 Sets IPv4 address family.

unicast Indicates the address family modifier as unicast.

labeled-unicast Indicates the address family modifier as labeled-unicast.

Examples
Displaying unicast route information that match a prefix list:
ML66#show bgp ipv4 unicast prefix-list mylist

99.27 show bgp quote-regexp

Synopsis

— show bgp quote-regexp <NAME>

— show bgp ipv4 {unicast | labeled-unicast} quote-regexp <REGEXP>

Description
Use this command to display unicast route information for an Autonomous
System (AS) path regular expression within an IPv4 environment.

Note: Use quotes to enclose the regular expression.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— BGP Commands

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 917


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

REGEXP A regular-expression to match the BGP AS paths.

Options

ipv4 Sets IPv4 address family.

unicast Indicates the address family modifier as unicast.

labeled-unicast Indicates the address family modifier as labeled-unicast.

Examples
Displaying unicast route information for an AS path regular expression:
ML66#show bgp ipv4 unicast quote-regexp “IPI”

99.28 show bgp regexp

Synopsis

— show bgp regexp <REGEXP>

— show bgp ipv4 {unicast | labeled-unicast} regexp <REGEXP>

Description
Use this command to display unicast route information that match the
Autonomous System (AS) path regular expression within an IPv4 environment.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— BGP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

REGEXP A regular-expression to match the BGP AS paths.

918 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Options

ipv4 Sets IPv4 address family.

unicast Indicates the address family modifier as unicast.

labeled-unicast Indicates the address family modifier as labeled-unicast.

Examples
Displaying unicast route information that match the AS path regular expression:
ML66#show bgp ipv4 unicast regexp myexpression

99.29 show bgp summary

Synopsis

— show bgp summary

— show bgp ipv4 {unicast | labeled-unicast} summary

Description
Use this command to display BGP neighbor status summary.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— BGP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Options

ipv4 Sets IPv4 address family.

unicast Indicates the address family modifier as unicast.

labeled-unicast Indicates the address family modifier as labeled-unicast.

Examples
Display BGP neighbor status summary:
ML66#show bgp ipv4 unicast summary

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 919


CLI Descriptions

99.30 show bgp vpnv4 all

Synopsys

— show bgp vpnv4 all [{<NETWORK> | summary | tags}]

Description
Use this command to display information about all VPNv4 NLRIs.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— BGP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

NETWORK The network of which the information is displayed in the


BGP routing table. The format is <A.B.C.D>.

Options

summary Displays the summary BGP neighbor status.

tags Displays BGP tags for prefixes.

Examples
ML66>show bgp vpnv4 all summary

99.31 show bgp vpnv4 details

Synopsys

— show bgp vpnv4 details

Description
Use this command to display detailed information about all VPNv4 Routes.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

920 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

— BGP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
ML66>show bgp vpnv4 details

99.32 show bgp vpnv4 rd

Synopsys

— show bgp vpnv4 rd <RD> [{<NETWORK> | label | summary}]

Description
Use this command to display information for a VPNv4 Route Distinguisher.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— BGP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

RD The unique Route Distinguisher (RD) value on the router


as follows:
— An Autonomous System (AS) number and an
arbitrary number. For example, 100:1.

— A 32-bit IP address and an arbitrary number. For


example, 192.16.10.1:1.

NETWORK The network of which the information is displayed in the


BGP routing table. The format is <A.B.C.D>.

Options

label Displays BGP tags for prefixes.

summary Displays the summary of BGP neighbor status.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 921


CLI Descriptions

Examples
ML66>show bgp vpnv4 rd 100:1 summary

99.33 show bgp vpnv4 vrf

Synopsys

— show bgp vpnv4 vrf <VRF> [{<NETWORK> | label | summary}]

Description
Use this command to display BGP VPNv4 routing or forwarding instance
information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— BGP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

VRF The name of the VRF instance.

NETWORK The network of which the information is displayed in the


BGP routing table. The format is <A.B.C.D>.

Options

label Displays Multiprotocol Label Switching (MPLS) labels for


prefixes.

summary Displays the summary BGP neighbor status.

Examples
ML66>show bgp vpnv4 vrf vrf_1 label

99.34 show board

Synopsis
show board <R/S> [status | hw | eeprom | config]

922 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Description
Use this command to display configuration information for a board.

Use the command without any options to display all information.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

R/S The Rack and Slot values, where the format is <Rack/
Slot>.

Options

status Displays the status of the board.

hw Displays hardware configuration information.

eeprom Displays EEPROM configuration information.

config Displays configuration information.

Examples
Displaying the hardware configuration for 1/6:
ML66>show board 1/6
EEPROM identifiers:
Board Product Number: ROJ 208 1323/1
Board Revision: P1E
Product Serial Number: A2310FN9LD
Date of Manufacturing: 20160720
Place of Manufacturing: A23
SPI CPLD Product Number: CDAR 101 027/22
SPI CPLD Revision: R1A04
Primary/First MAC Address: AC:60:B6:9F:D3:7B
PCI FPGA Product Number:
PCI FPGA Revision:
Power Capability: 0
TDM BB Variant: 15
Load Module SW Product: CXP 902 9630/1
Load Module SW Min Rev: R1A01
Last MAC Address: AC:60:B6:9F:D3:AA
PRI Status:
APV-NP/NPV: 1

Displaying the hardware configuration for LTU 1002 1/11 with ETSI:
ML66>show board 1/11
EEPROM identifiers:
Board Product Number: ROJ 119 2518/1
Board Revision: R1D
Product Serial Number: A2310G46XQ
Date of Manufacturing: 20170710
Place of Manufacturing: A23
SPI CPLD Product Number: CDAR 101 027/31
SPI CPLD Revision: R1A07

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 923


CLI Descriptions

Primary/First MAC Address: 34:6E:9D:45:26:B7


PCI FPGA Product Number:
PCI FPGA Revision:
Power Capability: 0
TDM BB Variant: 13
Load Module SW Product: CXP 903 4290/1
Load Module SW Min Rev: R1A01
Last MAC Address:
PRI Status:
APV-NP/NPV: 1
Supported Board Profiles:
[Profile ID] [Description]
1 PDH and SDH
2 PDH and CES
3 (active) CES only

Displaying the hardware configuration for ETU 1002 1/2:


ML66>show board 1/2
EEPROM identifiers:
Board Product Number: ROJ 119 2529/1
Board Revision: P1B
Product Serial Number: A2310G5D3T
Date of Manufacturing: 20180815
Place of Manufacturing: A23
SPI CPLD Product Number: CDAR 101 027/26
SPI CPLD Revision: R2A
Primary/First MAC Address: 34:6E:9D:46:10:F4
PCI FPGA Product Number:
PCI FPGA Revision:
Power Capability: 0
TDM BB Variant: 13
Load Module SW Product: CDA 102 0659/2
Load Module SW Min Rev: R1A01
Last MAC Address:
PRI Status:
APV-NP/NPV: 1
Supported Board Profiles:
[Profile ID] [Description]
1 4x1G
2 1x10G

99.35 show bridge-basics

Synopsis
show bridge-basics

Description
Use this command to display the basic bridge configuration.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying basic bridge configuration:
ML66>show bridge-basics

924 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

99.36 show bridge-port

Synopsis
show bridge-port [<RSP>]

Description
Use this command to display bridge-port configuration.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Bridging and Switching

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port value of the bridge port where
the format is <Rack/Slot/Port>.

Examples
Displaying bridge-port information:
ML66>show bridge-port 1/6/5

99.37 show bridge-port

Synopsis
show bridge-port

Description
Use this command to display bridge port settings of the interface.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Interfaces

Command Mode
Ethernet interface configuration submode — (config-eth)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 925


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Displaying bridge port setting of the interface:
ML66(config-eth)#show bridge-port

99.38 show capability vrf-lite

Synopsis
show capability vrf-lite

Description
Use this command to display Virtual Routing and Forwarding lite (VRF-lite)
support status.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Router Basic Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying VRF-lite support status:
ML66>show capability vrf-lite
VRF-Lite is disabled

99.39 show carrier-termination

Synopsis
show carrier-termination

Description
Use this command to display the Carrier Termination (CT) configuration.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— Carrier Termination Commands MMU 1001 and MMU 1002

926 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

— Carrier Termination Commands: MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 – Carrier

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Examples
Displaying CT configuration:
ML66(config-ct)#show carrier-termination
Carrier Termination 1/1/1
--------------------------------------------
distinguished-name: CT 1/1/1
description: CT 1/1/1
status: Up(3)
frame-id: 259
carrier-id: C(4)
selected-min-acm: acm64QAMStd(11)
actual-tx-acm: acm512QAMStd(20)
selected-max-acm: acm512QAMStd(20)
reference-sec: SEC4l(3)
wanted-licensed-capacity[kb/s]: 80000
actual-licensed-capacity[kb/s]: 100000
actual-tx-capacity[kb/s]: 80000
polarization: Horizontal(2)
xpic-status NotApplicable(5)
mimo-status: NotApplicable(5)
actual-snir: 486
actual-xpi: Unknown
auto-remove-loop-enable: Disabled(2)
ber-alarm-treshold: Ber1e3(2)
actual-rx-acm: acm512QAMStd(20)
if-loop: Disable(3)
rf-loop: Disable(3)
channel-spacing[MHz] 40
frame-format-type standard
available-min-capacity[kb/s] 53352
available-max-capacity[kb/s] 334507
available-min-acm 4QAMStrong
available-max-acm 1024QAML66ight
selected-min-capacity[kb/s] 53352
selected-max-capacity[kb/s] 334507

99.40 show carrier-termination-capability

Synopsis
show carrier-termination-capability

Description
Use this command to display Carrier Termination (CT) capability information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— Carrier Termination Commands MMU 1001 and MMU 1002

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 927


CLI Descriptions

— Carrier Termination Commands: MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 – Carrier

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Examples
Displaying CT capability information:
ML66(config-ct)#show carrier-termination-capability
Available Frame-id, ChannelSpace, Capacity and ACMProfile
-------------------------------------------------------------
Frameid: 256
-----------------------------------
ChannelSpace: chsp7MHz
Modulation Capacity [Kb/s]
-----------------------------------
qam4Strong(1) 18594
qam4Std(2) 21693
qam16Strong(4) 37189
qam16Std(5) 43387
qam32Std(8) 54408
qam64Std(11) 68179
qam128Std(14) 80575
qam256Std(17) 92972
qam512Std(20) 99170
qam512Light(21) 105368
Frameid: 257
-----------------------------------
ChannelSpace: chsp14MHz
Modulation Capacity [Kb/s]
-----------------------------------
qam4Strong(1) 18594
qam4Std(2) 21693
qam16Strong(4) 37189
qam16Std(5) 43387
qam32Std(8) 54408
qam64Std(11) 68179
qam128Std(14) 80575
qam256Std(17) 92972
qam512Std(20) 99170
qam512Light(21) 105368

99.41 show ces server

Synopsis

— show ces server [<RSC>]

— show ces server <RSC> pw [<ID>]

928 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Description
Use this command to display available Circuit Emulation Service (CES) servers
and the Pseudo-Wires (PWs) available on them.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— CES Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

RSC The Rack, Slot, and CesServerId values of the CES server,
in the following format: <Rack/Slot/CesServerId>.

ID The ID of the PW.

Options

pw Specifies to display the PWs available on the CES server.

Examples
Displaying all the available CES servers:
ML66>show ces server
CES server | Ports | Free | Source MAC address
1/1/101 | 16 | 10 | 98:c5:db:78:17:d3 (HW)

Displaying the configuration of CES server 1/11/101:


ML66>show ces server 1/11/101
ces server 1/11/101
mac-address aa:aa:aa:aa:aa:11
pw satop 1
name "1/11/101 1"
description ""
tdm-profile 1
timing-input recovered
encap eth
remote-mac aa:aa:aa:aa:aa:12
receive-ecid 11
transmit-ecid 12
no vlan
exit
no shutdown
exit
exit

Displaying the PWs available on CES server 1/1/101:


ML66>show ces server 1/11/101 pw
Pseudo Wire | Associated E1 | Admin status | Oper status | Summary | Name →
| Description
PW 1/1/101 1 | E1 1/1/101 1 | Down | Down | N/A | 1/1/101 1 →
| -------
PW 1/1/101 2 | E1 1/1/101 2 | Down | Down | N/A | 1/1/101 2 →

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 929


CLI Descriptions

|
PW 1/1/101 3 | E1 1/1/101 3 | Up | Down | N/A | 1/1/101 3 →
| IWF loop 1
PW 1/1/101 4 | E1 1/1/101 4 | Up | Down | N/A | 1/1/101 4 →
| IWF loop 2
PW 1/1/101 5 | E1 1/1/101 5 | Down | Down | N/A | 1/1/101 5 →
|
PW 1/1/101 6 | E1 1/1/101 6 | Down | Down | N/A | 1/1/101 6 →
|

Displaying the status of PW 2 on CES server 1/1/101:


ML66>show ces server 1/11/101 pw 2
CES Pseudo Wire 1/1/101 2 status
Oper status Down
Admin status Down
Name 1/1/101 2
Description
Type E1 SAToP
Timing Recovered
TDM profile TDM profile 2
PSN type Ethernet
Trap Enabled
CES Pseudo Wire 1/1/101 2 Ethernet configuration
Source MAC address 98:c5:db:78:17:d3
Destination MAC address 00:00:00:00:00:00
Receive ECID 4
Transmit ECID 0
VLAN tagging disabled

99.42 show ces tdm-profile

Synopsis
show ces tdm-profile [<ID> [status]]

Description
Use this command to display available TDM configuration profiles.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— CES Commands

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Operands

ID The ID of the TDM configuration profile.

Examples
Displaying all the available TDM profiles:
ML66#show ces tdm-profile
Index | Name | Used by PWs

930 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

1 | TDM profile one | 1/1/101 1, 1/4/101 16


2 | TDM profile two | -

Displaying TDM profile 1:


ML66#show ces tdm-profile 1
ces tdm-profile 1
name "IWF loop"
payload-size 256
packet-reorder
jtr-bfr-size 1792
! jitter-buffer-size 7
jtr-bfr-depth 3000
! jitter-buffer-playout-level 3
no payload-suppression
lops-clear-threshold 10
lops-set-threshold 10
packet-replace-policy allOnes
clock-recovery-mode adaptive

Displaying the status of TDM profile 1:


ML66#show ces tdm-profile 1 status
CES TDM Config profile details
Index 1
Name IWF loop
Payload size 256 bytes
Jitter buffer size 7 pkt
1792 bytes
1792.000 ms
Jitter buffer playout level 3 pkt
768 bytes
3.000 ms
Payload-suppression disabled
LOPS clear threshold 10 pkt
LOPS set threshold 10 pkt
Packet reorder enabled
Packet replace policy Fill with 0xFF bytes
Clock recovery mode Adaptive
Used by Pseudo Wire(s) 1/1/101 3, 1/1/101 4

99.43 show cfm alarms

Synopsis
show cfm alarms

Description
Use this command to display the active Ethernet Service Operation,
Administration, and Maintenance (OAM) alarms.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Maintenance End Point and Maintenance


Intermediate Point Configuration

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 931


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Displaying the active Ethernet Service OAM alarms:
ML66>show cfm alarms

99.44 show cfm ma

Synopsis
show cfm ma { string <MDNAME> [<MANAME> ] | none <LEVEL>
[<MANAME> ] }

Description
Use this command to display a Maintenance Association (MA).

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Maintenance Association Configuration

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

LEVEL The level of the domain.

MANAME The name of the MA.

MDNAME The name of the domain.

Options

none Sets the domain name format type to none.

string Sets the domain name format type to string.

Examples
Displaying an MA with string domain name:
ML66>show cfm ma string MDName

99.45 show cfm md

932 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Synopsis
show cfm md [ string <MDNAME> | none <LEVEL> ]

Description
Use this command to display a Maintenance Domain (MD).

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Maintenance Domain Configuration

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

LEVEL The level of the domain.

MDNAME The name of the domain.

Options

none Sets the domain name format type to none.

string Sets the domain name format type to string.

Examples
Displaying an MD with none domain name:
ML66>show cfm md none 0

99.46 show cfm mep

Synopsis
show cfm mep { string <MDNAME> <MANAME> [<MEPID> ] | none <LEVEL>
<MANAME> [<MEPID> ] }

Description
Use this command to display Maintenance End Points (MEPs).

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 933


CLI Descriptions

— Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Maintenance End Point and Maintenance


Intermediate Point Configuration

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

LEVEL The level of the domain.

MANAME The name of the MA.

MDNAME The name of the domain.

MEPID The ID of the MEP.

Options

none Sets the domain name format type to none.

string Sets the domain name format type to string.

Examples
Displaying a MEP with string domain name:
ML66>show cfm mep string MDName MAName

99.47 show cfm mep-peer

Synopsis
show cfm mep-peer { string <MDNAME> <MANAME> <MEPID> [<RMEPID> ]
| none <LEVEL> <MANAME> <MEPID> [<RMEPID> ] }

Description
Use this command to display Maintenance End Point (MEP) peers or remote
MEPs.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Maintenance End Point and Maintenance


Intermediate Point Configuration

934 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

LEVEL The level of the domain.

MANAME The name of the MA.

MDNAME The name of the domain.

MEPID The ID of the MEP.

RMEPID The ID of the remote MEP.

Options

none Sets the domain name format type to none.

string Sets the domain name format type to string.

Examples
Displaying a remote MEP with none domain name:
ML66>show cfm mep-peer none 0 MAName 1 1

99.48 show cfm mip

Synopsis
show cfm mip { string <MDNAME> <MANAME> [port <RSP> | lag <LAGID> ]
| none <LEVEL> <MANAME> [port <RSP> | lag <LAGID> ] }

Description
Use this command to display a Maintenance Intermediate Point (MIP).

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Maintenance End Point and Maintenance


Intermediate Point Configuration

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 935


CLI Descriptions

Operands

LAGID The Link Aggregation Group (LAG) ID in <Rack/Slot/


Port> format.

LEVEL The level of the domain.

MANAME The name of the MA.

MDNAME The name of the domain.

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port value of the port where the
format is <Rack/Slot/Port> .

Options

none Sets the domain name format type to none.

string Sets the domain name format type to string.

port Specifies the port value.

lag Specifies the LAG ID.

Examples
Displaying a MIP with string domain name:
ML66>show cfm mip string MDName MAName

99.49 show cliprotocol

Synopsis
show cliprotocol

Description
Use this command to display the current CLI protocol setting. The displayed CLI
protocol setting is one of the following:

— telnet

— ssh

936 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the CLI protocol setting:
ML66>show cliprotocol
CLI protocol = telnet

99.50 show clns is-neighbors

Synopsis
show clns [<TAG>] is-neighbors [<IFNAME_RSP_VLAN>] [detail]

Description
Use this command to display all IS neighbor adjacencies.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— IS-IS Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

TAG The routing instance tag.

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN
The Rack, Slot, and Port values and VLAN number of the
L3 VLAN subinterface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/
Port.VLAN>, for example, 1/9/4.500.

Options

detail Displays detailed information.

Examples
ML66>show clns is-neighbors detail
Area is1:
System Id Interface State Type Priority Circuit Id
0000.0000.0001 1/9/4.500 Up L1 64 0000.0000.000
Up L2 64 0000.0000.000
L1 Adjacency ID: 1
L2 Adjacency ID: 2
Uptime: 13:52:00

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 937


CLI Descriptions

Area Address(es): 49
IP Address(es): 40.40.0.3
Topology: IPv4
Level-1 Protocols Supported: IPv4
Level-2 Protocols Supported: IPv4
Adjacency advertisement: Advertise

99.51 show clns neighbors

Synopsis
show clns [<TAG>] neighbors [<IFNAME_RSP_VLAN>] [detail]

Description
Use this command to display IS neighbor adjacencies.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— IS-IS Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

TAG The routing instance tag.

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN
The Rack, Slot, and Port values and VLAN number of the
L3 VLAN subinterface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/
Port.VLAN>, for example, 1/9/4.500.

Options

detail Displays detailed information.

Examples
ML66>show clns neighbors detail
Area is1:
System Id Interface SNPA State Holdtime Type Protocol
0000.0000.0001 1/9/4.500 0000.0CFA.F002 Up 22 L2 IS-IS
Area Address(es): 49.0000
IP Address(es): 10.10.12.50
Uptime: 00:10:17
0000.0000.0099 1/9/4.600 0003.4797.5E4C Up 6 L2 IS-IS
Area Address(es): 00.0001 4900.00
IP Address(es): 10.10.12.99
Uptime: 00:10:16
000F.0000.0002 1/9/4.700 0006.5B0E.D27D Up 27 L1 IS-IS
Up 27 L2 IS-IS
Area Address(es): 49.000f

938 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

IP Address(es): 10.10.12.94
Uptime: 00:06:15

99.52 show clock

Synopsis
show clock

Description
Use this command to display the system date and time.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Basic Configuration Commands

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Examples
Displaying the system clock:
ML66#show clock
Fri Oct 9 15:38:23 CEST 2009

99.53 show config

Synopsis
show config

Description
Use this command to display configuration information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Maintenance Domain Configuration

— Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Maintenance Association Configuration

— Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Maintenance End Point and Maintenance


Intermediate Point Configuration

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 939


CLI Descriptions

— Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Linktrace and Loopback Configuration

Command Mode
Ethernet Service OAM submode — (cfm)

Ethernet Service OAM MD submode — (cfm-md)

Ethernet Service OAM MD MA submode — (cfm-md-ma)

Ethernet Service OAM MD MA MEP submode — (cfm-md-ma-mep)

Examples
Displaying configuration information:
ML66(cfm)#show config

99.54 show config-changed-timer

Synopsis
show config-changed-timer

Description
Use this command to display the value of the timer set for the NE Configuration
Changed event.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Basic Configuration Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the value of the timer set for the NE Configuration Changed event:
ML66>show config-changed-timer

99.55 show config-validation-info

940 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Synopsis
show config-validation-info source ftp

Description
Use this command to view information about the configuration file copied to the
node from local FTP before applying the configuration.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— Installation Mode Commands

— Software, Configuration, and Log File Handling Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying startup-configuration on local FTP:
ML66>config-validation-info source ftp
----------------------------------------
File: Loaded from FTP
----------------------------------------
NE Name: ML66-192-168-0-1
Created: Default
----------------------------------------
DCN Settings
DCN-Mode: vlan(3)
IP Host address: 10.80.45.214
IP Host Subnet Mask: 255.255.255.0
----------------------------------------
Hardware Inventory
Backplane Product Number: ROJR 609 006/1
Backplane Revision: R1E

Position Product Number Release


1 ROJR 219 014/1 R1A
3 ROJ 208 357/1 R1A
4 ROJ 208 357/1 R1C
7 ROJR 211 006/2 R1A
8 ROJR 211 007/1 P1B
----------------------------------------

99.56 show confirm

Synopsis
show confirm { ip | ip6 }

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 941


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to display the confirmed IP address.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— LAN-DCN Interface Commands

— DCN Loopback Interface Commands

— DCN Local Access (USB) Interface Commands

— L3 VLAN Subinterface Commands

— Router Loopback Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Options

ip Selects the confirmed IPv4 address.

ip6 Selects the confirmed IPv6 address.

Examples
Displaying the confirmed IPv4 address:
ML66>show confirm ip

99.57 show confirm timer

Synopsis
show confirm timer

Description
Some commands can cause loss of the Data Communication Network (DCN)
channel. After running such a command you have to save your configurations
within 15 minutes or the NE makes a warm restart, restoring the saved
configurations, and your unconfirmed changes are lost. Use this command to
display the remaining time until a configuration confirmation must be done. For
more information, see CLI User Guide.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

942 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

— Basic and Navigation Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the status of the confirm timer:
ML66>show confirm timer
confirm timer is not running!

In the example, confirm timer is not running! means that there are no
configuration changes that need to be confirmed.

See Also
write

99.58 show connect-cc

Synopsis
show connect-cc

Description
Use this command to display TDM cross-connections.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— TDM Cross-Connection Commands

— CES Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying TDM cross-connections:
ML66>show connect-cc
Cross connections
Interface1 Interface2 Name
-----------------------------------------------

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 943


CLI Descriptions

1/12/101 1 1/12/1D
1/11/101 1 1/11/1A

99.59 show copy

Synopsis
show copy

Description
Use this command to display the status of ongoing software upgrades.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Software, Configuration, and Log File Handling Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the status of ongoing software upgrades:
ML66#show copy
Command: copy ftp filename /tn_system_release/ml_tn_software/CXP9036600_1/CXP9036 →
600_1_MINI-LINK_6600_6366_1.3_R4A190 flash nowait
Status: Downloading
Progress: 93%

99.60 show counters

Synopsis
show counters

Description
Use this command to display the Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) interface
level counters of the current Ethernet interface.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: LLDP

944 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Command Mode
LLDP interface level configuration submode — (config-lldp)

Examples
Displaying the LLDP interface level counters of the Ethernet interface:
ML66(config-lldp)#show counters
LAN 1/6/4
Tx Frames total : 34
Rx Frames total : 33
Rx Frames discarded : 0
Rx Frames error : 0
Unknown TLVs total : 0
Ageouts total : 0

99.61 show current

Synopsis
show current

Description
Use this command to display current mode settings.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— LAN-DCN Interface Commands

— DCN Loopback Interface Commands

— DCN Local Access (USB) Interface Commands

— L3 VLAN Subinterface Commands

— Router Loopback Interface Commands

— Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Bridging and Switching

— Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Ring Protection

— Ethernet Commands: QoS - Scheduling

— Ethernet Commands: QoS - WRED

— Ethernet Commands: HQoS - Node and Profile Configuration Commands

— Ethernet Commands: LLDP

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 945


CLI Descriptions

— Performance Monitoring Commands

— Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Ethernet Bandwidth Notification

— Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: Clock Port Configuration

— Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: Unicast and Multicast


Configuration

— Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: Unicast Master Configuration

— CES Commands

Command Mode
All Ethernet Configuration submodes

For displaying Circuit Emulation Service (CES) configuration, CES Server


configuration submode — (config-ces-server).

For displaying CES TDM profile configuration, CES TDM Profile configuration
submode — (config-ces-tdm-profile).

Examples
Displaying current mode settings for Weighted Random Early Detection (WRED):
ML66(config-wred-profile)#show current
wred-profile 1 (read-only)
name StandardWRED
number-of-users 0
minThreshold 15 * 64 KByte(s)
maxThreshold 48 * 64 KByte(s)
p-mark 10 %
exponentWeight 9

Displaying current mode settings for scheduler:


ML66(config-scheduler-profile)#show current
scheduler-profile 5
name NEW_SCHEDULER_PROFILE
number-of-users 0
tc-queue 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
scheduler-type strict strict strict strict strict dwrr dwrr dwrr
weight - - - - - 3 1 1

Displaying current mode settings for QinQ:


ML66(config-qinqtermination)#show current
+-----------------------------+
| Interface | CeId | PeId |
+-----------------------------+
| LAN 1/6/4 | 100 | 201 |
+-----------------------------+

Displaying information about the current Ethernet Ring Protection (ERP)


configuration:

946 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

ML66(erp-group)#show current
erp-group 2 raps-vlan 200
description "erp-ring-1"
timer hold-off 0
timer guard 500
raps vlan-priority 7
raps ring-mdl 7
raps subring-raps vraps
erp-port east role normal
erp-port east bind interface-name 1/6/4
no erp-port east rmep
erp-port west role normal
erp-port west bind interface-name 1/6/8
no erp-port west rmep
alarm link-loss
no alarm unable-to-protect
alarm protocol-error
enable
exit

Displaying the current Ethernet Bandwidth Notification settings:


ML66(bnm)#show current
bandwidth-notification
interface 1/6/1
format itu-t
hold-time 1s
interval 10s
priority 4
level 5
portID 32442
enable
send
full-link-message always
failed-link-message
send-frequently-after-hold-time

Displaying the LLDP configuration for the current interface:


ML66(config-lldp)#show current
interface ethernet 1/6/4
! LLDP configuration
lldp dest-mac-address nearest-bridge
admin-status tx-and-rx
tlvs-tx-enable sys-name
tlvs-tx-enable sys-desc
tlvs-tx-enable man-addr-ipv4
exit

Listing the HQoS child nodes of a parent node:


ML66(config-hqos-node)#show current

Listing the HQoS nodes of a profile:


ML66(config-hqos-profile)#show current

Listing all QoS related profiles, including HQoS ones:


ML66(config-ethernet-profiles)#show current

Displaying the current CES configuration:


ML66(config-ces-server)#show current
ces tdm-profile 3
name "TDM profile 3"
payload-size 256
packet-reorder
rtp-header
jtr-bfr-size 1536
! jitter-buffer-size 6

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 947


CLI Descriptions

jtr-bfr-depth 3000
! jitter-buffer-playout-level 3
no payload-suppression
lops-clear-threshold 4
lops-set-threshold 10
packet-replace-policy allOnes
timestamp-mode differential

Displaying the current CES TDM profile configuration:


ML66(config-ces-tdm-profile)#show current
ces tdm-profile 1
name "IWF loop"
payload-size 256
packet-reorder
jtr-bfr-size 1792
! jitter-buffer-size 7
jtr-bfr-depth 3000
! jitter-buffer-playout-level 3
no payload-suppression
lops-clear-threshold 10
lops-set-threshold 10
packet-replace-policy allOnes
clock-recovery-mode adaptive

99.62 show dcn-mode

Synopsis
show dcn-mode

Description
Use this command to display the current DCN mode.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— DCN Basic Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the DCN mode:
ML66>show dcn-mode
dcn-mode vlan

99.63 show dcn-lan-ctag

Synopsis
show dcn-lan-ctag

948 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Description
Use this command to display double tagged Data Communication Network
(DCN) traffic on Provider Bridge.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— DCN Basic Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying double tagged DCN traffic:
ML66>show dcn-lan-ctag

99.64 show debug

Synopsis
show debug {bfd | bgp | hal | imi | isis | ldp | nsm | ospf | rsvp}

Description
Use this command to display debugging configuration.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Router Basic Commands

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode, at admin level — #

Options

bfd Displays the debugging configuration of Bidirectional


Forwarding Detection (BFD).

hal Extra logging for Hardware Abstraction Layer (HAL).

bgp Displays the debugging configuration of Border Gateway


Protocol (BGP).

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 949


CLI Descriptions

imi Displays the debugging configuration of Integrated


Management Interface (IMI).

isis Displays the debugging configuration of Intermediate


System–Intermediate System (IS-IS).

ldp Displays the debugging configuration of Label


Distribution Protocol (LDP).

nsm Displays the debugging configuration of Network


Services Manager (NSM).

ospf Displays the debugging configuration of Open Shortest


Path First (OSPF).

rsvp Extra logging for Reservation Protocol (RSVP).

Examples
Displaying the debugging configuration of BFD:
ML66>show debug bfd

99.65 show dm

Synopsis
show dm [ 15m [<INTERVAL> ] | 24h [<INTERVAL> ] ]

Description
Use this command to display Delay Measurement (DM) statistics.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Session Configuration

Command Mode
Ethernet Service OAM MD MA MEP PM submode — (cfm-md-ma-mep-pm)

Operands

INTERVAL The number of the completed interval. The valid range is


1–96, where 1 is the most recently completed interval.

950 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Options

15m Displays DM 15 minute interval statistics.

24h Displays DM 24 hour statistics.

Examples
Displaying DM statistics:
ML66(cfm-md-ma-mep-pm)#show dm 15m 1
[15m] History Delay Measurement Result (1 of 1):
[start_time:2012-09-11 02:59:50 , end_time:2012-09-11 03:00:00]
Interval number : 1
Configured DMM interval : 1 s
Configured Delay Percentile : 90 %
Configured Delay Variation : 90 %
Configured Delay Threshold : 100 ms
Configured Delay Var Threshold : 100 ms
Valid : FALSE
Sent DMM Num : 10
Received DMR_OK Num : 10
Received DMR_NOK Num : 0
Min Delay : 2597.000 us
Max Delay : 4318.000 us
Average Delay : 2792.300 us
90-percentile Delay : 4318.000 us
Min Delay Variation : 5.000 us
Max Delay Variation : 1721.000 us
Average Delay Variation : 218.222 us
90-percentile Delay Variation : 1721.000 us

99.66 show enableLocalUsers

Synopsis
show enableLocalUsers

Description
Use this command to display the status of local users (admin_user and
view_user) when centralized authentication is configured.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the status of local users when centralized authentication is
configured:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 951


CLI Descriptions

ML66>show enableLocalUsers
local users status is enabled

99.67 show epl

Synopsis
show epl

Description
Use this command to display configured Layer 1 connections.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Bridging and Switching

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying Layer 1 Connection:
ML66#show epl
ethernet-epl port1 1/6/4 port2 1/1/1
no llf-enable

99.68 show erp-group

Synopsis
show erp-group [<RINGID> ]

Description
Use this command to display the configured Ethernet Ring Protection (ERP)
rings.

Use <RINGID> operand to display a selected ERP ring.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Ring Protection

952 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

RINGID The ID of the selected ring.

Examples
Displaying all configured ERP rings:
ML66#show erp-group
ID VLAN Port East Port West Status Description
----- ----- ---------- ---------- --------- -------------------
1 0 1/9/4 1/9/8 Disabled
----- ----- ---------- ---------- --------- -------------------
Total ERP ring count: 1

99.69 show ferlt

Synopsis
show ferlt

Description
Use this command to display the Radio Link Terminal (RLT) configuration at far
end.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Radio Link Terminal Commands: MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 – RLT

Command Mode
Far End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-ferlt)

Examples
Displaying the RLT configuration at far end:
ML66(config-ferlt)#show ferlt
R/S/P: 1/1/1
distinguished-name: FRLT 1/1/1
ne-ip-address: 10.120.54.62
ne-ipv6-address:
ne-name: ML66-TN62
ne-type: MINI-LINK Traffic Node
id: Milano
expected-far-end-id: RLT 1/1/1
far-end-id-check: disable
status: up
mode: 2+0RLB
actual-tx-total-capacity[kbps]: 533518000

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 953


CLI Descriptions

actual-tx-packet-capacity[kbps]: 427612000
limited-total-capacity[kbps]: 0
protection-switch-mode: manual
protection-status: unprotected
revertive-preferred-tx: off
revertive-wait-to-restore[seconds]: 0
fade-notification-timer[seconds]: 200
tx-switch-over-far-end: RLTNOTSUP

Displaying the RLT configuration at far end in case of EQP configuration:


ML66(config-rlt)#show ferlt
R/S/P: 1/3/1
distinguished-name: FRLT 1/1+3/1
ne-ip-address: 10.120.54.112
ne-ipv6-address:
ne-name: ML66-10-120-54-112
ne-type: MINI-LINK Traffic Node
id: RLT 1/1+3/1
expected-far-end-id:
far-end-id-check: disable
status: down
mode: 1+1RLP
actual-tx-total-capacity[kbps]: 0
actual-tx-packet-capacity[kbps]: 0
limited-total-capacity[kbps]: 0
protection-switch-mode: manual
protection-status: protected
revertive-preferred-tx: off
revertive-wait-to-restore[seconds]: 0
fade-notification-timer[seconds]: 200
tx-switch-over-far-end: RLTNOTSUP
eqp-protection-switch-mode: manual
eqp-active-unit: low-unit
eqp-distinguished-name: 1/1+3/1

99.70 show fetdm

Synopsis
show fetdm

Description
Use this command to display information regarding TDM at far end.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Radio Link Terminal Commands: MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 – TDM

Command Mode
Far End Radio Link Terminal TDM submode — (config-ferlt-fetdm)

Examples
Displaying TDM information at far end:
ML66(config-ferlt-fetdm)#show fetdm
R/S/P: 1/1/1
tdm-connect: enable

954 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

actual-tdm-tributaries: 50
wanted-tributaries-allocation: 1-50
actual-tributaries-allocation: 1-50
distinguished-name: FTDM 1/1/1
available-tdm-tributaries: 0

99.71 show file-integrity-alarm

Synopsis
show file-integrity-alarm

Description
Use this command to display the status of the file integrity monitoring function.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the status of the file integrity monitoring function:
ML66>show file-integrity-alarm

99.72 show ftpprotocol

Synopsis
show ftpprotocol

Description
Use this command to display the current default FTP protocol setting. The
displayed FTP protocol setting is one of the following:

— ftp

— sftp

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 955


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Displaying the default FTP protocol setting:
ML66>show ftpprotocol
Default FTP protocol = FTP

99.73 show ftp active

Synopsis
show ftp active

Description
Use this command to display the associated FTP server for all services.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the associated FTP server for all services:
ML66#show ftp active
Service name FTP server ID name
Audit log 1 remotehost
Config automatic backup 1 remotehost
Config load 3 mlftp
Config report 1 remotehost
Diagnostics log 1 remotehost
Directory list 1 remotehost
Error log 1 remotehost
File Integrity upload 1 remotehost
File Integrity view 1 remotehost
License install 1 remotehost
License report 1 remotehost
NE Performance 1 remotehost
NTP key 1 remotehost
SOAM Performance 1 remotehost
Software upgrade 3 mlftp

99.74 show ftp activeftp

Synopsis
show ftp activeftp

Description
Use this command to display the default FTP server.

956 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the default FTP server:
ML66>show ftp activeftp
FTP server ID name
1 remotehost

99.75 show ftp configtable

Synopsis
show ftp configtable

Description
Use this command to display the FTP server entries of the FTP configuration
table.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the FTP configuration table:
ML66#show ftp configtable
ID host/IPaddr port user conn name
1 10.0.0.2 21 anonymous 2 remotehost
2 10.0.0.2 21 anonymous 2 localhost
3 10.20.30.1 21 ericsson 2 mlftp

99.76 show history

Synopsis
show history

Description
Use this command to display the commands used during the current session. For
more information, see CLI User Guide.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 957


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the command history:
ML66>show history
show interface
enable
debug ospf ifsm events
no debug ospf ifsm events
show history

99.77 show igmp snooping

Synopsis
show igmp snooping

Description
Use this command to display the global status of Internet Group Management
Protocol (IGMP) snooping on the NE.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— IGMP and MLD Snooping Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the global status of IGMP snooping:
ML66>show igmp snooping
IGMP snooping Admin State: Enabled
IGMP snooping Oper State: Up

99.78 show igmp snooping config

Synopsis
show igmp snooping config

958 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Description
Use this command to display Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP)
snooping configuration.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— IGMP and MLD Snooping Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying IGMP snooping configuration:
ML66>show igmp snooping config
igmp snooping enable
igmp snooping vlan 10
proxy-reporting
query-interval 125
robust 2
exit

99.79 show igmp snooping group

Synopsis
show igmp snooping group [<GRPADDR> [source <SRCADDR>]] vlan
<VLANID> [ctag <CVID>]

Description
Use this command to display a list of Internet Group Management Protocol
(IGMP) multicast groups and the associated member ports on a specific VLAN.

Use the optional <GRPADDR> and <SRCADDR> operands to display detailed


port membership information for a specific multicast group or channel.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— IGMP and MLD Snooping Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

GRPADDR Specifies the multicast group address.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 959


CLI Descriptions

SRCADDR Specifies the IP address of the multicast source.

VLANID The VLAN identification number in the outer VLAN tag.


The valid range is 1–4094.

CVID The C-VID identification number in the inner VLAN tag.


The valid range is 1–4094.

Options

source The IP address of the multicast source.

ctag The customer VLAN tag.

Examples
Displaying the list of multicast groups and channels on VLAN 10:
ML66>show igmp snooping group vlan 10
VLAN:10 CVLAN:-
Group Addr: 239.195.7.1, Source Addr: 10.1.1.1, Members: 1/6/4
Group Addr: 239.195.7.1, Source Addr: 10.2.2.2, Members: 1/6/4
Group Addr: 239.195.7.2, Source Addr: * , Members: 1/6/4,1/1/2

Displaying detailed information for multicast group 239.195.7.2 on VLAN 10:


ML66>show igmp snooping group 239.195.7.2 vlan 10
Multicast Group details
Group Addr: 239.195.7.2, Source Addr: *, VLAN/CVLAN: 10/-
LAN 1/6/4 Expires: 198 s, Uptime: 00:26:59
WAN 1/1/2 Expires: 195 s, Uptime: 00:03:23

99.80 show igmp snooping mrouter

Synopsis
show igmp snooping mrouter [vlan <VLANID> [ctag <CVID>]]

Description
Use this command to display the multicast router ports on a specific VLAN.

Use this command without the vlan option to display multicast router ports on all
Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) snooping enabled VLANs.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— IGMP and MLD Snooping Commands

960 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

VLANID The VLAN identification number in the outer VLAN tag.


The valid range is 1–4094.

CVID The C-VID identification number in the inner VLAN tag.


The valid range is 1–4094.

Options

ctag The customer VLAN tag.

Examples
Displaying multicast router ports of VLAN 10:
ML66>show igmp snooping mrouter vlan 10
Multicast router ports
VLAN:10 CVLAN:-
LAN 1/6/4 Expires: 105 s, Uptime: 00:26:21

99.81 show igmp snooping vlan

Synopsis
show igmp snooping vlan <VLANID> [ctag <CVID>] [counter]

Description
Use this command to display IGMP snooping status on a specific VLAN.

Use the counter option to also display the per VLAN port IGMP message
counters.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— IGMP and MLD Snooping Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

VLANID The VLAN identification number in the outer VLAN tag.


The valid range is 1–4094.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 961


CLI Descriptions

CVID The C-VID identification number in the inner VLAN tag.


The valid range is 1–4094.

Options

ctag The customer VLAN tag.

counter Displays the port counters.

Examples
Displaying IGMP snooping status of VLAN 10:
ML66>show igmp snooping vlan 10 counter
VLAN:10 CVLAN:-
Querier address: 0.0.0.72
Querier version: 3
Query interval: 125 s
Robustness variable: 2
Query response interval: 10 s
Group count: 3
Router port count: 1
IGMP counters
LAN 1/6/4
Joins received: 254
Leaves received: 0
Gen.queries received: 121
Spec.queries sent: 0
Spec.queries received: 0
Invalid IGMP msg. rec.: 0
WAN 1/1/2
Joins received: 123
Leaves received: 0
Gen.queries received: 0
Spec.queries sent: 0
Spec.queries received: 0
Invalid IGMP msg. rec.: 0

99.82 show interface

Synopsis

— show interface [<IFNAME_RSP> | lo-dcn]

— show interface {lan-dcn | local-access} [<IFNAME_RSP>]

— show interface host [ip | ipv6]

— show interface [<IFNAME_VLAN> | <IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> |


<IFNAME_RSP_H> | lo | lo.<VRF> | router]

Description
Use this command to display the configuration and counter values of a DCN IP or
a router interface.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

962 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

— LAN-DCN Interface Commands

— DCN Loopback Interface Commands

— DCN Local Access (USB) Interface Commands

— Serial (PPP) Interface Commands

— L3 Interface Commands

— Router Loopback Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode —>

Operands

IFNAME_RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port values of the DCN IP interface,
where the format is <Rack/Slot/Port>, for example,
1/6/0.

IFNAME_VLAN The VLAN number of the L3 VLAN interface, where the


format is vlan.<VLAN>, for example, vlan.100.

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN
The Rack, Slot, and Port values and VLAN number of the
L3 VLAN subinterface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/
Port.VLAN>, for example, 1/6/4.500.

IFNAME_RSP_H The Rack, Slot, Port, and Hierarchy values of the serial
(PPP) interface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/Port-
Hierarchy>, for example, 1/5/5-RS:D1-3.

Options

lan-dcn Displays the parameters of the LAN-DCN interface.

lo-dcn Displays the parameters of the DCN loopback interface.

local-access Displays parameters of the Local Access (USB) interface.

host Displays the IPv4 or the IPv6 host interface configuration


(defaults to IPv4).

lo Displays parameters of the router loopback interface.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 963


CLI Descriptions

lo.VRF Displays parameters of the loopback interface of a Virtual


Routing and Forwarding (VRF) instance, for example
lo.vrf_1

router Displays the parameters of the LAN-DCNDisplays


parameters of all router interfaces, including loopback
and L3 VLAN subinterfaces.

Examples
Displaying the configuration of the LAN-DCN interface:
ML66#show interface lan-dcn
Interface LAN-DCN 1/9/0
Hardware is Ethernet Current HW addr: ac60.b699.ab89
Physical:ac60.b699.ab89
speed 100 mtu 1500
<ENABLED,UP>
inet 10.41.97.22/23 broadcast 10.41.97.255
inet6 2005::21/64
input packets 11087, bytes 1331883, discarded 0, error 0
output packets 6192, bytes 1111232, discarded 0, error 0

Displaying the configuration of the DCN loopback interface:


ML66#show interface lo-dcn
Interface LO-DCN
Hardware is Loopback
<ENABLED,UP>
inet 10.1.54.1/32

Displaying the configuration of the Local Access (USB) interface:


ML66#show interface local-access
Interface LOCAL-ACCESS 1/9/1
Hardware is USB Current HW addr: 3220.ab46.4aef
Physical:3220.ab46.4aef
speed 12 mtu 1500
<ENABLED,UP>
inet 10.0.0.1/30 broadcast 10.0.0.3
inet6 2001:db8::/127
input packets 228, bytes 46035, discarded 0, error 0
output packets 280, bytes 37668, discarded 0, error 0

Displaying the configuration and counters of the router loopback interface:


ML66#show interface lo
Interface lo
Hardware is Loopback index 4001 metric 1 mtu 16436 duplex-full arp ageing timeo →
ut 0
<UP,LOOPBACK,RUNNING>
VRF Binding: Not bound
Label switching is disabled
Administrative Group(s): None
inet 127.0.0.1/8
input packets 4, bytes 304
output packets 4, bytes 304

Displaying the configuration and counters of an L3 VLAN interface:


ML66#show interface vlan.100
Interface ip vlan.100
Hardware is VLAN Current HW addr: ac60.b699.ab8d
Physical:ac60.b699.ab8d
index 8 metric 1 mtu 1500 duplex-full arp ageing timeout 180
<UP,BROADCAST,RUNNING,MULTICAST>
VRF Binding: Not bound

964 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Label switching is disabled


Administrative Group(s): None
Bandwidth 1g
inet 10.20.19.30/24 broadcast 10.20.19.255
input packets 0, bytes 0
output packets 0, bytes 0

Displaying the configuration and counters of an L3 VLAN subinterface:


ML66#show interface 1/6/4.400
Interface ip 1/6/4.400 (untagged)
Hardware is Ethernet Current HW addr: ac60.b699.ab90
Physical:ac60.b699.ab90
index 5 metric 1 mtu 1500 duplex-full arp ageing timeout 180
<UP,BROADCAST,MULTICAST>
VRF Binding: Not bound
Label switching is disabled
Administrative Group(s): None
Bandwidth 1g
inet 1.45.67.2/30 broadcast 1.45.67.3
input packets 0, bytes 0
output packets 1, bytes 90

Note: (untagged) indicates an untagged L3 VLAN subinterface.

99.83 show interface (PTP)

Synopsis
show interface

Description
Use this command to display the available interfaces capable of time-stamping
and their statuses. For details, see the show ptp interface command.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: General Configuration

Command Mode
PTP configuration submode — (config-ptp)

Examples
Displaying the status of the interfaces capable of time-stamping:
ML66(config-ptp)#show interface

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 965


CLI Descriptions

99.84 show interface ethernet

Synopsis
show interface ethernet <RSP>

Description
Use this command to display the current configuration of the Ethernet interface.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Interfaces

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port of the interface where the format
is <Rack/Slot/Port>.

Examples
Displaying the current configuration of 1/6/4:
ML66>show interface ethernet 1/6/4
interface ethernet 1/6/4
!LAN 1/6/4 - Port 4
no shutdown
trapenable
role inni
lan
no alarm-enable ethernet-down
speed auto-detect
mdix auto
no flowcontrol
autoneg
no sync-enable
no alarm-enable sync-unsupported
! Ethernet link OAM
ethernet-oam
no admin-state
mode passive
ignore-loopback
frame window 10
frame threshold 1
frame-period threshold 1
frame-secs-summary window 100
frame-secs-summary threshold 1
no symbol-period
no frame-period
no frame
no frame-secs-summary
no dying-gasp
no critical-event
no alarm-enable linkfault
no alarm-enable loopback
no disable-support loopback
no disable-support event
symbol-period threshold 1

966 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

exit
exit
ifName "1/6/4"
operstatus:up
clock-port:cp1
RX bytes:65452 packets:324 multicast:478 broadcast:0 dropped:0 errors:0
TX bytes:105580 packets:323 multicast:947 broadcast:1 dropped:0 errors:0

99.85 show interface ethernet-pm

Synopsis
show interface ethernet-pm <RSP> {wan | lan} {tc <TRAFFICCLASS> |
interval <INTERVAL> | current | all | 24} {bandwidth}

Description
Use this command to display Ethernet Performance Monitoring (PM) data.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Performance Monitoring Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port of the interface to select. The
format is <Rack/Slot/Port>.

Note: Port refers to a WAN or LAN interface, not to a


switch port.

TRAFFICCLASS The traffic class for which PM data is displayed.

INTERVAL The interval for which PM data is displayed.

Options

wan Displays PM data for a WAN interface.

lan Displays PM data for a LAN interface.

tc Displays PM data for the specified traffic class on the


selected interface.

interval Displays PM data for the specified interval on the selected


interface.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 967


CLI Descriptions

current Displays current PM data for the selected interface.

all Displays all PM data for the selected interface.

24 Displays 24h PM data for the selected interface.

bandwidth Displays bandwidth PM data for the selected interface.

Examples
Displaying Ethernet PM bandwidth counters for a LAN interface (excerpt):
ML66>show interface ethernet-pm 1/6/1 lan current bandwidth
xfBandwidthCurrent15m RX TX
TimeElapsed 226
ValidData Valid
Average 35000 25000
Maximum 35138 25098
Minimum 34383 24559
0To5PercentSecs 226 226
5To10PercentSecs 0 0
10To15PercentSecs 0 0
15To20PercentSecs 0 0
20To25PercentSecs 0 0
25To30PercentSecs 0 0
30To35PercentSecs 0 0
35To40PercentSecs 0 0
40To45PercentSecs 0 0
45To50PercentSecs 0 0
50To55PercentSecs 0 0
55To60PercentSecs 0 0
60To65PercentSecs 0 0
65To70PercentSecs 0 0
70To75PercentSecs 0 0
75To80PercentSecs 0 0
80To85PercentSecs 0 0
85To90PercentSecs 0 0
90To95PercentSecs 0 0
95To100PercentSecs 0 0
xfTrafficCurrent15m
TimeElapsed 226
ValidData Valid
RxOctets 988761920
RxUnicastPkts 15449405
RxMulticastPkts 0
RxBroadcastPkts 0
RxDiscards 0
RxErrors 0
TxOctets 706258496
TxUnicastPkts 11035289
TxMulticastPkts 0
TxBroadcastPkts 0
TxDiscards 0
TxErrors 0

99.86 show interface ethernet status

Synopsis
show interface ethernet status

Description
Use this command to display status information for all Ethernet interfaces.

968 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Interfaces

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying status information for all Ethernet interfaces:
ML66#show interface ethernet status
Max
Admin Oper Frame
Interface Port Role Status Status Speed Size LAG membership Deep Buff →
ering Clock Port
-------------+----+------+-------+---------+------+-----+---------------+--------- →
------+-----------
LAN 1/6/4 2 uni Down Down 1000 2000 Enabled
LAN 1/6/5 3 uni Up Up 1000 2000 Enabled
LAN 1/6/7 5 inni Up Up 1000 9216 Disabled
LAN 1/6/8 6 inni Up Up 1000 9216 Enabled
WAN 1/1/1 7 inni Up Down 75 9216 Enabled
WAN 1/1/2 8 inni Down Down 221 9216 Enabled →
test
LAN-DCN 1/6/0 1 uni Up Up 0 2000 Not suppo →
rted
Deep buffer bandwidth limit: 60000 Mbit/s
Deep buffer bandwidth used: 3000 Mbit/s
LAG-ID Name Members
-------------+----------+-------

99.87 show interface ip

Synopsis

— show interface ip [<IFNAME_RSP> | <IFNAME_RSP_H> | lan-dcn | lo-


dcn | host] [brief]

— show interface ip [<IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> | lo | lo.<VRF> | router]


[brief]

or

— show ip interface [<IFNAME_RSP> | <IFNAME_RSP_H> | lan-dcn | lo-


dcn | host] [brief]

— show ip interface [<IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> | lo | lo. <VRF> | ] [brief]

Use this command to display the IP parameters of an IP interface.

— LAN-DCN Interface Commands

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 969


CLI Descriptions

— DCN Loopback Interface Commands

— L3 VLAN Subinterface Commands

— Router Loopback Interface Commands

— Serial (PPP) Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IFNAME_RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port values of the LAN-DCN IP


interface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/Port>The
related configuration commands can be found in the
following section:, for example, 1/6/0.

IFNAME_RSP_H The related configuration commands can be found in the


followingThe Rack, Slot, Port, and Hierarchy values of the
serial (PPP) interface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/
Port-Hierarchy>, for example, 1/5/5-RS:D1-3.

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN
The Rack, Slot, and Port values and VLAN number of the
L3 VLAN subinterface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/
Port.VLAN>, for example, 1/6/4.500.

Options

lan-dcn Displays parameters of the LAN-DCN IP interface. By


default, this option is selected.

lo-dcn Displays the parameters of the DCN loopback interface.

local-access Displays parameters of the Local Access (USB) interface.

host Displays the configuration of the IPv4 host interface.

lo Displays parameters of the router loopback interface.

lo.VRF Displays parameters of the loopback interface of a Virtual


Routing and Forwarding (VRF) instance, for example
lo.vrf_1

router Displays parameters of all router interfaces, including


loopback and L3 VLAN subinterfaces.

970 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

brief Displays a brief summary.

Examples
Displaying the IP parameters of the LAN-DCN IP interfaces:
ML66#show interface ip lan-dcn
interface local-access 1/6/1
ip address 10.0.0.1/30
ipv6 address 2001:db8::/127
no shutdown
mtu 1500
no pingtargethost
interface lan-dcn 1/6/0
ip address 10.41.97.22/23
no ipv6 address
mtu 1500
interface lo-dcn
ip address 12.24.23.1/32

ML66#show ip interface lan-dcn brief


interface local-access 1/6/1
ip address 10.0.0.1/30
ipv6 address 2001:db8::/127
interface lan-dcn 1/6/0
ip address 10.41.97.22/23
no ipv6 address
interface lo-dcn
ip address 12.24.23.1/32

Displaying IP parameters of the router IP interfaces:


ML66#show interface ip router
1/6/5.500, Interface Status: admin up
IP MTU:1500 bytes (using link MTU)
VRF Binding: Not bound
lo, Interface Status: link up/admin up
IP address: 10.10.0.1, IP subnet: 10.10.0.1/32
VRF Binding: Not bound

Displaying IP parameters of a router IP interface:


ML66#show interface ip 1/6/4.500
1/6/5.500, Interface Status: admin up
IP MTU:1500 bytes (using link MTU)
name “my alias”
trapenable
clock-port:cp1

Displaying a brief summary of the IP parameters of the router IP interfaces:


ML66#show interface ip router brief
Interface IP-Address Status Protocol
1/6/5.500 unassigned down down
lo 127.0.0.1 up up

99.88 show interface serial

Synopsis
show interface serial [<IFNAME_RSP_H>]

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 971


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to display the configuration parameters of a serial (PPP)
interface.

Running the command without the <IFNAME_RSP_H> operand, configuration


parameters are displayed for all serial (PPP) interfaces.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Serial (PPP) Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IFNAME_RSP_H The Rack, Slot, Port, and Hierarchy value of the serial
(PPP) interface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/Port-
Hierarchy>, for example, 1/5/5-RS:D1-3.

Examples
Displaying the configuration parameters of the serial (PPP) interfaces 1/5/5-
RS:D1-3:

ML66#show interface serial 1/5/5-RS:D1-3


interface serial 1/5/5-RS:D1-3
ip unnumbered
no trapenable
no shutdown
mru 1500

99.89 show investigation-mode

Synopsis
show investigation-mode

Description
Use this command to display the status of additional troubleshooting
possibilities.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode, at admin level

972 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Examples
Displaying the status of additional troubleshooting possibilities:
ML66#show investigation-mode
Investigation mode is disabled

99.90 show ip forwarding

Synopsis
show ip forwarding

Description
Use this command to display IP forwarding status.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying IP forwarding status:
ML66#show ip forwarding
IP forwarding is on

99.91 show ip host interface

Synopsis
show ip host interface

Description
Use this command to display the host interface configuration for DCN-Mode
Routed.

In DCN-Mode VLAN, the current host interface is displayed together with the
configuration which is effective only in DCN-Mode Routed.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Router IP Commands

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 973


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the host interface configuration in DCN-Mode VLAN:
ML66#show ip host interface
Current host interface: LAN-DCN
ip host interface lo (auto)

Note: (auto) indicates that the host interface is auto-selected by the NE.

99.92 show ip host mtu

Synopsis
show ip host mtu

Description
Use this command to display the host Maximum Transmission Unit (MTU)
configuration.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Router IP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the host MTU configuration:
ML66#show ip host mtu
ip host mtu 1500

99.93 show ip interface host

Synopsis
show ip interface host [brief]

974 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Description
Use this command to display the configuration of the current host interface.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Router IP Commands on page 159

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Options

brief Displays only the configured IPv4 and, if exist, IPv6


addresses.

Examples
Displaying the host interface configuration in DCN-Mode VLAN, where the IPv4
host interface is the LAN-DCN interface and the IPv6 host interface is the
loopback interface:
ML66#show ip interface host
interface lan-dcn 1/9/0 (auto)
ip address 10.41.97.32/23
mtu 1500
interface lo-dcn (auto)
ipv6 address 2010::32/128
ML66#show ip interface host brief
interface lan-dcn 1/9/0 (auto)
ip address 10.41.97.32/23
interface lo-dcn (auto)
ipv6 address 2010::32/128

Note: (auto) indicates that the host interface is auto-selected by the NE.

Displaying the host interface configuration in DCN-Mode Routed:


ML66#show ip interface host
interface lo (auto)
ip address 10.41.104.30/32

Note: (auto) indicates that the host interface is auto-selected by the NE.

99.94 show ip isis igp-shortcut-lsp

Synopsis
show ip isis [<TAG>] igp-shortcut-lsp

Description
Use this command to display the IS-IS IGP shortcut LSP entries.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 975


CLI Descriptions

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— IS-IS Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

TAG The routing instance tag.

Examples
ML66>show ip isis igp-shortcut-lsp

99.95 show ip isis route

Synopsis
show ip isis [<TAG>] route

Description
Use this command to display IS-IS routing table for IPv4.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— IS-IS Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

TAG The routing instance tag.

Examples
ML66>show ip isis route
Codes: C - connected, L1 - IS-IS level-1, L2 - IS-IS level-2
ia - IS-IS inter area, D - discard, E - external metric
Area is1:
Destination Metric Next-Hop Interface Tag
C 10.10.0.0/24 10 -- 1/9/4.500 123
L1 10.10.11.0/24 20 10.10.0.43 1/9/4.500 124
L1 10.10.12.0/24 40 10.10.0.32 1/9/4.600 125
L2 172.16.15.1/32 30 10.10.0.25 1/9/4.700 127

976 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

99.96 show ip isis route igp-shortcut

Synopsis
show ip isis [<TAG>] route igp-shortcut

Description
Use this command to display the IS-IS IGP shortcut routing table.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— IS-IS Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

TAG The routing instance tag.

Examples
ML66>show ip isis is1 route igp-shortcut
Codes: C - connected, E - external, L1 - IS-IS level-1, L2 - IS-IS level-2
ia - IS-IS inter area, D - discard, e - external metric
Area is1:
Destination Metric Tunnel-ID Tunnel-End-Point

99.97 show ip ospf

Synopsis
show ip ospf [<PROC_ID> ]

Description
Use this command to display general information about OSPF routing processes.

Running the command without the <PROC_ID> operand, all OSPF routing
processes are displayed.

Running the command with the <PROC_ID> operand, only the selected OSPF
routing process is displayed.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 977


CLI Descriptions

— OSPF Configuration Commands

— OSPF Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

PROC_ID OSPF process ID. The valid range is 0–65535.

Examples
Displaying general information about OSPF routing processes:
ML66#show ip ospf

99.98 show ip ospf border-routers

Synopsis
show ip ospf [<PROC_ID> ] border-routers

Description
Use this command to display the Area Border Routers (ABRs) and Autonomous
System Border Routers (ASBRs) for an OSPF instance.

Running the command without the <PROC_ID> operand, ABRs and ASBRs are
displayed for all OSPF instances.

Running the command with the <PROC_ID> operand, ABRs and ASBRs are
displayed only for the selected OSPF instance.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— OSPF Configuration Commands

— OSPF Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

978 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Operands

PROC_ID OSPF process ID. The valid range is 0–65535.

Examples
Displaying ARBs and ASBRs for all OSPF instances:
ML66#show ip ospf border-routers

99.99 show ip ospf database

Synopsis

— show ip ospf database [self-originate | max-age | adv-router


<ADV_ROUTER> ]

— show ip ospf <PROC_ID> database [self-originate | max-age | adv-


router <ADV_ROUTER> ]

— show ip ospf database [asbr-summary | external | network | router |


summary | nssa-external | opaque-link | opaque-area | opaque-as]
[self-originate | adv-router <ADV_ROUTER> ]

— show ip ospf database [asbr-summary | external | network | router |


summary | nssa-external | opaque-link | opaque-area | opaque-as]
<LINK_STATE_ID> [self-originate | adv-router <ADV_ROUTER> ]

— show ip ospf <PROC_ID> database [asbr-summary | external | network


| router | summary | nssa-external | opaque-link | opaque-area |
opaque-as] [self-originate | adv-router <ADV_ROUTER> ]

— show ip ospf <PROC_ID> database [asbr-summary | external | network


| router | summary | nssa-external | opaque-link | opaque-area |
opaque-as] <LINK_STATE_ID> [self-originate | adv-router
<ADV_ROUTER> ]

Description
Use this command to display a database summary for OSPF information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— OSPF Configuration Commands

— OSPF Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 979


CLI Descriptions

Operands

ADV-ROUTER Advertising router in <A.B.C.D> format.

PROC_ID OSPF process ID. The valid range is 0–65535.

LINK_STATE_ID Link state ID, where the format is <A.B.C.D> .

Options

asbr-summary Displays ASBR summary link states.

external Displays external link states.

network Displays network link states.

router Displays router link states.

summary Displays network summary link states.

nssa-external Displays Not-So-Stubby Area (NSSA) external link state.

opaque-link Displays link local Opaque-LSA.

opaque-area Displays link area Opaque-LSA.

opaque-as Displays link Autonomous System (AS) Opaque-LSA.

self-originate Displays self-originated link states.

max-age Displays Link State Advertisements (LSAs) in MaxAge


list.

adv-router Displays advertising router link states.

Examples
Displaying a database summary for OSPF information:
ML66#show ip ospf database

99.100 show ip ospf igp-shortcut-lsp

Synopsis
show ip ospf igp-shortcut-lsp

980 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Description
Use this command to display Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP) Shortcut Labeled
Switch Paths (LSPs) used by OSPF.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— OSPF Configuration Commands

— OSPF Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying IGP Shortcut LSPs used by OSPF:
ML66#show ip ospf igp-shortcut-lsp

99.101 show ip ospf igp-shortcut-route

Synopsis
show ip ospf [<PROC_ID> ] igp-shortcut-route

Description
Use this command to display Interior Gateway Protocol (IGP) Shortcut routes
calculated by OSPF.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— OSPF Configuration Commands

— OSPF Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

PROC_ID OSPF process ID. The valid range is 0–65535.

Examples
Displaying IGP Shortcut routes calculated by OSPF:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 981


CLI Descriptions

ML66#show ip ospf igp-shortcut-route

99.102 show ip ospf interface

Synopsis
show ip ospf interface [<IFNAME_RSP_H> | <IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> | lo |
lo.<VRF>]

Description
Use this command to display interface information for OSPF.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— OSPF Configuration Commands

— OSPF Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN
The Rack, Slot, and Port value and VLAN number of the
L3 VLAN subinterface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/
Port.VLAN>, for example, 1/9/4.500.

IFNAME_RSP_H The Rack, Slot, Port, and Hierarchy value of the serial
(PPP) interface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/Port-
Hierarchy>, for example, 1/5/5-RS:D1-3.

Options

lo The router loopback interface.

lo.VRF The loopback interface of a VRF instance, for example,


lo.vrf_1.

Examples
Displaying interface information:
ML66#show ip ospf interface

982 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

99.103 show ip ospf multi-area-adjacencies

Synopsis
show ip ospf [<PROC_ID> ] multi-area-adjacencies

Description
Use this command to display multi-area adjacency information for OSPF
instances.

Running the command without the <PROC_ID> operand, multi-area adjacency


information is displayed for all OSPF instances.

Running the command with the <PROC_ID> operand, multi-area adjacency


information is displayed only for the selected OSPF instance.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— OSPF Configuration Commands

— OSPF Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

PROC_ID OSPF process ID. The valid range is 0–65535.

Examples
Displaying multi-area adjacency information:
ML66#show ip ospf multi-area-adjacencies

99.104 show ip ospf neighbor

Synopsis
show ip ospf [<PROC_ID> ] neighbor [all | detail | <NEIGHBOR_ID>
[detail] | detail all | interface <INTERFACE_ADDR> ]

Description
Use this command to display information on OSPF neighbors.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 983


CLI Descriptions

Running the command without the <PROC_ID> operand, information is


displayed on all OSPF neighbors.

Running the command with the <PROC_ID> operand, information is displayed


only on the selected OSPF neighbor.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— OSPF Configuration Commands

— OSPF Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

PROC_ID OSPF process ID. The valid range is 0–65535.

NEIGHBOR_ID Neighbor ID, where the format is <A.B.C.D> .

INTERFACE_ADDR
Address of the interface, where the format is <A.B.C.D> .

Options

all Displays information for all neighbors.

detail Displays detailed information.

interface Displays information for a selected interface.

Examples
Displaying information on OSPF neighbors:
ML66#show ip ospf neighbor

99.105 show ip ospf route

Synopsis
show ip ospf [<PROC_ID> ] route

Description
Use this command to display OSPF routing table.

984 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Running the command without the <PROC_ID> operand, all OSPF routing tables
are displayed.

Running the command with the <PROC_ID> operand, only the selected OSPF
routing table is displayed.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— OSPF Configuration Commands

— OSPF Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

PROC_ID OSPF process ID. The valid range is 0–65535.

Examples
Displaying OSPF routing tables:
ML66#show ip ospf route

99.106 show ip ospf virtual-links

Synopsis
show ip ospf [<PROC_ID> ] virtual-links

Description
Use this command to display virtual link information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— OSPF Configuration Commands

— OSPF Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 985


CLI Descriptions

Operands

PROC_ID OSPF process ID. The valid range is 0–65535.

Examples
Displaying virtual link information:
ML66#show ip ospf virtual-links

99.107 show ip prefix-list

Synopsis
show ip prefix-list

Description
Use this command to display IP prefix lists.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Router IP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
ML66#show ip prefix-list

99.108 show ip route

Synopsis

— show ip route [summary]

— show ip route [vrf <VRF> ] [<IPADDR> | <IPADDR/PREFIX> ]

— show ip route [vrf <VRF> ] [database] [bgp | connected | ospf | static


| isis]

986 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Description
Use this command to display the IP routing table for a protocol or from a
particular table.

An internal route selection mechanism selects the best routes, based on protocol
administrative distance and metric values. These best routes can be displayed
with this command. To display all routes (selected and not selected), use the
database option.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Router IP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

VRF The Virtual Routing and Forwarding (VRF) instance


name

IPADDR Specifies a network in the IP routing table to display,


where the format is <A.B.C.D> .

IPADDR/PREFIX Specifies a network address with prefix length in the IP


routing table to display, where the format is <A.B.C.D> .

Options

summary Displays summary of all routes.

vrf Specifies a VRF instance.

database Displays IP routing table database information.

bgp Specifies BGP routes.

connected Specifies connected routes.

ospf Specifies OSPF routes.

static Specifies static routes.

isis Specifies IS-IS routes.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 987


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Displaying the active (best) routes:
ML66>show ip route
Codes: K - kernel, C - connected, S - static, R - RIP, B - BGP
O - OSPF, IA - OSPF inter area
N1 - OSPF NSSA external type 1, N2 - OSPF NSSA external type 2
E1 - OSPF external type 1, E2 - OSPF external type 2
i - IS-IS, L1 - IS-IS level-1, L2 - IS-IS level-2, ia - IS-IS inter area
ew - East-West API * - candidate default
C 1.2.6.7/32 is directly connected, lo

Displaying only the selected OSPF routes learned by the router:


ML66#show ip route ospf
O 1.1.1.0/24 [110/20] via 2.2.2.1, 1/9/4.500, 00:00:44
O IA 4.4.4.0/24 [110/21] via 2.2.2.1, 1/9/4.500, 00:00:44

99.109 show ip vrf

Synopsis
show ip vrf [<VRF> ]

Description
Use this command to display Virtual Routing and Forwarding (VRF) information.
Running the command without the <VRF> operand, information is displayed for
all VRF instances.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— Router IP Commands

— IP VRF Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

VRF The name of the VRF instance.

Examples
Displaying information of VRF instance vrf_1:
ML66>show ip vrf vrf_1

988 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

99.110 show iptables

Synopsis
show iptables [config]

Description
Use this command to display IPv4 firewall status information or the list of IPv4
firewall user-defined rules.

Running this command without the config option, the current status of the IPv4
firewall is displayed.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Firewall Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Options

config Displays the IPv4 firewall user-defined rules.

Examples
Displaying IPv4 firewall status information:
ML66>show iptables

Displaying IPv4 firewall user-defined rules:


ML66>show iptables config
! Iptables configuration
open ip snmp 172.31.28.0/23

99.111 show ip6tables

Synopsis
show ip6tables [config]

Description
Use this command to display IPv6 firewall status information or the list of IPv6
firewall user-defined rules.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 989


CLI Descriptions

Running this command without the config option, the current status of the IPv6
firewall is displayed.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Firewall Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Options

config Displays the IPv6 firewall user-defined rules.

Examples
Displaying IPv6 firewall status information:
ML66>show ip6tables

Displaying IPv6 firewall user-defined rules:


ML66>show ip6tables config
! Iptables configuration
open6 ip snmp 2004::0/23

99.112 show isis counter

Synopsis
show isis counter

Description
Use this command to display the IS-IS system counter entry MIBs.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— IS-IS Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
ML66>show isis counter
Area is1:
IS-IS Level-1 isisSystemCounterEntry:
isisSysStatCorrLSPs: 0
isisSysStatAuthTypeFails: 0

990 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

isisSysStatAuthFails: 0
isisSysStatLSPDbaseOloads: 0
isisSysStatManAddrDropFromAreas: 0
isisSysStatAttmptToExMaxSeqNums: 0
isisSysStatSeqNumSkips: 0
isisSysStatOwnLSPPurges: 0
isisSysStatIDFieldLenMismatches: 0
isisSysStatMaxAreaAddrMismatches: 0
isisSysStatPartChanges: 0
isisSysStatSPFRuns: 0
isisSysStatPRCRuns: 0
IS-IS Level-2 isisSystemCounterEntry:
isisSysStatCorrLSPs: 0
isisSysStatAuthTypeFails: 0
isisSysStatAuthFails: 0
isisSysStatLSPDbaseOloads: 0
isisSysStatManAddrDropFromAreas: 0
isisSysStatAttmptToExMaxSeqNums: 0
isisSysStatSeqNumSkips: 0
isisSysStatOwnLSPPurges: 0
isisSysStatIDFieldLenMismatches: 0
isisSysStatMaxAreaAddrMismatches: 0
isisSysStatPartChanges: 0
isisSysStatSPFRuns: 0
isisSysStatPRCRuns: 0

99.113 show isis database

Synopsis
show isis [<TAG>] database [<LSPID> | {detail | verbose} | {level-1 |
level-2}]

Description
Use this command to display link state database information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— IS-IS Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

TAG The routing instance tag.

LSPID The LSP ID in the format of <XXXX.XXXX.XXXX.XX-XX>.

Options

detail Displays detailed link state database information.

verbose Displays verbose database information.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 991


CLI Descriptions

level-1 Specifies IS-IS level-1 routing link state database.

level-2 Specifies IS-IS level-2 routing link state database.

Examples
ML66>show isis database detail
Area is1:
IS-IS Level-1 Link State Database:
LSPID LSP Seq Num LSP Checksum LSP Holdtime ATT/P/OL
000F.0000.0001.00-00* 0x00000007 0xE15E 1188 1/0/0
Area Address: 49.000F
NLPID: 0xCC
IP Address: 10.10.12.97
Metric: 10 IP 10.10.12.0 255.255.255.0
Metric: 10 IS 000F.0000.0001.02
000F.0000.0001.02-00* 0x00000003 0x3C66 1026 1/0/0
Metric: 0 IS 000F.0000.0001.00
Metric: 0 IS 000F.0000.0002.00
000F.0000.0002.00-00 0x00000003 0x8C4B 1025 1/0/0
Area Address: 49.000F
NLPID: 0xCC
Hostname: isisd@redhat
IP Address: 10.10.12.94
Metric: 10 IP 10.10.12.0 255.255.255.0
Metric: 10 IS 000F.0000.0001.02

99.114 show isis interface

Synopsis
show isis interface [<IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> | lo | lo.<VRF> | counter]

Description
Use this command to display detailed interface information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— IS-IS Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN
The Rack, Slot, and Port value and VLAN number of the
L3 VLAN subinterface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/
Port.VLAN> , for example, 1/9/4.500.

992 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Options

lo Specifies the router loopback interface.

lo.VRF Specifies the loopback interface of a Virtual Routing and


Forwarding (VRF) instance, for example, lo.vrf_1.

counter Specifies the interface counters.

Examples
ML66>show isis interface
1/9/4.500 is up, line protocol is up
Routing Protocol: IS-IS (123)
Network Type: Broadcast
Circuit Type: level-1-2
Local circuit ID: 0x01
Extended Local circuit ID: 0x00000007
Local SNPA: 000c.29bc.bf2a
IP interface address:
100.4.5.5/24
IPv6 interface address:
1000::1/64
fe80::20c:29ff:febc:bf2a/64
Level-1 Metric: 10/10, Priority: 64, Circuit ID: 0000.0000.000B.01
Number of active level-1 adjacencies: 1
Level-1 LSP MTU: 1492
Level-2 Metric: 10/10, Priority: 64, Circuit ID: 0000.0000.000B.01
Number of active level-2 adjacencies: 0
Level-2 LSP MTU: 1492
Next IS-IS LAN Level-1 Hello in 2 seconds
Next IS-IS LAN Level-2 Hello in 6 seconds

ML66>show isis interface counter


1/9/4.500:
IS-IS LAN Level-1 isisCircuitCounterEntry:
isisCircAdjChanges: 0
isisCircNumAdj: 0
isisCircInitFails: 0
isisCircRejAdjs: 0
isisCircIDFieldLenMismatches: 0
isisCircMaxAreaAddrMismatches: 0
isisCircAuthTypeFails: 0
isisCircAuthFails: 0
isisCircLanDesISChanges: 0
IS-IS LAN Level-2 isisCircuitCounterEntry:
isisCircAdjChanges: 0
isisCircNumAdj: 0
isisCircInitFails: 0
isisCircRejAdjs: 0
isisCircIDFieldLenMismatches: 0
isisCircMaxAreaAddrMismatches: 0
isisCircAuthTypeFails: 0
isisCircAuthFails: 0
isisCircLanDesISChanges: 0
IS-IS Level-1 isisPacketCounterEntry:
isisPacketCountIIHello in/out: 0/0
isisPacketCountLSP in/out: 0/0
isisPacketCountCSNP in/out: 0/0
isisPacketCountPSNP in/out: 0/0
isisPacketCountUnknown in/out: 0/0
IS-IS Level-2 isisPacketCounterEntry:
isisPacketCountIIHello in/out: 0/0
isisPacketCountLSP in/out: 0/0
isisPacketCountCSNP in/out: 0/0
isisPacketCountPSNP in/out: 0/0
isisPacketCountUnknown in/out: 0/0

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 993


CLI Descriptions

99.115 show isis topology

Synopsis
show isis [<TAG>] topology {level-1 | level-2}

Description
Use this command to display IS-IS topology information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— IS-IS Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

TAG The routing instance tag.

Options

level-1 Specifies paths to all level-1 routers in the area.

level-2 Specifies paths to all level-2 routers in the area.

Examples
ML66>show isis topology
Area is1:
IS-IS paths to level-1 routers
System Id Metric Next-Hop Interface SNPA
000F.0000.0001 --
000F.0000.0002 10 000F.0000.0002 1/9/4.500 0006.5B0E.D27D
IS-IS paths to level-2 routers
System Id Metric Next-Hop Interface SNPA
0000.0000.0001 10 0000.0000.0001 1/9/4.500 0000.0CFA.F002
0000.0000.0099 10 0000.0000.0099 1/9/4.500 0003.4797.5E4C
0001.0002.0003 20 0000.0000.0099 1/9/4.500 0003.4797.5E4C
000F.0000.0001 --
000F.0000.0002 10 000F.0000.0002 1/9/4.500 0006.5B0E.D27D

99.116 show l1-bonding

Synopsis
show l1-bonding [<RSP> ]

994 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Description
Use this command without the <RSP> operand to display the members and
configured mappings of all L1-bonding groups.

Use this command with the <RSP> operand to display the members and
configured mappings of a specific L1-bonding group.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: L1 Bonding

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port values of the selected L1-
bonding group in the following format: <Rack/Slot/
Port> .

Examples
Displaying the members and configured mappings of all L1-bonding groups:
ML66>show l1-bonding

Displaying the members and configured mappings of the L1-bonding group


1/1/1:
ML66>show l1-bonding 1/1/1

99.117 show lag

Synopsis
show lag [<LAGID>]

Description
Use this command to display Link Aggregation Groups (LAGs).

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: LAG

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 995


CLI Descriptions

Operands

LAGID The Rack, Slot, and Port value of the master port of the
LAG in <Rack/Slot/Port> format.

Examples
Displaying LAG:
ML66>show lag 1/6/5

99.118 show lag lacpstats

Synopsis
show lag lacpstats

Description
Use this command to display Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) statistics.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: LAG

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying LACP statistics:
ML66>show lag lacpstats

99.119 show lag status

Synopsis
show lag status [<LAGID> ]

Description
Use this command to display status information about the Link Aggregation
Group (LAG).

996 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

If the <LAGID> parameter is not specified, the command shows status for all
LAGs.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: LAG

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

LAGID The Link Aggregation Group (LAG) ID in <Rack/Slot/


Port> format.

Examples
Displaying the status of a LAG configured to LACP Active mode:
ML66>show lag status 1/9/4
LAG 1/9/4
---------
Name:
Designated Interface: LAN 1/9/4
Alarm Status: -
Oper Status: up
Local System Priority: 32766
Local System Id: ac:60:b6:99:a5:8d
Local Oper Key: 2
Remote System Priority: 32768
Remote System Id: ac:60:b6:9f:a8:1b
Remote Oper Key: 2
LAN 1/9/4
Local Port Priority: 1
Local Port Number: 2
Local Lacp Oper State: 0xfc(Activity,Timeout,Aggregation,Synchronization,Collect →
ing,Distributing)
Remote System Priority: 32768
Remote System Id: ac:60:b6:9f:a8:1b
Remote Oper Key: 2
Remote Port Priority: 1
Remote Port Number: 3
Remote Lacp Oper State: 0x7c(Timeout,Aggregation,Synchronization,Collecting,Distr →
ibuting)
LAN 1/9/8
Local Port Priority: 32768
Local Port Number: 6
Local Lacp Oper State: 0xfc(Activity,Timeout,Aggregation,Synchronization,Collect →
ing,Distributing)
Remote System Priority: 32768
Remote System Id: ac:60:b6:9f:a8:1b
Remote Oper Key: 2
Remote Port Priority: 32768
Remote Port Number: 30
Remote Lacp Oper State: 0x7c(Timeout,Aggregation,Synchronization,Collecting,Distr →
ibuting)

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 997


CLI Descriptions

99.120 show lan-dcn

Synopsis

— show lan-dcn [arp | ip | ipv6 address | ipv6 route | networks]

— show lan-dcn interface [brief]

Description
Use this command to display information about the LAN-DCN network.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— LAN-DCN IP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Options

arp Displays the Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) table. For


more information, see show arp on page 902.

interface Displays the parameters of all LAN-DCN interfaces.

ip Displays LAN-DCN IP information. For more information,


see show lan-dcn ip on page 999.

ipv6 address Displays the IPv6 address of the LAN DCN interface.

ipv6 route Displays the IPv6 routing table.

networks Show all connected DCNs.

brief Displays a brief summary.

Examples
Displaying general information about LAN-DCN:
ML66#show lan-dcn
interface local-access 1/6/1
ip address 10.0.0.1/30
ipv6 address 2001:db8::/127
no shutdown
mtu 1500
no pingtargethost
interface lan-dcn 1/6/0
ip address 10.41.97.22/23

998 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

no ipv6 address
mtu 1500
interface lo-dcn
ip address 12.24.23.1/32
no ipv6 address

99.121 show lan-dcn ip

Synopsis
show lan-dcn ip [address | dhcp | domainname | dscp | interface | name-
server | route | sockets | traffic]

Description
Use this command to display information about the DCN IP network and
interfaces.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— LAN-DCN IP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Options

address Displays the IPv4 address of the LAN-DCN interfaces.

dhcp Displays the DHCP configuration.

domainname Displays the name of the domain.

dscp Displays the DSCP value configured for outgoing IPv4


DCN traffic.

interface Displays the properties of the LAN-DCN interfaces.

name-server Displays the Domain Name System (DNS) server settings.

route Displays the IPv4 routing table.

sockets Displays the LAN-DCN IP socket status.

traffic Displays the LAN-DCN IP statistics.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 999


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Displaying the IP address of the LAN-DCN interfaces:
ML66#show lan-dcn ip address
interface local-access 1/6/1
ip address 10.0.0.1/30
ipv6 address 2001:db8::/127
interface lan-dcn 1/6/0
ip address 10.41.97.22/23
no ipv6 address
interface lo-dcn
ip address 12.24.23.1/32
no ipv6 address

Displaying the IPv4 routing table:


ML66#show lan-dcn ip route
Codes: K - kernel, C - connected, S - static, R - RIP, B - BGP
O - OSPF, IA - OSPF inter area
N1 - OSPF NSSA external type 1, N2 - OSPF NSSA external type 2
E1 - OSPF external type 1, E2 - OSPF external type 2
i - IS-IS, L1 - IS-IS level-1, L2 - IS-IS level-2, ia - IS-IS inter area
ew - East-West API> - selected route, * - FIB route, p - stale info
C *> 10.41.96.0/23 is directly connected, LAN-DCN 1/6/0
C 10.0.0.0/30 is directly connected, LOCAL-ACCESS 1/6/1
C *> 10.10.12.13/32 is directly connected, LO-DCN
S *> 0.0.0.0/0 via 10.41.96.1, LAN-DCN 1/6/0

Displaying the DNS server configuration:


ML66>show lan-dcn ip name-server
lan-dcn ip name-server 1.2.3.4 2005::45 0.0.0.0

99.122 show lan-dcn ipv6

Synopsis
show lan-dcn ipv6 [address | dhcp | domainname | dscp | interface | name-
server | ndp | route | sockets | traffic]

Description
Use this command to display information about the DCN IP network and
interfaces.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— LAN-DCN IPv6 Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Options

address Displays the IPv6 address of the LAN-DCN interfaces.

1000 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

dhcp Displays the DHCP configuration.

domainname Displays the name of the domain.

dscp Displays the DSCP value configured for outgoing IPv6


DCN traffic.

interface Displays the properties of the LAN-DCN


interfaces.Displays the DSCP value configured for
outgoing IPv6 DCN traffic.

name-server Displays the Domain Name System (DNS) server settings.

ndp Displays the IPv6 Neighbor Discovery Protocol (NDP)


table.

route Displays the IPv6 routing table.

sockets Displays the LAN-DCN IP socket status.

traffic Displays the LAN-DCN IP statistics.

Examples
Displaying IPv6 address of the LAN-DCN interfaces:
ML66Displays the DSCP value configured for outgoing#show lan-dcn ipv6 address
interface local-access 1/6/1
ip address 10.0.0.1/30
ipv6 address 2001:db8::/127
interface lan-dcn 1/6/0
ip address 10.41.97.22/23
no ipv6 address
interface lo-dcn
ip address 12.24.23.1/32
ipv6 address 2006::32/128

Displaying the IPv6 routing table:


ML66#show lan-dcn ipv6 route
Codes: K - kernel, C - connected, S - static, R - RIP, B - BGP
O - OSPF, IA - OSPF inter area
N1 - OSPF NSSA external type 1, N2 - OSPF NSSA external type 2
E1 - OSPF external type 1, E2 - OSPF external type 2
i - IS-IS, L1 - IS-IS level-1, L2 - IS-IS level-2, ia - IS-IS inter area
ew - East-West API> - selected route, * - FIB route, p - stale info
C *> 2001:db8::/127 is directly connected, LOCAL-ACCESS 1/6/1
C *> 2006::32/128 is directly connected, LO-DCN

99.123 show lan-dcn ipv6 dhcp relayaddress

Synopsis
show lan-dcn ipv6 dhcp relayaddress

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1001


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to display the configured Dynamic Host Configuration
Protocol (DHCP) server address.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— LAN-DCN IPv6 Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the configured DHCP server address:
ML66>show lan-dcn ipv6 dhcp relayaddress
2001::1

99.124 show lan-dcn ipv6 dhcp status

Synopsis
show lan-dcn ipv6 dhcp status

Description
Use this command to display the running state of the Dynamic Host
Configuration Protocol (DHCP) relay agent.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— LAN-DCN IPv6 Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the running state of the DHCP relay agent:
ML66>show lan-dcn ipv6 dhcp status
DHCP relay agent is running

99.125 show ldp

1002 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Synopsis
show ldp

Description
Use this command to display basic Label Distribution Protocol (LDP) attributes
defined for the current Label Switch Router (LSR).

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— LDP Configuration Commands

— LDP Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying basic LDP attributes defined for the current LSR:
ML66#show ldp
Router ID : 5.5.5.5
LDP Version : 1
Global Merge Capability : Merge Capable
Label Advertisement Mode : Downstream Unsolicited
Label Retention Mode : Liberal
Label Control Mode : Ordered
Instance Loop Detection : Off
Request Retry : On
Propagate Release : Disabled
Graceful Restart : Disabled
Hello Interval : 5
Targeted Hello Interval : 15
Hold time : 15
Targeted Hold time : 45
Keepalive Interval : 10
Keepalive Timeout : 30
Request retry Timeout : 5
Transport Address data :
Labelspace 0 : 5.5.5.5 (in use)
Import BGP routes : No
DSCP value : 48

99.126 show ldp adjacency

Synopsis
show ldp adjacency

Description
Use this command to display all the adjacencies for the current Label Switch
Router (LSR).

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1003


CLI Descriptions

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— LDP Configuration Commands

— LDP Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying all the adjacencies for the current LSR:
ML66#show ldp adjacency
IP Address Interface Name Holdtime LDP ID
192.168.3.5 1/9/4.500 15 10.10.0.18:0
192.168.4.5 1/9/4.501 15 10.10.0.18:0

99.127 show ldp downstream

Synopsis
show ldp downstream

Description
Use this command to display the status of all downstream sessions and the label
information exchanged.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— LDP Configuration Commands

— LDP Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the status of all downstream sessions and the label information
exchanged:
ML66#show ldp downstream
Session peer 192.168.11.50:
Downstream state: Established Label: impl-null RequestID: 0 Peer:
192.168.11.50 Attr:
Downstream state: Established Label: impl-null RequestID: 0 Peer:
192.168.11.50 Attr:
Downstream state: Established Label: impl-null RequestID: 0 Peer:

1004 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

192.168.11.50 Attr:
Downstream state: Established Label: 20 RequestID: 0 Peer: 192.168.11.50
Attr:
Session peer 192.168.13.60:
Downstream state: Established Label: impl-null RequestID: 0 Peer:
192.168.13.60 Attr:
Downstream state: Established Label: 16 RequestID: 0 Peer: 192.168.13.60
Attr:
Downstream state: Established Label: 17 RequestID: 0 Peer: 192.168.13.60
Attr:
Downstream state: Established Label: impl-null RequestID: 0 Peer:
192.168.13.60 Attr:
Downstream state: Established Label: 18 RequestID: 0 Peer: 192.168.13.60
Attr:
Downstream state: Established Label: impl-null RequestID: 0 Peer:
192.168.13.60 Attr:
Downstream state: Established Label: 19 RequestID: 0 Peer: 192.168.13.60
Attr: --More--
Downstream state: Established Label: 20 RequestID: 0 Peer: 192.168.13.60
Attr:

99.128 show ldp fec

Synopsis

— show ldp fec [prefix]

— show ldp fec prefix [<FEC/PREFIX> ]

Description
Use the following command to display all Forwarding Equivalence Classes (FECs)
known to the current Label Switch Router (LSR).

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— LDP Configuration Commands

— LDP Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

FEC/PREFIX The IPv4 prefix, where the format is <A.B.C.D/P> .

Options

prefix Sets a FEC prefix.

Examples
Displaying all FECs known to the current LSR:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1005


CLI Descriptions

ML66#show ldp fec


LSR codes : E/N - LSR is egress/non-egress for this FEC,
L - LSR received a label for this FEC,
> - LSR will use this route for the FEC
Code FEC Session Out Label Nexthop Addr
E> 10.10.0.0/24 non-existent none connected
NL 10.10.0.0/24 192.168.3.5 impl-null connected
E> 192.168.3.0/24 non-existent none connected
NL 192.168.3.0/24 192.168.3.5 impl-null connected
E> 192.168.4.0/24 non-existent none connected
NL 192.168.4.0/24 192.168.3.5 impl-null connected
NL 192.168.5.0/24 192.168.3.5 impl-null invalid

99.129 show ldp inter-area-fecs

Synopsis
show ldp inter-area-fecs [prefix [<FEC/PREFIX> ] ]

Description
Use this command to display all Forwarding Equivalence Classes (FECs) using
the LPM-based mapping procedure.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— LDP Configuration Commands

— LDP Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

FEC/PREFIX The IPv4 FEC for the inter area FEC, where the format is
<A.B.C.D/P> .

Options

prefix Sets a prefix for inter area FEC.

Examples
Displaying all FECs using the LPM-based mapping procedure:
ML66#show ldp inter-area-fecs
LSR codes : E/N - LSR is egress/non-egress for this FEC,
L - LSR received a label for this FEC,
> - LSR will use this route for the FEC
Code FEC Session Out Label Nexthop Addr
Matching RIB prefix - 1.1.1.0/24

1006 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

NL> 1.1.1.1/32 33.33.33.33 52485 11.11.11.1


NL> 1.1.1.2/32 33.33.33.33 52486 11.11.11.1

99.130 show ldp interface

Synopsis
show ldp interface [<IFNAME> ]

Description
Use this command to display the list of all interfaces on the current Label Switch
Router (LSR), and to indicate whether a given interface is label-switching or not.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— LDP Configuration Commands

— LDP Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IFNAME The name of the interface.

Examples
Displaying a list of all interfaces on the LSR:
ML66#show ldp interface
Interface LDP Identifier Label-switching Merge Capability
1/9/4.500 10.10.0.11:0 Disabled N/A
lo 10.10.0.11:0 Disabled N/A
1/9/4.501 10.10.0.11:0 Enabled Merge capable
1/9/4.502 10.10.0.11:0 Enabled Merge capable

Displaying information about interface 1/9/4.501:


ML66#show ldp interface 1/9/4.501
Status : Enabled
Primary IP Address : 192.168.3.4
Interface Type : Ethernet
Label Merge Capability : Merge Capable
Hello Interval : 5
Targeted Hello Interval : 15
Hold Time : 15
Targeted Hold Time : 45
Keepalive Interval : 10
Keepalive Timeout : 30
Advertisement Mode : Downstream On Demand
Label Retention Mode : Liberal
Administrative Groups : ipi1

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1007


CLI Descriptions

99.131 show ldp lsp

Synopsis
show ldp lsp {detail | host | prefix [<FEC/PREFIX> ] [detail] }

Description
Use this command to display Label Distribution Protocol (LDP) Label-Switched
Paths (LSPs) and, optionally, advertise-label information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— LDP Configuration Commands

— LDP Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

FEC/PREFIX The IPv4 Forwarding Equivalence Class (FEC) for an LSP,


where the format is <A.B.C.D/P> .

Options

detail Displays detailed onformation.

host Sets host LDPs to display.

prefix Sets prefix LSPs to display.

Examples
Displaying detailed LSP information:
ML66#show ldp lsp detail
Advertisement spec:
Prefix acl = pfx1; Peer acl = pfx1
Prevent the distribution of any assigned labels
FEC IPV4:1.1.1.0/30 -> 0.0.0.0
Downstream state: Established Label: impl-null RequestID: 0 Peer:
50.50.50.50
Attr:
Advert acl(s): Prevent the distribution of any assigned labels
FEC IPV4:3.3.3.0/30 -> 0.0.0.0
Advert acl(s): Prevent the distribution of any assigned labels
FEC IPV4:10.30.0.0/24 -> 0.0.0.0
Downstream state: Established Label: impl-null RequestID: 0 Peer:
50.50.50.50

1008 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Attr:
Advert acl(s): Prevent the distribution of any assigned labels
FEC IPV4:50.50.50.50/32 -> 1.1.1.1
Advert acl(s): Prefix acl = pfx1; Peer acl = pfx1
FEC IPV4:55.55.55.55/32 -> 3.3.3.2
Advert acl(s): Prevent the distribution of any assigned labels
FEC IPV4:169.254.0.0/16 -> 0.0.0.0
Downstream state: Established Label: impl-null RequestID: 0 Peer:
50.50.50.50
Attr:
Advert acl(s): Prevent the distribution of any assigned labels

99.132 show ldp session

Synopsis
show ldp session [<IPADDR> ]

Description
Use this command to display all sessions established between the current Label
Switch Router (LSR) and other LSRs. Use the IP address parameter to display
detailed information for established sessions with the peer having the specified
IPv4 address.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— LDP Configuration Commands

— LDP Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the peer, where the format is


<A.B.C.D> .

Examples
Displaying detailed information about established sessions with the peer
192.168.3.5:
ML66#show ldp session 192.168.3.5
Session state : OPERATIONAL
Up Time : 1d 3h 30m 8s
Session role : Passive
TCP Connection : Established
Peer Address for TCP : 192.168.3.5
Local Address for TCP : 192.168.1.5
Interface being used : 1/9/4.500
Peer LDP ID : 10.10.0.18:0
Peer LDP Password : mypwd
Authentication type : MD5

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1009


CLI Descriptions

Adjacencies : If Name Peer Address


1/9/4.500 192.168.3.5
1/9/4.501 192.168.4.5
Advertisement mode : Downstream Unsolicited
Label retention mode : Liberal
Graceful Restart : Not Capable
Keepalive Timeout : 30
Keepalive Interval : 10
Reconnect Interval : 15
Address List received : 192.168.3.5
192.168.4.5
Received Labels : Fec Label Maps To
IPV4:10.10.0.0/24 impl-null none
IPV4:192.168.3.0/24 impl-null none
IPV4:192.168.4.0/24 impl-null none
IPV4:192.168.5.0/24 impl-null none
Sent Labels : Fec Label Maps To
IPV4:10.10.0.0/24 impl-null none
IPV4:192.168.3.0/24 impl-null none
IPV4:192.168.4.0/24 impl-null none

99.133 show ldp statistics

Synopsis

— show ldp statistics [<IFNAME> ]

— show ldp statistics advertise-labels

Description
Use this command to display Label Distribution Protocol (LDP) packet statistics.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— LDP Configuration Commands

— LDP Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IFNAME The name of the interface.

Options

advertise-labels Sets an IP access list of advertise-labels.

Examples
Displaying LDP packet statistics:

1010 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

ML66#show ldp statistics


=======================================================
LSR ID = 0.0.0.0:0 : INTERFACE NAME: 1/9/4.500
=======================================================
PacketType Total
Sent Received
Notification 0 0
Hello 0 0
Initialization 0 0
Keepalive 0 0
Address 0 0
Address Withdraw 0 0
Label Mapping 0 0
Label Request 0 0
Label Withdraw 0 0
Label Release 0 0
Request Abort 0 0
=======================================================

Displaying LDP packet statistics for advertise-labels:


ML66#show ldp statistics advertise-labels
Advertisement spec:
Prefix acl = pfx1; Peer acl = pfx1
Deny : Label Mapping = 2
Label Request = 0
Prevent the distribution of any assigned labels
Deny : Label Mapping = 9
Label Request = 3

99.134 show ldp targeted-peers

Synopsis
show ldp targeted-peers

Description
Use this command to display the targeted peers configured on the current Label
Switch Router (LSR).

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— LDP Configuration Commands

— LDP Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the targeted peers configured on the current LSR:
ML66#show ldp targeted-peers
IP Address Interface

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1011


CLI Descriptions

192.168.201.2 1/9/4.500

99.135 show ldp upstream

Synopsis
show ldp upstream

Description
Use this command to display the status of all upstream sessions and label
information exchanged.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— LDP Configuration Commands

— LDP Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the status of all upstream sessions and label information exchanged:
ML66#show ldp upstream
Session peer 192.168.11.50:
Upstream state: Established Label: impl-null RequestID: 0 Peer:
192.168.11.50 Attr:
Upstream state: Established Label: impl-null RequestID: 0 Peer:
192.168.11.50 Attr:
Upstream state: Established Label: impl-null RequestID: 0 Peer:
192.168.11.50 Attr:
Session peer 192.168.13.60:
Upstream state: Established Label: impl-null RequestID: 0 Peer:
192.168.13.60 Attr: None
Upstream state: Established Label: impl-null RequestID: 0 Peer:
192.168.13.60 Attr: None
Upstream state: Established Label: impl-null RequestID: 0 Peer:
192.168.13.60 Attr: None
Upstream state: Established Label: 16 RequestID: 0 Peer: 192.168.13.60 Attr:
None
Upstream state: Established Label: 17 RequestID: 0 Peer: 192.168.13.60 Attr:
None
Upstream state: Established Label: impl-null RequestID: 0 Peer:
192.168.13.60 Attr: None
Upstream state: Established Label: 18 RequestID: 0 Peer: 192.168.13.60 Attr:
None
Upstream state: Established Label: 19 RequestID: 0 Peer: 192.168.13.60 Attr:
N --Mo

1012 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

99.136 show legalnotice

Synopsis
show legalnotice

Description
Use this command to display the customized legal notice.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Commands

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Examples
Displaying the customized legal notice:
ML66#show legalnotice
This is a customized legal notice.

99.137 show license install status

Synopsis
show license install status

Description
Use this command to display the status of the License Key File (LKF) installation.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— License Handling Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the status of the LKF installation:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1013


CLI Descriptions

ML66>show license install status


LKF was downloaded, stored on RMM and activated

99.138 show license restrict-unlocked-period

Synopsis
show license restrict-unlocked-period

Description
Use this command to display the current status of the unlocked period restriction
for control_user.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— License Handling Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the current status of the unlocked period restriction:
ML66>show license restrict-unlocked-period
Unlocked period restriction is disable

99.139 show license status

Synopsis
show license status [all | brief | fal <FAL>]

Description
Use this command to display the following information regarding the licensing
status of the NE:

— NE License Status

— NE License Mode

— RMM fingerprint

— Information about every license

1014 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— License Handling Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

FAL The license product FAL number.

Options

all Displays the licensing status of the NE and the status of


each license.

brief Displays the licensing status of the NE in brief. This option


is selected by default.

fal Displays the status of the given license product.

Examples
Displaying the licensing status of the NE:
ML66>show license status
NE License Status: Degraded
NE License Mode: Locked
RMM fingerprint: 6801135126a986072326ffff

Displaying the licensing status of the NE and the status of all licenses handling by
the SBL:
ML66>show license status all
NE License Status: Degraded
NE License Mode: Locked
RMM fingerprint: 6801135126a986072326ffff
Prod NO |Product Name |Use|Ins|Unl|Sum|Feature |License
------------+------------------------------+---+---+---+---+--------+--------
FAL1241127|Enable Monitoring | 1| 1| 0| 1| Ok| Ok
FAL1242515|M-L 669x R1 Basic SW | 1| 0| 1| 1| Ok| Ok
FAL1242517|M-L 6600 Eth ProviderMode | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242518|M-L 6600 Eth SOAM FM/PM | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242519|M-L 6600 IGMP snooping | 1| 0| 0| 0|Degraded| Missing
FAL1242521|M-L 6600 1588 sync | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242523|M-L 6600 PDH Network Prot | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242524|M-L 6600 Enable Eth port | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242525|M-L 6600 UG 25to50Mbps | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242526|M-L 6600 UG 50to100Mbps | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242527|M-L 6600 UG 100to150Mbps | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242528|M-L 6600 UG 150to200Mbps | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242529|M-L 6600 UG 200to250Mbps | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242530|M-L 6600 UG 250to300Mbps | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242531|M-L 6600 UG 300to350Mbps | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242532|M-L 6600 UG 350to400Mbps | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242533|M-L 6600 UG 400to450Mbps | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242534|M-L 6600 UG 450to500Mbps | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242535|M-L 6600 UG 500to600Mbps | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242536|M-L 6600 1+1 RL Prot | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1015


CLI Descriptions

FAL1242537|M-L 6600 XPIC | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok


FAL1242538|M-L 6600 RL Bonding | 6| 0| 3| 3|Degraded| Missing
FAL1242540|M-L 6600 Header Compr | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242541|M-L 6600 2nd carrier | 3| 0| 1| 1|Degraded| Missing
FAL1242542|M-L 6600 TX HP | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242543|M-L 6600 Mod Agile RAU Xu | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242544|M-L 6600 Node GUI | 1| 0| 1| 1| Ok| Ok
FAL1242609|M-L 6600 ERP | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242671|M-L 6600 UG 600to700Mbps | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242672|M-L 6600 UG 700to800Mbps | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242673|M-L 6600 UG 800to900Mbps | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242674|M-L 6600 UG 900to1000Mbps | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242675|M-L 6600 UG 1000to1250Mbps | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242692|M-L 6600 10Gb port | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242693|M-L 6600 E1 ports | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242805|M-L 6600 STM-1 port | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242806|M-L 6600 CES | 1| 0| 0| 0|Degraded| Missing
FAL1242973|M-L 6600 L3VPN Full Capacity | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1242974|M-L 6600 Basic IP/MPLS | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1243028|M-L 6600 NPU prot | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1243039|M-L 6600 Energy Eff | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok
FAL1243068|M-L 6600 OTH Encryption | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok

Displaying the licensing status of the FAL 124 2526 license:


ML66>show license status fal FAL1242526
Prod NO |Product Name |Use|Ins|Unl|Sum|Feature |License
------------+------------------------------+---+---+---+---+--------+--------
FAL1242526|M-L 6600 UG 50to100Mbps | 0| 0| 0| 0| Ok| Ok

99.140 show license status ports

Synopsis
show license status ports [[degraded] | {all | fal <FAL> | node | slot
<SLOTNUMBER> | port <SLOTNUMBER> <PORTNUMBER>}]

Description
Use this command to display detailed information on license usage on the NE.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— License Handling Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

FAL The license product FAL number.

SLOTNUMBER The slot number.

PORTNUMBER The port number.

1016 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Options

degraded Displays information about the degraded licenses only.

all Displays information about all licenses.

fal Displays information about licenses with the given license


product number.

node Displays information about licenses on node level.

port Displays information about licenses on the selected port.

slot Displays information about licenses on the selected slot.

Examples
Displaying all used licenses on the NE:
ML66>show license status ports
Prod NO |Product Name |Scope |Status
------------+----------------------------------------+-----------+----------
FAL1241127|Enable Monitoring | node| Ok
------------+----------------------------------------+-----------+-----------
FAL1242515|M-L 669x R1 Basic SW | node| Ok
------------+----------------------------------------+-----------+-----------
FAL1242519|M-L 6600 IGMP snooping | node| Degraded
------------+----------------------------------------+-----------+-----------
FAL1242538|M-L 6600 RL Bonding | 1/2/1| Ok
| | 1/2/2| Ok
| | 1/11/1| Ok
| | 1/11/2| Degraded
| | 1/12/1| Degraded
| | 1/12/2| Degraded
------------+----------------------------------------+-----------+-----------
FAL1242541|M-L 6600 2nd carrier | 1/2/2| Ok
| | 1/11/2| Degraded
| | 1/12/2| Degraded
------------+----------------------------------------+-----------+-----------
FAL1242544|M-L 6600 Node GUI | node| Ok
------------+----------------------------------------+-----------+-----------
FAL1242806|M-L 6600 CES | 1/7| Degraded
------------+----------------------------------------+-----------+-----------

99.141 show license unlockedperiod

Synopsis
show license unlockedperiod [ all | brief ]

Description
Use this command to display status information of the licensing unlocked
periods.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1017


CLI Descriptions

— License Handling Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Options

all Displays information about all type of unlocked periods.

brief Displays information about the current unlocked period.

Examples
Displaying information about the current unlocked period:
ML66>show license unlockedperiod
--Status---------------------------------------------
Unlocked Period Reason: N/A
Left Unlocked Time: N/A
Latest Unlocked Period Entered: 2014.08.25., 14:49:23

Displaying information about all type of unlocked periods:


ML66>show license unlockedperiod all
--Status---------------------------------------------
Unlocked Period Reason: N/A
Left Unlocked Time: N/A
Latest Unlocked Period Entered: 2014.08.25., 14:49:23
Integration Unlock Tokens: 1
Maintenance Unlock Tokens: 2
Emergency Unlock Tokens: 2
--Statistics-----------------------------------------
Unlocked by Integration: 0
Unlocked by Maintenance: 0
Unlocked by Emergency: 0
Unlocked by RMM Missing: 0
Unlocked by Software Upgrade: 1

99.142 show license upload status

Synopsis
show license upload status

Description
Use this command to display the upload status of the License Request File (LRF).

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— License Handling Commands

1018 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the upload status of the LRF:
ML66>show license upload status
Upload finished successfully

99.143 show linktrace

Synopsis
show linktrace

Description
Use this command to display linktrace results.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Linktrace and Loopback Configuration

Command Mode
Ethernet Service OAM MD MA MEP submode — (cfm-md-ma-mep)

Examples
Displaying linktrace results:
ML66(cfm-md-ma-mep)#show linktrace
Linktrace finished

Start Time:2014-11-18 12:09:05 ,TTL:64,Destination: 3

Transmitted 1 LTM and got 2 responses

Seq Number 1794766368 ,Receive Order 1


{
Ltr TTL: 63
Forwarded: YES
Terminal Mep: NO
Last Egress Identifier: 0000c8:35:b8:2f:57:47
Next Egress Identifier: 0000c8:35:b8:2f:57:34
Relay Action: RlyFDB

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1019


CLI Descriptions

Ingress Action: IngOK


Ingress MAC address: c8:35:b8:2f:57:34
}

Seq Number 1794766368 ,Receive Order 2


{
Ltr TTL: 62
Forwarded: NO
Terminal Mep: YES
Last Egress Identifier: 0000c8:35:b8:2f:57:34
Next Egress Identifier: 00003c:19:7d:4a:a1:43
Relay Action: RlyHit
Ingress Action: IngOK
Ingress MAC address: 3c:19:7d:4a:a1:43
LinkTrace hit Success
}

99.144 show lldp config

Synopsis
show lldp config [<RSP>]

Description
Use this command to display the current Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP)
configuration.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: LLDP

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

RSP The rack, slot, and port values of the interface whose
current LLDP configuration is to be displayed, in the
following format: <Rack/Slot/Port> .

Examples
Displaying all LLDP configuration of the NE:

1020 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

ML66>show lldp config


LLDP global settings:
lldp message-tx-interval 30
lldp message-tx-hold-multiplier 4
lldp message-fast-tx 1
lldp tx-fast-init 4
lldp notification-interval 30
LLDP interface level settings:
interface ethernet 1/6/4
! LLDP configuration
lldp dest-mac-address nearest-bridge
admin-status tx-and-rx
tlvs-tx-enable sys-name
tlvs-tx-enable sys-desc
tlvs-tx-enable man-addr-ipv4
exit
exit
interface ethernet 1/6/5
! LLDP configuration
lldp dest-mac-address nearest-bridge
admin-status disabled
tlvs-tx-enable sys-name
tlvs-tx-enable sys-desc
tlvs-tx-enable man-addr-ipv4
exit
exit

Displaying LLDP configuration only for LAN 1/6/4:


ML66>show lldp config 1/6/4
interface ethernet 1/6/4
! LLDP configuration
lldp dest-mac-address nearest-bridge
admin-status tx-and-rx
tlvs-tx-enable sys-name
tlvs-tx-enable sys-desc
tlvs-tx-enable man-addr-ipv4
exit
exit

99.145 show lldp counters

Synopsis
show lldp counters [<RSP>]

Description
Use this command to display Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP) counters.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: LLDP

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1021


CLI Descriptions

Operands

RSP The rack, slot, and port values of the interface whose
current LLDP counters are to be displayed, in the
following format: <Rack/Slot/Port>.

Examples
Displaying all LLDP counters on the NE:
ML66>show lldp counters
LLDP global counters:
Remote table inserts : 2
Remote table deletes : 0
Remote table drops : 0
Remote table ageouts : 0
Remote tables last changed : 0 days 0 hours 8 minutes 8 seconds ago
LAN 1/6/4
Tx Frames total : 48
Rx Frames total : 46
Rx Frames discarded : 0
Rx Frames error : 0
Unknown TLVs total : 0
Ageouts total : 0
LAN 1/6/6
Tx Frames total : 23
Rx Frames total : 19
Rx Frames discarded : 0
Rx Frames error : 0
Unknown TLVs total : 0
Ageouts total : 0

Displaying the LLDP counters of LAN 1/6/4:


ML66>show lldp counters 1/6/4

LAN 1/6/4
Tx Frames total : 52
Rx Frames total : 50
Rx Frames discarded : 0
Rx Frames error : 0
Unknown TLVs total : 0
Ageouts total : 0

99.146 show lldp local-info

Synopsis
show lldp local-info

Description
Use this command to display the LLDP-related local system information that is
advertised to LLDP neighbors.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

1022 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

— Ethernet Commands: LLDP

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying LLDP-related local system information:
ML66>show lldp local-info
LLDP local system data:
Chassis Id type : locally assigned(7)
Chassis Id : X912405681
System Name : ML66-10-41-105-133
System Description : MINI-LINK 6600
Management Address : 10.41.105.133
Management Address : 2001:db8::1

99.147 show lldp neighbors

Synopsis
show lldp neighbors [<RSP>]

Description
Use this command to display the LLDP information received from LLDP
neighbors.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: LLDP

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

RSP The rack, slot, and port values of the selected interface, in
the following format: <Rack/Slot/Port> .

Examples
Displaying information received from all LLDP neighbors:
ML66>show lldp neighbors
+----------+-------------------+----------------------+----------------+------+--- →
-------------------+----------------------------+----------------------+
|Interface |Dest. Mac Address |Chassis ID |Port ID |TTL |Sys →
tem Name |System Description |Management Address |
+----------+-------------------+----------------------+----------------+------+--- →

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1023


CLI Descriptions

-------------------+----------------------------+----------------------+
|1/6/4 |01:80:C2:00:00:0E |X912466689 |1/6/4 |121 |ML66 →
-10-41-105-132 |MINI-LINK 6600 |10.41.105.132 |
|1/6/5 |01:80:C2:00:00:0E |X912405677 |1/6/5 |121 |ML66 →
-10-41-105-128 |MINI-LINK 6600 |10.41.105.128 |

Displaying information received from LLDP neighbors on LAN 1/6/4:


ML66>show lldp neighbors 1/6/4
Local Interface : 1/6/4
Dest. Mac Address : 01:80:C2:00:00:0E
Chassis ID Type : locally assigned(7)
Chassis ID : X912466689
Port ID Type : interface name(5)
Port ID : 1/6/4
Port Description : LAN
Time to Live : 121
System Name : ML66-10-41-105-132
System Description : MINI-LINK 6600
Management Address : 10.41.105.132

99.148 show local-info

Synopsis
show local-info

Description
Use this command to display the LLDP-related local system information that is
advertised to LLDP neighbors.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: LLDP

Command Mode
LLDP interface level configuration submode — (config-lldp)

Examples
Displaying LLDP-related local system information:
ML66(config-lldp)#show local-info
LLDP local system data:
Chassis Id type : locally assigned(7)
Chassis Id : X912405681
System Name : ML66-10-41-105-133
System Description : MINI-LINK 6600
Management Address : 10.41.105.133
Management Address : 2001:db8::1

99.149 show localuseridletimer

1024 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Synopsis
show localuseridletimer

Description
Use this command to display the inactivity timer in minutes for all local users.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the inactivity timer for local users:
ML66>show localuseridletimer
idle Timer user local = 15 min

99.150 show loopback

Synopsis
show loopback

Description
Use this command to display loopback results.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Linktrace and Loopback Configuration

Command Mode
Ethernet Service OAM MD MA MEP submode — (cfm-md-ma-mep)

Examples
Displaying loopback results:
ML66(cfm-md-ma-mep)#show loopback
Loopback session status: in progress
Source MEP Id: 61
Destination MAC: 00:00:00:00:00:00
LBM messages to send: 1
LBR timeout: 5000 ms

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1025


CLI Descriptions

Vlan priority: 0
Vlan drop eligibility enabled: yes
PDU secuense number: 0
Sent LBMs: 9
Received LBRs: 9
Lost LBRs: 0
Missordered LBRs: 0

99.151 show mac-address-table

Synopsis
show mac-address-table [interface <R/S/P>] [vlan <VLAN-ID>] [port
<BRIDGE-PORT-ID>] [address <MAC-ADDRESS-MASK>] [lag <LAGID>]
[static] [dynamic] [full] [count]

Description
Use this command to display the contents of the table with learned Media Access
Control (MAC) addresses.

If a filter is specified, only MAC address entries that match the filter are listed. If
no filter is specified, maximum 100 rows are displayed to prevent flooding the
user terminal. Use the full option to display all address entries.

Note: The displayed MAC address table is refreshed in every 64 seconds.The


MAC address can be visible at latest 64 seconds after it was deleted
from the lower layer forwarding table.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

R/S/P The Rack, Slot, and Port value of the interface where the
format is <Rack/Slot/Port>.

VLAN-ID Identifier of the VLAN.

BRIDGE-PORT-ID
Identifier of the port.

MAC-ADDRESS-MASK
Identifier of the MAC address. It can be complete MAC
address, like 06:fe:12:34:56:78, or incomplete MAC
address with wildcard * marks, like * 06:fe *.

LAGID Identifier of LAG, in <Rack/Slot/Port> format.

1026 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Options

interface Lists only the entries belonging to the specified interface.

vlan Lists only the entries belonging to the specified VLAN.

port Lists only the entries for the specified bridge port.

address Lists only the entries matching this address.

static Lists only the entries that are static.

lag Lists only the entries belonging to the LAG.

dynamic Lists only the entries that are dynamic.

full Lists all address entries.

count Displays only the count without MAC address table.

Examples
Displaying MAC address table:
ML66#show mac-address-table
VLAN MAC Address Status Port Interface
----+-----------------+-------+----+-------------
1 00:0f:66:8e:67:7e learned 3 LAN 1/6/5
1 00:0f:66:ad:b1:f3 learned 3 LAN 1/6/5
1 08:00:27:9a:c2:04 learned 3 LAN 1/6/5
1 34:64:a9:7e:3c:20 learned 3 LAN 1/6/5
1 9c:b6:54:9f:9a:44 learned 3 LAN 1/6/5
1 ac:60:b6:97:20:99 learned 1 LAN-DCN 1/6/0
1 ec:f4:bb:35:0e:ca learned 3 LAN 1/6/5
1 f0:4d:a2:4e:8f:e3 learned 3 LAN 1/6/5
----+-----------------+-------+----+-------------
Showing 8 out of 8 entries.
Aging Time 300

99.152 show mac-whitelist

Synopsis
show mac-whitelist [<LISTNO> ]

Description
Use this command to display the contents of a Media Access Control (MAC) white
list.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1027


CLI Descriptions

— Ethernet Commands: Security and Admission Control

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

LISTNO The number of the MAC address list.

Examples
Displaying the specified MAC white list:
ML66>show mac-whitelist 1
ethernet-mac-whitelist 1
name whitelist
mac 00:00:00:00:00:00
mac 00:00:00:00:00:01
mac 00:00:00:00:00:02

99.153 show memory

Synopsis
show memory process cesp

Description
Use this command to display information about memory processes.

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Options

process cesp Displays information about the Circuit Emulation Service


(CES) process.

Examples
Displaying information about the CES process:
ML66#show memory process cesp
/proc info:
VmPeak: 9016 kB
VmSize: 9000 kB
VmLck: 0 kB
VmPin: 0 kB
VmHWM: 2452 kB
VmRSS: 2452 kB
VmData: 408 kB

1028 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

VmStk: 132 kB
VmExe: 652 kB
VmLib: 6276 kB
VmPTE: 36 kB
VmSwap: 0 kB
mallinfo():
Total space allocated (arena): 255016
number of non-inuse chunks (ordblks): 43
unused -- always zero (smblks): 0
number of mmapped regions (hblks): 0
total space in mmapped regions (hblkhd): 0
unused -- always zero (usmblks): 0
unused -- always zero (fsmblks): 0
total allocated space (uordblks): 117088
total non-inuse space (fordblks): 137928
top-most, releasable (malloc_trim) space (keepcost): 128328

99.154 show mfib status

Synopsis
show mfib status

Description
Use this command to display the alarm status, capacity, and fill level of the IP
multicast forwarding table, used by Internet Group Management Protocol
(IGMP) and Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD) snooping.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— IGMP and MLD Snooping Commands

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Examples
Displaying the status of the IP multicast forwarding table:
ML66#show mfib status
Alarm Information
MC forwarding table alarm enabled: no
MC forwarding table alarm status: 0
Max. number of MC forwarding table entries in HW: 1023
Current number of MC forwarding table entries in HW: 2

99.155 show mld snooping

Synopsis
show mld snooping

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1029


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to display the global status of Multicast Listener Discovery
(MLD) snooping on the NE.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— IGMP and MLD Snooping Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the global status of MLD snooping:
ML66#show mld snooping
MLD snooping Admin State: Enabled
MLD snooping Oper State: Up

99.156 show mld snooping config

Synopsis
show mld snooping config

Description
Use this command to display Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD) snooping
configuration.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— IGMP and MLD Snooping Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying MLD snooping configuration:
ML66#show mld snooping config
mld snooping enable
mld snooping vlan 10
proxy-reporting
query-interval 125
robust 2
exit

1030 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

99.157 show mld snooping group

Synopsis
show mld snooping group [<GRPADDR> [source <SRCADDR>]] vlan
<VLANID> [ctag <CVID>]

Description
Use this command to display a list of Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD)
multicast groups and the associated member ports on a specific VLAN.

Use the optional <GRPADDR> and <SRCADDR> operands to display detailed


port membership information for a specific multicast group or channel.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— IGMP and MLD Snooping Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

GRPADDR Specifies the multicast group address.

SRCADDR Specifies the IP address of the multicast source.

VLANID The VLAN identification number in the outer VLAN tag.


The valid range is 1–4094.

CVID The C-VID identification number in the inner VLAN tag.


The valid range is 1–4094.

Options

source The IP address of the multicast source.

ctag The customer VLAN tag.

Examples
Displaying the list of multicast groups and channels on VLAN 10:
ML66#show mld snooping group vlan 10
VLAN:10 CVLAN:-
Group Addr: ff38::db8:0:1, Source Addr: 2001::1, Members: 1/6/4

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1031


CLI Descriptions

Group Addr: ff38::db8:0:1, Source Addr: 2001::2, Members: 1/6/4


Group Addr: ff38::db8:0:2, Source Addr: * , Members: 1/6/4,1/1/2

Displaying detailed information for multicast group ff38::db8:0:2 on VLAN 10:


ML66#show mld snooping group ff38::db8:0:2 vlan 10
Multicast Group details
Group Addr: ff38::db8:0:2, Source Addr: *, VLAN/CVLAN: 10/-
LAN 1/6/4 Expires: 198 s, Uptime: 00:26:59
WAN 1/1/2 Expires: 195 s, Uptime: 00:03:23

99.158 show mld snooping mrouter

Synopsis
show mld snooping mrouter [vlan <VLANID> [ctag <CVID>]]

Description
Use this command to display the multicast router ports on a specific VLAN.

Use this command without the vlan option to display multicast router ports on all
Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD) snooping enabled VLANs.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— IGMP and MLD Snooping Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

VLANID The VLAN identification number in the outer VLAN tag.


The valid range is 1–4094.

CVID The C-VID identification number in the inner VLAN tag.


The valid range is 1–4094.

Options

ctag The customer VLAN tag.

Examples
Displaying multicast router ports of VLAN 10:
ML66#show mld snooping mrouter vlan 10
Multicast router ports

1032 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

VLAN:10 CVLAN:-
LAN 1/6/4 Expires: 105 s, Uptime: 00:26:21

99.159 show mld snooping vlan

Synopsis
show mld snooping vlan <VLANID> [ctag <CVID>] [counter]

Description
Use this command to display Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD) snooping status
on a specific VLAN.

Use the counter option to also display the per VLAN port MLD message counters.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— IGMP and MLD Snooping Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

VLANID The VLAN identification number in the outer VLAN tag.


The valid range is 1–4094.

CVID The C-VID identification number in the inner VLAN tag.


The valid range is 1–4094.

Options

ctag The customer VLAN tag.

counter Displays the port counters.

Examples
Displaying MLD snooping status of VLAN 10:
ML66#show mld snooping vlan 10 counter
VLAN:10 CVLAN:-
Querier address: fe80::1
Querier version: 2
Query interval: 125 s
Robustness variable: 2
Query response interval: 10 s
Group count: 3
Router port count: 1

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1033


CLI Descriptions

MLD counters
LAN 1/6/4
Joins received: 254
Leaves received: 0
Gen.queries received: 121
Spec.queries sent: 0
Spec.queries received: 0
Invalid MLD msg. rec.: 0
WAN 1/1/2
Joins received: 123
Leaves received: 0
Gen.queries received: 0
Spec.queries sent: 0
Spec.queries received: 0
Invalid MLD msg. rec.: 0

99.160 show mpls

Synopsis
show mpls

Description
Use this command to display MPLS data.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— MPLS Configuration Commands

— MPLS Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying MPLS data:
ML66#show mpls
Minimum label configured: 16
Maximum label configured: 1048575
Per label-space information:
Label-space 0 is using minimum label: 16 and maximum label: 1048575
Label-space 2342 is using minimum label: 556 and maximum label: 1048575
Custom ingress TTL configured: none
Custom egress TTL configured: none
Log message detail: none
Admin group detail: none
Packets dropped IP:115167, dropped MPLS:0 sent to IP:490943, labeled:0,
switch
d:0
MPLS Differentiated Services Supported Classes data:
CLASS DSCP_value
be 000000
MPLS Differentiated Services CLASS to EXP mapping data:
CLASS DSCP_value EXP_value
be 000000 0

1034 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

99.161 show mpls cross-connect-table

Synopsis
show mpls cross-connect-table [<INDEX> ] [detail]

Description
Use this command to display detailed information for all entries created in the
MPLS cross-connect table.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— MPLS Configuration Commands

— MPLS Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

INDEX The cross connect entry index. The valid range is 1–


4294967295.

Options

detail Displays detailed information.

Examples
Displaying detailed information for all entries created in the MPLS cross-connect
table:
ML66#show mpls cross-connect-table
Cross connect ix: 3, in intf: -, in label: 0, out-segment ix: 3
Owner: RSVP, Persistent: No, Admin Status: Up, Oper Status: Up
Out-segment with ix: 3, owner: RSVP, out intf: 1/9/4.500, out label: 16
Nexthop addr: 10.10.20.80, cross connect ix: 3, op code: Push
Cross connect ix: 6, in intf: -, in label: 0, out-segment ix: 6
Owner: RSVP, Persistent: No, Admin Status: Up, Oper Status: Up
Out-segment with ix: 6, owner: RSVP, out intf: 1/9/4.500, out label: 17
Nexthop addr: 10.10.20.80, cross connect ix: 6, op code: Push

99.162 show mpls forwarding-table

Synopsis
show mpls forwarding-table

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1035


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to display Diffserv configuration information and the
forwarding table entries.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— MPLS Configuration Commands

— MPLS Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Display Diffserv configuration information and the forwarding table entries:
ML66#show mpls forwarding-table
Codes:> - selected FTN, p - stale FTN, B - BGP FTN, K - CLI FTN,
L - LDP FTN, R - RSVP-TE FTN, S - SNMP FTN, I - IGP-Shortcut,
U - unknown FTN, T - MPLS-TP Map FTN
Code FEC Tunnel-id FTN-ID Pri Nexthop Out-Label Out-Intf LSP-Type
T> 114.1.2.3/32 0 1 Yes - 57 1/9/4.500 LSP_DEFAULT

99.163 show mpls ftn-table

Synopsis
show mpls ftn-table [<IPADDR/PREFIX> ] [detail]

Description
Use this command to display MPLS FEC-To-NHLFE (FTN) table information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— MPLS Configuration Commands

— MPLS Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IPADDR/PREFIX The Forwarding Equivalence Class (FEC) for which FTN


entries are displayed with prefix length, where the format
is <A.B.C.D/P> .

1036 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Options

detail Displays detailed FTN entries for the given FEC.

Examples
Displaying FTN table information:
ML66#show mpls ftn-table

99.164 show mpls ilm-table

Synopsis
show mpls ilm-table [ {<IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> | –} <LABEL> ]

Description
Use this command to display MPLS Incoming Label Map (ILM) table information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— MPLS Configuration Commands

— MPLS Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN
The incoming interface name, where the format is <Rack/
Slot/Port.VLAN> .

LABEL The incoming label. The valid range is 16–1048575.

Options

– Displays entries for packets on any interface.

Examples
Displaying MPLS ILM table information:
ML66#show mpls ilm-table
Codes:> - selected ILM, p - stale ILM, K - CLI ILM, T - MPLS-TP
Code In-Label Out-Label In-Intf Out-Intf Nexthop FEC ILM-ID LSP-Typ

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1037


CLI Descriptions

T> 22 N/A 1/9/4.500 N/A N/A N/A 1


LSP_DEFAULT

99.165 show mpls in-segment-table

Synopsis
show mpls in-segment-table [ {<IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> | –} <LABEL> ]
[detail]

Description
Use this command to display detailed information about all entries in the
Incoming Label Map (ILM) table.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— MPLS Configuration Commands

— MPLS Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN
The incoming interface name, where the format is <Rack/
Slot/Port.VLAN> .

LABEL The incoming label. The valid range is 16–1048575.

Options

– Displays entries for packets on any interface.

detail Displays detailed information.

Examples
Displaying detailed information about all entries in the ILM table:
ML66#show mpls in-segment-table

99.166 show mpls interface

1038 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Synopsis
show mpls interface [<IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> ] [detail]

Description
Use this command to display all interfaces bound to an MPLS interface.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— MPLS Configuration Commands

— MPLS Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN
The Rack, Slot, and Port values and VLAN number of the
L3 VLAN subinterface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/
Port.VLAN>, for example, 1/9/4.500.

Options

detail Displays detailed information.

Examples
Displaying all interfaces bound to an MPLS interface:
ML66#show mpls interface 1/9/4.500 detail

99.167 show mpls ldp

Synopsis

— show mpls ldp discovery [<IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> | lo]

— show mpls ldp fec prefix [<IPADDR/PREFIX>]

— show mpls ldp igp sync [<IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> | lo | lo. <VRF>]

— show mpls ldp parameter

— show mpls ldp neighbor [detail]

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1039


CLI Descriptions

— show mpls ldp session [<IPADDR>]

Description
Use this command to display MPLS Label Distribution Protocol (LDP) data.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— LDP Configuration Commands

— LDP Interface Commands

— MPLS Configuration Commands

— MPLS Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN
The Rack, Slot, and Port values and VLAN number of the
L3 VLAN subinterface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/
Port.VLAN>, for example, 1/9/4.500.

lo.VRF The loopback interface of a Virtual Routing and


Forwarding (VRF) instance, for example lo.vrf_1.

IPADDR The IPv4 address of the session peer, where the format is
<A.B.C.D>.

IPADDR/PREFIX The IPv4 address and prefix length of the session peer,
where the format is <A.B.C.D/P>.

Options

discovery Displays the sources of locally generated LDP discovery


hello PDUs.

lo Displays the router loopback interface.

fec prefix Displays the Forwarding Equivalence Class and the


Forwarding Equivalence Class (FEC) prefix.

igp sync Displays LDP IGP parameters and LDP IGP


synchronization parameters.

1040 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

parameter Displays LDP configuration parameters.

neighbor Displays LDP neighbor information.

detail Displays detailed neighbor information.

session Displays LDP session information.

Examples
Displaying MPLS LDP data:
ML66#show mpls ldp session 1.1.1.1

99.168 show mpls mapped-routes

Synopsis
show mpls mapped-routes

Description
Use this command to display MPLS mapped routes.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— MPLS Configuration Commands

— MPLS Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying MPLS mapped routes:
ML66#show mpls mapped-routes
Mapped-route IPv4 FEC MPLS-TP Tunnel
14.1.2.3/32 N/A NH4

99.169 show mpls out-segment-table

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1041


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
show mpls out-segment-table [<IPADDR> <IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> <LABEL> ]

Description
Use this command to display detailed information of out-segment entries table.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— MPLS Configuration Commands

— MPLS Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IPADDR The nexthop IPv4 address, where the format is


<A.B.C.D> .

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN
The egress interface name, where the format is <Rack/
Slot/Port.VLAN> .

LABEL The egress label. The valid range is 0–1048575.

Examples
Displaying detailed information of out-segment entries table:
ML66#show mpls out-segment-table

99.170 show mpls vc-table

Synopsis
show mpls vc-table

Description
Use this command to display configured virtual circuit components.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— MPLS Configuration Commands

1042 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

— MPLS Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying configured virtual circuit components:
ML66#show mpls vc-table
VC-ID Vlan-ID Access-Intf Network-Intf Out Label Tunnel-Label Nexthop
Status
500 N/A 1/9/4.500 1/9/4.501 544 57 N/A
Active

99.171 show mpls vrf-table

Synopsis

— show mpls vrf-table <VRFNAME> [<IPADDR/PREFIX> ] [detail]

— show mpls vrf-table [detail]

Description
Use this command to display detailed information for all the installed FTN entries
for a Virtual Routing and Forwarding (VRF) instance.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— MPLS Configuration Commands

— MPLS Interface Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

VRFNAME Displays the MPLS VRF table by its configured name.

IPADDR/PREFIX The Forwarding Equivalence Class (FEC) for which the


VRF entry is displayed, where the format is <A.B.C.D/P> .

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1043


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Displaying detailed information for all the installed FTN entries for a VRF
instance:
ML66#show mpls vrf new_vrf

99.172 show mst

Synopsis
show mst

Description
Use this command to display Multiple Spanning Tree (MST) configuration.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying spanning tree MST configuration:
ML66>show mst

99.173 show neighbors

Synopsis
show neighbors

Description
Use this command to display the LLDP information received from LLDP
neighbors.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: LLDP

Command Mode
LLDP interface level configuration submode — (config-lldp)

1044 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Examples
Displaying information received from the LLDP neighbors of the current interface:
ML66(config-lldp)#show neighbors
Local Interface : 1/6/4
Dest. Mac Address : 01:80:C2:00:00:0E
Chassis ID Type : locally assigned(7)
Chassis ID : X912466689
Port ID Type : interface name(5)
Port ID : 1/6/4
Port Description : LAN
Time to Live : 121
System Name : ML66-10-41-105-132
System Description : MINI-LINK 6600
Management Address : 10.41.105.132

99.174 show netstat

Synopsis
show netstat [ udp | tcp | stats | routes | ip | interfaces | icmp ]

Description
Use this command to display netstatistics.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Options

udp Displays UDP statistics.

tcp Displays TCP statistics.

stats Displays statistics.

routes Displays route statistics.

ip Displays IP statistics.

interfaces Displays interface statistics.

icmp Displays Internet Control Message Protocol (ICMP)


statistics.

Examples
Displaying UDP statistics:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1045


CLI Descriptions

ML66>show netstat udp

99.175 show network-synch status

Synopsis
show network-synch status

Description
Use this command to display status information about the Netsync and
configured Netsync Nominees.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Synchronization Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
For ETSI, displaying Network-Synch status:
ML66>show network-synch status
Selection mode: QL-enabled
Active NomId: 2
Forced switch: 0 (disabled)
Status: LOCKED
Availability: AVAILABLE
Netref redundancy: Yes
Holdover slot: 4
Holdover count: 1
Holdover source: NETREF2
Squelch config: Disabled
Squelch status: OFF
Egress SSM: PRC
NomId R/S/P Priority Assigned Quality Quality Level Locked Out →
Elapsed SSM
1 1/4/3 4 SSU-B SSU-B No →
99.999s NSUPP
2 1/4/8 NS 4 Not assigned PRC No →
99.999s PRC
3 - - - - - →
-.- -
4 - - - - - →
-.- -

For ANSI, displaying Network-Synch status:


ML66>show network-synch status
Selection mode: QL-enabled
Active NomId: 1
Forced switch: 0 (disabled)
Status: LOCKED
Availability: AVAILABLE
Netref redundancy: Yes

1046 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Holdover slot: 9
Holdover count: 1
Holdover source: NETREF2
Squelch config: Disabled
Squelch status: OFF
Egress SSM: ST3
NomId R/S/P Priority Assigned Quality Quality Level Locked Out →
Elapsed SSM
1 1/9/3 4 ST3 ST3 No →
99.999s NSUPP
2 1/9/4 NS 2 SMC SMC No →
99.999s INV
3 - - - - - →
-.- -
4 - - - - - →
-.- -

99.176 show notification-log

Synopsis
show notification-log { alarms | events }

Description
Use this command to display the history of notifications generated by the node.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Options

alarms Displays the generated alarm notifications.

events Displays the generated event notifications.

Examples
Displaying alarm notifications:
ML66>show notification-log alarms

99.177 show ntp-status

Synopsis
show ntp-status

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1047


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to display NTP configuration and status.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying NTP configuration and status:
ML66>show ntp-status
NTP server Address: 10.44.66.18
NTP protocol type/version: v4Auth
FTP key file server Address: FTPWrongKey
NTP status: Service Down

99.178 show pingtargethost

Synopsis
show pingtargethost

Description
Use this command to display the Ping Target Host address.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— DCN Basic Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Local Access configuration submode — (interface-local-access)

Examples
Displaying the Ping Target Host address:
ML66(interface-local-access)#show pingtargethost

1048 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

99.179 show policing

Synopsis
show policing [<RSP>]

Description
Use this command to display policing configuration.

Executing the command without <RSP> operand, all policing configuration is


displayed. Executing the command with <RSP> operand, only the specified
interface is displayed.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: QoS - Policing and Color Marking

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port values of the interface where the
format is <Rack/Slot/Port>.

Examples
Displaying policing configuration:
ML66>show policing 1/6/5

99.180 show policing-bandwidth-profile

Synopsis
show policing-bandwidth-profile [<PROFILENUMBER> ]

Description
Use this command to display policing bandwidth profiles.

Executing the command without <PROFILENUMBER> operand, all policing


bandwidth configuration is displayed. Executing the command with
<PROFILENUMBER> operand, only the specified profile number is displayed.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1049


CLI Descriptions

— Ethernet Commands: QoS - Policing and Color Marking

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

PROFILENUMBER
The unique index of the bandwidth profile.

Examples
Displaying policing bandwidth profiles:
ML66>show policing-bandwidth-profile 2

99.181 show policing-cos-groups

Synopsis
show policing-cos-groups [<RSP>]

Description
Use this command to display policing Class of Service (CoS) groups configuration.

Executing the command without <RSP> operand, all policing CoS groups
configuration is displayed. Executing the command with <RSP> operand, only
the specified interface is displayed.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: QoS - Policing and Color Marking

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port values of the interface, where
the format is <Rack/Slot/Port>.

Examples
Displaying policing CoS groups configuration:

1050 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

ML66>show policing-cos-groups 1/6/5

99.182 show policing-cos-group-mapping

Synopsis
show policing-cos-group-mapping [<RSP>]

Description
Use this command to display policing CoS group mapping configuration.

Executing the command without <RSP> operand, all policing CoS group mapping
configuration is displayed. Executing the command with <RSP> operand, only
the specified interface is displayed.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: QoS - Policing and Color Marking

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port values of the interface, where
the format is <Rack/Slot/Port>.

Examples
Displaying policing CoS group mapping configuration:
ML66>show policing-cos-group-mapping 1/6/5

99.183 show policing-vlan-groups

Synopsis
show policing-vlan-groups [<RSP>]

Description
Use this command to display policing VLAN groups configuration.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1051


CLI Descriptions

Use the command without the <RSP> operand to display all policing VLAN
groups configuration. Execute the command with the <RSP> operand to display
only the specified interface.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: QoS - Policing and Color Marking

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port values of the interface in the
following format: <Rack/Slot/Port>.

Examples
Displaying policing VLAN groups configuration:
ML66>show policing-vlan-groups 1/6/5

99.184 show policing-vlan-group-mapping

Synopsis
show policing-vlan-group-mapping [<RSP>]

Description
Use this command to display policing VLAN group mapping configuration.

Use the command without the <RSP> operand to display all policing VLAN group
mapping configuration. Execute the command with the <RSP> operand to
display only the specified interface.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: QoS - Policing and Color Marking

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port values of the interface in the
following format: <Rack/Slot/Port>.

1052 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Examples
Displaying policing VLAN group mapping configuration:
ML66>show policing-vlan-group-mapping 1/6/5

99.185 show processes

Synopsis
show processes

Description
Use this command to list the running Operating System (OS) processes in the
node, such as CPU and memory use.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying OS processes:
ML66>show processes

99.186 show ptp alarms-and-events

Synopsis
show ptp alarms-and-events

Description
Use this command to display alarm and event status of the Precision Time
Protocol (PTP) function.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: General Configuration

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1053


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Displaying alarm and event status:
ML66(config)#show ptp alarms-and-events
Alarms
============================================
freeRunningMode enabled
traceabilityLost enabled
holdoverEntered enabled
clockProtectionLost enabled
incompatibleHardware enabled
Events
============================================
clockSwitch disabled

99.187 show ptp clock

Synopsis
show ptp clock

Description
Use this command to display clock status information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: General Configuration

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying clock status information:
ML66(config)#show ptp clock
Ptp Clock:
------------
Clock-identity: AA:CC:99:FF:EE:99:CC:22
Clock state: LOCKED
RTC Time: 1418474783 sec, 2014-12-13T12:45:48Z
Locked state counter: 1
All time spent in locked state: 87130 sec, 1 days 0 hours 12 min 10 sec
Last time spent in locked state: 87130sec, 1 days 0 hours 12 min 10 sec
Master changed counter: 1
Clock-servo state: locked (5)
Clock-servo pdv: forward 124ns, backward 127ns
Clock-servo flags: 0x00000000

1054 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

99.188 show ptp clock current-ds

Synopsis
show ptp clock current-ds

Description
Use this command to display the current values in the current Dataset (DS). For
more information, see Precision Clock Synchronization Protocol for Networked
Measurement and Control Systems.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: General Configuration

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the current values in the current DS:
ML66(config)#show ptp clock current-ds
current-ds:n
-------------------------
steps-removed: 5
offset-from-master: -6
mean-path-delay: 1000 ns

99.189 show ptp clock default-ds

Synopsis
show ptp clock default-ds

Description
Use this command to display the current values in the default Dataset (DS). For
more information, see Precision Clock Synchronization Protocol for Networked
Measurement and Control Systems.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: General Configuration

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1055


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the current values in default DS:
ML66(config)#show ptp clock default-ds
default-ds:
-------------------------
two-step-flag: false
clock-identity: AA:CC:99:FF:EE:99:CC:22
priority1: 128
priority2: 128
slave-only: false
quality-class: 187
quality-accuracy: unknown
quality-offset: 18944

99.190 show ptp clock parent-ds

Synopsis
show ptp clock parent-ds

Description
Use this command to display the current values in the parent Dataset (DS). For
more information, see Precision Clock Synchronization Protocol for Networked
Measurement and Control Systems.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: General Configuration

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the current values in parent DS:
ML66(config)#show ptp clock parent-ds
parent-ds:
-------------------------
parent-port-identity: 3C:19:7D:FF:FE:48:EB:F6
parent-stats: 1
offset-scaled-logvar: 17408
phase-change-rate: 0
gm-identity: 00:B0:AE:FF:FE:00:00:30
gm-priority1: 50
gm-priority2: 50
gm-quality-class: 187

1056 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

gm-quality-accuracy: unknown
gm-quality-offset: 25600

99.191 show ptp clock settings

Synopsis
show ptp clock settings

Description
Use this command to display the general settings of the clock.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: General Configuration

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the general setting of the clock:
ML66(config)#show ptp clock settings
Domain number : 0
Device type : boundary clock
Transport mode : multicast
Profile : ieee1588v2
Role : Best Master Algorithm
User description:

99.192 show ptp clock time-properties-ds

Synopsis
show ptp clock time-properties-ds

Description
Use this command to display the current values in time properties Dataset (DS).
For more information, see Precision Clock Synchronization Protocol for
Networked Measurement and Control Systems.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: General Configuration

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1057


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the current values in time properties DS:
ML66(config)#show ptp clock time-properties-ds
time-properties-ds:
-------------------------
current-utc-offset-valid: 1
current-utc-offset: 35
leap59: false
leap61: false
time-traceable: true
freq-traceable: true
ptp-timescale: true
source: gps

99.193 show ptp clock-port

Synopsis
show ptp clock-port [<NAME>] [statistics]

Description
Use this command to display the clock port related objects.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: General Configuration

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

NAME The name of the clock port.

Options

statistics Displays the related statistic information for the specified


clock port.

Examples
Displaying clock port related objects:
ML66(config)#show ptp clock-port
configured L2 ports:
---------------------+------------+-----------+----------+-------------+-----+---- →

1058 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

-+-----------------+
Name |Admin State |Oper State |Port Role |Interface |Vlan |Prio →
|Local Address |
---------------------+------------+-----------+----------+-------------+-----+---- →
-+-----------------+
test |DOWN |DOWN |disabled |WAN 1/1/1 |no |7 →
|34:6E:9D:43:8B:A9|
configured L3 ports:
---------------------+------------+-----------+----------+-------------+---------- →
--------+-----+
Name |Admin State |Oper State |Port Role |Interface |IP Address →
|DSCP |
---------------------+------------+-----------+----------+-------------+---------- →
--------+-----+
1/6/5 |UP |UP |master |1/6/5.1588 |172.16.254. →
2 |46 |

Displaying 1/6/5 IP clock port related objects:


ML66(config)#show ptp clock-port 1/6/5
1/6/5
--------------------------------------------------------------
Admin state: UP
Operational state: UP
Port role: master
Transport mode: unicast
EncapsulationType: udpipv4
Interface: 1/6/5.1588
IpAddress: 172.16.254.2
Dscp: 46
Name: 1/6/5
PortIdentity: 34:6E:9D:FF:FE:43:8B:A9::00:00
DelayMech: End to end
PTPVersion: 2
Unicast Configuration:
--------------------------------------------------------------
AnnounceInterval: 1 (2.000000 sec)
AnnounceRctTimeout: 3
DelayRespInterval: -4 (0.062500 sec)
DelayRespTimeout: 3
Duration: 300 sec
QueryInterval: 0 (1.000000 sec)
SyncInterval: -4 (0.062500 sec)
SyncTimeout: 3
WaitToRestoreTime: 5 min
UnicastMaster: Calnex-1
--------------------------------------------------------------
PortId: 00:00:00:00:00:00:00:00
NetworkProtocol: udpipv4
IpAddress: 192.168.0.2
LocalPriority: 8
Enabled: true
Accessible: No

Displaying L2 clock port named test:


ML66(config)#show ptp clock-port test
test
--------------------------------------------------------------
Admin state: DOWN
Operational state: DOWN
Port role: disabled
Transport mode: unicast
EncapsulationType: ieee8023
Interface: WAN 1/1/1
Local MAC address 34:6E:9D:43:8B:A9
VlanId: 0
VlanPriority: 7
Name: test
PortIdentity: 34:6E:9D:FF:FE:43:8B:A9::00:02
DelayMech: End to end
PTPVersion: 2
Unicast Configuration:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1059


CLI Descriptions

--------------------------------------------------------------
AnnounceInterval: 1 (2.000000 sec)
AnnounceRctTimeout: 3
DelayRespInterval: -4 (0.062500 sec)
DelayRespTimeout: 3
Duration: 300 sec
QueryInterval: 0 (1.000000 sec)
SyncInterval: -4 (0.062500 sec)
SyncTimeout: 3
WaitToRestoreTime: 5 min

Displaying cp1 clock port related packet counters. Delta counters show the
transmitted and received packets of each type since the last query of the
statistics.
ML66(config)#show ptp clock-port cp1 statistics
RX TX delta_RX delta_TX
Announce : 80446 0 2 0
Synch : 1287136 0 40 0
Follow up : 0 0 0 0
Delay req : 0 1420264 0 42
Delay resp : 1420264 0 42 0
Pdelay req : 0 0 0 0
Pdelay resp: 0 0 0 0
Signaling : 0 0 0 0

99.194 show ptp config

Synopsis
show ptp config

Description
Use this command to display Precision Time Protocol (PTP) configuration. For
more information, see Configuring Network Time Synchronization.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: General Configuration

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying PTP configuration:
ML66(config)#show ptp config
priority1 128
priority2 128
clock ieee1588v2 boundary unicast bmc
holdover-timeout 3000
domain 0
sync-port disabled
network-synch-assistance enabled
interface 1/6/4 0
interface 1/6/5 0
interface 1/6/6 0
interface 1/1/1 0

1060 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

interface 1/1/2 0
link-delay-compensation 1/6/4 0
link-delay-compensation 1/6/5 0
link-delay-compensation 1/6/6 0
clock-port 1/6/7
!ipaddress 172.16.254.2 vrf 1
ip-interface 1/6/7.1588
dscp 46
delay-mechanism e2e
enabled
unicast-configuration
announce-interval 1
announce-timeout 3
delay-resp-interval -4
delay-resp-timeout 3
duration 300
query-interval 0
sync-interval -4
sync-timeout 3
wait-to-restore-time 5
unicast-master Calnex-1
address udpipv4 192.168.0.2
enabled
exit
exit
exit
clock-port test
port 1/1/1
delay-mechanism e2e
no enabled
unicast-configuration
announce-interval 1
announce-timeout 3
delay-resp-interval -4
delay-resp-timeout 3
duration 300
query-interval 0
sync-interval -4
sync-timeout 3
wait-to-restore-time 5
exit
exit
exit

99.195 show ptp interface

Synopsis
show ptp interface

Description
Use this command to display the available interfaces capable of time-stamping
and their statuses.

The displayed attributes are described in Table 111.

Table 111 The Attributes of the Show PTP Interface Command


L2 Interface The name of the L2 interface (<Rack/Slot/Port>).
Clockport The name of the Precision Time Protocol (PTP) Clock Port
created on the interface.
Admin state The administrative status of the PTP time-stamping unit of
the interface.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1061


CLI Descriptions

Operational The operational status of the PTP time-stamping unit of the


state interface.
L3 Interface The name of the IP interface (<Rack/Slot/Port.VlanId>).
IP address The IP address of the IP interface. This attribute is displayed
only for IP interfaces.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: General Configuration

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the status of the interfaces capable of time-stamping:
ML66#show ptp interface
Timestamping capable interfaces:
L2 Interface Clockport Admin state Operational state
LAN 1/6/4 cp1 UP UP
LAN 1/6/5 cp2 UP UP
WAN 1/1/1 UP UP
L3 Interface IP address Clockport Admin state Operational state
1/6/5.1588 192.168.1.1 1/6/5 UP UP
1/6/6.555 10.1.1.1 UP UP
1/6/6.1588 172.16.254.1 1/6/6 UP UP

99.196 show ptp peers

Synopsis
show ptp peers

Description
Use this command to display the connected peers. Depending on the selected
profile, the Master peer (for example in multicast mode for boundary clocks and
ordinary clock slaves) and/or the slave peers (for example in unicast mode for
boundary clocks and ordinary clock grandmasters) are displayed.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: General Configuration

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

1062 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Examples
Displaying the connected peers:
ML66(config)#show ptp peers

Displaying the connected peers for a unicast master clock-port:


ML66#show ptp peers
SLAVES:
Local Port Name Peer Address Announce Interval Synch Interval
--------------------------------------------------------------------------
cp_master ac:60:b6:9f:a8:1b 1 -4

MASTERS:
Local Port Name Peer Address Grandmaster ClockID Accessible Ti →
mestamping Interface
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------- →
------------------------

Displaying the connected peers for a unicast slave clock-port:


ML66#show ptp peers
SLAVES:
Local Port Name Peer Address Announce Interval Synch Interval
--------------------------------------------------------------------------

MASTERS:
Local Port Name Peer Address Grandmaster ClockID Accessible Ti →
mestamping Interface
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------- →
------------------------
cp_slave ac:60:b6:99:a5:8d AC:60:B6:FF:FE:99:A5:8D Yes Su →
pported LAN 1/9/4

99.197 show ptp sync

Synopsis
show ptp sync

Description
Use this command to display the status of the frequency synchronization signal
that is recovered from the IEEE1588 session and can be used as nominee for the
Network Synchronization function. This is relevant in G.8265.1 profile, where the
admin status is always enabled. In IEEE1588 and G.8275.1 profiles the admin
status is disabled.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Synchronization PTP 1588v2 Commands: General Configuration

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1063


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Displaying the current values and settings of PTP synchronization:
ML66(config)#show ptp sync
PTP sync port:
--------------
Interface name: 1/6/20
Administrative status: enabled
Operational status: healty
Frequency quality: PRC
Network sync assistance: disabled

99.198 show qos

Synopsis
show qos

Description
Use this command to display QoS settings of the interface.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Interfaces

Command Mode
Ethernet interface configuration submode — (config-eth)

Examples
Displaying QoS settings of the interface:
ML66(config-eth)#shoq qos

99.199 show queue-set-profile

Synopsis
show queue-set-profile [<PROFILENUMBER> ]

Description
Use this command to display the queue-set profile settings.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

1064 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

— Ethernet Commands: QoS - Queue-Set

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Operands

PROFILENUMBER
The number of the queue-set profile.

Examples
Displaying all queue-set profile settings:
ML66#show queue-set-profile

99.200 show radius_address_Type

Synopsis
show radius_address_Type

Description
Use this command to display the IP protocol type of the Remote Authentication
Dial In User Service (RADIUS) address.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the IP protocol type of the RADIUS address:
ML66>show radius_address_Type

99.201 show radius-server config

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1065


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
show radius-server config ipaddress <IPADDRESS>

Description
Use this command to display Remote Authentication Dial In User Service
(RADIUS) server configuration.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IPADDRESS The IP address in <A.B.C.D> format.

Options

ipaddress Specifies the IP address.

Examples
Displaying RADIUS server configuration:
ML66>show radius-server config ipaddress 192.168.0.1

99.202 show radius-server statistics

Synopsis
show radius-server statistics ipaddress <IPADDRESS>

Description
Use this command to display Remote Authentication Dial In User Service
(RADIUS) server statistics.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Commands

1066 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IPADDRESS The IP address in <A.B.C.D> format.

Options

ipaddress Specifies the IP address.

Examples
Displaying RADIUS server statistics for RADIUS server IP address 10.58.28.225 :
ML66>show radius-server statistics ipaddress 10.58.28.225
index: 1
ipaddress: 10.58.28.225
AccessRequestSend: 1
AccessRequestResend: 0
AccessRequestAccept: 0
AccessRequestReject: 1
AccessRequestTimeout: 0
AcctRequestSend: 0
AcctRequestResend: 0
AcctRequestAccept: 0
AcctRequestReject: 0
AcctRequestTimeout: 0

99.203 show radius-server status

Synopsis
show radius-server status ipaddress <IPADDRESS>

Description
Use this command to display Remote Authentication Dial In User Service
(RADIUS) server status.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IPADDRESS The IP address in <A.B.C.D> format.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1067


CLI Descriptions

Options

ipaddress Specifies the IP address.

Examples
Displaying RADIUS server status:
ML66>show radius-server status

99.204 show rf-frequency

Synopsis
show rf-frequency

Description
Use this command to display the RF parameters for MMU 1001 and MMU 1002.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Carrier Termination Commands: MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 - Frequency

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Examples
Displaying the RF parameters for MMU 1001 and MMU 1002:
ML66(config-ct)#show rf-frequency
RF Frequency Parameters
-----------------------------------------------
min-tx-frequency[kHz]: 7582000
max-tx-frequency[kHz]: 7638000
min-rx-frequency[kHz]: 7428000
max-rx-frequency[kHz]: 7484000
base-tx-frequency[kHz]: 7581750
base-rx-frequency[kHz]: 7427750
tx-frequency[kHz]: 23303000
rx-frequency[kHz]: 22295000
tx-frequency-step-size[kHz]: 250
tx-step-limit-low: 1
tx-step-limit-high: 225
actual-tx-step-number: 177
tx-oper-status: TxOn(3)
tx-admin-status: On(3)
rx-frequency-step-size[kHz]: 250
rx-step-limit-low: 0
rx-step-limit-high: 0

1068 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

actual-rx-step-number: 0
duplex-distance[kHz]: 1008000

99.205 show rf-power

Synopsis
show rf-power

Description
Use this command to display the RF Power data for MMU 1001 and MMU 1002.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Carrier Termination Commands: MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 - Power

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Examples
Displaying the RF Power data for MMU 1001 and MMU 1002:
ML66(config-ct)#pe9

RF Power parameters
--------------------------------------------
selected-min-output-power[dBm]: -10
selected-max-output-power[dBm]: 10
actual-output-power[dBm]: 4
available-min-output-power[dBm]: -10
available-max-output-power[dBm]: 18
target-input-power-far-end[dBm]: -45
actual-input-power[dBm]: -44
max-input-power-last-7Days[dBm]: 0
min-input-power-last-7Days[dBm]: 0
max-input-power-since-reset[dBm]: -445
min-input-power-since-reset[dBm]: -504
input-power-alarm-threshold[dBm]: -93
output-power-4QAM[dBm]: 18
output-power-16QAM[dBm]: 18
output-power-32QAM[dBm]: 18
output-power-64QAM[dBm]: 18
output-power-128QAM[dBm]: 18
output-power-256QAM[dBm]: 17
output-power-512QAM[dBm]: NotValid
output-power-1024QAM[dBm]: NotValid
output-power-2048QAM[dBm]: NotValid
output-power-4096QAM[dBm]: NotValid
max-output-power-not-limited[dBm]: NotValid
max-output-power-possible[dBm]: 2
mean-input-power-1m[dBm]: -448
max-output-power-last-7Days[dBm]: 0
min-output-power-last-7Days[dBm]: 0
max-output-power-since-reset[dBm]: 3
min-output-power-since-reset[dBm]: 3
available-output-power-type: Standard

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1069


CLI Descriptions

selected-output-power-type: Standard
taps: disabled

99.206 show rlt

Synopsis
show rlt

Description
Use this command to display the Radio Link Terminal (RLT) configuration at near
end.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Radio Link Terminal Commands: MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 - RLT

Command Mode
Near End Radio Link Terminal submode — (config-rlt)

Examples
Displaying the RLT configuration at near end:
ML66(config-rlt)#show rlt
R/S/P: 1/1/1
distinguished-name: RLT 1/1/1
ne-ip-address: 10.120.54.112
ne-ipv6-address:
ne-name: TN-10-120-54-112
ne-type: MINI-LINK Traffic Node
id: RLT 1/1/1
expected-far-end-id:
far-end-id-check: disable
status: down
mode: 2+0RLB
actual-tx-total-capacity[kbps]: 0
actual-tx-packet-capacity[kbps]: 0
limited-total-capacity[kbps]: 0
protection-switch-mode: manual
protection-status: unprotected
revertive-preferred-tx: off
revertive-wait-to-restore[seconds]: 0
fade-notification-timer[seconds]: 200
tx-switch-over-far-end: RLTNOTSUP
aes-encryption-oth-mk:
aes-encryption-oth: other
aes-encryption-oth-status: other

Displaying the RLT configuration at the near end in case of EQP configuration:
ML66(config-rlt)#show rlt
R/S/P: 1/3/1
distinguished-name: RLT 1/1+3/1
ne-ip-address: 10.120.54.112
ne-ipv6-address:
ne-name: ML66-10-120-54-112

1070 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

ne-type: MINI-LINK Traffic Node


id: RLT 1/1+3/1
expected-far-end-id:
far-end-id-check: disable
status: down
mode: 1+1RLP
actual-tx-total-capacity[kbps]: 0
actual-tx-packet-capacity[kbps]: 0
limited-total-capacity[kbps]: 0
protection-switch-mode: manual
protection-status: protected
revertive-preferred-tx: off
revertive-wait-to-restore[seconds]: 0
fade-notification-timer[seconds]: 200
tx-switch-over-far-end: RLTNOTSUP
eqp-protection-switch-mode: manual
eqp-active-unit: low-unit
eqp-distinguished-name: 1/1+3/1
aes-encryption-oth-mk:
aes-encryption-oth: other
aes-encryption-oth-status: other

99.207 show route-map

Synopsis
show route-map [<MAPNAME>]

Description
Use this command to display route-map information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Router Basic Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

MAPNAME The route-map name.

Examples
Displaying route-map information using REGEXP:
ML66>show route-map bgp2
route-map bgp2, permit, sequence 5
Match clauses:
metric 200
Set clauses:
metric 60

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1071


CLI Descriptions

99.208 show router-id

Synopsis
show router-id

Description
Use this command to display the router ID common for OSPF, BGP, LDP, and so
on processes.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Router Basic Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the common router ID:
ML66>show router-id
Router ID: 10.10.10.60 (config)

99.209 show rsvp

Synopsis
show rsvp

Description
Use this command to display RSVP information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— RSVP-TE Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
ML66>show rsvp
RSVP Version : 1

1072 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Process uptime : 3 hours 54 minutes


Bundle Send : Disabled
NSM Connection : Up
CSPF Connection IPv4 : Up
CSPF Connection IPv6 : Down
CSPF usage : Enabled
RSVP Refresh Timer : 30
Keep Multiplier : 3
Acknowledgement Await Timeout : 10
Explicit-Null For Direct Conn : Disabled
Local Protection : Disabled
Hello Interval : 1
Hello Timeout : 3
Loop detection : Enabled (all interface)
Ingress for IPv4 : 192.168.0.2
Ingress for IPv6 : N/A (not in use)
Penultimate Hop Popping : Enabled
Refresh PATH msg parsing : Enabled
Refresh RESV msg parsing : Enabled

99.210 show rsvp admin-groups

Synopsis
show rsvp admin-groups

Description
Use this command to display RSVP Administrative Group information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— RSVP-TE Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
ML66>show rsvp admin-groups
Admin group summary:
Value of 1 associated with admin group 'sample'

99.211 show rsvp interface

Synopsis
show rsvp interface [<IFNAME_RSP_VLAN> ]

Description
Use this command to display RSVP interface information. If an interface is
specified by its name, this command displays information about that interface. If

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1073


CLI Descriptions

no interface is specified, this command displays information about all RSVP


interfaces on the router.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— RSVP-TE Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IFNAME_RSP_VLAN
The Rack, Slot, and Port value and VLAN number of the
L3 VLAN subinterface, where the format is <Rack/Slot/
Port.VLAN> , for example, 1/9/4.500.

Examples
ML66>show rsvp interface
Interface RSVP status Interface Type
1/6/4.1500 Enabled Ethernet

99.212 show rsvp neighbor

Synopsis
show rsvp neighbor [<IPADDR> ]

Description
Use this command to display RSVP neighbor information. If a neighbor is
specified by its IPv4 address, this command displays information about that
neighbor. If no neighbor is specified, this command displays information about all
RSVP neighbors on the router.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— RSVP-TE Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of a neighbor.

1074 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Examples
ML66>show rsvp neighbor

99.213 show rsvp nexthop-cache

Synopsis
show rsvp nexthop-cache

Description
Use this command to display nexthop information cached in RSVP.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— RSVP-TE Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
ML66>show rsvp nexthop-cache

99.214 show rsvp path

Synopsis
show rsvp path [<PATHNAME> ]

Description
Use this command to display RSVP path information. If a path is specified by its
name, this command displays information about that path. If no path is specified,
this command displays information about all RSVP paths on the router.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— RSVP-TE Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1075


CLI Descriptions

Operands

PATHNAME The name of the path.

Examples
ML66>show rsvp path

99.215 show rsvp session

Synopsis
show rsvp session [up | down] [detail]

Description
Use this command to display RSVP session information. If no parameter is
specified, this command displays information about all RSVP sessions.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— RSVP-TE Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Options

up Specifies to display sessions that are currently


operational.

down Specifies to display sessions that are currently non-


operational.

detail Specifies to display detailed information.

Examples
ML66>show rsvp session up detail

99.216 show rsvp session count

1076 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Synopsis
show rsvp session count

Description
Use this command to display the count of existing RSVP sessions on a router.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— RSVP-TE Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
ML66>show rsvp session count

99.217 show rsvp session egress

Synopsis

— show rsvp session egress {up | down} [detail]

— show rsvp session egress <IPADDR>

— show rsvp session egress detail

Description
Use this command to display RSVP sessions that end at the router. If no
parameter is specified, this command displays information about all RSVP
sessions ending at the router.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— RSVP-TE Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of an egress router.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1077


CLI Descriptions

Options

up Specifies to display sessions that are currently


operational.

down Specifies to display sessions that are currently non-


operational.

detail Specifies to display detailed information.

Examples
ML66>show rsvp session egress detail

99.218 show rsvp session ingress

Synopsis

— show rsvp session ingress {up | down} [detail]

— show rsvp session ingress <IPADDR>

— show rsvp session ingress detail

— show rsvp session ingress <LSP-NAME> primary

Description
Use this command to display RSVP sessions that originate from the router. If no
parameter is specified, this command displays information about all RSVP
sessions originating from the router.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— RSVP-TE Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IPADDR The IPv4 address of an ingress router.

LSP-NAME The name of the LSP.

1078 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Options

up Specifies to display sessions that are currently


operational.

down Specifies to display sessions that are currently non-


operational.

detail Specifies to display detailed information.

primary Specifies to display primary sessions.

Examples
ML66>show rsvp session ingress detail

99.219 show rsvp session <LSP-NAME>

Synopsis
show rsvp session <LSP-NAME> [primary]

Description
Use this command to display RSVP sessions for an LSP specified by the LSP
name.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— RSVP-TE Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

LSP-NAME The name of the LSP.

Options

primary Specifies to display primary sessions.

Examples
ML66>show rsvp session sample primary

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1079


CLI Descriptions

99.220 show rsvp session transit

Synopsis
show rsvp session transit [up | down] [detail]

Description
Use this command to display RSVP sessions that pass through the router. If no
parameter is specified, this command displays information about all RSVP
sessions passing through the router.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— RSVP-TE Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Options

up Specifies to display sessions that are currently


operational.

down Specifies to display sessions that are currently non-


operational.

detail Specifies to display detailed information.

Examples
ML66>show rsvp session transit detail

99.221 show rsvp statistics

Synopsis
show rsvp statistics

Description
Use this command to display RSVP statistics.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

1080 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

— RSVP-TE Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
ML66>show rsvp statistics

99.222 show rsvp summary-refresh

Synopsis
show rsvp summary-refresh

Description
Use this command to display RSVP Summary Refresh information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— RSVP-TE Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
ML66>show rsvp summary-refresh

99.223 show rsvp trunk

Synopsis
show rsvp trunk [<NAME> | detail]

Description
Use this command to display RSVP trunk information. If no parameter is
specified, this command displays information about all trunks.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1081


CLI Descriptions

— RSVP-TE Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

NAME The name of the trunk to be displayed.

Options

detail Specifies to display detailed information.

Examples
ML66>show rsvp trunk detail

99.224 show rsvp version

Synopsis
show rsvp version

Description
Use this command to display RSVP version.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— RSVP-TE Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
ML66>show rsvp version

99.225 show rsyslog

Synopsis
show rsyslog

1082 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Description
Use this command to display the remote syslog configuration for alarms and
events.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— DCN Remote Syslog Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the remote syslog configuration:
ML66>show rsyslog
Remote syslog:Enabled
Trap severities=0x60
(0x80=indeterminate,0x40=critical,0x20=major,0x10=minor,0x08=warning,0x04=cleared)
Remote servers:
1: 192.168.0.1 514
2: 0
3: 0

See Also
rsyslog

99.226 show rsyslog6

Synopsis
show rsyslog6

Description
Use this command to display the remote syslog configuration for alarms and
events for IPv6.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— DCN Remote Syslog Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1083


CLI Descriptions

Examples
Displaying remote syslog configuration for IPv6:
ML66>show rsyslog6

99.227 show rsyslogsec

Synopsis
show rsyslogsec

Description
Use this command to display the remote syslog configuration for security events.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Remote Syslog Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples

Table 112 Displayed Information of the Security Events


Any Events Mask 0x0 No event is selected in
the specific group.
Events Mask Localauth 0xfc All local authentication
events are selected.
Events Mask Login 0xf0 All login events are
selected.
Events Mask Protocols 0xff All secure protocol
events are selected.
Events Mask Tacacs+ 0xf0 All TACACS+ events are
selected.
Events Mask Radius 0xf0 All RADIUS events are
selected.

Displaying remote syslog configuration for security events:


ML66#show rsyslogsec
Remote security syslog:Disabled
Remote IPv4 servers:
1: 0
2: 0
3: 0

1084 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Events Mask Localauth 0x0


Events Mask Login 0x0
Events Mask Protocols 0x0
Events Mask Tacacs+ 0x0
Events Mask Radius 0x0

ML66#show rsyslogsec
Remote security syslog:Enabled
Remote IPv4 servers:
1: 10.120.58.18 514
2: 0
3: 0
Events Mask Localauth 0xfc
Events Mask Login 0xf0
Events Mask Protocols 0xff
Events Mask Tacacs+ 0xf0
Events Mask Radius 0xf0

99.228 show rsyslogsec6

Synopsis
show rsyslogsec6

Description
Use this command to display the remote syslog configuration for security events
for IPv6.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Remote Syslog Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples

Table 113 Displayed Information of the Security Events


Any Events Mask 0x0 No event is selected in
the specific group.
Events Mask Localauth 0xfc All local authentication
events are selected.
Events Mask Login 0xf0 All login events are
selected.
Events Mask Protocols 0xff All secure protocol
events are selected.
Events Mask Tacacs+ 0xf0 All TACACS+ events are
selected.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1085


CLI Descriptions

Events Mask Radius 0xf0 All RADIUS events are


selected.

Displaying remote syslog configuration for security events:


ML66#show rsyslogsec6
Remote security syslog:Disabled
Remote IPv6 servers:
1: 0
2: 0
3: 0
Events Mask Localauth 0x0
Events Mask Login 0x0
Events Mask Protocols 0x0
Events Mask Tacacs+ 0x0
Events Mask Radius 0x0

ML66#show rsyslogsec6
Remote security syslog:Enabled
Remote IPv6 servers:
1: 2001:1:1::18 514
2: 0
3: 0
Events Mask Localauth 0xfc
Events Mask Login 0xf0
Events Mask Protocols 0xff
Events Mask Tacacs+ 0xf0
Events Mask Radius 0xf0

99.229 show running-config

Synopsis
show running-config [MAP_ENTRY | <CONFIG_ORDER>]

Description
Use this command to display the currently running configuration file.

Running the command without any parameters, the whole running configuration
is displayed, including the configuration of the router.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #<

Operands

MAP_ENTRY Sequence number of the saved configuration parameter


map. The valid range is 0–45.

CONFIG_ORDER Global order number of the configuration. The length is 4


digits, for example, 0003.

Examples
Displaying the currently running configuration file:

1086 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

ML66#show running-config
! EH (global order: 0001; local order: 0) :------
! EH configuration
telecom_standard etsi
! command group end
! LH (global order: 0003; local order: 0) :------
! LH Configuration
ftp svrs name "remotehost" …?

Note: The output from this command can be very long. The example above
includes just a small part of the actual output.

99.230 show running-config router

Synopsis
show running-config router [access-list | as-path access-list | bgp |
isis | key chain | ldp | mpls | ospf | rsvp | rsvp-path | rsvp-trunk
[<TRUNKNAME>]]

Description
Use this command to display the currently running configuration of the router.

If no parameter is specified, the whole router configuration is displayed.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Operands

TRUNKNAME The name of the RSVP trunk. If no trunk is specified, the


configurations for all the trunks are displayed.

Options

access-list Displays the current configuration of access-list entries.

as-path access-list
Displays the current configuration of Border Gateway
Protocol Autonomous System (BGP AS) path access lists.

bgp Displays the current configuration of BGP.

isis Displays the current configuration of the IS-IS routing


protocol.

key chain Displays the current configuration of encryption key


chains.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1087


CLI Descriptions

ldp Displays the current configuration of Label Distribution


Protocol (LDP).

mpls Displays the current configuration of Multiprotocol Label


Switching (MPLS).

ospf Displays the current configuration of Open Shortest Path


First (OSPF).

rsvp Displays the current configuration of Resource


Reservation Protocol (RSVP).

rsvp-path Displays the current configuration of RSVP paths.

rsvp-trunk Displays the current configuration of RSVP trunks.

Examples
ML66(config-router)>show running-config router isis
router isis
is-type level-1
metric-style wide
net 49.0001.0400.4004.0040.00

99.231 show rx-frequency

Synopsis
show rx-frequency

Description
Use this command to display the Rx frequency for MMU 1001 and MMU 1002.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Carrier Termination Commands: MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 - Frequency

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Examples
Displaying the Rx frequency for MMU 1001 and MMU 1002:
ML66(config-ct)#show rx-frequency
rx-frequency[kHz]: 22295000

1088 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

99.232 show scheduler-profile

Synopsis
show scheduler-profile [<PROFILENUMBER> ]

Description
Use this command to display scheduler profiles.

Executing the command without <PROFILENUMBER> operand lists all scheduler


profiles. Executing the command with <PROFILENUMBER> operand displays the
contents of the profile with that specified profile number.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: QoS - Scheduling

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

PROFILENUMBER
The unique index of the scheduler profile.

Examples
Displaying scheduler profiles:
ML66>show scheduler-profile 2

99.233 show secure-ssh

Synopsis
show secure-ssh

Description
Use this command to display the status of the file ssh-server security function.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Commands

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1089


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode, at admin level — #

Examples
Displaying the status of the file ssh-server security function:
ML66#show secure-ssh
secure SSH configuration enabled

99.234 show sfph

Synopsis
show sfph {sfpinfo {current <SLOT/SUBSLOT> | minmax <SLOT/SUBSLOT> |
minmax15mhistory <SLOT/SUBSLOT> {all | interval <INTERVALNUMBER>}
| minmax24hhistory <SLOT/SUBSLOT> {all | current | previous} | reset
<SLOT/SUBSLOT> {all | minmax}} | alarms | boards | subslots | subslot
<SLOT/SUBSLOT> | config}

Description
Use this command to display Small Form-Factor Pluggable (SFP) information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— SFP Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

INTERVALNUMBER
The number of the selected interval.

SLOT/SUBSLOT The Slot and Subslot values of the SFP where the format
is <Slot/Subslot>.

Options

sfpinfo Displays SFP subslot information.

current Displays the currently measured data.

minmax Displays the absolute minimum and maximum


measurements of the SFP since the last power-on or SFP
plug-in.

1090 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

minmax15mhistory
Displays the minimum and maximum measurements of
the SFP for the last 24 hours, in 15-minute intervals.

all Displays information for all intervals.

interval Displays information for the selected interval.

minmax24hhistory
Displays the minimum and maximum measurements of
the SFP for both the current and previous 24-hour
intervals.

previous Displays the previous intervals.

reset Clears the minimum and maximum measurements


history.

alarms Displays the active alarms of the existing SFP subslots.

boards Displays the number of the available SFP slots and their
status in each slot.

subslots Displays information of all SFP subslots.

subslot Displays information of the selected SFP subslot.

config Displays the running SFP configuration.

Examples
Displaying the currently measured data of an SFP in subslot 6/6:
ML66#show sfph sfpinfo current 6/6
SFP 1/6.6:
Current data measured at: Sat Feb 25 07:47:37 2017
Vendor name: DELTA
Vendor OUI: 00-00-00
Vendor Part Number: LCP-1250B4QDRT-E
Vendor Revision: A
Saleable Entity Code: RDH90120/D0210
Vendor Serial Number: 113404100091
Identifier: 0x03
Extended identifier: 0x04
Tranceiver code: 0x0000000200000000
Manufacturing date: 11082301
Product number: RDH90120/D0210
Revision: R4A
Temperature: 33.15 C
Voltage: 3.344 V
Tx Bias: 0.000 mA
Tx Power: 0.000 mW
Rx Power: 0.000 mW

Displaying the absolute minimum and maximum measurements of the SFP in


subslot 6/6, measured since the last power-on or SFP plug-in:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1091


CLI Descriptions

ML66#show sfph sfpinfo minmax 6/6


SFP 1/6.6:
Collecting since: Thu Feb 23 12:07:30 2017
Minimum Temperature: 31.48 C
Maximum Temperature: 33.99 C
Minimum Voltage: 3.340 V
Maximum Voltage: 3.347 V
Minimum Tx Bias: 0.000 mA
Maximum Tx Bias: 0.000 mA
Minimum Tx Power: 0.000 mW
Maximum Tx Power: 0.000 mW
Minimum Rx Power: 0.000 mW
Maximum Rx Power: 0.000 mW

Displaying the minimum and maximum measurements of the SFP in subslot 6/6
for the last 24 hours in 15-minute intervals (excerpt):
ML66#show sfph sfpinfo minmax15mhistory 6/6 all
SFP 1/6.6:
Min. Max. Min. Max. Min. Max. Mi →
n. Max. Min. Max.
Is Temp. Temp. Voltage Voltage TxBias TxBias Tx →
Power TxPower RxPower RxPower
No. Interval Time Valid [C] [C] [V] [V] [mA] [mA] [m →
W] [mW] [mW] [mW]
--- ------------- ----- ------- ------- ------ ------ ------- ------- -- →
----- ------- ------- -------
1 07:30-07:45 Yes 32.32 33.15 3.340 3.344 0.000 0.000 0. →
000 0.000 0.000 0.000
2 07:15-07:30 Yes 32.32 33.15 3.340 3.344 0.000 0.000 0. →
000 0.000 0.000 0.000
3 07:00-07:15 Yes 31.48 33.15 3.340 3.344 0.000 0.000 0. →
000 0.000 0.000 0.000
4 06:45-07:00 Yes 32.32 33.15 3.340 3.344 0.000 0.000 0. →
000 0.000 0.000 0.000
5 06:30-06:45 Yes 32.32 33.15 3.340 3.344 0.000 0.000 0. →
000 0.000 0.000 0.000
6 06:15-06:30 Yes 32.32 33.15 3.340 3.344 0.000 0.000 0. →
000 0.000 0.000 0.000
7 06:00-06:15 Yes 32.32 33.15 3.340 3.344 0.000 0.000 0. →
000 0.000 0.000 0.000
8 05:45-06:00 Yes 31.48 33.15 3.340 3.344 0.000 0.000 0. →
000 0.000 0.000 0.000
9 05:30-05:45 Yes 32.32 33.15 3.340 3.344 0.000 0.000 0. →
000 0.000 0.000 0.000
10 05:15-05:30 Yes 32.32 33.15 3.340 3.344 0.000 0.000 0. →
000 0.000 0.000 0.000

Displaying the status of all SFP subslots:


ML66#show sfph subslots
Slot 6: state
subslot 6: IDLE
subslot 7: IDLE
subslot 8: IDLE

99.235 show slot-capacity

Synopsis
show slot-capacity

Description
Use this command to display the maximum supported, respectively the allocated
backplane Ethernet capacity between the NPU and APU slots.

1092 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying slot capacity:
ML66#show slot-capacity
Slot Slot Ethernet Capacity (Gbps) APU Allocated Ethernet Capacit →
y (Gbps)
1 2.5 + 2.5 MMU 1002 2.5 + 2.5
2 10 | 2.5 + 2.5 + 2.5 + 2.5 MMU 1002 2.5 + 2.5
4 2.5 + 2.5
5 2.5 + 1

99.236 show snmpv3authprotocol

Synopsis
show snmpv3authprotocol

Description
Use this command to display the SNMPv3 authentication protocol.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the SNMPv3 authentication protocol:
ML66#show snmpv3authprotocol
xfSecuritySNMPv3AuthProtocol = md5

99.237 show snmpv3privprotocol

Synopsis
show snmpv3privprotocol

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1093


CLI Descriptions

Description
Use this command to display the SNMPv3 privacy protocol.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the SNMPv3 privacy protocol:
ML66#show snmpv3privprotocol
xfSecuritySNMPv3PrivProtocol = des

99.238 show snmpv3protocol

Synopsis
show snmpv3protocol

Description
Use this command to display the SNMPv3 data encryption type.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the SNMPv3 data encryption type:
ML66#show snmpv3protocol
xfSecuritySNMPv3Protocol = noPriv

1094 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

99.239 show spanning-tree

Synopsis
show spanning-tree [<RSP>]

Description
Use this command to display the spanning-tree configuration.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— Ethernet Commands: RSTP

— Ethernet Commands: MSTP

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

RSP The Rack, Slot, and Port values of the port, where the
format is <Rack/Slot/Port>.

Examples
Displaying the spanning-tree configuration (excerpt):
ML66>show spanning-tree
spanning-tree : enabled
stp type : rstp
protocol spec : IEEE 802.1d
priority : 32768
designated root : 80:00 90:55:AE:75:F1:EF
root cost : 20000
root port : LAN 1/6/4
max age : 2000
hello time : 200
forward-delay : 1500
br max-age : 2000
br hello time : 200
br fwd-delay : 1500
version : rstp
tx holdcount : 6
topology change : 68500
top changes : 9
LAN 1/6/4 : enabled
port number : 2
priority : 128
state : forwarding
role : root
designated root : 80:00 90:55:AE:75:F1:EF
designated cost : 0
designated bridge : 80:00 90:55:AE:75:F1:EF
designated port : 80:02
path cost : 20000
autoedge : enabled
mac-enable : true
admin-edgeport : false

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1095


CLI Descriptions

oper-edgeport : false
admin ptp : auto
oper ptp : true
admin path cost : 0
fwd transitions : 1

99.240 show spectrum-diagnostics-result

Synopsis
show spectrum-diagnostics-result

Description
Use this command to display the measured values of the latest sub-band or
channel scan. The table displays the scanned Rx frequencies and the measured
Received Signal Strength Indicator (RSSI) values.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Carrier Termination Commands: MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 - Spectrum


Diagnostics

Command Mode
Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

Examples
ML66(config-ct)#show spectrum-diagnostics-result
Spectrum Diagnostics result
+--------------------------------------+
| Rx Frequency (MHz) Rx Power (dBm) |
+--------------------------------------+
15287.000 -95.9
15289.000 -95.9
15291.000 -95.9
15293.000 -95.6
15295.000 -95.6
15297.000 -95.6
15299.000 -95.6
15301.000 -95.6
15303.000 -95.6
15305.000 -95.6
15307.000 -95.6
15309.000 -95.6
15311.000 -95.6
15313.000 -95.6

99.241 show spectrum-diagnostics-status

Synopsis
show spectrum-diagnostics-status

1096 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Description
Use this command to display the status of sub-band and channel scans.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Carrier Termination Commands: MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 - Spectrum


Diagnostics

Command Mode
Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

Examples
ML66(config-ct)#show spectrum-diagnostics-status
Spectrum Diagnostics status
-------------------------------------------------------------
Oper status: Channel scan finished
Channel scan estimated time (sec): 17
Sub-band scan estimated time (sec): 71
Last completed scan time: 2018-09-12T13:35:44
Channel spacing (kHz): 28000
Current Rx frequency (MHz): 15300.000
Minimum sub-band Rx frequency: (MHz) 15055.000
Maximum sub-band Rx frequency: (MHz) 15348.000

99.242 show startup-config

Synopsis
show startup-config [<MAP_ENTRY> | <CONFIG_ORDER> | router]

Description
Use this command to display the start-up configuration file in a readable format.
This file is stored in the permanent memory.

Running the command without any parameters, the whole start-up configuration
is displayed.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Operands

MAP_ENTRY The sequence number of the saved configuration


parameter map. The valid range is 0–45.

CONFIG_ORDER The global order number of the configuration. The length


is 4 digits, for example, 0003.

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1097


CLI Descriptions

Options

router Displays the start-up configuration of the router.

Examples
Displaying the start-up configuration file:
ML66#show startup-config
! EH configuration
telecom_standard etsi
! command group end
! LH configuration

Note: The output from this command can be very long. The example above
includes just a small part of the actual output.

99.243 show status

Synopsis
show status

Description
Use this command to display status information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following sections:

— Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Maintenance Domain Configuration

— Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Maintenance Association Configuration

— Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Maintenance End Point and Maintenance


Intermediate Point Configuration

— Ethernet Service OAM Commands: Linktrace and Loopback Configuration

— Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Ring Protection

— CES Commands

Command Mode
Ethernet Service OAM submode — (cfm)

Ethernet Service OAM MD submode — (cfm-md)

Ethernet Service OAM MD MA submode — (cfm-md-ma)

Ethernet Service OAM MD MA MEP submode — (cfm-md-ma-mep)

1098 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Ethernet Ring Protection Group submode — (erp-group)

CES TDM Profile configuration submode — (config-ces-tdm-profile).

Examples
Displaying status information:
ML66(cfm)#show status

Displaying information about the current Ethernet Ring Protection (ERP) ring
status:
ML66(erp-group)#show status
Ring ID: 1 ENABLED
-----------------------------------------------------------
Description: erp-ring-1
Ring status: Signal failure present
Ports
-----------------------------------------------------------
Interface Role Local Remote
EAST: 1/6/4 normal Idle SF BLOCKED
WEST: 1/6/8 normal Idle SF
RAPS
-----------------------------------------------------------
VLAN Priority MDL Subring VRAPS
100 7 7 Yes

Traffic VLANS
-----------------------------------------------------------
none
Guard time: 2000 ms
Hold-off time: 0 ms
Performance data
-----------------------------------------------------------
Collected since: Fri Apr 28 08:21:34 2017
Link failure: 1
RPL failure: 0
Manual switch: 0
Forced switch: 0
Notifications
-----------------------------------------------------------
Link loss: enabled
Unable to protect: disabled
Protocol error: enabled

Displaying the status of the current CES TDM profile configuration:


ML66(config-ces-tdm-profile)#show status
CES TDM Config profile details
Index 1
Name IWF loop
Payload size 256 bytes
Jitter buffer size 7 pkt
1792 bytes
1792.000 ms
Jitter buffer playout level 3 pkt
768 bytes
3.000 ms
Payload-suppression disabled
LOPS clear threshold 10 pkt
LOPS set threshold 10 pkt
Packet reorder enabled
Packet replace policy Fill with 0xFF bytes

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1099


CLI Descriptions

Clock recovery mode Adaptive


Used by Pseudo Wire(s) 1/1/101 3, 1/1/101 4

99.244 show strongpasswd

Synopsis
show strongpasswd

Description
Use this command to display the status of the strong password enforcement.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying strong password enforcement:
ML66>show strongpasswd

99.245 show subrack

Synopsis
show subrack <RACK>

Description
Use this command to display the configuration information for a subrack.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

RACK The number of the rack.

1100 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Examples
Displaying subrack information for rack 1:
ML66#show subrack 1
MINI-LINK 6693 BFL
0
3 |---o|-#o#-PFU 1301-|---#o#-NPU 1002---| 6
2 |FAU |-###------------|-###------------| 5
1 |1301|-###------------|-#o#-LTU 1001---| 4
0 BFB 109 046/1
1
2
3 ROJ 119 2519/1 [ROJ 119 2519/1 P1A]
4 ROJ 119 2515/1 [ROJ 119 2515/1 P1A]
5
6 ROJ 208 1323/1 [ROJ 208 1323/1 P1E]

99.246 show system

Synopsis
show system { restart | mode | hw }

Description
Use this command to display the state information for the system.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Options

restart Displays restart state of the system.

mode Displays mode state of the system.

hw Displays hardware state of the system.

Examples
Displaying restart state of the system:
ML66>show system restart

99.247 show sys_notes

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1101


CLI Descriptions

Synopsis
show sys_notes

Description
Use this command to display the added information related to the site.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Basic Configuration Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the added information related to the site:
ML66>show sys_notes
This is notes for the node

99.248 show tacacs_address_Type

Synopsis
show tacacs_address_Type

Description
Use this command to display the IP protocol type of the Terminal Access
Controller Access Control System Plus (TACACS+) address.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the IP protocol type of the TACACS+ address:
ML66>show tacacs_address_Type

1102 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

99.249 show tacacs-server config

Synopsis
show tacacs-server config ipaddress <IPADDRESS>

Description
Use this command to display Terminal Access Controller Access-Control System
Plus (TACACS+) server configuration.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IPADDRESS The IP address in <A.B.C.D> format.

Options

ipaddress Specifies the IP address.

Examples
Displaying TACACS+ server configuration:
ML66>show tacacs-server config ipaddress 192.168.0.1

99.250 show tacacs-server statistics

Synopsis
show tacacs-server statistics ipaddress <IPADDRESS>

Description
Use this command to display Terminal Access Controller Access Control System
Plus (TACACS+) server statistics.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1103


CLI Descriptions

— Security Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IPADDRESS The IP address in <A.B.C.D> format.

Options

ipaddress Specifies the IP address.

Examples
Displaying TACACS+ server statistics for TACACS+ server IP address
10.58.25.225:
ML66>show tacacs-server statistics ipaddress 10.58.25.225
index: 1
ipaddress: 10.58.25.225
ActiveSession: 0
PacketTransmitted: 0
PacketReceived: 0
ConnectionError: 13
TransmitError: 0
ReceiveError: 0
AcctPacketTransmitted: 0
AcctPacketReceived: 0
AcctConnectionError: 0
AcctTransmitError: 0
AcctReceiveError: 0
AuthenTimeout: 0
AuthorTimeout: 0
AcctTimeout: 0

99.251 show tacacs-server status

Synopsis
show tacacs-server status ipaddress <IPADDRESS>

Description
Use this command to display Terminal Access Controller Access Control System
Plus (TACACS+) server status.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Commands

1104 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

IPADDRESS The IP address in <A.B.C.D> format.

Options

ipaddress Specifies the IP address.

Examples
Displaying TACACS+ server status:
ML66>show tacacs-server status

99.252 show taps

Synopsis
show taps

Description
Use this command to display Traffic Aware Power Save (TAPS) configuration
status.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Carrier Termination Commands: MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 - Power

Command Mode
Global Configuration mode — (config)

Examples
Displaying TAPS configuration status:
ML66(config)#show taps
Traffic Aware Power Save (TAPS) configuration
---------------------------------------------
slot 1:
CT 1: TAPS disabled
CT 2: TAPS disabled
slot 3:
CT 1: TAPS disabled

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1105


CLI Descriptions

99.253 show tdm

Synopsis
show tdm

Description
Use this command to display information regarding TDM at near end.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Radio Link Terminal Commands: MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 - TDM

Command Mode
Near End Radio Link Terminal TDM submode — (config-rlt-tdm)

Examples
Displaying TDM information at near end:
ML66(config-rlt-tdm)#show tdm
R/S/P: 1/1/1
tdm-connect: enable
actual-tdm-tributaries: 0
wanted-tributaries-allocation: 1-10
actual-tributaries-allocation: 0
rx-loop: disable
distinguished-name: TDM 1/1/1
available-tdm-tributaries: 34

99.254 show tdm-interfaces

Synopsis
show tdm-interfaces <SLOT>

Description
Use this command to display all the available TDM interfaces that can be used in
cross-connection for a specific slot.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— TDM Cross-Connection Commands

— CES Commands

1106 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

SLOT The slot number.

Examples
Displaying the available TDM interfaces for slot 11:
ML66>show tdm-interfaces 11
TDM interfaces on slot 1/11 for board ROJ 119 2518/1
--- 1/11/101 1 ---
--- 1/11/4A ---
--- 1/11/4B ---
--- 1/11/4C ---
--- 1/11/4D ---
--- 1/11/3A ---
--- 1/11/3B ---
--- 1/11/3C ---
--- 1/11/3D ---
--- 1/11/2A ---
--- 1/11/2B ---
--- 1/11/2C ---
--- 1/11/2D ---
--- 1/11/1A ---
--- 1/11/1B ---
--- 1/11/1C ---
--- 1/11/1D ---

99.255 show temp

Synopsis
show temp

Description
Use this command to display the following information for each equipped board
slot in the NE:

— Temperature measured by the board temperature sensor.

— High temperature threshold, which is defined for each board type. When the
threshold is reached, High Temperature alarm is raised.

— Excessive temperature threshold, which is defined for each board type. When
the threshold is reached, the board is shut down as a hardware protection
action.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Commands

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1107


CLI Descriptions

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the temperature measured by the board temperature sensor:
ML66>show temp

99.256 show timezone

Synopsis
show timezone

Description
Use this command to display the time zone currently set.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Basic Configuration Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying the time zone:
ML66>show timezone
Europe/Stockholm

See Also
timezone

99.257 show twamp sessions

Synopsis
show twamp sessions

1108 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Description
Use this command to display the configured TWAMP sessions.

Note: Disabled TWAMP sessions are also displayed when this command is
executed.

DSCP values are also displayed if DSCP is enabled.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Examples
Displaying the configured TWAMP sessions:
ML66#show twamp sessions
twamp timestamp-source ieee1588
twamp-reflector-light 1 1/6/5.10 862
twamp-reflector-light 5 1/6/5.10 889
twamp-reflector-light 5 use-dscp 23
twamp-reflector-light 5 disable

99.258 show twamp statistics

Synopsis
show twamp statistics {global | <SESSION_ID>}

Description
Use this command to display TWAMP statistics.

Command Mode
Privileged Exec mode — #

Operands

SESSION_ID The unique ID of a particular TWAMP session. The valid


range is 1–4294967295.

Options

global Specifies to display a sum of the statistics of all TWAMP


sessions.

Examples
Displaying a sum of the statistics of all TWAMP sessions:

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1109


CLI Descriptions

ML66#show twamp statistics global


last reset: 2018-06-21 15:42:08
received packets: 20
received bytes: 2200
handled packets: 20
sent packets: 20
sent bytes: 2120

Displaying the statistics of the TWAMP session with session number 20:
ML66#show twamp statistics 20
twamp-reflector-light session 20 (enabled) ip interface: 1/6/5.6 - ip address: 10. →
41.103.15 - udp port: 908
last reset: 2018-08-07 11:24:03
received packets: 20
received bytes: 2200
handled packets: 20
sent packets: 20
sent bytes: 2120

99.259 show tx-frequency

Synopsis
show tx-frequency

Description
Use this command to display the Tx frequency for MMU 1001 and MMU 1002.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Carrier Termination Commands: MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 - Frequency

Command Mode

— Near End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct)

— Far End Carrier Termination submode — (config-ct-far)

Examples
Displaying the Tx frequency for MMU 1001 and MMU 1002:
ML66(config-ct)#show tx-frequency
tx-frequency[kHz]: 23303000

99.260 show userio

Synopsis
show userio

1110 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Description
Use this command to display user Input/Output (I/O) configuration and status of
the NPU.

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying user I/O configuration and status of the NPU:
ML66>show userio

99.261 show version

Synopsis
show version

Description
Use this command to display software and hardware revision information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Installation Mode Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Examples
Displaying software and hardware revision information:
ML66#show version
Active SBL : CXP: 9036600/1 MINI-LINK 6600 6366 1.3 R4D209
Passive SBL : CXP: 9036600/1 MINI-LINK 6600 6366 1.3 R4C250
NPU Passive SW : CXP: 9029630/1 R4C250
Active BNS : CXCR: 102 007/2 -debug - Sep 27 2017
Subrack : MINI-LINK Traffic Node - MINI-LINK 6693 R2A
CPU : e5500
CPU Clock : 1000.000000MHz
CPU Revision : 2.1 (pvr 8024 1021)
CPU BogoMips : 50.00
Memory : 0MB
Mode : OPERATIONAL
Last Restart Reason : Node warm restart issued by management
Last Restart Time : 09:19:26, August 10, 2017
Uptime : 5 hours, 7 minutes, 10 seconds

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1111


CLI Descriptions

99.262 show vlan

Synopsis
show vlan [<ID> ]

Description
Use this command to display VLAN configuration.

Use the command without <ID> operand to display all VLAN configurations.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: Ethernet Bridging and Switching

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Operands

ID Identifier of the VLAN.

Examples
Displaying the VLAN configuration:
ML66>show vlan 3

99.263 show wred-profile

Synopsis
show wred-profile [<PROFILENUMBER> ]

Description
Use this command to display Weighted Random Early Detection (WRED) profiles.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Ethernet Commands: QoS - WRED

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

1112 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Show Commands

Operands

PROFILENUMBER
The unique index of the WRED profile.

Examples
Displaying WRED profiles:
ML66>show wred-profile 2

99.264 show x

Synopsis
show x { crashlog | syslog | tail-syslog }

Description
Use this command to display log information.

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Security Commands

Command Mode
Exec mode — >

Options

crashlog Displays the FLASH crash-log.

syslog Displays the whole syslog.

tail-syslog Displays the last part of the syslog.

Examples
Displaying the whole syslog:
ML66>show x syslog

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1113


CLI Descriptions

99.265 show xpic

Synopsis
show xpic

Description
Use this command to display information regarding the XPIC pair associated
with the Radio Link Terminal (RLT).

The related configuration commands can be found in the following section:

— Radio Link Terminal Commands: MMU 1001 and MMU 1002 - XPIC

Command Mode
Near End Radio Link Terminal XPIC submode — (config-rlt-xpic)

Examples
Displaying XPIC information:
ML66(config-rlt-xpic)#show xpic
R/S/P: 1/1/1
xpic-member1: CT 1/1/2
xpic-member2: CT 1/1/2
mode: enable
recovery: disable
auto-restore: disable
number: 34

1114 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Appendix

100 Appendix

100.1 DCN over IPv4 Address Limitations


Table 114 displays DCN over IPv4 address limitations for the different interfaces.

Table 114 DCN over IPv4 Address Limitations


Interface
IPv4 Address
Node Host LAN-DCN LO-DCN
Link-local Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
addresses (subnet use use use
with
169.254.0.0/16)
Loopback Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
addresses (subnet use use use
with
127.0.0.0/8)
Multicast Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
addresses (subnet use use use
with
224.0.0.0/4)
Reserved Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
addresses (subnet use use use
with
240.0.0.0/4)
NAT64/DNS64 Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
Discovery use use use
addresses (subnet
with
192.0.0.170/31)
6to4 Relay Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
Anycast use use use
addresses (subnet
with
192.88.99.0/24)
Documentation Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
(TEST-NET-1) use use use
addresses (subnet
with
192.0.2.0/24)
Documentation Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
(TEST-NET-2) use use use
addresses (subnet
with

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1115


CLI Descriptions

Interface
IPv4 Address
Node Host LAN-DCN LO-DCN
198.51.100.0/2
4)
Documentation Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
(TEST-NET-3) use use use
addresses (subnet
with
203.0.113.0/24)
Network address, Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
which is the use use use
lowest address in
the subnet
Broadcast Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
address, which is use use use
the highest
address in the
subnet
Default host Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
address use use use
(192.168.0.1/24
)
"This host on this Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
network" address use use use
(0.0.0.0/8)
An address within Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
the default subnet use use use
of the Local
Access interface
(10.0.0.0/30)
Ping Target Host Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
address use use use
The address of Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
any other active use use use
interface (LO-
DCN, LAN-DCN,
Local Access)
Addresses within Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
a subnet already use use use
used by any other
active interface
(LO-DCN, LAN-
DCN, Local
Access)

1116 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30


Appendix

100.2 DCN over IPv6 Address Limitations


Table 115 displays DCN over IPv6 address limitations for the different interfaces.

Table 115 DCN over IPv6 Address Limitations


Interface
IPv6 Address Node Host LAN-DCN Local Access
(USB)
Global unicast Allowed to use(1) Allowed to use (1) Allowed to use (1)
addresses
Odd IPv6 Allowed to use Allowed to use Not allowed to
addresses use(2)
IPv4 compatible Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
addresses, using use use use
legacy format
(::a.b.c.d)
IPv4 mapped Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
addresses, for use use use
example ::ffff:
10.0.0.5
Loopback address Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
(::1/128) use use use
because it is not a
global unicast
address
Link-local Not allowed to Allowed to use Allowed to use
addresses (all use
addresses starting
with fe80::/8)
Multicast Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
addresses (all use use use
addresses starting
with ff00::/8)
Site-local Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
addresses (all use use use
addresses starting
with fec::/10)
IPv4-embedded Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
IPv6 addresses use use use
(all addresses
starting with
64:ff9b::/96)
IETF Protocol Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
Assignments use use use
addresses (all

54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30 1117


CLI Descriptions

Interface
IPv6 Address Node Host LAN-DCN Local Access
(USB)
addresses starting
with 2001::/23)
Benchmarking Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
addresses (all use use use
addresses starting
with
2001:2::/48)
Documentation Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
addresses (all use use use
addresses starting
with
2001:db8::/32)
Overlay Routable Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
Cryptographic use use use
Hash Identifiers
(ORCHID)
addresses (all
addresses starting
with
2001:10::/28)
The address of Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
IPv6 Ping Target use use use
Host
The address of Not allowed to Not allowed to Not allowed to
any other active use use use
interface (LO-
DCN, LAN-DCN,
Local Access)
An address within Not allowed to Not allowed to Allowed to use
the default Local use use
Access (USB)
subnet
(2001:db8::/127
)
An address within Not allowed to Not allowed to Allowed to use
the configured use use
Local Access
(USB) subnet
(1) Only global unicast addresses are allowed to use.
(2) Only set even IP address (odd pair is for the USB client).

1118 54/1551-HRA 901 20/11-V80 Uen L | 2019-08-30

You might also like